Ic21 CPPC 06000 0921
Ic21 CPPC 06000 0921
Ic21 CPPC 06000 0921
Product Catalog
usa.siemens.com/controls
Index Things to Know About the Catalog
Product Overview
SIRIUS Monitor
Pilot Lights & Stations; 8WD Signal Columns 10
Function Relays – 3RN Thermistor Motor Protection; 3RP & 7PV Timers;
Control Circuit Components
3RS Temperature Monitoring Relays & Converters; 3RQ Coupling Relays;
3UG Monitoring Relays; 3TG Power Relays; 3TX71 & LZS Plug-in Relays
11
Terminal blocks –
8WA / 8WH Terminal Blocks
8WA Special Label Marking Instructions
12
Limit Switches – 3SE5 (IEC) & 3SE03 (NEMA)
Safety – 3SE5 Hinge & Interlock, 3SE6 Magnet, and 3SE7
Cable-operated Switches; 3SK & 3TK28 Safety Relays; 3RK3 MSS
13
AS-Interface – 6GK7 Masters; 3RK Slaves, I/O Modules, & Safety
Modules; 3SF2 Cable Pull, 3SF1 Limit & Interlock Switches
IO-Link – 6ES7 Masters; 3RK Input Modules
14
Programmable Relays – LOGO! 6ED Modular Relays
Power Supplies – SITOP 6EP Power Supplies
Ethernet Switches – 6GK Unmanaged Ethernet Switches
15
Control Circuit Protection 5SJ4 Miniature Circuit Breakers to UL 489
5SP & 5SY Supplementary Protectors to UL 1077
3NW7 Fuse Holders to UL 512
16
Circuit Breakers 120/240 V Lug In/Lug Out and DIN Rail Breakers
15 to 3200A Molded Case Circuit Breakers 17
Switches Safety Switches – VBII
Enclosed Switches – VBII & 3LD2
Disconnect Switches – 3LD, CFS, CNFS, MCS & VBII
18
Appendix - General Information UL and CSA File & Guide Numbers; On-line References;
General Information; Spring-Loaded Terminal Overview;
ICE Quick Reference List
19
(Section was last modified on 01/10/22) Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog
Index
Navigation All page references are linked. Click on the For accessories, see page 2/66.
page number to navigate to that page.
Price units (PU) The price unit defines the number of units, sets or lengths
to which the price and weight apply.
Packaging sizes (PS) The packaging size defines the number of units, sets or length, for outer packaging.
Only the quantity defined by the packaging size or a multiple thereof can be ordered.
Symbols
On many selection pages in this catalog, Connections Combicon connection
you will find these symbols to aid in the quick
identification of critical product features. Insulation piercing method
Fast Connect
Spring-type terminals
Flat connectors
Screw terminals
Modular system
The 3RE4 enclosed IEC family includes contactors and starters in NEMA 1,
3/3R/4/12 or 4X enclosures.
The SIRIUS 3RM motor starters are compact, 22.5mm wide devices for
mounting in the control cabinet. The failsafe versions eliminate the need for
redundant controllers in safety applications. The ET 200SP motor starters
are an integral part of the ET 200SP I/O system and mount directly to the
rack.
The ET 200pro and SIRIUS M200D are enclosed controllers that connect to a
variety of communication protocols.
3RW30 – Basic performance Soft Starters up to 75HP with built-in bypass contacts.
3RW40 – Basic performance Soft Starters up to 75HP with overload protection
and device self protection
3RW50 – Basic performance Soft Starters from 100 to 400 HP with soft torque
and communication options
3RW52 – General performance Soft starters from 100 to 400 HP with options
for plug-in HMI and communication modules
3RW55 – High performance Soft starters from 7.5 to 1000 HP with HMI,
autoparameterization and plug-in communication modules
Class 73 – Non-Combination Enclosed Soft Starters
Class 74 – Combination Enclosed Soft Starters with circuit breaker or fusible
disconnect
6SL32 – SINAMICS G120X Variable Frequency Drives
3SB2 – 16mm SIRIUS Pilot Devices for applications where panel space is a
premium
3SU1 – 22mm SIRIUS ACT Pilot Devices offer maximum flexibility, industry best
time install savings and environmental ratings in round-metal and round-plastic
versions
Class 52 – 30mm is the classic pushbutton design for the NEMA markets offering
both standard die cast metal and the ultra rugged BLACK MAX for corrosion
resistant applications
8WD – Signal Columns offer twist and connect technology in both 50mm and
70mm diameter styles. Single element signal beacons add additional options for
OEMs and panel builders
SITOP offers a broad offering of compact single- and 3-phase switched mode
power supplies and 24VDC power security components, which provide reliable
solutions for the most common power interruptions, helping to minimize
downtimes and increase the efficiency of production.
Section 18 Switches
Siemens offers a complete line of both enclosed and open style switches to meet
a wide range of applications.
HF & HNF – Heavy Duty Safety Switches with Side Mounted Operating Handle
3LD2 – UL508 Open & Enclosed Rotary Switches (16-250A)
3LD3 – UL508 Compact Open Rotary Switches (16-63A)
3LD5 – UL489 Compact Open Rotary Switches (30-150A)
VBF & VBNF – Open Switches with Flange Mounted Operating Handle
MCS – Open Switches with Flange or Rotary Operating Handle
CFS – Open Compact Fusible Switches with Rotary Operating Handle
CNFS – Open Compact Non-fusible Switches with Rotary Operating Handle
contents
1 SIRIUS
Section
1
Section Overview 1/2 – 1/3
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Motor Starter Protectors
3RV20 MSP, Class 10/20 1/4 – 1/5
3RV21 MSP, Class 10 1/6 – 1/7
3RV10 MSP, Class 10 1/8
Circuit Breakers
3RV27, 3RV28 Circuit Breaker UL 489 1/9
Accessories
Auxiliary Switches 1/10
Auxiliary Releases 1/10
Busbars 1/11
Mounting Accessories 1/12 – 1/15
Rotary Operating Mechanisms 1/16 – 1/17
3RV29 Infeed System 1/18 – 1/21
General Data for Motor Starter Protectors
Manual Motor Starter Ratings 1/22
Group Installation Ratings 1/23
Combination Motor Controller Ratings 1/24
3RV27 and 3RV28 Circuit Breaker Ratings 1/25
Export Application Ratings 1/26 – 1/27
Rules for Mounting 1/28
Technical Data 1/29 – 1/32
Overview of MSP Functions & Applications 1/33
Application as a Combination Motor Controller 1/34
Application in DC Switching 1/35
Design 1/35
Characteristics 1/36
Circuit Diagrams 1/36
Dimensions 1/37 – 1/40
General Data for Accessories
Mountable Accessories
Overview 1/41 – 1/42
Circuit Diagrams 1/43 – 1/41
Dimensions 1/44
Busbar Accessories
Overview 1/45
Dimensions 1/46 – 1/47
Operating Mechanisms
Overview 1/48
Circuit Diagrams 1/49
Dimensions 1/49 – 1/50
Enclosures & Front Plates
Overview 1/51
Dimensions 1/52
Spring Terminal Infeed System
Design 1/53
Technical Data 1/53
Dimensions 1/54
(Section was last modified on 08/19/21) Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/1
IEC Power Control SIRIUS
Motor Starter Protectors
contents
1
Size S00, S0
For motor protection For motor protection General data for SIRIUS
CLASS 10 CLASS 20 motor starter protectors
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data Page
Size Rated Current Page Size Rated Current Page Technical data 1/22
S00 up to 16 A 1/4 S2 up to 65 A 1/5 Overview 1/32
S0 up to 40 A 1/4 S3 up to 100 A 1/5 Characteristics 1/36
S2 up to 65 A 1/5 Circuit diagrams 1/36
S3 up to 100 A 1/5 Dimension drawings 1/37
1/2 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
IEC Power Control SIRIUS
Accessories
contents
1
Accessories for motor starter
3RV busbar and
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
protectors with Spring-Type Mounting Accessories
accessories
terminals
Page Page
Selection and ordering data 1/17 Selection and ordering data 1/17
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/3
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
For Motor Protection
3RV20 Class 10 — up to 40A
The 3RV20x MSPs are UL approved as Self Protected Combination Motor Controllers E ON/OFF rotary handle with lockout and
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
which are also called Type E. In this application, all the required functions for a motor visible trip indication.
branch are provided in one device: disconnect, short circuit protection, motor control and E Adjustment dial for setting to motor FLA.
overload protection. A type E terminal adaptor is required for screw terminal versions. E Class 10 overload trip characteristics.
3RV20x MSPs with spring terminal can only be applied as Type E when used in the E Short circuit trip at 13 times the maximum
3RV29 Infeed System. . The 3RV20x MSPs are also approved for use as follows: setting of the FLA adjustment dial.
– Manual Motor Controller: Motor starter, motor disconnect, control and overload— E Short circuit current rating:
protection. E Ambient compensated up to 140° F
– Group Installation: Motor starter only, motor disconnect, control and overload (applies to side by side mounting).
protection. E Phase loss sensitivity.
– Tap conductor Protection in Group Installation acc. NEC: Motor starter only; E Test trip function.
motor disconnect, control and overload protection. E Terminal versions: screw, spring, ring lug.
When the 3RV20x is used with one of the 3 above mentioned approvals, the 3RV20x can E Auxiliaries and Accessories
be installed downstream of one circuit breaker or fuse set. see pages 1/10–1/21.
E General Information see pages 1/33–1/36.
For more detailed application information and rules how to apply, size and rate the E Technical Data see pages 1/22–1/32.
3RV20x in control panels in general, in group installations or in accordance to interna- E Dimensions see page 1/37–1/40.
tional IEC standards visit our website: www.usa.siemens.com/controlpaneldesign
Note: Select MSP by motor Full Load Amperes. Horsepower ratings are for reference only.
Instant- UL short-
aneous circuit
Single-Phase Three-Phase
1) short breaking
HP Ratings HP Ratings
FLA circuit capacity Size S00 2) 4) Size S0 2) 4)
Adjustment release @ 277V/
Illustration Range [A] 115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V [A] 480V [kA] Order Number Order Number
0.11-0.16 — — — — — — 2.1 65 3RV2011-0AA●● 3RV2021-0AA●●
0.14-0.2 — — — — — — 2.6 65 3RV2011-0BA●● 3RV2021-0BA●●
0.18-0.25 — — — — — — 3.3 65 3RV2011-0CA●● 3RV2021-0CA●●
0.22-0.32 — — — — — — 4.2 65 3RV2011-0DA●● 3RV2021-0DA●●
0.28-0.4 — — — — — — 5.2 65 3RV2011-0EA●● 3RV2021-0EA●●
0.35-0.5 — — — — — — 6.5 65 3RV2011-0FA●● 3RV2021-0FA●●
0.45-0.63 — — — — — — 8.2 65 3RV2011-0GA●● 3RV2021-0GA●●
0.55-0.8 — — — — — — 10 65 3RV2011-0HA●● 3RV2021-0HA●●
0.7-1 — — — — — ½ 13 65 3RV2011-0JA●● 3RV2021-0JA●●
0.9-1.25 — — — — ½ ½ 16 65 3RV2011-0KA●● 3RV2021-0KA●●
1.1-1.6 — 1⁄10 — — ¾ ¾ 21 65 3RV2011-1AA●● 3RV2021-1AA●●
1.4-2 — 1⁄8 — — ¾ 1 26 65 3RV2011-1BA●● 3RV2021-1BA●●
1.8-2.5 — 1⁄6 ½ ½ 1 1½ 33 65 3RV2011-1CA●● 3RV2021-1CA●●
2.2-3.2 1⁄10 ¼ ½ ¾ 1½ 2 42 65 3RV2011-1DA●● 3RV2021-1DA●●
2.8-4 1⁄8 1⁄3 ¾ ¾ 2 3 52 65 3RV2011-1EA●● 3RV2021-1EA●●
3.5-5 1⁄6 ½ 1 1 3 3 65 65 3RV2011-1FA●● 3RV2021-1FA●●
4.5-6.3 ¼ ½ 1 1½ 3 5 82 65 3RV2011-1GA●● 3RV2021-1GA●●
5.5-8 1⁄3 1 2 2 5 5 104 65 3RV2011-1HA●● 3RV2021-1HA●●
7-10 ½ 1½ 2 3 5 7½ 130 65 3RV2011-1JA●● 3RV2021-1JA●●
9-12.5 ½ 2 3 3 7½ 10 163 65 3RV2011-1KA●● 3RV2021-1KA●●
10-16 1 2 3 5 10 — 208 65 3RV2011-4AA●● 3RV2021-4AA●●
13-20 1½ 3 5 5 10 — 260 65 — 3RV2021-4BA●●
16-22 1½ 3 5 7½ 15 — 286 65 — 3RV2021-4CA●●
18-25 2 3 5 7½ 15 — 325 65 — 3RV2021-4DA●●
23-28 2 5 7½ 10 20 — 364 50 — 3RV2021-4NA●●
27-32 2 5 7½ 10 20 — 400 50 — 3RV2021-4EA●●
3) 5)
30-36 3 5 10 10 25 — 432 12 — 3RV2021-4PA●●
3) 5)
34-40 3 7½ 10 10 30 — 480 12 — 3RV2021-4FA●●
Screw terminals, no auxiliary: ●● = 10
Screw Terminals, with 1NO/1NC Aux:●● = 15
Spring terminals, no auxiliary: ●● = 20
Spring Terminals, with 1NO/1NC Aux: ●● = 25
Ring Lug Terminals, no Auxiliary: ●● = 40
1) Select motor starter protector by motor full load amps. tion motor controller, a Type E terminal is required. 4) 3RV2 MSPs can only be used with Innovations
Horsepower ratings for reference only. See accessories page 1/10. contactors and accessories
2) The motor starter protectors rated up to 32 A can be 3) These products are NOT certified as Type E combi- 5) Spring and Ring Lug terminals are not available
used as manual motor controllers or as Type E combi- nation motor controllers. They can only be used as
nation motor controllers. For use as a Type E combina- manual motor controllers.
1/4 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
For Motor Protection
3RV10 Class 10 & 20 — up to 100A
1
The 3RV203 / 204 MSPs are UL approved as Self Protected Combination Motor Controllers E ON/OFF rotary handle with lockout and
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
which are also called Type E. In this application, all the required functions for a motor branch visible trip indication.
are provided in one device: disconnect, short circuit protection, motor control and overload E Adjustment dial for setting to motor FLA.
protection. A type E terminal adaptor is required for all screw terminal version S2 frame E Class 10 overload trip characteristics.
3RV2031 above 45A and all S2 frame 3RV2032 as well as for all S3 frame motor starter E Short circuit trip at 13 times the maximum
protectors. Spring terminal MSPs can only be applied as Type E when used in the 3RV29 setting of the FLA adjustment dial.
Infeed System. E Short circuit current rating:
E Ambient compensated up to 140° F
The 3RV203 / 204 MSPs are also approved for use as follows:
(applies to side by side mounting).
– Manual Motor Controller: Motor starter, motor disconnect, control and overload protection.
E Phase loss sensitivity.
– Group Installation: Motor starter only, motor disconnect, control and overload protection.
E Test trip function.
– Tap conductor Protection in Group Installation acc. NEC: Motor starter only; motor
E Auxiliaries and Accessories see
disconnect, control and overload protection.
pages 1/10–1/21.
When the 3RV203 / 204 is used with one of the 3 above mentioned approvals, they can be E General Information see pages 1/33–1/36.
installed downstream of one circuit breaker or fuse set. E Technical Data see pages 1/22–1/32.
E Dimensions see page 1/37–1/40.
For more detailed application information and rules how to apply, size and rate these MSPs in
control panels in general, in group installations or in accordance to international IEC standards
visit our website: www.usa.siemens.com/controlpaneldesign
Note: Select MSP by motor Full Load Amperes. Horsepower ratings are for reference only.
Single Phase 3 Phase UL short-
1) 1)
HP rating HP Rating Inst. circuit
FLA Short- breaking
Adjustment Circuit capacity Trip Class 10 Trip Class 20
Range Release @ 277V/
Illustration [A] 115V 240V 200V 230V 460V 575V [A] 480V [kA] 6) Order Number4) Order Number4)
1) Select motor starter protector by motor full load amps. 3) Shaded ratings apply for group installation only. These ratings 6) For 100kA SCCR rated MSPs, change the part
Horsepower ratings for reference only. do not apply as UL listed manual combination starters. number from 3RV2031 to 3RV2032. (applies to
2) Size S2 and S3 are listed as type E combination motor 4) Pre-assembled motor starter protector and transverse S2 frame only through 65A).
controllers. For required Type E terminals see page 1/13. auxiliary switch with 1NO + 1NC is available. Replace the last 7) Suitable for use with IE3/IE4 motors up to a
3RV2031 MSPs with a current setting limit of 45A or less digit of the order no. with a “5”. starting current of 720A. For higher starting
do not require a type E terminal and fulfill the spacing 5) 3RV1 MSPs can only be used with 3RT1 contactors currents use size S3.
requirements of UL508. and accessories. 3RV2 MSPs can only be used with 3RT2
contactors and accessories.
Refer to pages 1/22 to 1/24 when using an MSP in a Manual Motor Starter or a Manual Self-Protected Combination Motor Controller.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/5
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers
3RV21 Class 10 — up to 32A with overload relay function (automatic RESET) IE3/IE4 ready
The 3RV21x MSPs are UL approved as Self Protected Combination Motor Controllers which E ON/OFF rotary handle with lockout and
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
are also called Type E. In this application, all the required functions for a motor branch are visible trip indication.
provided in one device: disconnect, short circuit protection, motor control and overload protec- E Adjustment dial for setting to motor FLA.
tion. A type E terminal adaptor is required for screw terminal versions. 3RV20x MSPs with E Class 10 overload trip characteristics.
spring terminal can only be applied as Type E when used in the 3RV29 Infeed System. The E Short circuit trip at 13 times the maximum
3RV21x MSPs are also approved for use as follows: setting of the FLA adjustment dial.
– Manual Motor Controller: Motor starter, motor disconnect, control and overload E Short circuit current rating:
protection. E Ambient compensated up to 140° F
– Group Installation: Motor starter only, motor disconnect, control and overload protection. (applies to side by side mounting).
– Tap conductor Protection in Group Installation acc. NEC: Motor starter only; E Phase loss sensitivity.
motor disconnect, control and overload protection. E Test trip function.
When the 3RV21x is used with one of the 3 above mentioned approvals, the 3RV21x E Terminal versions: screw only.
can be installed downstream of one circuit breaker or fuse set. E Auxiliaries and Accessories see
pages 1/10–1/21.
For more detailed application information and rules how to apply, size and rate the 3RV21x E General Information see pages 1/33–1/36.
in control panels in general, in group installations or in accordance to international IEC stan- E Technical Data see pages 1/22–1/32.
dards visit our website: www.usa.siemens.com/controlpaneldesign E Dimensions see page 1/37–1/40.
Note: Select MSP by motor Full Load Amperes. Horsepower ratings are for reference only.
Single-Phase Three-Phase
Setting range 1) UL short-
HP Ratings HP Ratings
for thermal Instantaneous circuit break-
overload electronic ing capacity
Illustration release 115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V release [A] @ 480V [kA] Catalog Number
2) 3)
Size S00
0.11 ... 0.16 — — — — — — 2.1 100 3RV2111-0AA10
0.14 ... 0.2 — — — — — — 2.6 100 3RV2111-0BA10
0.18 ... 0.25 — — — — — — 3.3 100 3RV2111-0CA10
0.22 ... 0.32 — — — — — — 4.2 100 3RV2111-0DA10
0.28 ... 0.4 — — — — — — 5.2 100 3RV2111-0EA10
0.35 ... 0.5 — — — — — — 6.5 100 3RV2111-0FA10
0.45 ... 0.63 — — — — — — 8.2 100 3RV2111-0GA10
0.55 ... 0.8 — — — — — — 10 100 3RV2111-0HA10
0.7 ... 1 — — — — — ½ 13 100 3RV2111-0JA10
0.9 ... 1.25 — — — — ½ ½ 16 100 3RV2111-0KA10
1.1 ... 1.6 — 1⁄10 — — ¾ ¾ 21 100 3RV2111-1AA10
1.4 ... 2 — 1⁄8 — — ¾ 1 26 100 3RV2111-1BA10
3RV2111-4FA10 1.8 ... 3RV2111-0BA10
2.5 — 1⁄6 ½ ½ 1 1½ 33 100 3RV2111-1CA10
2.2 ... 3.2 1⁄10 ¼ ½ ¾ 1½ 2 42 100 3RV2111-1DA10
2.8 ... 4 1⁄8 1⁄3 ¾ ¾ 2 3 52 100 3RV2111-1EA10
3.5 ... 5 1⁄6 ½ 1 1 3 3 65 100 3RV2111-1FA10
4.5 ... 6.3 ¼ ½ 1 1½ 3 5 82 100 3RV2111-1GA10
5.5 ... 8 1⁄3 1 2 2 5 5 104 100 3RV2111-1HA10
7 ... 10 ½ 1½ 2 3 5 7½ 130 100 3RV2111-1JA10
9 ... 12.5 ½ 2 3 3 7½ 10 163 100 3RV2111-1KA10
105) ... 16 1 2 3 5 10 — 208 55 3RV2111-4AA10
Size S02) 3)
A10 3RV2111-0BA10 105) ... 16 1½ 3 5 5 10 — 208 55 3RV2121-4AA10
135) ... 20 1½ 3 5 7½ 15 — 260 55 3RV2121-4BA10
165) ... 22 2 3 5 7½ 15 — 286 55 3RV2121-4CA10
185) ... 25 2 5 7½ 10 20 — 325 55 3RV2121-4DA10
23 ... 284) 3 5 10 10 25 — 364 55 3RV2121-4NA10
27 ... 324) 5) 6) 3 7½ 10 10 30 — 400 55 3RV2121-4EA10
1) Select motor starter protector by motor full load amps. combination motor controller, a Type E terminal is 6) Suitable for use with IE3/IE4 motors up to a starting
Horsepower ratings are for reference only. required. See accessories page 1/10. current of 256 A. For higher starting currents we
2) Accessories for mounting on the right and 3RV2915 4) These products are NOT certified as Type E combination recommend using 3RV2 motor starter protectors size S2.
three-phase busbars cannot be used. Accessories can motor controllers. They can only be used as manual 7) 3RV2 MSPs can only be used with Innovations
be ordered separately. motor controllers. contactors and accessories.
3) The motor starter protectors rated up to 32 A can 5) The setting range of the thermal overload releases has
be used as manual motor controllers or as Type E been extended.
combination motor controllers. For use as a Type E
1
The 3RV2131/2142 MSPs are UL approved as Self Protected Combination Motor Controllers E ON/OFF rotary handle with lockout and
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
which are also called Type E. In this application, all the required functions for a motor visible trip indication.
branch are provided in one device: disconnect, short circuit protection, motor control and E Adjustment dial for setting to motor FLA.
overload protection. A type E terminal adaptor is required for all screw terminal version E Class 10 overload trip characteristics.
S2 frame 3RV2131 above 45A as well as for all S3 frame motor starter protectors. Spring E Short circuit trip at 13 times the maximum
terminal MSPs can only be applied as Type E when used in the 3RV29 Infeed System.
setting of the FLA adjustment dial.
The 3RV2131/2142 MSPs are also approved for use as follows: E Short circuit current rating:
– Manual Motor Controller: Motor starter, motor disconnect, control and overload E Ambient compensated up to 140° F
protection. (applies to side by side mounting).
– Group Installation: Motor starter only, motor disconnect, control and overload protection. E Phase loss sensitivity.
– Tap conductor Protection in Group Installation acc. NEC: Motor starter only; motor E Test trip function.
disconnect, control and overload protection.
E Terminal versions: screw only.
When the 3RV2131/2142 is used with one of the 3 above mentioned approvals, they can be E Auxiliaries and Accessories
installed downstream of one circuit breaker or fuse set. see pages 1/10–1/21.
For more detailed application information and rules how to apply, size and rate these E General Information see pages 1/33–1/36.
MSPs in control panels in general, in group installations or in accordance to international E Technical Data see pages 1/22–1/32.
IEC standards visit our website: www.usa.siemens.com/controlpaneldesign E Dimensions see page 1/37–1/40.
Note: Select MSP by motor Full Load Amperes. Horsepower ratings are for reference only.
Single-Phase Three-Phase
Setting range 1) UL short-
HP Ratings HP Ratings
for thermal Instantaneous circuit break-
overload electronic ing capacity
Illustration release 115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V release [A] @ 480V [kA] Catalog Number
2)
Size S2
9.5 ... 14 1.5 3 5 5 10 15 208 65 3RV2131-4SA10
12 ... 17 1.5 3 5 7.5 15 15 260 65 3RV2131-4TA10
14 ... 20 1.5 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 260 65 3RV2131-4BA10
18 ... 25 2 5 7.5 10 20 25 325 65 3RV2131-4DA10
22 ... 32 3 5 10 10 25 30 416 65 3RV2131-4EA10
28 ... 36 3 7.5 15 15 30 40 520 65 3RV2131-4PA10
32 ... 40 3 7.5 15 15 30 40 585 65 3RV2131-4UA10
35 ... 45 3 10 15 15 40 50 650 65 3RV2131-4VA10
42 ... 52 5 10 15 20 40 50 741 65 3RV2131-4WA10
49 ... 59 5 15 20 25 50 60 845 65 3RV2131-4XA10
54 ... 65 5 15 20 25 50 60 845 65 3RV2131-4JA10
3RV2131-4WB10 3RV2142-4FA10
62 ... 73 7.5 15 25 30 60 75 949 65 3RV2131-4KA10
70 ... 804) 7.5 15 25 30 60 75 1040 65 3RV2131-4RA10
Size S3 with increased switching capacity2)
28 ... 40 3 7.5 15 15 30 40 520 55 3RV2142-4FA10
36 ... 50 5 10 15 20 40 50 650 55 3RV2142-4HA10
45 ... 63 5 15 20 25 50 60 819 55 3RV2142-4JA10
57 ... 75 7.5 15 25 25 60 75 975 55 3RV2142-4KA10
65 ... 84 7.5 15 25 30 60 75 1170 55 3RV2142-4RA10
3)
75 ... 93 7.5 20 30 40 75 100 1300 55 3RV2142-4YA10
3)
80 ... 1005) 10 25 40 40 75 100 1300 55 3RV2142-4MA10
WB10 3RV2142-4FA10
1) Select motor starter protector by motor full load amps. 4) Suitable for use with IE3/IE4 motors up to a starting 6) Size S2 and S3 are listed as type E combination motor
Horsepower ratings are for reference only. current of 720 A. For higher starting currents we controllers. For required Type E terminals see page
2) Accessories for mounting on the right and 3RV2915 recommend using 3RV2 motor starter protectors size S3. 1/10. 3RV2031 MSPs with a current setting limit of 45A
three-phase busbars cannot be used. Accessories can 5) Suitable for use with IE3/IE4 motors up to a starting or less do not require a type E terminal and fulfill the
be ordered separately. current of 780 A. For higher starting currents we spacing requirements of UL508.
3) Shaded ratings apply for group installation only. These recommend using 3VA circuit breakers. 7) 3RV2 MSPs can only be used with 3RT2 contactors and
ratings do not apply as UL listed manual combination accessories.
starters.
The 3RV101 MSP’s, can be used as components in Group Installation E ON/OFF rocker mechanism with lockout.
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
per NEC 430-53(C) to turn motors on and off. Each device has built-in E Adjustment dial for setting to motor FLA.
heater elements that provide overload protection and magnetic trip E Class 10 overload trip characteristics.
elements to protect the motor. When the 3RV101 is used as a
E Short circuit trip at 12 times the maximum setting of the
FLA adjustment dial.
component in Group Installation, multiple MSP’s can be installed
E Short circuit current rating:
below one circuit breaker to protect its own motor. A contactor can E Ambient compensated up to 140° F
be mounted to the MSP to provide a remotely operated starter.
(applies to side by side mounting).
E Phase loss sensitivity.
E Test trip function.
E Cage Clamp version.
E Terminal versions: screw, spring, ring lug.
E Auxiliaries and Accessories see pages 1/10–1/21.
E General Information see pages 1/33–1/36.
E Technical Data see pages 1/22–1/32.
E Dimensions see page 1/37–1/40.
Note: Select MSP by motor Full Load Amperes. Horsepower ratings are for reference only.
Single-Phase Three-Phase
FLA HP Ratings HP Ratings1) Instantaneous UL short-circuit Screw
Adjustment short circuit breaking capacity connection
Illustration Range [A] 115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V release [A] @ 480V [kA] Catalog Number
1) Select MSP by motor full load amps. Horse power 3) Shaded ratings apply for group installation only.
ratings for reference only. These ratings do not apply as UL listed manual
2) Size S00 MSP are listed for group installation only. combination starters.
1
Selection and ordering data
For Motor For Transformer
Protection 2) Protection 3)
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Thermal Short Circuit Instant- Instant-
overload breaking capacity aneous Order aneous Order
Rated release [kA] Over Number Over Number
Cur- (non-ad- Current Current
1)
rent justable) 480 480Y/ 600Y/ Release (Screw Weight Release (Screw Weight
[A] [A] VAC 277VAC 347VAC [A] Terminals) [kg] [A] Terminals) [kg]
Innovations Frame Size S00 4)
0.16 0.16 — 65 10 2.1 3RV2711-0AD10 0.390 3.3 3RV2811-0AD10 0.390
0.2 0.2 — 65 10 2.6 3RV2711-0BD10 0.390 4.2 3RV2811-0BD10 0.390
0.25 0.25 — 65 10 3.3 3RV2711-0CD10 0.390 5.2 3RV2811-0CD10 0.390
0.32 0.32 — 65 10 4.2 3RV2711-0DD10 0.390 6.5 3RV2811-0DD10 0.390
0.4 0.4 — 65 10 5.2 3RV2711-0ED10 0.390 8.2 3RV2811-0ED10 0.390
0.5 0.5 — 65 10 6.5 3RV2711-0FD10 0.390 10 3RV2811-0FD10 0.390
0.63 0.63 — 65 10 8.2 3RV2711-0GD10 0.390 13 3RV2811-0GD10 0.400
0.8 0.8 — 65 10 10 3RV2711-0HD10 0.390 16 3RV2811-0HD10 0.450
1 1 — 65 10 13 3RV2711-0JD10 0.450 21 3RV2811-0JD10 0.450
1.25 1.25 — 65 10 16 3RV2711-0KD10 0.450 26 3RV2811-0KD10 0.460
1.6 1.6 — 65 10 21 3RV2711-1AD10 0.460 33 3RV2811-1AD10 0.460
2 2 — 65 10 26 3RV2711-1BD10 0.460 42 3RV2811-1BD10 0.460
2.5 2.5 — 65 10 33 3RV2711-1CD10 0.460 52 3RV2811-1CD10 0.460
3.2 3.2 — 65 10 42 3RV2711-1DD10 0.460 65 3RV2811-1DD10 0.460
4 4 — 65 10 52 3RV2711-1ED10 0.450 82 3RV2811-1ED10 0.460
5 5 — 65 10 65 3RV2711-1FD10 0.460 104 3RV2811-1FD10 0.460
6.3 6.3 — 65 10 82 3RV2711-1GD10 0.460 130 3RV2811-1GD10 0.460
8 8 — 65 10 104 3RV2711-1HD10 0.460 163 3RV2811-1HD10 0.460
10 10 — 65 10 130 3RV2711-1JD10 0.460 208 3RV2811-1JD10 0.460
12.5 12.5 — 65 10 163 3RV2711-1KD10 0.460 260 3RV2811-1KD10 0.460
15 15 — 65 — 208 3RV2711-4AD10 0.470 286 3RV2811-4AD10 0.470
Innovations Frame Size S0 4)
20 20 — 50 — 260 3RV2721-4BD10 0.514 325 3RV2821-4BD10 0.516
22 22 — 50 — 286 3RV2721-4CD10 0.516 364 3RV2821-4CD10 0.528
Innovations Frame Size S3 5)
10 10 65 — 20 150 3RV2742-5AD10 0.460 — — —
15 15 65 — 20 225 3RV2742-5BD10 0.460 — — —
20 20 65 — 20 260 3RV2742-5CD10 0.460 — — —
25 25 65 — 20 325 3RV2742-5DD10 0.460 — — —
30 30 65 — 20 390 3RV2742-5ED10 0.460 — — —
35 35 — 65 20 455 3RV2742-5FD10 0.460 — — —
40 40 — 65 20 520 3RV2742-5GD10 0.460 — — —
45 45 — 65 20 585 3RV2742-5HD10 0.460 — — —
50 50 — 65 20 650 3RV2742-5JD10 0.460 — — —
60 60 — 65 20 780 3RV2742-5LD10 0.460 — — —
70 70 — 65 10 910 3RV2742-5QD10 0.460 — — —
1) 100 % rated value acc. to UL 489 and IEC 60947-2 4) Transverse and lateral auxiliary switches can be ordered busbars. Up until now it was limited to standard 3RV20
(100 % rated breaker). separately (see “Mountable accessories”). MSPs. These new approvals will greatly enhance appli-
2) Circuit breakers for system protection of motor and non- 5) Transverse auxiliary switches must not be mounted. cation flexibility for customers. Not only can they use the
motor loads. Requires use of separate overload protec- Lateral auxiliary switches can be ordered separately (see bus systems to feed motor loads, they can now feed
tion for motor applications. “Mountable accessories”). non-motor loads which should allow the bus systems
to feed complete control panel applications. Customers
3) Circuit breakers for system and transformer protection 6) Siemens now has UL/CSA approvals for using the
will need to remove the line side terminals on any 3RV27
according to UL/CSA. Specially designed for transform- 3RV27 and 3RV28 UL489 Circuit Breakers with the
or 28s that will be fed by the bus system. Contact your
ers with high inrush current. 3RV2917 Infeed System and with the 3RV1915 comb-
Siemens representative for more information.
Refer to page 1/25 when using as upstream protection of a Manual Motor Controller or a Manual Motor Controller Suitable for Tap Conductor Protection in
Group Installations.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/9
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Accessories
Auxiliaries and Accessories
1
Auxiliary switches 3)
mm Innovations
3RV2901-1E Transverse auxiliary 1 CO S00, S0, S2, 3RV2901-1D
switches 1 NO + 1 NC S3 1), 2) 3RV2901-1E
2 NO 1) 3RV2901-1F
1) This product is also available with spring terminals. The 3) Each motor starter protector can be fitted with one 5) One auxiliary release can be mounted at the right of
order no. must be changed in the 8th position to a transverse and one lateral auxiliary switch. The lateral each MSP. motor starter protector.
“2”:e.g. 3RV1901-2E or 3RV2901-2E auxiliary switch 2 NO + 2 NC is used without trans-
6) The response voltage at the lower limit of the voltage
verse auxiliary switch.
2) This product is also available with ring lug terminals. The range at 0.85 (Tu=60°C) is valid for 100% (infinite)
order no. must be changed in the 8th position to a “4”: 4) One signaling switch can be mounted at the left of the
7) The response voltage at the lower limit of the voltage
e.g. 3RV2901-4E motor starter protector. This accessory cannot be used
range at 0.9 (Tu=60°C) applies for a duty cycle of 5
on the 3RV27 and 3RV28 circuit breakers.
seconds at AC 50/60 Hz and DC.
1/10 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Accessories
Mounting accessories
1
Modu- Number of motor starter Rated For motor Order No. Order Weight
lar protectors that can be current starter quantity approx.
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
spac- connected In at protectors
ing Without Incl. With 690 V Size
lateral lateral auxil-
acces- auxil- iary trip
sories iary unit
switch
mm A kg
Three-phase busbar systems for Classic and Innovations
For feeding several motor starter protectors with screw
terminals, mounted side-by-side on standard mounting
rails, insulated, with touch protection.
3RV19 15-1AB
45 2 -- -- 63 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-1AB 1 unit 0.044
3 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-1BB 1 unit 0.071
4 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-1CB 1 unit 0.099
5 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-1DB 1 unit 0.124
3RV19 15-1BB 55 -- 2 -- 63 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-2AB 1 unit 0.048
3 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-2BB 1 unit 0.079
4 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-2CB 1 unit 0.111
5 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-2DB 1 unit 0.140
63 -- -- 2 63 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-3AB 1 unit 0.052
3RV19 15-1CB
4 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-3CB 1 unit 0.120
55 2 -- -- 108 S23) 3RV19 35-1A 1 unit 0.150
3 S23) 3RV19 35-1B 1 unit 0.214
4 S23) 3RV19 35-1C 1 unit 0.295
3RV19 15-1DB 75 -- 2 2 108 S2 3RV19 35-3A 1 unit 0.161
3 3 S2 3RV19 35-3B 1 unit 0.262
4 4 S2 3RV19 35-3C 1 unit 0.369
1) Not suitable for 3RV21 motor starter protectors with overload relay 2) Not suitable for 3RV UL 489 circuit breakers.
function. The 3RV1915-5DB connecting piece is available for connecting 3) Auxiliary trip units and lateral auxiliary switches cannot be used in combi-
motor starter protectors from size S0 to size S00. nation.
1) Do not mix 3RV1 Classic Accessories with 3RV2 2) Do not mix 3RV2 Innovations Accessories with 3RV1 3) This terminal is connected in place of a switch, please
Innovations MSPs Classic MSPs take the space requirement into account.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/11
3RV Motor
Motor Starter
Starter Protectors
Protectors/Circuit Breakers
SIRIUS
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 80 A
Accessories
Accessories
Mounting accessories
Mounting accessories
Overview
1
00
408 3RW30 soft S00 S00 3RA2921- 3RA2911-
1_
IC0 starters 1BA00 2GA00
S0 S00 --
3RW30/ S0 S0 3RA2921- 3RA2921-
SIRIUS 3RV2938-1K phase barrier* 3RW40 1BA00 2GA00
soft starters S00 S0 --
* These accessories are only for screw terminals and mount on top of MSPs
S22) S22) 3RA2931- --
and are not for use on spring terminals which are located on the front of MSPs. 1AA00
If screw terminal MSPs and spring terminal contactors are preferred, a 3RF34 solid- S00/S0 S00 3RA2921- --
hybrid link module can be utilized. See note 3. state contac- 1BA00
tors
Motor starter Size Essential accessories Hybrid link modules for connecting contactors with spring-type
protectors/ for "Self-Protected Combination terminals to 3RV2 motor starter protectors/circuit breakers with
circuit breakers Motor Controllers (Type E)" according screw terminals3)
to UL 508/UL 60947-4-1
3RT2 contac- S00 S00 3RA2911- --
3RV201., 3RV202. S00/S0 3RV2928-1H terminal block or tors with AC or 2FA00
3RV2928-1K phase barrier DC coil S0 S0 3RA2921- --
3RV2031-4B1., S2 -- 2FA00
3RV2031-4D.1.,
3RV2031-4E1., -- Version not possible
3RV2031-4P.1., 1)
The link modules cannot be used for the 3RV2.21-4PA1., 3RV2.21-4FA1.,
3RV2031-4S.1., 3RV2.31-4K.1., 3RV2.31-4R.1., 3RV2.32-4K.1., 3RV2.32-4R.1., 3RV27 and
3RV2031-4T.1., 3RV28 motor starter protectors/circuit breakers.
3RV2031-4U.1., 2)
3RV2031-4V.1. To assemble the feeder between a motor starter protector and a soft starter
in size S2, the 3RA2932-1AC00 standard mounting rail adapter must be
3RV2031-4J.1., S2 3RV2938-1K phase barrier used.
3RV2031-4K.1., 3)
3RV2031-4R.1., The motor starter protector to contactor hybrid link modules cannot be
3RV2031-4W.1., used for the 3RV2.21-4PA1., 3RV2.21-4FA1., 3RV27 and 3RV28 motor
3RV2031-4X.1., starter protectors/circuit breakers. They are only suitable for constructing
3RV2032 direct-on-line starters.
3RV204 S3 3RT2946-4GA07 terminal block Note:
-- No accessories needed • Link modules can be used in
- Sizes S00 and S0: up to max. 32 A
Special 3-phase infeed terminals are required for constructing - Size S2: up to max. 65 A
“Type E Starters” with an insulated 3-phase busbar system
• Hybrid link modules can be used in
(see page 1/11). These infeed terminals are only available for 3RV20
- Sizes S00 and S0: up to max. 32 A
motor starter protectors with screw terminals.
The 3RV29 infeed system also enables the assembly of “Type E
Starters”, see page 1/18 onwards.
Note:
According to CSA, these terminal blocks and the phase barriers
can be omitted when the device is used as a "Self-Protected
Combination Motor Controller (Type E)".
1/12 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
7/38 Siemens IC 10 · 2015
maintaining the required voltage clearances
and as touch protection if box terminal is
removed (2 units can be mounted per motor
3RV Motor Starter Protectors
starter protector/circuit breaker) SIRIUS
Accessories
3RV2 (size S3) with
3RT1946-4EA1 (left)
Mounting accessories
Scale covers 3RV20, 3RV21, } 3RV2908-0P 100 10 units 41E
Sealable, 3RV24:
for covering the set current scale S00 ... S3
Selection and ordering data
1
3RV2908-0P
Covers for devices with screw terminals For motorScrew
starterterminalsInnovations Order
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Version
(box terminals) protector size 3RV2/3RT2 Order No. Quantity
Terminal blocks andAdditional touch protection
phase barriers to be fitted at theCombination
for “Self-Protected
box terminals
Motor Controllers (Type E)” according to UL 508 / UL 60947-4-1
(2 units required per device)
3RT2936-4EA2 Note:
• Main current level }
S2 clearance and 2-inch3RT2936-4EA2 1 1 unit 41B
7
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/13
LV1N_05_04.fm Page 30 Friday, September 27, 2013 2:28 PM
Mounting accessories
Selection and ordering data
1
Single-unit packaging
S00 S00 3RA29 11-2GA00 1 1 unit 0.038
S0 S0 3RA29 21-2GA00 1 1 unit 0.072
Multi-unit packaging
S00 S00 3RA29 11-2G 1 10 units 0.380
3RA29 21-2GA00 S0 S0 3RA29 21-2G 1 10 units 0.720
5
1) The link modules for motor starter protector to soft starter and for motor Note:
starter protector to solid-state contactor cannot be used for the S0 link modules can be used up to max. 32 A.
3RV2. 21-4PA1., 3RV2. 21-4FA1., 3RV27 and 3RV28 motor starter
protectors. S2 link modules can be used up to max. 65 A.
3RA29 11-2FA00
Multi-unit packaging
AC/DC S00 S00 3RA29 11-2F 1 10 units 0.290
AC2)/DC S0 S0 3RA29 21-2F 1 10 units 0.560
Spacers2)
for compensating the height on AC contactors
Single-unit packaging S0 S0 3RA29 11-1CA00 1 1 unit 0.001
Multi-unit packaging S0 S0 3RA29 11-1C 1 5 units 0.001
3RA29 21-2FA00
1) The hybrid link modules for motor starter protector to contactor cannot be Note:
used for the 3RV2. 21-4PA1., 3RV2. 21-4FA1., 3RV27 and 3RV28 motor Hybrid link modules can be used up to max. 32 A.
starter protectors or reversing starters.
2) A spacer for height compensation on AC contactors size S0 is optionally
available. See 3RA2911-1CA00
3) To assemble the starter between a motor starter protector and a soft starter
in size S2, the 3RA2932-1AC00 standard mounting rail adapter must be used.
4) It is only permissible to assemble the feeder between the motor starter
protector and the soft starter in Size S3 on a mounting plate.
1/14 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
1
Weight
For SIRIUS Order approx.
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Type Design MSP size Order No. Quantity (kg)
Isolator module 1)
3RV2938-1A 3RV29 28-1A Visible isolating distance for S00, S0 3RV29 28-1A 1 unit 0.132
without padlock without padlock
isolating individual motor starter
protectors from the network,
1)
lockable in isolating position. S2 3RV29 38-1A 1 unit 0.368
Covers
3RV1 (size S3) with
3RT19 46-4EA1 Terminal cover Additional touch guard
for box terminals to be fitted at the box terminals S2 3RT29 36-4EA2 1 unit 0.014
(2 units can be mounted per MSP)
S3 3RT29 46-4EA2 1 unit 0.019
Fixing Material
3RB1900-0B Push-in lugs Two units are required for
For screwing the each motor starter protector. S00 3RB19 00-0B 10 units 0.10
motor starter protector
onto mounting plates.
1) The isolator module for size S2 can be used only with 3RV2 motor 2) Compatible with 3RV20 motor starter protectors.
starter protectors/circuit breakers up to max. 65 A. Similarly, it cannot
3) Compatible with 3RV20, 3RV21, and 3RV24 motor
be used with the transverse auxiliary switch or three-phase busbars.
starter protectors.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/15
© Siemens 2021
Protection
3RV equipment
Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
Accessories
SIRIUS 3RV2 motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
Rotary operating mechanisms
Accessories > Rotary operating mechanisms
Version Color of Version of For motor starter SD Article No. Price PU PS* PG
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
The door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms consist of a actuator, a coupling driver and a 130/330 mm long extension shaft
(6 mm x 6 mm).
The door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms are dimensioned for degree of protection IP64. For UL/CSA applications, they are
approved for Enclosure Types 1, 3R and 12. The door interlocking prevents accidental opening of the control cabinet door in the
ON position of the motor starter protector. The OFF position can be locked with up to three padlocks.
With the optional 3RV2926-0Q tolerance compensation, an offset can be compensated when installing the door-coupling rotary
operating mechanism.
Door-coupling Gray 130 S001) ... S3 X 3RV2926-1B 1 1 unit 41E
rotary 330 S001) ... S3 X 3RV2926-1K 1 1 unit 41E
operating
3RV2926-1B mechanisms
EMERGENCY Red/ 130 S001) ... S3 X 3RV2926-1C 1 1 unit 41E
OFF door- yellow 330 S001) ... S3 X 3RV2926-1L 1 1 unit 41E
coupling
rotary
operating
mechanisms
3RV2926-1C
Optional accessories
7
3RV2926-0Q
1) Not for 3RV1011 motor starter protectors.
1/16 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Version Color of Version of For motor starter SD Article No. Price PU PS* PG
1
actuator extension shaft protectors/circuit per PU (UNIT,
breakers SET, M)
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
mm Size d
Door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms for harsh conditions
The door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms consist of a actuator, a coupling driver, an extension shaft of 300 mm in length
(8 mm x 8 mm), a spacer and two metal brackets into which the motor starter protector/circuit breaker is inserted.
The door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms are designed to degree of protection IP65. For UL/CSA applications, they are
approved for Enclosure Types 1, 3R and 12. The door interlocking reliably prevents opening of the control cabinet door in the
ON position of the motor starter protector/circuit breaker. The OFF position can be locked with up to three padlocks.
Laterally mountable auxiliary releases and 2-pole auxiliary switches can be used.
The door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms thus meet the requirements for isolating functions according to IEC 60947-2.
With the optional 3RV2926-2Q tolerance compensation, an offset can be compensated when installing the door-coupling rotary
operating mechanism for harsh conditions.
Door-coupling Gray 300 S001), S0 NEW NEU
X 3RV2926-3B 1 1 unit 41E
3RV2946-3B
rotary S2 NEW NEU
X 3RV2936-3B 1 1 unit 41E
operating
mechanisms S3 NEW NEU
X 3RV2946-3B 1 1 unit 41E
EMERGENCY Red/ 300 S001), S0 NEW NEU
X 3RV2926-3C 1 1 unit 41E
OFF door- yellow S2 NEW NEU
X 3RV2936-3C 1 1 unit 41E
coupling
rotary S3 NEW NEU
X 3RV2946-3C 1 1 unit 41E
operating
mechanisms
3RV2946-3C
Optional accessories
Tolerance -- -- S00 ... S3 NEW NEU
X 3RV2926-2Q 1 1 unit 41E
compensation
7
3RV2926-2Q
Necessary accessories for mounting one main switch in size S3 according to UL 508A and NFPA 79
(see also page 7/55)
Shaft supports -- -- S3 NEW NEU
X 3RV2926-0P 1 1 unit 41E
3RV2926-0P
Supplementary
handles
• Standard Gray -- S3 2 3VA9137-0GC01 1 1 unit 12P
3VA9137-0GC01
• EMERGENCY Red/ -- S3 2 3VA9137-0GC05 1 1 unit 12P
OFF yellow
3VA9137-0GC05
1) Not for 3RV1011 motor starter protectors.
Overview
The 3RV29 infeed system is a convenient means of energy two sockets onto each of which a motor starter protector can
supply and distribution for a group of several motor starter
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
be snapped.
protectors or complete motor starters with a screw or spring-
type connection in sizes S00 and S0 (exception: this system Expansion modules are available for extending the system
cannot be used for the 3RV21). (three-phase busbars for system expansion). The individual
modules are connected through an expansion plug.
Siemens now has UL/CSA approvals for using the 3RV27 and
3RV28 UL489 Circuit Breakers with the 3RV2917 Infeed System The electrical connection between the three-phase busbars and
and with the 3RV1915 comb-busbars. Up until now it was lim- the motor starter protectors is implemented through plug-in
ited to standard 3RV20 MSPs. These new approvals will greatly connectors. The complete system can be mounted on a TH 35
enhance application flexibility for customers. Not only can they standard mounting rail to EN 60715 and can be expanded as
use the bus systems to feed motor loads, they can now feed required up to a maximum current carrying capacity of 63 A.
non-motor loads which should allow the bus systems to feed The system is mounted extremely quickly and easily thanks to
complete control panel applications. Customers will need to the simple plug-in technique. Thanks to the lateral infeed, the
remove the line side terminals on any 3RV27 or 28s that will be system also saves space in the control cabinet. The additional
fed by the bus system. overall height required for the infeed unit is only 30 mm. The
The 3RV29 infeed system is approved in accordance with alternative infeed possibilities on each side offer a high degree
IEC to 500V. It is also UL approved and authorized for “Self- of flexibility for configuring the control cabinet: Infeed on left-
Protected Combination Motor Controller” (Type E starter) as hand or right-hand side as well as infeed on one side and out-
well as for Type F starter (Type E starter + contactor). The feed on the other side to supply further loads are all possible.
system is based on a basic module complete with a lateral A terminal block with spring-type connections in combination
incoming unit (three-phase busbar with infeed). This infeed with with a standard mounting rail enables the integration of not only
spring-type terminals is mounted on the right or left depending SIRIUS motor starter protectors but also single-phase, 2-phase
on the version and can be supplied with a maximum conductor and 3-phase components such as 5SY miniature circuit breakers
cross-section of 4 AWG (with end sleeve). A basic module has or SIRIUS relay components.
55
3b
3b
5
5 3a
3a
5
5
1
1
2
2
4
4
7
7
6
6
NSB0_02078
NSB0_02078
1 3-phase busbar with infeed 3a Expansion plug 4 End cover 6 Contactor base
1 3-phase busbar with infeed 3a Expansion plug 4 End cover 6 Contactor base
2 3-phase busbar for system expansion 3b Extra-wide expansion plug 5 Plug-in connector 7 Terminal block
2 3-phase busbar for system expansion 3b Extra-wide expansion plug 5 Plug-in connector 7 Terminal block
1/18 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 5/23
SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 5/23
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 40 A
Accessories
Accessories
3RV29 infeed system
3RV29 infeed system
$ Three-phase busbars with infeed * Contactor base
1
A three-phase busbar with infeed unit is required for connecting Motor starters can be assembled in the system using the contac-
the energy supply. This module comprises one infeed module tor base. The contactor bases are suitable for contactors sizes
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
and 2 sockets which each accept one motor starter protector. A S00 and S0 with spring-type and screw terminals and are simply
choice of two versions with infeed on the left or right is available. snapped onto the three-phase busbars. Direct-on-line starters
The infeed is connected using spring-type terminals. The and reversing starters are possible. One contactor base is re-
spring-type terminals permit conductor cross-sections of up to quired for direct-on-line starters and two are required for revers-
25 mm2 with end sleeves. An end cover is supplied with each ing starters.
module.
To assemble motor starters for reversing starters, the contactor
% Three-phase busbars for system expansion bases can be arranged alongside each other (90 mm overall
width). In this case the mechanical interlocking of the contactors
The three-phase busbars for system expansion allow the system is possible. The contactor bases are also suitable for soft start-
to be expanded. There is a choice of modules with 2 or 3 sock- ers size S00 and S0 with screw connection.
ets. The system can be expanded as required up to a maximum
current carrying capacity of 63 A. An expansion plug is supplied The infeed system is designed for mounting on a 35 mm stan-
with each module. dard mounting rail with 7.5 mm overall depth. This standard
mounting rail gives the contactor base a stable mounting sur-
&a Expansion plug face to sit on. If standard mounting rails with a depth of 15 mm
are used, the spacer connected to the bottom of the contactor
The expansion plug is used for electrical connection of adjacent base must be knocked out and plugged into the mating piece
three-phase busbars. The current carrying capacity of this plug that is also on the underside. Then the contactor base also has
equals 63 A. One expansion plug is supplied with each three- a stable mounting surface. When standard mounting rails with a
phase busbar for system expansion. Additional expansion plugs depth of 7.5 mm are used, the spacer has no function and can
are therefore only required as spare parts. be removed.
&b Extra-wide expansion plug The link modules are used for direct start motor starters, in which
The wide expansion plug makes the electrical connection be- case the use of a contactor base is not absolutely necessary.
tween two three-phase busbars, thus performing the same func- Motor starter protector and contactor assemblies can then be di-
tion as the 3RV29 17-5BA00 expansion plug; the electrical char- rectly snapped onto the sockets of the three-phase busbars. For
acteristics (e.g. a current carrying capacity of 63 A) are starters of size S00 and S0, the corresponding 3RA19 21-1....,
5
) Plug-in connector
The plug-in connector is used for the electrical connection be-
tween the three-phase busbar and the 3RV2 motor starter pro-
tector. These plug-in connectors are available in versions for
screw or spring-type terminals.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/19
5/24 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
SIRIUS
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 40 A
3RV Motor Starter Protectors
Accessories Accessories
3RV29 infeed system
3RV29 infeed system
3RV29 17-1A
Three-phase busbars for system expansion
Three-phase For motor starter
busbars protectors with
incl. 3RV29 17- screw connection or
5BA00 expansion spring-type
plug terminals
• For 2 motor starter S00, S0 3RV29 17-4A 1 unit 0.229
protectors
• For 3 motor starter S00, S0 3RV29 17-4B 1 unit 0.328
protectors
5
3RV29 17-4A
Plug-in connectors
Plug-in • For spring-type Spring-type
connectors terminals terminals
to make contact - Single-unit S001) 3RV29 17-5AA00 1 unit 0.046
with the motor packaging S02) 3RV29 27-5AA00 1 unit 0.059
starter protectors
- Multi-unit S001) 3RV29 17-5A 10 units 0.046
packaging S02) 3RV29 27-5A 10 units 0.059
3RV29 17-5AA00
• For screw Screw terminals
terminals
- Single-unit S001) 3RV29 17-5CA00 1 unit 0.029
packaging S02) 3RV19 27-5AA00 1 unit 0.040
- Multi-unit S001) 3RV29 17-5C 10 units 0.029
packaging 2) 3RV19 27-5A 10 units 0.036
S0
3RV29 17-5CA00
3RV29 27-7AA00
1) I > 14 A, note derating; see the system manual "SIRIUS Innovations",
Chapter "Motor Starter Protectors".
2) I > 16 A, note derating; see the system manual "SIRIUS Innovations",
Chapter "Motor Starter Protectors".
1
Type Version Order No. Standard Weight
Pack approx.
Quantity
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
kg
Terminal blocks
Terminal blocks Single-unit packaging 3RV29 17-5D 1 unit 0.049
For integration of
single-phase, two-phase
and three-phase
components
3RV29 17-5D
45 mm standard mounting rails
45 mm standard Single-unit packaging 3RV19 17-7B 1 unit 0.261
mounting rails
for mounting onto
bus bar adapters
3RV19 17-7B
Extra-wide expansion plugs
Extra-wide expansion Single-unit packaging 3RV29 17-5E 1 unit 0.037
plugs as accessory
5
3RV29 17-5E
Expansion plugs
Expansion plugs1) Single-unit packaging 3RV29 17-5BA00 1 unit 0.026
as spare part
3RV29 17-5BA00
End covers
End covers2) Multi-unit packaging 3RV29 17-6A 10 units 0.005
as spare part
3RV29 17-6A
Terminal blocks for device infeed
Terminal blocks for Single-unit packaging 3RV29 17-5FA00 1 unit 0.010
device infeed
3RV29 17-FA00
1) The expansion plug is included in the scope of supply of the 3RV29 17-4
three-phase busbars for system expansion.
2) The end cover is included in the scope of supply of the 3RV29 17-1 three-
phase busbars with infeed system.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/21
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
5/26 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A (Domestic applications)
Motor starter protectors of the 3RV2 series are approved for These motor starter protectors can be used as "Manual Motor
Motor starter protectors of the 3RV2 series are approved for These motor starter protectors can be used as "Manual Motor
UL/CSA, and according to UL508/UL 60947-4-1 and CSA C22.2 Controllers" for "Group Installations", as "Manual Motor Control-
UL/CSA, and according to UL508/UL 60947-4-1 and CSA C22.2 Controllers" for "Group Installations", as "Manual Motor Control-
No. 14/CSA C22.2 No. 60947-4-1 they can be used on their own lers Suitable
Suitable for Tap Conductor Protection in Group Installations"
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
No. 14/CSA C22.2 No. 60947-4-1 they can be used on their own lers for Tap Conductor Protection in Group Installations"
and as "Self-Protected Combination Motor Controllers" (Type E).
or as load feeders in combination with a contactor. and as "Self-Protected Combination Motor Controllers" (Type E).
or as load feeders in combination with a contactor.
1/22 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A (Domestic applications)
1
3RV motor starter protectors as "Manual Motor Controllers Suitable for Tap Conductor Protection in Group Installations"
The application as "Manual Motor Controllers Suitable for Tap protector according to UL 489 can be used.
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Conductor Protection in Group Installations" is only available These devices must be dimensioned according to the National
from UL. Electrical Code.
CSA does not
3RV motor recognize
starter this as
protectors approval!
"ManualWhen Motorthe motor starter
Controllers Suitable for Tap Conductor Protection in Group Installations"
protector is used as a "Manual Motor Controller Suitable for Tap The 3RV motor starter protectors are approved as "Manual
The application
Conductor as "Manual
Protection Motor
in Group Controllers itSuitable
Installations", for Tap
must always be Motor Controllers
protector accordingSuitable for Tap
to UL 489 canConductor
be used. Protection in
Conductor
combined withProtection in Group
upstream Installations"
short-circuit is only
protection. Asavailable
short-cir- Group Installations"
These devices mustunder the following
be dimensioned file number:
according to the National
from UL.
cuit-protection device, approved fuses or a motor starter •Electrical
UL File Code.
No. 47705, CCN: NLRV.
CSA does not recognize this approval! When the motor starter
protector is used as a "ManualhpMotor The 3RV motor starter protectors are approved as "Manual
Motor starter ratingController
1) for FLA2) Suitable for Tap
Rated 240 V AC
Motor Up tofor
Controllers Suitable 480Y/277V AC
Tap Conductor UpProtection
to 600Y/347V
in AC
Conductor
protectors Protection in Group Installations", it must always
max. In
current be
combined with upstream short-circuit protection. As short-cir- Group
UL Installations" under
UL the following file ULnumber:
cuit-protection device, approved fuses or a motor starter I•bcUL
3)
Ibc3) NLRV.
File No. 47705, CCN: Ibc3)
1)
HP rating = Power rating in horse power (maximum motor rating).
2) FLA = Full Load Amps/Motor full load current.
3) Complies with "short-circuit breaking capacity" according to UL.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/23
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A (Domestic applications)
3RV motor starter protectors as "Self-Protected Combination Motor Controllers (Type E)"
1
UL 508/UL 60947-4-1 approval demands 1-inch clearance and when the device is used as a “Self-Protected Combination Motor
2-inch creepage distance at line side for “Self-Protected Combination Controller”.
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
3RV motor
Motor starter
Controller protectors
Type E”. as "Self-Protected Combination Motor Controllers (Type E)"
The 3RV20 motor starter protectors are approved as “Self-Protected
Therefore, 3RV20 motor starter protectors of sizes S00 to S2 are Combination Motor Controllers” under the following file numbers:
approved according to UL 508/UL 60947-4-1 in combination with the • UL File No. E156943, CCN: NKJH
terminal blocks listed below.
• CSA Master Contract 165071, Product Class: 3211 08
CSA does not require these extended clearances and creepage
distances. According to CSA, these terminal blocks can be omitted
Motor starter hp rating1) for FLA2) Rated current Up to 240 V AC Up to 480 Y/277 V AC Up to 600 Y/347 V AC
protectors max. In UL/CSA Ibc3) UL/CSA Ibc3) UL/CSA Ibc3)
Type V 1-phase 3-phase A kA kA kA
Size S00
Motor starter hp rating1) for FLA2) Rated current Up to 240 V AC Up to 480 Y/277 V AC Up to 600 Y/347 V AC
protectors max. In UL/CSA Ibc3) UL/CSA Ibc3) Ibc3)
3RV2011 + 3RV29 28-1H4) 5) 0.16 ... 12.5 65 65 UL/CSA
30
Type2) V 1-phase 3-phase A
16 kA
65 kA
65 kA
—
FLA max. 16 A 115 1 2
Size S00
480 V 200 2 3
3RV2011 + 3RV29 28-1H4) 5) 0.16 ... 12.5 65 65 30
NEMA size 0 230 2 5
16 65 65 —
FLA2) max. 16 A 230
115 —
1 10
2
480 V 575/600
200 —
2 10
3
Size S0
NEMA size 0 230 2 5
3RV2021 + 3RV29 28-1H2304) 5) — 10 0.63 ... 1.6 65 65 30
575/600 — 10 2 65 65 30
FLA 2) max. 2.5 65 65 30
Size S0 115 2 5
25 A, 480 V 2004) 5) 3 7.5 3.2 65 65 30
3RV2021 + 3RV29
12.5 A, 600 V 28-1H
230 3 10 0.63
4 ... 1.6 65
65 65
65 30
30
2 65
65 65
65 30
2) max. 460 — 20 5 30
FLA 115 2 5 2.5 65 65 30
NEMA size 1 575/600 — — 6.3 65 65 30
25 A, 480 V 200 3 7.5 3.2 65 65 30
8 65 65 30
12.5 A, 600 V 230 3 10 4 65
65 65
65 30
10 30
460 — 20 5 65 65 30
NEMA size 1 575/600 — — 12.5 65 65 30
6.3 65
65 65
65 30
16 —
8 65
65 65
65 30
20 —
10 65
65 65
65 30
—
22
12.5
25 65 65 30
—
16
32 65
50 65
50 —
20 65 65 —
Size S2 22 65
3RV2031 3RV2032 65
3RV2031 3RV2032 —
3RV2031 3RV2032
25
14 65
65 100 6565 100 —
25 25
Size S2 32 50 50 —
3RV2031/3RV2032 + 3RV2938-1K 4) 17 65 100 65 100 25 25
3RV2031/3RV2032 + 3RV2938 16 65 65 25
20
20 6565 100 6565 100 25
25 25
FLA 2)
2) MAX. 65A 115/120 5 10 25
25 6565 100 6565 100 25
25 25
Size S2
FLA
600V
max. 115
200/208
3
10
--
20 32 65 100 65 100 25 25
50 A, 600 V 200 7 1/2 15 32 65 65 25
3RV2031/3RV2032
NEMA
NEMA size
size 22 + 3RV2938
230/240
230 15
10 25
20 16
36
40 65
6565 100 65
6565 100 25
25
25 25
460/480
460 —
-- 50
40 20
40
45 65
6565 100 65
6565 100 25
22
25 22
2)
FLA max. 115
575/600 3
-- --
50 25
50 65 65 25
575/600 — 60 45 6565 100 6565 100 25
22 22
50 A, 600 15
Size S3 V 200 7 1/2 32
52 6565 100 6565 100 25
22 22
NEMA size 2 230 10 20 40 65 65 25
3RV2041 + 3RT2946-4GA07 4) 59
16 6565 100 2065 30 —30 —
460 -- 40 45 25
575/600 -- 50 20
65
50 6565 100 2065 30 —30
25 —
2) 25 65 65 30
Size S3
FLA max. 115 10 --
100 A, 480 V 200 4) 20 30 32 65 65 30
3RV2041 + 3RT2946-4GA07
230 20 40 16
40 65
65 65
65 30
30
75 A, 600 V 20 65 65 30
460 -- 75 50 65 65 30
FLA2) max.
NEMA size 3 115
575/600 10
-- --
75 25 65 65 30
200 20 30 63 65 65 30
100 A, 480 V 32
75 65
65 65
65 30
30
75 A, 600 V 230 20 40 40
90 65
65 65
65 30
—
460 -- 75 50
100 65
65 65
65 30
—
NEMA size 3 575/600 -- 75 63 65 65 30
Ratings of the auxiliary switches Lateral auxiliary65
75 switch with Transverse
65 auxiliary Transverse
30
and alarm switches 1 NO + 1 NC, 2 NO,
90 65 2 NC, switch
65 with auxiliary
— switch with
2
100 NO + 2 NC and signalling
65 switch 1 changeover
65 contact 1—NO + 1 NC, 2 NO
Ratings
Max. ratedof the auxiliary
voltage switches
• to NEMA u AC V 600
Lateral auxiliary switch with Transverse auxiliary 250
Transverse
and alarm switches • to NEMA s AC V 1600
NO + 1 NC, 2 NO, 2 NC, switch with 250
auxiliary switch with
Uninterrupted current A 210NO + 2 NC and signalling switch 1
5 changeover contact 1 NO + 1 NC, 2 NO
2.5
Breaking
Max. rated capacity
voltage • to NEMA u AC V A600
600 B600 C300
250
Q300 R300 R300
• to NEMA s AC V 600 250
1) HP rating = Power rating in horse power (maximum motor rating). 3) Corresponds to "short-circuit breaking capacity" according to UL/CSA.
U n i n t e r r u p t e d c u rre n t
2) FLA = Full Load Amps/Motor full load current. A 10 5
4) Not required for CSA. 2.5
Breaking capacity A600 B600 C300
5) Alternatively, the 3RV2928-1K phase barrier can also be used.
Q300 R300 R300
1) HP rating = Power rating in horse power (maximum motor rating). 3) Corresponds to "short-circuit breaking capacity" according to UL/CSA.
2) FLA = Full Load Amps/Motor full load current. 4) Not required for CSA.
5) Alternatively, the 3RV2928-1K phase barrier can also be used.
1/24 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV27/28 circuit breakers
1
These circuit breakers are approved according to UL 489 and The 3RV27/28 circuit breakers are approved under the
CSA C22.2 No. 5-02 for 100 % rated current (100 % rated following file numbers:
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
breaker). They can be used therefore as upstream short-circuit • UL File No. E235044, CCN: DIVQ,
protective devices for "Manual Motor Controllers" and "Manual
Motor Controllers Suitable for Tap Conductor Protection in • CSA Master Contract 165071, Product Class: 1432 01.
Group Installations".
Circuit breakers Rated 240 V AC 480 Y/277 V AC 480 V AC 600 Y/347 V AC
current In UL/CSA UL/CSA UL/CSA UL/CSA
Type A I bc1) kA Ibc1) kA Ibc1) kA Ibc1) kA
Size S00/S0
3RV27 11 / 3RV28 11 0.16 … 1.25 65 65 — 10
3RV27 21 / 3RV28 21 1.6 65 65 — 10
2 65 65 — 10
2.5 65 65 — 10
3.2 65 65 — 10
4 65 65 — 10
5 65 65 — 10
6.3 65 65 — 10
8 65 65 — 10
10 65 65 — 10
12.5 65 65 — 10
15 65 65 — --
20 50 50 — --
22 50 50 — --
Size S3
3RV27 42 10 65 65 65 20
15 65 65 65 20
20 65 65 65 20
25 65 65 65 20
30 65 65 65 20
35 65 65 — 20
40 65 65 — 20
45 65 65 — 20
50 65 65 — 20
60 65 65 — 20
70 65 65 — 10
1) Complies with "short-circuit breaking capacity" according to UL.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/25
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A (Export applications)
Technical specifications
1
Short-circuit breaking capacity Icu, Ics acc. to IEC 60947-2 table, a back-up fuse is required. It is also possible to install an
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
This table shows the rated ultimate short-circuit breaking upstream motor starter protector/circuit breaker with a limiter
capacity Icu and the rated service short-circuit breaking function.
capacity Ics of the 3RV2 motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
with different inception voltages dependent of the rated current The maximum rated current for the back-up fuse is specified in
In of the motor starter protectors/circuit breakers. the tables. The rated ultimate short-circuit breaking capacity
then applies as specified on the fuse.
Power can be supplied to the motor starter protectors/circuit
Fuseless construction
breakers via the terminals at the top or at the bottom without
restricting the rated data. If the short-circuit current at the place Motor starter protector contactor combinations for short-circuit
of installation exceeds the rated short-circuit breaking capacity currents up to 150 kA can be ordered in the form of fuseless load
of the motor starter protector/circuit breaker as specified in the feeders according to Chapter 6.
Type A kA kA A kA kA A kA kA A kA kA A kA kA A
Size S00
3RV2.11 0.16 ... 1 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 °
1.25; 1.6 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 °
2; 2.5 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 10 10 25
3.2; 4 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 50 10 ° 100 100 ° 10; 6 10; 4 32
5; 6.3 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 50 10 ° 100 100 ° 6 4 32
8 100 100 ° 50 12.5 ° 50 50 63 42 42 63 6 4 50
10 100 100 ° 50 12.5 ° 50 50 80 42 42 63 6 4 50
12 100 100 ° 50 12.5 ° 50 50 80 42 42 80 4 4 63
16 100 100 ° 55 30 100 50 10 80 10 5 80 4 4 63
Size S0
3RV2.21 16 100 100 ° 55 25 100 50 10 80 10 5 80 4 2 63
20 100 100 ° 55 25 125 50 10 80 10 5 80 4 2 63
22 100 100 ° 55 25 125 50 10 100 10 5 80 4 2 63
25 100 100 ° 55 25 125 50 10 100 10 5 80 4 2 63
28 100 100 ° 55 25 125 30 10 125 10 5 100 4 2 100
32 100 100 ° 55 25 125 30 10 125 10 5 100 4 2 100
36 100 100 ° 20 10 125 12 8 125 6 3 100 3 2 100
40 100 100 ° 20 10 125 12 8 125 6 3 100 3 2 100
Size S2
3RV2.31 14; 17 100 100 ° 65 30 100 50 25 100 12 6 63 5 3 63
20 100 100 ° 65 30 100 50 25 100 12 6 80 5 3 80
25 100 100 ° 65 30 100 50 15 100 12 6 80 5 3 80
32; 36 100 100 ° 65 30 125 50 15 125 10 5 100 4 2 100
40; 45 100 100 ° 65 30 160 50 15 125 10 5 100 4 2 100
52 100 100 ° 65 30 160 50 15 125 10 5 125 4 2 125
59 ... 80 Values on request
Size S2, with increased
switching capacity
3RV2.32 14; 17 100 100 ° 100 50 ° 65 30 100 18 10 63 8 5 63
20; 25 100 100 ° 100 50 ° 65 30 100 18 10 80 8 5 80
32 ... 45 100 100 ° 100 50 ° 65 30 125 15 8 100 6 4 100
52 100 100 ° 100 50 ° 65 30 125 15 8 125 6 4 125
59 ... 80 Values on request
Size S3
3RV2. 41 40 100 100 ° 50 25 125 50 20 125 12 6 100 6 3 63
50 100 100 ° 50 25 125 50 20 125 12 6 100 6 3 80
63 100 100 ° 50 25 160 50 20 160 12 6 100 6 3 80
75 100 100 ° 50 25 160 50 20 160 8 4 125 5 3 100
90; 100 100 100 ° 50 25 160 50 20 160 8 4 125 5 3 125
1/26 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A (Export applications)
Short-circuit breaking capacity IcuIT in the IT system In the colored areas, IcuIT is 100 kA, or in some ranges it is
1
(IT network) according to IEC 60947-2 50 kA. Therefore the motor starter protectors are short-circuit re-
sistant in these ranges.
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
3RV motor starter protectors are suitable for operation in
IT systems. Values valid for triple-pole short-circuit are Icu up to If the short-circuit current at the place of installation exceeds the
Ics. In case of double ground fault on different phases at the in- rated short-circuit breaking capacity of the motor starter protec-
put and output side of a motor starter protector, the special tor as specified in the table, a back-up fuse is required. The max-
short-circuit breaking capacity IcuIT applies. The specifications imum rated current for the back-up fuse is specified in the ta-
in the table below apply to 3RV motor starter protectors. bles. The rated short-circuit breaking capacity then applies as
specified on the fuse.
Motor starter Rated current Up to 240 V AC1) Up to 400 V1)/415 V AC2) Up to 500 V1)/525 V AC2) Up to 690 V AC1) 5)
protectors In IcuIT Max. fuse IcuIT Max. fuse IcuIT Max. fuse IcuIT Max. fuse
(gL/gG)3) (gL/gG)3)4) (gL/gG)3) (gL/gG)3)
Type A kA A kA A kA A kA A
Size S00
3RV20, 0.16 ... 0.63 100 ° 100 ° On request On request On request On request
3RV26 11-0BD10 0.8; 1 100 ° 100 °
1.25; 1.6 100 ° 100 °
2; 2.5 100 ° 8 25
3.2; 4 100 ° 8;4 32
5; 6.3 100 ° 4 32:50
8; 10 100 ° 4 50
12.5 100 ° 4 63
16 55 80 4 63
Size S0
3RV2.21 16 55 80 4 63 2 50 1.5 40
20 55 80 4 63 2 50 1.5 50
22 55 80 4 63 2 50 1.5 50
25 55 80 4 63 2 50 1.5 50
28 55 80 2 63 2 63 1.5 63
32 55 80 2 63 2 63 1.5 63
36 20 80 2 63 2 63 1.5 63
40 20 80 2 63 2 63 1.5 63
Size S2
3RV2.31 14...25 100 ° 8 100 6 80 4 63
32...45 100 ° 6 125 4 100 3 80
52 100 ° 4 160 3 125 2 100
59 ... 80 Values on request
Size S2, with increased
switching capacity
3RV2.32 14 ... 25 100 ° 8 100 6 80 4 63
32 ... 45 100 ° 6 125 6 100 4 80
52 100 ° 6 160 6 125 4 100
59 ... 80 Values on request
Size S3
3RV2. 41 40 50 125 10 63 5 50 5 50
50 50 125 8 80 3 63 3 63
63 50 160 6 80 3 63 3 63
75 50 160 5 100 2 80 2 80
90; 100 50 160 5 125 2 100 2 100
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/27
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A
Technical data
1
When mounting MSPs, the following clearance must be maintained to grounded or live
parts.
SIRIUS MSP Clearance to grounded or live parts Minimum clearance between MSPs and grounded
Y X at the side Z or live parts
Type size mm mm mm
3RV2.1 S00 up to 690 V 30 70 9
3RV2. 2 S0 2) up to 500 V 30 90 9
up to 690 V 50 1) 90 30
3RV2. 3 S2 up to 690 V 50 — 10
3RV2. 4 S3 up to 240 V 50 167 10
up to 440 V 70 167 10
up to 500 V 110 167 10
up to 690 V 150 167 30
3RV27 42 S3 up to 240 V 90 167 10
up to 400 V 90 167 10
1) Up to and including the setting range of 32 A. For the 36/40 A setting range the clearance is 70 mm.
2) In conjunction with the type E terminal block 3RV2928-1H the applicable lateral clearance is 30 mm for all voltages.
Wiring module
1/28 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
© Siemens AG 2015
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Motor Starter
General Data Protectors/Circuit Breakers
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 80 A
3RV — up to 80 A
General data
General data
1
Type 3RV2.1. 3RV2.2. 3RV2.3. 3RV27, 3RV28
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Size S00 S0 S2 S00, S0
H
Dimensions (W x H x D)
• Screw terminals mm 45 x 97 x 91 45 x 97 x 91 55 x 140 x 149 45 x 144 x 92
D
W
• Spring-type terminals mm 45 x 106 x 91 45 x 119 x 91 -- --
Standards
• IEC 60947-1, EN 60947-1 (VDE 0660 Part 100) Yes
• IEC 60947-2, EN 60947-2 (VDE 0660 Part 101) Yes
• IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102) Yes Yes Yes --
• UL 508/UL 60947-4-1, CSA C22.2 No. 14/CSA C22.2 No. 60947-4-1 Yes Yes Yes --
• UL 489, CSA C22.2 No. 5 -- -- -- Yes
Number of poles 3
Max. rated current In max A 16 40 80 22
(= max. rated operational current Ie)
Permissible ambient temperature
• Storage/transport °C –50 ... +80
• Operation In: 0.16 ... 32 A °C –20 ... +70 --
(current reduction above +60 °C)
In: 36 ... 40 A °C -- –20 ... +40 --
(the devices must
not be mounted
side-by-side and
they must not be
assembled with
link modules with
contactors.
A lateral clear-
ance of 9 mm is
required.)
In: 14 ... 80 A °C -- –20 ... +70 --
7
(current reduction
above +60 °C)
Permissible rated current at inside temperature of control cabinet
• +60 °C % 100
• +70 °C % 87
Permissible rated current at ambient temperature of enclosure
(applies for motor starter protector/circuit breaker inside enclosure ≤ 32 A)
• +35 °C % 100 On 100
• +60 °C % 87 request 87
Rated operational voltage Ue
• Acc. to IEC V AC 690 (when a molded-plastic enclosure is used only 500 V)
• Acc. to UL/CSA V AC 600
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Utilization category
• IEC 60947-2 (motor starter protector/circuit breaker) A
• IEC 60947-4-1 (motor starter) AC-3
Trip class CLASS Acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 10 10/20 --
DC short-circuit breaking capacity (time constant t = 5 ms)
• 1 conducting path 150 V DC kA 10 On 10
• 2 conducting paths in series 300 V DC kA 10 request 10
• 3 conducting paths in series 450 V DC kA 10 10
Power loss Pv for each motor starter In: 0.16 ... 0.63 A W 5 -- 5
protector/circuit breaker In: 0.8 ... 6.3 A W 6 -- 6
Dependent on In: 8 ... 16 A W 7 -- 7
the rated current In In: 16 A W -- 7 10 7
(upper setting range)
In: 17 ... 25 A W -- 8 12 8
P In: 28 ... 32 A
R per conducting path = -------------- W -- 11 14 --
Ι 2× 3 In: 36 ... 40 A W -- 14 15 --
In: 45 ... 52 A W -- -- 17 --
In: ... 80 A W -- -- On request --
Shock resistance Acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 25/11 (square and sine pulse)
Protection class IP on the front Acc. to IEC 60529 IP20
Touch protection Acc. to EN 50274 Finger-safe for vertical contact from the front
Temperature compensation Acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 °C –20 ... +60
Phase failure sensitivity Acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 Yes (only for 3RV23 motor starter protectors) No
Explosion protection – Safe operation of motors with Yes (only for 3RV20 motor starter protectors)
"increased safety" type of protection
EC type test certificate number according to DMT 02 ATEX F 001 II (2) GD On request No
directive 94/9/EC (ATEX)
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/29
7/16 Siemens IC 10 · 2015
© Siemens AG 2015
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 80 A
3RV — up to 80 A
General data
3RV2.31-4E.1., 3RV2.31-4R.1.,
3RV2.31-4P.1., 3RV2.31-4W.1.,
3RV2.31-4S.1., 3RV2.31-4X.1.,
3RV2.31-4T.1., 3RV2431-4VA1.,
3RV2.31-4U.1., 3RV2.32
3RV2.31-4V.1.
Size S00 S0 S2 S00, S0
Connection type Screw terminals
7
1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid or stranded mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 4) 2 x (1 ... 10) --
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) 2 x (1 ... 6) --
• Finely stranded with end sleeve (DIN 46228-11) mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) 2 x (1 ... 6) --
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 12) 2 x (18 ... 8) --
Max. external diameter of the conductor insulation mm 3.6 3.6 --
Connection type Ring terminal lug connections
1/30 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Siemens IC 10 · 2015 7/19
© Siemens AG 2015
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 80 A
3RV — up to 80 A
General data
1
3RV2.1. 3RV2.2. 3RV2.3. 3RV27, 3RV28
S00 S0 S2 S00, S0
Front transverse auxiliary switches
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Switching capacity for different voltages
1 CO 1 NO + 1 NC, 2 NO
Rated operational current Ie
• At AC-15, alternating voltage
- 24 V A 4 2
- 230 V A 3 0.5
• At AC-12 = Ith, alternating voltage
- 24 V A 10 2.5
- 230 V A 10 2.5
• At DC-13, direct voltage L/R 200 ms
- 24 V A 1 1
- 48 V A -- 0.3
- 60 V A -- 0.15
- 110 V A 0.22 --
- 220 V A 0.1 --
Minimum load capacity V 17
mA 1
Front transverse solid-state compatible auxiliary switches
Switching capacity for different voltages
1 CO
Rated operational voltage Ue Alternating voltage V 125
Rated operational current Ie/AC-14 at Ue = 125 V A 0.1
Rated operational voltage Ue Direct voltage L/R 200 ms V 60
7
Rated operational current Ie/DC-13 at Ue = 60 V A 0.3
Minimum load capacity V 5
mA 1
Lateral auxiliary switches with signaling switch
Switching capacity for different voltages:
Lateral auxiliary switch with 1 NO + 1 NC, 2 NO, 2 NC, 2 NO + 2 NC
Signaling switch
Rated operational current Ie
• At AC-15, alternating voltage
- 24 V A 6
- 230 V A 4
- 400 V A 3
- 690 V A 1
• At AC-12 = Ith, alternating voltage
- 24 V A 10
- 230 V A 10
- 400 V A 10
- 690 V A 10
• At DC-13, direct voltage L/R 200 ms
- 24 V A 2
- 110 V A 0.5
- 220 V A 0.25
- 440 V A 0.1
Minimum load capacity V 17
mA 1
Auxiliary releases
Undervoltage releases Shunt releases
Power consumption
• During pick-up
- A C vo lt a g es VA/W 20.2/13 20.2/13
- DC voltages W 20 13 ... 80
• During uninterrupted duty
- A C vo lt a g es VA/W 7.2/2.4 --
- DC voltages W 2.1 --
Response voltage
• T ripping V 0.35 ... 0.7 x Us 0.7 ... 1.1 x Us
• Pick-up V 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us --
Opening time maximum ms 20
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/31
Siemens IC 10 · 2015 7/17
© Siemens AG 2015
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Motor Starter
General Data Protectors/Circuit Breakers
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 80 A
3RV — up to 80 A
General data
1/32 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
7/20 Siemens IC 10 · 2015
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A
Overview
1
S00 MSP with laterally mounted Construction
undervoltage release with leading 3RV Motor Starter Protectors The motor starter protectors are • Size S2 - 3RV203
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
auxiliary switch
(MSPs) are built for a world of available in four sizes: Maximum rated current is 50
applications while meeting the Amps. Suitable for motors up
requirements of control users to 50 HP at 600V.
worldwide. Each MSP features • Size S00 - 3RV201
a manual ON/OFF switch, a Maximum rated current is 16 • Size S3 - 3RV204
Class 10 adjustable bimetallic Amps. Suitable for motors up Maximum rated current is
overload relay (Class 20 avail- to 10 HP at 600V. Available in 100 Amps. Suitable for
able in the two largest frame both screw terminal and spring- motors up to 100 HP at 600V.
sizes), and magnetic trip ele- type terminal versions.
ments for short circuit protec- • Size S0 - 3RV202
tion. Maximum rated current is 40
Amps. Suitable for motors up
to 20 HP at 600V. Available in
both screw terminal and spring-
type terminal verisons.
Functions
Releases Release classes Operating mechanisms
3RV motor starter protectors The release classes of thermally S00, S0, S2 and S3 MSPs are In the case of MSPs with
are equipped with bimetallic- delayed releases are based on actuated via a rotary operating rotary operating mechanisms,
based, inverse-time delayed the tripping time (tA) at 7.2 times mechanism. If the MSP trips, an electrical signal can be out-
overload releases - electromag- the operational current in cold the rotary operating mechanism put via a signalling switch to
netic short-circuit releases. state (excerpt from IEC 60 947- switches to the tripped position indicate that the MSP has
4): to indicate this. Before the MSP tripped.
The overload releases can be
set in accordance with the load • CLASS 10 A 2 s < tA < 10 s is reclosed, the rotary operating All operating mechanisms can
current. The overcurrent re- • CLASS 10 4 s < tA < 10 s mechanism must be reset man- be locked in 0 position with a
leases are permanently set to a • CLASS 20 6 s < tA < 20 s ually to 0 position, in order to padlock (shackle diameter
value 13 times the rated current • CLASS 30 9 s < tA < 30 s prevent the former from closing 3.5 to 4.5 mm).
and thus enable trouble-free by mistake before the fault has
start-up of motors. The release must trip within this
been cleared.
time!
The scale cover can be sealed
to prevent unauthorized adjust-
ments to the set current.
Application
Operating conditions Motor Protection
3RV MSPs are suitable for use 3RV MSPs use bimetallic Each MSP has a fourth bimetal- A built-in differential trip bar
in any climate. They are heater elements to provide lic strip that reacts only to the causes the MSP to trip faster
designed for operation in class 10 or 20 overcurrent pro- ambient temperature inside the on a phase loss condition, to
closed rooms under normal tection for both AC and DC control panel. This ambient help reduce motor damage
conditions (e.g. no dust, corro- motors. The bimetallic heaters compensation prevents the from phase loss.
sive vapours or harmful gases). sense the motor current MSP from nuisance tripping
Suitable enclosures must be directly, so the overloads are when the panel temperature is Magnetic trip elements in each
higher than the ambient tem- MSP take the device off line
provided for installation in dusty insensitive to high frequencies,
or damp rooms. harmonic waves and sinusoi- perature of the motor. when it senses currents of 13
dal currents and voltages. times the maximum FLA dial
setting.
3RT2 0 1 1 - 0 A A 1 0
SIRIUS MSP or Application Frame Size Standard Amperage Range Class Terminal Type Auxiliary
Circuit Breaker 0 = Motor Protection 3 = S2 Possible choices listed below see A = 10 1 = Screw Switch
7 = UL 489 4 = S3 page 1/4-1/7 for an entire listing 2 = Spring Loaded
0, 1, 4 B through K 4 = Ring Lug
3RV2 0 1 1 - 0 A A 1 0
SIRIUS Application Frame Size Standard Amperage Range Class Terminal Type Auxiliary
Innovations 0 = Motor Protection 1 = S00 Possible choices listed below see A = 10 1 = Screw Switch
MSP or 7 = UL 489 2 = S0 page 1/4-1/7 for an entire listing B = 20 2 = Spring Loaded
Circuit Breaker
3 = S2 0, 1, 4 B through K 4 = Ring Lug
4 = S3
Note: MPSs and Contactors of the same frame size are made to easily fit together with the use of a link module.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/33
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Mounting accessories
Applications:
1
As a manual starter As a Self-protected manual As part of a Combination As a circuit breaker for export
combination starter, Type E. Motor Contoller, Type F When exporting to many coun-
All 3RV MSPs are UL listed as
Manual Motor Controllers per Most 3RV MSPs have also been When a 3RT contactor is con- tries outside of the U.S. and
UL508. This makes them ideal UL listed as UL508 Type E, Self- nected to the load side of a 3RV North America, the 3RV can be
for applications requiring sim- protected Manual Combination device that is rated as a "Man- applied as a thermal magnetic
ple manual starting and stop- Starters. This UL listing allows ual Self-protected Combination circuit breaker for use in motor
ping of motors. A separate the MSP to be mounted in a Motor Controller, Type E", the branch circuits.
short circuit protective device, manually operated machine assembly can be applied as a 3RV29 28-1K 3RV29 38-1K
such as a circuit breaker or without having to add separate "Combination Motor Controller,
fuses, is still required ahead of short circuit protection Type F". This versions allows
the MSP. This up-stream pro- upstream. for remote starting and stopping
tective device should be sized of the motor load.
per NEC code, not to exceed These devices have a short cir-
400% of the maximum FLA cuit current rating of 65 kA @ These assemblies have a short
adjustment dial setting. 240V, 480Y/277V and up to circuit current rating of 65 kA @
30kA @ 600Y/347V. 240V, 480Y/277V and up to 30
As a component in a group kA @ 600Y/347V.
installation Terminals for "Combination Motor Controller Type E" to UL 508
A group motor installation indi- The 3RV MSP for motor protec- The terminal block 3RT29 46- 3RV29 28-1H
cates multiple motor controllers tion is approved according to 4GA07 must be used for size
under one short circuit protec- UL 508 as "Combination Motor S3. The standard box terminal is
tive device, such as a circuit Controller Type E". to be replaced by this terminal
breaker. 3RV MSPs have a block.
group installation short-circuit As of July, 2001, UL 508
current rating of 65 kA at 480V demands at line-side of the According to CSA, these termi-
and up to 30kA at 600V. By device used for this purpose an nal blocks can be omitted when
using a link module, a 3RT con- increased clearance and creep- the device is used as "Combina-
tactor can be directly mounted age distance (1" or 2"). tion Motor Controller Type E".
to the load side of the MSP. 3RT29 46-4GA07
Here, the terminal block 3RV29 By using a link module, a 3RT
3RV MSPs have been UL 28-1H must be used for size S0. contactor can be directly mount-
tested with and without 3RT The block is simply screwed to ed to the load side of a 3RV MSP.
contactors for group installa- the basic unit. This assembly of a 3RV and a
tion. 3RT provides a complete, re-
Basic units of size S2 are motely operated, combination
already compliant with new starter, Type F.
clearance and creepage dis-
tance requirements.
1/34 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A
1
3RV motor starter protectors fo r alternating currents are also The response values of the overload release remain unchanged;
suitable for DC switching. the response values of a short-circuit release increase by ap-
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
proximately 30 % for DC. The example circuits for DC switching
The maximum permissible DC voltage per conducting path can be seen in the table below.
must, however, be adhered to. Higher voltages require a series
connection with 2 or 3 conducting paths.
Example circuit for size S00 to S3 3RV motor starter protectors
Example circuit for size S00 Maximum permitted Notes
to S3 3RV motor starter protectors DC voltage Ue
1)
It is assumed that this circuit always provides safe disconnection even in
the event of a double ground fault that bridges two contacts.
Design
Mounting Screw connection The box terminals of the S3 MSP with Spring-type terminal
MSPs can be removed in order connection
The motor starter protectors are 3RV MSPs of sizes S00 and
to connect conductors with
secured in position by snap- S0 are fitted with terminals with
cable lugs or connecting bars.
ping them onto 35 mm standard captive screws and clamping
A terminal cover is available to
mounting rails according to DIN pieces, allowing the connection
help prevent contact with shock
EN 50 022. A mounting rail with of 2 conductors with different
protection and to ensure that
a height of 15 mm is required cross-sections.
the required clearances and
for S3 MSPs. A 75-mm mount- creepage distances are main-
The box terminals of the S2 and
ing rail can be used as an alter- tained if the box terminals are
native here. S3 MSPs also enable 2 con-
ductors with different cross- removed.
S2 and S3 MSPs can also be sections to be connected. With
screwed directly onto a base- the exception of S3 MSPs Spring-type connection 2)
plate. which are equipped with 4 mm
hexagon socket terminal As an alternative to screw ter-
The push-in lugs 3RV29 28-0B screws, all terminal screws are minals, S00 and S0 devices are
are available for screw mount- tightened with a Pozidriv screw- also available with Spring-type
ing of S00 and S0 MSPs. driver size 2. terminal connection.
This screwless Spring-type
3RV2928-0B terminal technique, as known
for modular terminal blocks,
offers shock-proof and vibration
proof connection of conductors.
Devices with Spring-type con-
nection allow independent con-
nection of two conductors per
terminal.
1) It is assumed that this circuit always provides safe cut-out, even in the event of a
double earth fault that bridges two contacts.
2) For notes on Spring-type terminal connection, see section 19.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/35
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A
Characteristics
1
The time/current characteristic, (short-circuit releases, ’N’ re- Typical time/current characteristic of 3RV
the current limiting characteris- leases) are based on the rated
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
Circuit diagrams
Internal connections
Motor starter protectors
3RV.
1/36 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A
Dimension drawings
1
3RV2 MSP, size S00 3RV2 MSP, size S0
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
3RV20 11 3RV20 21
45 49 96.9 45 96.9
49
97
97
5 5
1/ L1 3/ L2 5/ L3
70
140
130
2/ T1 4/ T2 6/ T3
5
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/37
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A
149.3
55 144.3 12.4 30
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
4.8
1/ L1 3/ L2 5/ L3 70
140
130
2/ T1 4/ T2 6/ T3
5
3RV2.4 size S3
176
70 171 30
1 / L1 3 / L2 5 / L3
83
165
155
2 / T1 4 / T2 6 / T3
5
20
45 96.9
49
97
1
65
45 96.9
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
49
97
149.4
4.8
1 / L1 3 / L2 5 / L3
95
96
70
NC
140
130
NO
98
97
2 / T1 4 / T2 6 / T3
5
1 / L1 3 / L2 5 / L3
83
95
96
NC
165
155
NO
98
97
2 / T1 4 / T2 6 / T3
5
20
75
45 70
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
1 / L1 3 / L2 5 / L3
45
90
2 / T1 4 / T2 6 / T3
2) Drilling pattern.
Ø5
126
112
45
144
106
2)
3RV1011-1AA10 1) 11/22/2019
Subject to change without notice
© Copyright Siemens
Page 6/7
17
NSB0_01726b
14 14 55
45 79
92
155
45
2)
1)
NSB0_01531c
5
70 132
7 153
157
169
Overview
1
Mounting location and function
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
The 3RV2 motor starter protectors/circuit breakers have three These components are easily fitted to the switches without the
main contact elements. In order to achieve maximum flexibility, use of any tools according to requirements.
auxiliary switches, signaling switches, auxiliary releases and
isolator modules can be supplied separately. Overview graphic, see page 7/7.
Front side Transverse auxiliary An auxiliary switch block can be inserted transversely on the front.
Note: switches, solid-state The overall width of the motor starter protectors/circuit breakers remains
compatible transverse unchanged.
• A maximum of four auxiliary contacts with auxiliary switches
auxiliary switches can be mounted on each
motor starter protector/circuit breaker. 1 NO + 1 NC
or
2 NO
or
1 CO
Left-hand side Lateral auxiliary switches One of the three lateral auxiliary switches can be mounted on the left side
Notes: (2 contacts) per motor starter protector/circuit breaker. The contacts of the auxiliary
1 NO + 1 NC switch close and open together with the main contacts of the motor starter
• A maximum of four auxiliary contacts with protector/circuit breaker.
auxiliary switches can be mounted on each or
motor starter protector/circuit breaker. 2 NO The width of the lateral auxiliary switch with two contacts is 9 mm.
• Lateral auxiliary switches (two contacts) or
and signaling switches can be mounted 2 NC
separately or together. Lateral auxiliary switches One lateral auxiliary switch with four contacts can be mounted on the left
• The signaling switch cannot be used for the (4 contacts) side per motor starter protector/circuit breaker. The contacts of the auxiliary
3RV27 and 3RV28 circuit breakers. switch close and open together with the main contacts of the motor starter
2 NO + 2 NC
protector/circuit breaker.
The width of the lateral auxiliary switch with four contacts is 18 mm.
Signaling switches One signaling switch can be mounted on the left side of each motor starter
7
Tripping 1 NO + 1 NC protector.
Short circuit 1 NO + 1 NC The signaling switch has two contact systems.
One contact system always signals tripping irrespective of whether this was
caused by a short circuit, an overload or an auxiliary release. The other
contact system only switches in the event of a short circuit. There is no
signaling as a result of switching off with the actuator.
In order to be able to switch on the motor starter protector again after a short
circuit, the signaling switch must be reset manually after the error cause has
been eliminated.
The overall width of the signaling switch is 18 mm.
Right-hand side Auxiliary releases
Notes: Shunt releases For remote-controlled tripping of the motor starter protector/circuit breaker.
• One auxiliary release can be mounted per The release coil should only be energized for short periods (see circuit
motor starter protector/circuit breaker. diagrams).
• Accessories cannot be mounted at the or
right-hand side of the 3RV21 motor starter
protectors for motor protection with overload Undervoltage releases Trips the motor starter protector/circuit breaker when the voltage is inter-
relay function. rupted and prevents the motor from being restarted accidentally when the
voltage is restored. Used for remote-controlled tripping of the motor starter
protector/circuit breaker.
Particularly suitable for EMERGENCY-STOP disconnection by way of corre-
sponding EMERGENCY-STOP pushbuttons according to DIN EN 60204-1.
or
Undervoltage releases with Function and use as for the undervoltage release without leading auxiliary
leading auxiliary contacts contacts, but with the following additional function: the auxiliary contacts will
2 NO open in switch position OFF to deenergize the coil of the undervoltage
release, thus interrupting energy consumption. In the "tripped" position,
these auxiliary contacts are not guaranteed to open. The leading contacts
permit the motor starter protector/circuit breaker to reclose.
The overall width of the auxiliary release is 18 mm.
Top Isolator modules Isolator modules can be mounted to the upper connection side of the motor
Notes: starter protectors.
• The isolator module cannot be used for the The supply cable is connected to the motor starter protector through the
3RV27 and 3RV28 circuit breakers. isolator module.
• The isolator module for size S2 The plug can only be unplugged when the motor starter protector is open
- can only be used with 3RV2 motor starter and isolates all 3 poles of the motor starter protector from the network.
protectors/circuit breakers up to max. 65 A The shock-protected isolation point is clearly visible and secured with a
- cannot be used with the transverse auxiliary padlock to prevent reinsertion of the plug.
switch
• The isolator module covers the terminal screws
of the transverse auxiliary switch. If the isolator
module is used, we therefore recommend that
either the lateral auxiliary switches be fitted or
that the isolator module not be mounted until For a complete overview of which accessories can be used for. the
the auxiliary switch has been wired. various motor starter protectors/circuit breakers, see page 7/2
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/41
Siemens IC 10 · 2015 7/31
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Mountable accessories
Overview
1
8
S00 and S0 motor starter protectors with mountable accessories
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
NSB0_02076
4
6.1
Mountable accessories for all sizes S00 ... S3 Mountable accessories for sizes Mountable accessories for sizes
1 Transverse auxiliary switch 6.1 Undervoltage release with S00, S0 7 Signaling switch (can not be S00 ... S3
leading auxiliary contacts used with 3RV27 and 3RV28
2 Lateral auxiliary switch with 2 contacts
(can not be used with 3RV21 S2, S3 circuit breakers)
3 Lateral auxiliary switch with 4 contacts circuit breakers) 8 Isolator module (can not be S0 and S2
4 Shunt release 6.2 Undervoltage release with used with 3RV27 and 3RV28
leading auxiliary contacts circuit breakers)
5 Undervoltage release
9 Terminal block E
1/42 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Mountable accessories
Circuit diagrams
1
Internal connections
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Shunt release Undervoltage Undervoltage release Lateral auxiliary switch
release with leading auxiliary contacts with 4 contacts
3RV19 02-1D / 3RV29 02-1D 3RV19 02-1A / 3RV29 02-1A 3RV19 01-1J / 3RV29 01-1J
3RV19 22-1C / 3RV29 22-1C
External connections
Shunt release Undervoltage release
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/43
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Mountable accessories
Circuit diagrams
1
Typical circuits
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
F1 Fuses (gL/gG)
H2: "Overload" or "Tripped by max. 10 A
auxiliary release" signal
Q1 MSP
S1 Signalling switch
Dimension drawings
Isolator modules
3RV29 28-1A 3RV29 38-1A
for MSPs size S00, S0 for MSPs size S2
54.8 144.7
56.9
107.9
1/44 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
3RV Motor Starter Protectors up to 100 A
Accessories – Busbar accessories
Overview
1
Busbar adapters
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
The MSPs are mounted directly The MSPs are snapped onto SIRIUS MSPs and combination starters with FastBus-busbar adapters
with the aid of busbar adapters the adapter and connected on snapped onto busbars
on FastBus-busbar systems with the line side. This prepared unit
40 mm and 60 mm centerline is then plugged directly onto the
spacing, in order to save space busbar system, and is thus con-
and to reduce wiring times and nected both mechanically and
costs. electrically at the same time.
FastBus-busbar adapters for Refer to page 1/10 for busbar
busbar systems with 40 mm adapters for specific MSPs and
centerline spacing are suitable accessories.
for copper busbars with a width
of 12 mm to 15 mm, while those Further busbar adapters for
with 60 mm centerline spacing snap-mounting direct-on-line
are suitable for widths of 12 mm starters and reversing starters,
to 30 mm. The busbars can be as well as additional accesso-
4 to 5 mm or 10 mm thick. ries such as line terminals and
outgoing terminals, busbar
copper, etc., can be found in
Section 5.
The busbars are suitable for between 2 and 5 circuit break- The motor starter protectors are snapped onto the adapter and
ers/motor starter protectors. However, any kind of extension is connected on the line side. This prepared unit is then plugged
possible by clamping the tags of an additional busbar (rotated directly onto the busbar system, and is thus connected both me-
by 180°) underneath the terminals of the respective last motor chanically and electrically at the same time.
starter protector. For further busbar adapters for snap-mounting direct-on-line
A combination of motor starter protectors of different sizes is starters and reversing starters as well as additional accessories
possible. The motor starter protectors are supplied by appropri- such as line terminals and outgoing terminals, flat copper profile,
ate feeder terminals. etc., can be found in Section 5.
3RV29 25-5AB
3RV19 15-1CB
3RV29 15-5B
NSB0_02079
NSB0_02080
3RV19 15-6AB
SIRIUS three-phase busbar system size S00/S0 SIRIUS load feeders with busbar adapters snapped onto busbars
The three-phase busbar systems are finger-safe. They are de- The three-phase busbar systems can also be used to construct
signed for any short-circuit stress which can occur at the output “Type E Starters” according to UL/CSA. Special feeder terminals
side of connected motor starter protectors. must be used for this purpose however (see “Selection and
Ordering Data” on page 1/11).
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/45
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Busbar accessories
Dimension drawings
1
55
110
168
1/46 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Busbar accessories
Dimension drawings
1
3RV19 35-3. . 3-phase busbar
for S2 MSP, modular spacing 75 mm
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
for 2 MSPs with accessories 3RV19 35-3A
for 3 MSPs with accessories 3RV19 35-3B
for 4 MSPs with accessories 3RV19 35-3C
15
33
98
75
130
168
3RV29 25-5AB. 3-phase line-side terminals 3RV29 25-5EB 3-phase line-side terminal
connection from above, 3RV29 35-5B a) 3RV1. 1 19 mm connection from above,
size S00 and S0 connection from above, 3RV1. 2 23 mm size S0
size S00 and S0
91
161
54.5 76.5
55,3
44 33,8
30,8
78,8
65.8
NSB0_02012
127,8
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/47
© Siemens 2021
Protection
3RV equipment
Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
General Data
SIRIUS 3RV2 motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
Busbar accessories
Accessories > Rotary operating mechanisms
Overview
1
Door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms Door-coupling rotary operating mechanism for mounting one
main switch in size S3 according to UL 508A and NFPA 79
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS
1 Actuator
3 Coupling driver
7
2 Plastic cover
4 Extension shaft (6 mm x 6 mm),
130 mm long 3 Coupling driver
5 Coupling enclosure 5 4 Extension shaft (8 mm x 8 mm), 300 mm long
5 Spacer
6 Control cabinet door
IC01_00713
4
6 Metal brackets for inserting
3 motor starter protector/circuit breaker
4
Comprising:
1 Actuator
3
2 Plastic cover
3 Coupling driver 6
2
4 Extension shaft (8 mm x 8 mm),
300 mm long 7
5 Spacer 5
1
6 Metal brackets for inserting
motor starter protector/circuit
breaker 4 SIRIUS 3RV2946-3C EMERGENCY OFF door-coupling rotary operating
mechanism for harsh operating conditions according to UL 508A and
7 Control cabinet door NFPA 79 with optional shaft support and supplementary handle
3 (EMERGENCY OFF version)
7
1
1/48 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Siemens IC 10 · 2021
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Rotary operating mechanisms
Circuit diagrams
1
Typical circuits
3RV MSP with 3RV19 36/3RV19 46 remote-controlled motorized
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
operating mechanism
US
~ ~
- +
1
O 2
M
3
4
5
L I T
v
NSB00024a
Dimensional drawings
Door coupling rotary mechanism
3RV29 26-0B/3RV29 26-0C short shaft 4), for MSP sizes S00, S0, S2 and S3
66
45 19 25
15
1...4 1) Lockable in 0 position, with
shackle diameter max. 8 mm
2) Mounting with screw cap
1) 3) Supplied with a shaft length of
330 mm; adaptable by shortening
of the shaft.
4) Supplied with a shaft length of
5 2) 130 mm; adaptable by shortening
of the shaft.
max 127 33 17 5) Grounding terminal 35 mm2 and
min 55 bracket for 330 mm shaft.
3
4)
24.3
Ø2
2.5
NSB01108
max 130
min 56
3RV29 26-0K/3RV29 26-0L long shaft (with bracket) 3), for MSP sizes S00, S0, S2 and S3
66
16 45 19 25
15
1...4
I ON
1)
0 OFF
NSB01090a
5 2)
5) max 327 33 17
min 55
3
3)
24.3
Ø2
2.5
NSB01108
max 330
min 56
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/49
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Rotary operating mechanisms
Dimension drawings
1
65
75
B
A
40
6
max. 341
D E F 62 14 H C
min. 42
1/50 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors
Motor Starter ProtectorsSIRIUS
General Data SIRIUS 3RV1 Motor Starter Protectors up to 100 A
Accessories — Enclosures and front plates
Accessories
Enclosures and front plates
Overview
1
Enclosure Front plates
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
For stand-alone installation of motor starter protector size S2 Motor starter protectors are frequently required to be actuated in
( In max = 65 A), molded-plastic enclosures for surface mounting any enclosure. Front plates equipped with a rotary operating
are available. mechanism for motor starter protector sizes S2 and S3 are avail-
able for this purpose.
When installed in a molded-plastic enclosures the motor starter
protectors have a rated operational voltage Ue of 500 V.
The molded-plastic enclosures are designed to degree of pro-
tection IP55.
NSB0_02194
NSB0_02193
7
Enclosures for surface mounting
All enclosures are equipped with N and PE terminals. There are
two knock-out cable entries for cable glands at the top and two
at the bottom; also on the rear corresponding cable entries are
scored. There is a knockout on the top of the enclosure for indi-
cator lights that are available as accessories.
In the enclosure for motor starter protector size S2 there is also
room for the laterally mounted auxiliary release. There is no pro-
vision for installing a motor starter protector with a signaling
switch.
The molded-plastic enclosures of the size S2 motor starter pro-
tectors are fitted with a rotary operating mechanism.
The enclosures can be supplied with either a black rotary oper-
ating mechanism or with an EMERGENCY-STOP rotary operat-
ing mechanism with a red/yellow knob.
The rotary operating mechanisms can be locked in the Open po-
sition with up to 3 padlocks.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/51
Siemens IC 10 · 2012 7/61
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Mounting accessories
Dimension drawings
1
1/52 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV Spring-type terminal infeed system
Design
1
Installation guidelines
PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Distance in Y direction from live, earthed or insulated parts ac-
cording to IEC 60947-4: 10 mm.
In addition, the installation guidelines for motor starter protectors
or fuseless load feeders including the clearances must be com-
plied with.
Technical specifications
Type 3RV29 .7
Rated operational voltage Ue
• IEC
- 10 % overvoltage V 500
- 5 % overvoltage V 525
• UL/CSA V 600
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Rated current In A 63
Permissible ambient temperature
• During storage/transport °C -50 ... +80
• During operation °C -20 ... +60
Permissible rated current of the 3RV10 11 motor starter protectors
(size S00) at control cabinet internal temperature
• +60 °C % 100
Permissible rated current of the 3RV10 21 motor starter protectors
(size S0) up to 16 A at control cabinet internal temperature
• +60 °C % 100
Permissible rated current for 3RV1. 21 motor starter protectors (size S0)
from 16 A at control cabinet internal temperature
• +40 °C % 100
• +60 °C % 87
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 IP201)
Touch protection acc. to IEC 61140 Finger-safe
Conductor cross-sections for main circuit infeed
• Solid, stranded: mm2 4 ... 25
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 4 ... 25
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 6 ... 25
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 10 ... 3
Conductor cross-sections of terminal block
• Solid mm2 1.5 ... 6
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 1.5 ... 4
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 1.5 ... 6
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 15 ... 10
1)
In infeed terminal compartment without a conductor connected: IP00.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/53
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV Cage clamp infeed system
3RV29 17-1.
108
75 108 a
70
80
128
128
45
4,5
NSB0_01248
278
15
7,5
75
S00 S0
a 104 125
128
128
128
45
4,5
278
NSB0_01249
15
7,5
75
S00 S0
a 104 125
1/54 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Industrial Control Product Catalog 2021
contents
Section Overview 2/2 - 2/5 SIRIUS Contactor Spare Parts
Coils
2 SIRIUS
Section
2/96 - 2/100
Product Overview 2/6 - 2/7
Arc Chutes 2/101
SIRIUS Contactors Contact Kits 2/101
3RT20, 3-pole to 95A 2/8
2
Obsolete Contactor / Relay Spare Parts...... 2/104 - 2/105
3RT10, 3-pole to 500A 2/9
3RT10, 3-pole to 500A with Integrated Safety 2/11 - 2/10 Design / Function Overview
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT12, 3-pole Vacuum to 500A 2/12 3RT20 Contactors, S00 to S3 2/106 - 2/107
3RT23, 4-pole with 4 NO 2/13 3RT10 Contactors, S6 to S12 2/108 - 2/109
3RT24, 3-pole for Resistive Loads 2/14 WYE-Delta Starters 2/112 - 2/117
3RT25, 4-pole with 2 NO + 2 NC 2/15 3RH2 Control Relays 2/118
3RT26, for Capacitor Switching 2/21 3TF6 Vacuum Contactors up to 820A 2/119
3RT20, Interface Coupling Contactors 2/22 - 2/23 3RT / 3RH Accessories 2/120 - 2/122
3RT20 Motor Contactors for DC Operation 2/18 - 2/20 Technical Data
3RH21 Contactor Relays 2/16 - 2/17 3RT10 / 3RT20 Contactors 2/123 - 2/153
3RA13 / 3RA23 Reversing Contactors 2/39 - 2/46 3RT12 Vacuum Contactors 2/129, 2/154 - 2/159
3RT, 3TF Safety Contactors and 3RT24 Resistive Load Contactors 2/160 - 2/167
3RH2, 3TH2 Safety Control Relays 2/24 - 2/25
3RT23 4-pole Contactors 4 NO 2/168 - 2/169
Function Modules for Communications 2/26 - 2/38
3RT25 4-pole Contactors 2 NO & 2 NC 2/170 - 2/171
3RA24, Wye-Delta Starting 2/47 - 2/50
3RT26 Capacitor Switching Contactors 2/172
Contactor Coil Codes 2/51
3RT20 Interface Relays 2/173
SIRIUS Control Relays & Coupling Relays 3TF6 Vacuum Contactors up to 820A 2/174 - 2/179
3RH2 Control Relays 2/52 3TC DC Switching Contactors 2/180 - 2/183
3RH24 Latched Control Relays 2/53 Accessories 2/184 - 2/186
Auxiliary Switches 2/53 3RH2 Control and Latching Relays 2/187 - 2/190
3RH21 Coupling Relays 2/54 3RH21 Coupling Relays 2/191
Special Application Contactors (3TF6 / 3TB5 / 3TC) Circuit Diagrams
3TF6 Vacuum Contactors up to 820A 2/55 - 2/56 3RT Contactors & Accessories 2/192 - 2/200
3TC DC Switching Contactors 2/57 - 2/58 3RA23 Reversing Contactors 2/201
3TB5 Contactor Coils 2/102 - 2/103 WYE-Delta Starters 2/202
3TF6 Vacuum Contactors up to 820A 2/203
SIRIUS Contactor & Relay Accessories
3RH2 Control & Latching Relays 2/205
Overview 2/59 - 2/67
3RH21 Coupling Relays 2/204
Auxiliary Switches 2/68 - 2/71
AuxiliaryTime Delay and Latching Blocks 2/72 - 2/73 Position of Terminals
Surge and EMC Suppressors 2/75 - 2/76 3RT Contactors and Accessories 2/205 - 2/209
Contactor Accessories 2/78 - 2/81 3RT Capacitor Contactors 2/208
Reversing Accessories 2/82 - 2/84 3TF6 Vacuum Contactors up to 820A 2/210
Wye-delta Accessories 2/85 3RH2 Control Relays 2/205
NEMA 1 Enclosures 2/95 Dimensions
SIRIUS Current Monitoring Relays 3RT, 3-pole Contactors S00 to S3 2/211 - 2/214
3RR21 Basic Versions 2/86 - 2/89 3RT10, 3-pole Contactors S6 to S12 2/215 - 2/216
3RR22 Standard Versions 2/86 - 2/89 3RT24, 3-pole Contactors for Resistive Loads 2/215 - 2/216
3RR24 with IO-Link 2/90 - 2/93 3RT10, Contactors S6 to S12, integrated safety 2/217
Accessories 2/94 3RT12, 3-pole Vacuum Contactors 2/218
3RT23, 3RT25 4-pole Contactors 2/219
Special Application Contactor Accessories
3RT26, Contactors for Capacitor Switching 2/220
Auxiliary Contacts 2/55
3RA13 / 23 Reversing Contactors 2/221 - 2/223
Box Terminals and Covers 2/56
3TF6 Vacuum Contactors up to 820A 2/224
Surge Suppressors for 3TB, 3TC, 3TF 2/56
Contactor Accessories 2/225 - 2/226
3RH2 Control and Coupling Relays 2/227
(Section was last modified on 05/18/21) Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/1
IEC Power Control SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors for switching three-phase motors
contents
Contactors for switching three-phase motors
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT12 vacuum contactors, 3-pole, 3RA13 / 23 contactor assemblies for Wye Delta for
150 to 400 HP, reversing, 3 to 75 HP, sizes S00 to S3 customer assembly of
sizes S10 and S12 with screw or spring loaded connections sizes S00 to S12
Page Page Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• AC/DC operation 2/12 • AC/DC operation 2/42 • For wye-delta starting 2/49
• Accessories 2/68 • Accessories 2/82 • Accessories 2/85
• Spare parts 2/100 • Spare parts 2/96 • Spare parts 2/96
Description 2/108 Overview 2/40 Overview 2/110
Technical data 2/154 Description 2/39 Description 2/112
Internal circuit diagrams 2/198 Circuit diagrams 2/201 Circuit diagrams 2/202
Position of terminals 2/206 Position of terminals 2/206
Dimension drawings 2/218 Dimension drawings 2/221
contents
Contactors for special applications
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT14 / 24 contactors, 3RT23 contactors, 3RT25 contactors,
Ie /AC-1: 140 to 690 A, AC-1: 18 to 140 A with 4 NO main AC-3: 7.5-25 HP with 2 NO + 2 NC
3-pole, sizes S3 to S12, contacts, sizes S00 to S3 main contacts, sizes S00 to S2
with screw connections with screw or spring connections with screw or spring connections
Page Page Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• AC/DC operation 2/14 • AC/DC operation 2/13 • AC/DC operation 2/15
• Accessories 2/68 • Accessories 2/68 • Accessories 2/68
• Spare parts 2/99 • Spare parts 2/96 • Spare parts 2/96
Descriptions 2/14 Description 2/13 Description 2/15
Technical Data 2/160 Technical Data 2/168 Technical Data 2/170
Internal circuit diagrams 2/198 Internal circuit diagrams 2/193 Internal circuit diagrams 2/192
Position of terminals 2/206 Position of terminals 2/209 Position of terminals 2/205
Dimension drawings 2/213 Dimension drawings 2/219 Dimension drawings 2/219
contents
Contactors for special applications
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
Note: MSPs and Contactors of the same frame size are made to easily fit together with the use of a link module or can be purchased pre-assembled as 3RA starter
assemblies. See section 4.
Note: Contactors and Overloads of the frame size S00 - S3 are made to easily fit together without the use of accessories.
Note: This is only a guide to decode the model number. All possible combinations of these are not available.
Contents
SIRIUS contactor relays
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RH21, 3RH22 control relays 4- and 8-pole, 3RH24 latched control relays, 4-pole,
size S00, AC/DC operation Page size S00, AC/DC operation Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• With screw connections 2/52 • With screw connections 2/53
• With spring connections 2/52 • Accessories for 3RH2 2/53
• Accessories for 3RH2 2/53
Overview 2/16 Application 2/118
Technical data 2/187 Technical data 2/187
Terminal diagrams 2/204 Terminal diagrams 2/204
Position of terminals 2/205 Position of terminals 2/205
Dimension drawings 2/227 Dimension drawings 2/227
3RH21 coupling relays for switching auxiliary circuits, 3RR current monitoring relays for direct mounting
4-pole, size S00, DC operation Page to SIRIUS contactors Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• With screw connections 2/54 • Basic versions 2/89
• with Cage Clamp connections 2/54 • Standard versions 2/89
• Versions with IO-Link 2/93
• Accessories for 3RR 2/94
3RT20 contactors
Type 3RT2015 3RT2016 3RT2017 3RT2018 3RT2023 3RT2024 3RT2025 3RT2026 3RT2027 3RT2028 3RT2035 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2038
AC/DC operation (p. 2/8) (p. 2/8) (p. 2/8)
Type
AC/DC operation
Maximum 3-phase horsepower ratings at 460V (UL and CSA listed values)
200 V HP 1.5 2 3 3 2 3 5 7.5 10 10 10 15 20 20
230 V HP 2 3 3 5 3 3 5 7.5 10 10 15 15 20 25
460 V HP 3 5 7.5 10 5 7.5 10 15 20 25 30 40 50 50
575 V HP 5 7.5 10 10 7.5 10 15 20 25 25 40 50 50 60
AC-3
Ie/AC-3/400V A 6 9 12 16 9 12 17 25 32 38 40 50 65 80
230 V kW 1.5 2.2 3 4 2.2 3 4 5.5 7.5 11 11 15 18.5 22
400 V kW 3 4 5.5 7.5 4 5.5 7.5 11 15 18.5 18.5 22 30 37
500 V kW 3.5 4.5 5.5 7.5 4.5 7.5 10 11 18.5 18.5 22 30 37 37
690 V kW 4 5.5 5.5 7.5 7.5 7.5 11 11 18.5 18.5 22 22 37 45
1000 V kW — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
AC-4 (at Ia = 6 x Ie)
400 V kW 3 4 4 5.5 4 5.5 7.5 7.5 11 11 18.5 22 30 37
400 V (200,000 kW
operating cycles) 1.15 2 2 2.5 2 2.6 3.5 4.4 6 6 11.6 12.6 14.7 15.8
AC-1 (40°C, ≤ 690V)
Ie A 18 22 22 22 40 40 40 40 50 50 60 70 80 90
Mechanical interlocks 3RA2912-2H (p. 2/84) 3RA2922-2H (p. 2/84) 3RA2934-2B (p. 2/82)
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
Type S3 3RT2. 4 S6 3RT1. 5 S10 3RT1. 6 S12 3RT1. 7 S14 3TF6
3RT20 contactors
Type 3RT2045 3RT2046 3RT2047 3RT1054 3RT1055 3RT1056 3RT1064 3RT1065 3RT1066 3RT1075 3RT1076 — —
AC/DC operation (p. 2/8) (p. 2/11) (p. 2/11) (p. 2/11)
Type 3RT1264 3RT1265 3RT1266 3RT1275 3RT1276 3TF68 3TF69
AC/DC operation (p. 2/12) (p. 2/12) (p. 2/55)
Maximum 3-phase horsepower ratings at 460V (UL and CSA listed values)
200 V HP 25 30 30 40 50 60 60 75 100 125 150 200 290
230 V HP 30 30 40 50 60 75 75 100 125 150 200 250 350
460 V HP 60 75 75 100 125 150 150 200 250 300 400 500 700
575 V HP 60 75 100 125 150 200 200 250 300 400 500 650 860
AC-3
Ie/AC-3/400V A 80 95 110 115 150 185 225 265 300 400 500 630 820
230 V kW 22 22 30 37 45 55 55 75 90 132 160 200 260
400 V kW 37 45 55 55 75 90 110 132 160 200 250 335 450
500 V kW 45 55 75 75 90 110 160 160 200 250 355 434 600
690 V kW 55 75 90 110 132 160 200 250 250 400 400/500 600 800
1000 V kW 37 — — 75 90 90 90/315 132/355 132/400 250/560 250/710 600 800
AC-4 (at Ia = 6 x Ie)
400 V kW 37 45 55 55 75 90 110 132 160 200 250 355 400
400 V (200,000 kW
operating cycles) 17.9 22 24.3 29 38 45 54/78 66/93 71/112 84/140 98/161 168 191
AC-1 (40°C, ≤ 690V)
Ie A 125 130 130 160 185 215 275/330 330 330 430/610 610 700 910
460 V HP 60 75 75 100 125 150 150 200 250 300 400 500 700
Installation kits / 3RA2943-2AA1 (p. 2/83) 3RA1953-2A (p. 2/83) 3RA1963-2A (p. 2/83) 3RA1973-2A (p. 2/83) 3TX7680-1A
wiring connectors
Mechanical interlocks 3RA2934-2B 3RA1954-2A (p. 2/82) 3TX7686-1A
Note: Ring lug terminals are also available in size S00 & S0 AC Coil Selection for 3RT201 through 3RT204
contactors, except contactors with communication inter- ●●Coil Code C23) H24) K6 P6 U6 V6 T6
face or UC coil. Change the 8th digit of the order number
to a “4”, e. g. 3RT2015-4AK61. 60 Hz 24 V 48 V 120 V 240 V 277 V 480 V 600 V
50 Hz 24 V 48 V 110 V 220 V — — —
For further coil voltages, see page 2/51.
For auxiliaries and accessories, see page 2/68-2/85.
For spare parts, see page 2/96-2/101. DC Coil Selection for 3RT201 & 3RT202 (for 3RT203 & 3RT204 see UC)
For technical data, see page 2/123-2/144. ●●Coil Code A45) B4 W4 E4 F4 G4 M4
For description, see page 2/106-2/107. DC 12 V 24 V 48 V 60 V 110 V 125 V 220 V
For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/192-2/199.
For dimension drawings, see page 2/211-2/214. UC Coil Selection for 3RT202 UC Coil Selection for 3RT203 & 3RT204
●●Coil Code B3 F3 P35) ●● B3 F3 P36)
1) All
terminals are spring loaded on frame sizes S00 & S0. UC 21-28V 95-130V 200-280V 20-33V 83-155V 175-280V
Only the coil terminals are spring loaded on frame sizes
S2 & S3. 3) Use Code B0 for 3RT201, S00 5) 3RT201 and 3RT202 only
2) Max UL FLA = 65A at 460V 4) Use Code H0 for 3RT201, S00 6) at upper limit = 1.1 x Us
2/8 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
IEC Power Control SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT contactors, 3-pole – Size S6-S12 and NEMA size 4-6
2
* Box terminals ordered separately
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT1054-6A. . 6 3RT1065-6P. . 5
Spring-type
Amp Single-phase Three-phase Auxiliary Screw Terminals terminals on coil Weight
Ratings HP ratings HP ratings contacts on coil and aux. and aux. contacts approx.
Frame
Size AC3 AC1 115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V NO NC Order No. Order No. kg
Spring-type
Single-phase Three-phase Auxiliary Screw Terminals terminals on coil Weight
HP ratings HP ratings contacts on coil and aux. and aux. contacts approx.
NEMA Amp
SIze Ratings 115V 230V 208V 230V 460V 575V NO NC Order No. Order No. kg
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/9
IEC Power Control SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors with Integrated Safety
3RT contactors, 3-pole up to 400 HP
Features Benefits
New Contactors from 100 to 400 HP for • Savings on standard outputs in the
direct control by fail-safe controllers controller
2
Overview
The size S6 to S12 range of tried and tested contactors from 100 The big advantage of this solution is that it saves on additional,
to 400 HP @ 480V has been expanded to include versions suitable possibly positively-driven coupling relays and makes evaluation of
for direct control from fail-safe controllers, rendering the coupling safety information considerably easier.
level superfluous. The new contactors are also available with non- This reduction in coupling relays is also a huge plus point for
removable, lateral auxiliary switches, enabling fulfilment of Swiss non-safety applications. Whereas previously space, money and
Accident Insurance Institute (SUVA) requirements. wiring expertise were required in order to operate contactors from
The new contactors constitute the logical extension and further 100 HP and higher using controllers, both functional and safety
development of the SIRIUS Modular System, serving to promote switching can now take place by direct activation.
safe switching. They are the first contactors on the market to be Using the Safety Evaluation Tool you can quickly find the right
equipped with an input for fail-safe signals. This makes it possible contactor and safely configure your application.
to attain SIL 2 and/or PL c with just one contactor and SIL 3 and/
or PL e with two contactors in series according to IEC 62061 and
ISO 13849-1.
Save space and costs with a direct connection to the controller – no need for coupling relays!
Feedback
Feedback
F-DQ
F-DQ DQ
A1
A1
PLC-IN
F-PLC-IN
A2 A2
A1
A1
PLC-IN
F-PLC-IN
A2
A2
N/-
N/-/-
2
• Attainable
– With one Safety Integrity
contactor: SILLevel
CL 2 (SIL):
acc. to IEC 62061 or PL c acc. terminals
- Withtoone ISOcontactor:
13849-1 SIL CL 2 acc. to IEC 62061 or PL c acc. • Mainscrews, spring washer
conductors: Busbarand nut is enclosed.
connections;
to– ISO
With 13849-1
two contactors in series: SIL CL 3 acc. to IEC 62061 or a connection kit with screws, spring washer and nut is
Assemblies
Contactors and
- WithPL two contactors in series: SIL CL 3 toacc. to IEC 62061 testor enclosed.
For more information on safety systems, see Section 13.
3
Standards
Size S0: In order to make 4-pole contactor assemblies using two
3RT232. contactors, the fourth pole of the left-hand contactor must
IEC 60947-1, EN 60947-1 always be moved to the left-hand side. The contactor assembly
IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1 can then be made easily with the aid of the 3RA2922-2H mechani-
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1 (auxiliary switches) cal interlock and connecting clip set fitted between the
two contactors.
Design Sizes S2 and S3: Contactor assemblies can be made using two
The contactors are suitable for use in any climate. They are safe 3RT23 3 or 3RT23 4. contactors in conjunction with the laterally
2
from touch to DIN VDE 0106, Part 100. The accessories for the mountable mechanical interlock and the mechanical connectors.
3-pole SIRIUS contactors can also be used for the 4-pole de- The mechanical interlock for fitting onto the front cannot be used
Assemblies
Contactors and
signs. for size S2 and S3 contactors.
Mountable auxiliary contacts
Size S00: 4 auxiliary contacts of which up to 3 can be NC. Application
Size S0 & S2: 4 additional auxiliary contacts up to 3 can be NC. • Switching resistive loads
Sizes S2 and S3: Up to 4 auxiliary contacts (either laterally • Isolating systems with unearthed or poorly earthed neutral
mounted or snappped onto the top). conductors
Contactor assemblies with mechanical interlock • System transfers when alternative AC power supplies are used
The 4-pole 3RT23 contactors with 4 NO contacts as the main • As contactors which only carry current and do not have to switch
contacts are suitable for making contactor assemblies with a me- in case of inductive loads – e.g. variable-speed operating
chanical interlock, e.g. for system transfers. mechanisms
Size S00: Contactor assemblies can be made using two 3RT231. • Switching mixed loads in distribution systems (e.g. for supply-
contactors in conjunction with the mechanical interlock and two ing heaters, lamps, motors, PC power supply units) with p.f. >
connecting clips (Order No. 3RA2912-2H, pack comprising 10 0.8 according to IEC 60947-4-1, test conditions for utilization
interlocking elements and 20 clips for 10 contactor assemblies, category AC-1
see accessories on page 2/72).
1) Size S00 and S0 contactors are also available with For further voltages, see page 2/51. For technical data, see page 2/168-2/169.
spring-type terminals. Replace the 8th digit of the order For coil voltage tolerance, p. 2/51 For in. circuit diagrams, see page 2/193-2/198.
no. with a “2” e.g. “3RT23 16-2AK60” For auxiliaries and accessories, For dimension drawings, see page 2/219.
2) Minimum conductor cross-section 8 AWG.
see page 2/68-2/85.
For spare parts, see page 2/96-2/101.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/13
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT24, 3-pole for switching resistive loads (AC-1)
Application
AC and DC operation The contactors are suitable for (AC-1) or as contactors, for The accessories for the SIRIUS
(size S3) use in any climate. They are example in variable-speed 3RT10/3RT20 contactors can
UC operation (AC/DC) safe from touch to DIN VDE drives which normally only have also be used here.
(sizes S6 to S12) 0106 Part 100. to carry the current.
IEC 60 947, EN 60 947 3RT14/3RT24 contactors are
(VDE 0660) used for switching resistive loads.
2
Universal Coil Selection for 3RT145 through 3RT147: Conventional Operation For further coil voltages, see page 2/51.
Coil Code B3 D3 F3 M3 P3 U3 V3 R3 S3 T3
For auxiliaries and accessories,
Volts AC/DC 23 .. 26 V 42 .. 48 V 110 .. 127 V 200 .. 220 V 220 .. 240 V 240 .. 277 V 380 .. 420 V 440 .. 480 V 500 .. 550 V 575 .. 600 V see page 2/68-2/85.
40 - 60 Hz, DC For spare parts, see page 2/96-2/101.
For technical data, see page 2/160-2/167.
For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/198.
Universal Coil Selection for 3RT145 through 3RT147: Solid-State Note: B3 code not available for
Coil Code B3 F3 P3 For dimension drawings,
Remaining Lifetime Contactors.
Volts AC/DC 21 .. 27.3 V 96 .. 127 V 200 .. 277 V see page 2/213, 2/215-2/216.
40 - 60 Hz, DC
2/14 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT25 contactors, 4-pole (2 NO + 2 NC) contacts for switching motors
2
climate. They are safe to touch accord- mounted or snapped onto the top; auxiliary
ing to EN 50274. The accessories for the switch blocks to EN 50 012 and EN 50
Assemblies
Contactors and
3-pole SIRIUS contactors can also be 005)
used for the 4-pole designs.
NO NC
A2 V UC
2 R2 R4 4 14 22
35 30 20 60 55 1 1 24 3RT25 35-1AC20 20-33 3RT25 35-1NB30
110/120 3RT25 35-1AK60 83-155 3RT25 35-1NF30
220/240 3RT25 35-1AP60 175-280 3RT25 35-1NP30
41 30 25 70 60 1 1 24 3RT25 36-1AC20 20-33 3RT25 36-1NB30
110/120 3RT25 36-1AK60 83-155 3RT25 36-1NF30
220/240 3RT25 36-1AP60 175-280 3RT25 36-1NP30
For further voltages, see page 2/51. 1) For changing polarity; not suitable for reversing. 3) Size S00:
For auxiliaries and accessories, see page 2/68-2/85. 2) Size S00 and S0 contactors are also available
Coil voltage tolerance
For spare parts, see page 2/96-2/101. at 50 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
with spring-type terminals. Replace the 8th
For technical data, see page 2/170-2/171. at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us
digit of the order no. with a “2” e.g. “3RT25
For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/193-2/198. 16-2AK60” 4) The NC contact can switch up to 5 HP.
For dimension drawings, see page 2/219.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/15
SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
3RT, 3RH Contactors for Special Applications
3RT, 3RH Contactors
Contactors with ExtendedforOperating
SpecialRange 0.7 ... 1.25 x Us, for Railway Applications
Applications
3RH21 contactor relays
3RH21 contactor relays
Overview Application
DC operation For operation in installations which are subject both to consider-
able variations in the control voltage and to high ambient tem-
IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1, for requirements according to peratures, e. g. railway applications under extreme climatic
IEC 60077-1 and IEC 60077-2. conditions, rolling mills, etc.
The contactor relays are finger-safe according to EN 50274. The Also for control supply voltages with battery buffer for longer
size S00 contactor relays have spring-type connections for all
2
3
tactor relays (across the full coil operating range) is -40 to These contactor relays have an extended operating range from
+70 °C. 0.7 to 1.25 x Us; the solenoid coils are fitted with a suppressor
diode. An additional series resistor is not required.
Uninterrupted duty at temperatures > +60 °C reduces the
mechanical endurance, the current carrying capacity of the con- Note:
ducting paths and the switching frequency. An additional auxiliary switch block cannot be mounted.
Control and auxiliary circuits Side-by-side mounting
The solenoid coils of the contactor relays have an extended coil A clearance of 10 mm is required for side-by-side mounting at
operating range from 0.7 to 1.25 x Us and are fitted as standard ambient temperatures > 60 °C ≤ 70 °C.
with suppressor diodes to provide protection against overvolt- Contactor relays with series resistor
age. The opening delay is consequently 2 to 5 ms longer than for
standard contactors. Control and auxiliary circuits
The DC solenoid systems of the contactor relays are modified (to
hold-in coil) by means of a series resistor.
The size S00 contactor relays are supplied prewired with a plug-
on module containing the series resistor. The suppressor diode
is integrated.
L+
L-
S1
E1+
RV K1
K1 13 23 31
NSB0_02177
A2-
14 24 32
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3
A A A A NO NC V DC kg
3RH21 contactor relays
Size S00
Without series resistor
Terminal designations according to EN 50011
2 NO + 2 NC, identification number 22E
13 21 31 43
A1(+)
A2(–)
14 22 32 44
10 3 2 1 2 21) 24 3RH21 22-2KB40 0.300
110 3RH21 22-2KF40 0.300
With series resistor
Terminal designations according to EN 50005
2 NO + 1 NC, identification number 21E
13 23 31
A1(+)
A2(–)
14 24 32
10 3 2 1 2 12) 24 3RH21 22-2KB40-0LA0 0.300
110 3RH21 22-2KF40-0LA0 0.300
1) It is not possible to mount an auxiliary switch block.
2) 4-pole auxiliary switch block according to EN 50005 can be mounted.
More information
Contactors Type 3RH21 ..
Upright mounting position
• Contactors with series resistor Special version (on request)
• Contactors without series resistor Special version (on request)
Ambient temperature
• During operation °C -40 ... +70
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Solenoid coil operating range DC 0.7 ... 1.25 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils For cold coil and 1.0 x Us
• Contactors with series resistor - Closing W 13
- Closed W 4
• Contactors without series resistor - Closing W 2.8
- Closed W 2.8
L-
Ambient temperature
3
S1
The permissible ambient temperature for operation of the con-
tactors (across the full coil operating range) is -40 to +70 °C.
Uninterrupted duty at temperatures > +60 °C reduces the E1+
mechanical endurance, the current carrying capacity of the Rv
conducting paths and the switching frequency. Q1
NSB0_02178
A2-
standard with suppressor diodes. The opening delay is 2/T1 4/T2 6/T3
consequently 2 to 5 ms longer than for standard contactors.
Application The size S00 contactors are supplied prewired with a plug-on
module containing the series resistor. The suppressor diode is
For operation in installations which are subject both to integrated. A 4-pole auxiliary switch block (according to
considerable variations in the control voltage and to high EN 50005) can be fitted additionally.
ambient temperatures, e. g. railway applications under extreme
A circuit diagram showing the terminals is labeled on each con-
climatic conditions, rolling mills, etc.
tactor. One NC of the auxiliary contacts is required for the series
Also for control supply voltages with battery buffer for longer resistor function. The selection and ordering data shows the
operating times should the battery charging fail. number of additional, unassigned auxiliary contacts. With size
S00 it is possible to extend the number of auxiliary contacts.
Contactors without series resistor
Side-by-side mounting
Control and auxiliary circuits
At ambient temperatures up to 70 °C, the size S00 contactors
These contactors have an extended operating range from and contactor relays are allowed to be mounted side by side.
0.7 to 1.25 x Us; on size S00 the coils are fitted with suppressor
diodes, on size S0 with varistors. An additional series resistor is 3RT20 2. contactors with solid-state operating mechanism,
not required. extended operating range
Note: Control and auxiliary circuits
An additional auxiliary switch block cannot be mounted.
The solenoid coils of the contactors have an extended coil oper-
Side-by-side mounting ating range from 0.7 to 1.3 x Us and are fitted as standard with
varistors to provide protection against overvoltage.
A clearance of 10 mm is required for side-by-side mounting at
ambient temperatures > 60 °C ≤ 70 °C. The contactors are energized via upstream control electronics
which ensure the coil operating range of 0.7 to 1.3 x Us at an
ambient temperature of 70 °C. They are supplied as complete
units with integrated coil electronics. A varistor is integrated for
damping opening surges in the coil.
The mounting possibilities for auxiliary switches correspond to
those of the standard contactors for switching motors in the
matching size (see page
page 2/60).
3/6).
Side-by-side mounting
Side-by-side mounting is permitted at ambient temperatures up
to 70 °C for these contactor versions in size S0.
2/18 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/55
SIRIUS
3RT, 3RH Contactors for Special Applications
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3
A2(–)
2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 14
• 1 NC, identification number 01
A1(+) 1/L1 3/L2 5/L3 21
A2(–)
2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 22
12 -- 3 7.5 10 10E1) 1 -- 24 3RT20 17-2KB41 0.300
125 3RT20 17-2KG41 0.300
12 -- 3 7.5 10 011) -- 1 24 3RT20 17-2KB42 0.300
125 3RT20 17-2KG42 0.300
With series resistor
A2(–)
2/T1 4/T2 6/T3
12 -- 3 7.5 10 --2) -- 13) 24 3RT20 17-2KB42-0LA0 0.300
125 3RT20 17-2KG42-0LA0 0.300
16 -- 5 10 10 --2) -- 13) 24 3RT20 18-2KB42-0LA0 0.300
125 3RT20 18-2KG42-0LA0 0.300
For
Foraccessories
accessoriesand
andspare
spareparts,
parts,see page
see 2/68-2/71.
page 3/93.
1) It is not possible to mount an auxiliary switch block. A clearance of 10 mm
is required for side-by-side mounting at ambient temperatures > 60 °C.
2) One 4-pole auxiliary switch block according to EN 50005 can be mounted;
no distance required up to 70 °C.
3) NC contact cannot be used because it is required for switching the series
resistor.
4) Versions available with screw terminals.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/19
3/56 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT, 3RH Contactors for Special Applications
3RT, 3RH Contactors
Contactors with ExtendedforOperating
SpecialRange
Applications
0.7 ... 1.25 x Us, for Railway Applications
3RT20 motor contactors, 7.5 ... 25 HP
3RT20 motor contactors, 7.5 ... 25 HP
DC operation · DC solenoid system
Spring-type terminals
For screw and snap-on mounting onto standard mounting rail
Solenoid coil fitted with varistor (S0)
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
3
3RT20 2. -2K . 4 0 3RT20 2 . -2X . 40-0LA2
A2(–)
2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 14 22
More information
Contactors Type 3RT20 17 3RT20 2. 3RT20 2.-2XB40- 3RT20 2.-2XF40-
0LA2 0LA2
Ambient temperature
• During operation °C -40 ... +70
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Solenoid coil operating range DC 0.7 ... 1.25 x Us 0.7 ... 1.3 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils For cold coil and 1.0 x Us
• Contactors with series resistor - Closing W 13 -- -- --
- Closed W 4 -- -- --
• Contactors without series resistor - Closing W 2.8 4.5 -- --
- Closed W 2.8 4.5 -- --
• Contactors with solid-state operating - Closing W -- -- 6.7 13.2
mechanism
- Closed W -- -- 0.8 1.56
All specs and technical specs not mentioned here are identical
to those of the standard contactors for switching motors.
2
The 3RT26 capacitor contactors nection with the capacitors. capacitor contactor of sizes
are application specific variants S0 contains the three leading 3RT20 contactor variant, see
of the size S00 to S2 SIRIUS NO contacts and one stan- the technical data.
Assemblies
Contactors and
Innovations contactors. The dard NO contact, which is
capacitors are precharged by unassigned.
means of the mounted leading
NO contacts and resistors; only
then do the main contacts close.
Size S0
1Ø 4.8 5.3 11 13 24 1NO / 2NC 24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT26 25-1AC25 0.49
3Ø 8.3 9.1 18 23 120 V, 60 Hz 3RT26 25-1AK65
240 V, 60 Hz 3RT26 25-1AP65
Size S2
1Ø 14 16 33 40 72A 2 NC 23-33 VUC 3RT26 36-1NB35 1.11
3Ø 25 27 55 69 83-155 VUC 3RT26 36-1NF35
175-280 VUC 3RT26 36-1NP35
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/21
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT20 coupling contactors (interface) for switching motors, 3-pole
AC and DC operation
IEC 60947, EN 60947. The 3RT20 1 coupling contactors Depending on the version, the
The 3RT20 coupling contactors for cannot be expanded with auxiliary solenoid coils are supplied either
switching motors are tailored to the switch blocks. without overvoltage damping or with
special requirements of working with Coupling contactors have a low a diode, suppressor diode or varistor
electronic controls. power consumption and an extended connected as standard.
solenoid coil operating range.
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT2015-1HB41 3RT2015-2HB41
Amps HP NO NC kg
Diode 12 7.5 10E 1 – 3RT20 17-1J B41 3RT20 17-2J B41 0.28/0.30
integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 17-1J B42 3RT20 17-2J B42
Suppressor diode 12 7.5 10E 1 – 3RT20 17-1KB41 3RT20 17-2KB41 0.28/0.30
integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 17-1KB42 3RT20 17-2KB42
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT2015-1VB41 3RT2015-2VB41 3RT2024-1KB40
Amps HP NO NC kg
For screwing and snapping onto
35 mm standard mounting rail
Size S00
Terminal designations according to EN 50 012
Rated control supply voltage Us =DC 24 V, coil voltage tolerance 0.85 to 1.85 × Us
Power consumption of the coils 1.6 W at 24 V (no auxiliary switch blocks can be mounted)
Size S0
Rated control supply voltage Us = DC 24 V, coil voltage tolerance 0.7 to 1.25 × Us
Power consumption of the coils 4.5 W at 24 V no auxiliary switch blocks can be mounted.
Applications
“Safety” Contactors Siemens Contactors for “Safety” Control Relays Siemens Control Relays for
Safety rated contactors are “Safety” applications: Safety rated control relays “Safety” applications:
required to have mirrored All Siemens standard 3RT, 3TF6, are required to have positively All SIRIUS 3RH control relays
contact construction accord- 40HN & 40PH Contactors are driven contact elements (with at least 1 NC contact)
ing to IEC 60947-4-1 Annex F. provided with positively driven according to IEC 60947-5-1 meet or exceed the criteria for
2
A mirror contact is a Normally (mirror) contacts which meet or Annex L. Positively driven con- “Safety Control Relays” accord-
Closed (NC) auxiliary contact exceed the criteria for “Safety tact elements are a combination ing to IEC 60947-5-1 Annex L.
Contactors and
Assemblies
which can not be closed simul- Contactors” according to IEC of NO auxiliary contacts and NC This is true for the basic 3RH
taneously with a Normally Open 60947-4 Annex F which auxiliary contacts whose con- relay with or without an addi-
(NO) main contact. describes the requirements for struction prevents them from tional auxiliary contact block.
mirror contact performance. being closed simultaneously.
In some industries, such as When applying Safety Contac-
automotive, requirements have tors in safety circuits, the NC In some industries, such as
been established that a safety auxiliary contacts must be wired automotive, requirements have
rated contactor must also have in series or parallel and must been established that a safety
permanently mounted auxiliary be used as monitoring contacts rated control relays must also
contact blocks. See page 2/25 with feedback to the safety have permanently mounted
for Contactors with permanently evaluation device (i.e. safety auxiliary contact blocks. See
mounted auxiliary contacts. relay or failsafe logic controller). page 2/20 for Control Relays
with permanently mounted
auxiliary contacts.
3RT20 2. -1A .00 3RT10 7. -6A ..6 3RH29 21. -1F 3RH29 21. -1DA 11 3RH21 3RH24 3RH2911-2HA..
Frame Frame
size Contactors Auxiliary contact block size Control Relays Auxiliary contact block
3RT201 3RH21
3RH2911
3RT231 3RH2911 S00 3RH24
S00
3RT251 3TH20 3TX44
3RT261 3RH1911
3RT202
3RT232 3RH2921
S0
3RT252
3RT262 3RH2921
3RT203
3RT233
S2 3RH2921
3RT253
3RT263
3RT204
3RT234
S3 3RH2921
3RT244
3RT264
3RT105
S6 3RH1921
3RT145
3RT106
S10 3RT126 3RH1921
3RT146
3RT107 For contactors, see pages 2/8-2/11.
S12 3RT127 3RH1921 For auxiliaries contact blocks, see pages 2/68-2/70.
3RT147 For control relays, see pages 2/52-2/54.
3TF6 3TY7561-1UA00 For auxiliaries contact blocks, see page 2/68-2/70..
2/24 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors & Relays for Safety Applications
3RT safety contactors, 3RH2 safety control relays with permanently mounted auxiliary contact blocks
Application
"Safety" Control Relays
IEC 60947-4-1 IEC 60947-5-1
“Safety” Contactors for contactors
Safety rated control relays are required for control
Safety rated contactors are required to to have positively driven contact relays
have mirrored contact construction elements according to IEC 60947-5-1
according to IEC 60947-4 Annex F. A Annex L. Positively driven contact
mirror contact is a Normally Closed (NC) elements are a combination of NO
auxiliary contact which can not be closed auxiliary contacts and NC auxiliary
2
simultaneously with a Normally Open contacts whose construction prevents
(NO) main contact. In some industries, them from being closed simultaneously.
Assemblies
Contactors and
such as Automotive, the auxiliary contact In some industries, such as automotive,
blocks are required to be permanently the auxiliary contact blocks are required
attached to meet the requirements of to be permanently attached to meet the
“unitentional misuse” as specified in IEC requirements of "unitentional misuse" as
60292, paragraph 3.12. Tested by SUVA. specified in IEC 60292, paragraph 3.12.
3RT202* -1AK64-3MA0 Tested by SUVA. 3RH22**-2BB40
Application
Max. Single-phase Three-phase
Frame current HP ratings HP ratings Auxiliary contacts Screw Spring-Type
Size AC3 AC1 115V 220/240V 200V 230V 460V 575V Terminals Terminals 1)
A A HP HP HP HP HP HP Ident. No. NO NC Order No. Order No.
Contactors with permanently mounted auxiliary contact blocks
S00 6 18 ¼ ¾ 1½ 2 3 5 22E 2 2 3RT2015-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2015-2●●●4-3MA0
9 22 1⁄3 1 2 3 5 7½ 22E 2 2 3RT2016-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2016-2●●●4-3MA0
12 22 ½ 2 3 3 7½ 10 22E 2 2 3RT2017-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2017-2●●●4-3MA0
16 22 1 2 3 5 10 10 22E 2 2 3RT2018-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2018-2●●●4-3MA0
S0 9 40 1 1 2 3 5 7½ 22E 2 2 3RT2023-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2023-2●●●4-3MA0
12 40 1 2 3 3 7½ 10 22E 2 2 3RT2024-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2024-2●●●4-3MA0
17 40 1 3 5 5 10 15 22E 2 2 3RT2025-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2025-2●●●4-3MA0
25 40 2 3 7½ 7½ 15 20 22E 2 2 3RT2026-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2026-2●●●4-3MA0
32 50 2 5 10 10 20 25 22E 2 2 3RT2027-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2027-2●●●4-3MA0
38 50 3 5 10 10 25 25 22E 2 2 3RT2028-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2028-2●●●4-3MA0
S2 40 60 3 7½ 10 15 30 40 22E 2 2 3RT2035-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2035-3●●●4-3MA0
50 70 3 10 15 15 40 50 22E 2 2 3RT2036-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2036-3●●●4-3MA0
65 80 5 10 20 20 50 50 22E 2 2 3RT2037-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2037-3●●●4-3MA0
804) 90 5 15 20 25 50 60 22E 2 2 3RT2038-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2038-3●●●4-3MA0
S3 80 120 7½ 15 25 30 60 75 22E 2 2 3RT2045-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2045-3●●●4-3MA0
95 120 10 20 30 30 75 100 22E 2 2 3RT2046-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2046-3●●●4-3MA0
S6 150 185 -- 30 50 60 125 150 22E 2 2 3RT1055-6●●●6-3PA0 —
185 215 -- 30 60 75 150 200 22E 2 2 3RT1056-6●●●6-3PA0 —
S10 225 275 -- -- 60 75 150 200 22E 2 2 3RT1064-6●●●6-3PA0 —
265 330 -- -- 75 100 200 250 22E 2 2 3RT1065-6●●●6-3PA0 —
300 330 -- -- 100 125 250 300 22E 2 2 3RT1066-6●●●6-3PA0 —
Control circuit coil options: Replace ●●● with the desired code
Frame Size S00 - S0 ●●● Frame Size S2 ●●● Frame Size S3 ●●● Frame Size S6 - S10 ●●●
120 V AC AK6 120 V AC AK6 120 V AC ** AK6 23 … 26 V UC*, conventional coil AB3
120 V AC, integrated varistor CK6 120 V AC w/ Varistor CK6 24V DC KB4 21-27 V UC*, solid state coil NB3
230 V AC AP0 24 V DC w/Varistor KB4 w/ integrated varistor w/ PLC interface
24 V DC BB4 24V AC/DC NB3 110 … 127 V UC*, conventional coil AF3
24 V DC, integrated varistor DB4 w/integrated varistor
*UC coil: accepts DC voltage or
24 V DC, integrated diode assy. FB4 AC voltage, 40 to 60 Hz.
For other voltages see page 2/51. For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/192-2/198.
For accessories, see pages 2/75-2/80. For dimension drawings, see pages 2/211-2/218. 2) For AC-15/AC-14, max current for front mounted auxiliary contacts = 6 A.
For spare parts, see pages 2/96-2/99. 3) The 3RH22 control relays are also available with ring lug terminals. Replace
1) All terminals are spring loaded on frame size S00 and S0.
For technical data, see pages 2/123-2/144. Only the coil and auxiliary contact terminals are spring the 8th digit of the order number with a “4”, e. g. 3RH2244-4AK60
For description, see pages 2/106-2/107. loaded on frame sizes S2 & S3. 4) Max UL FLA = 65A at 460V
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/25
SIRIUS
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Overview
The function modules for mounting onto contactors enable the
assembly of starters and contactor assemblies for direct-on-line,
reversing and wye-delta starting without any additional, compli-
cated wiring of the individual components. They include the key
control functions required for the particular starter, e. g. timing
and interlocking, and can be connected to the control system by
2
Version SIRIUS function modules SIRIUS function modules SIRIUS function modules
for IO-Link1) for AS-Interface1)
3
For reversing starting Wiring modules 1 function module for size S00, S0 & S2, 1 function module for size S00, S0 & S2,
for sizes S00, S0 & S2 screw and spring-type connection, plus screw and spring-type connection, plus
With screw or spring-type terminals · the respective wiring modules1) the respective wiring modules1)
(with screw terminals for main and control
circuit)
For wye-delta starting 1 function module for size S00, S0 & S2, For wye-delta starting: 1 function module For wye-delta starting: 1 function module
screw and spring-type connection of the for size S00, S0 & S2, plus screw and for size S00, S0 & S2, plus screw and
contactors, plus the respective wiring spring-type connection, plus the respec- spring-type connection, plus the respec-
modules2) tive wiring modules2) tive wiring modules2)
Accessories Sealable covers Operator panel for autonomous controlling AS-Interface addressing units
of up to 4 starters Sealable covers
Module connector for the grouping of
starters
Connection cable between the operator
panel and the starter group
Sealable covers
Overview Application
Simply by being plugged in place, the SIRIUS function modules The snap-on function modules for direct-on-line starting are
enable different functionalities required for the assembly of start- used above all for realizing timing functions independently of the
ers to be realized in the starter. The function modules and wiring control system.
kits help to reduce the wiring work within the starter practically to
zero. With the OFF-delay variant of the timing relay it is possible for
example for the fan motor for cooling a main drive to be switched
2
SIRIUS function modules for direct-on-line starting off with a delay so that sufficient cooling after operation is guar-
anteed even if the plant and its control system have already
The electronic timing relays which can be mounted onto the been switched off.
Assemblies
Contactors and
contactor are available in these versions:
• Sizes S00 and S0 for applications in the range from The ON-delay timing relays enable for example the time-delayed
starting of several drives so that the summation starting current
3
24 to 240 V AC/DC (wide voltage range)
does not rise too high, which could result in voltage failure.
• Size S2 for applications in either the range from 24 to
90 V AC/DC or 90 to 240 V AC/DC The function modules for wye-delta starting are mostly used
where current-limiting measures for starting a drive are required,
Both the electrical and mechanical connection are made by e.g. for large fans and ventilators, and a high level of availability
simple snapping on and locking. is essential at the same time. This technology has been used
A protection circuit (varistor) is integrated in each module. with success for several decades and has the additional advan-
tage of requiring relatively little know-how. Through the use of
The electronic timing relay with semiconductor output uses function modules, the assembly work with simple standard com-
two contact legs to actuate the contactor underneath by means ponents is even easier and error-free.
of a semiconductor after the set time t has elapsed.
The switching state feedback is performed by a mechanical Benefits
switching state indicator (plunger). In addition, the auxiliary
switches in the contactors are freely accessible and can be used The use of snap-on function modules for direct-on-line starting
for feedbacks to the control system or for signal lamps. (timing relays) results in the following advantages:
• Reduction of control current wiring
A sealable cover is available to protect against careless
adjustment of the set times. • Prevention of wiring errors
• Reduction of testing costs
SIRIUS function modules for reversing starting
• Implementation of timing functions independently of the
The wiring kits for reversing starters enable the cost-effective control system
assembly of contactor assemblies. They can be used for all
• Less space required in the control cabinet compared to a
applications with reversing duty up to 50 HP.
separate timing relay
For a detailed description see page 2/39.
• No additive protection circuit required (varistor integrated)
SIRIUS function modules for wye-delta starting
The use of function modules for wye-delta starting results in the
Both interlocking and timing functions are required for the following advantages:
assembly of wye-delta starters. With the function modules for
• Operation solely through the line contactor A1/A2 – no further
wye-delta starting and the matching link modules for the main
wiring needed
circuit, these starters can be assembled easily and with abso-
lutely no errors. • Reduction of the control current wiring inside the contactor
assembly and to the higher-level control system where
The entire sequence in the control circuit is integrated in the applicable
snap-on modules. This covers:
• Prevention of wiring errors
• An adjustable wye time t from 0.5 to 60 s
• Reduction of testing costs
• A non-adjustable dead interval of 50 ms
• Integrated electrical interlocking saves costs and prevents
• Electrical contacting to the contactors by means of coil errors
pick-off (contact legs)
• Less space needed in the control cabinet compared to using
• Feedback of the switching state at the contactor using a a separate timing relay
mechanical switch position indicator (plunger)
• Adjustable starting in star mode from 0.5 to 60 s
• Electrical interlocking between the contactors
• Independent of the contactor's control supply voltage
These modules do not require their own terminals and can there- (24 to 240 V AC/DC)
fore be used for contactors with both screw and spring-type • Varistor integrated – no additive protection circuit required
terminals in the S00, S0 and S2. To start the wye-delta starter,
only the first of the three contactors (line contactor) is actuated. • No control current wiring thanks to plug-in technology and
All other functions then take place inside the individual connecting cables
modules. • Mechanically coded assembly enables easy configuration
and reliable wiring
This also offers advantages if the timing function was previously
implemented in a controller, as it again results in a significant • Fewer versions – one module kit for screw and spring-type
reduction in the number of PLC outputs, the programming work connection and for the two sizes S00 to S2
and the wiring outlay. • Mechanical interlocking (with wiring kit for the main circuit)
The kits for the main circuit include the mechanical interlock, the
star jumper, the wiring modules at the top and at the bottom, and
the required connecting clips.
A protection circuit (varistor) is integrated in the basic module.
• Ideal for diagnostics to the automation controller • Reduces control wiring in the panel
• Quickly locate and rectify faults • Available for 24VDC control systems
• Configuration available in Step 7 and TIA Portal • Easily snap on IO-Link or AS-Interface
• Easy engineering of parameters modules onto contactors
• For DOL, reversing and wye delta starters up to 50 HP
2
Spring-type
Amp Single-phase Three-phase Auxiliary Screw Terminals Terminals 1) Weight
Ratings HP ratings HP ratings contacts 24 V DC coil 24 V DC coil approx.
Frame
Size AC3 AC1 115V 230V 208V 230V 460V 575V NO NC Order No. Order No. kg
3RT 3-pole Contactors
1 0 3RT2015-1BB41-0CC0 3RT2015-2BB41-0CC0
7 18 0.25 0.75 1.5 2 3 5
0 1 3RT2015-1BB42-0CC0 3RT2015-2BB42-0CC0
1 0 3RT2016-1BB41-0CC0 3RT2016-2BB41-0CC0
9 22 0.33 1 2 3 5 7.5
0 1 3RT2016-1BB42-0CC0 3RT2016-2BB42-0CC0
S00 0.28
1 0 3RT2017-1BB41-0CC0 3RT2017-2BB41-0CC0
12 22 0.5 2 3 3 7.5 10
3RT2018-1BB41-0CC0 0 1 3RT2017-1BB42-0CC0 3RT2017-2BB42-0CC0
1 0 3RT2018-1BB41-0CC0 3RT2018-2BB41-0CC0
16 22 1 2 3 5 10 10
0 1 3RT2018-1BB42-0CC0 3RT2018-2BB42-0CC0
9 40 1 1 2 3 5 7.5 1 1 3RT2023-1BB40-0CC0 3RT2024-2BB40-0CC0
12 40 1 2 3 3 7.5 10 1 1 3RT2024-1BB40-0CC0 3RT2024-2BB40-0CC0
16 40 1 3 5 5 10 15 1 1 3RT2025-1BB40-0CC0 3RT2025-2BB40-0CC0
S0 0.58
25 40 2 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 1 1 3RT2026-1BB40-0CC0 3RT2026-2BB40-0CC0
32 50 2 5 10 10 20 25 1 1 3RT2027-1BB40-0CC0 3RT2027-2BB40-0CC0
3RT2028-1BB40-0CC0
38 50 3 5 10 10 25 25 1 1 3RT2028-1BB40-0CC0 3RT2028-2BB40-0CC0
50 70 3 10 15 15 40 50 1 1 3RT2036-1NB30-0CC0 3RT2036-3NB30-0CC0
S2 1.122
65 80 5 10 20 20 50 50 1 1 3RT2037-1NB30-0CC0 3RT2037-3NB30-0CC0
Communication capable contactors are ideal for starter feedback to the automation level.
IO-Link starters in the cabinet save considerable wiring effort. AS-Interface is best suited
for distributed systems.
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RA28 16-0EW20 3RA29 13-2AA1 3RA29 13-2BB2
For Rated control supply Time setting range t Screw terminals Weight Spring-type 2) Weight
3
contactors voltage Us1) approx. terminals approx.
Order No. Order No.
Type V s kg kg
Assembly kits for reversing starting
Assembly kits for making 3-pole contactor
assemblies
The assembly kit contains:
Mechanical interlock;
2 connecting clips for 2 contactors,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
3RT20 1 . • For size S00 3RA29 13-2AA1 0.046 3RA29 13-2AA2 0.070
3RT20 2 . • For size S0 3RA29 23-2AA1 0.089 3RA29 23-2AA2 0.112
3RT20 3 . • For size S2 (w/o mechanical interlock, see pg. 2/45) 3RA29 33-2AA1 0.159 3RA29 33-2AA2 0.156
Assembly kits for wye-delta starting
Assembly kits for making 3-pole contactor
assemblies
The assembly kit contains:
Mechanical interlock,
4 connecting clips for 3 contactors;
star jumper,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
3RT20 1 . • For size S00 3RA29 13-2BB1 0.051 3RA29 13-2BB2 0.080
3RT20 2 . • For size S0 (only main circuit for version with 3RA29 23-2BB1 0.099 3RA29 23-2BB2 0.133
spring-type terminals)
3RT20 3 . • For size S2 (only main circuit for version with 3RA29 33-2BB1 0.242 3RA29 33-2BB2 0.182
spring-type terminals)
• 1 NO contact, delayed
Y
• 1 NO contact, instantaneous
t 50 ms
Overview
The SIRIUS function modules for IO-Link enable the assembly of control system through IO-Link, with the possibility of connecting
starters and contactor assemblies for direct-on-line, reversing up to four starters as a group to one port of the IO-Link master.
and wye-delta starting without any additional, complicated
wiring of the individual components. They include the key control Through this type of connection to the control system, a
functions required for the particular starter, e. g. timing and maximum of wiring is saved. The following essential signals are
interlocking. The electrical and mechanical connection to the transmitted:
2
contactor is established by snapping on and locking. An • Availability of the starter in response to an indirect inquiry from
additive protection circuit for the individual contactors can be the motor starter protector
dispensed with completely, and feedback from the contactor
Contactors and
Assemblies
• Starter operation
contacts is performed with Hall sensors which provide reliable
feedback concerning the switching state even under extremely • Feedback concerning the switching state of the starter
3
dusty conditions. The starters are connected to the higher-level
Availability
Control
NSB0_02084a
Motor starter
protector
Contactor
NSB0_02086
2
1 2 3 4
Direct-on- Direct-on- Reversing Reversing
line starter line starter starter starter
Assemblies
Contactors and
3
Port 1
...
NSB0_02087b
Port 2
Application Benefits
The use of SIRIUS function modules with IO-Link is recom- • Reduction of the control current wiring to no more than one
mended above all in machines and plants in which there are cable having three conductors for four starters
several motor starters in one control cabinet. Using IO-Link, the • Elimination of testing costs and wiring errors
connection of these starters to the automation level is easy, • Reduction of configuration work
quick and error-free. And with IO modules no longer needed, the
width of the ET200S becomes far smaller. • Integration in TIA for clear diagnostics if a fault occurs
• Fewer IO modules saves space in the control cabinet
• All essential timing and interlocking functions for reversing
duty and wye-delta starting are integrated
• No additional control circuit required
Furtherinformation
Further informationononthetheapplication
application and
and benefits
benefits of the
of the SIRIUS
SIRIUS
functionmodules
function modulesforforconnection
connection to to
thethe control
control system
system through
through
IO-Linkcan
IOLink canbebe found
found in Chapter
in Chapter 4 "Industrial
14 “Industrial Communication".
Communication”.
3
Contactors and
Assemblies
3RA2711-1AA00
3RA2711-2AA00
Function modules for reversing starting1)
IO-Link connection, 3RA2711-1BA00 3RA2711-2BA00
comprising one basic and one coupling module
and an additional module connector for assembling
an IO-Link group
3RA2711-1BA00
3RA2711-2BA00
Assembly kits for making 3-pole contactor
assemblies
The assembly kit contains:
mechanical interlock,
2 connecting clips for two contactors,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
3RA2923-2AA1 • For size S00 3RA2913-2AA1 3RA2913-2AA2
• For size S0
- For main, auxiliary and control circuits 3RA2923-2AA1 --
- Only for main circuit2) -- 3RA2923-2AA2
• For size S2
- For main, auxiliary and control circuits 3RA2933-2AA1 --
3RA2923-2AA2
- Only for main circuit2) -- 3RA2933-2AA2
1) For prewired contactor assemblies for reversing starting with voltage Matching contactors with communications interface required;
tap-off, see pages 2/42 and 2/45. When these contactor assemblies are see pages 2/26.
used, the assembly kit for the wiring is already integrated.
2) Version in sizes S0 and S2 with spring-type terminals:
Only the wiring modules for the main circuit are included.
No connectors are included for the auxiliary and control circuit.
2
assembling an IO-Link group
3
3RA2711-1CA00
Assemblies
Contactors and
Assembly kits for making 3-pole contactor
assemblies2)
The assembly kit contains:
mechanical interlock,
4 connecting clips for 3 contactors;
star jumper,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
3RA2923-2BB1 • For size S00 3RA2913-2BB1 3RA2913-2BB2
• For size S0
- For main, auxiliary and control circuits 3RA2923-2BB1 --
- Only for main circuit3) -- 3RA2923-2BB2
• For size S2
- For main, auxiliary and control circuits 3RA2933-2BB1 --
3RA2923-2BB2 - Only for main circuit3) -- 3RA2933-2BB2
1) For complete contactor assemblies for wye-delta starting including Matching contactors with communications interface required;
function modules, see pages 2/49 and 2/50. see pages 2/28.
2) When using the function modules for wye-delta starting, the wiring
modules for the auxiliary current are not required.
3) Version in sizes S0 and S2 with spring-type terminals:
Only the wiring modules for the main circuit are included.
No connectors are included for the auxiliary and control circuit.
3RA2910-0
Operator panels1)
Operator panel (set), comprising: 3RA6935-0A
• 1 x operator panel
• 1 x enabling module
• 1 x interface cover
• 1 x fixing terminal
3RA6935-0A
Connection cable, 3RA2711-0EE11
length 2 m, 10- to 14-pole
3RA2711-0EE11 For connecting the operator panel to the communication module
Enabling modules (replacement) 3RA6936-0A
Interface covers (replacement) 3RA6936-0B
1) Suitable only for communication through IO-Link.
For manuals, see
http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/39319600.
Overview
The SIRIUS function modules for AS-Interface enable the nected to one master and the address is entered in normal man-
assembly of starters and contactor assemblies for direct-on-line, ner with an addressing unit.
reversing and wye-delta starting without any additional, compli-
cated wiring of the individual components. They include the key Through the AS-Interface connection to the control system, a
control functions required for the particular starter, e. g. timing maximum of wiring is saved. The wiring outlay is reduced to the
and interlocking. The electrical and mechanical connection to control supply voltage and the two individual wires for
2
3
the switching state even under extremely dusty conditions. • Starter operation
Connection of the starters to the higher-level control system • Feedback concerning the switching state of the starter
takes place through AS-Interface with the Specification V2.1 in
A/B technology. As the result, up to 62 starters can be con-
Availability
Control
NSB0_02085a
Motor starter
protector
Contactor
NSB0_02086
2
NSB0_02088a
Assemblies
Contactors and
3
AS-Interface
Application Benefits
The use of SIRIUS function modules with AS-Interface is recom- • Reduction of control current wiring
mended above all in machines and plants requiring easy • Elimination of testing costs and wiring errors
connection of several different sensors and actuators both • Reduction of configuration work
inside and outside the control cabinet to the higher-level control
system. And with IO modules no longer needed, the width of the • Elimination of IO modules saves space in the control cabinet
PLC is far smaller. • All essential timing and interlocking functions for reversing
duty and wye-delta starting are integrated
• No additional control circuit required
3RA2712-1AA00
3RA2712-2AA00
Function modules for reversing starting1)
AS-Interface connection, 3RA2712-1BA00 3RA2712-2BA00
comprising one basic and one coupling module
3RA2712-1BA00
3RA2712-2BA00
Assembly kits for making 3-pole contactor
assemblies
The assembly kit contains:
mechanical interlock,
2 connecting clips for two contactors,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
3RA2923-2AA1 • For size S00 3RA2913-2AA1 3RA2913-2AA2
• For size S0
- For main, auxiliary and control current 3RA2923-2AA1 --
- Only for main current -- 3RA2923-2AA2
• For size S2
- For main, auxiliary and control current 3RA2933-2AA1 --
3RA2923-2AA2
- Only for main current -- 3RA2933-2AA2
Matching contactors with communications interface required; 1) For prewired contactor assemblies for reversing starting with communication
see page 2/28. interface, see pages 2/42 and 2/45. When these contactor assemblies are
used, the assembly kit for the wiring is already integrated.
For matching AS-Interface masters, routers and power supply
units, see Chapter 14 “Industrial Communication”.
2/36 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
3/206 Siemens IC 10 · 2015 Illustrations are approximate
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 ContactorsFunction Modules
SIRIUS 3RA27 Function Modules for AS-Interface for Mounting on 3RT2 Contactors
SIRIUS function modules for AS-Interface
For direct-on-line starting / for reversing starting / for wye-delta starting
2
3
3RA2712-1CA00
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RA2712-2CA00
Assembly kits for making 3-pole contactor
assemblies
The assembly kit contains:
mechanical interlock,
4 connecting clips for 3 contactors;
star jumper,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
3RA2923-2BB1 • For size S00 3RA2913-2BB1 3RA2913-2BB2
• For size S0
- For main, auxiliary and control circuits 3RA2923-2BB1 --
- Only for main circuit -- 3RA2923-2BB2
• For size S2
- For main, auxiliary and control circuits 3RA2933-2BB1 --
3RA2923-2BB2 - Only for main circuit -- 3RA2933-2BB2
1) For complete contactor assemblies for wye-delta starting including Matching contactors with communications interface required;
function modules, see pages 2/49 and 2/50. see page 2/28.
For matching AS-Interface masters, routers and power supply
units, see Chapter 14 “Industrial Communication”.
3RA2711-0EE10
Module connectors
• 14-pole, 9 cm 3RA2711-0EE06
For size jump + 1 space
3RA2711-0EE06
Interface covers 3RA2711-0EE15
(Set of 5)
3RA2711-0EE15
Sealable covers 3RA2910-0
For 3RA27, 3RA28, 3RA29
3RA2910-0
Technical specifications
Type 3RA2811 3RA2831 3RA2812 3RA2832 3RA2816
Can be used for size S00, S0 S2 S00, S0 S2 S00, S0, S2
Function ON-delay OFF-delay Wye-delta function
with control signal
2
General data
Rated insulation voltage Ui V AC 300
3
Contactors and
Assemblies
Pollution degree 3
Overvoltage category III
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV AC 4
Operating range of excitation 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us,
0.95 ... 1.05 times the rated frequency
Overvoltage protection Varistor integrated
Rated power W 1 1
• Power consumption at 230 V AC, 50 Hz VA 1 2
DIAZED protection Operational class gG A -- 4
Switching frequency for load
• With Ie at 230 V AC h-1 2 500 --
• With 3RT2 contactor at 230 V AC h-1 2 500 --
Recovery time ms 50 150
Minimum ON period ms -- 35 --
Residual current Max. mA 5 -- --
Voltage drop Max. VA 3.5 -- --
With conducting output
Setting accuracy Typ. ±15 %
With reference to upper limit of
scale
Repeat accuracy Max. ±1 %
Electrical endurance
• With 3RT2028 contactor Operating cycles 100 000 --
• At AC-15, 250 V, 3 A Operating cycles -- 100 000
Mechanical endurance Operating cycles 100 x 106 10 x 106
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -40 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix C IP20
Shock resistance g/ms 15/11
Half-sine acc. to IEC 60068-2-27
Vibration resistance
According to IEC 60068-2-6 Hz/mm 10 ... 55/0.35
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) IEC 61000-6-2, IEC 61000-6-4, IEC 61812-1, IEC 60947-4-1
Overvoltage protection Varistor integrated
Permissible mounting position Any (see contactor)
Conductor cross-sections
Connection type Screw terminals
(1 or 2 conductors can be connected)
• Solid mm 2 1 x (0.5 ... 4), 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) --
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5) --
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 14) --
• Terminal screws M3 (for standard screw driver size 2 or Pozidriv 2) --
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 --
Connection type Spring-type terminals
(1 or 2 conductors can be connected)
• Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5 --
• Solid mm 2 2 x (0.25 ... 1.5) --
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.25 ... 1.5) --
• Finely stranded m m2 2 x (0.25 ... 1.5) --
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (24 ... 16) --
Design The following points should be If the front-mounted mechani- Principle of operation
noted: cal interlock is used for size S2
Complete equipment The operating times of the
Size S00 to S3 contactors, two location
assemblies individual 3RT10/20 contactors
holes for single-pole auxiliary
The fully wired reversing contac- • For maintained-contact are rated in such a way that no
switch blocks are provided on
tor assemblies are suitable for operation: overlapping of the contact mak-
the front of each S2 contac-
use in any climate. They are safe use contactors with an NC ing and the arcing time between
tor while three additional,
from touch to EN 50274. two contactors can occur on
2
contact in the basic unit for single-pole auxiliary switch
The contactor assemblies each the electrical interlock. reversing, providing they are
blocks can be snapped onto
consist of two contactors with interlocked via their auxiliary
Assemblies
Contactors and
• For momentary-contact S3 contactors. The maximum
identical ratings. The contactors switches (NC contact interlock)
operation: auxiliary switch complements
are mechanically and electri- and the operating mechanisms.
use contactors with an NC per contactor stated on page 2/14
cally interlocked (NC contact An additional dead interval of
contact in the basic unit for must not be exceeded.
interlock). The main and control 50 ms is necessary on reversing
the electrical interlock; in When size S3 contactors are if the individual contactors are
circuits are wired according to addition, an auxiliary switch combined with a frontmo- used at voltages > 500 V. The
the circuit diagrams on block with at least one unted mechanical interlock, operating times of the individual
page 2/201. NO contact for latching is the 3RA19 33-2B and 3RA19 contactors are not affected by
For motor protection, either required per contactor. 43-2B installation kits cannot the mechanical interlock.
3RU2 or 3RB3 overload relays Size S0 and S2 be used.
for direct mounting or individual
Contactors come equipped Sizes S6 to S12 Surge suppression
mounting or thermistor motor
protection tripping units must be with integrated 1 NO and 1NC To insert the mechanical inter-
aux contacts in each contactor. Sizes S00 to S3
ordered separately. lock, the prestamped location
Both electrical interlocking and holes positioned opposite on All contactor assemblies can be
latching are satisfied with the the contactor must be knocked fitted with RC elements or varis-
Components for customer integrated auxiliaries. Mechani- tors for damping opening surges
assembly out. The internal auxiliary con-
cal interlocking is required in tacts (up to 1 NO + 1 NC per in the coil.
Installation kits for all sizes are either size and comes in the
available for customer assembly contactor) can be used for the As with the individual contac-
assembly kits except for size electrical interlock and latching. tors, the surge suppressors can
of reversing contactor assem- S2 where you need to order
blies. The mechanical interlock itself either be plugged onto the front
3RA2934-2B interlock sepa- does not contain any auxiliary of the contactors (S00) or fitted
Contactors, overload relays, the rately. contacts. Additional auxiliary onto the coil terminals on the
mechanical interlock and — for Sizes S3 contacts can be used on the top or bottom (S3). For sizes S0
momentary-contact operation — outside and front (on the front and S2, the surge protection
auxiliary switch blocks for latch- • For maintained-contact
in the case of 3RT10) of the fits behind the hinged door on
ing must be ordered separately operation:
reversing contactor assembly. the front of the contactor and
the contactors have no auxil-
iary contact in the basic unit; does not take up any additional
NC contacts for the electrical space.
interlock are therefore inte- Sizes S6 to S12
grated in the mechanical in- The contactors are fitted with
terlock that can be mounted varistors as standard.
on the side of each contactor
(one contact each for the left
and right-hand contactors).
• For momentary-contact
operation:
the electrical interlock is the
same as for maintained-con-
tact operation; in addition,
an auxiliary switch with one
NO contact for latching is
required per contactor. This
contact can be snapped
onto the top of the contac-
tors. Alternatively, auxiliary
switch blocks mounted on
the side can be used; they
must be fitted onto the out-
side of each contactor.
Overview
The 3RA13 and 3RA23 Sizes S00 to S12 For overload relays for motor The and approvals only
reversing contactor assemblies As components for customer protection, see section 3. apply to the complete contactor
can be ordered as follows: assembly. assemblies and not to the com-
Sizes S00 to S3 The 3RA23 and 3RA13 contactor ponents for customer assembly.
There is also a range of acces- assemblies have screw connections
Fully wired and tested, open sories (auxiliary switch blocks, and are available for screwing AC and DC operation
type, with mechanical and surge suppressors, etc.) that or snapping onto 35 mm standard
2
For accessories, see page 2/82-2/85. 1) An additional dead interval of 50 ms is neces- 7) Installation kit contains: 2 connecting clips for
For circuit diagrams, see page 2/201. sary on reversing at voltages > 500 V. 2 contactors; wiring connectors on the top and
For dimension drawings, see page 2) Laterally mountable with one auxiliary contact bottom and the mechanical interlock.
2/221-2/223. (except no auxiliary contact in S2 & S3) 8) Installation kit contains: 2 connecting clips for
3) For front mounting with one auxiliary contact. 2 contactors; wiring connectors on the top and
bottom.
4) Laterally mountable without auxiliary contact.
9) Installation kit contains: wiring connector on the
5) Interlock must be ordered with installation kit.
top and bottom.
6) Installation kit contains: mechanical interlock;
2 connecting clips for 2 contactors; wiring
connectors on the top and bottom.
2
3
Assemblies
Contactors and
5
7
1 4
2
10
IC01_00621
10
3
8
9
6
6
6
6
6
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/41
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RA23, 3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA23 Reversing Contactor Assemblies
3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies
3RA23 complete units, 3 ... 25 HP
Fully wired and tested contactor assemblies2) · Size S00 · Up to 10 HP
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
3
AC data UL data Screw terminals Weight
approx.
Amp Single-phase Three-phase Rated control Auxiliary Spring-type terminals
ratings HP ratings HP ratings supply voltage Us contacts
AC2/AC3 115 V 230 V 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V at 50/60 Hz NO NC Order No.
V kg
AC operation, 50/60 Hz
Size S00 1)
7 1/4 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 24 AC 0 2 3RA23 15-8XB30-@AB0 0.46/0.50
7 1/4 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 110/120 AC 0 2 3RA23 15-8XB30-@AK6 0.46/0.50
7 1/4 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 220/240 AC 0 2 3RA23 15-8XB30-@AP6 0.46/0.50
9 1/3 1 2 3 5 7 1/2 24 AC 0 2 3RA23 16-8XB30-@AB0 0.46/0.50
9 1/3 1 2 3 5 7 1/2 110/120 AC 0 2 3RA23 16-8XB30-@AK6 0.46/0.50
9 1/3 1 2 3 5 7 1/2 220/240 AC 0 2 3RA23 16-8XB30-@AP6 0.46/0.50
12 1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 24 AC 0 2 3RA23 17-8XB30-@AB0 0.46/0.50
12 1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 110/120 AC 0 2 3RA23 17-8XB30-@AK6 0.46/0.50
12 1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 220/240 AC 0 2 3RA23 17-8XB30-@AP6 0.46/0.50
16 1 2 3 5 10 10 24 AC 0 2 3RA23 18-8XB30-@AB0 0.46/0.50
16 1 2 3 5 10 10 110/120 AC 0 2 3RA23 18-8XB30-@AK6 0.46/0.50
16 1 2 3 5 10 10 220/240 AC 0 2 3RA23 18-8XB30-@AP6 0.46/0.50
DC operation
7 1/4 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 15-8XB30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
9 1/3 1 2 3 5 7 1/2 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 16-8XB30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
12 1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 17-8XB30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
16 1 2 3 5 10 10 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 18-8XB30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
With communication interface3)
7 1/4 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 15-8XE30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
9 1/3 1 2 3 5 7 1/2 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 16-8XE30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
12 1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 17-8XE30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
16 1 2 3 5 10 10 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 18-8XE30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 2
1)
For other voltages see page
page 2/51
3/17. 1) For coil
coil operating
operating range,
range,see
seepage
page2/51.
3/17.
2)
2) The contactors integrated
integrated in
in the
the contactor
contactor assemblies
assemblies have
haveno
no unas-
unassigned
For accessories and
and spare
spare parts,
parts, see
see page
page2/68-2/85.
3/93. auxiliary
signed contacts.
auxiliary contacts.
3) communication modules.
modules. See Section 2
3) For use with 3RA27 and 3RA28 communication
andpages
See also page
2/263/76.
to 2/33.
2/42 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/31
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies
Reversing Contactor for Switching Motors
Assemblies
2
3
Assemblies
Contactors and
1
7
4 2
IC01_00622
9 3
8 5
6
6 6
6
6
3
3RA23 2 4 -8XE30-1 BB4 3RA23 2 . -8XB30-1 A . . 3RA23 2 . -8XB30-2 A . .
AC data UL data Screw terminals Weight
approx.
Amp Single-phase Three-phase Rated control Auxiliary Spring-type terminals
ratings HP ratings HP ratings supply voltage Us contacts
AC2/AC3 115 V 230 V 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V at 50/60 Hz NO NC Order No.
V kg
AC operation, 50/60 Hz
Size S01)
12 1 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 24 AC 2 2 3RA23 24-8XB30-@AC2 0.84/0.94
12 1 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 110/120 AC 2 2 3RA23 24-8XB30-@AK6 0.84/0.94
12 1 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 220/240 AC 2 2 3RA23 24-8XB30-@AP6 0.84/0.94
16 1 3 5 5 10 15 24 AC 2 2 3RA23 25-8XB30-@AC2 0.84/0.94
16 1 3 5 5 10 15 110/120 AC 2 2 3RA23 25-8XB30-@AK6 0.84/0.94
16 1 3 5 5 10 15 220/240 AC 2 2 3RA23 25-8XB30-@AP6 0.84/0.94
25 2 3 7 1/2 7 1/2 15 20 24 AC 2 2 3RA23 26-8XB30-@AC2 0.84/0.94
25 2 3 7 1/2 7 1/2 15 20 110/120 AC 2 2 3RA23 26-8XB30-@AK6 0.84/0.94
25 2 3 7 1/2 7 1/2 15 20 220/240 AC 2 2 3RA23 26-8XB30-@AP6 0.84/0.94
32 2 5 10 10 20 25 24 AC 2 2 3RA23 27-8XB30-@AC2 0.84/0.94
32 2 5 10 10 20 25 110/120 AC 2 2 3RA23 27-8XB30-@AK6 0.84/0.94
32 2 5 10 10 20 25 220/240 AC 2 2 3RA23 27-8XB30-@AP6 0.84/0.94
38 3 5 10 10 25 25 24 AC 2 2 3RA23 28-8XB30-@AC2 0.84/0.94
38 3 5 10 10 25 25 110/120 AC 2 2 3RA23 28-8XB30-@AK6 0.84/0.94
38 3 5 10 10 25 25 220/240 AC 2 2 3RA23 28-8XB30-@AP6 0.84/0.94
DC operation
12 1 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 24-8XB30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
16 1 3 5 5 10 15 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 25-8XB30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
25 2 3 7 1/2 7 1/2 15 20 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 26-8XB30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
32 2 5 10 10 20 25 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 27-8XB30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
38 3 5 10 10 25 25 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 28-8XB30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
With communication interface 2)
12 1 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 24-8XE30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
16 1 3 5 5 10 15 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 25-8XE30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
25 2 3 7 1/2 7 1/2 15 20 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 26-8XE30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
32 2 5 10 10 20 25 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 27-8XE30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
38 3 5 10 10 25 25 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 28-8XE30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 2
1)
For othervoltages
For other voltages
see see
pagepage
2/51. 3/17. 1) For coil
coil operating
operating range,
range,see page2/51.
seepage 3/17.
2) communication modules.
modules. See Section 2
For accessories andand
sparespare
parts, parts,
see page 2/68-2/85. 2) For use with 3RA27 and 3RA28 communication
For accessories see page 3/93. andpages
See also page
2/263/76.
to 2/33.
2
A HP HP HP HP HP HP NO NC Order No. kg
AC operation
Assemblies
Contactors and
40 3 7.5 10 15 30 40
24 V, 50/60 Hz 2 2 3RA2335-8XB30-1AC2 1.72
120 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2335-8XB30-1AK6
240 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2335-8XB30-1AP6
50 3 10 15 15 40 50 24 V, 50/60 Hz Reversing
2 2 Contactor Assemblies
3RA2336-8XB30-1AC2 1.72
120 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2336-8XB30-1AK6
240 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2336-8XB30-1AP6
50 24 V, 50/60 Hz 2 2 3RA2337-8XB30-1AC2
65 5 10 20 20 50
SIRIUS 3RA23
120 V, 60 Hz
reversing
2
contactor
2
assemblies, up2.548
3RA2337-8XB30-1AK6
to 55 kW
240 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2337-8XB30-1AP6
80 1) 5 15 20 25 50 60 24 V, 50/60 Hz 2 2 3RA2338-8XB30-1AC2 2.548
120 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2338-8XB30-1AK6
For Reversing 240 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2338-8XB30-1AP6
Contactors with AC/DC operation
communication 40 3 7.5 10 15 30 40 20-33 AC/DC 2 2 3RA2335-8XB30-1NB3 2.5
interface: replace 50 20-33 AC/DC 2 2 3RA2336-8XB30-1NB3
50 3 10 15 15 40
the 8XB30-1NB3
65 5 10 20 20 50 50 20-33 AC/DC 2 2 3RA2337-8XB30-1NB3
with 8XE30-1NB3.
80 1) 5 15 20 25 50 60 20-33 AC/DC 2 2 3RA2338-8XB30-1NB3
3
1) Max UL FLA = 65A at 460V
Mountable
Fully wiredaccessories
and tested(to be ordered
reversing separately):
contactor The fully· wired and tested contactor assembly includes the following
assemblies
components:
Size S2 · Up to 50 HP
The figure shows the version with screw terminals
4
3
1
5 2
7 IC01_00623a
9
9
8
6
6 4
6
The connecting leads
are not shown.
6
6
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/45
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies
A HP HP HP HP HP HP NO NC Order No. kg
AC operation
Reversing Contactor Assemblies
Contactors and
Assemblies
Mountable accessories (to be ordered separately): The fully wired and tested contactor assembly includes the following
Fully wired
Mountable and tested
accessories reversing
(to be ordered contactorThe
separately): components:
assemblies
fully wired·and tested contactor assembly includes the following
Size S3 · Up to 75 HP components:
2
3
7 5
IC01_00624
9
9
8 4
6
6
6
The connecting leads
are not shown.
The connecting leads
are not shown.
Accessor y 6 6
Order No. Page Components Order No. Page
Accessor y Order No. Page Components OrderK1 No. K2 Page
12 Mechanical interlock, 1 2 Contactors, 60 HP K1 3RT2045K2 3RT2045
Mountable accessories (optional) Complete reversing contactor assembly
mountable
12 Mechanical on the front
interlock, 3RA19 24-1A 1 2 1Contactors, 60 HP75 HP 3RT2045
2 Contactors, 3RT20463RT2045 3RT2046
To be ordered separately Type Individual parts Type
mountable
14 Auxiliary on the frontblock, 3RA19 24-1A
switch 1 2 1Contactors, 75 HP75 HP 3RT2046
2 Contactors, 3RT20473RT2046 3RT2047
mountable on the front 3RH19 21-1CA.. Q11 Q12
14 Auxiliary switch block, 1 2 4Contactors, 3RT20473RT2045
11 15AuAuxiliary
xiliaryon
mountable swthe
itchfront
switchbloblock,
ck, front 3RH19 21-1CA..
3RH2911 Conta75
1 2 Mechanical ctoHP 37 kW 3RT2047
rs, interlock, 3RT2045
4 laterally mountable 3RA19 24-2B
15 12 Aulaterally
xiliaswitch
Auxiliary r y swmountable
itcblock,
h block, lateral 3RH19
3R21-1EA..
H 2921 1Mechanical
2 Contacinterlock,
tors, 45 kW 3RT2046 3RT2046
5laterally mountable
6 Installation kit 3RA19 24-2B43-2A
3RA19
laterally
13 rgemountable
16SuSurge susuppressor
ppressors 3RH19 21-1EA..
3RT19
3R26-1....
T2936 1 2 Contactors, 55 kW 3RT2047 3RT2047
5 6 Installation kit
The installation 3RA19 43-2A
kit contains:
Function
Surge
16 14 module for connection
suppressor 3RT193RT19
3R36-1....
A271 . -1BA00
26-1.... 3 4 Assembly kit 3RA2943-2AA1
to the control system (the associated module
3RT19 36-1.... The installation kit contains:
5comprising:
2 connecting clips for 2 contactors with a clearance of
connectors 3RA2711-0EE17 must be ordered separately 3 10Two
mmconnectors
5 2 connecting clips for 2for
contactors with a clearance of
two contactors
For further voltages, see page 2/51. 106mm
4 Wiring connectors
Wiring modules on onthe
thetop
top
andand bottom
bottom for connecting the main
1) Coil voltage tolerance
For overview, see page 2/39-2/40. at 50 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us 6 Wiring connectors
and auxiliaryon the
currenttop and bottom
circuits, electrical interlock included
For accessories, see page 2/68-2/85. 1) Coil voltage tolerance
at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us (NC contact interlock)
at 50 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
For circuit diagrams, see page 2/202. at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us 5 Mechanical interlock 3RA2934-2B
For dimension drawings, see page 2/221. (must be ordered separately)
2/46 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIRIUS
3RA23, 3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
3RA24
3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
Contactor Assemblies for Wye-Delta
for Wye-Delta StartingStarting
3RA24 complete units, 5.5 ... 22 kW
3RA24 complete units, 5.5 ... 22 kW
Overview
These 3RA24 contactor assemblies for wye-delta starting are Motor protection
designed for standard applications.
Overload relays or thermistor motor protection releases can be
Note: used for overload protection.
Contactor assemblies for wye-delta starting in special applica-
tions such as very heavy starting or wye-delta starting of The overload relay can be either mounted onto the line contactor
or separately fitted. It must be set to 0.58 times the rated motor
2
special motors must be customized. Help with designing such
special applications is available from Technical Assistance. current.
Surge suppression
Assemblies
Contactors and
The 3RA24 contactor assemblies for wye-delta starting can be
ordered as follows: Sizes S00 and S0
3
Sizes S00 and S0 Surge suppression (varistor) is included in the function modules
• Fully wired and tested, with electrical and mechanical for wye-delta starting.
interlock.
Function modules for wye-delta starting
• As individual parts for customer assembly.
The 3RA28 16-0EW20 wye-delta function module (see
A dead interval of 50 ms on reversing is already integrated in the page 2/29 replaces the complete wiring in the control circuit
function module for wye-delta starting. and can be used in the voltage range from 24 to 240 V AC/DC.
There is also a range of accessories (lateral auxiliary switch It is snapped onto the front of the contactor assembly size S00
blocks, etc.) that must be ordered separately. or S0.
For overload relays for motor protection see Chapter 3 One function module comprises a complete module kit:
"Overload Relays" --> "3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays". • One 3RA29 12-0 basic module with integrated control logic
and time setting,
The 3RA24 contactor assemblies have screw or spring-type
terminals and are suitable for screwing or snapping onto TH 35 • And two 3RA29 11-0 coupling modules with related connect-
standard mounting rails. ing cables.
With the fully wired and tested 3RA24 contactor assemblies, the The scope of supply comprises a complete module kit for one
auxiliary contacts included in the basic devices are unassigned. contactor assembly for wye-delta starting size S00 or S0,
regardless of the connection method.
Screw terminals
Rated data Size
at AC 50 Hz 400 V
Power Operational current Motor current Line/delta contactor Star contactor Order No.
Ie complete
kW A A
5.5 12 9.5 ... 13.8 S00-S00-S00 3RT2015-1.... 3RT2015-1.... 3RA2415-8XF32-1...
7.5 16 12.1 ... 17 3
3RT2017-1.... 3RT2015-1.... 3RA2416-8XF32-1...
11 25 19 ... 25 3RT2018-1....
3 3RT2016-1.... 3RA2417-8XF32-1...
11 25 19 ... 25 S0-S0-S0 3RT2024-1...0 3RT2024-1...0 3RA2423-8XF32-1...
15 32 24.1 ... 34 3RT2026-1...0 3RT2024-1...0 3RA2425-8XF32-1...
18.5 40 34.5 ... 40 3RT2026-1...0 3RT2024-1...0 3RA2425-8XF32-1...
22 50 31 ... 43 3RT2027-1...0 3RT2026-1...0 3RA2426-8XF32-1...
4
22/30 50 31 ... 43 S2-S2-S0 3RT2035-1...0 3RT2026-1...0 3RA2434-8XF32-1...
37 80 62.1 ...77.8 3RT2035-1...0 3RT2027-1...0 3RA2435-8XF32-1...
45 86 69 ... 86 3RT2036-1...0 3RT2028-1...0 3RA2436-8XF32-1...
55 115 77.6 ...108.6 S2-S2-S2 3RT2037-1...0 3RT2035-1...0 3RA2444-8XF32-1...
75 150 120.7 ... 150 3RT2045-1...0 3RT2036-1...0 3RA2445-8XF32-1...
90 160 86 ... 160 3RT2046-1...0 3RT2037-1...0 3RA2446-8XF32-1...
Spring-type terminals
Rated data Size
at AC 50 Hz 400 V
Power Operational current Motor current Line/delta contactor Star contactor Order No.
Ie complete
kW A A
5.5 12 9.5 ... 13.8 S00-S00-S00 3RT2015-2.... 3RT2015-2.... 3RA24 15-8XF31-2. . .
7.5 16 12.1 ... 17 3RT2017-2.... 3RT2015-2.... 3RA24 16-8XF31-2. . .
11 25 19 ... 25 3RT2018-2.... 3RT2016-2.... 3RA24 17-8XF31-2. . .
11 25 19 ... 25 S0-S0-S0 3RT2024-2....0 3RT2024-2....0 3RA24 23-8XF32-2. . .
15 32 24.1 ... 34 3RT2026-2....0 3RT2024-2....0 3RA24 25-8XF32-2. . .
18.5 40 34.5 ... 40 3RT2026-2....0 3RT2024-2....0 3RA24 25-8XF32-2. . .
25 50 31 ... 43 3RT2027-2....0 3RT2026-2....0 3RA24 26-8XF32-2. . .
Note:
The selection of contactor types refers to fused configurations.
The wiring kits for sizes S00 and S0 contain the top and bottom
main conducting path connections between the line and delta
Contactors and
Assemblies
Screw terminals
3
Accessories for Overload relay, thermal Overload relay, solid-state
customer assembly (trip class CLASS 10) (trip class CLASS 10)
Power Function modules Assembly kit B, Star jumper Setting range Order No. Setting range Order No.
for wye-delta for single infeed
starting
kW A A
5.5 3RA28 16-0EW20 3RA29 13-2BB11) 3RT29 16-4BA31 5.5 ... 8 3RU21 16-1HB0 4 ... 16 3RB30 16-1TB0
7.5 7 ... 10 3RU21 16-1JB0
11 11 ... 16 3RU21 16-4AB0
11 3RA28 16-0EW20 3RA29 23-2BB12) 3RT29 26-4BA31 11 ... 16 3RU21 26-4AB0 6 ... 25 3RB30 26-1QB0
15 14 ... 20 3RU21 26-4BB0
18.5 20 ... 25 3RU21 26-4DB0
22 20 ... 25 3RU21 26-4DB0
Spring-type terminals
Accessories for Overload relay, thermal Overload relay, solid-state
customer assembly (trip class CLASS 10) (trip class CLASS 10)
Power Function modules Assembly kit B, Star jumper Setting range Order No. Setting range Order No.
for wye-delta for single infeed
starting
kW A A
5.5 3RA28 16-0EW20 3RA29 13-2BB21) 3RT29 16-4BA32 5.5 ... 8 3RU21 16-1HC0 4 ... 16 3RB30 16-1TE0
7.5 7 ... 10 3RU21 16-1JC0
11 11 ... 16 3RU21 16-4AC0
11 3RA28 16-0EW20 3RA29 23-2BB22) 3RT29 26-4BA32 11 ... 16 3RU21 26-4AC0 6 ... 25 3RB30 26-1QE0
15 14 ... 20 3RU21 26-4BC0
18.5 20 ... 25 3RU21 26-4DC0
22 20 ... 25 3RU21 26-4DC0
1) The assembly kit contains: mechanical interlock, 4 connecting clips; wiring 2) The assembly kit contains: mechanical interlock, 4 connecting clips; wiring
modules on the top (connection between line and delta contactor) and on modules on the top (connection between line and delta contactor) and on
the bottom (connection between delta and star contactor); star jumper and the bottom (connection between delta and star contactor); star jumper.
auxiliary circuit wiring.
Note: For your orders, please use the order numbers quote in the
catalog in the Selection and ordering data.
The Order No. scheme is presented here merely for information
purposes and for better understanding of the logic behind the
order numbers.
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RA24 1 . -8XE31-2BB4 3RA24 1 . -8XF31-1A . 0 3RA24 1 . -8XF31-2A.0
3
Rated data AC-3 Rated control Screw terminals Weight Spring-type terminals Weight
Opera- Ratings of supply voltage approx. approx.
tional induction motors Us1) at Order No. Order No.
current Ie at 50 Hz and 50/60 Hz
up to
400 V 230 V 400 V 500 V 690 V
A kW kW kW kW V kg kg
AC operation, 50/60 Hz
12 3.3 5.5 7.2 9.2 24 AC 3RA24 15-8XF31-1AB0 0.910 3RA24 15-8XF31-2AB0 0.910
110/120 AC 3RA24 15-8XF31-1AF0 0.850 3RA24 15-8XF31-2AF0 0.910
220/240 AC 3RA24 15-8XF31-1AP0 0.850 3RA24 15-8XF31-2AP0 0.910
16 4.7 7.5 10.3 9.2 24 AC 3RA24 16-8XF31-1AB0 0.910 3RA24 16-8XF31-2AB0 0.910
110/120 AC 3RA24 16-8XF31-1AF0 0.850 3RA24 16-8XF31-2AF0 0.910
220/240 AC 3RA24 16-8XF31-1AP0 0.850 3RA24 16-8XF31-2AP0 0.910
25 5.5 11 11 11 24 AC 3RA24 17-8XF31-1AB0 0.850 3RA24 17-8XF31-2AB0 0.910
110/120 AC 3RA24 17-8XF31-1AF0 0.850 3RA24 17-8XF31-2AF0 0.910
220/240 AC 3RA24 17-8XF31-1AP0 0.850 3RA24 17-8XF31-2AP0 0.910
DC operation
12 3.3 5.5 7.2 9.2 24 DC 3RA24 15-8XF31-1BB4 0.910 3RA24 15-8XF31-2BB4 0.910
16 4.7 7.5 10.3 9.2 24 DC 3RA24 16-8XF31-1BB4 0.910 3RA24 16-8XF31-2BB4 0.910
25 5.5 11 11 11 24 DC 3RA24 17-8XF31-1BB4 1.030 3RA24 17-8XF31-2BB4 1.090
For IO-Link connection
12 3.3 5.5 7.2 9.2 24 DC 3RA24 15-8XE31-1BB4 1.030 3RA24 15-8XE31-2BB4 1.090
16 4.7 7.5 10.3 9.2 24 DC 3RA24 16-8XE31-1BB4 1.030 3RA24 16-8XE31-2BB4 1.090
25 5.5 11 11 11 24 DC 3RA24 17-8XE31-1BB4 1.030 3RA24 17-8XE31-2BB4 1.090
For AS-Interface connection
12 3.3 5.5 7.2 9.2 24 DC 3RA24 15-8XH31-1BB4 1.050 3RA24 15-8XH31-2BB4 1.110
16 4.7 7.5 10.3 9.2 24 DC 3RA24 16-8XH31-1BB4 1.050 3RA24 16-8XH31-2BB4 1.110
25 5.5 11 11 11 24 DC 3RA24 17-8XH31-1BB4 1.050 3RA24 17-8XH31-2BB4 1.110
1)
The wye-delta starters listed here are assembled from individual Coil operating range
contactors which are UL Listed. The overall assembly Catalog at 50 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us; at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us.
Number is not UL Listed.
For other voltages see page 2/51.
3
3RA24 2 . -8XE32-1BB4 3RA24 2 . -8XF32-1A . 2 3RA24 2 . -8XF32-2A . 2
Rated data AC-3 Rated control Screw terminals Weight Spring-type terminals Weight
Opera- Ratings of supply voltage approx. approx.
tional induction motors Us1) at Order No. Order No.
current Ie at 50 Hz and 50/60 Hz
up to
400 V 230 V 400 V 500 V 690 V
A kW kW kW kW V kg kg
AC operation, 50/60 Hz
25 7.1 11 15.6 19 24 AC 3RA24 23-8XF32-1AC2 1.370 3RA24 23-8XF32-2AC2 1.530
110/220 AC 3RA24 23-8XF32-1AK6 1.370 3RA24 23-8XF32-2AK6 1.530
220/240 AC 3RA24 23-8XF32-1AP6 1.370 3RA24 23-8XF32-2AP6 1.530
32 / 40 11.4 15 / 19 19 24 AC 3RA24 25-8XF32-1AC2 1.370 3RA24 25-8XF32-2AC2 1.530
18.5 110/220 AC 3RA24 25-8XF32-1AK6 1.370 3RA24 25-8XF32-2AK6 1.530
220/240 AC 3RA24 25-8XF32-1AP6 1.370 3RA24 25-8XF32-2AP6 1.530
50 -- 22 19 19 24 AC 3RA24 26-8XF32-1AC2 1.390 3RA24 26-8XF32-2AC2 1.550
110/220 AC 3RA24 26-8XF32-1AK6 1.390 3RA24 26-8XF32-2AK6 1.550
220/240 AC 3RA24 26-8XF32-1AP6 1.390 3RA24 26-8XF32-2AP6 1.550
DC operation
25 7.1 11 15.6 19 24 DC 3RA24 23-8XF32-1BB4 1.940 3RA24 23-8XF32-2BB4 2.100
32 / 40 11.4 15 / 19 19 24 DC 3RA24 25-8XF32-1BB4 1.940 3RA24 25-8XF32-2BB4 2.100
18.5
50 -- 22 19 19 24 DC 3RA24 26-8XF32-1BB4 1.960 3RA24 26-8XF32-2BB4 2.120
For IO-Link connection
25 7.1 11 15.6 19 24 DC 3RA24 23-8XE32-1BB4 1.940 3RA24 23-8XE32-2BB4 2.100
32 / 40 11.4 15 / 19 19 24 DC 3RA24 25-8XE32-1BB4 1.940 3RA24 25-8XE32-2BB4 2.100
18.5
50 -- 22 19 19 24 DC 3RA24 26-8XE32-1BB4 1.960 3RA24 26-8XE32-2BB4 2.120
For AS-Interface connection
25 7.1 11 15.6 19 24 DC 3RA24 23-8XH32-1BB4 1.960 3RA24 23-8XH32-2BB4 2.120
32 / 40 11.4 15 / 19 19 24 DC 3RA24 25-8XH32-1BB4 1.960 3RA24 25-8XH32-2BB4 2.120
18.5
50 -- 22 19 19 24 DC 3RA24 26-8XH32-1BB4 1.980 3RA24 26-8XH32-2BB4 2.140
1)
The wye-delta starters listed here are assembled from individual Coil operating range at 50 Hz:
contactors which are UL Listed. The overall assembly Catalog 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us ; at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us.
Number is not UL Listed.
For other voltages see page 2/51 .
2
Rated control
Rated control supplyContactor
supply voltagestype
(changes
3RT201to 10th and 11th positions
3RT202 of the Order No.)
3RT203 3RT231, 3RT232, 3RT233,
voltage
AC Us
Operation 1) 3RT251 3RT252 3RT253
Assemblies
Contactors and
Size S00 B0 S0 B0 S2
B0 B0 S00 B0 S0B0 B0 S2 B0
Coils for 50 Hz 24 V AC
Sizes S00 to S2
(exception: 42 V AC D0 D0 D0 -- -- D0 -- D0
1)
3
AC S00:
size operation
50 48 V AC H0 H0 H0 -- -- H0 -- H0
and 60 Hzcoils
Solenoid 2)
for 50110
Hz (exception:
V AC 60 Hz2))
Size S00: 50 and F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0
24 V AC 230 V AC B0 P0 B0 P0 P0
B0 P0 B0 P0 B0P0 P0 B0 P0
42 V AC 400 V AC D0 V0 D0 V0 D0
V0 V0 D0 V0 --V0 V0 -- V0
48 V AC H0 H0 H0 H0 -- --
Coils for
110 V AC 24 V AC F0 B0 F0 B0 C2
F0 C2 F0 C2 F0C2 C2 F0 C2
50 and 60 Hz
230 V AC 2) 42 V AC P0 D0 P0 D0 D2
P0 D2 P0 -- P0D2 D2 P0 D2
240 V AC 48 V AC U0 H0 U0 H0 U0
H2 H2 -- -- --H2 H2 -- H2
400 V AC V0 V0 V0 V0 V0 V0
110 V AC F0 F0 G2 G2 G2 G2 G2 G2
Solenoid coils for 50 and 60 Hz2)
208 V AC M2 M2 M2 M2 M2 M2 M2 M2
24 V AC 220 V AC B0 N2 C2 N2 C2
N2 N2 B0 N2 C2N2 N2 C2 N2
42 V AC D0 D2 D2 D0 D2 D2
48 V AC 230 V AC H0 P0 H2 P0 L2
H2 L2 H0 L2 H2L2 L2 H2 L2
110 V AC 240 V AC F0 P2 G2 P2 G2
P2 P2 F0 P2 G2P2 P2 G2 P2
220 V AC N2 N2 N2 N2 N2 N2
For USA
230 V AC 50 Hz: 60 Hz:
P0 L2 L2 P0 L2 L2
and Canada
Solenoid
3) 110and
coils (for USA V AC
Canada 120
3)) V AC K6 K6 K6 K6 K6 K6 K6 K6
220 V AC 240 V AC P6 P6 P6 P6 P6 P6 P6 P6
50 Hz 60 Hz
277 V AC — — — U6 — U6 U6 U6
110 V AC 120 V AC K6 K6 K6 K6 K6 K6
220 V AC 240 V AC 480 VP6 AC V6 P6 — V6
P6 — P6 — V6
P6 V6 P6 V6
Solenoid coils (for Japan) 600 V AC — — — T6 — T6 T6 T6
For
50/60Japan
Hz4)
50/60 Hz
60 Hz5)
4): 60 Hz5):
100 V AC 110 V AC G6 G6 G6 G6 G6 G6 G6 G6
100 V AC 110 V AC G6 G6 G6 G6 G6 G6
200 V AC 200
220VVAC
AC 220 VN6 AC N6 N6 N6 N6
N6 N6 N6 N6 N6
N6 N6 N6 N6
400 V AC 440VVAC
400 AC 440 VR6 AC R6 R6 R6 R6 R6 R6 R6 R6
R6 R6 R6 R6
1)
DC operation
DC Operation1)
12 V DC 12 V DC A4 A4 A4 A4 --
— — A4 — A4— — -- —
24 V DC B4 B4 -- B4 B4 --
42 V DC 24 V DC D4 B4 D4 B4 B4
-- B4 D4 — D4— — -- —
48 V DC 42 V DC W4 D4 W4 D4 D4
-- D4 W4 — W4— — -- —
60 V DC 48 V DC E4 W4 E4 W4 --
W4 W4 -- — --— — -- —
110 V DC F4 F4 -- F4 F4 --
125 V DC 60 V DC G4 E4 G4 E4 E4
-- E4 G4 — G4— — -- —
220 V DC 72 V DC M4 J8 M4 J8 --
J8 J8 M4 — M4— — -- —
230 V DC 80 V DC P4 — P4 — --
— — P4 — --— — -- —
Examples 110 V DC F4 F4 F4 F4 — — — —
AC operation 125 V DC
3RT2023-1AP00 G4screw terminals;
Contactor with G4 G4
with solenoid coil forG4 — control supply
50 Hz for rated — voltage 230— V AC —
220 V DC
3RT2023-1AG20 M4screw terminals;
Contactor with M4 with solenoid
M4 coil forM4
50/60 Hz for —
rated control — —110 V AC
supply voltage —
DC operation 230 V DC
3RT2025-2BB40 P4 spring-typeP4terminals; for
Contactor with P4rated control—supply voltage
— 24 V DC — — —
Coil codes for frame sizes S6-S12 can be found
3RT2025-2BG40 on page
Contactor with 2/9. Further voltages
spring-type terminals;onforrequest
rated control supply voltage 125 V DC
Rated control supply Contactor type -- 3RT2. 2.-.N Rated control supply Contactor 3RT2. 3.-.N 3RT2. 2.-.N
voltage voltage type
Us min ... Us max6) Size S00 S0 Us min ... Us max6) Size S2 S3
Sizes S00 to S3
AC/DC operation (50/60 Hz AC, DC)
21 ... 28 V AC/DC -- B3 20 ... 33 V AC/DC B3 B3
95 ... 130 V AC/DC -- F3 83 ... 155 V AC/DC F3 F3
200 ... 280 V AC/DC7) -- P3 175 ... 280 V AC/DC P3 P3
1) For deviating coil voltages and coil operating ranges of sizes S00 and S0, 4) Coil operating range
the SITOP power 24 V DC power supply unit with wide range input Size S00: at 50/60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us
(93 to 264 V AC; 30 to 264 V DC) can be used for coil excitation Size S0: at 50 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
(For more SITOP information see section 15). at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us
2) 5)
Coil operating range Coil operating range
at 50 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us at 60 Hz: 0.8 ...1.1 x Us
at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us 6)
Coil operating range for S0: 0.7 x Us min ... 1.3 x Us max
3)
Coil operating range Coil operating range for S2: 0.8 x Us min ...1.1 x Us max
Size S00: at 50 Hz: 0.85.... 1.1 x Us 7) The following applies to S0 and U
s max = 280 V: Upper limit =1.1 x Us max
at 60 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
Size S0 to S3: at 50 Hz and 60 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
3RH11 . . -1 . . . . 3RH11 . . -2 . . . .
Notes: 1) The 3RH21 contactor relays are also available with spring-type terminals. Replace the 8th digit of the
For further voltages, see page 2/51. order number with a “2” e.g. “3RH2140-2AB00”
For accessories, see pages 2/68-2/79.
For technical data, see pages 2/187-2/190. 2) The 3RH21 contactor relays are also available with ring lug terminals. Replace the 8th digit of the
order number with a “4” e.g. “3RH2140-4AB00”
For overview, see page 2/118.
For position terminals, see page 2/204-2/205. 3) AC coil operating range at 50 Hz: 0.8 to 1.1 x Us at 60 Hz: 0.85 to 1.1 x Us
For dimension drawings, see page 2/126. 4) For AC-15/AC-14 the following applies: Ie = 6A for mounted auxiliary contacts.
2/52 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Control Relays, Coupling Relays
3RH24 latched control relays, 4-pole
Overview
The contactor coil and the coil of the release solenoid are both RC elements, varistors diodes or diode assemblies can
designed for uninterrupted duty. be fitted to both coils from the front for damping opening
surges in the coil.
The number of auxiliary contacts can be extended by means of
front auxiliary switch blocks (up to 4 poles).
2
Selection and ordering data
Size S00 – Terminal designations according to EN 5001
Assemblies
Contactors and
Rated current Aux. contacts Rated Rated
at 240 V Ident. Version control control
AC-14, AC-15 No. supply AC Operation supply DC Operation
NEMA voltage Us voltage Us
A600/Q600 Screw Terminals1) Screw Terminals
For accessories for 3RH24, see below and page 2/68-2/79 For position of terminals, see page 2/204-2/205.
For technical data, see page 2/187-2/190. For dimension drawings, see page 2/227.
For overview, see page 2/118.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/53
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Coupling Relays
3RH21 coupling relays for switching auxiliary circuits, 4 pole
DC operation The 3RH21 coupling relays for The 3RH21 coupling relays Coupling relays have a low power
IEC 60 947 and EN 60 947 switching auxiliary circuits are cannot be extended with consumption, an extended coil
tailored to the special requirements auxiliary switch blocks. voltage tolerance and an integrated
of working with electronic controls. surge suppressor for damping
opening surges on select versions
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
3RH2140-1HB40
Rated control supply voltage Us Diode, varistor, 10 40E 4 — 3RH2140-1MB40-0KT0 3RH2140-2MB40-0KT0 0.300
= 24 V DC, coil voltage tolerance or RC element 10 31E 3 1 3RH2131-1MB40-0KT0 3RH2131-2MB40-0KT0 0.300
0.85 to 1.85 x Us can be mounted 10 22E 2 2 3RH2122-1MB40-0KT0 3RH2122-2MB40-0KT0 0.300
Power consumption of the coils
1.6 W at 24 V (no auxiliary switch Diode 10 40E 4 — 3RH2140-1VB40 3RH2140-2VB40 0.300
blocks can be mounted) integrated 10 31E 3 1 3RH2131-1VB40 3RH2131-2VB40 0.300
10 22E 2 2 3RH2122-1VB40 3RH2122-2VB40 0.300
3RH2140-2SB40
40E
1) Ring lug terminals are also available.
Replace the 8th digit of the order number
with a “4”, e.g. 3RH2140-4HB40
31E
22E
2/54 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3TF68 and 3TF69 vacuum contactors, 3-pole
2
AC operation 2) 3)
Size 14
Assemblies
Contactors and
3TF68 Auxiliary and control conductors: screw terminals
Main conductor: bar connections
• AC Operation
630 200 250 500 600 600 700 4 4 110-132, 50/60 Hz 3TF6844-nCF7 15
630 200 250 500 600 600 700 4 4 200-240, 50/60 Hz 3TF6844-nCM7 15
820 290 350 700 860 800 910 4 4 110-132, 50/60 Hz 3TF6944-nCF7 19
820 290 350 700 860 800 910 4 4 200-240, 50/60 Hz 3TF6944-nCM7 19
UL ratings shown in above table: n=0
For IEC use only up to 1000 V: n=8
• DC Operation
630 200 250 500 600 600 700 3 3 24 V DC 3TF6833-nDB4 16.9
820 290 350 700 860 800 910 3 3 24 V DC 3TF6933-nDB4 20.9
UL ratings shown in above table: n=1
For IEC use only up to 1000 V: n=8
Accessories and Spare parts for 3TF68 and 3TF69 vacuum contactors
Vacuum interrupters
In order to ensure reliable operation of the contactors, only 3TF68 3TY7680-0B 3.2
Siemens original replacement interrupters should be used. 3TF69 3TY7690-0B
3 vacuum interrupters with mouning parts per set. 3.5
Auxiliary switch blocks with screw terminals
1 NO and 1 NC First auxiliary switch block, left or right. 3TF68 / 3TF69 3TY7561-1AA00 0.042
Replacement type for: 3TY7561-1A, -1B
1 NO and 1 NC First auxiliary switch block, left or right late break 3TF68 / 3TF69 3TY7561-1EA00 0.042
1 NO and 1 NC Second auxiliary switch block, left or right. 3TF68 / 3TF69 3TY7561-1KA00 0.042
Replacement type for: 3TY7 561-1K, -1L
Auxiliary switches for coil reconnection, for DC economy circuit with screw connections
1 NC Auxiliary switch block late break 3TF68 / 3TF69 3TY7681-1G 0.042
Solid-state compatible auxiliary switch block with screw terminals
For mounting onto the side of contactors. For use in dusty atmosphere 3TF68 / 3TF69 3TY7561-1UA00 0.042
and electronic circuits with rated operational currents
3TY7561-1. Ie AC-14 and DC-13 from 1 mA to 300 mA at 3 V to 60 V.
For accessories, see page 2/55-2/56. 1) For further voltages, see page 2/104.
For technical data, see page 2/174-2/179. 2) Surge suppression integrated: fitted with varistor.
For description, see page 2/119. 3) For EMC, see description on page 2/119.
3TF68/69 vacuum contactors are supplied with integrated surge suppression for the main conducting paths (for
For internal circuit diagrams, see page 2/213.
description, see page 2/119). In operation in circuits with DC choppers, frequency converters, variable-speed drives,
For position of terminals, see page 2/210 for example, this protective circuitry is not required. It might be damaged by voltage peaks and harmonics generated,
For dimension drawings, see page 2/224. possibly followed by phase-to-phase shortcircuits. For this reason. the contactors can be supplied without overvoltage
damping. To order these versions add a “-Z” and the order code “A02”.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/55
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
Accessories and Spare parts for 3TF68 and 3TF69 vacuum contactors
14 3TF68 and For snapping onto the side of auxiliary switch 3TX7 090-0D 0.1 1
3TF69 blocks, with surge suppression
Terminal covers
3TX7 686-0A (Order No. and price per set)
14 3TF68 for protection against inadvertent contact 3TX7 686-0A 0.17 1 set =
with the exposed busbar connections 2 units
3TF69 (DIN VDE 0106 Part 100)" 3TX7 696-0A
Ordering information
• Select Contactor from table below.
• Complete catalog number replace the two daggers (††) with appropriate
coil voltage suffix. See corresponding coil voltage suffix table below.
• Technical Data see page 2/180-2/183.
• Dimensions see page 2/224.
3TC44 3TC5 2
2
2 Pole DC HP Ratings Auxiliary
Assemblies
Contactors and
Frame Ampere Rating (DC-3, DC-5) contacts AC-Operated DC-Operated
Size Open Enclosed 115 V 230 V 500 V 575 V NO NC Order No. Order No.
3TC DC Contactors
2 40 40 5 10 15 15 2 2 3TC4417–0B†† 3TC4417–0A††
4 75 68 8 18 40 45 2 2 3TC4817–0B†† 3TC4817–0A††
8 220 200 25 50 100 100 2 2 3TC5217–0B†† 3TC5217–0A††
12 330 300 40 75 150 150 2 2 3TC5617–0B†† 3TC5617–0A††
3TC44 3TY2440-0A
3TC48 3TY2480-0A
3TC 3TC52 3TY2520-0A
3TC56 3TY2560-0A
3TY2480-0A 1)
Main contact kits for size 3TC48 and larger include springs.
Smaller sizes do not.
Arc Chutes
2) On DC operated contactors the maximum number of auxiliary
3TC44 3TY2442-0A contacts is 2 NO, 2 NC.
3TC 3TC48 3TY2482-0A 3)
For use in dusty atmosphere and electronic circuits with rated
operational currents Ie AC-14 and DC-13 from 1 mA to 300 mA
3TC52 3TY2522-0A
at 3V to 60V. With 1 changeover contact.
3TC56 3TY2562-0A
4) Discount Code: DC Contactors
3TY2482-0A 5) Can only be mounted on AC-operated contactors.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/57
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
DC Contactor Replacement Parts Contactors for Switching DC Voltage
General Purpose - Type 3TC 3TC contactors,
1- and 2-pole, 32 ... 400 A
for sticking onto the contactor base 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3TX7 462-3H 1
3TX7 402-3 . or for mounting separately 127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3TX7 462-3J 1
240 ... 400 3TX7 462-3K 1
400 ... 600 3TX7 462-3L 1
8 and 12 3TC52, Varistor 24 ... 48 3TX7 462-3G 1
4
3TC56 for sticking onto the contactor base 48 ... 127 3TX7 462-3H 1
or for mounting separately 127 ... 240 3TX7 462-3J 1
240 ... 400 3TX7 462-3K 1
400 ... 600 3TX7 462-3L 1
8 and 12 3TC52, Varistors2) 24 ... 70 3TX7 522-3G 1
3TX7 462-3 . 3TC56 for separate screw connection or 70 ... 150 3TX7 522-3H 1
snapping onto TH 35 standard 150 ... 250 3TX7 522-3J 1
mounting rail
3TX7 522-3 .
Surge suppressors · RC elements
4 3TC48 RC elements 24 ... 48 3TX7 462-3R
For lateral snapping onto auxiliary 24 ... 70 3TX7 522-3R
switch or TH 35 standard mounting 48 ... 127 3TX7 462-3S
rail 70 ... 150 3TX7 522-3S
127 ... 240 3TX7 462-3T
150 ... 250 3TX7 522-3T
240 ... 400 3TX7 462-3U
400 ... 600 3TX7 462-3V
3TX7 462-3 . , 8 and 12 3TC52, RC elements 24 ... 48 3TX7 522-3R
3TX7 522-3 . 3TC56 For lateral snapping onto auxiliary 48 ... 127 3TX7 522-3S
switch or TH 35 standard mounting 127 ... 240 3TX7 522-3T
rail 240 ... 400 3TX7 522-3U
400 ... 600 3TX7 522-3V
Surge suppressors · Diodes
4 to 12 3TC48, Diode assemblies3) 24 ... 250 3TX7 462-3D
3TC52, . (diode and Zener diode) for DC
3TC56 solenoid system, for sticking onto
the contactor base or for mounting
separately
3TX7 462-3 .
Terminal covers
6 3TC48 For protection against inadvertent contact with 3TX6 506-3B 1 set=
exposed busbar connections. Can be screwed 6 units
on free screw end. Covers one busbar connection
10 and 14 3TC52, 3TX6 546-3B 1 set=
3TC56 6 units
3TX6 506-3B
1) The connection piece for mounting the surge suppressor must be bent
slightly.
2) Includes the peak value of the alternating voltage on the DC side.
3) Not for DC economy circuit.
■ Overview
Contactor relays,
size S00, with accessories
10
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
11
11
1
2
5
IC01_00632a
8
9
3
12
13 14
11
6
4
5 11
7
10
1 Contactor relay
2 Coupling contactor relay for auxiliary circuits
3 3RA28 function module 10 Solder pin adapter for contactor relays with 4-pole auxiliary switch block
4 1-pole auxiliary switch block, cable entry from the top 11 Solder pin adapter
5 2-pole auxiliary switch block, cable entry from the top 12 Additional load module for increasing the permissible residual current
6 1-pole auxiliary switch block, cable entry from the bottom 13 Surge suppressor with LED
7 2-pole auxiliary switch block, cable entry from the bottom 14 Surge suppressor without LED
8 4-pole auxiliary switch block
(terminal designations according to EN 50011 or EN 50005)
For contactor relays
9 2-pole auxiliary switch block, solid-state compatible version
(terminal designations according to EN 50005) For increasing the permissible residual current
3RT2 contactors and coupling relays – Size S00 with mountable accessories
General data
■ Overview
The SIRIUS family of controls
The SIRIUS modular system with its components for the
switching, starting, protection and monitoring of motors and
industrial systems stands for the fast, flexible and space-saving
construction of control cabinets.
2
3RT2 contactors
3
Size S00 with mountable accessories
Contactors and
Assemblies
10
11
12
13
16
1 15
18 1
6 2
7 17
8
IC01_00614
16
9
3
4
5
14
2 2-pole auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable 11 Star jumper, 3-pole, without connecting terminal
3 1-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front 12 Link for paralleling, 3-pole, with connecting terminal
cable entry from the top 13 Solder pin adapter
4 2-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front 14 Connection module (adapter and connector) for contactors
cable entry from the bottom with screw-type connection
5 4-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front 15 Safety main current connector for two contactors
6 3RA28 function module Assembly kit 3RA2913-2AA1
7 3RA27 function module for AS-Interface, direct starting comprising:
8 3RA27 function module for IO-Link, direct starting 16 Wiring modules on the top and bottom for connecting the main,
auxiliary and control current paths, electrical interlock 1)
9 Surge suppressor with/without LED
included (NC contact interlock), can be broken off
10 Three-phase feeder terminal (NC contact interlock)
17 Mechanical interlocks 2)
18 Two connecting clips for two contactors 2)
For contactors
For contactors and coupling contactors
1)
3RT201. contactors with one NC contact in the basic unit
are required for the electrical interlock. An additional NO contact
is required for momentary-contact operation.
2) The parts 17 and 18 can only be ordered together as 3RA2912-2H
mechanical connectors.
For accessories
2/60 and spare
Siemens Industry Inc.,parts, seeControl
Industrial pagesCatalog
3/75 to 3/123.
16
14
2
3
Assemblies
Contactors and
15
2 18
1
17
1
7 20
8
9
IC01_00615
19
5
4 10
6
18
13
14
3
11
12
1 Contactor size S0
2 2-pole auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable 12 Link for paralleling, 3-pole, with connecting terminal
3 1-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front 13 Connection module (adapter and plug) for contactors
cable entry from the top with screw-type connection
4 4-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front 14 Coil terminal module, on the top and bottom
5 2-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front 15 Three-phase feeder terminal
cable entry from the bottom
16 Link for paralleling (star jumper), 3-pole,
6 Surge suppressor with/without LED without connecting terminal
7 3RA27 function module for AS-Interface, direct starting 17 Safety main current connector for two contactors
8 3RA28 function module Assembly kit 3RA2923-2AA1
9 3RA27 function module for IO-Link, direct starting comprising:
10 Pneumatically delayed auxiliary switch block 18 Wiring modules on the top and bottom for connecting the
main current paths, electrical interlock included (NC
11 Mechanical latching block
contact interlock)
19 Mechanical interlocks 1)
20 Two connecting clips for two contactors 1)
For contactors
For contactors and coupling contactors
1) The parts19 and 20 can only be ordered together as 3RA2912-2H
mechanical connectors.
13
12
2
3
Contactors and
Assemblies
11
15
1
16
14
2 1
17
7
8
9
IC01_00616a
6
3 15
5
4 11
1 Contactor, size S2
10
2 2-pole auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable 13 Link for paralleling (star jumper), 3-pole,
without connection terminal
3 1-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front,
cable entry from above 14 Safety main current connector for two contactors
4 4-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front Assembly kit 3RA2933-2AA1
5 2-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front, comprising:
cable entry from below 15 Wiring modules on the top and bottom for connecting the
6 Surge suppressor with/without LED main current paths, electrical interlock included
(NC contact interlock)
7 3RA27 function modules for AS-Interface, direct-on-line starting
16 Two connecting clips for two contactors
8 3RA28 function modules
9 3RA27 function modules for IO-Link, direct-on-line starting To be ordered separately:
10 Link for paralleling, 3-pole, with connection terminal 17 Mechanical interlocks
11 Coil terminal module, top and bottom
12 Three-phase feeder terminal
3RT2 contactors
General data – Size S3 with mountable accessories
3RT2 contactors
Size S3 with mountable accessories
13
12
2
3
Assemblies
Contactors and
11
14
1
2 15 1
16
7
8
9
IC01_00617a
6
14
3
5
4
11
1 Contactor, size S3
10
2 2-pole auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable 10 Links for paralleling, 3-pole, with connection terminal
3 1-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front, 11 Coil terminal module, top and bottom
cable entry from above
12 Single-phase infeed terminals (3 units)
4 4-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front
13 Links for paralleling (star jumper), 3-pole
5 2-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front, without connecting terminal
cable entry from below Assembly kit 3RA2943-2AA1
6 Surge suppressor with/without LED comprising:
7 3RA27 function modules for AS-Interface, direct-on-line starting 14 Wiring modules on the top and bottom for connecting the main,
8 3RA28 function modules auxiliary and control current paths, electrical interlock1)
included, can be broken off (NC contact interlock)
9 3RA27 function modules for IO-Link, direct-on-line starting
15 Two connectors for two contactors
To be ordered separately:
16 Mechanical interlock
1)
3RT201. contactors with one NC contact in the basic unit
are required for the electrical interlock. An additional NO contact
is required for momentary-contact operation.
For accessories
Accessories and spare parts,
see pages 2/68 tosee pages 3/71 to 3/119.
2/83. Motor Starters see Chapter 4 Combination
Starters & Starters for group installation
1
2
3
IC01_00618a
Contactors and
Assemblies
5
7
2
3
8
1 3RT10 and 3RT14 air-break contactor, sizes S6, S10 and S12
2 Auxiliary switch block, solid-state time-delay 7 Terminal cover for cable lug and busbar connection
(ON or OFF-delay or star-delta (wye-delta) starting)
8 Terminal cover for box terminal
3 4-pole auxiliary switch block
9 Box terminal block
4 1-pole auxiliary switch block (up to 4 can be snapped on)
5 2-pole auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable left or right
6 Surge suppressor (RC element) for plugging into top of withdrawable coil
Accessories identical for sizes S6 to S12
Different accessories for sizes S6 and S10/S12
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3
2
4
IC01_00583a
7
7
5
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
3
3
7 2
IC01_00584a
6
6
2
3
Assemblies
Contactors and
3
4
5
5
1
IC01_00620a
1 3RT10 and 3RT14 air-break contactor, sizes S6, S10 and S12
(3RT1054, size S6 shown here)
2 3RT12 vacuum contactor, sizes S10 and S12
(3RT1266, size S10 shown here)
3 Withdrawable coils for 3RT1...-.A... contactors with conventional operating mechanism
(size S10: differentiation between 3RT10/3RT14 air-break contactors and 3RT12 vacuum contactors)
(size S12: the same for air-break and vacuum contactors)
4 Withdrawable coils for 3RT1...-.N... contactors with solid-state operating mechanism.
(size S10: differentiation between 3RT10/3RT14 air-break contactors and 3RT12 vacuum contactors)
(size S12: the same for air-break and vacuum contactors)
5 Withdrawable coils and laterally mountable module (plug-on) for 3RT1...-.P... air-break
contactors with solid-state operating mechanism and remaining lifetime indicator
6 Surge suppressor (RC element), plug-mountable on withdrawable coils
• 3RT1...-.A... with conventional operating mechanism
• 3RT1...-.N... with solid-state operating mechanism
Auxiliary switch blocks for snapping onto the front according to EN 50012
(also compliant with the requirements according to EN 50005)
Size S00 2)
For assembling contactors with 2, 3, 4, or 5 auxiliary contacts
3RT201., 11E — 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA01 3RH2911-2HA01
Ident. No. 10E 12E — 2 — — 3RH2911-1HA02 3RH2911-2HA02
3RT231. 13E — 3 — — 3RH2911-1HA03 3RH2911-2HA03
3RT251. 21E 1 — — — 3RH2911-1HA10 3RH2911-2HA10
21E 1 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA11 3RH2911-2HA11
22E 1 2 — — 3RH2911-1HA12 3RH2911-2HA12
23E 1 3 — — 3RH2911-1HA13 3RH2911-2HA13
31E 2 — — — 3RH2911-1HA20 3RH2911-2HA20
31E 2 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA21 3RH2911-2HA21
32E 2 2 — — 3RH2911-1HA22 3RH2911-2HA22
41E 3 — — — 3RH2911-1HA30 3RH2911-2HA30
41E 3 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA31 3RH2911-2HA31
Size S0 to S3
For assembling contactors with 3, 4, or 5 auxiliary contacts
3RT202. , 12E — 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA01 3RH2911-2HA01
Ident. No. 11E 13E — 2 — — 3RH2911-1HA02 3RH2911-2HA02
3RT232. 14E — 3 — — 3RH2911-1HA03 3RH2911-2HA03
3RT252. 21E 1 — — — 3RH2911-1HA10 3RH2911-2HA10
3RT203. 22E 1 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA11 3RH2911-2HA11
3RT233. 23E 1 2 — — 3RH2911-1HA12 3RH2911-2HA12
3RT235. 24E 1 3 — — 3RH2911-1HA13 3RH2911-2HA13
31E 2 — — — 3RH2911-1HA20 3RH2911-2HA20
32E 2 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA21 3RH2911-2HA21
33E 2 2 — — 3RH2911-1HA22 3RH2911-2HA22
41E 3 — — — 3RH2911-1HA30 3RH2911-2HA30
42E 3 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA31 3RH2911-2HA31
Auxiliary switch blocks for snapping onto the front according to EN 50012
Sizes S6 to S12
4-pole
EN50005 and EN50012 designate the markings 1) The 3RH2911-.HA.. aux. switches are available with 3) UL ratings: See appendix page 19/7
of the auxiliary terminal numbers. ring-lug terminals. Replace the 8th digit of the Order
For position of the terminals see pages 2/204-2/208. No. with a “4”.
For int. circuit diagrams see page 2/192. 2) Size S00 can be mounted according to EN 50012
3RH29 aux blocks are not intended for use with 3RT1 or only on basic units which have no integrated NC
3RH1 contactors and relays. contact.
3RH19 aux blocks are not intended for use with 3RT2 or
3RH2 contactors and relays.
For auxiliary switch blocks for 3RH2140 and 3RH2440 see
page 2/53.
2/68 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Auxiliary switch blocks
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RH2911-1FA40 3RH2911-2FA40 3RH19 21-1C. . . 3RH19 21-2C . . . 3RH19 21-1LA . . 3RH19 21-1MA..
Auxiliary switch blocks for snapping onto the front according to EN 50005
Sizes S00 to S3
2- or 4-pole auxiliary switch blocks for assembling contactors
with 3 and 5 or 4 and 6 auxiliary contacts
3RT2. 1., 40 4 — — — 3RH2911-1FA40 3RH2911-2FA40
3RT2. 2., 22 2 2 — — 3RH2911-1FA22 3RH2911-2FA22
3RT2. 3., 04 1) — 4 — — 3RH2911-1FA04 3RH2911-2FA04
3RH21 .., 11 2) — — 1 1 3RH2911-1FB11 3RH2911-2FB11
3RH24 .. 22 2) 1 1 1 1 3RH2911-1FB22 3RH2911-2FB22
22 2) — — 2 2 3RH2911-1FC22 3RH2911-2FC22
1- and 2- pole auxiliary switch blocks, cable entry from above or below
3RT2. 1., 10 Top 1 — — — 3RH2911-1AA10 —
3RT2. 2., Bottom 1 — — — 3RH2911-1BA10 —
3RT2. 3., 01 Top — 1 — — 3RH2911-1AA01 —
3RH21 .., Bottom — 1 — — 3RH2911-1BA01 —
3RH24 .. 11 Top 1 1 — — 3RH2911-1LA11 —
Bottom 1 1 — — 3RH2911-1MA11 —
20 Top 2 — — — 3RH2911-1LA20 —
Bottom 2 — — — 3RH2911-1MA20 —
Sizes S6 to S12
Single-pole auxiliary switch blocks (also compliant with EN 50012)
EN50005 and EN50012 designate the markings 1) Mounting is permitted only on basic units which 3) UL ratings: See appendix page 19/7
of the auxiliary terminal numbers. have no integrated NC contact.
For position of the terminals see pages 2/204-2/208. 2) Version with early make and delayed break contacts
For int. circuit diagrams see page 2/192.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/69
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks
Sizes S0 to S3
3RT2.2., A600/Q600 02 right or left — 2 3RH2921-1DA02 3RH2921-2DA02
3RT2.3.3) A600/Q600 11 right or left 1 1 3RH2921-1DA11 3RH2921-2DA11
A600/Q600 20 right or left 2 — 3RH2921-1DA20 3RH2921-2DA20
Sizes S6 to S12
3RT1. 4 to A300/Q300 right or left — 2 3RH1921-1EA02 3RH1921-2EA02
3RT1. 7 A300/Q300 right or left 1 1 3RH1921-1EA11 —
A300/Q300 right or left 2 — 3RH1921-1EA20 3RH1921-2EA20
Second laterally mountable auxiliary switch block, 2-pole
Sizes S6 to S12
3RT1. 4 to A300/Q300 right or left — 2 3RH1921-1KA02 3RH1921-2KA02
3RT1. 7 A300/Q300 right or left 1 1 3RH1921-1KA11 —
A300/Q300 right or left 2 — 3RH1921-1KA20 3RH1921-2KA20
EN50005 and EN50012 designate the markings 1) With size S00, mounting according to EN 50012 is per- 3) With 3RT23 2., 3RT25. 2. mountable only on the right.
of the auxiliary terminal numbers. mitted only on basic units which have no NC contact
4) UL ratings: See appendix page 19/7
For position of the terminals see pages 2/204-2/208. integrated.
For int. circuit diagrams see pages 2/192-2/197. 2) Ident. No. 41, 32 and 23 according to EN 50012 is
also possible. Please note the corresponding circuit
diagrams for mounting 3RH29 11-1DA.. on the left.
2/70 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Solid-state auxiliary switch blocks
2
n Mirror contacts according to EN 60947-4-1, Appendix F, for laterally mountable auxiliary switches
Assemblies
Contactors and
Selection and ordering data
EN50005 and EN50012 designate the markings 1) The 3RH29 11-.NF.. auxiliary switches are also 2) Size S00 can be mounted according to EN 50012
of the auxiliary terminal numbers. available with ring lug terminal connection. The 8th only on basic units which have no integrated NC
digit of the order number must be replaced with “4”, contact.
For position of the terminals see pages 2/204 -2/208.
e. g.: 3RH2911-1NF11 -> 3RH2911-4NF11
For int. circuit diagrams see pages 2/192-2/197.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/71
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Auxiliary switch blocks, delayed
Sizes S6 to S12
3RT1926-2FJ11 ON-delay (varistor integrated)
3RT10, 24 AC/DC 4) 0.05 … 1 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2EJ11 —
3RT13, 0.5 … 10 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2EJ21 —
3RT14, 5 … 100 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2EJ31 —
3RT15 100 … 127 AC 4) 0.05 … 1 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2EC11 —
0.5 … 10 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2EC21 —
5 … 100 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2EC31 —
4)
200 … 240 AC 0.05 … 1 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2ED11 —
0.5 … 10 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2ED21 —
5 … 100 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2ED31 —
OFF-delay without auxiliary voltage 5)
24 AC/DC 4) 0.05 … 100 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FJ11 —
(1, 10, 100, 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FJ21 —
selectable) 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FJ31 —
100 … 127 AC 4) 0.05 … 100 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FK11 —
(1, 10, 100, 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FK21 —
selectable) 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FK31 —
200 … 240 AC 4) 0.05 … 100 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FL11 —
(1, 10, 100, 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FL21 —
selectable) 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FL31 —
WYE-delta function
24 AC/DC 4) 1.5 … 30 each have: 3RT19 26-2GJ51 —
100 … 127 AC 4) 1.5 … 30 1 NO delayed 3RT19 26-2GC51 —
200 … 240 AC 4)
1.5 … 30 1 NO instant 3RT19 26-2GD51 —
interval 50ms
For technical data, see pages 2/184-2/185. 1) AC voltage values apply for 50 Hz and 60 Hz. 4) Terminals A1 and A2 for the rated control supply
For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/200. voltage of the solid-state time-delay auxiliary switch
2) Cannot be fitted onto coupling relays.
must be connected to the associated contactor by
For position of terminals, see page 2/208. 3) Setting of output contacts in as-supplied state not means of connecting leads.
defined (bistable relay). Application of the control
When the solid-state time-delay auxiliary switches are 5) Position of the output contacts not defined in the
supply voltage once results in contact change-over
used, no other auxiliary switches are allowed to be as-delivered state (bistable relay). Applying the con-
to the correct setting.
trol voltage once results in the contacts switching to
mounted on the basic units.
the correct position.
2/72 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power Contactors
Accessories forfor
3RTSwitching Motors / 3RH control relays
contactors
Accessories for 3RT2 Contactors
Function modules, delay blocks
Delay and latching blocks
2
3
3RA2812-1DW10 3RA2811-2CW10
Assemblies
Contactors and
1)
For contactors Rated control supply voltage Us Time setting range t Screw terminals Spring-type Weight
terminals
Order No. Order No.
Type V AC/D C s kg
Timing relays for mounting on 3RT2 contactors
Sizes S00 to S3
The electrical connection between the timing relay and the
contactor underneath is established automatically when it is
snapped on and locked.
ON-delay
Two-wire design, varistor integrated
3RT20.., 24 ... 240 0.05 ...100 3RA2811-1CW10 3RA2811-2CW10
3RT23.., (1, 10, 100; selectable)
3RT25..,
3RH212),
3RH24
3RT203 . 24 ... 90 0.05 ...100 3RA2831-1DG10 3RA2831-2DG10
90 ... 240 (1, 10, 100; selectable) 3RA2831-1DH10 3RA2831-2DH10
OFF-delay with control signal
Varistor integrated
3RT20.., 24 ... 240 0.05 ...100 3RA2812-1DW10 3RA2812-2DW10
3RT23.., (1, 10, 100; selectable)
3RT25..,
3RH212),
3RH24
3RT203 . 24 ... 90 0.05 ...100 3RA2832-1DG10 3RA2832-2DG10
90 ... 240 (1, 10, 100; selectable) 3RA2832-1DH10 3RA2832-2DH10
1)
AC voltage values apply for 50 Hz and 60 Hz.
2)
Cannot be fitted onto coupling relays.
For contactors Rated control supply Time setting range t Screw terminals Weight
voltage Us
Order No.
Type V s kg
OFF-delay devices
Sizes S00 to S2
For contactors with DC operation
Non-adjustable delay time
3RT201. -1BF4., 110 AC/DC S00: > 0,1 3RT2916-2BK01
3RT202. -1BF4., S0: > 0,08
3RT203. -1NF3., 110 DC S2: > 0,25
3RH2. . . -1BF40
3RT201. -1BM4./1BP4. , 220/230 AC/DC S00: > 0,5 3RT2916-2BL01
3RT202. -1BM4./1BP4. , S0: > 0,3
3RT203. -1NP3., 220/230 DC S2: > 0,8
3RH2. . . -1BM40/1BP40
3RT201.-1BB4., 24 DC S00: > 0,2 3RT2916-2BE01
3RT2916-2B.01 3RT202.-1BB4., S0: > 0,1
3RT203.-1NB3., S2: > 0,1
3RH2.. .-1BB40
Mechanical latching blocks
Size S0
For snapping onto the front of contactors
The contactor remains in the energized state
after a voltage failure
3RT202 . 24 AC/DC -- 3RT2926-3AB31
110 AC/DC -- 3RT2926-3AF31
For description, see page 2/121. 1) AC voltage ratings apply for 50 and 60 Hz.
230 AC/DC -- 3RT2926-3AP31
For technical data, see page 2/184. 2) The 3RA28 time-delay blocks are available
For circuit diagrams, see page 2/200. with spring-type terminals. Replace the 8th
digit of the order number with a “2”.
3RT2926-3A.31
3) Cannot be fitted onto coupling relays
For technical specifications, see page 3/54.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/73
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
3/70 Siemens IC 10 · 2015 Illustrations are approximate
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Function modules, delay blocks, and mechanical latching blocks
For description, see page 2/121. 1) AC voltage ratings apply for 50 and 60 Hz. 4) Versions according to DIN VDE 0116
For technical data, see page 2/184. on request.
2) The 3RA28 time-delay blocks are available
For circuit diagrams, see page 2/200. with spring-type terminals. Replace the 8th 5) In addition to these, no other auxiliary
digit of the order number with a “2”. contacts are permitted.
3) Cannot be fitted onto coupling relays
2
Size S00
3
For plugging onto the front side of the contactors
Assemblies
Contactors and
(with and without auxiliary switch block)
3RT2.1, Varistors 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2916-1BB00
3RH2. 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2916-1BC00
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2916-1BD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2916-1BE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2916-1BF00
3RT2.1, RC elements 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2916-1CB00
3RH2. 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2916-1CC00
3RT2916-1B.00 127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2916-1CD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2916-1CE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2916-1CF00
3RT2.1, Noise suppression diodes -- 12 ... 250 3RT2916-1DG00
3RH2.
3RT2.1, Diode assemblies -- 12 ... 250 3RT2916-1EH00
3RH2. (diode and Zener diode) for
DC operation
Size S0
For plugging onto the front side of the contactors
(prior to mounting of the auxiliary switch block)
3RT2.2 Varistors 2) 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2926-1BB00
48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2926-1BC00
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2926-1BD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2926-1BE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2926-1BF00
3RT2.2 RC elements 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2926-1CB00
3RT2926-1E.00 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2926-1CC00
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2926-1CD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2926-1CE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2926-1CF00
3RT2.2 Diode assembly -- 24 3RT2926-1ER00
for DC operation -- 30 ... 250 3RT2926-1ES00
Size S2 and S3
For plugging onto the front side of the contactors
(prior to mounting of the auxiliary switch block)
3RT2.3. Varistors 2)3) 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2936-1BB00
3RT2.4. 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2936-1BC00
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2936-1BD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2936-1BE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2936-1BF00
3RT2936-1B.00
3RT2.3. RC elements 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2936-1CB00
48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2936-1CC00
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2936-1CD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2936-1CE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2936-1CF00
3RT2.3. Diode assembly 3) -- 24 3RT2936-1ER00
3RT2.4. for DC operation -- 30 ... 250 3RT2936-1ES00
3RT2936-1E.00
Size S3
For plugging into the two recesses on the left next to the
connection block for auxiliary switches and coils A1 and
A2. The connecting cables are wired to A1 and A2.
3RT2.4 RC elements 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2946-1CB00
48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2946-1CC00
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2946-1CD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2946-1CE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2946-1CF00
1)
Can be used for AC operation for 50/60 Hz. Please inquire about other voltages.
2)
The varistor is already integrated into the AC/DC contactors.
3RT2946-1C.00 3)
Surge suppressors 3RT2936-1B/1E (version E03) can be used in 3RT2.4 contactors.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/75
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2015 3/71
IC10_03_05.fm Page 103 Tuesday, September 1, 2020 3:26 PM
For Version Rated control supply voltage Us1) SD Article No. Price PU PS*
contactors AC operation DC operation per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
Type V AC V DC d
2
3
3RT1.5 ... RC elements 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 } 3RT1956-1CB00 1 1 unit
3RT1.7 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 } 3RT1956-1CC00 1 1 unit
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 } 3RT1956-1CD00 1 1 unit
240 ... 400 -- } 3RT1956-1CE00 1 1 unit
400 ... 600 20 3RT1956-1CF00 1 1 unit
3RT1956-1C.00
Spring-loaded terminals
For con- Version Rated control supply Power con- SD Article No. Price PU PS* PG
tactors voltage Us1) sumption
Rated controlP supply per PU (UNIT,
of LED SET, M)
For AC DC voltage Us 1) Weight
contactors Version operation operation ACatoperation
Us
DC operation approx.
Order No.
TType
yp e V AC V DC m
V AC W d DC
V mW kg
Surge suppressors with LED (also for spring-loaded terminals)
Surge suppressors with LED (also for spring-type terminals)
Size S00
3RT2916-1J.00 Size S00 For For plugging onto the front side of the contactors
plugging onto the front of the contactors
(with and without auxiliary switch block)
(with or without auxiliary switches)
3RT2.1, Varistor 24 … 48 12 … 24 10 … 120 3RT2916-1JJ00 0.010
3RT2.1,
3RH2. Varistors 24 ... 48 12 ... 24 48 …127
10 ... 120 } … 3RT2916-1JJ00
24 70 20 … 470 1
3RT2916-1JK00 1 unit
0.010 41B
3RH2 48 ... 127 24 ... 70 12720… ...
240470 } … 3RT2916-1JK00
70 150 50 … 700 1
3RT2916-1JL00 1 unit
0.010 41B
127 ... 240 70 ... 150 50 ... 700 } 3RT2916-1JL00 1 1 unit 41B
-- —
150 ... 250 160 ... 950 150
2 ...3RT2916-1JP00
250 160 … 950 3RT2916-1JP00
1 0.010
1 unit 41B
3RT2.1,
3RT2.1, Noise
Noise -- 24 ... 70 — 20 ... 470 } … 3RT2916-1LM00
24 70 20 … 470 1
3RT2916-1LM00 1 unit
0.010 41B
3RH2
3RH2. suppression
suppression-- 50 ... 150 — 50 ... 700 2 … 3RT2916-1LN00
50 150 50 … 700 1
3RT2916-1LN00 1 unit
0.010 41B
3RT2916-1J.00 diodes
diode -- 150 ... 250 — 160 ... 950 } …3RT2916-1LP00
150 250 160 … 950 1
3RT2916-1LP00 1 unit
0.010 41B
Size S0
3RT2926-1MR00 Size S0 For For
plugging intoonto
plugging the front of the
the front contactors
side of the contactors
(before mounting
(prior the auxiliary
to mounting switch)switch block)
of the auxiliary
3RT2.2
3RT2.2 Varistors
Varistor 24 ... 48 12 ... 24 24 …1048 } … 3RT2926-1JJ00
... 120 12 24 10 … 120 3RT2926-1JJ00
1 0.010
1 unit 41B
48 ... 127 24 ... 70 48 …127 } … 3RT2926-1JK00
20 ... 470 24 70 20 … 470 1
3RT2926-1JK00 1 unit
0.010 41B
127 ... 240 70 ... 150 12750
… ...
240 } … 3RT2926-1JL00
700 70 150 50 … 700 1
3RT2926-1JL00 1 unit
0.010 41B
3RT2.2 Diode -- 24 20 ... 470 } 3RT2926-1MR00 1 1 unit 41B
3RT2.2 Diode
assemblies — 24 20 … 470 3RT2926-1MR00 0.010
assembly
3RT2926-1MR00
Sizes S2 and S3
For plugging into the front of the contactors
3RT2936-1J.00 Size S2 (before
For plugging
mountingonto the frontswitch)
the auxiliary side of the contactors
(prior2)to mounting of the auxiliary switch block)
and S3 Varistors
3RT2.3, 24 ... 48 12 ... 24 10 ... 120 5 3RT2936-1JJ00 1 1 unit 41B
3RT2.3,
3RT2.4 Varistor 2) 48 ... 127 24 ... 70 24 …2048
... 470 12
5 … 3RT2936-1JK00
24 10 … 120 3RT2936-1JJ00
1 0.010
1 unit 41B
3RT2.4 127 ... 240 70 ... 150 48 …127
50 ... 700 24
} … 3RT2936-1JL00
70 20 … 470 3RT2936-1JK00
1 0.010
1 unit 41B
127 … 240 70 … 150 50 … 700 3RT2936-1JL00 0.010
3RT2936-1JJ00
1)
Can be used for AC operation for 50/60 Hz. Other voltages on request.
2) 1) Can be used for AC operations for 50/60 Hz. 2. 3RT2936 (version E03) surge suppressors can be
From product version E03 onwards, 3RT2936 surge suppressors can be used for 3RT2.4 contactors.
Other voltages on request.
used for 3RT2.4 contactors.
2/76 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Surge suppressors, terminals, labels
For Weight
contactors Version Order No. approx.
Units kg
Main conducting path surge suppression module for 3RT12 vacuum contactors
2
Sizes S10 For damping overvoltages and protecting the motor windings against
and S12 multiple reignition when switching off three-phase motors.
3RT12 For connection on the contactor feeder side (2-T1/4-T2/6-T3).
Assemblies
Contactors and
For separate installation.
Rated operational voltage Ue ≥ 500 V AC ... ≤ 690 V AC 3RT1966-1PV3 0.18
Rated operational voltage Ue ≤ 1000 V AC 3RT1966-1PV4 0.36
Blank Labels
3RT29 00- 1SB20
Unit labeling plates
20 mm x 7 mm, pastel 340 units 3RT2900-1SB20 0.200
PC labeling system for individual inscription
of unitlabeling plates available from:
murrplastik Systems, Inc.
10 mm x 7 mm 816 units 3RT2900-1SB10 0.294
IC01_00181
Standard
For Maximum resistive current Ie/AC-1 Max. conductor Screw package Weight
Size contactors (at 60 °C) of contactors cross sections Terminals quantity approx.
Type A kg
Order No.
S00 3RT201. 3-pole, with terminal 1), 2) 4 AWG, stranded 3RT1916-4BB31 0.015
S0 3RT202. 0 AWG, stranded 3RT2926-4BB31 0.042
S2 3RT203. 95 mm2 3RT1936-4BB31 0.139
3
Contactors and
Assemblies
Up to 400 V 3RT2916-1PA1
Up to 575 V 3RT2916-1PA2
Up to 690 V 3RT2916-1PA3
3RT201 Varistors
Up to 400 V 3RT2916-1PB1
Up to 575 V 3RT2916-1PB2
3RT2916-1PA. Up to 690 V 3RT2916-1PB3
Coupling links for control by PLC
Size S0
3RT2. 2 For mounting onto the coil terminals of the contactors 3RH2924-1GP11
(only for contactors with screw terminals)
With LED for indicating switching state.
With integrated varistor for damping opening surges.
24 V DC control,
17 ... 30 V DC operating range
3RH2924-1GP11
Sizes S00 to S3
3RT2.1, For mounting on the front side of contactors
3RT2.2, with AC, DC or AC/DC operation
3RT2.3 24 V DC control, 3RH2914-1GP11
17 ... 30 V DC operating range
Spring-type terminals
24 V DC control, 3RH2914-2GP11
3RH2914-1GP11 17 ... 30 V DC operating range
Additional load modules
Size S00
3RT2.1, For plugging onto the front side of the contactors with or 3RT2916-1GA00
3RH2. without auxiliary switch blocks
For increasing the permissible residual current and for limiting
the residual voltage. It ensures the safe opening of contactors
with direct control via 230 V AC semiconductor outputs of
SIMATIC controllers. It acts simultaneously as a surge
suppressor.
Rated voltage:
50/60 Hz, 180 to 255 V AC
3RT2916-1GA00
LED module for indicating contactor operation
Sizes S00 to S3
3RT2.. For snapping into the location hole of an inscription label 3RT2926-1QT00
on the front of a contactor
either directly on the contactor or on the front auxiliary switch.
The LED module is connected to coil terminals A1 and A2 of
the contactor and indicates its energized state.
Yellow LED.
Rated voltage:
24 ... 240 V AC/DC, with reverse polarity protection.
3RT2926-1QT00
Control kit
Sizes S00 to S3
For manual operation of the contactor contacts
for start-up and service
3RT2.1, 3RT2916-4MC00
3RH2.
3RT2.2 3RT2926-4MC00
3RT2916-4MC00 3RT2. 3 3RT2936-4MC00
2
3RT2.2, for preventing manual operation
3RT2.3,
3
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RH2.1)
3RT2916-4MA10
Connection modules for contactors with screw terminals
Sizes S00 and S0
Adapters for contactors Screw terminals
Ambient temperature Tu max = 60 °C
3RT2 .1, Size S00, 3RT1916-4RD01
3RH2. rated operational current Ie at
AC-3/400 V: 20 A
3RT2. 2 Size S0, 3RT1926-4RD01
3RT1926-4RD01
rated operational current Ie at
AC-3/400 V: 25 A
3RT2 .1, Plugs for contactors 3RT1900-4RE01
3RT2.2, Size S00, S0
3RH2.
3RT1900-4RE01
Terminal covers for contactors with box terminals
Size S2
Covers for box terminals
3RT203 For 3-pole contactors 3RT2936-4EA2
3RT233, For 4-pole contactors (see Chapter 4) 3RT2936-4EA4
3RT253
3RT2936-4EA2
Coil connection modules
Sizes S0 and S2
3RT2.2, Connection from top 3RT2926-4RA11
3RT2.3 Connection from below 3RT2926-4RB11
Connection diagonally 3RT2926-4RC11
3RT2926-4RA11
Spring-type terminals
3RT2926-4RA12
Covers for contactors with ring cable lug connections
Size S00
Ring terminal lug connec-
tions
3RT2.1, Covers for ring terminal lug connections 3RT2916-4EA13
3RH2 Single covers
3RT2916-4EA13
Size S0
3RT2. 2 Covers for ring terminal lug connections 3RT2926-4EB13
Set for one device,
comprising 4 single covers:
- 2 x 3RT2926-4EB13
3RT2926-4EB13 - 2 x 3RV2928-4AA00
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry* Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/79
You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
3/74 Siemens IC 10 · 2015 Illustrations are approximate
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control Contactors for Switching Motors
relays
Accessories for 3RT2 Contactors
Terminals, covers, adapters, connectors
Terminals, covers, adapters, connectors
3RT1926-4P
3
Contactors and
Assemblies
3RT2.1, Assembly kit for soldering contactors onto a printed cir- 3RT1916-4KA1
3RH21 cuit board.
For 1 contactor, 1 set is required.
3RT1916-4KA1
Solder pin adapters for contactors up to 7.5 HP / 12 A
with mounted 4-pole auxiliary switch block
Size S00, up to 7.5 HP
3RT2.1, Assembly kit for soldering contactors with an auxiliary 3RT1916-4KA2
3RH21 switch block onto a printed circuit board.
For 1 contactor, 1 set is required.
3RT1916-4KA2
Safety main current connectors for 2 contactors
Sizes S00 to S2
For series connection of 2 contactors
3RT2 .1 3RA2916-1A
3RT2. 2 3RA2926-1A
3RT2.3 3RA2936-1A
3RA2926-1A
2
able cross-sections, see technical data of contactors,
page 2/99
Assemblies
Contactors and
S3 3RT20 4 10 AWG (solid), 0 AWG (stranded) / 2.5 to 70 mm2 3RT29 46-4G
S6 3RT1. 5 up to 70 mm2 / 2/0 AWG 3RT19 55-4G 0.23
(3RB205) up to 120 mm2 / 4/0 AWG 3RT19 56-4G 0.26
S10, 3RT1. 6, 240 mm2 - 500 mm2 / 500 MCM - 750 MCM 3RT19 66-4G 0.64
S12 3RT1. 7 with auxiliary conductor connection
(3RB206)
Weight
Design Order No. Package approx.
quantity kg
Insulation stop for securely holding back the conductor insulation
on conductors up to 1 mm2 (17 AWG)
3RT1916-4JA02
Insulation stop strips can be inserted in cable entry of the spring terminal
(2 strips per contactor required)
• For basic devices S00 (3RT201. or 3RH2. ), removable individually 3RT2916-4JA02 20 strips 0.005
• For auxiliary and control circuit on basic devices size S0 and S2 (3RT2.2., 3RT1916-4JA02 20 strips 0.010
3RT2.3.) and for mountable 3RH29 auxiliary switches, removable in pairs
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/81
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA13, 3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies
Accessories
3RT204, S3 1) laterally mountable each with one auxiliary contact 3RA2934-2B 0.05
3RT234, (1 NC) per contactor (can only couple contactors of max.
3RT245 1 level different size. The mounting depth of the smaller
contactor has to be adapted.)
Interlock width: 10 mm
3RA19 54-2G
3RT204 S3 adapter to mechanically interlock a 3RT204 with a 3RT105 3RA1954-2G
to to
3RT105 S6 includes the adapter and QTY 2 - 3RA1942-2G mechanical
connectors
Note:
Fits 3RT104 AC coil versions only.
Does not fit 3RT104 DC coil versions.
3RA19 54-2A
3RT1. 5 S6, laterally mountable without auxiliary contacts; 3RA1954-2A 0.02
to S10, size S6, S10 and S12 contactors
3RT1. 7 S12 can be interlocked with each other as required;
no adaptation of mounting depth is necessary.
Contactor clearance 10 mm.
Baseplates 1 unit
2/82 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA13, 3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies
Accessories
2
3RA2913-2AA1 3RT201 S00 The assembly kit contains:
Mechanical interlock,
Assemblies
Contactors and
2 connecting clips for 2 contactors,
Wiring modules on the top and
bottom
• For main, auxiliary and control 3RA2913-2AA1 3RA2913-2AA2 1 kit
circuits
1) Use of the 3RA2923-2AA1 assembly kit in conjunction with the 2) Version in size S0 with spring-type terminals: Only the 3) Version in size S2 with spring-type terminals in the
3RT202.-.....-3MA0 contactors is limited because the auxiliary wiring modules for the main circuit are included. No con- auxiliary and control circuits: Only the wiring mod-
switches in the basic unit are not allowed to be used on account nectors are included for the auxiliary and control circuit. ules for the main circuit are included. A cable set is
of the permanently mounted auxiliary switch block. included for the auxiliary circuit.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/83
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA13, 3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies
Accessories
Contactor
For gap for Screw Spring Pkg.
contactors Size interlock Version Terminals Terminals qty.
Type Order No. Order No.
Wiring modules
2
Contactor
For gap for Pkg.
contactors Size interlock Interlock Type Version Order No. qty.
Type
Mechanical connectors1)
3RA29. 2-2H 3RT201 S00- 0 mm Laterally For 3-pole contactors and 3RA2912-2H 1 set
S00 mountable 4-pole contactors
3RA1942-2G 3RT1. 5 S6- 10 mm Laterally Top (with phase reversal, 3RA1932-2D 10 sets
S6 mountable for connection without box
terminal)
Note: Standard package quantities may change. 1) 1 set for 1 contactor. Size S00 & S0: 1 set includes 2 connectors
Check Industry Mall for current package quantities. and 1 interlock. Size S2: The mechanical interlock must be
ordered separately. S3-S6: 1 set includes 2 connectors; one
connector for top and one connector for bottom.
2/84 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
WYE-delta accessories
Accessories
Design Sizes Order No. Weight
approx.
kg
Installation kits 1) 2)
The installation kit contains:
Mechanical interlock, 4 connecting clips, S00-S00-S00 3RA2913-2BB1 1 set 0.05
2
WYE jumper, Wiring connectors on the top and
bottom,- For main, auxiliary, and control circuits 3)
Assemblies
Contactors and
The installation kit contains:
mechanical interlock, 4 connecting clips, S0-S0-S0 3RA2923-2BB1 1 set 0.10
WYE jumper, wiring connectors on the top
3RA19 53-2B 1 set
and bottom - For main, auxiliary, and S2-S2-S0 3RA2933-2C 0.16
control circuits 3) S2-S2-S2 3RA2933-2BB1 0.16
1) Size S00, S0 and S2 installation kits for paralleling are available in spring-type terminals. 3) Also requires quantity (1) 3RA2816-0EW20 function module set for all control functions.
Change the last digit of the order number to a “2”. See page 2/47.
2) When using the function modules for wye-delta starting, the wiring modules for the 4) The 3RT19 56-4EA1 (S6) or 3RT19 66-4EA1 (S10, S12) cover can be used for
auxiliary current are not required. See page 2/47 for more information. shock-hazard protection.
Overview Benefits
• Can be mounted directly on 3RT2 contactors and
3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies, in other words,
there is no need for additional wiring in the main circuit
• Optimally coordinated with the technical characteristics of the
3RT2 contactors
2
10
The basic versions with two-phase apparent current monitoring,
a CO contact output and analog adjustability provide a high
level of monitoring reliability especially in the rated and overload
range.
Standard versions
The standard versions monitor the current in three phases with
selectable active current monitoring. They have additional diag-
nostics options such as residual current monitoring and phase
sequence monitoring, and they are also suitable for monitoring
motors below the rated torque. These devices have an addi-
tional independent semiconductor output, an actual value indi-
cator, and are digitally adjustable.
Both versions are available optionally with screw or spring-type
terminals, in each case for sizes S00 and S0. With variants of
size S2 the main current paths always have screw terminals;
the control current side can have screw or spring-type terminals.
Note:
In addition to the features of the standard versions, 3RR24
monitoring relays for mounting onto 3RT2 contactors for IO-Link
also offer the possibility of transmitting the measured values and
diagnostics data to a controller via an IO-Link. Furthermore,
the devices can be parameterized on the devices themselves or
via IO-Link.
Technical specifications
Function charts of 3RR214.-.A.30 basic variants, analog dial adjustable
Closed-circuit principle upon application of the control supply voltage
2
B1-B2
Assemblies
Contactors and
B1-B2
> 1~ = 0
> < 1~ = 0
Hysteresis 6,25 % ▲
Hysteresis 6,25 %
Hyst. 6,25 %
▼
2~ = 0
2~ = 0
NSB0_02050
NSB0_02048
31/34 31/34
31/32 31/32
FAULT FAULT
LED LED
OFF FLASH OFF FLASH OFF FLASH ON OFF FLASH OFF O F F FLASH O N FLASH O F F FLASH ON OFF FLASH ON O F F FLASH O F F
slow slow slow fast slow slow slow slow fast
Current undershoot
B1-B2
< 1~ = 0
Hysteresis 6,25 %
▼
10
2~ = 0
NSB0_02049
31/34
31/32
FAULT
LED O F F FLASH O N FLASH O F F FLASH ON OFF FLASH O F F
slow slow slow fast
Circuit diagrams
B1 / AC/DC 31 B1 / AC/DC 31
Note:
It is not necessary to protect the measuring circuit for device
protection. The protective device for line protection depends
on the cross-section used.
B1-B2
> >n x B1-B2
Contactors and
Assemblies
3~ = 0
3~ = 0
31/34
31/34 31/32
NSB0_02053
31/32 Q on
NSB0_02051
Q on Q off
Q off
onDel onDel Del RsDel Del RsDel
onDel onDel Del RsDel RsDel
B1-B2
B1-B2
> 1+ 2+ 3 ≥
Hysteresis
▼, !▼ L3- L 2- L1
3~ = 0 3~ = 0
31/34 31/34
10
31/32 31/32
NSB0_02052
NSB0_02054
Q on
Q on
Q off
Q off
onDel onDel Del RsDel
Circuit diagrams
B1 / AC/DC 31 B1 / AC/DC 31
Note:
It is not necessary to protect the measuring circuit for device
protection. The protective device for line protection depends
on the cross-section used.
2
• Auto or Manual RESET
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RR2141-1AW30 3RR2142-1AW30 3RR2241-1FW30 3RR2242-1FW30 3RR2141-2AA30 3RR2243-3FW30
Size Measuring range Hysteresis Control supply voltage Us Screw terminals Spring-type
terminals
Standard versions
• Digitally adjustable
• LC display
10
• Open or closed-circuit principle
• 1 CO contact
• 1 semiconductor output
• 3-phase current monitoring
• Active current or apparent current monitoring
• Phase sequence monitoring
• Residual current monitoring
• Blocking current monitoring
• Reclosing delay time 0 ... 300 min
• Start-up delay 0 ... 99 s
• Separate settings for warning and alarm thresholds
S00 1.6 ... 16 0.1 ... 3 24 AC/DC 3RR2241-1FA30 3RR2241-2FA30
24 ... 240 AC/DC 3RR2241-1FW30 3RR2241-2FW30
Overview
• Rapid parameterization of the same devices by duplication of
the parameterization in the controller
• Parameter transmission by upload to a controller by IO-Link
call or by parameter server (if IO-Link master from IO-Link
Specification V 1.1 and higher is used)
2
10
values are available, whereas the output relays can also be used
the conventional SIRIUS 3RR2 monitoring relays:
for the disconnection of the system if limit values that cannot be
• Measured value transmission to a controller, including resolu- reached during operation are exceeded.
tion and unit, may be parameterizable as to which value is
cyclically transmitted For further information on the IO-Link communication system,
see Chapter 14.
• Transmission of alarm flags to a controller
• Full diagnosis capability by inquiry as to the cause of the fault
in the diagnosis data record
• Remote parameterization is also possible, in addition to or
instead of local parameterization
Benefits Application
• Can be mounted directly on 3RT2 contactors and • Monitoring of current overshoot and undershoot
3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies, in other words, • Monitoring of broken conductors
there is no need for additional wiring in the main circuit
• Monitoring of no-load operation and load shedding, e.g. in the
• Optimally coordinated with the technical characteristics of the event of a torn V-belt or no-load operation of a pump
3RT2 contactors
• Monitoring of overload, e.g. on pumps due to a dirty filter
2
• No separate current transformer required system
• Variably adjustable to overshoot, undershoot or range • Monitoring the functionality of electrical loads such as heaters
monitoring
Assemblies
Contactors and
• Monitoring of wrong phase sequence on mobile equipment
• Freely configurable delay times and RESET response such as compressors or cranes
• Display of ACTUAL value and status messages • Monitoring of high-impedance faults to ground, e.g. caused
• All versions with removable control current terminals by damaged insulation or moisture
• All versions with screw or spring-type terminals The use of SIRIUS monitoring relays for IO-Link is particularly
• Simple determination of the threshold values through direct recommended for machines and plant in which these relays,
reference to actually measured values for setpoint loading in addition to their monitoring function, are to be connected
• Range monitoring and selectable active current measurement to the automation level for the rapid, simple and fault-free
mean that only one device for monitoring a motor is required provision of the current measured values and/or for remote
along the entire torque curve parameterization.
• In addition to current monitoring it is also possible to monitor The monitoring relays can either relieve the controller of monitor-
for current unbalance, broken cables, phase failure, ing tasks or, as a second monitoring entity in parallel to and
phase sequence, residual current and motor blocking independent of the controller, increase the reliability in the
process or in the system. In addition, the elimination of AI and
• Integrated counter for operating cycles and operating hours to IO modules allows the width of the controller to be reduced
support requirements-based maintenance of the monitored despite significantly expanded functionality.
machine or application
• Simple cyclical transmission of the current measured values,
relay switching states and events to a controller
• Remote parameterization
• Automatic reparameterizing when devices are exchanged
• Simple duplication of identical or similar parameterizations
• Reduction of control current wiring
• Elimination of testing costs and wiring errors
• Reduction of configuration work
• Integration in TIA means clear diagnostics if a fault occurs
• Cost saving and space saving in control cabinet due to the
elimination of AI and IO modules as well as analog signal
converters and duplicated sensors
10
Technical specifications
Function charts of 3RR24 for IO-Link, digitally adjustable
With the closed-circuit principle selected upon application of the control supply voltage
L+/L-
Contactors and
Assemblies
▲, !▲ Hyst.
Hysteresis ▼, !▼
3~ = 0
3~ = 0
31/34
31/34 31/32
IC01_00186
31/32 Q on
IC01_00185
Q on Q off
Q off
onDel onDel ▲Del RsDel ▼Del RsDel
onDel onDel ▲Del RsDel RsDel
L+/L-
>
L+/L-
1+ 2+ 3 ≥
Hysteresis
▼, !▼
L3-L2-L1
3~ = 0
10
3~ = 0
31/34 31/34
31/32 31/32
IC01_00187
IC01_00188
Q on
Q on
Q off
Q off
onDel onDel ▼Del RsDel
Circuit diagrams
L+ C/Q L- 31 L+ C/Q L- 31
IO-Link IO-Link
2
• Auto or Manual RESET
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RR2441-1AA40 3RR2442-1AA40 3RR2441-2AA40 3RR2442-2AA40 3RR2443-1AA40 3RR2443-3AA40
Size Measuring range Hysteresis Control supply voltage Us Screw terminals Spring-type
terminals
Order No. Order No.
A A V
• Digitally adjustable
• LC display
• Open or closed-circuit principle
• 1 CO contact
• 1 semiconductor output (in SIO mode)
• 3-phase current monitoring
• Active current or apparent current monitoring
• Current unbalance monitoring
• Phase sequence monitoring
• Residual current monitoring
• Blocking current monitoring
• Operating hours counter
• Operating cycles counter
• Reclosing delay time 0 ... 300 min
• Start-up delay 0 ... 999.9 s
• Separate settings for warning and alarm thresholds
S00 1.6 ... 16 0.1 ... 3 24 DC 3RR2441-1AA40 3RR2441-2AA40
Accessories
For 3RR21, For separate mounting of the overload relays Screw terminals
3RR22, or monitoring relays; screw and snap-on mounting
3RR24 onto TH 35 standard mounting rail according to
Contactors and
Assemblies
IEC 60715
• Screw connection S00 3RU2916-3AA01 1 unit
S0 3RU2926-3AA01 1 unit
S2 3RU2936-3AA01 1 unit
3RU2916-3AA01
Spring-type
terminals
• Spring-type connection S00 3RU2916-3AC01 1 unit
S0 3RU2926-3AC01 1 unit
3RU2926-3AC01
Blank labels
For 3RR21, Unit labeling plates2)
3RR22, For SIRIUS devices
3RR24
20 mm x 7 mm, titanium gray 3RT2900-1SB20 340 units
IC01_00181
3RT2900-1SB20
Sealable covers
For 3RR21, Sealable covers 3RR2940 5 units
3RR22, For securing against unintentional or unauthorized
3RR24 adjustment of settings
3RA2908-1A
1)
The accessories are identical to those of the 3RU21 thermal overload
relays and the 3RB3 electronic overload relays, see Chapter 3
"Overload Relays".
2)
PC labeling system for individual inscription
of unit labeling plates available from:
Systems, Inc.
www.murrplastic.com
2/94 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
10/84 Siemens IC 10 · 2015 Illustrations are approximate
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
NEMA 1 Enclosure
2
* Starters with thermal overload relays
* Starters with solid-state overload relays
Assemblies
Contactors and
Application
The 49EC14*B separate enclosures are designed for field assembly of a wide range of Siemens
SIRIUS open style control components and field modification kits as listed in the charts below. 49EC14EB110705R
Note that certain components require the addition of a DIN Rail kit for proper mounting in the enclosure.
NEMA 1 Enclosures
Max. current Contactor Max. current Overload relay Required DIN rail kit NEMA 1 Enclosure
A Non-reversing Reversing A Thermal Solid-state Order No. Order No.
16 3RT201 3RA231 16 3RU2116 3RB3016 MTR5 49EC14EB110705R
38 3RT202 3RA232 40 3RU2126 3RB3026 MTR5
50 3RT203 50 3RU2136 3RB3036 — 49EC14GB140807R
12 3RA231 12 3RU2116 3RB3016 MTR5
25 3RA232 25 3RU2126 3RB3036 MTR5
50 3RA233 50 3RU2136 3RB3036 —
95 3RT204 100 3RU2146 3RB3046 — 49EC14IB201208R
95 3RA234 100 3RU2146 3RB3046 —
Product Category: NEMA Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/95
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories and Spare Parts
3RT
For Contactors
3RT2, 3RH2 Contactors and Contactor Relays
Spare parts for 3RT2 contactors
Spare parts for 3RT2 contactors
3RT29 24-5A . 01
For contactors Rated control supply voltage Us Order No. Weight
approx.
Size Type 50 Hz 50/60 Hz 60 Hz
V V V kg
Solenoid coils • AC operation
S0 3RT20 23, 24 -- -- 3RT29 24-5AB01 0.100
3RT20 24, 42 -- -- 3RT29 24-5AD01 0.100
3RT20 25 48 -- -- 3RT29 24-5AH01 0.100
110 -- -- 3RT29 24-5AF01 0.100
230 -- -- 3RT29 24-5AP01 0.100
400 -- -- 3RT29 24-5AV01 0.100
-- 24 -- 3RT29 24-5AC21 0.100
-- 42 -- 3RT29 24-5AD21 0.100
-- 48 -- 3RT29 24-5AH21 0.100
-- 110 -- 3RT29 24-5AG21 0.100
-- 220 -- 3RT29 24-5AN21 0.100
-- 230 -- 3RT29 24-5AL21 0.100
110 -- 120 3RT29 24-5AK61 0.100
220 -- 240 3RT29 24-5AP61 0.100
-- 100 110 3RT29 24-5AG61 0.100
-- 200 220 3RT29 24-5AN61 0.100
-- 400 440 3RT29 24-5AR61 0.100
S0 3RT20 26 , 24 -- -- 3RT29 26-5AB01 0.100
3RT20 27, 42 -- -- 3RT29 26-5AD01 0.100
3RT20 28 48 -- -- 3RT29 26-5AH01 0.100
3RT23 2 5, 110 -- -- 3RT29 26-5AF01 0.100
3RT23 26, 230 -- -- 3RT29 26-5AP01 0.100
3RT23 27
400 -- -- 3RT29 26-5AV01 0.100
3RT25 2 6
-- 24 -- 3RT29 26-5AC21 0.100
-- 42 -- 3RT29 26-5AD21 0.100
-- 48 -- 3RT29 26-5AH21 0.100
-- 110 -- 3RT29 26-5AG21 0.100
-- 208 -- 3RT29 26-5AM21 0.100
-- 220 -- 3RT29 26-5AN21 0.100
-- 230 -- 3RT29 26-5AL21 0.100
110 -- 120 3RT29 26-5AK61 0.100
220 -- 240 3RT29 26-5AP61 0.100
-- 100 110 3RT29 26-5AG61 0.100
-- 200 220 3RT29 26-5AN61 0.100
-- 400 440 3RT29 26-5AR61 0.100
500 -- 3RT29 26-5AQ21 0.100
277 3RT29 26-5AU61 0.100
480 3RT29 26-5AV61 0.100
600 3RT29 26-5AT61 0.100
Note:
Contactors with AC and AC/DC coils have different depths.
It is only possible to replace the coils on AC contactors with
AC coils, and on AC/DC contactors with AC/DC coils. It is not
possible to replace the coils on DC contactors in the S0 frame.
2/96 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3/110 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2016
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Accessories
Contactor and Sparefor
Assemblies Parts for SIRIUS 3RT
Switching Contactors and SIRIUS 3RH2 Contactor Relays
Motors
Spare Parts
Spare parts for 3RT2 contactors
Solenoid coils
Screw terminals and spring-type terminals
2
3
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT2934-5A. 01 3RT2934-5N. 31
For contactors Rated control supply voltage Us SD Article No. Price PU PS* PG
50 Hz 50/60 Hz 60 Hz DC per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
Type V V V d
Solenoid coils · AC operation
Size S2
3RT203. -.A, 24 -- -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AB01 1 1 unit 41B
3RT233. -.A, 42 -- -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AD01 1 1 unit 41B
3RT253. -.A 48 -- -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AH01 1 1 unit 41B
110 -- -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AF01 1 1 unit 41B
230 -- -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AP01 1 1 unit 41B
400 -- -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AV01 1 1 unit 41B
-- 24 -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AC21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 42 -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AD21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 48 -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AH21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 110 -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AG21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 220 -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AN21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 230 -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AL21 1 1 unit 41B
110 -- 120 -- 5 3RT2934-5AK61 1 1 unit 41B
220 -- 240 -- 5 3RT2934-5AP61 1 1 unit 41B
-- -- 480 -- 5 3RT2934-5AV61 1 1 unit 41B
-- -- 600 -- 5 3RT2934-5AT61 1 1 unit 41B
-- 100 110 -- 5 3RT2934-5AG61 1 1 unit 41B
-- 200 220 -- 5 3RT2934-5AN61 1 1 unit 41B
-- 400 440 -- 5 3RT2934-5AR61 1 1 unit 41B
Size S3
3RT2.4.-. A 24 -- -- -- X 3RT2944-5AB01 1 1 unit 41B
42 -- -- -- X 3RT2944-5AD01 1 1 unit 41B
48 -- -- -- X 3RT2944-5AH01 1 1 unit 41B
110 -- -- -- X 3RT2944-5AF01 1 1 unit 41B
230 -- -- -- X 3RT2944-5AP01 1 1 unit 41B
400 -- -- -- X 3RT2944-5AV01 1 1 unit 41B
-- 24 -- -- X 3RT2944-5AC21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 42 -- -- X 3RT2944-5AD21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 48 -- -- X 3RT2944-5AH21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 110 -- -- X 3RT2944-5AG21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 220 -- -- X 3RT2944-5AN21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 230 -- -- X 3RT2944-5AL21 1 1 unit 41B
110 -- 120 -- X 3RT2944-5AK61 1 1 unit 41B
220 -- 240 -- X 3RT2944-5AP61 1 1 unit 41B
-- -- 480 -- X 3RT2944-5AV61 1 1 unit 41B
-- -- 600 -- X 3RT2944-5AT61 1 1 unit 41B
-- 100 110 -- X 3RT2944-5AG61 1 1 unit 41B
-- 200 220 -- X 3RT2944-5AN61 1 1 unit 41B
-- 400 440 -- X 3RT2944-5AR61 1 1 unit 41B
Solenoid coils · AC/DC operation, with varistor
Size S2
3RT203. -.A, -- 20 ... 33 -- 20 ... 33 5 3RT2934-5NB31 1 1 unit 41B
3RT233. -.A, -- 30 ... 42 -- 30 ... 42 5 3RT2934-5ND31 1 1 unit 41B
3RT253. -.A -- 48 ... 80 -- 48 ... 80 5 3RT2934-5NE31 1 1 unit 41B
-- 83 ... 155 -- 83 ... 155 5 3RT2934-5NF31 1 1 unit 41B
-- 175 ... 280 -- 175 ... 280 5 3RT2934-5NP31 1 1 unit 41B
Size S3
3RT2.4.-. A -- 20 ... 33 -- 20 ... 33 X 3RT2944-5NB31 1 1 unit 41B
-- 30 ... 42 -- 30 ... 42 X 3RT2944-5ND31 1 1 unit 41B
-- 48 ... 80 -- 48 ... 80 X 3RT2944-5NE31 1 1 unit 41B
-- 83 ... 155 -- 83 ... 155 X 3RT2944-5NF31 1 1 unit 41B
-- 175 ... 280 -- 175 ... 280 X 3RT2944-5NP31 1 1 unit 41B
Note:
It is only possible to replace the coils on AC contactors with AC coils, and on AC/DC contactors with AC/DC coils.
For contactor Rated control supply Screw connection Spring-type connection Weight
voltage Us approx.
Order No. Order No.
Size
2
Type kg
Coils · AC operation
Contactors and
Assemblies
For contactor Rated control supply Screw connection Spring-type connection Weight
voltage Us approx.
Order No. Order No.
Size
2
Type kg
Coils · AC operation
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT19 44-5A . 01 S3 3RT10 44 24 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 44-5AB01 3RT19 44-5AB02 0.130
42 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 44-5AD01 3RT19 44-5AD02
48 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 44-5AH01 3RT19 44-5AH02
110 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 44-5AF01 3RT19 44-5AF02
230 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 44-5AP01 3RT19 44-5AP02
400 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 44-5AV01 3RT19 44-5AV02
24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AC21 3RT19 44-5AC22
42 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AD21 3RT19 44-5AD22
48 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AH21 3RT19 44-5AH22
110 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AG21 3RT19 44-5AG22
208 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AM21 3RT19 44-5AM22
220 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AN21 3RT19 44-5AN22
230 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AL21 3RT19 44-5AL22
110 V, 50 Hz/120 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AK61 3RT19 44-5AK62
220 V, 50 Hz/240 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AP61 3RT19 44-5AP62
277 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AU61 3RT19 44-5AU62
480 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AV61 3RT19 44-5AV62
600 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AT61 3RT19 44-5AT62
100 V, 50/60 Hz/110 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AG61 3RT19 44-5AG62
3RT19 45-5A . 01 200 V, 50/60 Hz/220 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AN61 3RT19 44-5AN62
400 V, 50/60 Hz/440 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AR61 3RT19 44-5AR62
3RT10 45, 24 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 45-5AB01 3RT19 45-5AB02 0.130
3RT10 46, 42 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 45-5AD01 3RT19 45-5AD02
3RT13 4 ., 48 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 45-5AH01 3RT19 45-5AH02
3RT14 46 110 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 45-5AF01 3RT19 45-5AF02
230 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 45-5AP01 3RT19 45-5AP02
400 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 45-5AV01 3RT19 45-5AV02
24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AC21 3RT19 45-5AC22
42 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AD21 3RT19 45-5AD22
48 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AH21 3RT19 45-5AH22
110 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AG21 3RT19 45-5AG22
208 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AM21 3RT19 45-5AM22
220 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AN21 3RT19 45-5AN22
230 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AL21 3RT19 45-5AL22
3RT19 45-5AP02
110 V, 50 Hz/120 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AK61 3RT19 45-5AK62
220 V, 50 Hz/240 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AP61 3RT19 45-5AP62
277 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AU61 3RT19 45-5AU62
480 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AV61 3RT19 45-5AV62
600 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AT61 3RT19 45-5AT62
100 V, 50/60 Hz/110 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AG61 3RT19 45-5AG62
200 V, 50/60 Hz/220 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AN61 3RT19 45-5AN62
400 V, 50/60 Hz/440 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AR61 3RT19 45-5AR62
Coils · DC operation
3RT19 44-5BM42 S2 3RT10 3 ., 24 V 3RT19 34-5BB41 3RT19 34-5BB42 0.558
3RT13 3 ., 42 V 3RT19 34-5BD41 3RT19 34-5BD42
3RT15 3 . 48 V 3RT19 34-5BW41 3RT19 34-5BW42
60 V 3RT19 34-5BE41 3RT19 34-5BE42
110 V 3RT19 34-5BF41 3RT19 34-5BF42
125 V 3RT19 34-5BG41 3RT19 34-5BG42
220 V 3RT19 34-5BM41 3RT19 34-5BM42
230 V 3RT19 34-5BP41 3RT19 34-5BP42
S3 3RT10 4 ., 24 V 3RT19 44-5BB41 3RT19 44-5BB42 0.916
3RT13 4 ., 42 V 3RT19 44-5BD41 3RT19 44-5BD42
3RT14 4 . 48 V 3RT19 44-5BW41 3RT19 44-5BW42
60 V 3RT19 44-5BE41 3RT19 44-5BE42
110 V 3RT19 44-5BF41 3RT19 44-5BF42
125 V 3RT19 44-5BG41 3RT19 44-5BG42
220 V 3RT19 44-5BM41 3RT19 44-5BM42
230 V 3RT19 44-5BP41 3RT19 44-5BP42
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/99
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
Spare parts for 3RT1 contactors
2/100 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
Spare parts for 3RT1 contactors
2
S2 3RT20 3 . For AC coil contactors only 3RT29 36-7A 1 unit
3RT20 3 . For UC (AC/DC) coil contactors only 3RT29 36-7B
Assemblies
Contactors and
S3 3RT10 4 ., 3RT19 46-7A
3RT14 46
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/101
Discount Code: Replacement Parts
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
3TB World Series Contactors
3T Contactors
Rated
Rated control
control supply
supply voltages
voltages for coils
for coils
Rated control supply voltages (changes to 10th and 11th positions of the Order No.)
AC operation
2
Coils for 50 Hz
50 Hz 60 Hz
Contactors and
Assemblies
AC 24 V AC 39 V B0 –
AC 32 V AC 28 V – –
AC 36 V AC 42 V G0 –
AC 42 V AC 50 V D0 –
AC 48 V AC 58 V H0 –
AC 60 V AC 72 V E0 –
AC 110 V AC 132 V F0 –
AC 125/127 V AC 150/152 V L0 –
AC 230/220 V AC 277 V P0 1) –
AC 240 V AC 288 V U0 –
AC 400/380 V AC 480/460 V V0 1) –
AC 415 V AC 500 V R0 –
AC 500 V AC 600 V S0 –
Coils for 50/60 Hz
AC 110 V ... 132 V – F7
AC 200 V ... 240 V – M7
AC 230 V ... 277 V – P7 2)
AC 380 V ... 460 V – Q7
AC 500 V ... 600 V – S7
Rated control supply voltages (changes to 10th and 11th positions of the Order No.)
DC operation
DC 24 V B4 B4
DC 30 V C4 –
DC 36 V V4 –
DC 42 V D4 –
DC 48 V W4 –
DC 60 V E4 –
DC 110 V F4 F4
DC 125 V G4 G4
DC 180 V K4 –
DC 220 V M4 M4
DC 230 V P4 P4
Due to the mature nature of some product series, supply cannot be guaranteed on all versions listed on this page.
1) Coil voltage tolerance at 220 V or 380 V: 2) Lower tolerance range limit at 220 V:
0.85 to 1.15 x Us; 0.85 x Us acc. to IEC 60 947.
lower tolerance range limit acc. to
IEC 60 947.
2/102 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3TB World Series Contactors
Spare parts
Coils, AC1)
Catalog No
Frame
Size 24V AC 120V AC 208V AC 220/240V AC 277V AC 480V AC 600V AC
3TB40–44 3TY7403-0AC2 3TY7403-0AK6 3TY7403-0AM1 3TY7403-0AP6 3TY7403-0AU1 3TY7403-0AV0 3TY7403-0AS0
3TB47–48 3TY6483-0AC1 3TY6483-0AK6 3TY6483-0AM1 3TY6483-0AP6 3TY6483-0AP0 3TY6483-0AV0 3TY6483-0AS0
3TB52 — 3TY6523-0AK6 3TY6523-0AM1 3TY6523-0AP6 3TY6523-0AP0 3TY6523-0AV0 —
3TB56 — — — — 3TY6566-0AP0 3TY6566-0AV0 3TY6566-0AS0
2Assemblies
Contactors and
3 TY 6 4 6 3 - 0A K 6
Coils, DC
Catalog No
Frame
Size 12V DC 24V DC 42V DC 48V DC 110V DC 125V DC 240V DC
3TB40–43 3TY4803-0BA4 3TY4803-0BB4 3TY4803-0BD4 3TY4803-0BW4 3TY4803-0BF4 3TY4803-0BG4 3TY4803-0BQ4
3TB44 3TY6443-0BA4 3TY6443-0BB4 3TY6443-0BD4 3TY6443-0BW4 3TY6443-0BF4 3TY6443-0BG4 3TY6443-0BQ4
3TB46 — — 3TY6463-0BD4 3TY6463-0BW4 3TY6463-0BF4 — 3TY6463-0BQ4
3TB47–48 — 3TY6483-0BB4 3TY6483-0BD4 3TY6483-0BW4 3TY6483-0BF4 3TY6483-0BG4 —
3TB50 — 3TY6503-0BB4 3TY6503-0BD4 3TY6503-0BW4 3TY6503-0BF4 3TY6503-0BG4 3TY6503-0BQ4
3TB52 — 3TY6523-0BB4 3TY6523-0BD4 — 3TY6523-0BF4 3TY6523-0BG4 —
3T Y 6 4 8 3 - 0BB 4 3TB54 — 3TY6543-0BB4 3TY6543-0BD4 3TY6543-0BW4 3TY6543-0BF4 — 3TY6543-0BQ4
3TB56 — 3TY6563-0BB4 3TY6563-0BD4 — 3TY6563-0BF4 3TY6563-0BG4 3TY6563-0BQ4
3TB58 — — — — — — — obsolete
1)Some old 3TB coil catalog numbers have been superceded. Cross to current catalog number from these tables.
2)Main contact kits for size 3TB47 and larger include springs. Smaller sizes do not.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/103
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3TF World Series Contactors
Spare parts
3 TY 7 4 0 3 - 0AK 6 3TF44–45
3TF46–47 3TY7463-0AC2 3TY7463-0AK6 3TY7463-0AM1 3TY7463-0AP6 3TY7463-0AU1 3TY7463-0AV0 3TY7463-0AS0
3TF48–49 3TY7483-0AC2 3TY7483-0AK6 3TY7483-0AM1 3TY7483-0AP6 3TY7483-0AU1 3TY7483-0AV0 3TY7483-0AS0
Contactors and
Assemblies
Due to the mature nature of some product series, supply cannot be guaranteed on all versions listed on this page.
1) Vacuum bottles with mounting hardware.
2/104 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3TF Contactors and 3TH Control Relays
Spare parts
2
3TF44 to 3TF68 1 1 — — 3 1 2 4 1 Left 3TY7561-1A 3TY7561-1AA00
1 1 — — 2 Right 3TY7561-1B 3TY7561-1AA00
Assemblies
Contactors and
1 — — 1 4 Right 3TY7561-1K 3TY7561-1EA00
3TF46 to 3TF68 1 1 — — 3 Left 3TY7561-1K 3TY7561-1KA00
3T Y 7 5 6 1 - 1A 2nd Aux Contact Block 1 1 — — 4 Right 3TY7561-1L 3TY75611KA00
3TF46 to 3TF68 1 1 — — 3 Left 3TY7561-1U 3TY7561-1UA00
For Electronic Circuits 1 1 — — 4 Right 3TY7561-1V 3TY7561-1UA00
Mechanical Interlocks
Frame
Size Catalog No
3TF44-54 3TX7466-1A
3 T X7 4 6 6 - 1A
Arc Chutes
Frame Frame
Type Size Catalog No List Price $ Size Catalog No
3TB40–43 Not Replaceable 3TB50 3TY6502-0A
3TB44 — 3TB52 3TY6522-0A
3TB 3TB46 — 3TB54 3TY6542-0A
3TB47 — 3TB56 3TY6562-0A
3 T Y6 4 6 2 - 0A 3TB48 3TY6482-0A 3TB58 —
Coils, DC
Catalog No
Frame
Type Size 12V DC 24V DC 42V DC 48V DC 110V DC 125V DC 240V DC
3TH30–33
3TH 3TY4803-0BA4 3TY4803-0BB4 3TY4803-0BD4 3TY4803-0BW4 3TY4803-0BF4 3TY4803-0BG4 3TY4803-0BQ4
3TH40–43
Coils, DC
Catalog No List
Frame
Type Size 12V AC 24V AC 42V AC 48V AC 110V AC 125V AC 240V AC Price $
3TH 3TH80–83 3TY4803-0BA4 3TY4803-0BB4 3TY4803-0BD4 3TY4803-0BW4 3TY4803-0BF4 3TY4803-0BG4 3TY4803-0BQ4
Due to the mature nature of some product series, supply cannot be guaranteed on all versions listed on this page.
1) Maximum 4 blocks per relay.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/105
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT contactors, 3-pole, sizes S00 to S3
DIN VDE 0106 Part 100. Ident. No. 10E Ident. No. 01
The 3RT contactors are avail- The 3RT contactors can be
able screw, spring-type, or retrofitted with RC elements,
varistors, diodes or diode Aux. switch blocks, Aux. switch blocks,
ring lug connections. assemblies (combination of an EN 50012, EN 50005,
An auxiliary contact is inte- interference suppression diode 4, 3 or 1 contacts 4 or 2 contacts
grated in the basic unit of size and a Zener diode for short trip-
S00 contactors. The basic units ping times) for suppressing
of sizes S0 to S3 only contain opening surges in the coil.
the main conducting paths.
The surge suppressors are
All the basic units can be plugged onto the front of size
extended with auxiliary switch S00 contactors. Space is pro-
blocks. Cabinet units with 2 NO Ident. No. 32E, Ident. No. 40, 31,
vided for them next to a snap-
+ 2 NC (terminal designations on auxiliary switch block. 23E, 22E, 11E 22, 20, 11, 02, 03, 04
acc. to EN 50 012) are avail-
able as of size S0; the auxiliary With all size S0 to S3 contac-
switch block is removable. tors, varistors and RC elements
Contactors, Contactors,
can be plugged on directly at EN 50012 EN 50005,
The size S3 contactors have the coil terminals, either on the 5, 4 or 2 5 or 3
removable box terminals for the top or underneath. Diode aux. contacts aux. contacts
main conductor connections. assemblies are available in two
Ring cable lugs or bars can different designs with different
thus also be connected. polarities. Depending on the
application, they can be
attached either only on the bot- NSB0_02062a
Contact reliability tom (assembly with circuit-
breaker) or only on the top
If voltages ≤ 110 V and currents Ident. No. 32E, Ident. No. 40, 31,
(assembly with overload relay).
≤ 100 mA are to be switched, 23E, 22E, 11E 22, 20, 11, 02, 03, 04
the auxiliary contacts of 3RT The plug-in direction of the
contactors and 3RH contac- diodes and diode assemblies is
tor relays should be used to determined by a coding with identification numbers
Auxiliary switch blocks
ensure good contact stability. device. Exceptions: 40 to 02. The identification
3RT29 26-1E.00 and The 3RT basic units can be numbers on the auxiliary switch
These auxiliary contacts are blocks apply only to the
3RT19 36-1T.00; in these cases extended with various auxiliary
suitable for electronic circuits attached auxiliary contacts.
the plug-in direction is identi- switch blocks, depending on
with currents ≥ 1 mA at a volt-
fied by "+" and "–". the application: Single or 2-pole auxiliary switch
age of 17 V.
Coupling relays are supplied Size S00 (3RT201) blocks that can be connected
either without surge suppres- on either the top or the bottom
Short-circuit protection of sion or with a varistor or diode Contactors with one NO contact facilitate quick, straightforward
contactors connected as standard, as the auxiliary contact and wiring, especially when assem-
according to the design. with either screw or bling feeders. These auxiliary
For the short-circuit protection spring-type connections, iden- switch blocks are only available
of contactors without an over- tification number 10E, can be with screw-type terminals.
load relay, see the technical Note extended to obtain contactors
data. The opening times of the NO with 2, 4 or 5 auxiliary contacts The solid-state compatible
contacts and the closing times in accordance with EN 50 012 3RH29 11-1NF.. auxiliary switch
For the short-circuit protection using auxiliary switch blocks. blocks for size S00 contactors
of the NC contacts increase if
of contactors with an overload The identification numbers 11E, contain two enclosed contact
the contactor coils are pro-
relay, see section 3. 22E, 23E and 32E on the auxil- elements. They are ideal for
tected against voltage peaks
(interference suppression iary switch blocks apply to the switching low voltages and cur-
diode 6 to 10 times; diode complete contactors. These rents (hard gold-plated con-
assemblies 2 to 6 times; varis- auxiliary switch blocks cannot tacts) or for use in dusty atmo-
tor +2 ms to 5 ms). be combined with contactors sphere. The contacts do not
that have an NC contact in their have positively-driven opera-
basic unit, identification num- tion.
ber 01, as these are coded. All the above-mentioned auxil-
All size S00 contactors with one iary switch variants can be
auxiliary contact, identification snapped into the location holes
number 10E or 01, and the con- on the front of the contactors.
tactors with 4 main contacts The auxiliary switch block has a
can be extended to obtain con- centrally positioned release
tactors with 3 or 5 auxiliary con- lever for disassembly.
tacts (contactors with 4 main
contacts: 2 or 4 auxiliary con-
tacts) according to EN 50 005
using auxiliary switch blocks
3RT20 2. to 3RT20 4. contactors (sizes S0 to S3), 3RT20 2. to 3RT20 4. contactors (sizes S0 to S3),
single-pole auxiliary switch blocks, single-pole auxiliary switch blocks,
terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005 or EN 50 012. terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005 or EN 50 012.
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
1 NC
Sizes S0 to S3 (3RT202 to In addition, 2-pole auxiliary The laterally mountable auxil- Sizes S0 and S2 (3RT202
3RT204) switch blocks (screw-type ter- iary switch blocks to EN 50 012 and 3RT203)
minals) are provided for cable can only be used if no 4-pole
An extensive range of auxiliary Up to four auxiliary contacts can
entries from above or below in auxiliary switch blocks are
switch blocks is available for be mounted, whereby any
the style of a four-connector snapped onto the front. If sin-
various applications. The con- design of the auxiliary switch
block (feeder auxiliary switch). gle-pole auxiliary switch blocks
tactors themselves do not have blocks is permitted. If two 2-
are used in addition, the loca-
an integrated auxiliary conduct- If the available installation pole, laterally mounted, auxil-
tion digits on the contactor
ing path. depth is restricted, 2-pole auxil- iary switch blocks are used, one
must be noted.
iary switch blocks (screw or must be mounted on the left and
The auxiliary switch variants
spring-type connections) can Two enclosed contact ele- one on the right for the sake of
are identical for all size S0 to
be mounted laterally on the left ments and two standard con- symmetry.
S3 contactors.
or right. tact elements are available for
Under certain circumstances,
One 4-pole or up to four single- the 3RH29 21-.FE22 solid-state
The auxiliary switch blocks more auxiliary contacts are
pole auxiliary switch blocks (with compatible auxiliary switch
designed for mounting onto the allowed for size S2 (please ask
screw or spring-type connec- block mountable on the front.
front can be disassembled with for details).
tions) can be snapped onto the The laterally mountable
the aid of a centrally positioned
front of the contactors. When the 3RH29 21-2DE11 solid-state With regard to 3RT23 and
release lever; the laterally
contactors are energized, the compatible auxiliary switch 3RT24 4-pole contactors,
mountable auxiliary switch
NC contacts open before the block contains 2 enclosed con- please refer to pages 2/12 to 2/14.
blocks can be removed easily
NO contacts close. tact elements (1 NO + 1 NC).
by pressing on the fluted grips.
The enclosed contact elements Sizes S3 to S12 (3RT204 to
The terminal designations of the
The terminal designations of are ideal for switching low volt- 3RT107)
single-pole auxiliary switch
the individual auxiliary switch ages and currents (hard gold-
blocks consist of location digits Up to eight auxiliary contacts
blocks comply with EN 50 005 plated contacts) or for use in a
on the basic unit and function can be mounted, whereby the
or EN 50 012, while those of the dusty atmosphere. The con-
digits on the auxiliary switch following points must be noted:
complete contactors with an tacts are positively driven.
blocks. • Of these eight auxiliary con-
auxiliary switch block with 2 NO
+ 2 NC comply with EN 50 012. tacts, no more than four must
be NC contacts.
• If laterally mounted auxiliary
switch blocks are used, they
must be symmetrical.
With regard to 3RT15 4-pole
contactors, please refer
to pages 2/13 to 2/15.
Overview
Design
• 3RT10 contactors for switch- Operating mechanism Withdrawable coils Auxiliary contact complement
ing motors
Two types of solenoid-oper- To allow easy coil changing, for The contactors can be
• 3RT12 vacuum contactors for ated mechanism are available: example if the application is equipped with a maximum of
switching motors changed, the magnetic coil can 8 auxiliary contacts, with iden-
• Conventional operating mech-
2
• 3RT14 contactors for AC-1 anism be pulled out upwards without tical auxiliary switch blocks
applications tools after the release mecha- from S0 to S12. Of these, no
• Solid-state operating mecha- nism has been actuated, and more than 4 are permitted to be
Contactors and
Assemblies
2
relay contact (hard gold- DC 24 V "running"
/≥ 30 mA – PLC
DI0 "ready" 0 plated,
Device not ready/manual
enclosed) and can beoperation DO0 0 Contactor off
PLC output (EN 61 131-2) via – SIMOCODE-DP 3UF5
1 processed
Device ready/automatic
for exampleoperation
via 1 Contactor on
terminals IN+/IN-. via terminals H1/H2.
Assemblies
Contactors and
DI1 "running" 0 SIMOCODE-DP
Contactor off or PLC inputs DO1 0 Contact
– loading:
1 or elsewhere.
Contactor on 1 Us–/approx. 5 mA.
DI2 "remaining lifetime" 0 Permissible current
Remaining lifetime RLTcarrying
> 20 % DO2 0 –
When operated via SIMO-
1 capacity
Remainingoflifetime
relay output
RLT ≤ 20R1/
% 1CODE-DP,
– a communication
DI3 "free input" R2:
0 No input signal at SF1/2 DO3 0link –to PROFIBUS-DP is also
– Ie/AC-15/24 to 230 V: 3 A
1 Input signal at SF1/2 1provided.
–
– Ie/DC-13/24 V: 1 A
Overview
The contactor assemblies for
star-delta starting can be
ordered as follows:
• Sizes S00-S0 as assemblies. (see pages 2/47-2/48)
• Sizes S2-S12 as components for customer assembly
2
Foraccessories,
For accessories,see
see page
page 2/50.
2/85. 1) The installation kit contains mechanical inter- 2) The installation kit contains 5 connecting clips;
Forcircuit
circuitdiagrams,
diagrams, see page 2/162. lock; 3 connecting clips; wiring connectors on wiring connectors on the top (connection
For see page 2/202. the top (connection between line contactor and between line contactor and delta contactor) and
delta contactor) and the bottom (connection the bottom (connection between delta contactor
between delta contactor and star contactor); and WYE contactor); star jumper.
WYE jumper.
2
Overload relay, thermal Overload relay, solid-state
Assemblies
Contactors and
Installation kit B WYE jumper Baseplates Range of Order No. Range of Order No.
for single infeed overload relay, overload relay, overload relay, overload relay,
thermal [A] thermal solid-state [A] solid-state
3) Installation kit contains wiring connector on the 5) A mechanical interlock adapter, 3RA1954-2G, is 6) Only use wiring connector on the top from
bottom (connection between delta contactor required to use the standard 3RA1954-2A reversing contactor assembly (note conductor
and WYE contactor) and WYE jumper. mechanical interlock for the AC version of the cross-sections); order WYE jumper in addition.
4) Wiring connector on top from reversing contac- S6-S6-S3 WYE-Delta starter. The S6-S6-S3 7) For overload relays >100A, see 3RB2 electronic
tor assembly (note conductor cross-sections). WYE-Delta DC version would require a special Section 3, page 23.
custom build spacer, which is not manufactured,
to allow the mechanical interlock to operate.
carry approximately 50 % (class dead interval of approximately must be set to 0.58 times the
KL 16) or 30 % (class KL 10) of Contactors, overload relays,
50 ms on reversing. star-delta time-delay relays and rated motor current.
their rated torque; the starting
For the circuit diagrams for the auxiliary switches for the elec-
Contactors and
Assemblies
1) Exception:
The mechanical interlock between the delta and
WYE contactors is included in the installation kit
for size S00 contactor assemblies.
Contactor Assemblies
3RA24 Contactor for Switching
Assemblies Motors
for Wye-Delta Starting
LV1N_03_05.fm Page 38 Friday, October 18, 2013 3:24 PM
Contactor assemblies for WYE-delta starting Contactor Assemblies for Star-Delta (Wye-Delta) Starting
3RA24 complete units, 5.5 ... 22 kW
3RA23, 3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
Selection and ordering data
3RA24 Contactor Assemblies for Wye-Delta Starting
SIRIUS 3RA24 contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta) starting, up to 90 kW
Fully
Fully wired
wired and
and tested
tested contactor
contactor assembliesfor
assemblies · Size S00-S00-S00
star-delta · Up to
(wye-delta) 11 kW · Size S00-S00-S00 · Up to 11 kW
starting
3RA24
TheThe
figure complete
figure shows
shows thethe units,
version
version 5.5
with
with ... 22terminals
screw
screw kW
terminals
2
Fully wired and tested contactor assemblies · Size S00-S00-S00 · Up to 11 kW
The figure shows the version with screw terminals
Assemblies
Contactors and
9 6
3
3
16
7
6
5
3
1 5
1 2
IC01_00625a
7 2
4 5
4
NSB0_02066a
1 3
7 6 2
6
4
NSB0_02066a
Mountable accessories 8
Fully wired and tested contactor
3 assemblies
Individual parts Order No. Page Individual parts Order No. Page
8 6
Q111) Q132) Q122)
16 Three-phase feeder terminal3) 3RA29 13-3K 4 1 2 3 Contactor, 5.5 kW 3RT20 15 3RT20 15 3RT20 15
Mountable accessories (optional) Complete contactor assembly for star-delta (wye-delta) starting
1 2 3 Contactor, 7.5 kW 3RT20 17 3RT20 17 3RT20 15
To be ordered separately Type Page Individual parts Type Page
Mountable accessories Fully
1 2 wired and tested
3 Contactor, 11 kW contactor assemblies
3RT20 18 3RT20 18 3RT20 16
Q112) Q13 Q12
Individual parts Order No. Page In
4di5vid6ualAssembly
parts kit O rder N13-2BB1
3RA29 o. Page
9 Three-phase infeed terminal1) 3RA2913-3K 3/110 2/85 1 2 3 Contactors, 5.5 kW
comprising 3RT2015 3RT2015 3RT2015 2/8 3/57
3/50,
Q111) Q132) Q122)
1 2 13 2 Contactors, 7.5 kW interlock 3RT2017 3RT2017 3RT2015 3/50,
4 Mechanical 2/8 3/57
16 Three-phase feeder terminal3) 3RA29 13-3K 4 3 Contactor, 5.5 kW 3RT20 15 3RT20 15 3RT20 15
1 2 3 Contactors, 5 4 11 kW
connecting clips 3RT2018 3RT2018 3RT2016 3/50, 2/8 3/57
1 2 3 Contactor, 7.5 kW 3RT20 17 3RT20 17 3RT20 15
4 ... 7 Assembly kit S00-S00-S00
6 Wiring modules on the3RA2913-2BB1
top and bottom 2/85
3/106
3 Contactor, 11 kW
1 2 comprising: 3RT20 18 3RT20 18 3RT20 16
for connecting the main current paths
7 5 46 Assembly
4 Mechanical
Function kitinterlock
modules 3RA29
3RA28 13-2BB1
16-0EW20
comprising
for wye-delta starting
5 Four connecting clips for three contactors
1) Use version with 1 NO. 4 Mechanical interlock
6 Note:
Wiring modules on top and bottom for
2) Use version with 1 NC. 5 4 connecting
connecting clips
the main and auxiliary circuits
7 6
WhenWiring
the function modules for contactor assemblies for wye-
3) Part
16 can only be mounted with contactors with screw terminal. Star jumpermodules on the top and bottom
deltaforstarting are used,
connecting no current
the main other auxiliary
paths switches are allowed
2/29
8 Functionbemodules
toFunction
mounted for star-delta 3RA2816-0EW20
on the basic 3/101
7 (wye-delta) modules
starting 3RA28units.
16-0EW20
for wye-delta starting
1)
1)
PartUse
9 version
can only with
be 1mounted
NO. in the case of contactors with screw terminal. Note:
Complete contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta)
2)
2) TheUse version
version withwith
1 NO1 NC.
is required for momentary-contact operation. starting
When thesee page 3/174.
function modules for contactor assemblies for wye-
3) Part
16 can only be mounted with contactors with screw terminal. delta starting are used, no other auxiliary switches are allowed
to be mounted on the basic units.
9
Fully wired and tested contactor assemblies · Size S0-S0-S06· Up to 22 kW
Contactors and
Assemblies
16
6
17 5
1
1 5 2
7
2
3
IC01_00626a
4
NSB0_02067b
4
5 3
1
6
7
2
6
Mountable accessories Fully wired and 4tested contactor assemblies
Individual parts Order No. Page Individual parts Order No. Page
NSB0_02067b
3 Q11 Q13 Q12
8
16 Three-phase feeder terminal1) 3RV29 25-5AB 3/43 1 2 3 Contactor, 11 kW 3RT20 24 3RT20 24 3/10 3RT20 24
17 Three-phase busbar 1)
3RV19 15-1AB 3/43 1 2 683 Contactors, 15/18.5 kW 3RT20 26 3RT20 26 3/10 3RT20 24
1 2 3 Contactor, 22 kW 3RT20 27 3RT20 27 3RT20 26 3/10
Mountable accessories (optional) Complete 4 5 6contactor
Assembly assembly
kit for star-delta
3RA29 23-2BB1 (wye-delta) starting 3/43
To be ordered separately Type Page Individual partsThe assembly kit contains:Type Page
Mountable accessories Fully wired and tested contactor assemblies
Q11 Q13 Q12
Individual parts Order No. Page Individual par4ts Mechanical interlock Order No. Page
9 Three-phase infeed terminal1) 3RV2925-5AB 2/85 3/110 1 2 3 Contactors, 11 kW
5 Connecting clipsQ11 3RT2024
Q13 3RT2024 3RT2024 2/8
Q12 3/51, 3/61
10 Three-phase
16 busbar1)
Three-phase feeder 3RV29 25-5AB 1/8
terminal1) 3RV1915-1AB 3/110
3/43 1 12 23 3 Contactors,
6 Wiring
Contactor, 15/18.5
11 kW kW on
modules the3RT2026
3RT20 top 3RT2026
24 and3RT20
bottom 3RT2024
24 3RT20 2/8
3/51, 3/61
24 3/10
1 12 23 3 Contactors, for22
connecting
kW the main current paths
3RT2027 3RT2027 3RT2026 2/8
3/51, 3/61
17 Three-phase busbar1) 3RV19 15-1AB 3/43 Contactors, 15/18.5 kW 3RT20 26 3RT20 26 3RT20 24 3/10
4 1... 277 3 Assembly
Function
Contactor,
modules
kit S0-S0-S0 3RA28 16-0EW20
3RA2923-2BB1
22 kWstarting 3RT20 27 3RT20 27 3RT20 26 3/10
3/44
2/85
3/106
for wye-delta
comprising:
4 5 6 Assembly
1) The parts 16 and 17 can only be mounted with contactors with screw kit
Mechanical interlock
3RA29 23-2BB1 3/43
4 Note:
terminal. The Four
assembly kit contains:
connecting clips for three contactors
5 When the function modules for contactor assemblies for wye-
4 Mechanical interlock
Wiring
6 delta modules
starting onused,
are top andnobottom
otherfor
auxiliary switches are allowed
to Connecting
5 connecting
be mounted theclips
main and auxiliary circuits
on the basic units.
7 6 Star
Wiring modules on the top and bottom
jumper
Functionfor modules
connecting the main current
for star- paths
3RA2816-0EW20 2/29
3/101
8
7 Function
delta modules
(wye-delta) starting 3RA28 16-0EW20 3/44
for wye-delta starting
1)
1) The
Theparts and17
parts169 and 10can
canonly
onlybebemounted
mountedwith
withcontactors with
contactors screw
with screw Note:
Complete contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta)
terminal.
terminal, the 6 wiring modules must be removed beforehand. starting
When see page
the function 3/175. for contactor assemblies for wye-
modules
delta starting are used, no other auxiliary switches are allowed
to be mounted on the basic units.
2
33
5
Assemblies
Contactors and
5
11
onents to be ordered separately:
11
6
6
4
4
8
8
IC01_00627a
IC01_00627a
1
1 2
2 3
3
5
5
The connecting leads
are not shown.
9
9 9
9
ory Order No. Page Components Order No. Page
Mountable accessories (optional) Complete contactor K1 assemblyK3 for star-delta
K2 (wye-delta) starting
Mountable
To be orderedaccessories
separately (optional)
Type Page Complete contactor assembly for star-delta
Individual parts
1 2 3 Contactors,
Type (wye-delta) starting Page
chanical interlock, laterally mountable,
th must be adapted To be ordered separately Type Page IndivA,
50/60 idu30
al p
HParts 3RT20 35 3RT20 35 T3RT20
ype 26 Q13
Q11 Q12 Page
1.5 mm; K2: 0 mm 3RA19 24-2B
11 Three-phase infeed terminal 3RV2935-5A 3/110
8 1 2 3 Contactors,
Time-delay relay, 22/30 kW Q11
3RT2035 Q13
3RT2035 Q12
3RT2026 3/53, 3/62
d-state time-delay 11auxiliary switch
Three-phase block,
infeed terminal 3RV2935-5A 3/110 laterally
11 22 mountable
33 Contactors,3RP15
Contactors, 37 kW
22/3074-1N.30
kW 3RT2035 Sec.
3RT2035 11
3RT2035
3RT2035 3RT2027
3RT2026 3/53, 3/62
3/53, 3/62
untable on the front 3RT19 26-2G... 9 Contactors,
11 22 33switch
Auxiliary Contactors, 45 kW
37
block withkW 3RT2036
3RT2035
one unassigned 3RT2036
3RT2035 3RT2028
3RT2027 3/53, 3/62
3/53, 3/62
iliary switch block, NO11contact
22 33 Contactors, 3RH19
Contactors, 55 kW
45 kW21-1CA10 3RT2036
3RT2037 3RT2037
3RT2036 3RT2035
3RT2028 3/53, 3/62
3/53, 3/62
rally mountable 3RH19 21-1EA.. Auxiliary
10 ... 77switch
44 ... blockkit
Assembly
Assembly forS2-S2-S0
kit local control
S2-S2-S2 3RA2933-2BB1
3RA2933-2C 3/106
3/106
ge suppressor 3RT19 26-1.... 2 units comprising:
3RH19 21-1CA01
comprising:
3RT19 36-1.... 3 units Four3RH19
44 Four 21-1CA10
connectors
connectors for three
for three contactors
contactors (not
(not required
required for
for fully
fully pre-
pre-
hase feeder terminal 3RV19 35-5A 11 Baseplate wired
wired contactor
contactor
3RA19 32-2Eassemblies for
assemblies for star-delta
star-delta (wye-delta)
(wye-delta) starting)
starting)
Wiring modules
modules onon top
top and
and bottom
bottom forfor
hase busbar 3RV19 35-1A 6 Installation kit55 Wiring
3RA19 33-2C
connecting the
connecting the main
main and
and auxiliary
auxiliary circuits
circuits
h-in lug 2) for time-delay The installation
6
kitStar
contains
jumper the
S2 WYE jumper on the top
6 Star jumper S2
y for screw mounting 3RP19 03 Sec.11 and the wiring jumper on the bottom for connecting the
Cable for
77 Cable
main conducting paths. for connecting
connecting the
the A2
A2 coil
coil contact
contact from
from the
the line
line contactor
contactor
with the
with the A2
A2 coil
coil contact
contact of
of the
the delta
delta contactor
contactor
(not shown
(not shown in in the
the drawing)
drawing)
88 Mechanical interlock
Mechanical interlock 3RA2934-2B
3RA2934-2B 3/109
3/109
99 Function modules
Function modules for
for star-delta
star-delta 3RA2816-0EW20
3RA2816-0EW20 3/101
3/101
(wye-delta) starting
(wye-delta) starting
10
10 Base plate
Base plate star-delta
star-delta (wye-
(wye- 3RA2932-2F
3RA2932-2F 3/113
3/113
delta)
delta)
1)
Complete contactor assembly for star-delta
1) Not included (wye-delta)
in scope of supply starting in size
of complete Complete
2) Possible contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta)
in principle.
1) S2-S2-S0 (not shown): Thecontactor
3RA2933-2Cassemblies; available
assembly kit is toasbe
accessory.
used here, Ifstarting
a solid-state
seetime-delay auxiliary switch block
page 3/176.
Complete contactor assembly for star-delta (wye-delta) starting in size
see page 3/106. Complete
For overview,
is mountedsee contactor
ontopage ofassemblies
2/112.
the front for star-delta (wye-delta)
K3, an ordinary
S2-S2-S0 (not shown): The 3RA2933-2C assembly kit is to be used here, starting
auxiliary see block
switch page 3/176.
can only be mounted onto
see page 3/106. For circuit diagrams, see page 2/202.
the side.
10
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
3
5
IC01_00627a
1
2
3
9
The connecting leads
9 are not shown.
Mountable accessories (optional) Complete contactor assembly for star-delta (wye-delta) starting
To be ordered separately Type Page Individual parts Type Page
ory Order No. Page Components Order No. Page
K1 K3 Q11
K2 Q13 Q12
chanical interlock, Three-phase24-2B
11lateral3RA19 infeed terminal 3RV2935-5A 3/110
1 2 3 1 2 3 Contactors, 55 kW
Contactors, 3RT2037 3RT2037 3RT2035 3/53, 3/62
d-state time-delay auxiliary switch block, 507HPAssembly3RT20
80 4A,... kit S2-S2-S2
35 3RT20 35 3RA2933-2BB1
3RT20 34 3/106
untable on the front 3RT19 26-2G... comprising:
1 2 3 Contactors,
chanical interlock, 4 Four connectors for three contactors (not required for fully pre-
untable on the front 3RA19 24-1A 86 A, 60 HP wired 3RT20 36 3RT20
contactor 36 3RT20
assemblies 34
for star-delta (wye-delta) starting)
8 Time-delay relay,
5 Wiring modules on top and bottom for
iliary switch block,
ral 3RH19 21-1EA.. lateral 3RP15 74-1N.30
connecting the main and auxiliary circuits
9 Auxiliary switch
6 block with one
Star jumper S2 unassigned
ge suppressor 3RT19 26-1....
3RT19 36-1.... NO contact 7 Cable 3RH19 21-1CA10
for connecting the A2 coil contact from the line contactor
10 with the
Auxiliary switch block forA2 coil control
local contact of the delta contactor
hase feeder terminal 3RV19 35-5A (not shown in the drawing)
2 units 3RH19 21-1CA01
hase busbar 3RV19 35-1A 3 units
8 Mechanical 3RH19 21-1CA10 3RA2934-2B
interlock 3/109
h-in lug 2) for time-delay relay 11 Baseplate
9 3RA19 32-2F
Function modules for star-delta 3RA2816-0EW20 3/101
screw mounting 3RP19 03 (wye-delta) starting
6 Installation kit 3RA19 33-2B
The10installation
Basekitplate star-delta
contains the (wye-
WYE jumper 3RA2932-2F
on top and 3/113
delta)
the wiring jumper on bottom for connecting the main
conducting paths.
10
5
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
11
3
6
2
4
1
3
8
IC01_00628b
5
9
9
The connecting leads
Mountable accessories (optional) Complete contactor assembly for
arestar-delta
not shown. (wye-delta) starting
To be ordered separately Type Page Individual parts Type Page
Q11 Q13 Q12
ory Order No.
11 Single-phase Page 3RA2943-3L
infeed terminal Components
3/110 1 2 3 Order
Contactors, 55 kWNo. 3RT2045 Page
3RT2045 3RT2035 3/54, 3/62
(3 units are required)
1 2 3 Contactors, K175 kW K3 K2
3RT2045 3RT2045 3RT2036 3/54, 3/62
chanical interlock, lateral, 1 2 3 Contactors, Contactors, 90 kW 3RT2046 3RT2046 3RT2037 3/54, 3/62
1 2 3
th must be adapted 1154 A,
0 mm; K2: 27.5 mm 3RA19 24-2B ...75
7 HP
Assembly3RT20 45 3RT20 45 3RA2943-2C
kit S3-S3-S2 3RT20 35 3/106
1 2 3 Contactors, comprising:
d-state time-delay auxilary switch block,
150 A, 100 HP 4 Two3RT20
connectors for three
45 3RT10 45contactors
3RT20 36(not required for fully pre-
untable on the front 3RT19 26-2G... wired contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta) starting)
iliary switch block, lateral3RH19 21-1EA.. 8 Time-delay relay, lateral 3RP15 74-1N.30
5 Wiring modules on top and bottom (S3-S2) for connecting the
ge suppressor 3RT19 . 6-1.... 9 Auxiliary switch block withauxiliary
main and one unassigned
circuits and a cable set for the auxiliary
h-in lug 2) for time-delay relay NO contact 3RH19 21-1CA10
circuit
screw mounting 3RP19 03 10 Auxiliary switch
6 block for local
Star jumper S2 control
2 units 7 Cable3RH19 21-1CA01
for connecting the A2 coil contact from the line contactor
3 units with3RH19 21-1CA10
the A2 coil contact of the delta contactor
11 Baseplate (not 3RA19
shown in the drawing)
42-2E
6 8
Installation Mechanical
kit interlock
3RA19 43-2C 3RA2934-2B 3/109
Function
9 kit contains
The installation themodules
WYE jumperfor star-delta
on the3RA2816-0EW20
top and the wir- 3/101
ing jumper on the bottom(wye-delta) starting the main conducting
for connecting
10 Base plate star-delta (wye- 3RA2942-2F 3/113
1) Not included in scope of supply of the complete
contactor assemblies; available as an accessory. delta)
2) Possible in principle.If a solid-state time-delay aux-
1) Contactor assembly for star-delta
iliary switch block is mountedfor onto the front of K3, Complete
(wye-delta) starting customer assem- For overview,contactor assemblies
see page 2/112. for star-delta (wye-delta)
a standard
bly in size S3-S3-S3 (not shown): auxiliary switchassembly
The 3RA2943-2BB. block cankitonly bebe
is to starting
For circuitsee page see
diagrams, 3/177.
page 2/202.
used here, see page 3/106. mounted onto the side.
They
(VDE are finger-safe according to EN 50274. The devices with
0660) on the device,
ring lug terminal connection comply All with
control relaysofwith
degree 4 con-
protection Control relay, EN no more than four NC contacts are permitted.
50 011,
tacts in accordance with 4 contacts
IP20 when fitted with the related terminal cover.
Contactors and
Assemblies
3
4 contacts
High contact
They are stability
safe from at to
touch low voltages and40currents,
blocks suitable
to 02 to obtain for
control
solid-state circuits
DIN VDE 0106 Part 100. with currents ≥ 1 mA at
relays a voltage
with of 17 V.in
6 or 8 contacts
accordance with EN 50 005.
Surge suppression
The 3RH21 control relays have
The identification numbers on Ident. No. 40E Ident. No. 31E, 22E
screw, spring style or ring lug
RC elements,Four
connections. varistors,
contacts are or the
diodes auxiliary
diode switch blocks
assemblies (combina-
tion of a diode
available in the and Zener diode)apply
basica unit. only
can be to the attached
plugged onto all auxil-
con-
iary switch
tactor relays from the front for damping blocks.
opening surges in the Aux. switch blocks,
Ident. No. 40E Aux. switch blocks,
Ident. No. 31E, 22E
coil. Thereliability
plug-in direction is determined by a coding device. 4 contacts 4 or 2 contacts
Contact
Surge suppression
Note:
High contact stability at low Aux. switch blocks, Aux. switch blocks,
The OFF-delay
voltages of the NO
and currents, contact RC
suitable andelements, varistors,
the ON-delay diodes
of the EN 50 011, EN 50 005,
NC contact are
for electronic increased
circuits or diode coils
with if the contactor assemblies (combina-
are attenuated 4 contacts 4 or 2 contacts
≥ 1 mA at
currents voltage
against a voltage
peaks tion of a diode
of suppression
(noise diodeand
6 toa10
Zener
times;
diode) can be plugged onto all
17 V. assemblies 2 to 6 times, varistor Ident. No. 80E, Ident. No. 40, 31,
diode +2 to 5 ms).
control relays from the front for 71E, 62E, 53E, 44E 22, 20, 11, 02
Auxiliary switch blocks damping opening surges in the
Auxiliary switch blocks coil. The plug-in direction is
The 3RH2 contactor
The 3RH21 relays
control relays cancan bedetermined
expanded by byaup to four
coding Control relay, Ident. No. 80E,
y , Control relay, Ident. No. 40, 31,
contacts
be expanded by the
by addition
up to fourofcon-
snap-on auxiliary switch blocks.
device. EN 50 011 71E, 62E, 53E, 44E
Hilfsschütze
EN 50EN50
005, 005,
tacts by the addition of mount- DIN 22, 20, 11, 02
The auxiliary switch block can easily be snapped onto the front 8 contacts 88oroder
6 contacts
6 Kontakte
able auxiliary switch blocks. Note block has a centrally po-
of the contactors. The auxiliary switch
The auxiliary
sitioned switch
release block
lever for can
disassembly.
The opening times of the NO Contactor relay, Contactor relay,
Hilfsschütze
easily be snapped onto the contacts and the closing times EN 50 011 EN
The
front contactor relays
of the relays. Thewith 4 contacts
auxiliary according to ENincrease
50011,if DIN50EN50
005,005,
of the NC contacts 8 contacts 88oroder
6 contacts
6 Kontakte
with the identification
switch block has a centrally number 40E, can
the be extended
relay with 80E to
coils are protected
44E auxiliary
positioned switch
release blocks
lever to obtain
for dis- contactor
against voltagerelays
peakswith
(sup-
NSB00067
assembly.
8 contacts according to EN 50011.pression The identification
diode 6 to 10 numbers
times, Ident. No. 80E, Ident. No.40, 31,
80E to 44E relays
The control on thewithauxiliary
4 con-switch diode
blocksassemblies
apply to the2 tocomplete
6 times, 71E, 62E, 53E, 44E 22, 20, 11, 02
contactors. These auxiliary
tacts in accordance with switchvaristor
blocks +2
(3RH29
ms to 11–1GA..)
5 ms).
NSB0_02105
cannot
EN 50 011, be combined with contactor relays with identification
with the identifica-
numbers
tion number 31E andcan
40E, 22E;
be they are coded. Ident. No. 80E,
extended with 80E to 44E auxi- 71E, 62E, 53E, 44E
All contactor relays with
liary switch blocks to obtain 4 contacts according to EN 50011, iden-
tification
control relays numbers
with 840E to 22E,
contacts in can be extended with auxiliary
switch
accordance blocks 40EN
with to 02
50 to
011.obtain contactor relays with 6 or 8 con-
tacts in accordance
The identification with EN
numbers 80E50005. The identification numbers
on the auxiliary
to 44E switchswitch
on the auxiliary blocks apply only to the attached auxiliary
switch blocks.
blocks apply to the complete
relays (see illustration along-
Order
side). No. scheme
Digit of the Order No. 1st - 4th 5th 6th 7th 8th 9th 10th 11th 12t 13th 14th 15th 16th
3rd h
3RH24 latched control relays, size S00 @@@ @ @ @ @ – @ @ @ @ @ – @ @ @ @
SIRIUS contactor relays 3RH
2nd generation
Application 2
Device
AC andtype
DC (e. g. 1 = 4-pole contactorThe
operation relay, 3 = 8-pole
terminal contactor relay)
designations com- @ of auxiliary con-
The number from the front for damping
Number
IEC of NO
60 947, 60 947 (e. g. 2 = 2 NO)ply with EN 50 011.
ENcontacts tacts can be@extended by opening surges.
(VDE 0660)
Number of NC contacts (e. g. 2 = 2 NC)The relay coil and the coil of the means of auxiliary
@ switch The control relay can also
release blocks (up to 4 poles).
Connection type (1 = screw, 2 = spring, 4 = ringsolenoid
lug) are both @ be switched on and released
designed for continuous duty. RC elements, varistors, diodes manually.
Operating range / solenoid coil circuit (e. g. A = AC standard / without)
or diode assemblies can be @
Rated control supply voltage (e. g. K6 = 110/120 V, 50/60 Hz ) plugged onto both coils @ @
No significance @
Special version @ @ @ @
Example 3RH 2 1 2 2 – 1 A K 6 0
Note:
The Order No. scheme is presented here merely for information For your orders, please use the order numbers quote in the
purposes and for better understanding of the logic behind the catalog in the Selection and ordering data.
order numbers.
2
uum interrupters can be moni- before the NO contacts close. ard.
nal covers (see accessories) tored in the closed position by
may have to be fitted onto the Contact reliability DC operation
means of three white double
Assemblies
Contactors and
connecting bars, depending on slides on the contactor base. The auxiliary contacts are Retrofitting options:
the configuration with other extremely reliable and as such • varistors.
devices. The vacuum interrupter must be are suitable for electronic cir-
replaced if the distance indi- cuits
cated by one of the double
• with currents 1 mA,
slides is less than 0.5 mm while
the contactor is in the closed • at voltages greater than 17 V.
position.
It is advisable to replace all
three interrupters in order to
ensure maximum reliability.
The timer module, which is The contactor on which the A varistor is integrated in the The OFF-delay variant operates
available in "ON-delay" and solid-state, time-delay auxiliary timer module for damping without an auxiliary power sup-
"OFF-delay" designs, allows switch block is mounted oper- opening surges in the contactor ply. Minimum ON period:
time-delayed functions up to ates without a delay. coil. 200 ms.
100 s (3 distinct delay ranges). The solid-state, time-delay aux- A single-pole auxiliary switch
It contains a relay with one NO Size S00 (3RT201) iliary switch block cannot be block can be snapped onto the
contact and one NC contact; The solid-state, time-delay aux- mounted on size S00 coupling front of the contactor in addition
the relay is switched either after relays. to the timer module.
2
The timer module with a WYE- power directly by plug-in con- 3RT107) ing opening surges.
DELTA function is equipped tacts via the coil terminals of The solid-state, time-delay aux-
with one delayed and one the contactor, in parallel with iliary switch block is fitted onto
instantaneous NO contact, with A1/A2. The time function is acti- the front of the contactor.
an interval time of 50 ms vated by closing the contactor
between the two (see diagram). on which the auxiliary switch The timer module is supplied
The delay time of the NO con- block is mounted. The OFF- with power via two terminals
tact can be set between 1.5 s delay variant operates without (A1/A2); the time delay of the
and 30 s. an auxiliary power supply. Mini- auxiliary switch block can be
mum ON period: 200 ms. activated either by a parallel
link to any contactor coil or by
WYE-delta function any power source.
2
variation from 0.1 to 20 V/ns. electromagnetically compati-
ble design.
Since the EMC interference
Assemblies
Contactors and
Capacitive input to various ana-
log and digital signals makes it suppression module achieves a
necessary to suppress interfer- significant reduction in radio-
ence in the load circuit. frequency components and the
voltage level in three phases,
the contact endurance is also
improved considerably. This
makes an important contribu-
tion towards enhancing the reli-
ability and availability of the
system as a whole.
There is no need for fine gradu-
ations within each perfor-
mance class, as smaller motors
inherently have a higher induc-
tance, so that one solution for
all fixed-speed drives up to
7.5 HP is adequate.
Two electrical variants are The advantages of the RC cir- The varistor circuit is able to
available: cuit lie mainly in the reduction in absorb high energy levels and
the rate of rise and in its RF is also suitable for frequencies
damping ability. The selected from 10 to 400 Hz (variable-
values ensure effective interfer- speed drives). There is no limit-
ence suppression over a wide ing below the knee-point volt-
range. age, however.
OFF-delay device
for size S00 to S3 contactors
AC and DC operation contactor does not open. The A contactor opens after a delay Operation
IEC 60 947, EN 60 947 3RT19 16/3RT29 16 OFF-delay when the capacitors of the con- In the case of the versions for
devices are specifically designed tactor coil, built into the OFF- rated control supply voltages of
For screwing and snapping for operation with the 3RT contac- delay device, are switched in
onto 35 mm standard mounting 110 V and 230 V, either AC volt-
tors and 3RH contactor relays parallel. In the event of voltage age or DC voltage can be
rail. The OFF-delay devices of the SIRIUS series. failures, the capacitors are dis-
have screw connections. applied on the line side, where
charged via the coil and as the variant for 24 V is
thereby delay the opening of designed for DC operation only.
Principle of operation the contactor.
Application The OFF-delay device operates A DC-operated contactor is con-
The OFF-delay device pre- If the command devices are nected to the output in accor-
without external voltage on a upstream of the OFF-delay
vents a contactor from drop- capacitive basis, and can be dance with the input voltage that
ping out unintentionally when device in the circuit, the OFF is applied.
energized with either AC or DC delay takes effect with every
there is a short-time voltage dip (24 V version for DC operation The mean value of the OFF
or voltage failure. It supplies the opening operation. If the open-
only). Voltage matching, which ing operation is downstream of delay is approximately 1.5 times
necessary power for a series- is only necessary with AC oper- the specified minimum time.
connected, DC-operated con- the OFF-delay device, an OFF
ation, is performed using a rec- delay only applies in the event
tactor during a voltage dip to tifier bridge.
ensure that the of failure of the mains voltage.
Application Functions
DC operation Design Surge suppression Mounting
IEC 60 947 and EN 60 947 System-compatible operation The 3RH29 24-1GP11 interface The 3RH29 24-1GP11 interface
The interface is suitable for use with DC 24 V, coil voltage toler- has an integrated surge sup- is mounted directly on the con-
in any climate. It is safe from ance 17 V to 30 V. pressor (varistor) for the con- tactor coil.
touch to DIN VDE 0106 Part Low power consumption in con- tactor coil being switched.
100. The terminal designations formity with the technical data
2
Interface Interface
Contactor Contactor
More information
2
The data apply to integrated auxiliary contacts and contacts in the
auxiliary switch blocks for contactor sizes S00 to S01)
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 690
Assemblies
Contactors and
Conventional thermal current Ith = A 10
Rated operational current Ie/AC-12
3
AC load
Rated operational current Ie/AC-15/AC-14
• For rated operational voltage Ue 24 V A 101)
110 V A 101)
125 V A 101)
220 V A 101)
230 V A 101)
380 V A 3
400 V A 3
500 V A 2
660 V A 1
690 V A 1
DC load
Rated operational current Ie/DC-12
• For rated operational voltage Ue 24 V A 6
60 V A 6
110 V A 3
125 V A 2
220 V A 1
440 V A 0.3
600 V A 0.15
Rated operational current Ie/DC-13
• For rated operational voltage Ue 24 V A 6
60 V A 2
110 V A 1
125 V A 0.9
220 V A 0.3
440 V A 0.14
600 V A 0.1
Contact reliability at 17 V, 1 mA Frequency of contact faults <10-8 i. e. <1 fault per 100 million operating
acc. to EN 60947-5-4 cycles
Endurance of the auxiliary contacts
It is assumed that the operating mechanisms are switched randomly,
i. e. not synchronized with the phase angle of the supply system. NSB0_02061a
I
I I I I
Diagram legend:
Ia = Breaking current
Ie = Rated operational current
230 V
500 V
690 V
400 V
Contactor 3RT20 15, 3RT20 16 3RT20 17, 3RT20 18
mechanisms are switched randomly, i. e. not synchronized type (3 HP, 5 HP) (7.5 HP, 10 HP)
with the phase angle of the supply system. 10 7
2
10 7 8 6 8
NSB0_02059
4
rent) and is intended for a contact endurance of at least 2
2
200,000 operating cycles. 10 6
2
3
2
10 6 8 10 6
If a shorter endurance is sufficient, the rated operational 10 6 8 6
current Ie/AC-4 can be increased. Ie 8 6
4
8
6
6 4
If the contacts are used for mixed operation, i. e. normal 4
4
2
switching (breaking the rated operational current according 2 2
to utilization category AC-3) in combination with intermittent 2 10 5
inching (breaking several times the rated operational cur- 10 5 8 10 5
rent according to utilization category AC-4), the contact en- 10 5 8 6 8
durance can be calculated approximately from the following 8 6
4 6
equation: 6 4 4
4 2
2 2
2 10 4
4
10 8 10 4
2 3 4 5 6 8 10 20 a (A) 40 50 60 80
Characters in the equation: 7 9 12 16 e (A)
500 V
690 V
400 V
Diagram legend:
PN= Rated power for squirrel-cage motors at 460 V
Ia = Breaking current
Ie = Rated operational current
Technical data
500 V
690 V
400 V
2
7 type (18,5 kW) (22 kW) (30 kW) (37 kW)
7 10
10 8 6 8 IC01_00456
8 6 4 6
Assemblies
Contactors and
6 4 4
4 2
2 6 2
2 6 10 6
6 10 8 10
10 8 6 8
8 6 4 6
6 4 4
4 2
2 5 2
2 5 10 5
5 10 8 10
10 8 6 8
8 6 4 6
6 4 4
4 2
2 2
2 4
4 10 4
10 8 10
10 20 30 40 50 60 80 100 150 200 300 400500
Breaking current a (A)
Sizes S6 to S12
I
I
at 60 Hz 230 V hp 2 3 3 5
460 V hp 3 5 7.5 10
3
575 V hp 5 7.5 10 10
Short-circuit protection1) At 600 V kA 5 5 5 5
(contactor or overload relay) • Fuse CLASS J2) A 40 40 40 40
• Circuit breakers with overload A 50 50 50 50
protection according to UL 489
• Combination motor controllers --3) --3) --3) --3)
type E according to UL 508
NEMA/EEMAC ratings
NEMA/EEMAC size -- 0
• Uninterrupted current - Open A -- 18
- Enclosed A -- 18
• Rated power for induction motors At 200 V hp -- 3
at 60 Hz 230 V hp -- 3
460 V hp -- 5
575 V hp -- 5
Overload relays • Type 3RU21 1 / 3RB30 1
• Setting range A 0.11 ... 16 / 0.1 ... 16
2
Maximum horsepower Ratings at 115 V hp 3 3 5 5 5 7.5 10
ratings single at 230 V hp 7.5 10 10 15 15 15 -
Assemblies
Contactors and
phase motors
at 50/60 Hz
Technical data
Continuous current, at 40 °C Free air and enclosed A 140 195 195 250 330 330
Maximum horsepower ratings Ratings at 115 V
single 230 V HP 25 30 30
Contactors and
Assemblies
phase motors
at 50/60 Hz
(s and u-approved values)
Ratings 200 V HP 40 50 60 60 75 100
of three-phase motors 230 V HP 50 60 75 75 100 125
at 50/60 Hz 460 V HP 100 125 150 150 200 250
575 V HP 125 150 200 200 250 300
Short-circuit protection kA 10 10 10 10 18 18
CLASS RK5 fuse A 450 500 500 700 800 800
Circuit-breaker
acc. to UL 489 A 350 450 500 500 700 800
NEMA/EEMAC ratings NEMA/EEMAC SIZE – 4 – – – 5
Conventional thermal current Free air A – 150 – – – 300
Enclosed A – 135 – – – 270
Ratings a t 200 V HP – 40 – – – 75
of three-phase motors 230 V HP – 50 – – – 100
at 60 Hz 460 V HP – 100 – – – 200
575 V HP – 100 – – – 200
Overload relay Type 3RB20 56 3RB20 66
Technical data
2
Continuous current, at 40 °C Free air and enclosed A 330 540
Maximum horsepower ratings
(s and u-approved values)
Assemblies
Contactors and
Ratings a t 200 V HP 60 75 100 125 150
of three-phase motors 230 V HP 75 100 125 150 200
at 50/60 Hz 460 V HP 150 200 250 300 400
575 V HP 200 250 300 400 500
Short-circuit protection kA 10 18 18 18 30
CLASS RK5 fuse A 700 800 800 1200 1200
Circuit-breaker
acc. to UL 489 A 500 700 900 1000 1200
NEMA/EEMAC ratings NEMA/EEMAC SIZE – 5 – 6
Conventional thermal current Free air A – –
Enclosed A – –
Ratings a t 200 V HP – –
of three-phase motors 230 V HP – –
at 60 Hz 460 V HP – –
575 V HP – –
Overload relay Type 3RB20 66 3RB20 66
H
• With mounted auxiliary switch block mm 45 x 57.5 x 116 / 45 x 70 x 121
D
W
• With mounted function block mm 45 x 57.5 x 142 / 45 x 70 x 142
General data
Permissible mounting positions
2
AC and DC
The contactors are designed for operation on a operation
360° 22,5° 22,5°
NSB0_00478c
vertical mounting surface.
Contactors and
Assemblies
3
Mechanical endurance
• Basic unit Operating 30 million
cycles
• Basic unit with snap-on auxiliary switch block Operating 10 million
cycles
• Solid-state compatible auxiliary switch block Operating 5 million
cycles
2)
Electrical endurance
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 690
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Protective separation between the coil and the main V 400
contacts acc. to EN 60947-1, Appendix N
Mirror contacts
A mirror contact is an auxiliary NC contact that cannot be closed
simultaneously with a NO main contact.
• 3RT20 1 ., 3RT23 1 . (removable auxiliary switch block) Yes, this applies to both the basic unit as well as to between the basic unit
and the mounted auxiliary switch block acc. to EN 60947-4-1, Appendix F
• 3RT20 1 ., 3RT23 1 . (permanently mounted auxiliary switch block) Yes, acc. to EN 60947-4-1, Appendix F
• 3RH29 19- . NF . . solid-state compatible auxiliary switch blocks have no
mirror contacts.
Ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Protection class IP on the front acc. to IEC 60529 IP20, coil assembly IP40
Touch protection on the front acc. To IEC 60529 Finger-safe, for vertical contact from the front
(screw and spring-type terminal)
Shock resistance rectangular pulse
• AC operation g/ms 6.7/5 and 4.2/10 7.3/5 and 4.7/10
• DC operation g/ms 6.7/5 and 4.2/10 7.3/5 and 4.7/10
Shock resistance sine pulse
• AC operation g/ms 10.5/5 and 6.6/10 11.4/5 and 7.3/10
• DC operation g/ms 10.5/5 and 6.6/10 11.4/5 and 7.3/10
Conductor cross-sections 3)
2
• DC operation Up to 50 °C 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
Up to 60 °C 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils (when coil is cold and 1.0 x Us)
Assemblies
Contactors and
• AC operation, 50/60 Hz, - Closing VA 27/24.3 37/33
standard version - P.f. 0.8/0.75 0.8/0.75
3
- Closed VA 4.2/3.3 5.7/4.4
- P.f. 0.25/0.25 0.25/0.25
Hz and 60 Hz
• The following applies to a contact endurance of about 200 000 operating
3
cycles:
- Rated operational currents Ie Up to 400 V A 2.6 4.1 4.1 5.5
690 V A 1.8 3.3 3.3 4.4
- Rated power for squirrel-cage motors with At 230 V kW 0.67 1.1 1.1 1.5
50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 1.15 2 2 2.5
500 V kW 1.45 2 2 3
690 V kW 1.15 2.5 2.5 3.5
Switching frequency
Switching frequency z in operating cycles/hour
• Contactors without overload relays No-load switching h-1 10 000
frequency AC
Dependence of the switching frequency z' on No-load switching h-1 10 000
the operational current I' and operational frequency DC
voltage U': Rated operation
z' = z ⋅ (Ie/I') ⋅ (400 V/U')1.5 ⋅ 1/h AC-1 (AC/DC) h-1 1 000
AC-2 (AC/DC) h-1 750
AC-3 (AC/DC) h-1 750
• Contactors with overload relays (mean value) AC-4 (AC/DC) h-1 250
1) h-1 15
The data only apply to 3RT25 16 and 3RT25 17 (2 NO + 2 NC) up to a
rated operational voltage of 400 V.
H
• With mounted function block 45 x 85 x 166 / 45 x 101.5 x 166
D
W
Dimensions (W x H x D) for DC operation1) mm 45 x 85 x 107 / 45 x 101.5 x 107
2
• With mounted auxiliary switch block mm 45 x 85 x 151 / 45 x 101.5 x 154
• With mounted function block 45 x 85 x 176 / 45 x 101.5 x 176
General data
Assemblies
Contactors and
Permissible mounting positions
360° 22,5° 22,5°
NSB0_00478c
The contactors are designed for operation on a
vertical mounting surface.
2
• Rated operational current Ie At 40 °C up to 690 V A 40 50
At 60 °C up to 690 V A 35 42
Assemblies
Contactors and
• Rated power for AC loads1) 230 V kW 13.3 15.5
P.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 23 27.5
3
500 V kW 29 35
690 V kW 40 47.5
• Minimum conductor cross- At 40 °C mm2 10 10
section for loads with Ie At 60 °C mm2 10 10
Utilization category AC-3
• Rated operational currents Ie Up to 400 V A 9 12 17 25 32 38
440 V A 9 12 17 22 32 35
500 V A 9 12 17 18 32 32
690 V A 9 9 13 13 21 21
• Rated power for slipring or At 230 V HP 3 3 5 7.5 10 10
squirrel-cage motors at 460 V HP 5 7.5 10 15 20 25
50 and 60 Hz 575 V HP 7.5 10 15 20 25 25
Thermal load capacity 10 s current2) A 80 110 150 200 260 300
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-3 W 0.4 0.5 0.9 1.6 2.7 3.8
Utilization category AC-4 (for Ia = 6 x Ie)
• Rated operational current Ie Up to 400 V A 8.5 12.5 15.5 15.5 22
• Rated power for squirrel-cage At 400 V kW 4 5.5 7.5 7.5 11
motors with 50 and 60 Hz
• The following applies to a contact endurance of
about 200 000 operating cycles:
- Rated operational currents Ie Up to 400 V A 4.1 5.5 7.7 9 12
690 V A 3.3 5.5 7.7 9 12
- Rated power At 110 V kW 0.5 0.73 1 1.2 1.6
for squirrel-cage motors At 230 V kW 1.1 1.5 2 2.5 3.4
with 50 and 60 Hz 400 V kW 2 2.6 3.5 4.4 6
500 V kW 2 3.3 4.6 5.6 7.5
690 V kW 2.5 4.6 6 7.7 10.3
Switching frequency
Switching frequency z in operating cycles/hour
• Contactors without overload No-load switching frequency h-1 5 000
relays AC
-1
No-load switching frequency h 1 500
Dependence of the switching fre- DC
quency z' on the operational cur- AC-1 (AC/DC) h-1 1 000
rent I’ and operational voltage U’: AC-2 (AC/DC) h-1 1 000 750
z’ = z ⋅ ( Ie/ I’) ⋅(400 V/U’)1.5 ⋅1/h AC-3 (AC/DC) h-1 1 000 750
AC-4 (AC/DC) h-1 300 250
• Contactors with overload relays (mean value) h-1 15
1) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters with resistance heating, etc.
(increased power consumption on heating up has been taken into
account).
2) According to IEC 60947-4-1.
For rated values for various start-up conditions
see Section 3 --> "Overload Relays" .
Conductor cross-section
2
• Solid mm² 2 x (1 ... 2.5)1); 2 x (2.5 ... 10)1) according to IEC 60947
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm² 2 x (1 ... 2.5)1); 2 x (2.5 ... 6)1); 1 x 10
Contactors and
Assemblies
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (16 ... 12); 2 x (14 ... 8)
• Terminal screws M4 (Pozidriv size 2)
3
Auxiliary conductors
• Terminal screw M3, Pozidriv size 2
• Operating devices mm Ø 5 ... 6
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2
• Usable ring terminal lugs mm d2 = min. 3.2
mm d3 = max. 7.5
1) If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping
point, both cross-sections must lie in the range specified.
H
• With mounted auxiliary switch block1) mm 55 x 114 x 174 / 55 x 114 x 178
D
W
• With mounted function module1) mm 55 x 114 x 199 / 55 x 114 x 202
General data
Permissible mounting position
2
The contactors are designed for operation on a 360° 22,5° 22,5°
3
NSB0_00478c
vertical mounting surface.
Assemblies
Contactors and
Upright mounting position
NSB0_00477a
• AC operation, 60 Hz -- 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
• DC operation -- 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils (for cold coil and 1.0 x Us)
Contactors and
Assemblies
Main circuit
Load rating with AC
Utilization category AC-1,
switching resistive loads
• Rated operational current Ie At 40 °C up to 690 V A 60 70 80 90
At 60 °C up to 690 V A 55 60 70 80
• Rated power for AC loads2) 230 V kW 23 26 30 34
P.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 39 46 53 59
690 V kW 68 79 91 102
• Minimum conductor At 40 °C mm2 16 25 25 35
cross-section for loads with Ie At 60 °C mm2 16 16 25 25
Utilization categories AC-2 and AC-3
• Rated operational currents Ie Up to 400 V A 40 50 65 80
440 V A 40 50 65 80
500 V A 40 50 65 80
690 V A 24 24 47 58
• Rated power for slipring At 230 V kW 11 15 18.5 22
or squirrel-cage motors 400 V kW 18.5 22 30 37
at 50 and 60 Hz 690 V kW 22 22 37 45
Thermal load capacity 10 s current3) A 400 420 520 640
Power loss per conducting path At Ie/AC-3 W 2.2 4 3.8 5.7
1) 2)
The OFF-delay of the NO contact and the ON-delay of the NC contact are Industrial furnaces and electric heaters with resistance heating, etc.
increased if the contactor coils are attenuated against voltage peaks (increased power consumption on heating up has been taken into account).
(varistor +2 ms to 5 ms, diode assembly: 2 to 6 times). 3) According to IEC 60947-4-1.
Rated values for various start-up conditions,
see Chapter 7, "Protection Equipment" "Overload Relays".
2
- Rated operational current Ie Up to 400 V A 35 41 55 55
- Rated power for squirrel-cage motors At 400 V kW 18.5 22 30 30
3
Assemblies
Contactors and
with 50 Hz and 60 Hz
• The following applies to a contact endurance
of about 200 000 operating cycles:
- Rated operational currents Ie Up to 400 V A 22 24 28 30
690 V A 18.5 20 22 24
- Rated power At 110 V kW 3.2 3.5 4.1 4.3
for squirrel-cage motors 230 V kW 6.7 7.3 8.5 9.1
with 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 11.6 12.6 14.7 15.8
690 V kW 16.8 18.2 20 21.8
Load rating with DC
Utilization category DC-1, switching resistive loads (L/R ≤ 1 ms)
• Rated operational currents Ie (at 60 °C)
- 1 conducting path Up to 24 V A 55
60 V A 23
110 V A 4.5
220 V A 1
440 V A 0.4
600 V A 0.25
- 2 conducting paths in series Up to 24 V A 55
60 V A 45
110 V A 25
220 V A 5
440 V A 1
600 V A 0.8
- 3 conducting paths in series Up to 24 V A 55
60 V A 55
110 V A 55
220 V A 45
440 V A 2.9
600 V A 1.4
Utilization category DC-3/DC-5,
shunt-wound and series-wound motors (L/R ≤ 15 ms)
• Rated operational currents Ie (at 60 °C)
- 1 conducting path Up to 24 V A 35
60 V A 6
110 V A 2.5
220 V A 2
440 V A 0.1
600 V A 0.06
- 2 conducting paths in series Up to 24 V A 55
60 V A 45
110 V A 25
220 V A 5
440 V A 0.27
600 V A 0.16
- 3 conducting paths in series Up to 24 V A 55
60 V A 55
110 V A 55
220 V A 25
440 V A 0.6
600 V A 0.35
Switching frequency
Switching frequency z in operating cycles/hour
Contactors without overload relays
• No-load switching frequency AC h-1 5 000
AC/DC h-1 1 500
• Switching frequency z during rated operation1)
- Ie/AC-1 At 400 V h-1 1 200 1 000 800 700
- Ie/AC-2 At 400 V h-1 750 600 400 350
- Ie/AC-3 At 400 V h-1 1 000 800 700 500
- Ie/AC-4 At 400 V h-1 300 250 200 150
Contactors with overload relays
• Mean val ue h-1 15
1)
Dependence of the switching frequency z’ on the operational current I’ and operational voltage U’:
z’ = z x ( Ie/ I’) x (400 V/U’)1.5 x 1/h
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (18 ... 2)1); 1 x (18 ... 1)1)
3
• Terminal screws Pozidriv size 2; ∅ 5 ... 6
Contactors and
Assemblies
Technical data
Contactor Size S3 S3 S3
Type 3RT20 45 3RT20 46 3RT20 47
General data
Permissible mounting position AC and DC operation For DC operation and forward
The contactors are designed for operation inclination up to 22.5°: coil voltage
2
on a vertical mounting surface. tolerance 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us
Assemblies
Contactors and
Upright mounting position:
1) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2": 2) Test conditions acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1.
IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload relay,
Type of coordination "1": but contact welding on the contactor is permitted if
Destruction of the contactor and the overload the contacts can be easily separated.
relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over-
load relay must be replaced if necessary.
Technical data
Contactor Size S3 S3 S3
Type 3RT20 45 3RT20 46 3RT20 47
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC 0.8 to 1.1 × Us
2
Power consumption of the coils (with coil in cold state and 1.0 × Us) Standard design
AC operation Hz 50 50/60 50 50/60
Contactors and
Assemblies
1) The opening times of the NO contacts and the 2) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters with 3) Acc. to VDE 0660 Part 102.
closing times of the NC contacts increase if the resistance heating, for example (higher current For rated values for various starting conditions,
contactor coils are protected against voltage input allowed for during heating up). see Section 3.
peaks (varistor +2 ms to 5 ms, diode assem-
blies 2 to 6 times).
Technical data
Contactor Size S3 S3 S3
Type 3RT20 45 3RT20 46 3RT20 47
Main circuit
Load ratings with AC
AC-4 utilization category (at Ia = 6 × Ie)
2
Rated operational current Ie up to 400 V A 55 66 80
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 400 V kW 30 37 45
Assemblies
Contactors and
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz
For a contact endurance of approx. 200 000 operating cycles:
Rated operational currents Ie up to 400 V A 28 34 42
690 V A 28 34 42
1000 V A 20 23 23
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 230 V kW 8.7 10.4 12
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 15.1 17.9 22
500 V kW 18.4 22.4 27
690 V kW 25.4 30.9 38
1000 V kW 22 30 30
AC-5a utilization category, switching gas discharge lamps
per main conducting path at 230 V
Rating Rated operational
per lamp current per lamp (A)
uncorrected
L 18 W 0.37 Units 243 270
L 36 W 0.43 Units 209 232
L 58 W 0.67 Units 134 149
lead-lag
L 18 W 0.11 Units 818 909
L 36 W 0.21 Units 428 476
L 58 W 0.32 Units 281 312
Switching gas discharge lamps with correction, electronic ballast
per main conducting path at 230 V
Rating Capacitor Rated operational
per lamp (µF) current per lamp (A)
Parallel correction
L 18 W 4.5 0.11 Units 160 197 234
L 36 W 4.5 0.21 Units 160 197 234
L 58 W 7 0.32 Units 103 127 150
With electronic ballast,
single lamp
L 18 W 6.8 0.10 Units 455 560 665
L 36 W 6.8 0.18 Units 253 311 369
L 58 W 10 0.27 Units 168 207 246
With electronic ballast,
twin lamp
L 18 W 10 0.18 Units 253 311 369
L 36 W 10 0.35 Units 130 160 190
L 58 W 22 0.52 Units 88 108 128
Px = Pn 30
Technical data
Contactor Size S3 S3 S3
Type 3RT20 45 3RT20 46 3RT20 47
Main circuit
Load ratings with DC
DC-1 utilization category,
2
Contactor Size S3
Type 3RT20 4.
Conductor cross-sections
Screw connections Main conductor: Front terminal Back terminal Both terminals
(1 or 2 conductor With box terminal connected connected connected
connections possible) Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2.5 ... 35 2.5 ... 50 max. 2 × 35
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 4 ... 50 10 ... 50 max. 2 × 35
Solid mm2 2.5 ... 16 2.5 ... 16 max. 2 × 16
Stranded mm2 4 ... 70 10 ... 70 max. 2 × 50
Ribbon cable (qty. × width × thickness) mm 6 × 9 × 0.8 6 × 9 × 0.8 2 × (6 × 9 × 0.8)
AWG conductor connections, solid and stranded AWG 10 ... 2/0 10 ... 2/0 2 × (10 ... 1/0)
– Terminal screws M 6 (hexagon socket)
– Tightening torque Nm 4 ... 6 (36 ... 53 lb.in)
Connection for drilled max. width mm 10 If bars larger than 12 × 10 mm are con-
copper bars nected, a 3RT19 46-4EA1 terminal cover is to
comply with the phase clearance.
Without box terminal Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 10 ... 501) If conductors larger than 25 mm2 are con-
With cable lugs Stranded with cable lug mm2 10 ... 701) nected, a 3RT19 46-4EA1 terminal cover is
(1 or 2 conductor AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded 7 ... 1/0 needed to comply with the phase clearance.
connections possible)
Auxiliary conductor:
Solid mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5) acc. to IEC 60 947;
max. 2 × (0.75 ... 4)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (20 ... 16); 2 × (18 ... 14); 1 × 12
– Terminal screws M3
– Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)
Cage Clamp connections Auxiliary conductor:
(1 or 2 conductor Solid mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 2.5)
connections possible) Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 2.5)
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (24 ... 14)
• For tool for opening
opening the Cage Clamp connection,
connection, see
see on accessories
accessories on page
page2/81
2/46.
• An "insulation
“insulation stop"
stop” must
must be
be used
used for
for conductor cross-sections ≤≤11 mm2,
conductor cross-sections see accessories
mm2, see accessories on page
page 2/46.
2/81.
• Max. outer diameter of conductor insulation:
insulation: 3.6 mm.
• For information about Cage Clamp
Clamp connections,
connections, see
see Appendix
Appendixpage
page19/17.
19/17.
1) Only
Only crimping
crimping cable
cablelugs
lugsacc.
acc.totoDIN
DIN46 46234
234
Technical data
Contactor Size S6 S6 S6
Type 3RT10 54 3RT10 55 3RT10 56
General data
Permissible mounting position
The contactors are designed for operation
2
on a vertical mounting surface.
Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Oper. 10 million
cycles
Electrical endurance See page 2/125
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Safe isolation between coil, auxiliary contacts and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Positively driven operation Yes, between main contacts and auxiliary NC contacts and within
There is positively driven operation if the NC and the auxiliary switch blocks acc. to ZH 1/457, IEC 60 947-4-1,
NO contacts cannot be closed at the same time Annex H (draft 17B/996/DC)
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60/+55 with AS-Interface
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 00/open type, coil system IP 20
Shock resistance Rectangular pulse g/ms 8.5/5 and 4.2/10
Sine pulse g/ms 13.4/5 and 6.5/10
Contactor Size S6
Type 3RT10 5 .
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC (UC) 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max
Power consumption of solenoid mechanism Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(with coil in cold state and rated range Us min ... Us max) Us min Us max Us min Us max
AC operation Closing VA 250 300 190 280
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
Closed VA 4.8 5.8 3.5 4.4
p.f. 0.8 0.8 0.5 0.4
DC operation Closing W 300 360 250 320
Closed W 4.3 5.2 2.3 2.8
PLC control input (EN 61 131-2/Type 2) DC 24 V/ 30 mA
Operating times Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(Break-time = opening time + arcing time) Operation via
A1/A2 PLC input
– at 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max closing time ms 20 ... 95 95 ... 135 35 ... 75
opening time ms 40 ... 60 80 ... 90 80 ... 90
– at Us min ... Us max closing time ms 25 ... 50 100 ... 120 40 ... 60
opening time ms 40 ... 60 80 ... 90 80 ... 90
Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10 ... 15 10 ... 15
1) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2": 2) Test conditions acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1.
IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload relay,
Type of coordination "1": but contact welding on the contactor is permitted if
Destruction of the contactor and the overload the contacts can be easily separated.
relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over-
load relay must be replaced if necessary.
Technical data
Contactor Size S6 S6 S6
Type 3RT10 54 3RT10 55 3RT10 56
Main circuit
Load ratings with AC
AC-1 utilization category, switching resistive load
2
at 60 °C up to 1000 V A 80 90 100
Ratings of three-phase loads 1) at 230 V kW 53 60 70
p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 92 105 121
500 V kW 115 131 152
690 V kW 159 181 210
1000 V kW 131 148 165
Minimum conductor cross-section with Ie load at 40 °C mm2 70 95 95
60 °C mm2 50 70 95
AC-2 and AC-3 utilization categories
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 115 150 185
690 V A 115 150 170
1000 V A 53 65 65
Ratings of slipring or squirrel-cage at 230 V kW 37 50 61
motors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 64 84 104
500 V kW 81 105 132
690 V kW 113 146 167
1000 V kW 75 90 90
Thermal loading capacity 10 s current 2) A 1100 1300 1480
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-3/500 V W 7 9 13
AC-4 utilization category (at Ia = 6 × Ie)
Rated operational current Ie up to 400 V A 97 132 160
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 400 V kW 55 75 90
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz
For a contact endurance of approx. 200 000 operating cycles:
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 54 68 81
690 V A 48 57 65
1000 V A 34 38 42
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 230 V kW 16 20 25
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 29 38 45
500 V kW 37 47 57
690 V kW 48 55 65
1000 V kW 49 55 60
AC-6a utilization category, switching three-phase transformers
with inrush n 30 20 30 20 30 20
Rated operational current Ie up to 690 V A 90 115 99 148 99 148
Ratings of three-phase transformers at 230 V kVA 35 45 39 58 39 58
with an inrush of n = 30 or 20. 400 V kVA 62 79 68 102 68 102
The ratings must be re-calculated 500 V kVA 77 99 85 128 85 128
for other inrush factors x: 690 V kVA 107 137 118 176 118 176
30 1000 V kVA 80 80 98 98 117 117
Px = Pn 30 ⋅ ------
x
1) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters with 2) Acc. to VDE 0660 Part 102.
resistance heating, for example (higher current For rated values for various starting conditions,
input allowed for during heating up). see Section 3.
Technical data
Contactor Size S6 S6 S6
Type 3RT10 54 3RT10 55 3RT10 56
Main circuit
Load ratings with DC
DC-1 utilization category,
2
switching resistive load (L/R ≤ 1 ms)
Rated operational current Ie (at 60 °C)
Assemblies
Contactors and
Number of conducting paths connected in series 1 2 3
up to 24 V A 160 160 160
60 V A 160 160 160
110 V A 18 160 160
220 V A 3.4 20 160
440 V A 0.8 3.2 1.4
600 V A 0.5 1.6 0.75
DC-3 and DC-5 utilization categories,
shunt and series motors (L/R ≤ 15 ms)
Rated operational current Ie (at 60 °C)
Number of conducting paths connected in series 1 2 3
up to 24 V A 160 160 160
60 V A 7.5 160 160
110 V A 2.5 160 160
220 V A 0.6 2.5 160
440 V A 0.17 0.65 11.5
600 V A 0.12 0.37 4
Operating frequency
Operating frequency z in operating cycles per hour
Contactors without overload relays No-load operating 1/h 2000 2000
frequency
Dependence of the operating frequency z’ on the for AC-1 1/h 800 800
operational current I’ and the operational voltage U’: for AC-2 1/h 400 300
for AC-3 1/h 1000 750
I 400 V 1.5 for AC-4 1/h 130 130
- ⋅ ----------
z’ = z ⋅ ---
I′ U ′ 1/h
Contactors with overload relays (mean value) 1/h 60 60
Contactor Size S6
Type 3RT10 5.
Conductor cross-sections
Screw connections Main conductor: Front terminal Back terminal Both terminals
with 3RT19 55-4G box terminal (75 HP) connected connected connected
finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 16 ... 70 16 ... 70 max. 1 × 50, 1 × 70
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 16 ... 70 16 ... 70 max. 1 × 50, 1 × 70
Stranded mm2 16 ... 70 16 ... 70 max. 2 × 70
AWG conductor connections, solid/stranded 6 ... 2/0 6 ... 2/0 max. 2 × 1/0
Ribbon cable (qty. x width × thickness) mm min. 3 × 9 × 0.8 min. 3 × 9 × 0.8
mm max. 6 × 15.5 × 0.8 max. 6 × 15.5 × 0.8 max. 2 × (6 × 15,5 × 0.8)
with 3RT19 56-4G box terminal
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 16 ... 120 16 ... 120 max. 1 × 95, 1 × 120
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 16 ... 120 16 ... 120 max. 1 × 95, 1 × 120
Stranded mm2 16 ... 120 16 ... 120 max. 2 × 120
AWG conductor connections, solid/stranded 6 ... 250 kcmil 6 ... 250 kcmil max. 2 × 3/0
Ribbon cable (qty. × width × thickness) mm min. 3 × 9 × 0.8 min. 3 × 9 × 0.8
mm max. 10 × 15.5 × 0.8 max. 10 × 15.5 × 0.8 max. 2 × (10 × 15.5 × 0.8)
– Terminal screws M 10 (hexagon socket, A/F4)
– Tightening torque Nm 10 ... 12 (90 ... 110 lb.in)
Without box terminal/busbar connection
Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 16 ... 95 If cable lugs acc. to DIN 46 235 are connected,
Stranded with cable lug mm2 25 ... 120 as of a conductor cross-section of 95 mm2 a
3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal cover is necessary to
comply with the phase clearance.
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 4 ... 250 kcmil
Connecting bar (max. width) mm 17
– Terminal screws M 8 × 25 (A/F 13)
– Tightening torque Nm 10 ... 14 (89 ... 124 lb.in)
Auxiliary conductor:
Solid mm2 2 × (0.5 ...1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5) acc. to IEC 60 947;
max. 2 × (0.75 ... 4)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (18 ... 14)
– Terminal screws M 3 (PZ 2)
– Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)
Technical data
Safe isolation between coil, auxiliary contacts and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Positively driven operation Yes, between main contacts and auxiliary NC contacts and within
There is positively driven operation if the NC and the auxiliary switch blocks acc. to ZH 1/457, IEC 60 947-4-1, Annex
NO contacts cannot be closed at the same time H (draft 17B/996/DC)
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60/+55 with AS-Interface
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 00/open type, coil system IP 20
Shock resistance Rectangular pulse g/ms 8.5/5 and 4.2/10
Sine pulse g/ms 13.4/5 and 6.5/10
1) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2": 2) Test conditions acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1.
IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload relay,
Type of coordination "1": but contact welding on the contactor is permitted if
Destruction of the contactor and the overload the contacts can be easily separated.
relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over-
load relay must be replaced if necessary.
Technical data
2
Rated operational currents Ie at 40 °C up to 690 V A 275 330
at 60 °C up to 690 V A 250 300
Assemblies
Contactors and
at 60 °C up to 1000 V A 100 150
Ratings of three-phase loads 1) at 230 V kW 94 113
p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 164 197
500 V kW 205 246
690 V kW 283 340
1000 V kW 164 246
Minimum conductor cross-section with Ie load at 40 °C mm2 150 185
60 °C mm2 120 185
AC-2 and AC-3 utilization categories
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 225 265 300
690 V A 225 265 280
1000 V A 68 95 95
Ratings of slipring or squirrel-cage at 230 V kW 73 85 97
motors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 128 151 171
500 V kW 160 189 215
690 V kW 223 265 280
1000 V kW 90 132 132
Thermal loading capacity 10 s current 2) A 1800 2400 2400
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-3/500 V W 17 18 22
AC-4 utilization category (at Ia = 6 × Ie)
Rated operational current Ie up to 400 V A 195 230 280
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 400 V kW 110 132 160
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz
For a contact endurance of approx. 200 000 operating cycles:
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 96 117 125
690 V A 85 105 115
1000 V A 42 57 57
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 230 V kW 30 37 40
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 54 66 71
500 V kW 67 82 87
690 V kW 82 102 112
1000 V kW 59 80 80
AC-6a utilization category, switching three-phase transformers
with inrush n 30 20 30 20 30 20
Rated operational current Ie up to 690 V A 151 227 182 265 182 273
Ratings of three-phase transformers at 230 V kVA 60 90 72 105 72 109
with an inrush of n = 30 or 20. 400 V kVA 105 157 126 183 126 189
The ratings must be re-calculated 500 V kVA 130 196 158 229 158 236
for other inrush factors x: 690 V kVA 180 271 217 317 217 326
1000 V kVA 117 117 164 164 164 164
30
Px = Pn 30 ------
x
1) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters 2) Acc. to VDE 0660 Part 102.
with resistance heating, for example (higher For rated values for various
current input allowed for during heating up). starting conditions, see Section 3.
Technical data
Technical data
2
on a vertical mounting surface.
Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Oper. 10 million
cycles
Electrical endurance See page 2/125
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Safe isolation between coil, auxiliary contacts and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Positively driven operation Yes, between main contacts and auxiliary NC contacts and within
There is positively driven operation if the NC and the auxiliary switch blocks acc. to ZH 1/457, IEC 60 947-4-1,
NO contacts cannot be closed at the same time Annex H (draft 17B/996/DC)
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60/+55 with AS-Interface
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 00/open type, coil system IP 20
Shock resistance Rectangular pulse g/ms 8.5/5 and 4.2/10
Sine pulse g/ms 13.4/5 and 6.5/10
Conductor cross-sections See page 2/153
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) See page 2/108
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG
NH Type 3NA, DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
– to IEC 60 947-4/EN 60 947-4-4 (VDE 0660 Part 102) Type of coord. "1" 1) A 630 630
Type of coord. "2" 1) A 500 500
Weld-free 2) A 250 315
Auxiliary circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG A 10
(weld-free protection at Ik 1 kA)
DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
or miniature circuit-breaker with C-characteristic (Ik < 400 A)
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC (UC) 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max
Power consumption of solenoid mechanism Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(with coil in cold state and rated range Us min ... Us max) Us min Us max Us min Us max
AC operation closing VA 700 830 560 750
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
closed VA 7.6 9.2 5.4 7
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
DC operation closing W 770 920 600 800
closed W 8.5 10 4 5
PLC control input (EN 61 131-2/Type 2) DC 24 V/ 30 mA
1) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2": 2) Test conditions acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1.
IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload relay,
Type of coordination "1": but contact welding on the contactor is permitted if
Destruction of the contactor and the overload the contacts can be easily separated.
relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over-
load relay must be replaced if necessary.
Technical data
1) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters 2) Acc. to VDE 0660 Part 102. 3) Ambient temperature 50 °C
with resistance heating, for example (higher For rated values for various for 3RT10 76-.N contactor
current input allowed for during heating up). starting conditions, see Section 3. 4) Ambient temperature 55 °C
for 3RT10 76-.N contactor
Technical data
2
switching resistive load (L/R 1 ms)
Rated operational current Ie (at 60 °C)
Assemblies
Contactors and
Number of conducting paths connected in series 1 2 3
up to 24 V A 400 400 400
60 V A 330 400 400
110 V A 33 400 400
220 V A 3.8 400 400
440 V A 0.9 4 11
600 V A 0.6 2 5.2
DC-3 and DC-5 utilization categories,
shunt and series motors (L/R 15 ms)
Rated operational current Ie (at 60 °C)
Number of conducting paths connected in series 1 2 3
up to 24 V A 400 400 400
60 V A 11 400 400
110 V A 3 400 400
220 V A 0.6 2.5 400
440 V A 0.18 0.65 1.4
600 V A 0.125 0.37 0.75
Operating frequency
Operating frequency z in operating cycles per hour
Contactors without overload relays No-load operating 1/h 2000 2000
frequency
Dependence of the operating frequency z’ on the for AC-1 1/h 700 500
operational current I’ and the operational voltage U’: for AC-2 1/h 200 170
for AC-3 1/h 500 420
Ie 400 V 1.5 for AC-4 1/h 130 130
z’ = z ----
I
---------- 1/h
U
Technical data
Power consumption of solenoid mechanism Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(with coil in cold state and rated range Us min ... Us max) Us min Us max Us min Us max
AC operation closing VA 530 630 420 570
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
closed VA 6.1 7.4 4.3 5.6
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
DC operation closing W 580 700 460 630
closed W 6.8 8.2 3.4 4.2
PLC control input (EN 61 131-2/Type 2) DC 24 V/ 30 mA
1) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2": 2) Test conditions acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1.
IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload relay,
Type of coordination "1": but contact welding on the contactor is permitted if
Destruction of the contactor and the overload the contacts can be easily separated.
relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over-
load relay must be replaced if necessary.
Technical data
2
Rated operational currents Ie at 40 °C up to 1000 V A 330
at 60 °C up to 1000 V A 300
Assemblies
Contactors and
Ratings of three-phase loads 1) at 230 V kW 113
p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 197
500 V kW 246
690 V kW 340
1000 V kW 492
Minimum conductor cross-section with Ie load at 40 °C mm2 185
60 °C mm2 185
AC-2 and AC-3 utilization categories
Rated operational currents Ie up to 1000 V A 225 265 300
Ratings of slipring or squirrel-cage at 230 V kW 73 85 97
motors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 128 151 171
500 V kW 160 189 215
690 V kW 223 265 288
1000 V kW 320 378 428
Thermal loading capacity 10 s current 2) A 1800 2120 2400
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-3 W 9 12 14
AC-4 utilization category (at Ia = 6 × Ie)
Rated operational current Ie up to 690 V A 195 230 280
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 400 V kW 110 132 160
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz
For a contact endurance of approx. 400 000 operating cycles:
Rated operational currents Ie up to 690 V A 97 115 140
1000 V A 68 81 98
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 230 V kW 30 37 45
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 55 65 79
500 V kW 68 81 98
690 V kW 94 112 138
1000 V kW 95 114 140
AC-6a utilization category, switching three-phase transformers
with inrush n 30 20
Rated operational current Ie up to 690 V A 185 278
Ratings of three-phase transformers at 230 V kVA 74 111
with an inrush of n = 30 or 20. 400 V kVA 128 193
The ratings must be re-calculated 500 V kVA 160 241
for other inrush factors x: 690 V kVA 221 332
1000 V kVA 320 482
1) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters 2) Acc. to VDE 0660 Part 102.
with resistance heating, for example (higher For rated values for various
current input allowed for during heating up). starting conditions, see Section 3.
Technical data
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 70 ... 240 120 ... 185 min. 2 × 50,
max. 2 × 185
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 70 ... 240 120 ... 185 min. 2 × 50,
Contactors and
Assemblies
max. 2 × 185
Stranded mm2 95 ... 300 120 ... 240 min. 2 × 70,
max. 2 × 240
AWG conductor connections, solid or AWG 3/0 ... 600 kcmil 250 ... 500 kcmil min. 2 × 2/0,
stranded max. 1 × 500 kcmil
Ribbon cable (qty. × width × thickness) mm min. 6 × 9 × 0.8 min. 6 × 9 × 0.8
mm max. 20 × 24 × 0.5 max. 20 × 24 × 0.5 max. 2 × (20 × 24 ×
0.5)
– Terminal screws M 12 (hexagon
socket, A/F 5)
– Tightening torque Nm 20 ... 22 (180 ... 195 lb.in)
Without box terminal/busbar connection
Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 50 ... 240 If cable lugs acc. to DIN 46 234 are con-
Stranded with cable lug mm2 70 ... 240 nected, as of a conductor cross-section of
240 mm2 and acc. to DIN 46 235 as of a con-
ductor cross-section of 185 mm2 a 3RT19 66-
4EA1 terminal cover is necessary to comply
with the phase clearance.
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2/0 ... 500 kcmil
Connecting bar (max. width) mm 25
– Terminal screws M 10 × 30 (A/F 17)
– Tightening torque Nm 14 ... 24 (124 ... 210 lb.in)
Auxiliary conductor:
Solid mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5) acc. to IEC 60 947;
max. 2 × (0.75 ... 4)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (18 ... 14)
– Terminal screws M 3 (PZ 2)
– Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)
Technical data
2
on a vertical mounting surface.
Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Oper. 10 million
cycles
Electrical endurance See page 2/125
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Safe isolation between coil, auxiliary contacts and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Positively driven operation Yes, between main contacts and auxiliary NC contacts and within
There is positively driven operation if the NC and the auxiliary switch blocks acc. to ZH 1/457, IEC 60 947-4-1,
NO contacts cannot be closed at the same time Annex H (draft 17B/996/DC)
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60/+55 with AS-Interface
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 00/open type, coil system IP 20
Shock resistance Rectangular pulse g/ms 8.5/5 and 4.2/10
Sine pulse g/ms 13.4/5 and 6.5/10
Conductor cross-sections See page 2/159
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) See page 2/108
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG
NH Type 3NA, DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
– to IEC 60 947-4/EN 60 947-4-4 (VDE 0660Part 102) Type of coord. "1" 1) A 800
Type of coord. "2" 1) A 800
Weld-free 2) A 500
Auxiliary circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG A 10
(weld-free protection at Ik 1 kA)
DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
or miniature circuit-breaker with C-characteristic (Ik < 400 A)
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC (UC) 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max
Power consumption of solenoid mechanism Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(with coil in cold state and rated range Us min ... Us max) Us min Us max Us min Us max
AC operation closing VA 700 830 560 750
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
closed VA 7.6 9.2 5.4 7
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
DC operation closing W 770 920 600 800
closed W 8.5 10 4 5
PLC control input (EN 61 131-2/Type 2) DC 24 V/ 30 mA
Operating times Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(Break-time = opening time + arcing time) Operation via
A1/A2 PLC input
– at 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max closing time ms 45 ... 100 120 ... 150 60 ... 90
opening time ms 60 ... 100 80 ... 100 80 ... 100
– at Us min ... Us max closing time ms 50 ... 70 125 ... 150 65 ... 80
opening time ms 70 ... 100 80 ... 100 80 ... 100
Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10 ... 15 10 ... 15
1) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2": 2) Test conditions acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1.
IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload relay,
Type of coordination "1": but contact welding on the contactor is permitted if
Destruction of the contactor and the overload the contacts can be easily separated.
relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over-
load relay must be replaced if necessary.
Technical data
1) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters 2) Acc. to VDE 0660 Part 102.
with resistance heating, for example (higher For rated values for various
current input allowed for during heating up). starting conditions, see Section 3.
Technical data
2
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 70 ... 240 120 ... 185 min. 2 × 50,
max. 2 × 185
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 70 ... 240 120 ... 185 min. 2 × 50,
Assemblies
Contactors and
max. 2 × 185
Stranded mm2 95 ... 300 120 ... 240 min. 2 × 70,
max. 2 × 240
AWG conductor connections, solid or AWG 3/0 ... 600 kcmil 250 ... 500 kcmil min. 2 × 2/0,
stranded max. 2 × 500 kcmil
Ribbon cable (qty. × width × thickness) mm min. 6 × 9 × 0.8 min. 6 × 9 × 0.8
mm max. 20 × 24 × 0.5 max. 20 × 24 × 0.5 max. 2 × (20 × 24 × 0.5)
– Terminal screws M 12 (hexagon
socket, A/F 5)
– Tightening torque Nm 20 ... 22 (180 ... 195 lb.in)
Without box terminal/busbar connection
Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 50 ... 240 If cable lugs acc. to DIN 46 234 are con-
Stranded with cable lug mm2 70 ... 240 nected, as of a conductor cross-section of
240 mm2 and acc. to DIN 46 235 as of a con-
ductor cross-section of 185 mm2 a 3RT19 66-
4EA1 terminal cover is necessary to comply
with the phase clearance.
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2/0 ... 500 kcmil
Connecting bar (max. width) mm 25
– Terminal screws M 10 × 30 (A/F 17)
– Tightening torque Nm 14 ... 24 (124 ... 210 lb.in)
Auxiliary conductor:
Solid mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5) acc. to IEC 60 947;
max. 2 × (0.75 ... 4)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (18 ... 14)
– Terminal screws M 3 (PZ 2)
– Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)
Technical data
Contactor Size S3
Type 3RT24 46
General data
Permissible mounting position AC and DC operation For DC operation and forward
The contactors are designed for operation inclination up to 22.5°:
on a vertical mounting surface. coil voltage tolerance 0.85 ... 1.1 ×
2
Us
Contactors and
Assemblies
1) The opening times of the NO contacts and the 2) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2":
closing times of the NC contacts increase if the IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload
contactor coils are protected against voltage Type of coordination "1": relay, but contact welding on the contactor is
peaks: varistor +2 ms to 5 ms, diode assem- Destruction of the contactor and the overload permitted if the contacts can be easily sepa-
blies 2 to 6 times. relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over- rated.
load relay must be replaced if necessary.
Technical data
Contactor Size S3
Type 3RT24 46
Main circuit
Load ratings with AC
AC-1 utilization category, switching resistive load
2
Rated operational currents Ie at 40 °C up to 690 V A 140
at 60 °C up to 690 V A 130
Assemblies
Contactors and
at 1 000 V A 60
Ratings at 230 V kW 50
of three-phase loads 400 V kW 86
p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 500 V kW 107
690 V kW 148
1 000 V kW 98
Minimum conductor cross-section with Ie load at 40 °C mm2 50
at 60 °C mm2 50
AC-2 and AC-3 utilization categories
With an electrical endurance of 1.3 million operating cycles
Rated operational current Ie up to 690 V A 44
Ratings of slipring or squirrel-cage at 230 V kW 12.7
motors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 22
500 V kW 29.9
690 V kW 38.2
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-1 W 12.5
Load ratings with DC
DC-1 utilization category, switching resistive load L/R 1 ms)
Number of conducting paths when connected in series 1 2 3
Rated operational currents Ie (at 60 °C) up to 24 V A 130 130 130
60 V A 80 130 130
110 V A 12 130 130
220 V A 2.5 13 130
440 V A 0.8 2.4 6
600 V A 0.48 1.3 3.4
Ie 400 V
1.5
z’ = z ---- ----------
- 1/h
I U
T24 46
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
Technical data
Contactor Size S6
Type 3RT14 56
General data
Permissible mounting position
The contactors are designed for operation
on a vertical mounting surface.
2
Mechanical endurance Oper. 10 million
Assemblies
Contactors and
cycles
Electrical endurance Oper. 0.5 million
AC-1 utilization category at Ie cycles
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Safe isolation between coil, auxiliary contacts and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60/+55 with AS-Interface
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 00/open type, coil system IP 20
Shock resistance
Rectangular pulse g/ms 8.5/5 and 4.2/10
Sine pulse g/ms 13.4/5 and 6.5/10
Conductor cross-sections See page 2/164
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) See page 2/108
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG,
NH, Type 3NA Type of coordination "1" A 355
Fuse links, utilization category gR,
SITOR, Type 3NE Type of coordination "2" A 350
Auxiliary circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG A 10
(weld-free protection at Ik 1 kA)
DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
or miniature circuit-breaker with C-characteristic (Ik < 400 A)
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC (UC) 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max
Power consumption of solenoid mechanism Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(with coil in cold state and rated range Us min ... Us max) Us min Us max Us min Us max
AC operation closing VA 250 300 190 280
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
closed VA 4.8 5.8 3.5 4.4
p.f. 0.8 0.8 0.5 0.4
DC operation closing W 300 360 250 320
closed W 4.3 5.2 2.3 2.8
PLC control input (EN 61 131-2/Type 2) DC 24 V/ 30 mA
Technical data
2
on a vertical mounting surface.
Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Oper. 10 million
cycles
Electrical endurance Oper. 0.5 million
AC-1 utilization category at Ie cycles
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Safe isolation between coil, auxiliary contacts and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60/+55 with AS-Interface
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 00/open type, coil system IP 20
Shock resistance
Rectangular pulse g/ms 8.5/5 and 4.2/10
Sine pulse g/ms 13.4/5 and 6.5/10
Conductor cross-sections See page 2/167
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) See page 2/108
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG,
NH, Type 3NA Type of coordination "1" A 500 800
Fuse links, utilization category gR,
SITOR, Type 3NE Type of coordination "2" A 500 710
Auxiliary circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG A 10
(weld-free protection at Ik 1 kA)
DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
or miniature circuit-breaker with C-characteristic (Ik < 400 A)
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
More information
Contactors Type 3RT23 16 3RT23 17 3RT23 25 3RT23 26 3RT23 27
Size S00 S0
Dimensions (W x H x D)3) Width mm 45 x 57.5 x 73 60 x 85 x 97
General data
Permissible mounting position1)
2
cycles
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
(pollution degree 3)
Permissible ambient temperature • During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Degree of protection Device IP20 IP20
Acc. to EN 60947-1, Appendix C Connection range IP00
Touch protection acc.to EN 50274 Finger-safe
Short-circuit protection of contactors without overload relays
Main circuit
Fuse links, gG operational class: • Type of coordination "1"1) A 35 63
LV HRC 3NA, DIAZED 5SB, NEOZED 5SE • Type of coordination "2"1) A 20 20
according to IEC 60947-4-1/ • Weld-free A 10 16
EN 60947-4-1
Control
Solenoid coil operating range
• AC operation - At 50 Hz 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us --
- At 60 Hz 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us --
• DC operation - At 50 °C 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us --
- At 60 °C 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us --
• AC/DC operation -- 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils (when coil is cold and 1.0 x Us)
• AC operation, 50 Hz, - Closing VA -- 77
standard version - P.f. -- 0.82
- Closed VA -- 9.8
- P.f. -- 0.25
• AC operation, 50/60 Hz, - Closing VA 27/24.3 37/33 81/79
standard version - P.f. 0.8/0.75 0.8/0.75 0.72/0.74
- Closed VA 4.2/3.3 5.7/4.4 10.5/8.5
- P.f. 0.25/0.25 0.25/0.25 0.25/0.28
• AC operation, 60 Hz, - Closing VA 31.7 43 87
USA, Canada - P.f. 0.77 0.77 0.76
- Closed VA 4.8 6.5 9.4
- P.f. 0.25 0.25 0.28
• DC operation - Closing W 4 5.9
= Closed
Operating times for 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us2)
Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 8 ... 35 8 ... 33 9 ... 38 8 ... 40
- Opening delay ms 3.5 ... 14 4 ... 15 4 ... 16 4 ... 16
• DC operation - Closing delay ms 30 ... 100 50 ... 170
- Opening delay ms 7 ... 13 15 ... 17.5
• Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10
Main circuit
AC capacity
Utilization category AC-1, switching resistive loads
• Rated operational currents Ie At 40 °C, up to 690 V A 18 22 35 40 50
At 60 °C, up to 690 V A 16 20 30 35 42
• Rated power for AC loads At 460 V HP 5 5 10 10 10
P.f. = 0.95 (at 40 °C)
• Minimum conductor cross-section At 40 °C mm2 2.5 2.5 10 10 10
for loads with Ie At 60 °C mm2 2.5 2.5 10 10 10
Utilization category AC-3
• Rated operational currents Ie At 60 °C, up to 400 V A 9 12 15.5 17 17
• Rated power for slipring At 460 V HP 5 5 10 10 10
or squirrel-cage motors at 60 Hz s
Technical specifications
Type 3RT23 36 3RT23 44 3RT23 46
Size S2 S3 S3
4
Dimensions (W x H x D) mm 74.5 x 113.5 x 130 / 73 x 112 x 110 93 x 146 x 134
H
74.5 x 113.5 x 130
D
W
• With mounted auxiliary switch block mm 74.5 x 113.5 x 173.5 / 73 x 112 x 160 93 x 146 x 183
2
74.5 x 113.5 x 177.5
General technical specifications
Permissible mounting position1)
Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Operating 10 million
cycles
Electrical endurance at Ie/AC-1 Operating Approx. 0.5 million
cycles
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
(pollution degree 3)
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Degree of protection Device IP20
acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix C Connection range
Touch protection acc. to EN 50274 Finger-safe
Short-circuit protection of contactors without overload relays
Main circuit
Fuse links, operational class gG: • Type of coordination "1"1) A on request 250 250
LV HRC, 3NA; DIAZED, 5SB; NEOZED, 5SE • Type of coordination "2"1) A on request 125 160
according to IEC 60947-4-1/EN 60947-4-1 • Weld-free A on request 63 100
Control circuit
Coil operating range (AC/DC) 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils (when coil is cold and 1.0 x Us)
• AC operation, 50 Hz - Closing VA 190 270
- P.f. VA 0.72 0.68
- Closed VA 16 22
- P.f. VA 0.37 0.27
• AC operation, 50/60 Hz - Closing VA 210/188 298/274
- P.f. 0.69/0.65 0.72/0.62
- Closed VA 17.2/16.5 27/20
- P.f. 0.36/0.3 0.29/0.31
• DC operation - Closing W 15
= Closed
Operating times for 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us2)
Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time
• DC operation - Closing delay ms 110 ... 200
- Opening delay ms 14 ... 20
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 10 ... 80 20 ... 50
- Opening delay ms 10 ... 18 10 ... 25
• Arcing time ms 10 ... 20 10 ... 15
Main circuit
AC capacity
Utilization category AC-1, switching resistive loads
• Rated operational currents Ie At 40 °C, up to 690 V A 60 110 140
At 60 °C, up to 690 V A 55 100 120
• Rated power for AC loads At 230 V kW 21 42 53
P.f. = 0.95 (at 40 °C) 400 V kW 36 72 92
• Minimum conductor cross-section At 40 °C mm² 16 50 50
for loads with Ie At 60 °C mm² 25 50 50
Utilization categories AC-2 and AC-3
• Rated operational currents Ie At 60 °C, up to 400 V A -- --
• Rated power for slipring At 230 V kW -- --
or squirrel-cage motors at 50 and 60 Hz 400 V kW -- --
1)
In accordance with the corresponding 3-pole 3RT1 contactors.
2)
With size S00, DC operation: Operating times for 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us
Technical specifications
Type 3RT2516 3RT2517 3RT2518 3RT2526 3RT2535 3RT2536
Size S00 S0 S2
General technical specifications
Permissible mounting position
2
NSB0_00478c
vertical mounting surface.
Contactors and
Assemblies
NSB0_00477a
• with mounted auxiliary switch block 45 x 57.5 x 116 / 45 x 70 x 121 74.5 x 113.5 x 173.5 / 74.5 x 113.5 x 177.5
D
Type 3RT2526
Size S0
Dimensions (W x H x D) for AC operation1)2) mm 60 x 85 x 97 / 60 x 101.5 x 97
H
W
Dimensions (W x H x D) for DC operation1)2) mm 60 x 85 x 107 / 60 x 101.5 x 107
• with mounted auxiliary switch block mm 60 x 85 x 151 / 60 x 101.5 x 154
1) Dimensions for devices with screw terminals/spring-type terminals.
2)
For size S0, devices for AC and DC operation differ in depth. The following
applies: Depth (DC) = Depth (AC) + 10 mm.
2
• DC operation up to 50 °C 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us --
up to 60 °C 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us --
• AC/DC operation -- 0.8 x Usmin... 1.1 x Usmax
Assemblies
Contactors and
Power consumption of the solenoid coils see see 3RT2317 see 3RT2326 see 3RT233
(for cold coil and 1.0 x Us) 3RT2316
Operating times for 0.8 to 1.1 x Us see see 3RT2317 see 3RT2326 see 3RT233
(Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time) 3RT2316
4
Main circuit
Load rating with AC
Utilization category AC-1
Switching resistive loads
• Rated operational currents Ie at 40 °C up to 690 V A 18 22 40 60 70
at 60 °C up to 690 V A 16 20 35 55 60
• Rated power for at 230 V kW 6 7.5 13.3 21 23
AC loads 400 V kW 10.5 13 23 36 39
p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C)
• Minimum conductor cross-section at 40 °C mm2 2.5 2.5 10 16 25
for loads with Ie
Utilization categories AC-2 and AC-3 AC1) DC1)
• Rated operational currents Ie NO up to 400 V A 9 12 16 25 25 35 41
(at 60 °C) NC up to 400 V A 9 9 9 25 20 35 41
• Rated power for slipring or squirrel-cage NO at 230 V kW 2.2 3 4 5.5 5.5 11
motors at 50 and 60 Hz NC at 230 V kW 2.2 2.2 2.2 5.5 5.5 11
NO at 400 V kW 4 5.5 7.5 11 11 18.5 22
NC at 400 V kW 4 4 4 11 7.5 18.5 22
Load rating with DC
Utilization category DC-1
Switching resistive loads (L/R ≤ 1 ms)
• Rated operational currents Ie (at 60 °C)
- 1 conducting path up to 24 V A 16 20 35 55 60
60 V A 16 20 20 23
110 V A 2.1 2.1 4.5 4.5
220 V A 0.8 0.8 1 1
440 V A 0.6 0.6 0.4 0.4
- 2 conducting paths in series up to 24 V A 16 20 35 55
60 V A 16 20 35 45
110 V A 12 12 35 45
220 V A 1.6 1.6 5 5
440 V A 0.8 0.8 1 1
Utilization category DC-3/DC-52)
Shunt-wound and series-wound motors (L/R ≤ 15 ms)
• Rated operational currents Ie (at 60 °C)
- 1 conducting path up to 24 V A 16 20 20 35
60 V A 0.5 0.5 5 6
110 V A 0.15 0.15 2.5 2.5
220 V A 0.75 0.75 1 1
440 V A -- -- 0.09 0.1
- 2 conducting paths in series up to 24 V A 16 20 35 55
60 V A 5 5 35 45
110 V A 0.35 0.35 15 25
220 V A -- -- 3 5
440 V A -- -- 0.27 0.27
1)
Values for devices with AC and DC operation: for 3RT25 26 with
DC operation, different values apply to AC-2 and AC-3 for the NC.
2)
For Us >24 V, the rated operational currents Ie for the NC contact
conducting paths are 50 % of the values for the NO contact
conducting paths.
4
only then do the main contacts close. In addition, a 2-pole auxiliary switch block can be mounted lat-
This prevents disturbances in the network and welding of the erally on the 3RT16 47 capacitor contactors (2 NO, 2 NC or
3RT16 capacitor contactors
contactors. 1 NO + 1 NC versions); type 3RH19 21-1EA . . . The fitting of aux-
iliary switches for 3RT16 17 and 3RT16 27 is not expandable.
Technical specifications
All technical specifications not mentioned in the table below are those of the 3RT10 26 contactors for size S0 and to those of the
identical to those of the 3RT10 17 contactors for size S00, to 3RT10 45 contactors for size S3. .
Type 3RT16 17-.A. .3 3RT16 27-.A. .1 3RT16 47-.A. .1
Size S00 S0 S3
Dimensions (W x H x D) mm 45 x 101 x 105 45 x 100 x 130 70 x 167 x 183
H
2
D
W
Contactors and
Assemblies
More information
All technical specifications not mentioned in the table below are
identical to those of the 3RT20 contactors for switching motors
(see 2/130-2/132)
Contactors Type 3RT20 1.-.HB4. 3RT20 1.-.JB4. 3RT20 1.-.KB4. 3RT20 2.-.KB4.
Size S00 S00 S00 S0
2
Width mm 45 45 45 45
General data
Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Oper- 30 million 10 million
ating
3
cycles
Protective separation between the coil and the main contacts V 400
acc. to EN 60947-1, Appendix N
Control
Solenoid coil operating range 0.7 ... 1.25 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid At Us 17 V W 1.6 2.3
coil 24 V W 2.8 4.5
(for cold coil)
Closing = Closed 30 V W 4.4 7
Permissible residual current < 10 mA x (24 V/Us) < 6 mA x (24 V/Us)
of the electronics (for 0 signal)
Overvoltage configuration of the solenoid coil Without overvolt- With diode With suppressor With varistor
age damping diode
3TF6
3TF68 vacuum
and contactors,
3TF69 Vacuum contactors
3-pole, 335 ... 450 kW
Overview
Standards Electromagnetic compatibility
IEC 60947-1, EN 60947-1, The 3TF68/69 . . - . C contactors for AC operation are fitted with an
IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1, electronically controlled solenoid operating mechanism with a
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1 (auxiliary switches) high interference immunity (for EMC values see page 3/115).
The 3TF68/69 contactors are climate-proof. The solenoid coil is connected to varistors for protection against
3 2
overvoltages.
They are finger-safe according to EN 50274. Terminal covers
may have to be fitted onto the connecting bars, depending on The 3TF68/69 . . - . Q .. contactors for AC operation are designed
Contactors and
Assemblies
the configuration with other devices (see Accessories and Spare for operation in systems with AC control supply voltage which is
Parts on page 2/56). subject to strong interference. The solenoid systems of these
contactors are configured in the DC economy circuit with rectifi-
Main contacts cation. The rectifier bridge is connected to varistors for protec-
Contact erosion indication with 3TF68/69 vacuum contactors tion against overvoltages.
The contact erosion of the vacuum interrupters can be checked Protection of the main current paths
during operation with the help of 3 white double slides on the
contactor base. If the distance indicated by one of the double An integrated RC varistor connection for the main current paths
slides is < 0.5 mm while the contactor is in the closed position, dampens the switching overvoltage rises to safe values. This
then the vacuum interrupter must be replaced. To ensure maxi- prevents multiple restricting. It can therefore be assumed that
mum reliability, it is recommended to replace all 3 vacuum inter- the motor winding cannot be damaged by switching overvolt-
rupters simultaneously. ages with steep voltage rises.
Note:
Auxiliary contacts
During operation in installations in which the emitted interference
Contact reliability limits cannot be observed, e.g. when used for output contactors
These auxiliary contacts are particularly suitable for solid-state in converters, 3TF68/69 . . - . Q contactors without a main current
circuits with currents ≥ 1 mA at a voltage ≥ 17 V. path circuit are recommended.
Technical specifications
Contactor Type 3TF68 and 3TF69
Rated data of the auxiliary contacts Acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
(pollution degree 3)
Conventional thermal current A 10
Ith = Rated operational current Ie/AC-12
AC load
Rated operational current Ie/AC-15/AC-14
• For rated operational voltage Ue
- At 24 V A 10
- At 110 V A 10
- At 125 V A 10
- At 220 V A 6
- At 230 V A 5.6
- At 380 V A 4
- At 400 V A 3.6
- At 500 V A 2.5
- At 660 V A 2.5
- At 690 V A 2.3
DC load
Rated operational current Ie/DC-12
• For rated operational voltage Ue
- At 24 V A 10
- At 60 V A 10
- At 110 V A 3.2
- At 125 V A 2.5
- At 220 V A 0.9
- At 440 V A 0.33
- At 600 V A 0.22
Rated operational current Ie/DC-13 Auxiliary contacts with
• For rated operational voltage Ue delayed NC contact: NS = No specification
- At 24 V A 10 6
- At 60 V A 5 NS
- At 110 V A 1.14 0.98
- At 125 V A 0.98 NS
- At 220 V A 0.48 NS
- At 440 V A 0.13 NS
- At 600 V A 0.07 0.07
s and u rated data of the auxiliary contacts
Rated voltage, max. V AC 600
Switching capacity A 600, P 600
Operating cycles
supply system. 7
2
10
8
The characteristic curves apply to 230 V AC. 6
3
4
Assemblies
Contactors and
3
2
6
10
8
6
4
3
2
5
10
-2 -1 0 1
10 2 3 4 6 8 10 2 3 4 6 8 10 2 3 4 6 8 10 2
Breaking current a ( A )
2
Operating cycles at 500 V
2 2
6
2 6 10
10 8 10
6
6 8
10 6 8
8 6 6
4
6 4 4
4 2
2 2
2 5
5 10
10 8 10
5
10
5 8 6 8
8 6 6
4
6 4 4
4 2
2 2
2 4
4 10
10 8 10
4
10
4 8 6 8
8 6 6
4
6 4 4
4 2
2 2
2 3
3 10
10 10
3
100 200 400 600 1000 2000 4000 a (A) 6000
635
820 e (A)
335 Prated (kW)
450
Diagram legend:
Prated = Rated power for squirrel-cage motors at 400 V
a
= Breaking current
e
= Rated operational current
3TF6
3TF68 vacuum
and contactors,
3TF69 Vacuum contactors
3-pole, 335 ... 450 kW
General data
3 2
NSB0_00649a
instructions1) 2) 90° 90°
Contactors and
Assemblies
2
• AC operation, Us max - Closing VA/p.f. 1850/1 950/0.98
- Closed VA/p.f. 49/0.15 30.6/0.31
• AC operation, Us min - Closing VA/p.f. 1200/1 600/0.98
3
Assemblies
Contactors and
- Closed VA/p.f. 13.5/0.47 12.9/0.43
• DC economy circuit1) - Closing at 24 V W 1010 960
- Closed W 28 20.6
For contactors of type 3TF68/69 . . - . Q:
• AC operation, Us min2) - Closing VA/p.f. 1000/0.99 1150/0.99
- Closed VA/p.f. 11/1 11/1
Operating times for 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us (Values apply to cold and warm coil)
(Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time)
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 70 ... 120 (22 ... 65)3) 80 ... 120
- Opening delay ms 70 ... 100 70 ... 80
• DC economy circuit - Closing delay ms 76 ... 110 86 ... 280
- Opening delay ms 50 19 ... 25
• Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10
For contactors of type 3TF68/69 . . - . Q:
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 35 ... 90 45 ... 160
- Opening delay ms 65 ... 90 30 ... 80
Operating times for 1.0 x U s
(Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time)
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 80 ... 100 (30 ... 45)3) 85 ... 100
- Opening delay ms 70 ... 100 70
• DC economy circuit - Closing delay ms 80 ... 90 90 ... 125
- Opening delay ms 50 19 ... 25
Minimum command duration Standard ms 120 120
for closing Reduced make-time ms 90 --
Minimum interval time between two ON commands ms 100 300
1) At 24 V DC; for further voltages, deviations of up to ±10 % are possible.
2) Including reversing contactor.
3) Values in brackets apply to contactors with reduced operating times.
Contactor Type 3TF6. 44- 3TF6. 44- 3TF6. 44- 3TF6. 44- 3TF6. 44-
.CF7 .CM7 .CP7 .CQ7 .CS7
Electromagnetic compatibility
Rated control supply voltage Us V AC 110 ... 132 200 ... 240 230 ... 277 380 ... 460 500 ... 600
Overvoltage type acc. to IEC 60801 Burst/Surge
Degree of severity acc. to IEC 60801
• Burst 3 4 4 4 4
• Surge 4 4 4 4 4
Overvoltage resistance
• Burst kV 2 4 4 4 4
• Surge kV 6 5 5 6 6
3TF6
3TF68 vacuum
and contactors,
3TF69 Vacuum contactors
3-pole, 335 ... 450 kW
• Rated power for AC loads with p.f. = 0.95 230 V kW 240 323
at 55°C 400 V kW 415 558
500 V kW 545 735
690 V kW 720 970
1000 V kW 780 1 385
• Minimum conductor cross-sections for loads At 40°C mm2 2 x 240 Ie ≥ 800 A: 2 x 60 x 5
with Ie (copper busbars)
At 55°C mm2 2 x 185 Ie < 800 A: 2 x 240
Utilization categories AC-2 and AC-3
• Rated operational currents Ie Up to 690 V A 630 820
1000 V A 435 580
• Rated power for slipring or squirrel-cage mo- At 230 V kW 200 260
tors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 347 450
500 V kW 434 600
690 V kW 600 800
1000 V kW 600 800
Thermal load capacity 10 s current A 5 040 7 000
Power loss per conducting path At Ie/AC-3 W 45 70
Utilization category AC-4 (for Ia = 6 x Ie)
• Rated operational current Ie Up to 690 V A 610 690
• Rated power for squirrel-cage motors At 400 V kW 355 400
with 50 Hz and 60 Hz
The following applies to a contact endurance
of about 200 000 operating cycles:
• Rated operational currents Ie Up to 690 V A 300 360
1000 V A 210 250
• Rated power for squirrel-cage motors At 230 V kW 97 110
with 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 168 191
500 V1) kW 210 250
690 V1) kW 278 335
1000 V1) A 290 350
Switching frequency
Switching frequency z in operating cycles/hour
• Contactors without overload relays No-load switching 1/h 2 000 1 000
frequency AC
No-load switching 1/h 1 000 1 000
frequency DC
AC-1 1/h 700 700
AC-2 1/h 200 200
AC-3 1/h 500 500
AC-4 1/h 150 150
• Contactors with overload relays (mean value) 1/h 15 15
1) Max. permissible rated operational current Ie/AC-4 = Ie/AC-3 up to 500 V,
for reduced contact endurance and reduced switching frequency.
• Busbar connections
- Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 50 ... 240 50 ... 240
2
- Stranded with cable lug mm2 70 ... 240 50 ... 240
- Solid or stranded AWG 2/0 ... 500 MCM 2/0 ... 500 MCM
3
- Connecting bar (max. width) mm 50 60 (Ue ≤ 690 V)
Assemblies
Contactors and
50 (Ue > 690 V)
• Terminal screw M10 x 30 M12 x 40
- Tightening torque Nm 14 ... 24 (124 ... 210 lb.in) 20 ... 35 (177 ... 310 lb.in)
• With box terminal1)
- Connectable copper bars
- Width mm 15 ... 25 15 ... 38
- Max. thickness mm 1 x 26 or 2 x 11 1 x 46 or 2 x 18
- Terminal screw A/F 6 (hexagon socket) A/F 8 (hexagon socket)
- Tightening torque Nm 25 ... 40 35 ... 50
lb.in 221 ... 354 266 ... 443
Auxiliary conductors:
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1)2)/2 x (1 ... 2.5)2)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1)2)/2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)2)
• Pin-end connector acc. to DIN 46231 mm2 2 x (1 ... 1.5)
• Solid or stranded AWG 2 x (18 ... 12)
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.4
lb.in 7 ... 12
1) See “Accessories and Spare Parts”, page 2/56.
2) If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping
point, both cross-sections must lie in one of the ranges specified.
Overview Application
3TC4 and 3TC5 The contactors are suitable for switching and controlling DC mo-
tors as well as all other DC circuits.
IEC 60947-1, EN 60947-1,
IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1 A version with an especially large coil operating range is avail-
able for operation in electrically driven vehicles and in switch-
The contactors are finger-safe according to EN 50274. Terminal gears with significant fluctuations in the actuating voltage
covers may have to be fitted onto the connecting bars, depend-
2
.
ing on the configuration with other devices.
The DC motor ratings given in the tables are applicable to the
Contactors and
Assemblies
Technical specifications
Contactors Type 3TC4 and 3TC7 3TC5
Rated data of the auxiliary contacts
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
(pollution degree 3)
Conventional thermal current Ith = A 10 10
Rated operational current Ie/AC-12
AC load
Rated operational current Ie/AC-15/AC-14
• For rated operational voltage Ue
24 V A 10 10
110 V A 10 10
125 V A 10 10
220 V A 6 6
230 V A 5.6 5.6
380 V A 4 4
400 V A 3.6 3.6
500 V A 2.5 2.5
660 V A 2.5 2.5
690 V A -- --
DC load
Rated operational current Ie/DC-12
• For rated operational voltage Ue
24 V A 10 10
60 V A 10 10
110 V A 3.2 8
125 V A 2.5 6
220 V A 0.9 2
440 V A 0.33 0.6
600 V A 0.22 0.4
Rated operational current Ie/DC-13
• For rated operational voltage Ue
24 V A 10 10
60 V A 5 5
110 V A 1.14 2.4
125 V A 0.98 2.1
220 V A 0.48 1.1
440 V A 0.13 0.32
600 V A 0.07 0.21
2
Contact endurance of the main contacts
10 7 20
Assemblies
Contactors and
NSB0_00656
8 NSB0_00655
6 Mill.
4
10 6
8
6 14
4
12
2
5
10 10
8
6
4 8
2
6
10 4
8
6 4
4
2
2
0,5
10 3
200 400 50 100 150 200 250 300 a (A) 400
10 20 40 100 600 1000 a (A)
H
• DC operation mm 70 x 85 x 141 100 x 183 x 180 135 x 238 x 232 160 x 279 x 310
D
• AC operation W mm 70 x 85 x 100 100 x 183 x 154 135 x 238 x 200 160 x 279 x 251
Control circuits
Coil operating range 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
2
H
Dimensions mm 78 x 352 x 276 160 x 366 x 290
D
W
NSB0_00650c
2
The contactors are designed for operation on a
vertical mounting surface.
Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Operating cycles 30 million
Electrical endurance Operating cycles 1)
4
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Protective separation between the coil and the main contacts V 630
acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix N
Permissible ambient temperature °C -25 ... +55
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix C IP00/open
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, operational class gG:
LV HRC, type 3NA
• Type of coordination "1" A 630
• Type of coordination "2" A 500
Auxiliary circuits
• Short-circuit test with fuse links of gG operational class: A 16
DIAZED, type 5SB; NEOZED, type 5SE
with short-circuit current Ik = 1 kA acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
• Test with miniature circuit breaker up to 230 V with C characteristic: A 10
Short-circuit current Ik = 400 A acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
Control circuits
Coil operating range
• DC operation At Uc = 24 V 0.8 ... 1.2 x Us
At Uc > 24 V 0.7 ... 1.2 x Us
• AC operation At Uc = 24 V 0.7 ... 1.15 x Us
At Uc > 24 V 0.7 ... 1.14 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils (when coil is cold and 1.0 x Us)
• DC operation Closing = Closed W 46 92
• AC operation, 50 Hz Closing, VA 80 160
Closed 0.95 0.95
Operating times (The values apply up to and including 15 % undervoltage,
(Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time) 10 % overvoltage, as well as when the coil is cold and warm)
• AC and DC operation - Closing delay ms 60 ... 100
- Opening delay ms 20 ... 35
• Arcing time at 0.06 ... 4 x Ie ms 40 ... 70
Main circuit
Load rating with DC
Utilization category DC-1, switching resistive loads (L/R ≤ 1 ms)
• Rated operational current Ie/DC-1 (at 55 °C) A 500 500
• Minimum conductor cross-section mm2 2 x 150 2 x 150
• Rated power At 220 V kW 110 110
440 V kW 220 220
600 V kW 300 300
750 V kW 375 375
1200 V kW — 600
1500 V kW — 750
• Critical currents, without arc extinction At 440 V A ≤7 —
600 V A ≤ 13 —
750 V A ≤ 15 —
≤ 800 V A — ≤7
1200 V A — ≤ 13
1500 V A — ≤ 15
2)
Utilization categories DC-3 and DC-5, switching DC motors
Permissible rated current for regenerative braking At 110 ... 600 V A 400
Switching frequency
Switching frequency z in operating cycles/hour
AC/DC operation
• With resistive load DC-1 h-1 750 1 000
• For inductive load DC-3/DC-5 h-1 500 500
1)
Endurance see page 2/181..
2) .
See Selection and ordering data.
Technical specifications
Contactor Type 3RT19 2 6-2C 3RT19 26-2D 3RT19 26-2E 3RT19 26-2F 3RT19 26-2G
Solid-state timing relay blocks Solid-state time-delay auxiliary switch blocks
with semiconductor output
General data
Rated insulation voltage Ui V AC 250
32
Pollution degree 3
Overvoltage category III acc. to EN 60664-1
Permissible ambient temperature
Contactors and
Assemblies
2
(varistor integrated) Timing relay
NSB0_0939a
A2 the contactor or the
A1
timing relay.
1
3
t
– – – – To be connected
Assemblies
Contactors and
A1/A2 A1 A2
Contactor optionally
NSB0_00556
2
A1 A2 1 Timing relay block
N/L- 2 Contactor
NSB0_0940a
B1/A2 A1 B1 A2 from the timing relay.
> 35 ms
1
A1/A2 Do not connect
Contactor t A1 A2
NSB0_00557
2 1 Timing relay block
A1 A2
N/L 2 Contactor
NSB0_00936
-7/-8
-5/-6 27 35
A1
t
A2
28 36
NSB0_01873
-7/-8 27 35
A1
-5/-6
t A2
28 36
NSB0_01874a
2
A1 1 Coupling link
A2 2 Contactor
NSB0_00182a
Conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm² 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
Terminal screws M3
Control side
Rated control supply voltage Us V DC 24
Operating range V DC 17 ... 30
Power consumption at Us W 0.5
Nominal current input mA 20
Release voltage V ≥4
Function display Yellow LED
Protection circuit Varistor
Load side
Mechanical endurance Operating cycles 20 x 106
Electrical endurance at Ie Operating cycles 1 x 105
Switching frequency Operating cycles h-1 5 000
Make-time ms Approx. 7
Break-time ms Approx. 4
Bounce time ms Approx. 2
Contact material AgSnO
Switching voltage AC/DC V 24 ... 250
Permissible residual current of the electronics (with 0 signal) mA 2.5
Control Relays
SIRIUS 3RH2 contactor relays,
3RH2 control relays — size S00
4- and 8-pole
Technical specifications
Contactor relays Type 3RH2
Size S00
Permissible mounting positions
The contactor relays are designed for operation on a 360° 22,5° 22,5°
NSB0_00478c
vertical mounting surface.
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
Upright mounting position
NSB0_00477a
Yes, in the basic unit and the auxiliary switch block as well as between There is positively-driven operation if it is ensured that the NC and NO con-
the basic unit and the front-mounted auxiliary switch block (removable) tacts cannot be closed at the same time.
acc. to:
• ZH 1/457 ZH1/457
• IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix L Safety Rules for Controls on Power-Operated Metalworking Presses.
3RH22:
Yes, in the basic unit and the auxiliary switch block as well as between IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix L
the basic unit and the snap-on auxiliary switch block (permanently Low-Voltage Controlgear, Controls and Contact Blocks. Special requirements
mounted) acc. to: for positively-driven contacts
• ZH 1/457
• IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix L
Note:
3RH29 11- . NF. solid-state compatible auxiliary switch blocks have no
positively-driven contacts.
Contact reliability
Contact reliability at 17 V, 1 mA acc. to IEC 60947-5-4 Frequency of contact faults <10-8 i.e. < 1 fault per 100 million operating
cycles
Contact endurance for AC-15/AC-14 and
DC-13 utilization categories
The contact endurance is mainly dependent on the breaking current. It is 30 NSB0_02061a
assumed that the operating mechanisms are switched randomly, i.e. not Basic unit
synchronized with the phase angle of the supply system.
Million operating cycles (106)
10
If magnetic circuits other than the contactor coil systems or solenoid
valves are present, e.g. magnetic brakes, protective measures for the 5 Basic unit with
4 attachable
load circuits are necessary, e.g. in the form of RC elements and free- 3
wheel diodes. contact block AC-15/AC-14
2
DC-13 DC-13 Basic unit with
The characteristic curves apply to: 1 220 V 110 V attachable
• 3RH21/3RH22 contactor relays
• 3RH24 latched contactor relays 0,5 contact block
• 3RH29 11 auxiliary switch blocks1)
• Auxiliary switch blocks for snapping onto the front, DC-13
max. 4-pole and for mounting onto the side in size S00 24V
0,1
0,05
0,01
0,01 0,03 0,05 0,1 0,3 0,5 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 10 a (A)
e -DC-13 e -DC-13 e -DC-13 e-AC-15
220 V 110 V 24 V < 230 V
Diagram legend:
a = Breaking current
e = Rated operational current
H
Dimensions (W x H x D) with screw terminals mm 45 x 57.5 x 73 -- 90 x 57.5 x 73
• With mounted auxiliary switch block mm 45 x 57.5 x 116 45 x 57.5 x 116 --
D
W
5
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Protection class IP on the front acc. to IEC 60529 IP20, coil assembly IP40
Touch protection on the front acc. to IEC 60529 Finger-safe, for vertical contact from the front
(screw and spring-type terminal)
Shock resistance • Rectangular pulse - AC operation g/ms 7.3/5 and 4.7/10
- DC operation g/ms >10/5 and >5/10
• Sine pulse - AC operation g/ms 11.4/5 and 7.3/10
- DC operation g/ms >15/5 and >8/10
Short-circuit protection
• Short-circuit test with fuse links of gG operational class: A 10
DIAZED, type 5SB; NEOZED, type 5SE
with short-circuit current Ik = 1 kA acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
• Test with miniature circuit breaker up to 230 V with C characteristic: A 6
Short-circuit current Ik = 400 A acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
Conductor cross-sections
Auxiliary conductors and coil terminals Screw terminals
(1 or 2 conductors can be connected)
2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)1); 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1) according to IEC 60947;
• Solid mm
max. 2 x (0.5 ... 4)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)1); 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 16)1); 2 x (18 ... 14)1)
• Terminal screw M3 (for standard screwdriver size 2 or Pozidriv 2)
- Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)
Auxiliary conductors and coil terminals Spring-type terminals
(1 or 2 conductors can be connected)
• Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5; 3.5 x 0.5
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 4)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 12)
Auxiliary conductors for front and laterally mounted auxiliary switches
• Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5; 3.5 x 0.5
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 14)
Auxiliary conductor and coil terminals Ring terminal lug connection
• Terminal screw d3
mm M3, Pozidriv size 2
• Operating devices d2 Nm Ø 5 ... 6
• Tightening torque mm 0.8 ... 1.2
• Usable ring terminal lugs mm d2 = min. 3.2
- DIN 46234 without insulation sleeve mm d3 = max. 7.5
- DIN 46225 without insulation sleeve
- DIN 46237 with insulation sleeve
I2_12740
Control Relays
SIRIUS 3RH2 contactor relays,
3RH2 control relays — size S00
4- and 8-pole
2
At +60 °C 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils
Assemblies
Contactors and
(when coil is cold and 1.0 x Us)
• AC operation, 50 Hz
- Closing VA/p.f. 37/0.8
- Closed VA/p.f. 5.7/0.25
• AC operation, 60 Hz
- Closing VA/p.f. 33/0.75
- Closed VA/p.f. 4.4/0.25
• DC operation W 4.0
(closing = closed)
5
500 V A 2
690 V A 1
Load rating with DC
Rated operational currents Ie
DC-12 for rated operational voltage Us
• 1 conducting path 24 V A 6
60 V A 6
110 V A 3
220 V A 1
5
440 V A 0.3
600 V A 0.15
• 2 conducting paths in series 24 V A 10
60 V A 10
110 V A 4
220 V A 2
440 V A 1.3
600 V A 0.65
• 3 conducting paths in series 24 V A 10
60 V A 10
110 V A 10
220 V A 3.6
440 V A 2.5
600 V A 1.8
DC-13 for rated operational voltage Us
• 1 conducting path 24 V A 6
60 V A 2
110 V A 1
220 V A 0.3
440 V A 0.14
600 V A 0.1
• 2 conducting paths in series 24 V A 10
60 V A 3.5
110 V A 1.3
220 V A 0.9
440 V A 0.2
600 V A 0.1
• 3 conducting paths in series 24 V A 10
60 V A 4.7
110 V A 3
220 V A 1.2
440 V A 0.5
600 V A 0.26
Switching frequency
Switching frequency z in operating cycles/hour
• For rated operation AC-12/DC-12 h-1 1 000
For utilization category AC-15/AC-14 h-1 1 000
DC-13 h-1 1 000
• No-load switching frequency h-1 10 000
Dependence of the switching frequency z' on
the operational current I' and operational voltage U':
z' = z ⋅ Ie/ I' ⋅ (Ue/U')1.5 ⋅ 1/h
s and u rated data
Basic units and auxiliary switch blocks
• Rated control supply voltage V AC max. 600
• Rated voltage V AC 600
• Switching capacity A 600, Q 600
• Uninterrupted current at 240 V AC A 10
Technical specifications
All technical specifications not mentioned in the table below are
identical to those of the 3RH21 contactor relays (see page 5/6).
Contactor type 3RH21 . . - . HB40 3RH21 . . - . JB40 3RH21 . . - . KB40
Size S00 S00 S00
Control circuits
2
Coil operating range 0.7 ... 1.85 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coil
Assemblies
Contactors and
(for cold coil)
Closing = Closed
• At Us = 17 V W 1.4
• At Us = 24 V W 2.8
• At Us = 30 V W 4.4
Permissible residual current < 10 mA x (24 V/Us)
of the electronics for 0 signal
Overvoltage configuration of the solenoid coil No overvoltage damping With diode With suppressor diode
5
Operating times
• Closing at 17 V
- ON-delay NO ms 40 ... 130
- OFF-delay NC ms 30 ... 80
• At 24 V
- ON-delay NO ms 35 ... 60
- OFF-delay NC ms 25 ... 40
• At 30 V
- ON-delay NO ms 25 ... 50
- OFF-delay NC ms 15 ... 30
• Opening at 17 ... 30 V
- OFF-delay NO ms 7 ... 20 38 ... 65 7 ... 20
- ON-delay NC ms 20 ... 30 55 ... 75 20 ... 30
Upright mounting position Request required
Control circuits
Operating times
• Closing at 20.5 V
- ON-delay NO ms 30 ... 120
- OFF-delay NC ms 20 ... 110
• At 24 V
- ON-delay NO ms 25 ... 90
- OFF-delay NC ms 15 ... 80
• At 44 V
- ON-delay NO ms 15 ... 60
- OFF-delay NC ms 10 ... 50
• Closing at 17 ... 30 V
- OFF-delay NO ms 5 ... 20 20 ... 80 5 ... 20
- ON-delay NC ms 10 ... 30 30 ... 90 10 ... 30
Upright mounting position Request required
• 40 = 4 NO
Selection guide for mountable auxiliary switch blocks for power contactors and contactor relays
The auxiliary switch blocks of the 3RH29 series for mounting on Where the columns and lines intersect (blue and green in the
the front and side can be used for power contactors as well as example) you will find the identification number for the combina-
for contactor relays. tion of basic unit (column) and auxiliary switch block (line).
The possible combinations of basic unit and mounted auxiliary
switch block can be found in the tables below.
SIRIUS
3. 4. 5. 6.
13 21 A1
14 22 14 22 SIRIUS
1 3 5 13 A1
2. 3. 4. 5.
2. 3. 4. 5. 5. 6. 7. 8. 3. 4. 5. 6.
According to EN 500121) Order No.
Auxiliary switches without NO contact 3. 4. 5. 6.
-- 1 .1 11 02 12 3RH29 11-.HA01 14 22 A2
NSB0_02124
NSB0_02112
NSB0_02114
2. 3. 4. 5.
2 4 6
2 4 6 14 A2
.2
Sequence 2. 3. 4. 5. 3. 4. 5. 6.
-- 2 .1 .1 12 03 13 3RH29 11-.HA02 digit
NSB0_02125
-- 3 .1 .1 .1 13 04 14 3RH29 11-.HA03
NSB0_02126
NSB0_02116
IC01_00131
.2 .2 .2
.2 .2 .2 .2 .2 .2 .2
digit .2 .2 .2 .2 .2 .2 .2
Type 3RT20 motor contactor, S00 3RT20 motor contactor, S0
.2 .2 .2 .2 with auxiliary switch block with auxiliary switch block
13 21 A1
SIRIUS
13 A1
4. 5. .1 .1 .1
2. 3.
.4
.1 .1 .1 .1
1 1 .1 .3 21 12 22 3RH29 11-.HA11
NSB0_02128
.2 .2 .2
14 22 A2
NSB0_02120
.2 .2 .2 .2
IC01_00132
.2 .4 14 A2
Terminal 13 21 31 41 51 13 21 31 41 51
design. 14 22 32 42 52 14 22 32 42 52
1) Combinations according to EN 50012, EN 50011 and IEC 60947-5-1
are in bold print. All combinations comply with EN 50005. Type Ident. No. 14 Ident. No. 14
2
3-pole contactors 4-pole contactors Contactor relays
Assemblies
Contactors and
Auxiliary contacts S00 S0 S00 S0/S2 S00
Version 3RT20 1 3RT20 1 3RT20 2 3RT23 1 3RT25 1 3RT23 3RT25 3RH21, 3RH24 3RH21, 3RH24 3RH21, 3RH24
NO NC 10 01 11 -- -- 11 11 40E 31E 22E
13 21 13 21 13 21 13 21 13 23 33 43 13 21 33 43 13 21 31 43
NSB0_00534a
NSB0_00534a
NSB0_00534a
IC01_00124
IC01_00125
IC01_00126
IC01_00123
IC01_00122
14 22 14 22 14 22 14 22 14 24 34 44 14 22 34 44 14 22 32 44
2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 3. 4. 5. 1. 2. 3. 1. 2. 3. 3. 4. 5. 3. 4. 5. 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8
5. 8. 6. 4. 4. 6. 6.
Front auxiliary switches According to EN 500121) According to EN 500121) According to EN 500111) Order No.
Without NO contact
-- 1 .1 11 02 12 01 01 12 12 41X 32X 23X 3RH29 11-.HA01
NSB0_02124
.2
.2 .2
-- 3 .1 .1 .1 13 04 14 03 -- -- -- 43 34 -- 3RH29 11-.HA03
NSB0_02126
.2 .2 .2
.2 .2 .2 .2
With 1 NO contact
1 -- .3 20 11 21 10 10 21 21 50E 41E 32E 3RH29 11-.HA10
NSB0_02127
.4
.2 .4
1 2 .1 .1 .3 22 13 23 12 12 23 -- 52 43 34 3RH29 11-.HA12
NSB0_02129
.2 .2 .4
.2 .2 .2 .4
With 2 NO contacts
2 -- .3 .3 30 21 31 20 20 31 31 60E 51X 42X 3RH29 11-.HA20
NSB0_02131
.4 .4
2 1 .1 .3 .3 31 22 32 21 21 32 32 61 52 43 3RH29 11-.HA21
NSB0_02132
.2 .4 .4
.2 .2 .4 .4
.4 .2 .2 .4
NSB0_00534a
NSB0_00534a
NSB0_00534a
2
IC01_00124
IC01_00125
IC01_00126
IC01_00123
IC01_00122
14 22 14 22 14 22 14 22 14 24 34 44 14 22 34 44 14 22 32 44
Contactors and
Assemblies
2. 3. 4. 5. 5. 6. 7. 8. 3. 4. 5. 6. 1. 2. 3. 4. 1. 2. 3. 4. 3. 4. 5. 6. 3. 4. 5. 6. 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8
According to EN 500121) According to EN 500121) According to EN 500111) Order No.
Front auxiliary switches with 3 NO contacts
3 -- .3 .3 .3 40 31 41 30 30 41 41 70 61 52 3RH29 11-.HA30
NSB0_02134
.4 .4 .4
.2 .4 .4 .4
.4 .4 .4 .4
.8 .6
-- 2 .3 .1 .5 .7 32 23 33 22 22 33 -- 62 53 44 3RH29 11-.FB22
NSB0_02145
.4 .2 .6 .8
-- 3 .7 .7 .5 .5 32 23 33 22 22 33 -- 62 53 44 3RH29 11-.FC22
NSB0_02146
.8 .8 .6 .6
74
1 -- 73 20 11 21 10 10 21 21 50 41 32 3RH29 11-1BA10
IC01_00127
74
-- 1 71 11 02 12 01 01 12 12 41 32 23 3RH29 11-1AA01
IC01_00128
72
-- 1 71 11 02 12 01 01 12 12 41 32 23 3RH29 11-1BA01
IC01_00128
72
1 1 73 81 21 12 22 11 11 22 22 51 42 33 3RH29 11-1LA11
NSB0_02150
74 82
1 1 73 81 21 12 22 11 11 22 22 51 42 33 3RH29 11-1MA11
NSB0_02150
74 82
2 -- 73 83 30 21 31 20 20 31 31 60 51 42 3RH29 11-1LA20
NSB0_02151
74 84
2 -- 73 83 30 21 31 20 20 31 31 60 51 42 3RH29 11-1MA20
NSB0_02151
74 84
1) Combinations according to EN 50012, EN 50011 and IEC 60947- 2) Terminals from the top or bottom.
5-1 are in bold print. All combinations comply with EN 50005.
2
13 21 13 21 13 21 13 21 13 23 33 43 13 21 33 43 13 21 31 43
NSB0_00534a
NSB0_00534a
NSB0_00534a
IC01_00124
IC01_00125
IC01_00126
IC01_00123
IC01_00122
14 22 14 22 14 22 14 22 14 24 34 44 14 22 34 44 14 22 32 44
Assemblies
Contactors and
2. 3. 4. 5. 5. 6. 7. 8. 3. 4. 5. 6. 1. 2. 3. 4. 1. 2. 3. 4. 3. 4. 5. 6. 3. 4. 5. 6. 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8
Acc. to EN 50005 Acc. to EN 50005 According to EN 500111) Order No.
Front auxiliary switches with complete inscription (for contactor relays)
4 -- 53 63 73 83 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 80E -- -- 3RH29 11-.GA40
NSB0_02156
54 64 74 84
54 62 74 84
54 62 72 84
54 62 72 82
52 62 72 82
-0MA0
54 64 74 84
-0MA0
54 62 74 84
-0MA0
54 62 72 84
-0MA0
52 62 72 82
.2 .2
1 1 .3 .1 21 12 22 11 11 22 22 51 42 33 3RH29 11-.NF11
NSB0_02147
.4 .2
2 -- .3 .3 30 21 31 20 20 31 31 60 51 42 3RH29 11-.NF20
IC01_00134
.4 .4
NSB0_00534a
NSB0_00534a
NSB0_00534a
IC01_00124
IC01_00125
IC01_00126
IC01_00123
IC01_00122
2
14 22 14 22 14 22 14 22 14 24 34 44 14 22 34 44 14 22 32 44
Contactors and
Assemblies
2. 3. 4. 5. 5. 6. 7. 8. 3. 4. 5. 6. 1. 2. 3. 4. 1. 2. 3. 4. 3. 4. 5. 6. 3. 4. 5. 6. 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8
Left Right According to EN 500121) According to EN 500121) According to EN 500111) Order No.
Lateral auxiliary switches for size S00
-- 2 41 51 21 31 12 -- -- 02 02 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA02
NSB0_02136
42 52 22 32
Anbau Anbau
-- 2 41 51
links 21 31
rechts 14 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA02
NSB0_02136
42 52 22 32
Anbau Anbau
1 1 41 53
links 21 33
rechts 21 -- -- 11 11 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA11
NSB0_02137
42 54 22 34
1 1 Anbau
41 53 Anbau
21 33 32 -- -- 22 22 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA11
NSB0_02137
links rechts
42 54 22 34
2 -- Anbau
43 53 Anbau
23 33 30 -- -- 20 20 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA20
NSB0_02138
links rechts
44 54 24 34
2 -- Anbau
43
4353
53 Anbau
23
233333 50 -- -- 40 40 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA20
NSB0_02138
NSB0_02138
links rechts
44
44 54
54 24
24 34
34
2 -- Anbau
Anbau
41435353 Anbau
Anbau
21
233333 41 -- -- 31 31 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA20 +
NSB0_02137
NSB0_02138
links
links rechts
rechts
3RH29 11-.DA11
1 1 4244 5454 2224 3434
Anbau Anbau
Anbau
2 -- 4143 51
53 2123 31
33 32 -- -- 22 22 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA20 +
NSB0_02136
NSB0_02138
links rechts
rechts
3RH29 11-.DA02
-- 2 4244 5254 2224 3234
Anbau Anbau
Anbau
1 1 41 53
51 21 31
33 23 -- -- 13 -- -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA11 +
NSB0_02136
NSB0_02137
links rechts
rechts
3RH29 11-.DA02
-- 2 42 52
54 22 32
34
Anbau Anbau
Lateral auxiliary
links
switches for size S0
rechts
-- 2 51 61 31 41 12 03 13 02 02 13 -- -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA02
NSB0_02139
52 62 32 42
Anbau Anbau
-- 2 51
51 61
61 31
31 41
41 14 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA02
NSB0_02139
NSB0_02139
links rechts
52
52 62
62 32
32 42
42
Anbau
Anbau Anbau
Anbau
1 1 51 63 31 43 21 12 22 11 11 22 22 -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA11
NSB0_02140
links
links rechts
rechts
52 64 32 44
1 1 Anbau
51 63 Anbau
31 43 32 23 33 22 22 33 -- -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA11
NSB0_02140
links rechts
52 64 32 44
Anbau Anbau 3RH29 21-.DA20
2 -- 53 63 33 43 30 21 31 20 20 31 31 -- -- --
NSB0_02141
links rechts
54 64 34 44
Anbau Anbau 3RH29 21-.DA20
2 -- 53
53 63
63 33
33 43
43 50 41 51 40 40 51 51 -- -- --
NSB0_02141
NSB0_02141
links rechts
54
54 64
64 34
34 44
44
Anbau
Anbau Anbau
Anbau
1) Combinations
links according
links rechtsto EN 50012, EN 50011 and IEC 60947-
rechts
5-1 are in bold print. All combinations comply with EN 50005.
NSB0_00534a
NSB0_00534a
NSB0_00534a
2
IC01_00126
IC01_00125
IC01_00124
IC01_00122
IC01_00123
14 22 14 22 14 22 14 22 14 24 34 44 14 22 34 44 14 22 32 44
Assemblies
Contactors and
2. 3. 4. 5. 5. 6. 7. 8. 3. 4. 5. 6. 1. 2. 3. 4. 1. 2. 3. 4. 3. 4. 5. 6. 3. 4. 5. 6. 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8
Left Right According to EN 500121) According to EN 500121) According to EN 500111) Order No.
Lateral auxiliary switches for size S0, S00
2 -- 51 53
63 63 43 4341
31 33 32 42 31 31 42 42 -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA20 +
NSB0_02140
NSB0_02141
3RH29 21-.DA11
1 1
52 54
64 64 32 34
44 44
2 -- Anbau
Anbau
51 5361 63
Anbau
Anbau
31 3341 4332 23 33 22 22 33 -- -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA20 +
NSB0_02139
NSB0_02141
links
links rechts
rechts
3RH29 21-.DA02
-- 2
52 5462 64 32 3442 44
1 1 Anbau
Anbau Anbau
Anbau23 14 24 13 -- -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA11 +
5151 6163 313341
41
NSB0_02139
NSB0_02140
links
links rechts
rechts
3RH29 21-.DA02
-- 2
5252 6264 323442
42
LateralAnbau
Anbau
auxiliary
links
links
Anbau
Anbau
switches
rechts
rechts
for contactor relays
-- 2 51 61 31 41 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 42Z 33X 24 3RH29 21-.DA02
NSB0_02139
52 62 32 42
links rechts
52 64 32 44
links rechts
54 64 34 44
Anbau
Lateral auxiliary Anbau
switches, Solid-state compatible for size S00
links rechts
1 1 41 53 23 31 21 -- -- 11 11 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-2DE11
NSB0_02137
42 54 24 32
links rechts
52 64 34 42
links rechts
LateralAnbau
Anbau
auxiliary
links
links
Anbau
Anbau
switches,
rechts
rechts
Solid-state compatible for contactor relays
1 1 51 63 33 41 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 51X 42X 33X 3RH29 21-.DE11
NSB0_02140
52 64 34 42
Anbau
1) Combinations Anbau
links according
rechts to EN 50012, EN 50011 and IEC 60947-
5-1 are in bold print. All combinations comply with EN 50005.
Internal circuit diagrams (applicable to screw, spring and ring lug connection)
Sizes S3 to S12 Contactors with 4 main contacts, sizes S3
Terminal designations according to EN 50 012 Terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005
3RT10 4 to 3RT10 7, 3RT12, 3RT14 contactors 3RT13/23 and 3RT15/25 contactors
4 NO 2 NO + 2 NC
-Q A1 1/L1 3/L2 5/L3 13 21
NO NC
2
NO NC
Contactors and
Assemblies
2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 14 22 (3RH19 21 auxiliary switch blocks acc. to EN 50 005 can be snapped on)
F0 F0
1/L1
5/L3
3/L2
1/L1
5/L3
3/L2
A1 A1
A2
2/T1
4/T2
6/T3
A2
2/T1
4/T2
6/T3
52 62 52 64
IC01_00374
IC01_00375
Ident. no. 31 22 22 13
C1 C1
Surge suppressor (plug-in direction coded; exception: marked +/– for 3RT19 16-1T... diode assembly) for sizes S2 to S3
Diode Diode assembly Varistor RC element Diode with LED Varistor with LED
1) 3RH29 auxiliaries are intended to be used only with 3RT2 or 3RH2 base devices.
3RH19 auxiliaries are intended to be used only with 3RT1 or 3RH1 base devices.
2) Not for 3RT12. vacuum contactors
Internal circuit diagrams (applicable to screw connection and Spring-type terminal connection)
Accessories for size S61) to S12 contactors
Terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005
3RH19 21-.F..., 4-pole,
for snapping onto the front 1)
4 NO 3 NO + 1 NC 2 NO + 2 NC 4 NC 2 NO + 2 NC
Ident. no. 40 31 22 04 22 U
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
make-before-break
3RH19 21- . CA.. auxiliary switch blocks, single-pole, 3RH19 21-1CD.. auxiliary switch blocks, single-pole,
for snapping onto the front 2) with make-before-break contacts, for snapping onto the front 1)
1 NO 1 NC 1 NO 1 NC
Example: 1 NO + 1 NC,
cable entry from below
3RH19 21- . EA.. first laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (left) 3RH19 21- . EA.. first laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (right)
2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC 2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC
3RH19 21- . KA.. second laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (left) 3RH19 21- . KA.. second laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (right)
(only for sizes S3 to S12) (only for sizes S3 to S12)
2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC 2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC
1) RH29 auxiliaries are intended to be used only with 3RT2 or 3RH2 base devices.
3RH19 auxiliaries are intended to be used only with 3RT1 or 3RH1 base devices.
2) Not for 3RT12. vacuum contactors
Circuit diagrams
Accessories for size S3 contactors and control relays
Solid-state time-delay blocks
(see configuring aid on page 2/38)
3RT19 16-2C... 3RT19 16-2D... Sizes S2 to S12
ON-delay OFF-delay (with auxiliary voltage) 3RT19 16-2E.../2F.../2G... solid-state, time-delay auxiliary switch blocks
Size S00 Size S00
1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NO
2
Time-delay block
Contactor
A2 can be connected to
N(L–) via either the contac-
tor or the time-delay relay.
- - - optional connection
Q Q
16 18 16 18
A2 A2
N(-) N(-)
3RA2813-.FW10 L1(+) 3RA2815-.FW10 L1(+)
ON-delay, S1 OFF-delay without S1
1 NC contact/ A1 auxillary voltage, A1
1 NO contact 27 35 1 NC contact/ 27 35
1 NO contact
Q Q
28 36 28 36
A2 A2
N(-) N(-)
3RT29 accessories are intended to be used only with 3RT2 or 3RH2 base devices.
3RT19 auxiliaries are intended to be used only with 3RT1 or 3RH1 base devices.
Circuit diagrams
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
The 3RA2913-2AA. (S00) and 3RA2913-2AA (S0)
installation kit contains wiring connectors for
connecting the main conducting paths, the
mechanical interlock and two connecting clips
for the contactors.
The 3RA19 .3-2A installation kits contain, among The 3RA19 24-2B mechanical interlock contains one NC
other things, the wiring connectors on the top and contact for the NC contact interlock for each contactor
bottom for connecting the main conducting paths.
Position of terminals
Sizes S2 to S3
Terminal designations according to EN 50 005
3RA19 24-2B mechanical interlock (laterally mountable),
integrated in reversing contactor assemblies (reversing starters),
contains one NC contact for the electrical interlock for each contactor
2 NC
S0 "OFF" button
S1 "Clockwise ON" button
S2 "Counterclockwise ON" button
S "CW-OFF-CCW" button
K1 Clockwise contactor
K2 Counterclockwise contactor
F1 Fuses for main circuit
F3 Fuses for control circuit
F2 Overload relay
Circuit diagrams
Size S00 / S0 Control circuits
Main circuit with 3RA2816-0EW20 function module (set of three)
snapped onto the front
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
Sizes S2 to S3 3RA2816-0EW20
Main circuit
Sizes S2 and S3
s
Control circuits
with 3RP15 7. time-delay relay,
laterally mounted (typical circuits)
for momentary-contact operation for maintained-contact operation
S0 "OFF" button
S1 "ON" button
S Maintained-contact switch
K1 Line contactor
K2 Star contactor
K3 Delta contactor
K4 Solid-state, time-delay auxiliary switch
block or time-delay relay
F0 Fuses
F1 Overload relay
Contact element 17/18 is only closed on the star step; the contact element is open
on the delta step and when de-energized.
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
Auxiliary switch blocks Auxiliary switch blocks Auxiliary switch blocks Auxiliary switch blocks
3TY7 681-1G 3TY7 561-1AA00 3TY7 561-1KA00 3TY7 561-1EA00
for coil reconnection, first auxiliary switch block second auxiliary switch block with make-before-break contacts
3TF68 and 3TF69, left or right left or right
DC economy circuit mounted on left mounted on right mounted on left mounted on right mounted on left mounted on right
Terminal diagrams
DC operation
L+ is to be connected to coil terminal A1.
3RH21 coupling relays for auxiliary circuits,
size S00
Terminal designations according to EN 50 011
(it is not possible to snap on an auxiliary switch block)
2
Diode integrated
4 NO 3 NO + 1 NC 2 NO + 2 NC
Ident no.:40E 31E 22E
Position of terminals
Size S00
3RH21 coupling relays
4 NO 3 NO + 1 NC 2 NO + 2 NC
Ident no.: 40E 31E 22E
3RH19 21- . DA11 first laterally 3RH19 21- . JA11 second laterally
mountable auxiliary switch mountable auxiliary switch
block 1) block 1)
mountable on left or right mountable on left or right
(only for sizes S3 to S12)
1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC
left right left right
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RH21 40 control relays
with 3RH19 11-1GA.. auxiliary switch blocks snapped onto the front
8 NO 7 NO + 1 NC 6 NO + 2 NC 5 NO + 3 NC
Ident no.:80E 71E 62E 53E
4 NO + 4 NC
Ident no.:44E
2 NO + 2 NC
Ident no.: 22E
2 NO + 3 NC 3 NO + 2 NC
Ident. no.: 23 32
Size S0 Size S2
Terminal designations according to EN 50 012 Terminal designations according to EN 50 012
3RT20 2 Contactors with 1NO + 1NC 3RT20 2 Contactors 3RT20 3 Contactors with 1NO + 1NC 3RT20 3 Contactors
3RT20 2 Coupling Relays with 3NO + 3NC 3RT20 3 Coupling Relays with 3NO + 3NC
1/L1 3/L2 5/L3 1/L1 3/L2 5/L3 1/L1 3/L2 5/L3 1/L1 3/L2 5/L3
13 21 A1 13 21 A1 13 21 A1 13 21 A1
1 1 3 3 1 1 3 3
2 2 4 4 2 2 4 4
14 22 A2 14 22 A2 14 22 A2 14 22 A2
2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 2/T1 4/T2 6/T3
2
Ident. no. 40 31 22 04 22 U
Assemblies
Contactors and
make-before-break
3RH19 21-1LA.. auxiliary switch blocks, 2-pole, 3RH19 21-1MA.. auxiliary switch blocks, 2-pole,
for snapping onto the front, cable entry from above for snapping onto the front, cable entry from below
2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC 2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC
Position of terminals
Accessories for size S2 to S12 contactors
Terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005
3RH19 21- . EA.. first laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (left) 3RH19 21- . EA.. first laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (right)
2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC 2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
3RH19 21- . KA.. second laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (left) 3RH19 21- . KA.. second laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (right)
(only for sizes S3 to S12; can only be used if no auxiliary (only for sizes S3 to S12; can only be used if no auxiliary
switches are snapped onto the front) switches are snapped onto the front)
2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC 2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC
The auxiliary switch block comprises 3 leading contacts The auxiliary switch block comprises 3 leading contacts
(not shown) and one unassigned NO contact. (not shown) and one unassigned NO contact.
with conventional op. mechanism with solid-state op. mechanism with solid-state op. mechanism
(3RT1. ..-.A...) (3RT1. ..-.N...) (3RT1. ..-.P...)
with laterally mountable auxiliary with laterally mountable auxiliary with laterally mountable auxiliary
2
switch blocks 3RH19 21-1DA11 switch blocks 3RH19 21-1DA11 switch blocks 3RH19 21-1DA11
(for 2 NO + 2 NC, incl. in contactor) (for 2 NO + 2 NC, incl. in contactor) (for 1 NO + 1 NC, incl. in contactor)
3RH19 21-1JA11 3RH19 21-1JA11 3RH19 21-1JA11
Assemblies
Contactors and
(expandable to 4 NO + 4 NC) (expandable to 4 NO + 4 NC) (expandable to 2 NO + 2 NC)
2 NO + 2 NC or 4 NO + 4 NC 2 NO + 2 NC or 4 NO + 4 NC 1 NO + 1 NC or 2 NO + 2 NC
Contactors with 4 main contacts, size S00 Contactors with 4 main contacts, sizes S2 to S3
Terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005 Terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005
3RT23 and 3RT25 contactor s 3RT13 and 3RT15 contactors
4 NO 2 NO + 2 NC 4 NO 2 NO + 2 NC
Size S0 with
integrated
1NO + 1NC aux
(13/14 + 21/22)
and only one set
of A1+A2 on front
Position of terminals
AC operation DC operation Solid-state compatible auxiliary switch blocks
3TY7 561-1 . for lateral mounting onto
3TF68 and 3TF69 contactors 3TF68 and 3TF69 contactors
size 6 to 14 contactors
4 NO + 4 NC 3 NO + 3 NC
max. complement of auxiliary
switches
mounted mounted
2
on left on right
Contactors and
Assemblies
Dimension drawings
3RT2.1.-1 contactor and 3RH21..-1 contactor relays
Size S00 and NEMA Size 0, screw connection Lateral clearance from
with surge suppressor and auxiliary switch block earthed parts = 6 mm
2
5 35
1) Laterally mountable
Assemblies
Contactors and
auxiliary switch block
3RH2911-1DA.. / -1DE.. /
50
-1EE..
2) Auxiliary switch block for
mounting on the front
3RH2911-1FA.. / -1GA.. /
-1HA.. / -1NF..
5 35
1) Laterally mountable
auxiliary switch block
3RH2911-2DA.. / -2DE.. /
50
-2EE..
2) Auxiliary switch block for
mounting on the front
3RH2911-2FA.. / -2GA.. /
-2HA.. / -2NF..
1) Laterally mountable
auxiliary switch block
3RH2921-1DA.. / -1DE..
2) Auxiliary switch block for
mounting on the front
3RH2911-1FA.. / -1GA.. /
-1HA.. / -1NF..
3) 3-phase infeed terminal
3RV2925-5AB
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax
Dimension drawings
3RT2.2.-2 and 3RT202.-.....-0LA2 contactors
Size S0 (spring-loaded connection) with auxiliary switch blocks mounted
2
1) Laterally mountable
auxiliary switch block
3RH2921-2DA.. / -2DE..
2) Auxiliary switch block for
mounting on the front
3RH2911-2FA.. / -2GA.. /
-2HA.. / -2NF..
3RT20 3 contactors
Size S2 and NEMA Size 2, screw connection
with surge suppressor, auxiliary switch blocks and mounted overload relay
130
55 125 45
5
1/ L1 3/ L2 5/ L3
56.7
A1
21NC
13NO
11
113.4
97.5
14NO
22NC
3. 4. 5. 6. A2
3RT20
2.5
2/ T1 4/ T2 6/ T3
8
4.9
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax
For size S2:
a = 0 mm with varistor < 240 V, diode assembly
a = 3.5 mm with varistor > 240 V
a = 17 mm with RC element
b = DC 15 mm deeper than AC
1) Auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable
2) Auxiliary switch block, mountable on the front
(1, 2 and 4-pole)
3) Surge suppressor
4) Drilling pattern
Dimension drawings
3RT20 3 contactors
Size S2, Spring-type terminal connection
with surge suppressor, auxiliary switch blocks and mounted overload relay
130
55 125 45
5
2
1/ L1 3/ L2 5/ L3
Assemblies
Contactors and
56.7
A1
21NC
13NO
11
113.4
97.5
14NO
22NC
3. 4. 5. 6.
A2
3RT20
2.5
2/ T1 4/ T2 6/ T3
8
4.9
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax For size S2:
a = 0 mm with varistor < 240 V, diode assembly
a = 3.5 mm with varistor > 240 V
a = 17 mm with RC element
b = DC 15 mm deeper than AC
1) Auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable
2) Auxiliary switch block, mountable on the front
(1, 2 and 4-pole)
3RT20 4, 3RT24 46 contactors Lateral clearance from
3) Surge suppressor
Size S3 and NEMA Size 3, screw connection earthed parts = 6 mm
4) Drilling pattern
with surge suppressor, auxiliary switch blocks
and mounted overload relay
Dimension drawings
3RT20 4 contactors,
Size S3, Spring-type terminal connection
with surge suppressor, auxiliary switch blocks
and mounted overload relay
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
Dimension drawings
3RT10 5, 3RT14 5 contactors
Size S6 and NEMA Size 4
with auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable and mountable on the front,
mounted overload relay and box terminals,
laterally mounted electronics module with remaining lifetime indication
2
Clearance from earthed parts with
directly mounted overload relay:
lateral: 10 mm
Assemblies
Contactors and
front: 20 mm
Drilling pattern
Dimension drawings
3RT10 6, 3RT14 6 contactors
Size S10
with auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable and mountable on the front,
mounted overload relay and box terminals,
laterally mounted electronics module with remaining lifetime indication
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
Drilling pattern
Drilling pattern
Dimension drawings
3RT10 contactors with integrated safety
Size S6
$ $
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
/ / /
1& 1&
1& 1&
12 12
12 12
12 12
12 12
1& 1&
1& 1&
7 7 7
Size S10
$ $
/ / /
1& 1&
1& 1&
12 12
12 12
12 12
12 12
1& 1&
1& 1&
7 7 7
Size S12
$ $
/ / /
1& 1&
1& 1&
12 12
12 12
12 12
12 12
1& 1&
1& 1&
7 7 7
Dimension drawings
3RT12 6 vacuum contactors
Size S10
with auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable,
mounted overload relay and box terminals,
laterally mounted electronics module with remaining lifetime indication
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
Drilling pattern
Detail
Contact erosion indicator for vacuum interrupters
Drilling pattern
Dimension drawings
3RT23 1 and 3RT25 1 contactors Lateral clearance from
Size S00, screw connection earthed parts = 6 mm
with surge suppressor and auxiliary switch block
2
3RH2911-1DA.. / -1DE.. /
-1EE..
Assemblies
Contactors and
2) Auxiliary switch block for
mounting on the front
50
3RH2911-1FA.. / -1GA.. /
-1HA.. / -1NF..
21NC
A1
mountable (right or left)
13NO
2) Auxiliary switch block, mountable
11 on the front, (1, 2 and 4-pole,
113.4
compatible design)
3) Surge suppressor
14NO
22NC 4) Drilling pattern
3. 4. 5. 6. A2
5) For mounting on 35 mm standard
3RT23 mounting rail (15 mm deep) acc.
2.5
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax
Dimension drawings
3RT16 17 capacitor contactors
Size S00
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax
Dimension drawings
Size S00 / 3RA231
90 73
37
2
67.5
Assemblies
Contactors and
5
Size S0 / 3RA232
90 97
53
101
1/ L1 3/ L2 5/ L3 1/ L1 3/ L2 5/ L3
72.9
A1 A1
21NC 21NC
13NO 13NO
140.6
11 11
14NO 14NO
22NC 22NC
3. 4. 5. 6. A2 3. 4. 5. 6. A2
3RT20 3RT20
2/ T1 4/ T2 6/ T3 2/ T1 4/ T2 6/ T3
Size S3 / 3RA234
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax
Dimension drawings
Size S6
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
Size S10
The assemblies shown on this page are for customer assembly with individual components.
Dimension drawings
Size S12
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
M10x30
(3x)
2.1
2.2
2.3
6
2
7 M10x35
944
RA -00 (3x)
3RA1953-2A
R A - 0 1 0 27
3RA1963-2A 1)
RA-01027a
3RA1973-2A 2)
1
) 3RT1.6
M10x30 2
) 3RT1.7
6 (3x)
M10x35
(3x) 1.1
1.2
The assemblies shown on this page are for customer assembly with individual components. 1.3
Dimension drawings
3TF68 vacuum contactors 3TF69 vacuum contactors
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
Detail Detail
A = Contact erosion indicator for vacuum interrupter contacts A = Contact erosion indicator for vacuum interrupter contacts
t = minimum clearance from insulated components: 15 mm (600 V and 750 V) t = minimum clearance from insulated components: 15 mm (600 V),
20 mm (750 V)
from grounded components: 30 mm (600 V and 750 V) from grounded components: 35 mm (600 V),
55 mm (750 V)
a b a b c
DC operation 109 141 DC operation 112 180 21.5
AC operation 68 100 AC operation 86 154 23.5
2
2
t = minimum clearance from insulated components: 20 mm (600 V and 750 V) t = minimum clearance from insulated components: 25 mm (600 V and 750 V)
from grounded components: 70 mm (600 V and 750 V) from grounded components: 80 mm (600 V),
100 mm (750 V)
a b a b
DC operation 147 232 DC operation 200 310
AC operation 115 200 AC operation 141 251
Dimension drawings
Terminal cover for box terminals Terminal cover for box terminals
for size S2, for size S3,
3RT29 36-4EA2 3RT19 46-4EA2
2
Assemblies
Contactors and
Terminal cover for cable lug and bar connection Auxiliary conductor terminal, 3-pole
for size S3, 3RT19 46-4F
3RT19 46-4EA1 Size S3
mounted on contactor
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax
Dimension drawings
A B C D E
S6 190 205 250 229 9
S10 240 249 300 275 11
S12 280 249 330 275 11
3RA19.2-2E, 3RA19.2-2F
baseplates for star-delta assemblies
A B C D E
S6-S6-S3 316 205 376 229 9
S6-S6-S6 343 205 403 229 9
S10-S10-S6 393 250 453 275 11
S10-S10-S10 423 250 483 275 11
S12-S12-S10 450 250 510 275 11
S12-S12-S12 465 250 525 275 11
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax
Dimension drawings
3RH21 control relays
Size S00, with screw connections 73
Lateral clearance from
5 35 earthed parts = 6 mm
2
50
Assemblies
Contactors and
7.5
Dimension drawings
Size S00, with screw connections,
with surge suppressor
104.5
45 73 35 1) Surge suppressor
5 2) Drilling pattern
Deviating dimensions for
coupling relays with Spring-type
29.8
terminal connections
57.5
Height: 69.5 mm
50
5 1.2
3.8
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax
Notes
2 Assemblies
Contactors and
contents
Thermal overload relays Solid state overload relays
3 SIRIUS
Section
3
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RU21 overload relays up to 100 A 3RB24 overload relays up to 630A
with screw connection, CLASS 10 with IO-Link current monitoring
Page Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• Basic Unit 3/10 • Basic Unit 3/51
• Accessories 3/11 • Accessories 3/55
Description 3/8 - 3/9 Description 3/52 - 3/53
Technical data 3/12 - 3/14 Technical data 3/58 - 3/62
Circuit diagrams 3/15
Dimension drawings 3/16 - 3/17
(Section was last modified on 08/19/21) Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/1
Overload Relays
Overload Relays
General data
General data
Overview
Overload Relays
Overload Relays
General data
General data
3
the device
Remote RESET • Allows the remote resetting of the device
function (by means of (only with (only with (electrically via (electrically
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
separate mod- 3RB31 3RB21 external but- with button or
ule) and external and external ton) via IO-Link)
auxiliary volt- auxiliary volt-
age 24 V DC) age 24 V DC)
TEST function • Allows easy checking of the function and
for auxiliary wiring
contacts
TEST function — • Allows checking of the electronics
for electronics
Status display • Displays the current operating state
Large current • Makes it easier to set the relay exactly to
adjustment the correct current value
button
Integrated auxil- -- • Allows the load to be switched off if neces-
7
iary contacts (2 ×) sary
(1 NO + 1 NC) • Can be used to output signals
Integrated auxil- — — — — • Enables the controlling of contactors
iary contacts directly from the higher-level control sys-
(1 CO and 1 NO tem through IO-Link
in series)
IO-Link — — — — • Reduction of wiring in the control cabinet
connection • Enables communication
Connection of — — — — • Enables local operation
optional hand-
held device
n capability
Communication capability through IO-Link
Full starter — — — — • Enables in combination with the
functionality SIRIUS 3RT contactors the assembly of
through IO-Link communication-capable motor starters
(direct-on-line, reversing and wye-delta
starting)
Reading out of — — — — • Enables the reading out of diagnostics in-
diagnostics formation such as overload, open circuit,
functions ground fault, etc.
Reading out of — — — — • Enables the reading out of current values
current values and their direct processing in the higher-
level control system
Reading out all — — — — • Enables the reading out of all set parame-
set parameters ters, e.g. for plant documentation
Available
— Not available
Siemens IC 10 · 2012
IC10_07_08.fm Page 74 Monday, October 7, 2013 7:09 PM
General data
(in conjunction
with the corre-
sponding fuses
or the corre-
sponding motor
starter protector)
Electrical and 1) 1)
• Simplifies configuration
mechanical • Reduces wiring outlay and costs
matching to
3RT contactors • Enables stand-alone installation as well as
space-saving direct mounting
Straight- — • Reduces the contact resistance
through trans- (S2, S3) (S3 to S6) (S00 ... S6) (S00 ... S6) (only one point of contact)
formers for • Saves wiring costs
main circuit2) (easy, no need for tools, and fast)
(in this case the
7
General data
3
compensation peratures without derating
• Prevents premature tripping
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
• Allows compact installation of the control
cabinet without distance between the de-
vices/load feeders
Very high long- • Provides safe protection for the loads
term stability even after years of use
in severe operating conditions
Wide setting — • Minimize the configuration outlay and
ranges (1:4) (1:4) (1:10) (1:10) costs
• Minimize storage overheads, storage
costs, tied-up capital
Fixed trip class CLASS 10 3RB30: 3RB20: • Optimum motor protection for standard
CLASS 10A CLASS 10E or CLASS 10 or starts
CLASS 20E CLASS 20
Trip classes — 3RB31: 3RB21: • Enables solutions for very fast starting mo-
adjustable on
7
tors requiring special protection
the device (e.g. Ex motors)
CLASS 5, 10, 20, • Enables heavy starting solutions
30
• Reduces the number of versions
Low power loss — • Reduces energy consumption and energy
costs (up 98 % less energy is used than
for thermal overload relays).
• Minimizes temperature rises of the con-
tactor and control cabinet – in some cases
this may eliminate the need for control-
gear cabinet cooling.
• Direct mounting to contactor saves space,
even for high motor currents (i.e. no heat
decoupling is required).
Internal power —1) — — • Eliminates the need for configuration and
supply connecting an additional control circuit
Supplied from — — — • Eliminates the need for configuration and
an external volt- connecting an additional control circuit
age through
IO-Link
Overload — — — • Indicates imminent tripping of the relay di-
warning rectly on the device due to overload,
phase unbalance or phase failure through
flickering of the LEDs or in the case of the
3RB24 as a signal through IO-Link
• Allows the imminent tripping of the relay to
be signaled
• Allows measures to be taken in time in the
event of inverse-time delayed overloading
of the load for an extended period over the
current limit
Analog output — — — • Allows the output of an analog output sig-
nal for actuating moving-coil instruments,
feeding programmable logic controllers or
transfer to bus systems
• Eliminates the need for an additional mea-
suring transducer and signal converter
Available 1) SIRIUS 3RU21 thermal overload relays use a bimetal contactor
— Not available and therefore do not require a control supply voltage.
Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Overload Relays SIRIUS
Overload Relays
General data
General data
Overview of overload relays – matching contactors
Overload Current Current Contactors (type, size, rating in HP)
relays measure- range 3RT20 1. 3RT20 2. 3RT20 3. 3RT20 4. 3RT20 5. 3RT20 6. 3RT20 7 3TF68/
ment 3TF69
S00 S0 S2 S3 S6 S10 S12 Size 14
Type Type A 3/5/7.5/10 5/7.5/10/15/20/25 30/40/50 50/60/70 100/125/150 150/200/250 300/400 500/700
SIRIUS 3RU21 thermal overload relays
3RU21 1 Integrated 0.11 … 16 — — — — — — —
3RU21 2 Integrated 1.8 … 40 — — — — — — —
3RU21 3 Integrated 22 … 80 — — — — — — —
3RU21 4 Integrated 28 … 100 — — — — — — —
3
3RU21
3RB30
7
3RB31 4 Integrated 32 … 115 — — — — — — —
3RB31
3RB20
SIRIUS 3RB21 solid-state overload relays1)
3RB21 5 d 50 … 200 0
Integrated — — — — — — —
3RB21 6 Integrated 55 … 630
3RB21 1 + Integrated 630 … 820 — — — — — — —
3UF18
3RB21
Can be used 1) "Technical Specifications" for use of the overload relays with trip class
— Cannot be used ≥ CLASS 20 can be found in "Short-circuit protection with fuses for motor
feeders",
3
3UF18
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB22, 3RB23
3RB24
7
Can be used 1) "Technical Specifications" for use of the overload relays with trip class
— Cannot be used ≥ CLASS 20 can be found in "Short-circuit protection with fuses for motor
feeders",
Connection methods
Depending on the device version of the 3RU2 and 3RB3 over-
load relays, the terminals for screw terminals, spring-type termi-
nals or ring terminal lug connection are configured for both the
main and auxiliary circuit in frame sizes S00 and S0.
The 3RU21 thermal overload relays come with screw terminals.
The electronic overload relays 3RB20 and 3RB21 are available
with screw terminals (box terminals) or spring-type terminals on
the auxiliary current side; the same applies for the evaluation
modules of the 3RB22 to 3RB24 electronic overload relays for
High-Feature applications.
Description
The 3RU thermal overload re- (see "Environmental consider-
lays up to 100 A are designed for ations") and comply with all the
current-dependent protection of main international standards
applications with normal start-up and approvals (see "Specifica-
conditions (see "Trip classes") tions" and "Increased safety type
against impermissibly high rises of protection EEx").
in temperature as a result of
The accessories for the 3RU
overload or phase failure (see
thermal overload relays have
"Phase failure protection"). An
overload or phase failure causes
been designed on the principle
that all requirements are cov-
the motor current to rise above
ered by a small number of vari-
the set rated motor current (see
ants.
"Setting"). This current rise heats
NSB0_02075a
up the bimetal strips within the Application
3
Description
This is the schematic representation of a characteristic. The characteristics TEST function Operation with frequency
of the individual 3RU thermal overload relays can be requested from
Correct functioning of the ready converters
Technical Assistance at the e-mail address:
nst.technical-assistance@siemens.de 3RU thermal overload relay can The 3RU thermal overload re-
Tripping time
be tested with the TEST slide. The lays are suitable for operation with
10 000 slide is operated to simulate trip- frequency converters. Depending
ANSB00288 ping of the relay. During this simu- on the frequency of the converter,
100
min 5000 lation, the NC contact (95-96) is a current higher than the motor
60
40
s opened and the NO contact (97- current may have to be set due to
2000 98) is closed whereby the over- the occurrence of eddy currents
load relay checks that the auxiliary and skin effects.
1000
circuit is wired correctly. When the
10
500
3RU thermal overload relay is Environmental considerations
set to Automatic RESET, an auto-
5
matic reset takes place when the The devices are manufactured
3
200
TEST slide is released. The relay taking environmental consider-
2
100 must be reset using the RESET ations into account and comprise
3-pole
button when it is set to Manual environmentally-friendly and recy-
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
1 loading
50 RESET. clable materials.
Accessories
3
3RU29 36-3AA01
Mechanical RESET
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Resetting plunger, holder, and former overload reset adapter S00 to S3 3RU29 00-1A 0.038
3RU29 00-1
3RU19 00-2A.71
Terminal cover
Cover for cable lug S3 3RT19 46-4EA1 0.040
and bar connection
3RT1946-4EA1
Sealable covers
For covering the rotary setting dials. S00 to S2 3RV29 08-0P 0.100
Order in multiples of 10.
3RV29 08-0P
Tool for opening Spring Loaded terminal connections
Suitable up to a
For all SIRIUS devices with spring-type terminals
• Length: approx. 200 mm; 3RA2908-1A 0.045
3.0 × 0.5 mm (green)
3RA2908-1A
1)
The accessories are identical to those of the 3RB30/3RB31 solid-state overload relays.
Technical data
on manual RESET min depending on the level of tripping current and the tripping characteristic
on remote RESET min depending on the level of tripping current and the tripping characteristic
Features
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
Indication of status on the device Yes, using the slide "TEST function/ON-OFF indicator"
TEST function Yes
RESET button Yes
STOP button Yes
Safe operation of motors with “increased safety” type of protection
EC type test certificate number according to directive 94/9/EC (ATEX) DMT 98 ATEX G 001 II (2) GD On request
Ambient temperatures
Storage/transport °C –55 to +80 –55 to +80
Operation °C –40 to +70 –40 to +70
Temperature compensation °C up to +60 up to +60
Permissible rated current at Internal cabinet temperature of 60 °C % 100 (over +60°C, 100 (over +60°C,
the current must be reduced) current reduction
is not required)
Internal cabinet temperature of 70 °C % 87 87
Repeat terminals
Repeat coil terminal Yes Not required
Auxiliary switch repeat terminal Yes Not required
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 IP 20 IP 20 2)
Touch protection acc. to IEC 61140 Finger-safe for vertical contact from the front
Finger-safe only with optional terminal covers
Shock resistance (sine) acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11 (auxiliary contacts 95/96 and 97/98: 8g/11ms) 8/10
EMC
• Interference immunity Not relevant
• Emitted interference Not relevant
Resistance to extreme climates (humidity) % 90 100
Dimensions see dimensional drawings
Site altitude m Up to 2000; above this on request
Installation angle The permissible installation angles for mounting onto contactors and indi-
vidual mounting are shown in the diagrams. For mounting in the shaded
area, adjustment compensation of 10 % is necessary.
Individual mounting
Technical data
3
Power loss per device (max.) W 4.1...6.3 6.2...7.5 8...14 10 to 16.5
Short-circuit protection With fuse without contactor See selection and ordering data
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
With fuse and contactor See technical data (short-circuit protection with fuses /
circuit-breaker for motor feeders)
Protective separation between main and auxiliary current paths V
Acc. to IEC 60947-1,
• Screw terminals or ring terminal lug connections 440 690: Setting 690 690
ranges <
_ 25 A
• Spring - type terminals 440 440: Setting 690
ranges > 25 A
1) For conductor cross-sections for Cage Clamp 2) The box terminal can be removed. After the
terminals, see "Connection of the auxiliary box terminal has been removed, bar connec-
circuit.” tion and lug connection is possible.
Technical data
• 60 V A On request On request
• 110 V A 0.22 0.22
• 125 V A 0.22 0.22
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
Circuit diagrams
Protection of DC motors
3
1-pole 2-pole
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RU21 16 overload relay
-F 95 97
Dimension drawings
Screw connection
Lateral clearance to grounded components: at least 6 mm.
3RU21 16-..B0 3RU21 16-..B1
Size S00 Size S00
75.3 with adapter for installation as a single unit with accessories
73
68 45 79.5
34.9
4.5
30
37.8
45
89.15
87.9
3
77
76
61.7
60.4
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
70 5
5
4.5
3RU21 26-..B. 3RU21 26-..B1
Size S0 Size S0
3RT2...-.B.. (DC-Spule) 107 with adapter for installation as a single unit
3RT2...-.N.. (UC-Spule) 102
3RT2...-.A.. 97 45 94.7
(AC-Spule) 92
35.2
4.5
44.9
43
DCAC
97.1
45
85
108.8
66.7
66.8
84.8
4.5
3RT2...-.A.. 84.4
3RT2...-.B.. (DC-Spule) (AC-Spule) 84.6
3RT2...-.N.. (UC-Spule) 94.6
55
130.5
91.2
76.5
75.6
95 NC 96 97 NO 98
104.2
114.5
Dimension drawings
Spring Loaded terminals
Lateral clearance to grounded components: at least 6 mm.
3RU21 16 -..C0 89.4 3RU21 16 -..C1
Size S00 84.4 Size S00 with with adapter for installation as a single unit
36
45 79.2 35
45
4.5
51.45
101.9
70.5
80
3
86.5
104
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
70 5 5
4.5
3RU21 26-..C0 3RU21 26-..C1
Size S0 Size S0 with adapter for installation as a single unit
3RT2...-.B.. (DC-Spule)
3RT2...-.N.. (UC-Spule) 107
102 45 94.7
3RT2...-.A.. 97
(AC-Spule)
92
55.8
132.9
114
DCAC
45 79.5
5
101.6
130
82.6
132.9
125.1
55.2
3RT2...-.A.. 84.4
3RT2...-.B.. (DC-Spule) (AC-Spule) 98.2
3RT2...-.N.. (UC-Spule) 108.2
75.6
95 NC 96 97 NO 98
104.2
114.5
Overview
Application
Industries
The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state over load relays are suitable for
customers from all industries who want to provide optimum
inverse-time delayed protection of their electrical loads
3
Design
Device concept Overload relays in contactor assemblies for
Wye-Delta starting
The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays are compact
devices, i.e. current measurement (transformer) and the evalua- When overload relays are used in combination with contactor
tion unit are integrated in a single enclosure. assemblies for Wye-Delta starting it must be noted that only
0.58 times the motor current flows through the line contactor.
Mounting options An overload relay mounted onto the line contactor must be set
The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays are suitable for to 0.58 times the motor current.
direct and space-saving mounting onto 3RT1 / 3RT2 contactors When 3RB21 / 31 solid-state overload relays are used in combi-
and 3RW30/3RW31 soft starters as well as for stand-alone nation with contactor assemblies for Wye-Delta starting, the
installation. For more information on the mounting options, internal ground-fault detection must not be activated.
please see Technical Specifications and Selection and .
Ordering Data Operation with frequency converter
3
Connection technique The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays are suitable for
frequencies of 50/60 Hz and the associated harmonics. This
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Main circuit permits the 3RB2 / 3RB3 overload relays to be used on the
All sizes of the 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays can be incoming side of the frequency converter.
connected with screw-type terminals. As an alternative for sizes If motor protection is required on the outgoing side of the
S3 to S10/S12, the main circuits can be connected via the Bus- frequency converter, the 3RN thermistor motor protection
bar. Sizes S2 to S6 of the 3RB20/3RB21 relays are also available devices or the 3RU thermal overload relays are available for
with a straight-through transformer. In this case, the cables of the this purpose.
main circuit are routed directly through the feed-through open-
ings of the relay to the contactor terminals.
Auxiliary circuit
Connection of the auxiliary circuit (removable terminal block) is
possible with either screw terminals or spring-loaded terminals.
For more information on the connection options,
see Technical Specifications and Selection and Ordering Data.
Function
Basic functions Recovery time
The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays are designed for: With the 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays the recovery
• Inverse-time delayed protection of loads from overloading time after inverse-time delayed tripping is between 0.5 and 3
minutes depending on the preloading when automatic RESET
• Inverse-time delayed protection of loads from phase is set. These recovery times allow the load (e.g. motor) to
unbalance cool down.
• Inverse-time delayed protection of loads from phase failure
If the button is set to manual RESET, the 3RB2 / 3RB3 devices
• Protection of loads from high-resistance short-circuits can be reset immediately after inverse-time delayed tripping.
(internal ground-fault detection only with 3RB21 / 31).
After a ground fault trip the 3RB21 / 31 solid-state overload relays
Control circuit (with ground-fault detection activated) can be reset immediately
without a recovery time regardless of the reset mode set.
The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays have an internal
3
3RB30 26-@RB0
3
0.1 ... 0.4
3RB30 26-@NB0 0.32 ... 1.25
S0 3RB30 26-@PB0 1 ... 4
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB30 26-@SB0 3 ... 12
3RB30 26-@QB0 6 ... 25
3RB30 36-@UB0 12.5 ... 50
S2
3RB30 36-@WB0 20 ... 80
3RB30 46-@UB0 12.5 ... 50
S3
3RB30 46-@XB0 32 ... 115
3RB20 56-@FW2
S6 50 ... 200
3RB20 56-@FC2
3RB20 66-@GC2 55 ... 250
S10/S12
3RB20 66-@MC2 160 ... 630
CLASS 10 1
CLASS 20 2
Note:
A kg
Size S001)
S00 0.1 … 0.4 3RB30 16- @ RB0 3RB30 16-@RE0 0.172
3
3RB20 56-1FW2
Size S10/S122)
S10/S12 55 … 250 with busbar 3RB20 66- @ GC2 3RB20 66-@GF2 1.820
and size 14 160 … 630 3RB20 66- @ MC2 3RB20 66-@MF2 1.820
with busbar
(3TF68/
3TF69)
2 Class 20 2 Class 20
3RB20 66-1MC2
1 Class 10 1 Class 10
1) The relays with an Order No. ending with "0" are designed for direct mounting For accessories, see pages 3/49-3/50.
to the contactor. With the matching terminal brackets (see Accessories) the For description, see pages 3/18-3/20.
sizes S00 to S3 can also be installed as stand-alone units.
For technical data, see pages 3/24-3/29.
2) The relays with an Order No. ending with "2" are designed for direct
mounting and stand-alone installation. For 3TF68/3TF69 contactors, direct
For dimension drawings, see page 3/30.
mounting is not possible. For schematic diagrams, see page 3/31.
3) The relays with an Order No. ending with "1" are designed for stand-alone
installation.
4) Observe maximum rated operational current of the devices.
5) The relays with an Order No. with "X" in 10th position are equipped with a
straight-through transformer.
3/22 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications
A kg
Size S001)
3
S00 0.1 … 0.4 3RB31 13-4RB0 3RB31 13-4RE0 0.175
0.32 … 1.25 3RB31 13-4NB0 3RB31 13-4NE0 0.175
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
1…4 3RB31 13-4PB0 3RB31 13-4PE0 0.175
3 … 12 3RB31 13-4SB0 3RB31 13-4SE0 0.175
4 … 16 3RB31 13-4TB0 3RB31 13-4TE0 0.175
3RB31 13-4RB0
Size S01)
S0 0.1 … 0.4 3RB31 23-4RB0 3RB31 23-4RE0 0.215
0.32 … 1.25 3RB31 23-4NB0 3RB31 23-4NE0 0.215
1…4 3RB31 23-4PB0 3RB31 23-4PE0 0.215
3 … 12 3RB31 23-4SB0 3RB31 23-4SE0 0.215
6 … 25 3RB31 23-4QB0 3RB31 23-4QE0 0.215
3RB31 23-4QB0 10 … 40 3RB31 23-4VB0 3RB31 23-4VE0 0.215
Size S21)3)5)
S2 12 … 50 with busbar 3RB31 33-4UB0 3RB31 33-4UD0 0.360
with pass 3RB31 33-4UW1 3RB31 33-4UX1 0.230
through CT’s
20 … 80 with busbar 3RB31 33-4WB0 3RB31 33-4WD0 0.360
with pass 3RB31 33-4WW1 3RB31 33-4WX1 0.230
3RB31 33-4WB0 through CT’s
Size S31)3)5)
S3 12.5 … 50 with busbar 3RB31 43-4UB0 3RB31 43-4UD0 0.560
with pass 3RB31 43-4UW1 3RB31 43-4UX1 0.450
through CT’s
32 … 115 with busbar 3RB31 43-4XB0 3RB31 43-4XD0 0.560
with pass 3RB31 43-4XW1 3RB31 43-4XX1 0.450
through CT’s
3RB31 43-4XB0
Size S62)5)
S6 50 … 200 with busbar 3RB21 53-4FC2 3RB21 53-4FF2 1.030
with pass 3RB21 53-4FW2 3RB21 53-4FX2 0.690
through CT’s
3RB21 53-4FC2
Size S10/S122)
S10/S12 55 … 250 3RB21 63-4GC2 3RB21 63-4GF2 1.820
and size 14 160 … 630 3RB21 63-4MC2 3RB21 63-4MF2 1.820
(3TF68/
3TF69)
3RB21 63-4MC2
1) The relays with an Order No. ending with "0" are designed for direct mounting For accessories, see pages 3/49-3/50.
to the contactor. With the matching terminal brackets (see Accessories) the For description, see pages 3/18-3/21.
sizes S00 to S3 can also be installed as stand-alone units.
For technical data, see pages 3/24-3/29.
2) The relays with an Order No. ending with "2" are designed for direct
mounting and stand-alone installation. For 3TF68/3TF69 contactors, direct For dimension drawings, see page 3/30.
mounting is not possible. For schematic diagrams, see page 3/31.
3) The relays with an Order No. ending with "1" are designed for stand-alone
installation.
4) Observe maximum rated operational current of the devices.
5) The relays with an Order No. with "X" in 10th position are equipped with a
straight-through transformer.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/23
Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications
Technical specifications
Type 3RB30 16, 3RB30 26, 3RB30 36 3RB30 46, 3RB30 56, 3RB30 66,
3RB31 13 3RB31 23 3RB31 33 3RB31 43 3RB31 53 3RB31 63
Size S00 S0 S2 S3 S6 S10/S12
Width 45 mm 45 mm 55 mm 70 mm 120 mm 145 mm
General data
Trips in the event of Overload, phase failure, and phase unbalance
+ ground fault (for 3RB31 only)
Trip class according to IEC 60947-4-1 CLASS 3RB30: 10E, 20E;
3RB31: 5E, 10E, 20E or 30E adjustable
Phase failure sensitivity Yes
Overload warning No
3
• Recovery time
- For automatic RESET min. Appox. 3 min Appox. 3 min
- For manual RESET min. Immediately Immediately
- For remote RESET min. Immediately Immediately
Features
• Display of operating status on device Yes, by means of switch position indicator slide
• TEST function Yes, test of electronics by pressing the button Test
Test of auxiliary contacts and wiring of control current circuit by actuating
the switch position indicator slide/self-monitoring
• RESET button Yes
• STOP button No
PTB 09 ATEX 3001 On PTB 09 ATEX 3001
Explosion protection – Safe operation of motors
II (2) G [Ex e] [Ex d] [Ex px] request II (2) G [Ex e] [Ex d] [Ex px]
with"Increased safety" type of protection
II (2) G [Ex t] [Ex p] II (2) G [Ex t] [Ex p]
EC type test certificate number according to directive 94/9/EC (ATEX)
Ambient temperatures
• Storage/transport °C -40 ... +80
• Operation °C -25 ... +60
• Temperature compensation °C +60
• Permissible rated current at
- Temperature inside control cabinet 60 °C, stand-alone installation % — 100 100 100 or 902)
- Temperature inside control cabinet 60 °C, mounted on contactor % 100 100 70 70
- Temperature inside control cabinet 70 °C % On request On request
Repeat terminals
• Coil repeat terminal Yes Not required
• Auxiliary contact repeat terminal Yes Not required
Degree of protection according to IEC 60529 IP20 3) IP203)
Touch protection according to IEC 61140 Finger-safe for vertical contact from the front Finger-safe, Finger-safe
for busbar with cover
connection
with cover
Shock resistance with sine according to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11 (signaling contact 15/11 (signaling 15/11 (signaling contact
97/98 in position contact 97/98 in 97/98 in position
"tripped": 9g/ms) "Tripped" position: "tripped": 4 g/11ms)
8 g/11ms)
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) – Interference immunity
• Conductor-related interference
- Burst according to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2 (power ports), 1 (signal ports)
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
- Surge according to IEC 61000-4-5 kV 2 (line to earth), 1 (line to line)
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Electrostatic discharge according to IEC 61000-4-2 kV 8 (air discharge), 6 (contact discharge)
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Field-related interference according to IEC 61000-4-3 V/m 10
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) – Degree of severity B according to EN 55011 (CISPR 11) and EN 55022 (CISPR 22)
Emitted interference
Resistance to extreme climates – air humidity % 95 100
Dimensions See dimensional drawings
Installation altitude above sea level m Up to 2000
Mounting position Any
Type of mounting Direct mounting/stand-alone installation Direct mounting /
with terminal support Stand-alone installation
1) Permissible rated current in case of heavy starting 2) 90 % for relay with current setting range 160A to 630A
Size S0 at 10 A up to 40 A 3) Terminal compartment: degree of protection IP00.
- CLASS 20, Ie max = 32 A
- CLASS 30, Ie max = 25 A
3
Power loss per unit (max.) W 0.05 ... 0.2 0.05
Short-circuit protection
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
- With fuse without contactor See Selection and Ordering Data
- With fuse and contactor See Technical Specifications (short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders)
Protective separation between main and auxiliary V 690 for grounded networks, otherwise 600 V
conducting path according to IEC 60947-1 (pollution degree 2)
Connection for main circuit
Electrical connection version Screw terminal Screw terminal Screw terminal Screw terminal
with box terminal /
Screw terminal
• Terminal screw M3, Pozidriv size 2 M3, Pozidriv size 2 M4, Pozidriv size 2 M8, 4 mm Allen screw
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 2 ... 2.5 2 ... 2.5 4 ... 6
• Conductor cross-sections (min./max.)
- Solid or stranded mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5)3) 2 × (1 ... 2.5) 3) 1 × (1 ... 50) 2 × (2.5 ... 16)
2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)3) 2 × (2.5 ... 10) 2 × (1 ... 35)
2 × (0.05 ... 4)3) (Solid or Stranded)
- Finely stranded with end sleeve (DIN 46228 T1) mm 2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5)3) 2 × (1 ... 2.5) 3) 2 × (1 ... 25), 2 × (2.5 ... 35),
2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)3) 2 × (2.5 ... 6)3) 1 × (1 ... 35) 1 × (2.5 ... 50)
max. 1 x 10
- Stranded m m2 -- 2 × (10 ... 50),
1 × (10 ... 70)
- AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (20 ... 16)3) 2 × (16 ... 12)3) 2 × (18 ... 2) 2 × (10 ... 1/0),
2 × (18 ... 14)3) 2 × (14 ... 8)3) 1 × (18 ... 1) 2 × (10 ... 2/0)
2 × 12
1) For version with straight-through transformer up to 1000 VAC. 3) If two different conductor cross-sections are connected
2) For version with straight-through transformer up to 8 kV. to one clamping point, both cross-sections must lie in
the range specified.
Short-circuit protection
- With fuse without contactor See Selection and Ordering Data
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
- With fuse and contactor See Technical Specifications (short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders)
Safe isolation between main V 6901)
and auxiliary conducting path according to IEC 60947-1
Connection for main circuit
Electrical connection version Screw terminal with box terminal/ Screw terminal
Bus connection / with box terminal/
Straight-through transformer Bus connection
Screw terminal
• Terminal screw 4 mm Allen screw 5 mm Allen screw
• Tightening torque Nm 10 ... 12 20 ... 22
• Conductor cross-sections (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors
- Solid mm2 --
- Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (50 ... 185),
2 × (1 × max. 50, 1 × max. 70), front clamping point only:
1 × (10 ... 70) 1 × (70 ... 240)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (1 × max. 95, 1 × max. 120), 1 × (120 ... 185)
1 × (10 ... 120)
- Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (50 ... 185),
2 × (1 × max. 50, 1 × max. 70), front clamping point only:
1 × (10 ... 70) 1 × (70 ... 240)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (1 × max. 95, 1 × max. 120), 1 × (120 ... 185)
1 × (10 ... 120)
2
- Stranded mm With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (70 ... 240),
2 × (max. 70), front clamping point only:
1 × (16 ... 70) 1 × (95 ... 300)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (max. 120), 1 × (120 ... 240)
1 × (16 ... 120)
- AWG conductors, solid or stranded AWG With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (2/0 ... 500 kcmil),
2 × (max. 1/0), front clamping point only:
1 × (6 ... 2/0) 1 × (3/0 ... 600 kcmil)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (max. 3/0), 1 × (250 kcmil ... 500 kcmil)
1 × (6 ... 250 kcmil)
- Ribbon cable conductors mm With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (20 × 24 × 0.5),
(number x width x circumference) 2 × (6 × 15.5 × 0.8), 1 × (6 × 9 × 0.8 ... 20 × 24 × 0.5)
1 × (3 × 9 × 0.8 ... 6 × 15.5 × 0.8)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal:
2 × (10 × 15.5 × 0.8),
1 × (3 × 9 × 0.8 ... 10 × 15.5 × 0.8)
Busbar connections
• Terminal screw M 8 × 25 M 10 × 30
• Tightening torque Nm 10 ... 14 14 ... 24
• Conductor cross-section (min./max.)
- Finely stranded with cable lug m m2 16 ... 952) 50 ... 2403)
- Stranded with cable lug m m2 25 ... 1202) 70 ... 2403)
- AWG connections, solid or stranded, with cable lug AWG 4 ... 250 kcmil 2/0 ... 500 kcmil
- With connecting bar (max. width) mm 15 25
Straight-through transformers
• Diameter of opening mm 24.5 --
• Conductor cross-section (max.)
2
- N YY mm 120 --
- H07RN-F mm2 70 --
1) For grounded networks, otherwise 600 V. 3) When connecting cable lugs according to DIN 46234 for conductor cross-
2) When connecting cable lugs according to DIN 46235, use the sections from 240 mm2 as well as DIN 46235 for conductor cross-sections
3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal cover for conductor cross-sections from 185 mm2, use the 3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal cover to ensure phase
from 95 mm2 to ensure phase spacing. spacing.
Type 3RB30 16, 3RB30 26, 3RB30 36, 3RB30 46, 3RB30 56, 3RB30 66,
3RB31 13 3RB31 23 3RB31 33 3RB31 43 3RB31 53 3RB31 63
Size S00 S0 S2 S3 S6 S10/S12
Width 45 mm 45 mm 55 mm 70 mm 120 mm 145 mm
Auxiliary circuit
Number of NO contacts 1
Number of NC contacts 1
Auxiliary contacts – assignment 1 NO for the signal "tripped",
1 NC for switching off the contactor
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 300
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 4
Auxiliary contacts – Contact rating
• NC contact with alternating current AC-14/AC-15
Rated operational current Ie at Ue:
3
- 24 V A 4
- 120 V A 4
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
- 125 V A 4
- 250 V A 3
1 ... 4 A 3RT20 15 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 35 20
3RT20 16 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 35 20
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
3RT20 17 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 35 20
4 ... 16 A 3RT20 16 9 6.5 5.2 9 6.5 5.2 9 6.5 5.2 35 20
3RT20 17 12 9 6.3 10 9 6.3 9 9 6.3 35 20
3RT20 18 16 12.4 8.9 12.9 11.6 8.1 11.6 11.6 8.1 50 25
Size S0
3 ... 12 A 3RT20 23 9 6.5 5.2 9 6.5 5.2 -- -- -- 63 25
3RT20 24 12 12 9 12 12 9 12 12 9 63 25
3RT20 25 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 63 25
10 ... 40 3RT20 24 12 12 9 12 12 9 12 12 9 63 25
3RT20 25 17 17 13 16 16 13 14 14 13 63 25
3RT20 26 25 18 13 16 16 13 14 14 13 100 35
3RT20 27 32 32 21 18.6 18.6 15.1 16.2 16.2 15.1 125 50
3RT20 28 38 32 21 22.4 22.4 18.2 19.6 19.6 18.2 125 50
Size S2
12.5 ... 50 A 3RT20 35 40 40 24 40 40 24 36 36 36 160 80
3RT20 36 50 50 24 45 45 24 38 38 24 160 80
3RT20 37 50 50 47 48 48 47 42 42 42 250 125
3RT20 38 50 50 50 49 49 49 43 43 43 250 160
20 ... 80 A 3RT20 35 40 40 24 40 40 24 36 36 36 160 80
3RT20 36 50 50 24 45 45 24 38 38 24 160 80
3RT20 37 65 65 47 48 48 47 42 42 42 250 125
3RT20 38 80 80 58 49 49 49 43 43 43 250 160
Size S3
12.5 ... 50 A 3RT20 45 50 50 47 49 49 47 41.7 41.7 41.7 200 125
3RT20 46 50 50 50 50 50 50 45 45 45 200 160
32 ... 115 A 3RT20 45 65 65 47 49 49 47 41.7 41.7 41.7 200 125
3RT20 46 80 80 58 53 53 53 45 45 45 200 160
3RT20 47 95 95 58 59 59 58 50 50 50 200 160
3RT10 54 100 100 100 81.7 81.7 81.7 69 69 69 355 315
3RT10 55 -- -- -- 100 100 100 90 90 90 355 315
Size S6
50 ... 200 A 3RT10 54 115 115 115 81.7 81.7 81.7 69 69 69 355 315
3RT10 55 150 150 150 107 107 107 90 90 90 355 315
3RT10 56 185 185 170 131 131 131 111 111 111 355 315
Size S10/S12
55 ... 250 A 3RT10 64 225 225 225 160 160 160 135 135 135 500 400
3RT10 65 250 250 250 188 188 188 159 159 159 500 400
3RT10 66 250 250 250 213 213 213 180 180 180 500 400
160 ... 630 A 3RT10 64 225 225 225 160 160 160 -- -- -- 500 400
3RT10 65 265 265 265 188 188 188 -- -- -- 500 400
3RT10 66 300 300 280 213 213 213 180 180 180 500 400
3RT10 75 400 400 400 284 284 284 240 240 240 630 400
3RT10 76 500 500 450 355 355 355 300 300 300 630 500
3RT12 64 225 225 225 225 225 225 173 173 173 500 500
3RT12 65 265 265 265 265 265 265 204 204 204 500 500
3RT12 66 300 300 300 300 300 300 231 231 231 500 500
3RT12 75 400 400 400 400 400 400 316 316 316 800 800
3RT12 76 500 500 500 500 500 500 385 385 385 800 800
3TF683) 630 630 630 440 440 440 376 376 376 800 5004)
3TF693) 630 630 630 572 572 572 500 500 500 800 6304)
1) Please observe operational voltage. Type of coordination 2: the contactor or starter must not endanger
2) Coordination and short-circuit equipment according to EN 60947-4-1: persons or the installation in the event of a short-circuit.
Type of coordination 1: the contactor or starter must not endanger They must be suitable for further operation. There is a risk of contact welding.
persons or the installation in the event of a short-circuit. 3) Contactor cannot be mounted.
They do not need to be suitable for further operation without repair and the 4) Please ensure that the maximum AC-3 operational current has sufficient
renewal of parts. safety clearance from the rated current of the fuses.
Characteristic curves
The tripping characteristics show the relationship between the Tripping characteristics for 3-pole loads
tripping time and tripping current as multiples of the set current
Ie and are given for symmetrical three-pole and two-pole loads 1000
NSB0_01525
from the cold state. 800
600
The smallest current used for tripping is called the minimum trip- 400
ping current. According to IEC 60947-4-1, this current must be
Tripping time
s
within specified limits. The limits of the total tripping current for 200
the 3RB20/3RB21 solid-state overload relays for symmetrical
three-pole loads are between 105 % and 120 % of the set cur-
rent. 100
80
The tripping characteristic starts with the minimum tripping 60
current and continues with higher tripping currents based on the
3
40
characteristics of the so-called trip classes (CLASS 10,
CLASS 20 etc.). The trip classes describe time intervals within 20
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
which the overload relays have to trip with 7.2 times the set CLASS 30
current Ie from the cold state for symmetrical three-pole loads. CLASS 20
10
The tripping times according to IEC 60947-4-1, tolerance band 8
E, are as follows for: 6 CLASS 10
4
Trip class Tripping time CLASS 5
CLASS 5 3…5s 2
CLASS 10 5 … 10 s
CLASS 20 10 … 20 s 1
0,6 1 2 4 6 8 10× e
CLASS 30 20 … 30 s Tripping current
of the load in accordance with the tripping characteristic for two- 600
pole loads from the cold state (see illustration 2). With phase 400
Tripping time
20
CLASS 30
10
8 CLASS 20
6
4 CLASS 10
2 CLASS 5
1
0,6 1 2 4 6 8 10× e
Tripping current
Illustration 2
The above illustrations are schematic representations of
characteristic curves.
Dimensional drawings
51
48 Ø11 25
65
NSB0_01510
57
147
122
85
45 73
Ø9
125
3RB30 16, 3RB31 13, size S00
NSB0_01518
6
145 61
3
156
3RB20 66, 3RB21 63, size S10/S12
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
71
108.7
103.7
NSB0_01511
55
45 84
48.8
130
125.1
80.7
95 96 97 98
57
69.9
5.4 26.5 43.4
5
55
22.5
22.5
5
45
55
137.2
98.9
83.3
82.3
103.3
113.1
3RB30 36, 3RB31 33, size S2
51
64
67
86
11
23 Ø6 63
35
NSB0_01515
2
60
Ø5
5
70 119
106
64
89
18
NSB0_01514
30
5 31
70
119
3RB30 46, 3RB31 43, size S3 16 34
3RB30 46, 3RB31 43, size S3 with straight-through transformer
37 17 79
Ø5
62
119
79
95
99
95
79
60
60
NSB0_01516 NSB0_01517
3 5
95 Ø7 95 Ø7 73
5 120 150
120 47
150
3RB20 56, 3RB21 53, size S6 3RB20 56, 3RB21 53, size S6 with straight-through transformer
3/30 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Overload Relays
Schematics
3
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB30 26 to 3RB20 66 overload relays
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/31
Overload Relays
Overview
The modular, solid-state overload relays with external power
supply type 3RB22 (with monostable auxiliary contacts) and
type 3RB23 (with bistable auxiliary contacts) up to 630 A (up to
820 A possible with a series transformer) have been designed
for inverse-time delayed protection of loads with normal and
heavy starting (see Function) against excessive temperature
rises due to overload, phase unbalance or phase failure. An
overload, phase unbalance or phase failure result in an increase
of the motor current beyond the set motor rated current. This
current rise is detected by means of a current measuring module
and electronically evaluated by a special evaluation module
which is connected to it. The evaluation electronics sends a
signal to the auxiliary contacts. The auxiliary contacts then
3
switch off the load by means of the contactors control circuit. The
break time depends on the ratio between the tripping current
and set current Ie and is stored in the form of a long-term stable
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
Industries When using 3RB23 solid-state overload relays for the protection
of EEx e motors, separate monitoring of the control supply
The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays are suitable for voltage is recommended.
customers from all industries who want to provide optimum
inverse-time delayed and temperature-dependent protection of The basic safety and health requirements of ATEX guideline
their electrical loads (e.g. motors) under normal and heavy 94/9/EG are fulfilled by compliance with
starting conditions (CLASS 5 to CLASS 30), minimize project • EN 60947-1
3
completion times, inventories and power consumption, and • EN 60947-4-1
optimize plant availability and maintenance management.
• EN 60947-5-1
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Application • EN 60079-14
The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays have been EU type test certificate for Group II, Category (2) G/D under
designed for the protection of three-phase asynchronous and application. Number on request.
single-phase AC motors.
If single-phase AC motors are to be protected by the Accessories
3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays, the main circuits of
the current measuring modules must be series-connected. The following accessories are available for the 3RB22/3RB23
solid-state overload relays:
Ambient conditions
• A sealable cover for the evaluation module
The devices are insensitive to external influences such as • Box terminal blocks for the current measuring modules size S6
shocks, corrosive environments, ageing and temperature and S10/S12
changes.
• Terminal covers for the current measuring modules size S6
For the temperature range from –25 C to +60 °C, the and S10/S12
3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays compensate the • Push-in lugs for screw (panel) mounting the size S00 to S3
temperature according to IEC 60947-4-1. current measuring modules
Configuration notes for use of the devices below –25 °C or above
+60 °C on request.
3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays for full motor protection with screw connection or spring-loaded terminals
for stand-alone installation, CLASS 5, 10, 20 and 30 adjustable
Features and technical specifications:
• Overload protection, phase failure protection and unbalance • TEST function and self-monitoring
protection • Internal ground fault detection with function expansion
• External power supply 24 ... 240 V AC/DC module
• Auxiliary contacts 2 NO +2 NC • Screw connection or spring-loaded terminals for auxiliary,
• Manual and automatic RESET control and sensor circuits
• Electrical remote RESET integrated • Input for PTC sensor circuit
• 4 LEDs for operating and status displays • Analog output with function expansion module
Size Version Connection type Order No. Weight per
Contactor PU approx.
kg
3
Evaluation modules
S00 ... S12 Monostable Screw connection 3RB22 83-4AA1 0.300
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
3RB2. 83-4AA1
3RB2. 83-4AC1
Function expansion modules
– Analog Basic 1 module1) 3RB29 85-2AA0 0.030
Analog output DC 4 ... 20 mA, with
overload warning
Analog Basic 1 GF module1)2) 3RB29 85-2AA1 0.030
Analog output DC 4 ... 20 mA, with
internal ground fault detection and
overload warning
Analog Basic 2 GF module1)2) 3RB29 85-2AB1 0.030
Analog output DC 4 ... 20 mA, with
internal ground fault detection and
ground fault signaling
Basic 1 GF module2) 3RB29 85-2CA1 0.030
with internal ground fault detection
and overload warning
Basic 2 GF module2) 3RB29 85-2CB1 0.030
with internal ground fault detection
and ground fault signaling
1) The analog signal 4 ... 20 mA DC can be used for operating rotary coil Note: Analog input modules, e. g. SM 331, must be configured
instruments or for feeding into analog inputs of programmable logic for 4-wire measuring transducers. In this case the analog input
controllers.
module must not supply current to the analog output of the
2) The following information on ground fault protection refers to sinusoidal 3RB22/ 3RB23 relay.
residual currents at 50/60 Hz:
- With a motor current of between 0.3 and 2 times the set current Ie the unit
will trip at a ground fault current equal to 30% of the set current.
- With a motor current of between 2 and 8 times the set current Ie the unit
will trip at a ground fault current equal to 15% of the set current.
- The trip delay amounts to between 0.5 and 1 second.
3/34 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Overload Relays
3RB29 06-2.G1
Size S2/S32)4)
3
S2/S3 10 … 100 3RB29 06-2JG1 0.350
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB29 06-2JG1
Size S61)4)
S6 20 … 200 with pass through CT’s 3RB29 56-2TG2 0.600
with busbar 3RB29 56-2TH2 1.000
3RB29 56-2TG2
Size S10/S121)
S10/S12 and 63 … 630 3RB29 66-2WH2 1.750
size 14 (3TF68/
3TF69)
3RB29 66-2WH2
1) The current measuring modules with an Order No. ending with "2" are 3) Observe maximum rated operational current of the devices.
designed for direct mounting and stand-alone installation. For 4) The modules with an Order No. with "G" in 11th position are equipped with
3TF68/3TF69 contactors, direct mounting is not possible. a straight-through transformer.
2) The current measuring modules with an Order No. ending with "1" are
designed for stand-alone installation.
3RB29 87-2.
Design Function
Device concept Basic functions
The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays are based on a The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays are designed for:
modular device concept. Each device always comprises an • Inverse-time delayed protection of loads from overloading
evaluation module, which is independent of the motor current,
and a current measuring module, which is dependent on the mo- • Inverse-time delayed protection of loads from phase
tor current. The two modules are electrically interconnected by a unbalance
connection cable through the system interface. • Inverse-time delayed protection of loads from phase failure
The basic functionality of the evaluation module can be option- • Temperature-dependent protection of loads by connecting a
ally expanded with corresponding function expansion modules. PTC sensor circuit
The function expansion modules are integrated in the evaluation • Protection of loads from high-resistance short-circuits (internal
module for this purpose through a simple plug connection. ground-fault detection; detection of fault currents > 30 % of
the set current Ie)
3
Mounting options
• Output of an overload warning
Current measuring modules
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
3
mined. switch off as the result, bringing the test to an end.
• The lower rotary knob with percent scale (10 % ... 100 %) is After a test trip a faultless relay is reset by pressing the
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
then used to set the rated motor current in percent of the range TEST/RESET button. If a hardware fault is detected, the device
selected with the upper rotary button. trips and cannot be reset.
Example Self-monitoring
• Rating of induction motor = 45 kW (50 Hz, 400 V AC)
The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays have a self-moni-
• Rated motor current = 80 A toring feature, i.e. the devices constantly monitor their own basic
• Required trip class = CLASS 20 functions and trip if an internal fault is detected.
• Selected transformer: 10 to 100 A Display of the operating status
Solution The particular operating status of the 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state
• Step 1: Use the upper rotary knob (CLASS) to select the 100 A overload relays is displayed by means of four LEDs:
range • Green "Ready" LED: A continuous green light signals that the
• Step 2: Within the 100 A range set the trip class CLASS 20 overload relay is ready for operation. The 3RB22/3RB23 over-
• Step 3: Set the lower rotary knob to 80 % (= 0.8) of load relays are not ready (LED "OFF") if there is no control
100 A × 0.8 = 80 A. supply voltage or if the function test was negative.
• Red "Ground fault" LED: A continuous red light signals a
If the current which is set on the evaluation module does not ground fault.
correspond to the current range of the connected current trans-
former, an error will result. • Red "Thermistor" LED: A continuous red light signals a
temperature-dependent trip.
Manual and automatic reset • Red "Overload" LED: A continuous red light signals an inverse-
In the case of the 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays, a time delayed trip; a flickering red light signals an imminent
slide switch can be used to choose between automatic and inverse-time delayed trip (overload warning).
manual resetting. Auxiliary contacts
If manual reset is set, a reset can be carried out directly on the The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays have two outputs,
device after a trip by pressing the blue TEST/RESET button. each with one NO contact and one NC contact. Their basic as-
A remote RESET can be carried out electrically by jumpering the signment/function may be influenced by function expansion
terminals Y1 and Y2. modules.
If the slide switch is set to automatic RESET, the relay is reset The 3RB22 and 3RB23 differ with respect to the tripping charac-
automatically. teristics of their auxiliary contacts – monostable or bistable:
The time between tripping and resetting is determined by the The monostable 3RB22 solid-state overload relays will enter the
recovery time. "tripped" state if the control supply voltage fails (> 200 ms), and
Recovery time return to the original state they were in before the control supply
voltage failed when the voltage returns. These devices are there-
With the 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays the recovery fore especially suited for plants in which the control voltage is not
time after inverse-time delayed tripping is approx. 3 minutes strictly monitored.
regardless of the selected reset mode. The recovery time allows
the load to cool down. The bistable 3RB23 overload relays do not change their "tripped"
or "not tripped" status if the control voltage fails. The auxiliary
However, in the event of temperature-dependent tripping by contacts only switch over in the event of an overload and if the
means of a connected PTC thermistor sensor circuit, the device supply voltage is present. These devices are therefore espe-
can only be manually or automatically reset once the winding cially suited for plants in which the control voltage is monitored
temperature at the installation location of the PTC thermistor has separately.
fallen 5 Kelvin below its response temperature.
Response if the control supply voltage fails
After a ground fault trip the 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload
relay trips can be reset immediately without a recovery time. If the control supply voltage fails for more than 0.2 s, the output
relays respond differently depending on the version: Monostable
or bistable.
Technical specifications
The following technical information is intended to provide an
initial overview of the various types of device and functions.
Detailed information, see
• Reference Manual "Protection Equipment – 3RU1, 3RB2 • or specific information on a particular article number via the
Overload Relays", product data sheet,
http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/35681297 http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/20357046/133200
H
Dimensions of evaluation modules mm 45 x 111 x 95
(W x H x D)
D
W
3
General data
Trips in the event of Overload, phase failure and phase unbalance (> 40 % according to NEMA),
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
+ ground fault (with corresponding function expansion module) and activation of the
thermistor motor protection (with closed PTC sensor circuit)
Trip class acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 CLASS 5, 10, 20 and 30 adjustable
Phase failure sensitivity Yes
Overload warning Yes, from 1.125 x Ie for symmetrical loads
and from 0.85 x Ie for unsymmetrical loads
Reset and recovery
• Reset options after tripping Manual, automatic and remote RESET
• Recovery time
- For automatic RESET min. - for tripping due to overcurrent: 3 (stored permanently)
- for tripping by thermistor: time until the motor temperature has fallen 5 K
below the response temperature
7
- for tripping due to a ground fault: no automatic RESET
- For manual RESET min. - for tripping due to overcurrent: 3 (stored permanently)
- for tripping by thermistor: time until the motor temperature has fallen 5 K
below the response temperature
- for tripping due to a ground fault: Immediately
- For remote RESET min. - for tripping due to overcurrent: 3 (stored permanently)
- for tripping by thermistor: time until the motor temperature has fallen 5 K
below the response temperature
- for tripping due to a ground fault: Immediately
Features
• Display of operating state on device Yes, with four LEDs:
- green LED "Ready"
- red LED "Ground Fault"
- red LED "Thermistor"
- red LED "Overload"
• TEST function Yes, test of LEDs, electronics, auxiliary contacts and wiring of control circuit by
pressing the button TEST/RESET / self-monitoring
• RESET button Yes, with the TEST/RESET button
• STOP button No
Protection and operation of explosion-proof motors
EC type test certificate number according to PTB 05 ATEX 3022 II (2) GD, --
directive 94/9/EC (ATEX) see
http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/23115758
Ambient temperatures
• Storage/transport °C -40 ... +80
• Operation °C -25 ... +60
• Temperature compensation °C +60
• Permissible rated current
- Temperature inside control cabinet 60 °C % 100
- Temperature inside control cabinet 70 °C % On request
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 IP20: Current measuring modules in sizes S6 and S10/S12 with busbar connection
in conjunction with cover.
Touch protection acc. to IEC 61140 Finger-safe: Current measuring modules in sizes S6 and S10/S12 with busbar
connection in conjunction with cover.
Shock resistance with sine acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) – Interference immunity
• Conductor-related interference
- Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2 (power ports), 1 (signal port)
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
- Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV 2 (line to earth), 1 (line to line)
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Electrostatic discharge according to IEC 61000-4-2 kV 8 (air discharge), 6 (contact discharge)
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Field-related interference according to IEC 61000-4-3 V/m 10
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) – emitted interference Degree of severity A according to EN 55011 (CISPR 11) and EN 55022 (CISPR 22)
Type – Overload relay of current measuring module 3RB29 3RB29 3RB29 3RB29
Size S00/S0 S2/S3 S6 S10/S12
Width 45 mm 55 mm 120 mm 145 mm
Main circuit
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6 8
Rated operational voltage Ue V 690 1000
Type of current
• Direct current No
• Alternating current Yes, 50/60 Hz ± 5 % (other frequencies on request)
Set current A 0.3 ... 3; 10 ... 100 20 ... 200 63 ... 630
2.4 ... 25
Power loss per unit (max.) W 0.5
3
Short-circuit protection
• With fuse without contactor See Selection and Ordering Data
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
• With fuse and contactor See Technical Specifications (short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders)
Safe isolation between main and auxiliary V 6901)
conducting path according to IEC 60947-1
Screw terminal
• Terminal screw -- 4 mm Allen screw 5 mm Allen screw
• Tightening torque -- 10 ... 12 20 ... 22
• Conductor cross-sections (min./max.),
1 or 2 conductors
- Solid m m2 -- -- --
- Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 -- With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (50 ... 185),
2 × (1 × max. 50, 1 × max. 70), front clamping point only:
1 × (10 ... 70) 1 × (70 ... 240)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (1 × max. 95, 1 × max. 120), 1 × (120 ... 185)
1 × (10 ... 120)
- Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 -- With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (50 ... 185),
2 × (1 × max. 50, 1 × max. 70), front clamping point only:
1 × (10 ... 70) 1 × (70 ... 240)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (1 × max. 95, 1 × max. 120), 1 × (120 ... 185)
1 × (10 ... 120)
- Stranded mm2 -- With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (70 ... 240),
2 × (max. 70), front clamping point only:
1 × (16 ... 70) 1 × (95 ... 300)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (max. 120), 1 × (120 ... 240)
1 × (16 ... 120)
- AWG conductors, solid or stranded AWG -- With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (2/0 ... 500 kcmil),
2 × (max. 1/0), front clamping point only:
1 × (6 ... 2/0) 1 × (3/0 ... 600 kcmil)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (max. 3/0), 1 × (250 kcmil ... 500 kcmil)
1 × (6 ... 250 kcmil)
- Ribbon cable conductors mm -- With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (20 × 24 × 0.5),
(number x width x circumference) 2 × (6 × 15.5 × 0.8), 1 × (6 × 9 × 0.8 ...
1 × (3 × 9 × 0.8 ... 6 × 15.5 × 0.8) 20 × 24 × 0.5)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal:
2 × (10 × 15.5 × 0.8),
1 × (3 × 9 × 0.8 ...
10 × 15.5 × 0.8)
Busbar connections
• Terminal screw -- M8 × 25 M10 × 30
• Tightening torque Nm -- 10 ... 14 14 ... 24
• Conductor cross-section (min./max.) --
- Solid with cable lug m m2 -- 16 ... 952) 50 ... 2403)
- Stranded with cable lug m m2 -- 25 ... 1202) 70 ... 2403)
- AWG connections, solid or stranded, with cable lug AWG -- 4 ... 250 kcmil 2/0 ... 500 kcmil
- With connecting bar (max. width) mm -- 15 25
Straight-through transformers
• Diameter of opening mm 7.5 14 25 --
• Conductor cross-section (max.)
- N YY mm2 4) 4) 120 --
- H07RN-F mm2 4) 4)
70 --
1) For grounded networks, otherwise 600 V. 3) When connecting cable lugs according to DIN 46234 for conductor cross-
2) When connecting cable lugs according to DIN 46235, use the sections from 240 mm2 as well as DIN 46235 for conductor cross-sections
3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal cover for conductor cross-sections from 95 mm2 from 185 mm2, use the 3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal cover to ensure phase
to ensure phase spacing. spacing.
4) On request.
3RB2 Solid-State
Overload Relays Overload Relays
SIRIUS 3RB2 Electronic Overload Relays
3RB22, 3RB23 for standard applications
3RB22, 3RB23 up to 630 A for High-Feature applications
H
Dimensions of evaluation modules mm 45 x 111 x 95
(W x H x D)
D
W
3
Type of mounting
• Evaluation modules Stand-alone installation
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
• Current measuring module Size S00 to S3: Stand-alone installation,
S6 and S10/S12: stand-alone installation or mounting onto contactors
Rated power
• 50/60 Hz AC W 0.5
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
• DC W 0.5
Mains buffering time ms 200
Sensor circuit
Thermistor motor protection (PTC thermistor sensor)
• Summation cold resistance kΩ ≤ 1.5
• Response value kΩ 3.4 ... 3.8
• Return value kΩ 1.5 ... 1.65
Ground-fault detection The information refers to sinusoidal residual currents at 50/60 Hz.
• Tripping value IΔ1)
- For 0.3 × Ie < Imotor < 2.0 × Ie > 0.3 × Ie
- For 2.0 × Ie < Imotor < 8.0 × Ie > 0.15 × Imotor
7
• Response time ttrip ms 500 ... 1 000
Analog output1)2)
Rated values
• Output signal mA 4 ... 20
• Measuring range 0 ... 1.25 × Ie
4 mA corresponds to 0 × Ie
16.8 mA corresponds to 1.0 × Ie
20 mA corresponds to 1.25 × Ie
• Load, max. Ω 100
Conductor cross-sections for the auxiliary, control and
sensor circuit as well as the analog output
Connection type Screw terminals
3
2.4 ... 25 A 3RT20 15 7 5 4 7 5 4 7 5 4 35 20
3RT20 16 9 6.5 5.2 9 6.5 5.2 9 6.5 5.2 35 20
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RT20 17 12 9 6.3 10 9 6.3 9 9 6.3 35 20
3RT20 23 9 6.5 5.2 9 6.5 5.2 -- -- -- 63 25
3RT20 24 12 12 9 12 12 9 12 12 9 63 25
3RT20 25 17 17 13 16 16 13 14 14 13 63 25
3RT20 26 25 18 13 16 16 13 14 14 13 100 35
Size S2/S3
On request 3RT20 35 On request
3RT20 36 On request
3RT20 45 On request
3RT20 46 On request
3RT20 47 On request
Size S6
20 ... 200 A 3RT10 54 115 115 115 81.7 81.7 81.7 69 69 69 355 315
3RT10 55 150 150 150 107 107 107 90 90 90 355 315
3RT10 56 185 185 170 131 131 131 111 111 111 355 315
Size S10/S12
160 ... 630 A 3RT10 64 225 225 225 160 160 160 135 135 135 500 400
3RT10 65 265 265 265 188 188 188 159 159 159 500 400
3RT10 66 300 300 280 213 213 213 180 180 180 500 400
3RT10 75 400 400 400 284 284 284 240 240 240 630 400
3RT10 76 500 500 450 355 355 355 300 300 300 630 500
3RT12 64 225 225 225 225 225 225 173 173 173 500 500
3RT12 65 265 265 265 265 265 265 204 204 204 500 500
3RT12 66 300 300 300 300 300 300 231 231 231 500 500
3RT12 75 400 400 400 400 400 400 316 316 316 800 800
3RT12 76 500 500 500 500 500 500 385 385 385 800 800
3TF683) 630 630 630 440 440 440 376 376 376 800 5004)
3TF693) 630 630 630 572 572 572 500 500 500 800 6304)
Characteristic curves
The tripping characteristics show the relationship between the Tripping characteristics for 3-pole loads
tripping time and tripping current as multiples of the set current
Ie and are given for symmetrical three-pole and two-pole loads 1000
NSB0_01525
from the cold state. 800
600
The smallest current used for tripping is called the minimum 400
tripping current. According to IEC 60947-4-1, this current must
Tripping time
s
be within specified limits. The limits of the minimum tripping 200
current for the 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays for
symmetrical three-pole loads are between 105 % and 120 % of
the set current. 100
80
The tripping characteristic starts with the minimum tripping 60
current and continues with higher tripping currents based on the
3
40
characteristics of the so-called trip classes (CLASS 10,
CLASS 20 etc.). The trip classes describe time intervals within 20
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
which the overload relays have to trip with 7.2 times the set CLASS 30
current Ie from the cold state for symmetrical three-pole loads. CLASS 20
10
The tripping times according to IEC 60947-4-1, tolerance band 8
E, are as follows for: 6 CLASS 10
4
Trip class Tripping time CLASS 5
CLASS 5 3…5s 2
CLASS 10 5 … 10 s
CLASS 20 10 … 20 s 1
0,6 1 2 4 6 8 10× e
CLASS 30 20 … 30 s Tripping current
20
CLASS 30
10
8 CLASS 20
6
4 CLASS 10
2 CLASS 5
1
0,6 1 2 4 6 8 10× e
Tripping current
Illustration 2
The above illustrations are schematic representations of
characteristic curves. The characteristic curves of the individual
3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays can be requested from
Technical Assistance at the following e-mail address:
Technical-assistance@siemens.com
Dimensional drawings
86 4
5 59
30
12
106
80
NSB0_01519
45 36
3
5
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB29 06-2BG1, 3RB29 06-2DG1 current measuring module 3RB29 06-2JG1 current measuring module
Schematics
Protection of single-phase motors
(not in conjunction with internal ground-fault detection)
3
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB29 06-2.G1, 3RB29 56-2TG2 3RB29 56-2TH2, 3RB29 66-2WH2
Schematic representation of a possible application (3-phase)
Connections
Evaluation module Function expan- Basic function s I nputs
sion module
A1/A2 T1/T2 Y1/Y2
3RB22 83-4AA1 None Inverse-time delayed protection, Power supply Connection for Electrical
3RB22 83-4AC1 temperature-dependent protection, 24 ... 240 V AC/DC PTC sensor remote RESET
electrical remote RESET,
3RB23 83-4AA1 overload warning
3RB23 83-4AC1 3RB29 85-2CA1 Inverse-time delayed protection, Power supply Connection for Electrical
temperature-dependent protection, 24 ... 240 V AC/DC PTC sensor remote RESET
internal ground-fault detection,
electrical remote RESET,
overload warning
3RB29 85-2CB1 Inverse-time delayed protection, Power supply Connection for Electrical
temperature-dependent protection, 24 ... 240 V AC/DC PTC sensor remote RESET
3
3RB29 85-2AA0 Inverse-time delayed protection, Power supply Connection for Electrical
temperature-dependent protection, 24 ... 240 V AC/DC PTC sensor remote RESET
electrical remote RESET,
overload warning, analog output
3RB29 85-2AA1 Inverse-time delayed protection, Power supply Connection for Electrical
temperature-dependent protection, 24 ... 240 V AC/DC PTC sensor remote RESET
internal ground-fault detection,
electrical remote RESET,
overload warning, analog output
3RB29 85-2AB1 Inverse-time delayed protection, Power supply Connection for Electrical
temperature-dependent protection, 24 ... 240 V AC/DC PTC sensor remote RESET
internal ground-fault detection,
electrical remote RESET,
ground fault signal, analog output
Overview
Overload relays for standard applications Overload relays for high-feature applications
The following accessories are available for the 3RB2/3RB3 The following accessories are available for the 3RB22/3RB23
solid-state overload relays: solid-state overload relays:
• One terminal bracket each for the overload relays size S00 • A sealable cover for the evaluation module
and S0 (sizes S2 to S12 can be installed as single units without • Box terminal blocks for the current measuring modules size S6
a terminal bracket) and S10/S12
• One mechanical RESET module for all sizes • Terminal covers for the current measuring modules size S6
• One cable release for resetting devices which are difficult to and S10/S12
access (for all sizes) • Push-in lugs for screw mounting the size S00 to S3 current
• One sealable cover for all sizes measuring modules
3
• Box terminal blocks for sizes S6 and S10/S12
• Terminal covers for sizes S2 to S10/S12
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Selection and ordering data
Version Size Order No. Weight
per PU
approx.
kg
Terminal brackets for stand-alone installation 1) 2)
For separate mounti ng of the overload relay Screw S00 3RU29 16-3AA01 0.04
panel mount or snapped onto terminals S0 3RU29 26-3AA01 0.05
35 mm standard mounting rail, S2 3RU29 36-3AA01 0.18
size S3 also for 75 mm standard mounting rail S3 3RU29 46-3AA01 0.28
3RU19 00-1.
1) Accessories with a prefix of 3RB39 are intended for 3RB20/3RB30 overload relays only.
2) Only for 3RB20/3RB21. The accessories are identical to those of the
3RU1/3RU2 thermal overload relays.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/49
Overload Relays
3RT19 5.-4G
Push-in lugs
For screw fixing of 3RB22/3RB23 -- 3RP19 03 10 units 0.002
overload relays
3RP19 03
For screw mounting of 3RB29 06 current S00 ... S3 3RB29 00-0B 10 units 0.100
measuring modules
(2 units are required per module)
3RB19 00-0B
For more accessories (tools for spring-loaded terminals and
labeling plates), see page 3/57.
1) Only for 3RB20/3RB21. The accessories are identical to those of the
3RU11 thermal overload relays.
2) In the scope of supply for 3RT10 54-1 contactors (55 kW).
3/50 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Overload Relays
Overview
Overload relays for standard applications Overload relays for High-Feature applications
The following accessories are available for the 3RB20/3RB21 The following accessories are available for the 3RB22/3RB23
solid-state overload relays: solid-state overload relays:
• One terminal bracket each for the overload relays size S00 • A sealable cover for the evaluation module
and S0 (sizes S2 to S12 can be installed as stand-alone • Box terminal blocks for the current measuring modules size S6
installation without a terminal bracket) and S10/S12
• One mechanical remote RESET module for all sizes • Terminal covers for the current measuring modules size S6
• One cable release for resetting devices which are difficult to and S10/S12
access (for all sizes)
• One sealable cover for all sizes
3
• Box terminal blocks for sizes S6 and S10/S12
• Terminal covers for sizes S2 to S10/S12
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Technical specifications
Terminal brackets for stand-alone installation
Type 3RB29 13-0AA1 3RB29 23-0AA1
For overload relay 3RB20 16, 3RB21 13 3RB20 26, 3RB21 23
Size S00 S0
Type of mounting For screw and snap-on mounting onto TH35 standard mounting rail
Connection for main circuit
Connection type Screw terminal
Screw terminal
• Terminal screw Pozidriv size 2
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 2 ... 2.5
• Conductor cross-section (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors
- So l i d mm 2 1 × (0.5 ... 2.5), 1 × (1 ... 6),
Max. 1 × (... 4) Max. 1 × (... 10)
- Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 -- --
- F inely stranded with end sleeve mm 2 1 × (0.5 ... 2.5) 1 × (1 ... 6)
- Stranded m m2 1 × (0.5 ... 2.5), 1 × (1 ... 6),
Max. 1 × (... 4) Max. 1 × (... 10)
- AWG conductors, solid or stranded AWG 1 × (18 ... 14) 1 × (14 ... 10)
3RB24
SIRIUSSolid-State Overload
3RB2 Solid-State Relays
Overload Relays
3RB24
3RB24 for for IO-Link,
IO-Link, up630
up to to A
630
forAHigh-Feature applications
for High-Feature applications
Overview
break time depends on the ratio between the tripping current
and current setting Ie and is stored in the form of a long-term sta-
NSB0_02180
ble tripping characteristic see www.siemens.com/sirius/support
"Characteristic Curves"). The "tripped" status is signaled by
means of a continuously illuminated red "OVERLOAD" LED and
also reported as a group fault via IO-Link.
The LED indicates imminent tripping of the relay due to overload,
phase unbalance or phase failure by flickering when the limit
current has been violated. This warning can also be reported to
the higher-level PLC via IO-Link at the 3RB24 overload relay.
In addition to the described inverse-time delayed protection of
loads against excessive temperature rises, the 3RB24 solid-
3
Motor current and trip class setting: ground-fault detection (for details see "Manual for SIRIUS 3RB24
Setting the device to the motor current and to the required trip Solid-State Overload Relay for IO-Link",, not possible in conjunc-
class dependent on the start-up conditions is easy with the two
rotary switches. tion with contactor assembly for wye-delta starting). In the event
of a ground fault, the 3RB24 relays trip instantaneously.
Selector switch for manual/automatic RESET:
With this switch you can choose between manual and automatic The "tripped" status is signaled by means of a flashing red LED
RESET. "Ground Fault" and reported at the overload relay 3RB24 as a
Test/RESET button: group fault via IO-Link.
Enables testing of all important device components and functions,
plus resetting of the device after a trip when manual RESET is The reset after overload, phase unbalance, phase failure, therm-
selected. istor or ground-fault tripping is performed manually by key on
site, via IO-Link or by electrical remote RESET or automatically
Connecting terminals (removable terminal block): after the cooling time (motor model) or for thermistor protection
The generously sized terminals permit connection of two
conductors with different cross-sections for the auxiliary, control after sufficient cooling. Power cuts in devices due to function
and sensor circuits. Connection is possible with screw connection monitoring (broken wire or short circuit on the thermistor) can
and alternatively with spring-type connection. only be reset on-site ("Function" see "Manual for SIRIUS 3RB24
Plug-in point for operator panel: Solid-State Overload Relay for IO-Link",). In conjunction with a
enables connection of the 3RA69 35-0A operator panel. function expansion module, the motor current measured by the
microprocessor can be output in the form of an analog signal DC
4 to 20 mA for operating rotary coil instruments or for feeding
into analog inputs of programmable logic controllers.
SIRIUS 3RB24 evaluation module
The current values can be transmitted to the higher-level control-
The modular electronic overload relay 3RB24, which is powered ler via IO-Link.
via IO-Link (with monostable auxiliary contacts) up to 630 A (up
to 820 A possible with a series transformer) have been designed The devices are manufactured in accordance with environmen-
for inverse-time delayed protection of loads with normal and tal guidelines and contain environmentally friendly and reusable
heavy starting ("Function" see "Manual for SIRIUS 3RB24 Solid- materials.
State Overload Relay for IO-Link",) against excessive tempera- They comply with all important worldwide standards and ap-
ture rises due to overload, phase unbalance or phase failure. It provals.
comprises an evaluation unit, a current measuring module and
a connecting cable. The evaluation module 3RB24 also offers an Type of protection "increased safety EEx e and explosion-
motor starter function: The contactors, which are connected via proof enclosure EEx d" in accordance with ATEX Directive
the auxiliary contacts, can also be actuated for operation via 94/9/EC
IO-Link. In this way, direct, reversing and star-delta starters up to The electronic overload relay 3RB24 (monostable) are suitable
630 A (or 830 A) can be connected to the controller wirelessly for the overload protection of explosion-proof motors of types of
via the IO-Link controller. protection EEx e and EEx d.
An overload, phase unbalance or phase failure result in an in- They comply with the requirements of EN 60079-7 (Electrical ap-
crease of the motor current beyond the set rated motor current. paratus for areas subject to explosion hazards - Increased
This
This current
current rise
rise is
is detected
detected by by means
means ofof the
the current
current measuring
measuring safety "e" as well as for flameproof enclosure "d");
module
module (see
(see page
page3/55)
7/134)andandelectronically
electronicallyevaluated
evaluatedby by
thethe see www.siemens.com/sirius/atex.
evaluation module
evaluation module which
which isis connected
connected toto it. The evaluation
evaluation elec-
elec- EC type test certificate for Group II, Category (2) G/D has been
tronics sends
tronics sends aa signal
signaltoto the
the auxiliary
auxiliarycontacts.
contacts.The Theauxiliary
auxiliary submitted. On request.
contacts then switch off the load by by means
means of of aa contactor.
contactor. The
3
Example 3RB 2 4 8 3 – 4 A A 1
Note: For your orders, please use the order numbers quoted in the
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
catalog in the Selection and ordering data.
The Order No. scheme is presented here merely for information
purposes and for better understanding of the logic behind the
order numbers.
Benefits
The most important features and benefits of the 3RB24 solid-
state overload relays for IO-Link are listed in the overview table
(see "General Data", page 3/2 onwards).
Advantages through energy efficiency We offer you a unique portfolio for industrial energy manage-
ment, using an energy management system that helps to opti-
7
mally define your energy needs. We split up our industrial en-
ergy management into three phases – Identification, Evaluation
and Realization – and we support you with the appropriate hard-
ware and software solutions in every process phase.
The innovative products of the SIRIUS industrial controls portfo-
lio can also make a substantial contribution to a plant's energy
efficiency (see www.siemens.com/sirius/energysaving).
3RB24 solid-state overload relays for IO-Link contribute to en-
ergy efficiency throughout the plant as follows:
• Transmission of current values
4
0 24
Application
Industries If single-phase AC motors are to be protected by the 3RB24
solid-state overload relays, the main current paths of the current
The 3RB24 solid-state overload relays are suitable for customers measuring modules must be series-connected ("Schematics"
from all industries who want to guarantee optimum inverse-time see "Manual for SIRIUS 3RB24 Solid-State Overload Relay for
delayed and temperature-dependent protection of their electri- IO-Link",).
cal loads (e.g. motors) under normal and heavy starting condi-
tions (CLASS 5 to 30), minimize project completion times, inven- Ambient conditions
tories and energy consumption, and optimize plant availability
and maintenance management. The devices are insensitive to external influences such as
shocks, corrosive ambient conditions, ageing and temperature
Application fluctuations.
The 3RB24 solid-state overload relays have been designed for For the temperature range from –25 C to +60 °C, the 3RB24
the protection of three-phase asynchronous and single-phase solid-state overload relays compensate the temperature in ac-
AC motors. cordance with IEC 60947-4-1.
In addition to protection function, these devices can be used to- Configuration notes for use of the devices below –25 °C or
gether with contactors as direct or reversing starters (star-delta above +60 °C on request.
(wye-delta) start also possible), which are controlled via IO-Link.
This makes it possible to directly control drives via IO-Link from
a higher-level controller or on site via the optional hand-held de-
vice lamps and also, for example, to return current values di-
rectly via IO-Link.
Remote-RESET
(electrically or via IO-Link)
4 LEDs for operating and status displays
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
7
Available
PU (UNIT, SET, M) = 1
PS* = 1 unit
PG = 41G
Evaluation modules
S00 ... S12 Monostable 3RB24 83-4AA1 3RB24 83-4AC1
Notes:
• Analog input modules, e.g. SM 331, must be configured for Current
Current measuring
measuring modules
modules and
and related
related connecting
connectingcables
cablessee
see
. transducers. The analog input module may
4-wire measuring page
page 3/55,
3/55, accessories
accessories see
see pages
pages3/56
3/56 and
and 3/57.
3/57.
not supply current to the analog output of the 3RB24 relay.
3/54 Siemens
* You can order Industry
this quantity Inc., Industrial
or a multiple thereof. Control Catalog
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2012 7/133
Overload Relays
Overload Relays
3RB24
SIRIUSSolid-State Overload
3RB2 Solid-State Relays
Overload Relays
Current measuring modules for
Current measuring modules for 3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24
3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24
3
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB29 06-2.G1
Sizes S2/S32)6)
S2/S3 5.5 … 45 10 … 100 315 3RB22 to } 3RB29 06-2JG1 1 1 unit 41G
3RB24
3RB29 06-2JG1
Size S61)6)
7
3RB29 66-2WH2
3)
Note: Observe maximum rated operational current of the devices.
4)
Guide value for 4-pole standard motors at 50 Hz 400 V AC. The actual
The connecting cable between the current measuring module starting and rated data of the motor to be protected must be considered
and the evaluation module is not included in the scope of sup- when selecting the units.
ply; please order separately. 5)
Maximum protection by fuse for overload relay, type of coordination "2".
"Fuse Values in Connection with Contactors" see
1)
The current measuring modules with an Order No. ending with "2" are - "Configuration Manual for Configuring SIRIUS – Selection Data for Load
designed for mounting onto contactor and stand-alone installation. For Feeders in Fuseless and Fused Designs"
3TF68/3TF69 contactors, direct mounting is not possible. - "Configuration Manual for Configuring SIRIUS Innovations – Selection
2) Data for Load Feeders in Fuseless and Fused Designs".
The current measuring modules with an Order No. ending with "1" are 6)
designed for stand-alone installation. The modules with an Order No. with "G" in penultimate position are
equipped with a straight-through transformer.
Accessories
Size of con- Version For over- DT Order No. Price PU Pack PG
tactor load relays per PU (UNIT, Units
SET, M)
Additional general
Additional generalaccessories
accessoriessee
seepage
page3/57.
3/57.
Overview
Overload relays for High-Feature applications • Terminal covers for the 3RB29 current measuring modules
sizes S6 and S10/S12
The following optional accessories are available for the 3RB22 to
3RB24 solid-state overload relays: • Box terminal blocks for the 3RB29 current measuring modules
sizes S6 and S10/S12
• Operator panel for the evaluation modules 3RB24
• Push-in lugs for screw fixing for 3RB22 to 3RB24 evaluation
• Manual 3RB24 modules and 3RB29 06 current measuring modules
• Sealable cover for the evaluation modules 3RB22 to 3RB24
7
rately.
Connecting cable 3RB24 } 3UF79 33-0BA00-0 1 1 unit 42J
Length 2 m (round),
for connecting the evaluation module to the
operator panel
Enabling modules (replacement) 3RB24 A 3RA69 36-0A 1 1 unit 42F
Interface covers 3RB24 A 3RA69 33-0B 1 5 units 42F
1) The manual is also available as a free PDF download on the Internet at Additional general accessories see next page.
www.siemens.com/sirius/support "Manuals/Operating Instructions".
3/56 Siemens
* You can order Industry
this quantity Inc., Industrial
or a multiple thereof. Control Catalog
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2012 7/137
Overload Relays
Overload Relays
3RB24
SIRIUSSolid-State Overload
3RB2 Solid-State Relays
Overload Relays
Accessories for 3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24
Accessories for 3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24
General accessories
Version Size For over- Order No. PU Pack
load relays (UNIT, Units
SET, M)
3RB29 84-2
Terminal covers for current measuring modules
3
Covers for cable lugs and busbar con-
nections
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
• Length 100 mm S6 3RB29 56 3RT19 56-4EA1 1 1 unit
• Length 120 mm S10/S12 3RB29 66 3RT19 66-4EA1 1 1 unit
Covers for box terminals
• Length 25 mm S6 3RB29 56 3RT19 56-4EA2 1 1 unit
• Length 30 mm S10/S12 3RB29 66 3RT19 66-4EA2 1 1 unit
Covers for screw terminals S6 3RB29 56 3RT19 56-4EA3 1 1 unit
between contactor and overload relay, S10/S12 3RB29 66 3RT19 66-4EA3 1 1 unit
without box terminals
(1 unit required per combination)
Box terminal blocks for current measuring modules
For round and ribbon cables
• Up to 70 mm2 S61) 3RT19 55-4G
7
3RB29 56 1 1 unit
• Up to 120 mm2 S6 3RB29 56 3RT19 56-4G 1 1 unit
• Up to 240 mm2 S10/S12 3RB29 66 3RT19 66-4G 1 1 unit
Technical specifications for conductor cross-sections see "Reference
Manual for Protection Equipment–
3RT19 5.-4G 3RU1, 3RB2 Overload Relays".
Push-in lugs for evaluation modules and current measuring modules
For screw fixing the evaluation modules -- 3RB22 to 3RP19 03 1 10 units
3RB24
3RP19 03
For screw fixing the current measuring S00 ... S3 3RB29 06 3RB19 00-0B 100 10 units
modules
(2 units per module)
3RB29 00-0B
1) In the scope of supply for 3RT10 54-1 contactors (55 kW).
3RT19 00-1SB20
1)
PC labeling system for individual inscription
of unit labeling plates available from:
murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH
(see "Appendix" "External Partners").
Technical specifications
Type – Overload relay of evaluation modules 3RB24 83-4A.1
Size of contactor S00 ... S10/S12
General data
Trips in the event of Overload, phase failure and phase unbalance (> 40 % according to NEMA),
+ ground fault (connectable and disconnectable) and activation of the thermis-
tor motor protection (with closed PTC sensor circuit)
Trip class acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 CLASS 5, 10, 20 and 30 adjustable
Phase failure sensitivity Yes
Overload warning Yes, from 1.125 x Ie for symmetrical loads
and from 0.85 x Ie for unsymmetrical loads
Reset and recovery
• Reset options after tripping Manual and automatic RESET, electrical remote RESET or through IO-Link
3
• Recovery time
- For automatic RESET min - for tripping due to overcurrent: 3 (stored permanently)
- for tripping by thermistor: time until the motor temperature has fallen 5 K
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
H
Dimensions of evaluation modules (W x H x D) mm 45 x 111 x 95
D
W
Auxiliary circuit
Number of auxiliary switches 1 CO contact, 1 NO contact connected in series internally
Auxiliary contacts – assignment • 1 CO contact for selecting the contactor (for reversing starter func-
tion), actuated by the control system
• 1 NO contact for normal switching duty, actuated by the control sys-
tem (opens automatically when tripping occurs)
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 300
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 4
Auxiliary contacts – contact rating
3
• NC contact with alternating current AC-14/AC-15, rated operational current Ie at Ue
- 24 V A 6
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
- 120 V A 6
- 125 V A 6
- 250 V A 3
• NO contact with alternating current AC-14/AC-15, rated operational current Ie at Ue
- 24 V A 6
- 120 V A 6
- 125 V A 6
- 250 V A 3
• NC contact, NO contact with direct current DC-13, rated operational current Ie at Ue
- 24 V A 2
- 60 V A 0.55
- 110 V A 0.3
- 125 V A 0.3
7
- 250 V A 0.2
• Conventional thermal current Ith A 5
• Contact reliability (suitability for PLC control; 17 V, 5 mA) Yes
Short-circuit protection
• With fuse, operational class gG A 6
• With miniature circuit breaker, C characteristic A 1.6
Protective separation between auxiliary conducting paths V 300
acc. to IEC 60947-1
CSA, UL, UR rated data
Auxiliary circuit – switching capacity B300, R300
Conductor cross-sections of the auxiliary circuit
Connection type Screw terminals
3RB24
SIRIUSSolid-State Overload
3RB2 Solid-State Relays
Overload Relays
Current measuring modules for
Current measuring modules for 3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24
3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24
Overview
The current measuring modules are designed as system com-
ponents for connecting to evaluation units 3RB22 to 3RB24. Us-
ing these evaluation units the motor current is measured and the
measured value sent to the evaluation unit for evaluation. The
current measuring modules in sizes S00 to S3 up to 55 mm wide
are equipped with straight-through transformers and can be
snap-fitted under the evaluation units. The larger evaluation units
are installed directly on the contactor or as stand-alond units.
3
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
SIRIUS 3RB29 06 current measuring module
Technical specifications
Type – Overload relays: Current measuring 3RB29 06 3RB29 56 3RB29 66
modules
Size of contactor S00/S0 S2/S3 S6 S10/S12
H
Dimensions of current measuring modules mm 45 x 84 x 45 55 x 94 x 72 120 x 119 x 145 145 x 147 x 148
D
W
(W x H x D)
Main circuit
7
H
Dimensions of current measuring modules mm 45 x 84 x 45 55 x 94 x 72 120 x 119 x 145 145 x 147 x 148
D
W
(W x H x D)
Conductor cross-sections of the main circuit
Connection type Screw terminals with box terminal
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 — With 3RT19 55-4G 2 × (50 ... 185),
box terminal: rear clamping point
2 × (1 × max. 50, only:
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
7
box terminal: only:
2 × (1 × max. 95, 1 × (120 ... 185)
1 × max. 120),
1 × (10 ... 120)
• Stranded mm2 — With 3RT19 55-4G 2 × (70 ... 240),
box terminal: rear clamping point
2 × (max. 70), only:
1 × (16 ... 70) 1 × (95 ... 300)
With 3RT19 56-4G
box terminal: Rear clamping point
2 × (max. 120), only:
1 × (16 ... 120) 1 × (120 ... 240)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG — With 3RT19 55-4G 2 × (2/0 ... 500 kcmil),
box terminal: rear clamping point
2 × (max. 1/0), only:
1 × (6 ... 2/0) 1 × (3/0 ... 600 kcmil)
With 3RT19 56-4G
box terminal: Rear clamping point
2 × (max. 3/0), only:
1 × (6 ... 250 kcmil) 1×
(250 kcmil ... 500 kcmil)
• Ribbon cables (number x width x thickness) mm — With 3RT19 55-4G 2 × (20 × 24 × 0.5),
box terminal: 1 × (6 × 9 × 0.8 ...
2 × (6 × 15.5 × 0.8), 20 × 24 × 0.5)
1 × (3 × 9 × 0.8 ...
6 × 15.5 × 0.8)
With 3RT19 56-4G
box terminal:
2 × (10 × 15.5 × 0.8),
1 × (3 × 9 × 0.8 ...
10 × 15.5 × 0.8)
Connection type Busbar connections
Terminal screw — M8 × 25 M10 x 30
Prescribed tightening torque Nm — 10 ... 14 14 ... 24
Conductor cross-sections (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid with cable lug mm2 — 16 ... 951) 50 ... 2402)
• Stranded with cable lug mm2 — 25 ... 1201) 70 ... 2402)
• AWG cable, solid or stranded, with cable lug AWG — 4 ... 250 kcmil 2/0 ... 500 kcmil
• with connecting bar (max. width) mm — 17 25
Connection type Straight-through transformers
Diameter of opening mm 7.5 14 25 —
1) When connecting cable lugs according to DIN 46235 with conductor 2) When connecting cable lugs according to DIN 46234 with conductor
cross-sections of 95 mm2 and more, the 3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal cover cross-sections of 240 mm2 and more as well as to DIN 46235 with conduc-
must be used to ensure phase spacing. tor cross-sections of 185 mm2 and more, the 3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal
cover must be used for to keep the phase clearance.
■ Overview
SIMOCODE pro offers, for example:
• Multifunctional, solid-state full motor protection that is
independent of the automation system
• Integrated control functions instead of hardware for the motor
control
• Detailed operational, service and diagnostics data
• Open communication via PROFIBUS, PROFINET/PROFIsafe,
Modbus RTU, and Ethernet IP and OPC UA – which also lets
you take advantage of the cloud
• Safety relay function for the fail-safe disconnection of motors
up to SIL 3 (IEC 61508, IEC 62061) or PL e with Category 4
3
(EN ISO 13849-1)
• SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) is the software package for
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
SIMOCODE pro parameterization, start up and diagnostics.
Device series
Basic Performance with SIMOCODE pro C
SIMOCODE pro S and SIMOCODE pro V
The compact system for direct-on-line starters and reversing
More information starters or for controlling a motor starter protector.
Home page, see
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/simocode
www.siemens.com/simocode General Performance with SIMOCODE pro S or
Industry
IndustryMall,
Mall,see
seewww.siemens.com/product?3UF7
www.siemens.com/product?3UF7 SIMOCODE pro V PN GP
TIA
TIA Selection
SelectionTool
ToolCloud
Cloud(TST
(TSTCloud)
Cloud) The smart system for direct-on-line, reversing, and wye-delta
• For SIMOCODE
• For SIMOCODEpro proS,S,see
see starters or for controlling a motor starter protector or soft starter.
https://mall.industry.siemens.com/spice/TSTWeb/?kmat=SimocodeProS
https://mall.industry.siemens.com/spice/TSTWeb/?kmat=SimocodeProS
• For SIMOCODE
• For SIMOCODEpro proV,V,see
see Its expandability with an expansion module/multifunction
https://mall.industry.siemens.com/spice/TSTWeb/?kmat=SimocodeProV
https://mall.industry.siemens.com/spice/TSTWeb/?kmat=SimocodeProV module provides comprehensive input/output project data
volume, precise ground-fault detection via the 3UL23 residual-
SIMOCODE pro is a flexible, modular motor management current transformers and temperature measurement.
system for motors with constant speeds in the low-voltage
performance range. It optimizes the connection between I&C High Performance with SIMOCODE pro V
and motor feeder, increases plant availability and allows The variable system with all control functions and with the
significant savings to be made for installation, commissioning, possibility of expanding the inputs, outputs and functions of
operation and maintenance of a system. the system at will using expansion modules
10
PROFINET IO / OPC UA ETHERNET / IP PROFIBUS MODBUS RTU
Performance
High
Safety
SIMOCODE pro V PN SIMOCODE pro V EIP SIMOCODE pro V PB SIMOCODE pro V MR
Operator panel
General
1 expansion module
IC01_00548a
Device series
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/63
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
General data
General data
PROFIBUS
Functions
3RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Optional expansions
One option can be selected
1 2 3
Basic
Current Basic unit Operator Ground-fault Temperature Digital module
measuring module panel module module Standard
SIMOCODE pro V PN GP
PROFINET
Functions
IC01_00532a
10
Communication
Functions
3/64 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
General data
General data
Expansion possibilities SIMOCODE pro C SIMOCODE pro S SIMOCODE pro V SIMOCODE pro V
Basic Performance General Performance General Performance High Performance
PROFIBUS PROFIBUS PROFINET GP PROFIBUS/Modbus PROFINET/
RTU EtherNet/IP
Operator panels ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
Operator panels -- -- -- ✓ ✓
with display
Current measuring modules ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
Current/voltage measuring modules -- -- -- ✓ ✓
Expansion modules:
• Digital modules -- -- 12) 2 2
• Fail-safe digital modules1) -- -- -- 1 1
3
• Analog modules -- -- -- 1 2
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
• Ground-fault modules -- -- 1 1 1
• Temperature modules -- -- 1 1 2
• Multifunction modules -- 1 -- -- --
1)
✓ Available The fail-safe digital module can be used instead of one of the two digital
-- Not available modules.
2)
Only monostable version can be used.
Per feeder each system always comprises one basic unit and added to the SIMOCODE pro V and SIMOCODE pro S by
one current measuring module. The two modules are connected means of optional expansion modules, thus supplementing the
together electrically through the system interface with a connec- inputs and outputs already existing on the basic unit. With the
tion cable and can be mounted mechanically connected (one DM-F Local and DM-F PROFIsafe fail-safe digital modules it is
behind the other) or separately (side by side). The motor current also possible to integrate the fail-safe disconnection of motors in
to be monitored determines the size of the current measuring the SIMOCODE pro V motor management system.
module.
All modules are connected by connection cables. The connec-
An operator panel for mounting in the control cabinet door is tion cables are available in various lengths. The maximum dis-
optionally connectable through a second system interface on tance between modules (e.g. between the basic unit and the
the basic unit. Both the current measuring module and the current measuring module) must not exceed 2.5 m. The total
operator panel are electrically supplied by the basic unit through length of all the connection cables per system interface of the
the connection cable. More inputs, outputs and functions can be basic unit may be up to 3 m.
10
Product versions Article number
SIMOCODE pro motor management system 3UF7 @@@– 1 @@0 @– 0
Type of unit/module e.g. 0 = basic unit @
Functional version of the module e.g. 20 = SIMOCODE pro S @@
Connection type of the current transformer e.g. A = through-hole technology @
Voltage version e.g. B = 24 V DC @
Enclosure color e.g. 1 = titanium gray @
Example 3UF7 0 2 0 – 1 A B 0 1 – 0
Note:
The Article No. scheme shows an overview of product versions For your orders, please use the article numbers quoted in the
for better understanding of the logic behind the article numbers. selection and ordering data.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/65
Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE
SIMOCODE pro pro
3UF73UF7
Motor Management and Control Devices
General data
General data
■ Benefits
General customer benefits Recording of measuring curves
• Integrating the whole motor feeder into the process control by SIMOCODE pro can record measuring curves and therefore is
means of PROFIBUS DP, PROFINET/OPC UA, Modbus RTU able, for example, to present the progression of motor current
or EtherNet/IP significantly reduces the wiring between the during motor start up.
motor feeder and the PLC
• Decentralization of the automated processes by means of Flexible motor control implemented with integrated control
configurable control and monitoring functions in the feeder functions (instead of comprehensive hardware interlocks)
saves resources in the automation system and ensures full Many predefined motor control functions have already been
functionality and protection of the feeder even if the I&C or bus integrated into SIMOCODE pro, including all necessary logic
system fails operations and interlocks:
• The acquisition and monitoring of operating, service and • Overload relays
diagnostics data in the feeder and process control system
3
• The high degree of modularity allows users to perfectly • Two speeds, motors with separate windings (pole-changing
implement their plant-specific requirements for each starter); also with direction reversal
motor feeder • Two speeds, motors with separate Dahlander windings
• The SIMOCODE pro system offers functionally graded and (also with direction reversal)
space-saving solutions for each customer application • Positioner actuation
• The replacement of the control circuit hardware with integrated • Solenoid valve actuation
control functions decreases the number of hardware compo- • Actuation of a motor starter protector
nents and wiring required and in this way limits stock keeping
costs and potential wiring errors • Soft starter actuation (also with direction reversal)
• The use of electronic full motor protection permits better These control functions are predefined in SIMOCODE pro and
utilization of the motors and ensures long-term stability of can be freely assigned to the inputs and outputs of the device
the tripping characteristic and reliable tripping even after (including the PROFIBUS/PROFINET process image).
years of service
These predefined control functions can also be flexibly adapted
• Thanks to the precision of the current, voltage, power and to each customized configuration of a motor feeder by means of
energy measurements, costs can be internally allocated with freely configurable logic modules (truth tables, counters, timers,
a high degree of accuracy edge evaluation, etc.) and with the help of standard functions
• By virtue of its wide frequency range (20 to 400 Hz), (power failure monitoring, emergency start, external faults, etc.),
SIMOCODE can be used in combination with the without additional auxiliary relays being necessary in the control
2nd-generation current/voltage measuring modules circuit.
in a wide range of motor applications. SIMOCODE pro makes a lot of additional hardware and wiring
Multifunctional, electronic full motor protection in the control circuit unnecessary, which results in a high level
for rated motor currents up to 820 A of standardization of the motor feeder in terms of its design and
circuit diagrams.
SIMOCODE pro offers comprehensive protection of the motor
10
3/66 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
General data
General data
Detailed operational, service and diagnostics data Communication
SIMOCODE pro makes different operational, service and SIMOCODE pro V has either an integrated PROFIBUS DP
diagnostics data available and helps to detect potential faults or Modbus RTU interface (SUB-D or terminal connection)
in time and to prevent them by means of preventative measures. or a PROFINET or EtherNet/IP interface (2 x RJ45).
In the event of a malfunction, a fault can be diagnosed, localized
and rectified very quickly – there are no or very short downtimes. Fail-safe disconnection through PROFIBUS or PROFINET with
the PROFIsafe profile is also possible in conjunction with a
Operating data fail-safe controller (F-CPU) and the DM-F PROFIsafe fail-safe
• Motor switching state derived from the current flow in the main digital module.
circuit SIMOCODE pro PROFIBUS
• All phase currents SIMOCODE pro PROFIBUS supports, for example:
• All phase voltages and phase-to-phase voltages • Cyclic services (DPV0) and acyclic services (DPV1)
• Active power, apparent power and power factor • Extensive diagnostics and hardware interrupts
3
• Phase unbalance and phase sequence • Time stamp with high timing precision (SIMATIC S7)
• Ground-fault current for SIMOCODE pro V
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
• Frequency • DPV1 communication after the Y-Link
• Time to trip SIMOCODE pro PROFINET
• Motor temperature
SIMOCODE pro PROFINET supports, for example:
• Remaining cooling time etc.
• Line and ring bus topology (for 2-port devices with an
Service data integrated switch)
• Motor operating hours • Media redundancy via MRP protocol (for 2-port devices with
• Motor stop times an integrated switch)
• Number of motor starts • Operating, service and diagnostics data via standard web
browser
• Number of overload trips
• OPC UA server for open communication with visualization and
• Interval for compulsory testing of the enabling circuits control system
• Energy consumed • NTP-synchronized time
• Internal comments stored in the device etc. • Interval function and measured values for power
Diagnostics data management via PROFIenergy
• Numerous detailed early warning and fault messages • Module exchange without PC/memory module through
proximity detection
• Internal device fault logging with time stamp
• Extensive diagnostics and maintenance alarms
• Time stamping of freely selectable status, alarm or fault
messages etc. System redundancy with SIMOCODE pro PROFINET
Easy operation and diagnostics All SIMOCODE PROFINET devices support the system
redundancy mechanisms of PROFINET IO and therefore
Operator panel can be operated directly on fault-tolerant systems such as
10
The operator panel is used to control the motor feeder and can SIMATIC S7-400 H. As such, SIMOCODE pro can provide
replace all conventional pushbuttons and indicator lights to save decisive added value also for the field level of plants in which
space. It makes SIMOCODE pro or the feeder directly operable plant availability and control system redundancy are priorities.
in the control cabinet. It features all the status LEDs available on SIMOCODE pro Modbus RTU
the basic unit and externalizes the system interface for simple
parameterization or diagnosis on a PC/PG. SIMOCODE pro Modbus RTU supports, for example:
Operator panel with display • Communication at 1 200/2 400/4 800/9 600/19 200 or
57 600 baud
As an alternative to the 3UF720 standard operator panel for • Access to freely parameterizable process image via
SIMOCODE pro V, a 3UF721 operator panel with display is Modbus RTU
also available. This can additionally indicate current measured
values, operational and diagnostics data or status information of • Access to all operating, service and diagnostics data
the motor feeder at the control cabinet. The pushbuttons of the via Modbus RTU
operator panel can be used to control the motor. Furthermore, SIMOCODE pro EtherNet/IP
it is possible to set parameters such as rated motor current,
limit values, etc. directly via the operator panel with display SIMOCODE pro EtherNet/IP supports, for example:
(with SIMOCODE pro V PROFIBUS as of E15, SIMOCODE pro V • Line and ring bus topology thanks to an integrated switch
Modbus RTU as of E03 and with all SIMOCODE pro V PROFINET
and EtherNet/IP). • Ring structures via Device Level Ring (DLR) protocol
• Operating, service and diagnostics data via standard web
browser
• NTP-synchronized time
• Parameter assignment via SIMOCODE ES V14 or higher – via
local device interface and Ethernet
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/67
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
General data
General data
Notes on security Advantages from integrated energy management
In order to protect plants, systems, machines and networks
against cyber threats, it is necessary to implement – and
continuously maintain – a holistic, state-of-the-art industrial
security concept. Siemens products and solutions represent
only one component of such a concept. Ready for Ready for
SIMATIC
siemens.com/ SIMATIC
For more information on Industrial Security, see Energy Suite
www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity. energysuite Energy Suite
Autonomous operation As an integrated option for the TIA Portal, the SIMATIC Energy
An essential feature of SIMOCODE pro is the autonomous Suite couples energy management with automation efficiently,
execution of all protection and control functions, even when making energy consumption at your production facility
communication to the I&C system is interrupted. This means transparent.
3
that even in the event of bus system or automation system Thanks to the simplified configuration of energy-measuring
failure, full functionality of the feeder is ensured or a specific components, e.g. SIMOCODE pro V, configuration effort is
behavior can be parameterized in case of such a fault, e.g. also clearly reduced.
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
Application
SIMOCODE pro is often used for automated processes where With the DM-F Local and DM-F PROFIsafe fail-safe expansion
plant downtimes are very expensive (e.g. chemical, oil/gas, modules it is easy to integrate functions for fail-safe disconnection
water/wastewater, steel or cement industries) and where it is in the SIMOCODE pro V motor management system while
important to prevent plant downtimes through detailed retaining service-proven concepts. The strict separation of
operational, service and diagnostics data or to localize faults safety functions and operational functions proves particularly
very quickly when they occur. advantageous for planning, configuring and construction.
Seamless integration in the motor management system leads
SIMOCODE pro is modular and space-saving and suited to greater transparency for diagnostics and during operation
especially for operation in motor control centers (MCCs) of the system.
in the process industry and for power plant technology.
10
Suitable components for this purpose are the DM-F Local and
Applications DM-F PROFIsafe fail-safe expansion modules, depending on
• Protection and control of motors in hazardous areas for types the requirements:
of protection EEx e/d according to ATEX directive 2014/34/EU • The DM-F Local fail-safe digital module for when direct
- With heavy starting (paper, cement, metal and water assignment between a fail-safe hardware shutdown signal
industries) and a motor feeder is required, or
- In high-availability plants (chemical, oil, raw material
processing industries, power plants) • The DM-F PROFIsafe fail-safe digital module for when
a fail-safe controller (F-CPU) creates the signal for
• New: Dry-running protection of centrifugal pumps based disconnection and transmits it in a fail-safe manner
on active power monitoring for type of protection Ex b through PROFIBUS/PROFIsafe or PROFINET/PROFIsafe
Use of SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 with IE3/IE4 motors to the motor management system
3/68 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Technical data
General data
■ Technical specifications
More information
Technical specifications, see Application Manual "SIRIUS Controls with IE3/IE4 motors", see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16337/td https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/94770820
Manual Collection "SIMOCODE pro", see Configuration Manual "Load Feeders – SIRIUS Modular System", see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743951 https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/39714188
System Manual "SIMOCODE pro Safety Fail-Safe Digital Modules", see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/50564852
General data
Type 3UF7
Permissible ambient temperature
3
• During operation °C -25 ... +60; 3UF721: 0 ... +60
• During storage and transport °C -40 ... +80; 3UF721: -20 ... +70
Degree of protection (acc. to IEC 60529)
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
• Measurement modules with busbar connection IP00
• Operator panel (front) and door adapter (front) with cover IP54
• Other components IP20
Shock resistance (sine pulse) g/ms 15/11
Mounting position Any
Frequency Hz 50/60 5%
EMC interference immunity (according to IEC 60947-1) Corresponds to degree of severity 3
• Conducted interference, burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2 (power ports)
kV 1 (signal port)
• Conducted interference, high frequency acc. to V 10
IEC 61000-4-6
• Conducted interference, surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV 2 (line to ground); 3UF7320-1AB, 3UF7330-1AB: 1 (line to ground)
kV 1 (line to line); 3UF7320-1AB, 3UF7330-1AB: 0.5 (line to line)
• Electrostatic discharge, ESD acc. to IEC 61000-4-2 kV 8 (air discharge); 3UF7020: Operator input during operation only on the front
kV 6 (contact discharge); 3UF721: 4 (contact discharge)
• Field-related interference acc. to IEC 61000-4-3 V/m 10
EMC emitted interference (according to IEC 60947-1)
• Conducted and radiated interference emission EN 55011/EN 55022 (CISPR 11/CISPR 22)
(corresponds to degree of severity A)
Protective separation (acc. to IEC 60947-1) All circuits in SIMOCODE pro are safely separated from each other according
to IEC 60947-1, i.e. they are designed with doubled creepage paths and
clearances. In this context, compliance with the instructions in the test report
"Safe Isolation" No. 2668 is required.
10
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/69
Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Technical data
General data
Basic units
Type 3UF7000-1AU00-0, 3UF7010-1AU00-0, 3UF7000-1AB00-0, 3UF7010-1AB00-0,
3UF7011-1AU00-., 3UF7020-1AU01-0, 3UF7011-1AB00-., 3UF7020-0AB01-0,
3UF7012-1AU00-0, 3UF7013-1AU00-0 3UF7012-1AB00-0, 3UF7013-1AB00-0
Control circuit
Rated control supply voltage Us (acc. to IEC 61131-2) 110 ... 240 V AC/DC; 50/60 Hz 24 V DC
Operating range
• SIMOCODE pro C (3UF7000) and SIMOCODE pro V PROFIBUS 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us 0.80 ... 1.2 × Us
(3UF7010) SIMOCODE pro V Modbus RTU (3UF7012)
• SIMOCODE pro V PROFINET (3UF7011), SIMOCODE pro V
EtherNet/IP (3UF7013) and SIMOCODE pro S (3UF7020)
- Operation 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us 0.80 ... 1.2 × Us
- Start up 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us 0.85 ... 1.2 × Us
Power consumption1)
• SIMOCODE pro C (3UF7000) and SIMOCODE pro S (3UF7020) 7 VA/5 W 5W
3
3/70 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Technical data
General data
3
current setting Iu to 8 x max. current setting Io)
Digital modules or multifunction modules
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Type 3UF7300, 3UF7310, 3UF7600
Control circuit
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 300 (at pollution degree 3)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 4
Relay outputs
• Number 2 monostable or bistable relay outputs (depending on the version)
• Specified short-circuit protection for auxiliary contacts
(relay outputs)
- Fuse links 6 A operational class gG; 10 A quick-response (IEC 60947-5-1)
- Miniature circuit breakers 1.6 A, C characteristic (IEC 60947-5-1); 6 A, C characteristic (Ik < 500 A)
• Rated uninterrupted current A 6
• Rated switching capacity
- AC-15 6 A/24 V AC; 6 A/120 V AC; 3 A/230 V AC
- DC-13 2 A/24 V DC; 0.55 A/60 V DC; 0.25 A/125 V DC
Inputs (binary) 4 inputs, electrically isolated, supplied externally with 24 V DC or
110 ... 240 V AC/DC depending on the version, connected to a common potential
Ground-fault modules or multifunction modules
Type 3UF7510, 3UF7600
Control circuit
Connectable residual-current transformer 3UL23
Type of current for monitoring Type A (AC and pulsating DC residual currents)
Adjustable response value 30 mA ... 40 A
Relative measurement error % 7.5
Temperature modules or multifunction modules
Type 3UF7600, 3UF7700
10
Sensor circuit
Number of temperature sensors
• 3UF7700 3 temperature sensors
• 3UF7600 1 temperature sensor
Typical sensor current
• Pt100 mA 1
• Pt1000/KTY83/KTY84/NTC mA 0.2
Open-circuit/short-circuit detection
• Sensor type Pt100/Pt1000 KTY83-110 KTY84 NTC
- Open circuit ✓ ✓ ✓ --
- Short circuit ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
- Measuring range °C -50 ... +500 -50 ... +175 -40 ... +300 80 ... 160
Measuring accuracy at 20 °C ambient temperature (T20) K < 2
Deviation due to ambient temperature % 0.05 per K deviation from T20
(in % of measuring range)
Conversion time ms 500
Connection type Two- or three-wire connection
✓ Detection possible
-- Detection not possible
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/71
Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Technical data
General data
Analog module
Type 3UF74
Control circuit
Inputs
• Channels 2 (passive)
• Parameterizable measuring ranges mA 0/4 ... 20
• Shielding Up to 30 m shield recommended, from 30 m shield required
• Max. input current (destruction limit) mA 40
• Accuracy % 1
• Input resistance 50
• Conversion time ms 150
• Resolution Bit 12
• Open-circuit detection With measuring range 4 ... 20 mA
Outputs
• Channels 1
3
• Accuracy % 1
• Max. output load 500
• Conversion time ms 25
• Resolution Bit 12
• Short-circuit proof Yes
Connection type Two-wire connection
Electrical separation of inputs/output No
to the device electronics
Fail-safe digital modules
Type 3UF7320-1AB00-0 3UF7320-1AU00-0 3UF7330-1AB00-0 3UF7330-1AU00-0
Control circuit
Rated control supply voltage Us V 24 DC 110 ... 240 AC/DC; 24 DC 110 ... 240 AC/DC;
50/60 Hz 50/60 Hz
Power consumption 3W 9.5 VA/4.5 W 4W 11 VA/5.5 W
Rated insulation voltage V 300
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 4
Relay outputs
• Number 2 relay enabling circuits, 2 relay outputs
Version of the fuse link A 4, operational class gG
For short-circuit protection of the relay enabling circuit
Rated uninterrupted current A 5
Rated switching capacity
• AC-15 3 A/24 V AC; 3 A/120 V AC; 1.5 A/230 V AC
• DC-13 4 A/24 V DC; 0.55 A/60 V DC; 0.22 A/125 V DC
Inputs (binary) 5 (with internal power supply from the device electronics)
10
Cable length
• Between sensor/start signal and evaluation electronics m 1 500 1 500 -- --
• For further digital signals m -- -- 300 300
Safety data 1)
SIL level max. according to IEC 61508 3
Achievable performance level PL according to EN ISO 13849-1 e
Achievable category according to EN ISO 13849-1 4
Stop category according to EN 60204-1 0
Probability of a dangerous failure
for SIL 3 applications
• Per hour (PFHd) at a high demand rate 1/h 1.0 x 10-8 1.0 x 10-8
according to IEC 62061 for 2-channel sensor evaluation
• Per hour (PFDavg) at a low demand rate 2.0 x 10-6 2.0 x 10-6
according to IEC 61508 for 2-channel sensor evaluation
T1 value for proof test interval or a 20
service duration according to IEC 61508
1)
For more safety data, see System Manual
"SIMOCODE pro Safety Fail-Safe Digital Modules".
Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Technical data
General data
■ More information
Configuration instructions Types of protection EEx e and EEx d
When using an operator panel with display, please note that the The overload protection and the thermistor motor protection
type and number of expansion modules that can be connected of the SIMOCODE pro system comply with the requirements
are limited for the use of a SIMOCODE pro V PROFIBUS basic for overload protection of explosion-proof motors to the type
unit (with product version lower than E15) or SIMOCODE pro V of protection:
Modbus RTU (with product version lower than E03), see • EEx d "Flameproof enclosure" e.g. according to IEC 60079-1
• TIA Selection Tool • EEx e "Increased safety" e.g. according to IEC 60079-7
• SIMOCODE pro Manual Collection
When using SIMOCODE pro devices with a 24 V DC control
Protective separation voltage, electrical separation must be ensured using a battery
or a safety transformer according to IEC 61558-2-6.
All circuits in SIMOCODE pro are safely isolated from each other EC type test certificate: BVS 06 ATEX F 001
3
in accordance with IEC 60947-1. That is, they are designed with Test report: BVS PP 05.2029 EC.
double creepages and clearances. In the event of a fault,
therefore, no parasitic voltages can be formed in neighboring Type of protection Ex b
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
circuits. The instructions of test log No. 2668 must be complied
with. The function for dry-running protection of centrifugal pumps in
hazardous areas complies with the requirements of the following
type of protection:
• Ex b "Control of ignition source", ignition protection system b1,
e.g. according to EN 80079-37
SIMOCODE pro is registered for the dry-running protection
of centrifugal pumps by means of active power monitoring
according to both ATEX and IEC Ex.
10
Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE
SIMOCODE pro pro
3UF73UF7
Motor Management and Control Devices
Basic units IE3/IE4 ready
Basic units
3UF7000-1AB00-0
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
SIMOCODE pro S
PROFIBUS DP interface, 1.5 Mbps, RS 485
4 I/2 O freely assignable, input for thermistor connection,
monostable relay outputs, can be expanded by a
multifunction module
Note: The connection cable to the current measuring module
must be at least 15 cm.
Rated control supply voltage Us:
3UF7020-1AU01-0 • 24 V DC } 3UF7020-1AB01-0 1 1 unit
• 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7020-1AU01-0 1 1 unit
SIMOCODE pro V1)
PROFIBUS DP interface, 12 Mbps, RS 485
4 I/3 O freely assignable, input for thermistor connection,
monostable relay outputs, can be expanded by expansion
modules
Rated control supply voltage Us:
• 24 V DC } 3UF7010-1AB00-0 1 1 unit
3UF7010-1AB00-0 • 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7010-1AU00-0 1 1 unit
ETHERNET/PROFINET IO,
OPC UA server and web server, 100 Mbps,
PROFINET system redundancy,
4 I/3 O freely assignable, input for
thermistor connection, monostable relay outputs,
10
3
3UF7012-1A.00-0
SIMOCODE pro EtherNet/IP
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
SIMOCODE pro V EtherNet/IP 1)
EtherNet/IP interface, web server, 100 Mbps,
2 x connection to bus through RJ45,
DLR media redundancy,
4 I/3 O freely assignable,
input for thermistor connection,
monostable relay outputs,
can be expanded by expansion modules,
web server in German/English/Chinese/Russian
Rated control supply voltage Us:
3UF7013-1AB00-0 • 24 V DC } 3UF7013-1AB00-0 1 1 unit
• 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7013-1AU00-0 1 1 unit
SIMOCODE pro current or current/voltage measuring modules
Current measuring modules
• Straight-through transformers 0.3 ... 3 45 } 3UF7100-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
2.4 ... 25 45 } 3UF7101-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
10 ... 100 55 } 3UF7102-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
20 ... 200 120 } 3UF7103-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
• Busbar connection6) 20 ... 200 120 } 3UF7103-1BA00-0 1 1 unit
63 ... 630 145 } 3UF7104-1BA00-0 1 1 unit
3UF7103-1AA00-0 2nd-generation current/voltage measuring modules
for SIMOCODE pro V1)2)
Voltage measuring up to 690 V,
measured values with increased accuracy,
power, power factor and frequency monitoring
10
• Straight-through transformers 0.3 ... 4 45 } 3UF7110-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
3 ... 40 45 } 3UF7111-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
10 ... 115 55 } 3UF7112-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
20 ... 200 120 } 3UF7113-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
• Busbar connection6) 20 ... 200 120 } 3UF7113-1BA01-0 1 1 unit
3UF7110-1AA01-0 63 ... 630 145 } 3UF7114-1BA01-0 1 1 unit
Current/voltage measuring modules for dry-running protection of
centrifugal pumps in hazardous areas2)3)4) NEW NEU
• Straight-through transformers 0.3 ... 4 45 } 3UF7120-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
3 ... 40 45 } 3UF7121-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
10 ... 115 55 } 3UF7122-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
20 ... 200 120 } 3UF7123-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
• Busbar connection6) 20 ... 200 120 } 3UF7123-1BA01-0 1 1 unit
63 ... 630 145 } 3UF7124-1BA01-0 1 1 unit
3UF7123-1AA01-0
1) 5)
The SIMOCODE
SIMOCODE ES ES (TIA
(TIAPortal)
Portal)V14
V14software
softwareororhigher is is
higher necessary for for
necessary For the use of 2nd-generation current/voltage measuring modules,
parameterization, seepage
parameterization, see page3/83.
14/12. SIMOCODE pro V Modbus RTU with product version E03 (V2.0) must be
2)
When installing the basic unit on a current/voltage measuring module, ordered. This version does not have an NEPSI certificate. It can be ordered
the connection cable must be at least 15 cm long. at no extra charge. The article number must be supplemented by "–Z" and
3)
the order code "B01", e.g. 3UF7012-1AB00-0 -Z B01.
The current/voltage measuring modules for dry-running protection require 6)
SIMOCODE pro V PROFIBUS basic units as of product version E16 One terminal
terminal parts
parts kit
kit 3RT1955-4PA00 3RT1966-4PA00(see
3RT1955-4PA00 or 3RT1966-4PA00 (see page
page 3/82)
10/24)
(expected to be available from 03/2019), SIMOCODE pro V PROFINET is included
included in
in the
the scope
scopeof ofdelivery
deliveryfor
forconnection
connectiontotoaacontactor.
contactor.
as of product version E13 (expected to be available from 10/2018) or Note:
SIMOCODE pro V EtherNet/IP as of product version E04 (expected to
be available from 03/2019). SIMOCODE pro V basic unit in a hardened version via
4)
When using an operator panel with display with the current/voltage SIPLUS extreme upon request.
measuring modules for dry-running protection, an operator panel with
display as of product version E03 (both versions 3UF7210-1AA01-0 and
3UF7210-1BA01-0 expected to be available from 03/2019) is required.
3UF7200-1AA01-0
3
through the basic unit.
Notes:
The SIMOCODE pro V PN GP basic unit can be used with the
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3UF7300-1A.00-0 monostable digital module, the 3UF7510-
1AA00-0 ground-fault module, or the 3UF7700-1AA0-0 tem-
perature module.
Please order connection cable separately, see page 10/22.
Digital modules
Up to two digital modules can be used to add additional binary
inputs and relay outputs to the basic unit. The input circuits of
the digital modules are supplied from an external power supply.
Four binary inputs and two relay outputs,
up to two digital modules can be connected
Relay outputs Input voltage
Monostable 24 V DC } 3UF7300-1AB00-0 1 1 unit
110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7300-1AU00-0 1 1 unit
3UF7300-1AB00-0
Bistable 24 V DC } 3UF7310-1AB00-0 1 1 unit
110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7310-1AU00-0 1 1 unit
Analog modules
By means of the analog module, the basic unit can } 3UF7400-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
be optionally expanded by analog inputs and outputs
(0/4 ... 20 mA).
Two inputs (passive) for input and one output for output
of 0/4 ... 20 mA signals, max. one analog module can be con-
nected per pro V PB/MB RTU basic unit and max. two analog
modules per pro V PN/EIP basic unit
10
3UF7400-1AA00-0
Ground-fault modules
Ground-fault monitoring using 3UL23 residual-current trans- } 3UF7510-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
formers and ground-fault modules is used in cases where pre-
cise detection of the ground-fault current is required or power
systems with high impedance are grounded.
With the ground-fault module, it is possible to determine the
precise fault current as a measured value, and to define freely
selectable warning and trip limits in a wide range from 30 mA ...
40 A.
One input for connecting a 3UL23 residual-current transformer,
3UF7510-1AA00-0 up to one ground-fault module can be connected
Note:
Note:
For
For corresponding residual-current transformers,
corresponding residual-current transformers, see
see
page
page 10/94.
11/55.
Temperature modules
Irrespective of the thermistor motor protection of the basic units, } 3UF7700-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
up to an additional three analog temperature sensors can be
evaluated using a temperature module.
Sensor types: Pt100/Pt1000, KTY83/KTY84 or NTC
Three inputs for connecting up to three analog temperature
sensors, up to one temperature module can be connected per
pro V PB/MB RTU basic unit and up to two temperature mod-
ules per pro V PN/EIP basic unit
3UF7700-1AA00-0
Multifunction modules
OVERLOAD
RELAYS
3
power is supplied to the modules through a separate terminal
connection.
Note:
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Please order
order connection
connection cable
cableseparately,
separately,see
seepage
page3/80.
10/22.
10
3RA6936-0B
Addressing plugs
For assigning the PROFIBUS or Modbus RTU address without } 3UF7910-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
using a PC/PG to SIMOCODE pro through the system interface
3UF7910-0AA00-0
3
Y connection cables
For use in conjunction with the initialization module; connects
the basic unit, current measuring module or current/voltage
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
measuring module, and initialization module
System interface length Open cable end
0.1 m 1.0 m } 3UF7931-0CA00-0 1 1 unit
0.5 m 1.0 m } 3UF7932-0CA00-0 1 1 unit
1.0 m 1.0 m } 3UF7937-0CA00-0 1 1 unit
Bus connection terminals
For shield support and strain relief of the PROFIBUS cable on a } 3UF7960-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
SIMOCODE pro S
3UF7960-0AA00-0
Door adapters
For external connection of the system interface, } 3UF7920-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
e.g. outside a control cabinet
3UF7920-0AA00-0
Adapters for operator panel
The adapter enables the smaller 3UF7200 operator panel from } 3UF7922-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
10
SIMOCODE pro to be used in a front panel cutout in which pre-
viously, e.g. after a change of system, a larger 3UF52 operator
panel from SIMOCODE-DP had been used, degree of protec-
tion IP54
3UF7922-0AA00-0
Labeling strips
• For pushbuttons of the 3UF720 operator panel } 3UF7925-0AA00-0 100 400 units
• For pushbuttons of the 3UF721 operator panel with display } 3UF7925-0AA01-0 100 600 units
• For LEDs of the 3UF720 operator panel } 3UF7925-0AA02-0 100 1 200 units
3UF7925-0AA02-0
Push-in lugs
For screw fixing, e.g. on mounting plate,
2 units required per device
• Can be used for 3UF71.0, 3UF71.1 and 3UF71.2 2 3RV2928-0B 100 10 units
• Can be used for 3UF700, 3UF701, 3UF73, 3UF74, 3UF75 and 5 3RP1903 1 10 units
3UF77
3RV2928-0B • Can be used for 3UF7020, 3UF7600 2 3ZY1311-0AA00 1 10 units
3RT195.-4G
Bus termination modules
With separate control supply voltage for bus termination
following the last unit on the bus line
Supply voltage:
• 115/230 V AC 5 3UF1900-1KA00 1 1 unit
• 24 V DC 5 3UF1900-1KB00 1 1 unit
10
3UF1900-1KA00
Overview
3
Parameterizing with convenient --
graphical display
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Parameterizing with the integrated --
graphics editor (CFC-based)
Printing of diagrams --
Parameter comparison --
Selection of SIMOCODE pro device configuration in SIMOCODE ES
(TIA Portal) Access via PROFIBUS/PROFINET/ -- --
Ethernet2)
More information Teleservice via MPI -- --
Homepage, see www.siemens.com/sirius-engineering Routing3) -- --
Industry
IndustryMall,
Mall,see
seewww.siemens.com/product?3ZS1
www.siemens.com/product?3ZS1 Function available
Technical
TIA specifications,
Selection see Cloud)
Tool Cloud (TST -- Function not available
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16716/td 1) For SIMOCODE pro V.
Software
Software download
download 2)
In combination with Modbus devices, SIMOCODE ES Premium does not
• For SIMOCODE pro S, see offer any additional functions compared with SIMOCODE ES Standard.
• SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal), see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109752321 3)
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109752321
• For SIMOCODE pro V, see See http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/109738745.
• SIMOCODE ES 2007, see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109480470 Working with libraries
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109480470
Users can create copy templates for SIMOCODE pro device
SIMOCODE ES is the central software for configuration, startup, configuration and can manage them in global or project
operation and diagnostics of SIMOCODE pro. libraries.
SIMOCODE ES Version 15 is available as a powerful successor This way, individual modules, diagrams and complete device
to Version 2007, which is based on the central engineering configurations can be saved as reusable elements for frequently
framework Totally Integrated Automation Portal (TIA Portal). occurring tasks.
SIMOCODE ES V15 is integrated seamlessly when further Integrated graphics editor
TIA Portal-based software such as STEP 7 or WinCC is The graphics editor is a part of SIMOCODE ES Standard and
available, thus enabling users to achieve a consistent, SIMOCODE ES Premium. It is based on the Continuous Function
efficient and intuitive solution for all automation tasks. Chart (CFC) and adds a powerful tool to the parameterizing inter-
However, use of SIMOCODE ES V15 as stand-alone software face that enables easy parameterization of devices by drag &
also provides these advantages. drop. What is more, all the parameters can also be edited directly
in the graphics editor. Extremely compact documentation of all
Three program versions configured parameters is possible, as is the graphic online pre-
The user can choose between three different versions of sentation of the configured device functions including all signal
SIMOCODE ES: states during operation.
• SIMOCODE ES Basic
• SIMOCODE ES Standard
• SIMOCODE ES Premium
New: From V15, the powerful SIMOCODE ES Basic tool for
startup or maintenance personnel is available for downloading
free of charge in the Siemens Industry Online Support
(see "More information").
SIMOCODE ES Standard and Premium are the perfect tools for
engineers or configuration engineers on account of their larger
14
Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
■ Benefits
• Easy parameterization with the graphics editor based on the • Universally applicable through stand-alone version or seam-
Continuous Function Chart (CFC) reduces engineering work less integration into the central engineering framework when
and shortens startup times other TIA Portal-based software such as STEP 7 or WinCC are
• Clear plant documentation by means of graphic presentation available
• Detailed information, also when there are faults, is a help for • Parameter changes are also possible during normal operation
maintenance personnel and shortens downtimes • Users can create copy templates for device configurations
and can manage them in global libraries
14
3
6 languages (German/English/French/Italian/
Spanish/Chinese),
for all SIMOCODE pro,
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
online functions via system interface
SIMOCODE ES V15 Standard
Floating license for one user
Engineering software,
software and documentation on DVD,
6 languages (German/English/French/Italian/Spanish/
Chinese), Combo license for parallel use of versions 2007 and
V15 of SIRIUS ES, for all SIMOCODE pro,
online functions via system interface,
parameterizing with the integrated graphics editor (CFC-based)
• License key on USB flash drive, Class A } 3ZS1322-5CC13-0YA5 1 1 unit
• License key and software download, Class A } 3ZS1322-5CE13-0YB5 1 1 unit
3ZS1322-5CC13-0YA5
Upgrade for SIMOCODE ES 2007 Standard 2 3ZS1322-5CC13-0YE5 1 1 unit
Floating license for one user,
engineering software,
software and documentation on DVD,
license key on USB flash drive, Class A,
6 languages (German/English/French/Italian/Spanish/
Chinese), Combo license for parallel use of versions 2007 and
V15 of SIRIUS ES, for all SIMOCODE pro,
online functions via system interface,
parameterizing with integrated graphics editor (CFC-based)
Software Update Service } 3ZS1322-5CC00-0YL5 1 1 unit
For 1 year with automatic extension,
requires software version of SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal),
engineering software,
software and documentation on DVD,
online functions via system interface,
parameterizing with integrated graphics editor (CFC-based)
Notes:
SIMOCODE ES V12/V13/V14 licenses can also be used for
SIMOCODE ES V15.
Please orderPC
Please order PCcable
cableseparately,
separately,
seesee page
page 14/15.
3/80.
For aa description
descriptionofofthe
thesoftware
software versions,
versions, seesee page
page 14/12.
3/83.
14
14
contents
Self Protected Motor Starters per UL 508 Type E 3RA6
4 SIRIUS
Section
4
3RA61 / 3RA62 up to 32 A 3RA64 / 3RA65 up to 32 A 3RA68 up to 100 A
STARTERS
COMBINATION
for mounting rail, surface, for mounting rail, surface, for 3RA6 direct and
comb busbar, infeed system Page comb busbar, infeed system Page reversing starters Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• Direct start, Reversing duty 4/7 • Direct start, Reversing duty 4/8 • Infeed Components 4/16-4/19
• Accessories 4/9-4/13 • Accessories 4/9-4/13 • Accessories 4/20-4/21
Combination starters & starters for group installation 3RA2 Enclosed controllers 3RE4
(Section was last modified on 10/05/21) Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/1
Compact Combination Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
General data
General data
Overview
3RA6 fuseless compact starters and infeed system for 3RA6 Very high operational reliability
The high short-circuit breaking capacity and defined shut-down
when the end of service life is reached means that the
SIRIUS compact starter achieves a very high level of operational
reliability that would otherwise have only been possible with
considerable additional outlay. This sets it apart from devices
with similar functionality.
Safe disconnection
The auxiliary switches (NC contacts) of the 3RA6 compact
starters are designed as mirror contacts. This enables their use
for safe disconnection - e.g. EMERGENCY STOP up to SIL 1
(IEC 62061) or PL c (ISO 13849-1) or, if used in conjunction with
an additional infeed contactor, up to SIL 3 (IEC 62061) or PL e
(ISO 13849-1).
Communications integration through AS-Interface
To enable communications integration through AS-Interface
there is an AS-i add-on module available in several versions for
4
3RA62 reversing starter The design of the AS-i add-on module permits a group of up to
Integrated functionality 62 feeders with a total of four cables to be connected to the
control system. This reduces wiring work considerably com-
The SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters are a generation of innova- pared to the parallel wiring method.
tive load feeders with the integrated functionality of a motor
starter protector, contactor and electronic overload relay. Communications integration using IO-Link
In addition, various functions of optional mountable accessories Up to 4 compact starters in IO-Link version (reversing and
(e.g. auxiliary switches, surge suppressors) are already direct-on-line starters) can be connected together and conve-
integrated in the SIRIUS compact starter. niently linked to the IO-Link master through a standardized
8
IO-Link connection. The SIRIUS 4SI electronic modules are used
e.g. as IO-Link masters for connection to the SIMATIC ET 200S
distributed I/O system.
The IO-Link connection enables a high density of information in
the local range.
Details of the communications integration using IO-Link, see
Chapter 14 Communications.
The diagnostics data of the process collected by the 3RA6
compact starter, e.g. short circuit, end of service life, limit
position etc., are not only indicated on the compact starter itself
but also transmitted to the higher-level control system through
IO-Link.
Thanks to the optionally available operator panel, which can be
installed in the control cabinet door, it is easy to control the 3RA6
compact starters with IO-Link from the control cabinet door.
Permanent wiring / easy replacement
Using the SIRIUS infeed system for 3RA6 (see page 4/16) it is
possible to carry out the wiring in advance without a compact
starter needing to be connected.
Thanks to wide setting ranges for the rated current and wide Screw and spring-type terminals
voltage ranges, the equipment variance is greatly reduced The SIRIUS compact starters and the infeed system for 3RA6 are
compared to conventional load feeders. available with screw and spring-type terminals.
4/2 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Siemens IC 10 · 2015 8/51
Compact Combination Starters
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
General data
General data
To comply with the clearance and creepage distances Note:
demanded according to UL 508 there are the following infeed
possibilities: More technical specifications can be found in the system
manual at
Type of infeed Feeder terminal Type www.siemens.com/compactstarter
(according to UL 508,
type E) Overload tripping times
Conventional wiring Terminal block for "Self- 3RV29 28-1H The overload tripping time can be set on the device to less than
Protected Combination
Motor Controller 10 s (CLASS 10) and less than 20 s (CLASS 20 for heavy start-
(Type E)" ing). As the breaker mechanism still remains closed after an
overload, resetting is possible by either local manual reset or au-
Three-phase busbars Three-phase infeed ter- 3RV29 25-5EB
minal for constructing toreset after 3 minutes cooling time.
"Type E Starters", With autoreset there is no need to open the control cabinet.
UL 508
Infeed systems for 3RA6 Infeed on left, 3RA68 13-8AB (screw Diagnostics options
50/70 mm2, screw terminals), The compact starter provides the following diagnostics options
terminal with 3 sockets, 3RA68 13-8AC
outgoing terminal on site:
(spring-type terminals)
with screw/spring-type • With LEDs
connections, - Connection to the control voltage
including PE bar
- Position of the main contacts
SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters • With mechanical indication
4
- Tripping due to overload
The SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters are universal motor starters - Tripping due to short-circuit
according to IEC/EN 60947-6-2. As control and protective
STARTERS
COMBINATION
- Tripping due to malfunction (end of service life reached
switching devices (CPS) they can connect, convey and discon- because of worn switching contacts or a worn switching
nect the thermal, dynamic and electrical loads from short-circuit mechanism or faults in the control electronics)
currents up to Iq = 53 kA, i.e. they are essentially weld-free. They
combine the functions of a motor starter protectors, a contactor These states can also be evaluated in the higher-level control
and a solid-state overload relay in a single enclosure and can be system:
used wherever standard induction motors up to 32 A (up to ap- • With conventional wiring using the integrated auxiliary and
prox. 20 HP at 480 V AC) are started directly. Available versions signaling switches of the compact starter
are the direct-on-line starters with 45 mm width and the revers-
ing starters with 90 mm width. • With AS-Interface or IO-Link in even greater detail using the
respective communication interface
The reversing starter version comes with not only an internal
electrical interlock but also with a mechanical interlock to prevent Four complement variants for 3RA6 compact starters
simultaneous actuation of both directions of rotation. • For standard mounting rail or screw mounting:
basic version including 1 pair of main circuit terminals and
3RA6 compact starters are supplied in 5 current setting ranges. 1 pair of control circuit terminals
6
The 3RA61 and 3RA62 have 2 control voltage ranges (AC/DC),
the 3RA64 and 3RA65 have one control voltage range (DC): • For standard mounting rail or screw mounting when using the
AS-i add-on module:
Current At 460 V AC for Rated control supply voltage for comes without control circuit terminals because the AS-i add-
setting induction on module is attached in lieu of them
range motors 3RA61, 3RA62 3RA64, 3RA65
compact starters compact starters • For use with the infeed system for 3RA6:
Standard for IO-Link
output P without main circuit terminals because they are supplied with
the infeed system and the expansion modules
A HP V AC/DC V DC
• For use with the infeed system for 3RA6 and AS-i add-on
0.1 ... 0.4 0.12 24 24 module:
0.32 ... 1.25 0.43 ... 1.68 110 ... 240 without main or control circuit terminals as they are not needed
1 ... 4 1.34 ... 5.36 • The control circuit terminals are always required by the com-
pact starters for IO-Link; the main circuit terminals depend on
3 ... 12 4.02 ... 16.1 the use of the infeed system.
8 ... 32 10.7 ... 42.9
Additional components of the 3RA6
Note: The two control circuit terminals on the 3RA61/3RA62 allow
The 3RA1 motor starters can be used as motor starters access to signalling contacts for overload (1 CO) and short-
> 32 A up to 100 A. circuit / malfunction (1 NO). Furthermore, the 3RA61 has two
auxiliary contacts (1 NO + 1 NC) for indicating the position of the
The SENTRON 3VL circuit breakers and the SIRIUS 3RT main contacts, while the 3RA62 has one auxiliary contact (1 NO)
contactors can be used for motor starters >100 A. per direction of rotation per main contact.
Operating conditions
The SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters are suitable for use in nearly
all climates. They are intended for use in enclosed rooms in
which no severe operating conditions (such as dust, caustic va-
pors, hazardous gases) prevail. Suitable covers must be pro-
vided for installation in dusty and damp locations.
The SIRIUS compact starters are generally designed to degree
of protection IP20. The permissible ambient temperature during
operation is -20 to +60 °C.
The maximum short-circuit current based on UL testing is 30 kA
up to 12 A and 15 kA for the 8 ... 32 A versions at 480 V.
Function
Trip units Control through AS-Interface
The SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters are equipped with the follow- For control through AS-Interface, the AS-i add-on module is
ing trip units: mounted instead of the two control circuit terminals on the
• Inverse-time delayed solid-state overload release SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters (direct-on-line starters and re-
• Instantaneous electronic trip unit (electromagnetic short- versing starters).
circuit release)
The AS-i auxiliary voltage and the AS-i data line are installed on
The overload releases can be adjusted in accordance with the the AS-i add-on module easily and quickly without tools by
load current. means of two plug-in connector blocks with insulation displace-
ment connection.
The electronic trip units are permanently set to a value 13 times
the maximum rated current of the 4 A, 12 A and 32 A starter and The AS-i add-on module is equipped with the latest A/B technol-
thus enable trouble-free starting of motors. ogy and has an addressing socket onboard.
Trip classes An addressing unit is required and can be ordered for address-
ing the AS-i add-on module.
The trip classes of electronically delayed trip units are based on
the tripping time (tA) at 7.2 times the set current in the cold state Bit assignment (see below) is similar to that for the SIRIUS motor
(excerpt from IEC 60947-4): starters, which means that the same programming can be used
here.
CLASS 10: 4s < tA < 10 s
4
DI 0.0 ready
CLASS 20: 6s < tA < 20 s (for heavy starting)
DI 0.1 motor on
COMBINATION
STARTERS
Design
Mounting 3) By integrating in the infeed system for 3RA6
The 3RA6 compact starters can be mounted in 4 ways: The SIRIUS compact starters can be assembled with the infeed
system for 3RA6 (see "Infeed system for 3RA6").
1) By snapping onto a TH 35 standard mounting rail
The SIRIUS compact starters can be snapped onto a standard
mounting rail according to EN 60715 with a width of 35 mm.
4
ck
cli
NSB0_01880
STARTERS
COMBINATION
NSB0_01882
2) By screw fixing to a flat surface 4) By using the 8US busbar adapter for Fast Bus systems with
60 mm busbar center-to-center clearance
The SIRIUS compact starters are suitable for screw fixing to a flat
surface. One set of 3RA69 40-0A adapters for screw connection
(including push-in lugs) is required per direct-on-line starter, two
sets are required per reversing starter.
2
4
1
5
1
5
3 6
5
1
2
NSB0_01881
3
NSB0_01921
NSB0_01922
Mounting regulations
The module can be installed horizontally or vertically. For the dif-
ferent installations attention must be paid however to limit values
for protective separation according to IEC/EN 60947-2 of the
compact starters (for details see the "Technical specifications").
> 30
NSB0_01883
> 10 > 10
> 30
SIRIUS
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
3RA6 Compact Starters
Starters
3RA61,
3RA61, 3RA62
3RA62 compact
compact starters
starters; 3RA61 direct-on-line starters
3RA61 direct-on-line starters
HP A
4
For use with the infeed system for 3RA6 and with
the AS-i add-on module or as a replacement device,
STARTERS
COMBINATION
without main and control circuit terminals
-- 0.1 ... 0.4 3RA6@@0-0A @32 —
1/2 0.32 ... 1.25 3RA6@@0-0B @32 —
2 1 ... 4 3RA6@@0-0C @32 —
7 1/2 3 ... 12 3RA6@@0-0D @32 —
20 8 ... 32 3RA6@@0-0E @32 —
1)
Selection depends on the motor full load amps. Horse Power ratings pro-
vided for reference only.
2)
A set of 3RA69 40-0A adapters is required for screw mounting.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/7
6/40 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Compact Combination Starters
• Direct-on-line starters
• Rated control supply voltage 24 V DC
• Width 45 mm
• One set of 3RA69 40-0A adapters is required for screw fixing
3RA64 with 3RA69 11-1A
• Reversing starters
• Rated control supply voltage 24 V DC
• Width 90 mm
• One set of 3RA69 40-0A adapters is required for screw fixing
3RA65 with 3RA69 11-1A
Overview
Accessories for SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters 8US Fast Bus busbar adapters for 60 mm systems
The following accessories are available for the 3RA6 compact The compact starters are mounted directly with the aid of busbar
starters: adapters on the Fast Bus busbar systems with 60 mm center-to-
• AS-i add-on module: see AS-Interface Add-On Modules for center clearance in order to save space and to reduce infeed
3RA6, page 4/14 times and costs. These starters are suitable for copper busbars
with a width from 12 to 30 mm. The busbars can be 4 to 5 mm
• External auxiliary switch blocks: Snap-on auxiliary switch as or 10 mm thick.
versions 2 NO, 2 NC and 1 NO +1 NC with screw or spring-
type connections; the contacts of the auxiliary switch block The 8US Fast Bus busbar system can be loaded with a maxi-
open and close jointly with the main contacts of the compact mum summation current of 630A.
starter. The NC contacts are designed as mirror contacts. The "reversing starter" version requires a device holder along
• Control kit: aid for manually closing the main contacts in order side the busbar adapter for lateral mounting.
to evaluate the wiring and motor direction under conditions of
short-circuit protection The compact starters are snapped onto the adapter and con-
nected on the line side. This prepared unit is then plugged di-
• Adapter for screw mounting the compact starter, including rectly onto the busbar system, and is thus connected both me-
push-in lugs chanically and electrically at the same time.
• Main circuit terminals: Available in screw and spring-type ter-
minals For more accessories such as incoming and outgoing
terminals, flat copper profiles etc., see Section 5 “Fastbus
4
• Main circuit terminals for mixed connection method: Busbar Systems”.
With the main circuit terminal for the mixed connection method
it is also possible in the main circuit to change over from the Accessories for operation with closed control cabinet doors
STARTERS
COMBINATION
screw connection method on the incoming side to the spring- Door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms for standard and
type connection method on the outgoing side. emergency-stop applications are available for operating the
This enables for example the side-by-side mounting of several compact starter with closed control cabinet doors.
compact starters and their cost-effective connection using the
three-phase busbars on the infeed side. The motors are then Accessories for SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters in IO-Link
directly connected by the quick and reliably contacting version
spring-type connection method.
The following accessories are available specifically for the
Accessories for UL applications 3RA64, 3RA65 compact starters:
The terminal block for "Self-Protected Combination Motor • The 4SI SIRIUS solid-state module as IO-Link master allows
Controller", type E is available for complying with the clearance for the simple and economical connection of SIRIUS controls
and creepage distances according to UL 508. with IO-Link (e.g up to four groups of 4 compact starters) to
the multifunctional SIMATIC ET 200S distributed I/O system.
Accessories for infeed using three-phase busbar systems • Additional connection cables for side-by-side mounting of up
6
3RA69 50-0A
Adapters for screw mounting the 3RA69 40-0A 1 unit 0.152
compact starter
(set including push-in lugs)
Direct-on-line starters require 1 set,
reversing starters 2 sets.
4
3RA69 40-0A
Screw terminals
COMBINATION
STARTERS
3RA69 20-1A
6
Control circuit terminals
• For 3RA61 3RA69 20-1B 1 unit 0.042
• For 3RA62 3RA69 20-1C 1 unit 0.042
3RA69 20-1B
Spring-type terminals
3RA69 20-2A
Control circuit terminals
• For 3RA61 3RA69 20-2B 1 unit 0.036
• For 3RA62 3RA69 20-2C 1 unit 0.036
3RA69 20-2B
4/10 Siemens
* You can order thisIndustry
quantityInc.,
or aIndustrial
multiple Control
thereof.Catalog
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/45
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS3RA6
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
Accessories
Accessories
3RA69 20-3A
4
Additional connection cables (flat) for side-by-
side mounting of up to 4 compact starters
• 10-pole
STARTERS
COMBINATION
- 8 mm1) 3RA69 32-0A 5 units 0.007
- 200 mm1) 3RA69 33-0B 5 units 0.012
• 14-pole
- 8 mm2) 3RA69 31-0A 5 units 0.007
3RA69 31-0A - 200 mm 3RA69 33-0C 5 units 0.014
Operator panels 3RA69 35-0A 1 unit 0.052
- 1 operator panel
- 1 enabling module
- 1 interface cover
- 1 fixing terminal
3RA69 35-0A
Enabling block 3RA69 36-0A 1 unit 0.002
Blanking covers 3RA69 36-0B 5 units 0.001
6
Connection cable (round) for connecting the 3RA69 33-0A 1 unit 0.114
operator panel
10-pole, 2 000 mm
SIRIUS 4SI solid-state modules 3RK1 005-0LB00-0AA0 1 unit 0.057
IO-Link master for connection of up to
4 SIRIUS controls (max. 16 in groups of 4) with IO-
Link (3-wire connection) to
SIMATIC ET 200S,
width 15 mm,
supports firmware update
(STEP 7 V5.4 SP5 and higher)
Can be used with the following terminal
3RK1 005-0LB00-0AA0 modules:
• TM-E15S26-A1 (screw terminals)
• TM-E15C26-A1 (spring-type terminals)
• TM-E15N26-A1 (Fast Connect)
1) 10-pole connection cables are required for EMERGENCY-STOP group 2) Is included in the scope of supply of the SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starter in
concepts. IO-Link version.
Siemens Industry
* You Inc., Industrial
can order Control
this quantity or aCatalog 4/11
multiple thereof.
6/46 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers
Compact Combination Starters SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 80 A
Accessories
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
Busbar accessories
Accessories
Modular Number of motor starter protec- Rated For motor Order No. Std. Weight
spacing tors that can be connected current In starter pack approx.
Without With lateral With at 690 V protectors qty.
lateral auxiliary auxiliary
accesso- switch release
ries
mm A Size
Three-phase busbars1)
For feeding several motor starter protectors with screw terminals,
mounted side by side on standard mounting rails, insulated,
with touch protection
3RV1915-1AB
453) 2 -- -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-1AB 1 unit 0.044
3 -- -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-1BB 1 unit 0.071
4 -- -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-1CB 1 unit 0.099
5 -- -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-1DB 1 unit 0.124
3RV1915-1BB 554) -- 2 -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-2AB
-- 3 -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-2BB
-- 4 -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-2CB
-- 5 -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-2DB
2 -- -- 108 S2 3RV1935-1A
3RV1915-1CB
3 -- -- 108 S2 3RV1935-1B
4 -- -- 108 S2 3RV1935-1C
4
-- 2 2 108 S2
-- 3 3 108 S2 3RV1935-3B
-- 4 4 108 S2 3RV1935-3C
7
1) 4)
Not suitable for 3RV21 motor starter protectors for motor protection For 3RV2 motor starter protectors with auxiliary switches with 1 NO + 1 NC,
with overload relay function and for 3RV27 and 3RV28 circuit breakers 2 NO and 2 NC mounted on the left (9 mm wide).
according to UL 489/CSA C22.2 No. 5. 5)
For 3RV2 motor starter protectors with mounted accessories (18 mm wide).
2)
Approved for motor starter protectors size S0 with In ≤ 32 A. Auxiliary switches with 2 NO + 2 NC or signaling switch (mounted on the
3)
For 3RV2 motor starter protectors without accessories mounted left) or with auxiliary release (mounted on the right).
on the side.
3RV2935-5A
Connection from below
This terminal is connected in place of a switch, please take the
space requirement into account.
2.5 ... 25 2.5 ... 16 10 ... 4 Input: 4, S00, S0 3RV2915-5B 0.093
Output:
2 ... 2.5
3RV2915-5B
Three-phase infeed terminals for constructing "Type E Starters"
Connection from top
2.5 ... 25 2.5 ... 16 10 ... 4 3 ... 4 S00, S0 3RV2925-5EB 0.044
2x 2x 2x 4 ... 6 S2 3RV2935-5E
(2.5 ... 50)1), (2.5 ... 35)1), (10 ... 1/0)1),
3RV2925-5EB 1x 1x 1x
(2.5 ... 70)1) (2.5 ... 50)1) (10 ... 2/0)1)
8US12 11-1NS10
Device holders for lateral mounting along side the Fast Bus busbar
adapter for 60 mm systems
Required in addition to the busbar adapter for 8US12 50-1AA10 1 unit 0.239
mounting a reversing starter
4
STARTERS
COMBINATION
8US12 50-1AA10
6
interlocking prevents accidental opening of the control cabinet door in the ON position of the motor starter protector. The OFF
position can be locked with up to 3 padlocks.
Door-coupling rotary Black 130 3RV29 26-0B 1 unit 0.111
operating mecha-
nisms
3RV29 26-0B
EMERGENCY-STOP Red/ 130 3RV29 26-0C 1 unit 0.110
door-coupling Yellow
rotary operating
mechanisms
3RT19 00-1SB20
1) PC labeling system for individual inscription of unit labeling plates
available from: Murrplastik Systems, Inc. www.murrplastik.com.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/13
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/49
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS3RA6
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
Add-on modules for AS-Interface
Add-on modules for AS-Interface
Overview
Various AS-i add-on modules are available for communication of
the 3RA6 compact starter with the control system using
AS-Interface:
• Standard version
• With two local inputs
• With two free external inputs
• With one free external input and one free external output
• With two free external outputs
• For local control
The AS-i add-on modules can be combined only in connection
with compact starters with a rated control supply voltage of
24 V AC/DC.
AS-i add-on module for communications controlling
With this new module it is also possible for the connected com-
pact starter to be operated directly using simple switches, i.e.
without recourse to AS-i Communication, if required.
4
"Automatic" mode
NC contacts can be connected to the inputs Y2 and Y4 through
COMBINATION
STARTERS
the local terminals on the AS-i add-on module. If the "+" connec-
tions are connected simultaneously to both local inputs, the
AS-i add-on module will be in "Automatic" mode, i.e. it will
communicate with the control system through AS-Interface.
Local control
Circuit diagram example for operating a 3RA61 20 direct-on-line starter
Opening the two inputs Y2 and Y4 will result in the direct using an AS-i add-on module for on-site controller
disconnection of the compact starter. Operation through AS-i
Communication is ended and the compact starter can now be
switched on and off directly using NO contacts (one NO contact
per direction of rotation on the reversing starter).
"LED AUX Power" must light up green, the 24 V DC supply must
be connected and the AS-i control supply voltage must no lon-
ger be applied.
6
4
Only for direct-on-line starters,
replaces the digital standard output
"Motor left"
STARTERS
COMBINATION
For local control 3RA69 70-3F 1 unit 0.045
Control of the compact starter optionally using
AS-Interface or local switches
6
• For AS-Interface modules and sensors and actuators
with integrated AS-Interface in accordance with
AS-i Specification V3.0
• For setting the AS-i address of standard slaves,
and slaves with extended addressing mode
(A/B slaves)
• With input/output test function and many other
commissioning functions
• Battery operation with 4 batteries type AA
(IEC LR6, NEDA 15)
• Scope of supply:
- Addressing unit with 4 batteries
- Addressing cable, with M12 plug to addressing plug
3RK1904-2AB02 (hollow plug), length 1.5m
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/15
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/51
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS
3RA6 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
Infeed systems for 3RA6 — up to 100 A
Infeed systems for 3RA6
Overview
The infeed system for 3RA6 compact starters enables far less In addition, the integrated PE bar means it is optionally possible
wiring in the main circuit and, thanks to the easy exchangeability to connect the motor cable directly to the infeed system without
of the compact starters, reduces the usual downtimes for additional intermediate terminals. The infeed system for 3RA6
maintenance work during the plant's operating phase. compact starters is designed for summation currents up to
100 A with a conductor cross-section of max. 2/0 AWG on the
The infeed system provides the possibility of completely feeder terminal block.
prewiring the main circuit without a compact starter needing to
be connected at the same time. As the result of the removable The infeed system can be mounted on a standard mounting rail
terminals in the main circuit, compact starters can be integrated or flat surfaces.
in an infeed system in an easy manner (without the use of tools).
1
4
3
COMBINATION
STARTERS
5 9
11
6
6
NSB0_01878
12 7
10
4
and can be connected to each other in any number up to a max-
imum length of 1.2 meters. Component Maximum rated
operational current
STARTERS
COMBINATION
Two expansion modules are held together with the help of
2 connecting plates and 1 expansion plug. These assembly A
parts are included in the scope of supply of the respective Infeed with screw connection 0-2/0 AWG 100
expansion module.
Infeed with screw connection 4-2 AWG 63
When the infeed system for 3RA6 compact starters is used, the Infeed with spring-type connection 4-2 AWG 63
compact starters (plug-in modules) are easily mounted and re-
moved even when live. Expansion plugs 63
Optional possibilities: When several expansion modules are mounted side by side, the
• PE connection on motor starter side maximum rated operational current from the 2nd expansion
• Outfeed for external auxiliary devices module to the end of the row is 63 A.
• Connection to 3RV29 infeed system
• Integration of SIRIUS 3RV1 and 3RV2 motor starter protectors Proposal for upstream short-circuit protection devices
size S0 up to 25 A (using 3RA68 90-0BA adapter) The following short-circuit data apply for the components of the
6
Two-socket expansion modules infeed system for 3RA6 compact starters:
3
If only 2 instead of 3 additional sockets are required, then the Conductor Inscriptions Proposal for
2-socket expansion module is the right choice. It has the same cross- upstream short-circuit
section protection device
functionality as the 3-socket expansion module.
AWG
4 Expansion plug
Short-circuit protection for
Two expansion modules can be connected together using the infeed block (4-2 AWG)
expansion plug. Flexible expansion of the infeed system is thus with screw connection
possible. 14-2 Id, max = 19 kA, I²t = 440 kA²s 3RV10 41-4JA10
The PE infeed can be ordered with screw connection and 14-2/0 Id, max = approx. 22 kA 3RV10 41-4MA10
spring-type connection (2 AWG) and can be fitted on the right or Short-circuit protection for infeed block
left to the expansion block. with spring-type connection
6 PE expansion plug 12 Id, max = 9.5 kA, I²t = 85 kA²s 3RV10 21-4DA10
10 Id, max = 12.5 kA, I²t = 140 kA²s 3RV10 31-4EA10
The PE expansion plug is inserted from below and enables two
PE bars to be connected. 8 Id, max = 15 kA, I²t = 180 kA²s 3RV10 31-4HA10
PE tap-off 6-4 Id, max = 19 kA, I²t = 440 kA²s 3RV10 41-4JA10
7
Short-circuit protection for terminal block
The PE tap-off is available with screw connection and spring-
type connection (10-8 AWG). It is snapped into the infeed sys- 16 Id, max = 7.5 kA 5SY...
tem from below. 14 Id, max = 9.5 kA 1)
Siemens SIRIUS
Industry Inc., Industrial
Innovations Control2012
Supplement Catalog 4/17
6/53
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS3RA6
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
Infeed systems for 3RA6 — up to 100 A
Infeed systems for 3RA6
3RA68 12-8AC
Infeeds with screw connection
0-2/0 AWG left
Infeed with screw connection with Screw terminals
permanently fitted 3-socket expansion
module with screw or spring-type
terminals on the outgoing side and
integrated PE bar
Expansion module with 3 sockets for
3RA68 13-8AB 3 direct-on-line starters or 1 direct-on-line
starter and 1 reversing starter,
suitable for UL duty according to UL 508
Type E
• Screw terminals on outgoing side 3RA68 13-8AB 1.146
6
3RA68 13-8AC
Infeeds with spring-type
connection 4-2 AWG left or right
Spring-type terminals
3RA68 30-5AC
4/18 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
6/54 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Compact Combination Starters For Operation in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
Infeed systems for 3RA6
Infeed systems for 3RA6
4
STARTERS
COMBINATION
3RA68 22-0AC
Three-socket expansion modules
With screw or spring-type terminals
and integrated PE bar
with 3 sockets for 3 direct-on-line starters or
1 direct-on-line starter and 1 reversing starter
Expansion plug and 2 connecting plates
are included in the scope of supply.
Screw terminals
6
3RA68 23-0AC
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/19
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/55
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS3RA6
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
Infeed systems for 3RA6
Infeed systems for 3RA6
Accessories
Version Order No. Weight
approx.
kg
Accessories for 3RA6 infeed systems
PE infeeds 4-2 AWG
Screw terminals
3RA68 60-6AB
Spring-type terminals
3RA68 60-5AC
PE tap-offs 10-8 AWG
Screw terminals
3RA68 70-4AB
Spring-type terminals
3RA68 70-3AC
Expansion plugs
PE expansion plugs 3RA68 90-0EA 0.008
3RA68 90-0EA
Expansion plugs 3RA68 90-1AB 0.029
between 2 expansion modules
Is included in the scope of supply of the
expansion modules.
3RA68 90-1AB
Expansion plugs for SIRIUS 3RV19/29 infeed 3RA68 90-1AA 0.079
system
Connects infeed system for 3RA6 to
3RV29 infeed systems
3RA68 90-1AA
4/20 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
6/56 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS 3RA6andCompact
Load Feeders Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
Infeed systems for 3RA6
Infeed systems for 3RA6
3RA6890-0BA
Terminal covers for infeeds with screw connection
IP20 terminal covers for infeeds with screw connection 3RA6880-2AB
25/35 mm² (3RA6812-8AB/AC)
(2 units per pack)
4
3RA6880-2AB
STARTERS
COMBINATION
IP20 terminal covers for infeeds with screw connection 3RA6880-3AB
50/70 mm² (3RA6813-8AB/AC)
(2 units per pack)
3RA6880-3AB
Terminal blocks
8
3RV2917-5D
Tools for opening spring-type terminals
Screwdrivers
For all SIRIUS devices with spring-type terminals Spring-type terminals
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/21
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
8/78 Siemens IC 10 · 2015 Illustrations are approximate.
Compact Combination Starters For Operation in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
General data
General data
More information
Type 3RA61 3RA62 3RA64 3RA65
Size S0
Number of poles 3
General technical specifications
Device standard IEC/EN 60947-6-2
Mounting dimensions (WxHxD)
• Screw terminals mm 45 x 170 x 165 90 x 170 x 165 45 x 170 x 165 90 x 170 x 165
• Spring-type terminals mm 45 x 191 x 165 90 x 191 x 165 45 x 191 x 165 90 x 191 x 165
D
W
• For installation in SIRIUS infeed system for 3RA6 °C -20 ... +40
• During storage IEC/EN 60732-3-1 °C -55 ... +80
• During transport IEC/EN 60721-3-2 °C -55 ... +80
COMBINATION
STARTERS
6
EN 60947-4-1
Rated short-circuit current Iq Acc. to IEC 60947-4-1, kA 30 (up to 12 A units)
at AC 50/60 Hz 480 V EN 60947-4-1 15 (8 ... 32 A unit)
Types of coordination Acc. to IEC 60947-6-2, Continuous
EN 60947-6-2
Power loss Pv max of all main current paths 0.4 A mW 10
Dependent on the rated current Ie 1.25 A mW 100
(upper setting range) 4A W 1
12 A W 1.8
32 A W 5.4
Max. switching frequency AC-41 1/h 750
AC-43 1/h 250
AC-44 1/h 15
Drive losses
Active power At 24 V
• 0.1 ... 12 A W 2.7
• 8 ... 32 A W 2.95
At 110 ... 240 V
• 0.1 ... 12 A W 3.4
• 8 ... 32 A W 3.8
Overload function
Ratio of lower to upper current mark 1:4
Shock resistance (sine-wave pulse) a = 60 m/s² = 6 g with 10 ms; for every 3 shocks in all axes
Vibratory load f = 4 ... 5.8 Hz; d =15 mm; f = 5.8 ... 500 Hz; a = 20 m/s2;10 cycles
Protection class IP on the front Acc. to IEC 60529 IP20
Touch protection on the front Acc. to IEC 60529 Finger-safe, for vertical contact from the front
(screw and spring-type terminal)
Isolating features of the compact starter Acc. to IEC/EN 60947-3 Yes: Isolation is assured only by moving the actuator into
the *OFF* position
Main and EMERGENCY-STOP switch Acc. to IEC 60204 Yes
characteristics of the compact starter and
accessories
4/22 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/35
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS3RA6
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
General datadata
General
4
- Conductor - Ground kV 4 2
- Conductor - Conductor kV 2 1
• In the auxiliary circuit
0.51)
STARTERS
COMBINATION
- Conductor - Ground kV 2
- Conductor - Conductor kV 1 0.51)
Auxiliary switches
• Integrated
- Position of the main contacts 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NO
- Overload/short-circuit signal 1 CO/1 NO
• Expandable
- Position of the main contacts 2 NO, 2 NC, 1 NO + 1 NC
Surge suppressors Integrated (Varistor)
Pollution degree 3
Depth from standard mounting rail mm 160
Electromagnetic operating mechanism
Control voltage V 24 AC/DC 24 DC
V 110 ... 240 AC/DC --
Frequency At AC Hz 50/60 ( ±5 %)
6
@ = A, B, C or D
Rated operational current 12A Rated operational current 32 A
Rated control supply voltage V 24 DC 24 DC
Inrush peak current A 0.39 0.53
Hold current A 0.13 0.15
Closed W 2.9 3.4
Operating times, typical1)
• On ms <140 <140
• Off ms <35 <30
4/24 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/37
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS3RA6
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
General datadata
General
4
Control circuit
Rated operational voltage
STARTERS
COMBINATION
• External auxiliary switch block V 400/690
• Internal auxiliary switch V 400/690
• Short-circuit signaling switch V 400
• Overload signaling switch V 400
Switching capacity
• External auxiliary switch block AC-15
• At Ue = 230 V A 6
• At Ue = 400 V A 3
• At Ue = 289/500 V A 2
• At Ue = 400/690 V A 1
DC-13
• At Ue = 24 V A 6
• At Ue = 60 V A 0.9
• At Ue = 125 V A 0.55
• At Ue = 250 V A 0.27
• Internal auxiliary switch AC-15
• At Ue = 230 V A 6
6
• At Ue = 400 V A 3
• At Ue = 289/500 V A 2
• At Ue = 400/690 V A 1
DC-13
• At Ue = 24 V A 10
• At Ue = 60 V A 2
• At Ue = 125 V A 1
• At Ue = 250 V A 0.27
• At Ue = 480 V A 0.1
• Signaling switch AC-15
• At Ue = 230 V A 3
• At Ue = 400 V A 1
DC-13
• At Ue = 24 V A 2
• At Ue = 250 V A 0.11
Contact stability At 17 V and 5 mA Oper- 1 incorrect switching operation per 100 000 000
ating
cycles
Short-circuit protection
• Short-circuit current IK 1.1 kA Fuse links A 10
operational class gG
- NEOZED Type 5SE
- DIAZED Type 5SB
- LV HRC Type 3NA
• Short-circuit current IK < 400 A Miniature circuit breaker up to A 10
230 V with C characteristic
Signaling switches
Endurance in operating cycles
• Mechanical endurance 20 000
• Electrical endurance AC-15 At 230 V and 3 A 6 050
Contact stability At 17 V and 5 mA Oper- 1 incorrect switching operation per 100 000 000
6
ating
cycles
Short-circuit protection
• Short-circuit current IK 1.1 kA Fuse links A 6
operational class gG
- NEOZED Type 5SE
- DIAZED Type 5SB
- LV HRC Type 3NA
• Short-circuit current IK < 400 A Miniature circuit breaker up to A 6
230 V with C characteristic
Overload (short-circuit current IK 1.1 kA) Fuse links A 4
operational class gG
- NEOZED Type 5SE
- DIAZED Type 5SB
- LV HRC Type 3NA
4/26 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/39
Compact Combination Starters
Technical data
Connection type Screw connection Spring-type connection
• Finely stranded with ferrule mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5) 2 x (2.5 ... 6) 2 x (1.5 ... 6) 2 x (2.5 ... 6)
2
mm 2 x (2.5 ... 6)
• AWG cables AWG 2 x (16 ...14) 2 x (14 ...10) 2 x (16 ...10) 2 x (14 ...10)
AWG 2 x (14 ...10) 1x8 1x8 1x8
AWG 1x8
4
Connection type Screw connection Spring-type connection
STARTERS
COMBINATION
Conductor cross-sections of
control circuit terminals
Tools Posidrive size 2 (3.0 x 0.5) mm, DIN ISO 2380-1A
Prescribed tightening torque NM 0.8 ... 1.2 --
Minimum/maximum conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm² 1 x (0.5 ... 4) 2 x (0.25 ... 1.5)
mm² 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded with ferrule mm² 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5) 2 x (0.25 ... 1.5)
mm² 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
• Finely stranded with ferrule mm² 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5) 2 x (0.25 ... 1.5)
mm² 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)
Technical data
Order No. 3RA6970-3A, 3RA6970-3B, 3RA6970-3C, 3RA6970-3D,
3RA6970-3E
General data of the AS-i add-on module
Permissible ambient temperature
• Storage Acc. to IEC/EN 60721-3-1 °C -25 ... +70
• Transport Acc. to IEC/EN 60721-3-2 °C -25 ... +70
Degree of protection Acc. to IEC/EN 60947-1 IP20
EMC interference immunity Acc. to EN 50295
Conductor-related interference BURST acc. to kV 1/2
IEC/EN 61000-4-4
Electrostatic discharge Acc. to IEC/EN 61000-4-2 kV 6/8
Field-related interference Acc. to IEC/EN 61000-4-3 V/m 10 (80 MHz ... 2.7 GHz)
Maximum pick-up current mA 400
Maximum hold current mA 200
Power consumption, max. mA 30
IO code 7
ID code A
ID2 code E
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION
Technical data
Type 3RA6.
General data
Max. rated operational current
• Infeed with screw connection 0-2/0 AWG A 100
• Infeed with screw connection 4-2 AWG A 63
• Infeed with spring-type connection 10-3 AWG A 63
• Expansion plug A 63
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -20 ... +60 (over +40 current reduction is required)
- Permissible rated current at control cabinet inside temperature: +40 °C % 100
+60 °C % 80
• During storage/transport °C -55 ... +80
Relative air humidity % 10 ... 90
Installation altitude m Up to 2000 above sea level without restriction
Rated operational voltage Ue V 690 AC
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Shock resistance a = 60 m/s² = 6g with 10 ms; for every 3 shocks in all axes
Vibratory load f =1 ... 6 Hz; d =15 mm 10 cycles
f =150 Hz; a = 2 g
4
Degree of protection Acc. to IEC 60947-1 IP20 (IP 00 terminal compart-
ment)
STARTERS
COMBINATION
Touch protection Acc. to EN 50274 Finger-safe
Degree of pollution 3
Short-circuit protection for Recommendation for upstream
short-circuit protection device
infeed with screw connection 4-2 AWG 3RV1041-4JA10
and infeed with screw connection 0-2/0 AWG 3RV1041-4MA10
Id,max kA < 21
I²t kA²s 530 LV HRC gL/gG 3NA3, 315 A
Short-circuit protection for infeed with spring- Recommendation for upstream
type connection short-circuit protection device
• Conductor cross-section 12 AWG Id,max kA < 9.5 3RV2021-4DA10
I²t kA²s 85
• Conductor cross-section 10 AWG Id,max kA < 12.5 3RV1031-4EA10
I²t kA²s 140
• Conductor cross-section 8 AWG Id,max kA < 15 3RV1031-4HA10
I²t kA²s 180
• Conductor cross-section 6-4 AWG Id,max kA < 19 3RV1041-4JA10
I²t kA²s 440
Short-circuit protection for terminal block Recommendation for upstream
short-circuit protection device
• Conductor cross-section 16 AWG Id,max kA 7.5 5SY...
1)
• Conductor cross-section 14 AWG Id,max kA 9.5
• Conductor cross-section 12 AWG Id,max kA 9.5
• Conductor cross-section 10 AWG Id,max kA 12.5
1)
To prevent the possibility of short-circuits, the cables on the terminal block
must be installed so that they are short-circuit resistant according to
EN 60439-1 Section 7.5.5.1.2.
Type 3RV29.
Connection type Spring-type connection
Technical data
Type 3RA6.
Connection type Screw connection
Conductor cross-sections of infeed with screw connection
16-2 AWG (L1, L2, L3)1) and PE infeed 2 AWG2)
Order No. 3RA68 12-8AB, 3RA68 12-8AC, 3RA68 60-6AB
Tools Posidrive size 2
Specified tightening torque NM 3 ... 4.5
Conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm2 2.6 ... 16 2.6 ... 16 max. 2 x 16
• Stranded mm2 2.5 ... 35 2.5 ... 35 max. 2 x 25
• Finely stranded with ferrule mm2 2.5 ... 25 2.5 ... 25 max. 2 x 16
• Finely stranded without ferrule mm2 2.5 ... 25 2.5 ... 25 max. 2 x 16
• AWG cables AWG 12 ... 2 12 ... 2 max. 2 x (16 ... 2)
4
Conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm2 2.5 ... 16 2.5 ... 16 max. 2 x 16
• Stranded mm2 4 ... 70 10 ... 70 max. 2 x 50
• Finely stranded with ferrule mm2 2.5 ... 35 2.5 ... 50 max. 2 x 35
• Finely stranded without ferrule mm2 4 ... 50 10 ... 50 max. 2 x 35
• AWG cables AWG 10 ... 2/0 10 ... 2/0 max. 2 x (10 ... 1/0)
• Finely stranded without ferrule mm2 2 x (1 ... 2.5) 2 x (2.5 ... 6) 2 x (1.5 ... 6) 2 x (2.5 ... 6)
mm2 2 x (2.5 ... 6)
• AWG cables AWG 2 x (16 ... 14) 2 x (14 ... 10) 2 x (16 ... 10) 2 x (14 ... 10)
AWG 2 x (14 ... 10)
AWG 1x8 1x8 1x8 1x8
1) L1, L2, L3 main conductors on input side. 2) T1, T2, T3 main conductors on output side.
Dimensional drawings
Direct-on-line starters and reversing starters
45 90
25 10 25 165
1701)
1912)
24
185
30
4
NSB0_01884
STARTERS
COMBINATION
1) Screw connection
2) Spring-loaded connection
Schematics
3RA61 direct-on-line starters
3RA6911-.A
33 43
1L1 3L2 5L3
9896
34 44
95 3RA6912-.A
RLT 13 21 31 41
Q1
14 22 32 42
>> >> >>
77
3RA6913-.A
31 43
78 A1 A2
32 44
NSB0_01924
Dimensional drawings
3RA62 reversing starters
9896
95
3RA6911-.A 3RA6911-.A
23 33 53 63
24 34 54 64
RLT RLT
3RA6912-.A 3RA6912-.A
21 31 13 43 51 61
4
Q1 Q2
COMBINATION
STARTERS
22 32 14 44 52 62
3RA6913-.A 3RA6913-.A
21 33 51 63
77
78
A2 A1 B1 B2
NSB0_01925
■ Dimensional drawings
70 135 155
58
79
NSB0_01926
111
Ø4
,5
148
140
197
225
28
57 45
4
61
102
5
31
STARTERS
COMBINATION
65
Infeed with screw connection 0-2/0 AWG on left with fixed 3-socket expansion module with outgoing screw terminals
176
NSB0_01927
45 135 144
58
79
111
140
148
38
197
225
5
28
57 45
61
76
31
65
Infeed with screw connection 4-2 AWG on left with fixed 3-socket expansion module with outgoing screw terminals
70 135 155
58
NSB0_01928
79
111
Ø4
,5
140
148
208
227
19
57 45
60
102 5 67
4
Infeed with screw connection 0-2/0 AWG on left with fixed 3-socket expansion module with outgoing spring-type terminals
COMBINATION
STARTERS
45 135 176
NSB0_01929
144
58
79
111
Ø4
,5
140
148
208
38
227
19
57 45
60
76 5 67
Infeed with screw connection 4-2 AWG on left with fixed 3-socket expansion module with outgoing spring-type terminals
97
79
154
NSB0_01930
27 5
86
135 90 97
NSB0_01931
58
58
79
Ø4 Ø4
,5 ,5
148
148
197
197
197
45 5 65
3-socket expansion module and 2-socket expansion module with outgoing screw te rminals
4
135 90 97
NSB0_01932
STARTERS
COMBINATION
58
58
79
Ø4 Ø4
,5 ,5
148
148
208
208
197
5
45 67
10
3-socket expansion module and 2-socket expansion module with outgoing spring-type te rminals
> 30
NSB0_01933
> 30
> 10 > 10
Minimum clearances to adjacent components when using infeed system for 3RA6
kA A kg
Selection depends on motor full load amps
3RV20 3RT20 3RA
COMBINATION
STARTERS
6
1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 3RA21 1@-1F@15-1AK6 0.575
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 3RA21 1@-1G@15-1AK6 0.575
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 16-1AK61 3RA21 1@-1H@16-1AK6 0.575
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA21 1@-1J@16-1AK6 0.575
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12 11-1KA10 17-1AK61 3RA21 1@-1K@17-1AK6 0.575
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11… 16 11-4AA10 18-1AK61 3RA21 1@-4A@18-1AK6 0.575
S0 1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 24-1AK60 2921-1AA00 3RA21 2@-1F@24-0AK6 0.761
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 + 8US1251- 3RA21 2@-1G@24-0AK6 0.761
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 5NT10 3RA21 2@-1H@24-0AK6 0.761
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA21 2@-1J@24-0AK6 0.761
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12.5 11-1KA10 3RA21 2@-1K@24-0AK6 0.761
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11… 16 21-4AA10 26-1AK60 3RA21 2@-4A@26-0AK6 0.761
1 1/2 3 5 5 10 -- 65 14… 20 21-4BA10 3RA21 2@-4B@26-0AK6 0.761
1 1/2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 17… 22 21-4CA10 27-1AK60 3RA21 2@-4C@27-0AK6 0.761
2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 20… 25 21-4DA10 3RA21 2@-4D@27-0AK6 0.761
2 5 7 1/2 10 20 -- 50 27… 32 21-4EA10 3RA21 2@-4E@27-0AK6 0.761
4/36 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/13
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
3RA2 Starters
Non-Reversing, AC and DC Coil — up to 100 A
SCCR FLA setting Starter Size Consisting of the following individual devices
at range
480Y/ Inverse-time Order No.
4
277V delayed Motor starter + Contactor + Link module
overload protector +
kA release
Single-Phase HP Three-Phase2)
STARTERS
COMBINATION
Adapter for standard
Ratings HP ratings
mounting rail3)
115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V A
110VAC 50Hz / 120VAC 60 Hz
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 65 22... 32 3RA21 3@-4EA35-@AK6 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1AK60
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 28... 36 3RA21 3@-4PA36-@AK6 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 32... 40 3RA21 3@-4UA36-@AK6 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1AK60 3RA2931-1AA00
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 35... 45 3RA21 3@-4VA36-@AK6 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
5 10 20 20 50 50 65 42... 52 3RA21 3@-4WA37-@AK6 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1AK60 3RA2932-1AA00
(must be ordered
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 49... 59 3RA21 3@-4XA38- @AK6 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1AK60 separately)
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 54... 65 3RA21 3@-4JA38- @AK6 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 28... 40 3RA21 4@-4FB45-@AK6 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 36... 50 3RA21 4@-4HB45-@AK6 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1AK60
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 45... 63 3RA21 4@-4JB45-@AK6 3RV20 41-4JA10
3RA1941-1AA00
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 57... 75 3RA21 4@-4KB46-@AK6 3RV20 41-4KA10
+
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 65... 84 3RA21 4@-4RB46-@AK6 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1AK60 3RA2942-1AA00
10 20 30 30 75 – 65 75... 93 3RA21 4@-4YB46-@AK6 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 65 80...100 3RA21 4@-4MB47-@AK6 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1AK60
24V UC
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 65 22... 32 3RA21 3 -4EA35-@NB3 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1NB30
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 28... 36 3RA21 3@-4PA36-@NB3 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 32... 40 3RA21 3@-4UA36-@NB3 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1NB30
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 35... 45 3RA21 3@-4VA36-@NB3 3RV20 31-4VA10 3RA2931-1AA00
+
5 10 20 20 50 50 65 42... 52 3RA21 3@-4WA37-@NB3 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1NB30 3RA2932-1AA00
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 49... 59 3RA21 3@-4XA38- @NB3 3RV20 31-4XA10 (must be ordered
3RT2038-1NB30
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 54... 65 3RA21 3@-4JA38- @NB3 3RV20 31-4JA10 separately)
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 28... 40 3RA21 4@-4FB45-@NB3 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 36... 50 3RA21 4@-4HB45-@NB3 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1NB30
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 45... 63 3RA21 4@-4JB45- @NB3 3RV20 41-4JA10
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 57... 75 3RA21 4@-4KB46-@NB3 3RV20 41-4KA10 3RA1941-1BA00
+
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 65... 84 3RA21 4@-4RB46-@NB3 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1NB30
3RA2942-1AA00
10 20 30 30 75 – 65 70... 90 3RA21 4@-4YB46-@NB3 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 65 80...100 3RA21 4@-4MB47-@NB3 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1NB30
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/37
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
3RA2 Starters SIRIUS 3RA2 Motor Starters
Non-Reversing, DC Coil — up to 22 A 3RA21 direct-on-line starters
24 V DC
Direct-on-line
Rated control supply voltage 24 V DC
starting With screw connections
• The motor starter protector and contactor are mechanically
and electrically connected by means of the link module.
• Auxiliary switches1) on the motor starter protector and the con-
tactor can be easily fitted due to the modular system.
• Integrated auxiliary switches:
- Contactor size S00: 1 NO;
- Contactor size S0: 1 NO + 1 NC
Combination Starter, UL508 Type F
All size S00 and S0 devices can be applied as Combination
3RA21 20 3RA21 10 3RA21 20
Starters with the addition of either of these line side connectors:
3RA21 10
3RV29 28-1H, 3RV29 25-5EB or 3RV29 28-1K.
Size UL Data FLA setting Consisting of the following Assembled starter Weight
range inverse- single devices approx.
Single-phase Three-phase2) SCCR time delayed Motor + Contactor + Link Screw terminals
HP ratings HP ratings at overload starter module
480 V release protector + Busbar
115 V 230 V 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V adapter3) Order No.
kA A kg
Selection depends on motor full load amps
4
6
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA21 1@-1J@16-1BB4 0.630
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12 11-1KA10 17-1BB41 3RA21 1@-1K@17-1BB4 0.630
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11…16 11-4AA10 18-1BB41 3RA21 1@-4A@18-1BB4 0.630
S0 1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 24-1BB40 2921-1BA00 3RA21 2@-1F@24-0BB4 0.948
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 + 8US1251- 3RA21 2@-1G@24-0BB4 0.948
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 5NT10 3RA21 2@-1H@24-0BB4 0.948
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA21 2@-1J@24-0BB4 0.948
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12.5 11-1KA10 3RA21 2@-1K@24-0BB4 0.948
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11… 16 21-4AA10 26-1BB40 3RA21 2@-4A@26-0BB4 0.948
1 1/2 3 5 5 10 -- 65 14… 20 21-4BA10 3RA21 2@-4B@26-0BB4 0.948
1 1/2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 17… 22 21-4CA10 27-1BB40 3RA21 2@-4C@27-0BB4 0.948
2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 20… 25 21-4DA10 3RA21 2@-4D@27-0BB4 0.948
2 5 7 1/2 10 20 -- 50 27… 32 21-4EA10 3RA21 2@-4E@27-0BB4 0.948
4/38 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/15
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
3RA2 Starters
Non-Reversing Fast Bus® — AC and DC Coil
SCCR FLA setting Starter Size Consisting of the following individual devices
at range
480Y/ Inverse-time Order No.
4
277V delayed Motor starter + Contactor + Link module
overload protector +
kA release
Single-Phase Three-Phase2)
STARTERS
COMBINATION
HP Ratings HP ratings Adapter for standard
mounting rail3)
115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V A
110VAC 50Hz / 120 VAC 60Hz
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 65 22... 32 3RA21 3@-4ED35-@AK6 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1AK60
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 28... 36 3RA21 3@-4PD36- @AK6 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 32... 40 3RA21 3@-4UD36-@AK6 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1AK60 3RA2931-1AA00
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 35... 45 3RA21 3@-4VD36-@AK6 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
5 10 20 20 50 50 65 42... 52 3RA21 3@-4WD37-@AK6 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1AK60 8US1261-6MT10
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 49... 59 3RA21 3@-4XD38- @AK6 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1AK60
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 54... 65 3RA21 3@-4JD38- @AK6 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 28... 40 3RA21 4@-4FD45-@ AK6 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 36... 50 3RA21 4@-4HD45-@AK6 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1AK60
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 45... 63 3RA21 4@-4JD45-@AK6 3RV20 41-4JA10 3RA1941-1AA00
10 20 30 30 75 75 3RA21 4@-4KD46-@AK6 3RV20 41-4KA10 +
65 57... 75
8US1211-4TR00
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 65... 84 3RA21 4@-4RD46-@AK6 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1AK60
10 20 30 30 75 – 65 75... 93 3RA21 4@-4YD46-@AK6 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 65 80...100 3RA21 4@-4MD47-@AK6 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1AK60
24V UC
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 65 22... 32 3RA21 3@-4ED35-@NB3 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1NB30
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 28... 36 3RA21 3@-4PD36-@NB3 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 32... 40 3RA21 3@-4UD36-@NB3 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1NB30 3RA2931-1AA00
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 35... 45 3RA21 3@-4VD36-@NB3 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
5 10 20 20 50 50 65 42... 52 3RA21 3@-4WD37-@NB3 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1NB30 8US1261-6MT10
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 49... 59 3RA21 3@-4XD38- @NB3 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1NB30
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 54... 65 3RA21 3@-4JD38-@NB3 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 28... 40 3RA21 4@-4FD45-@NB3 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 36... 50 3RA21 4@-4HD45-@NB3 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1NB30
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 45... 63 3RA21 4@-4JD45-@NB3 3RV20 41-4JA10 3RA1941-1BA00
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 57... 75 3RA21 4@-4KD46-@NB3 3RV20 41-4KA10 +
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 65... 84 3RA21 4@-4RD46-@NB3 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1NB30 8US1211-4TR00
10 20 30 30 75 – 65 75... 93 3RA21 4@-4YD46-@NB3 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 65 80...100 3RA21 4@-4MD47-@NB3 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1NB30
6
1/8 1/3 3/4 3/4 2 3 65 2.8… 4 11-1EA10 3RA22 10-1E @15-2AK6 0.824
1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 3RA22 10-1F @15-2AK6 0.824
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 3RA22 10-1G @15-2AK6 0.824
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 16-1AK62 3RA22 10-1H @16-2AK6 0.824
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA22 10-1J @16-2AK6 0.824
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12 11-1KA10 17-1AK62 3RA22 10-1K @17-2AK6 0.824
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11…16 11-4AA10 18-1AK62 3RA22 10-4A @18-2AK6 0.824
S0 1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 24-1AK60 2921-1AA00 3RA22 20-1F @24-0AK6 1.434
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 + 2923-1BB1 (RH) 3RA22 20-1G @24-0AK6 1.434
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 + 2923-1DB1 (RS) 3RA22 20-1H @24-0AK6 1.434
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA22 20-1J @24-0AK6 1.434
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12.5 11-1KA10 3RA22 20-1K @24-0AK6 1.434
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11… 16 21-4AA10 26-1AK60 3RA22 20-4A @26-0AK6 1.434
1 1/2 3 5 5 10 -- 65 14… 20 21-4BA10 3RA22 20-4B @26-0AK6 1.434
1 1/2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 17… 22 21-4CA10 27-1AK60 3RA22 20-4C @27-0AK6 1.434
2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 20… 25 21-4DA10 3RA22 20-4D @27-0AK6 1.434
2 5 7 1/2 10 20 -- 50 27… 32 21-4EA10 3RA22 20-4E @27-0AK6 1.434
Add. weight
Order No. supplement for mounting onto standard mounting rail or screw fixing
• Without standard mounting rail adapter for size S004) 1 A
• With 2 standard mounting rail adapters for size S0 2 B
Screw fixing with 2 push-in lugs each per motor starter is possible
Order No. supplement for mounting onto Fastbus 60mm busbar system for size S00 1 D 0.486
With 8US Fast Bus busbar adapter for size S0 2 D 0.293
1) For push-in lugs and auxiliary switches, see Accessories on pages 4/44 and 4/52.
2) Selection depends on the motor full load amps. HP ratings for reference only.
3) According to ordering option:
RH = assembly kit for reversing duty with standard rail mounting adapter in size S0.
RS = assembly kit for reversing duty with 8US Fast Bus busbar mounting.
4) With standard rail mounting or screw fixing, the 3RA29 13-2AA1
wiring kit is required for size S00.
4/40 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/17
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
3RA2 Starter
Reversing, AC Coil — up to 100 A
4
time Motor starter + 2 Contactors + Link module
delayed protector +
overload assembly kit RH3)
STARTERS
COMBINATION
Single-Phase Three-Phase2)
HP Ratings HP ratings
115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V A
110VAC 50Hz / 120VAC 60Hz
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 22 ... 32 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1AK60
3 10 15 15 40 50 28 ... 36 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 32 ... 40 For customer 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1AK60 3RA2931-1AA00
3 10 15 15 40 50 35 ... 45 assembly 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1AK60 3RA2933-1BB1
5 10 20 20 50 50 42 ... 52
5 15 20 25 50 60 49 ... 59 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1AK60
5 15 20 25 50 60 54 ... 65 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 28 ... 40 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 36 ... 50 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1AK60
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 45 ... 63 For customer 3RV20 41-4JA10 3RA1941-1AA00
10 20 30 30 75 75 57 ... 75 assembly 3RV20 41-4KA10 +
3RA1943-1B4)
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 ... 84 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1AK60
10 20 30 30 75 – 75 ... 93 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 80 ...100 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1AK60
24VDC
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 22... 32 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1NB30
3 10 15 15 40 50 28... 36 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 32... 40 For customer 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1NB30 3RA2931-1AA00
3 10 15 15 40 50 35... 45 assembly 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
5 10 20 20 50 50 42... 52 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RA2933-1BB1
3RT2037-1NB30
5 15 20 25 50 60 49... 59 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1NB30
5 15 20 25 50 60 54... 65 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 28 ... 40 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 36 ... 50 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1NB30
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 45 ... 63 For customer 3RV20 41-4JA10 3RA1941-1BA00
assembly +
10 20 30 30 75 75 57 ... 75 3RV20 41-4KA10
3RA1943-1B4)
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 ... 84 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1NB30
10 20 30 30 75 – 75 ... 93 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 80 ...100 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1NB30
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/41
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
kA A kg
Selection depends on motor full load amps
COMBINATION
STARTERS
6
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 3RA22 10-1G@15-2BB4 0.934
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 16-1BB42 3RA22 10-1H@16-2BB4 0.934
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA22 10-1J@16-2BB4 0.934
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12 11-1KA10 17-1BB42 3RA22 10-1K@17-2BB4 0.934
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11…16 11-4AA10 18-1BB42 3RA22 10-4A@18-2BB4 0.934
S0 1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 24-1BB40 2921-1BA00 '+ 3RA22 20-1F@24-0BB4 1.811
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 2923-1BB1 (RH) '+ 3RA22 20-1G@24-0BB4 1.811
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 2923-1DB1 (RS) 3RA22 20-1H@24-0BB4 1.811
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA22 20-1J@24-0BB4 1.811
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12.5 11-1KA10 3RA22 20-1K@24-0BB4 1.811
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11… 16 21-4AA10 26-1BB40 3RA22 20-4A@26-0BB4 1.811
1 1/2 3 5 5 10 -- 65 14… 20 21-4BA10 3RA22 20-4B@26-0BB4 1.811
1 1/2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 17… 22 21-4CA10 27-1BB40 3RA22 20-4C@27-0BB4 1.811
2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 20… 25 21-4DA10 3RA22 20-4D@27-0BB4 1.811
2 5 7 1/2 10 20 -- 50 27… 32 21-4EA10 3RA22 20-4E@27-0BB4 1.811
Add. weight
Order No. supplement for mounting onto standard mounting rail or screw fixing
• Without standard mounting rail adapter for size S004) 1 A
• With 2 standard mounting rail adapters for size S0 2 B
Screw fixing with 2 push-in lugs each per motor starter is possible
Order No. supplement for mounting onto Fastbus 60mm busbar system for size S00 1 D 0.486
With 8US Fast Bus busbar adapter for size S0 2 D 0.306
1) For push-in lugs and auxiliary switches, see Accessories on pages 4/44 and 4/52.
2) Selection depends on the motor full load amps. HP ratings for reference only.
3) Code for abbreviations:
RH = assembly kit for reversing duty with standard rail mounting adapter in size S0.
RS = assembly kit for reversing duty with 8US Fast Bus busbar mounting.
4) With standard rail mounting or screw fixing, the 3RA29 13-2AA1 wiring kit and link
module are required for size S00.
4/42 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/19
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
3RA2 Starter
Reversing Fast Bus®, AC and DC Coil — up to 100 A
4
range Order No.
Inverse-time Motor starter + Contactor + Link module
delayed protector +
overload
STARTERS
COMBINATION
Adapter shoe for
release Fastbus
Single-Phase Three-Phase2)
HP Ratings HP ratings
115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V A
110VAC 50Hz / 120VAC 60Hz
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 22... 32 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1AK60
3 10 15 15 40 50 28... 36 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 32... 40 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1AK60 3RA2931-1AA00
For customer
3 10 15 15 40 50 35... 45 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
assembly
5 10 20 20 50 50 42... 52 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1AK60 3RA2933-1DB1
5 15 20 25 50 60 49... 59 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1AK60
5 15 20 25 50 60 54... 65 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 28... 40 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 36... 50 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1AK60
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 32... 40 For customer 3RV20 41-4JA10 3RA1941-1AA00
10 20 30 30 75 75 57... 75 assembly 3RV20 41-4KA10 +
10 20 30 30 75 75 3RA1943-2A3)
42... 52 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1AK60
10 20 30 30 75 – 75... 93 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 80...100 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1AK60
24VDC
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 22... 32 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1NB30
3 10 15 15 40 50 28... 36 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 32... 40 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1NB30 3RA2931-1AA00
For customer
3 10 15 15 40 50 35... 45 assembly 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
5 10 20 20 50 50 42... 52 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1NB30 3RA2933-1DB1
5 15 20 25 50 60 49... 59 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1NB30
5 15 20 25 50 60 54... 65 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 28... 40 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 36... 50 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1NB30
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 45... 63 For customer 3RV20 41-4JA10 3RA1941-1BA00
assembly 3RV20 41-4KA10 +
10 20 30 30 75 75 57... 75
3RA 1943-2A3)
10 20 30 30 75 75 65... 84 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1NB30
10 20 30 30 75 – 75... 93 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 80...100 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1NB30
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/43
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
3RA2 Accessories
Auxiliary switches
Overview
The accessories listed here are parts and add-ons for the 3RA2 direct-on-line and reversing
starters as well as components for the customer assembly of motor starters
3RV29 01-1E 3RV29 01-2E 3RV29 01-1A 3RV29 01-2A 3RV29 02-1A 3RV29 02-2D
1 One transverse auxillary switch and one lateral auxillary switch can be attached per motor starter protector.
When the lateral auxillary switch with 2 NO + 2 NC is used, a transverse auxillary switch is not allowed.
Shunt releases
— — 20…24 20...70 S00 ... S3 3RV29 02-1DB0 0.119 3RV29 02-2DB0 0.115
1 The voltage range is valid for 100% (infinite) ON period. The response voltage lies at 0.9 of the lower limit of the voltage range.
2 The voltage range is valid for 5s ON period at AC 50 Hz/60 Hz and DC. The response voltage lies at 0.85 of the lower limit of the voltage range.
3 One auxiliary release can be mounted on the right per motor starter protector
(does not apply to 3RV21 motor starter protectors with overload reset function).
4/44 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
3RA2 Accessories
Auxiliary switches, terminals
3RH29 11-1MA20
Cable entry from two sides S00 ... S3 4-pole 2 NO + 2 NC 3RH29 11-1FA22 0.060 3RH29 11-2FA22 0.049
4
S00 2-pole 1 NO + 1 NC 3RH29 11-1DA11 0.039 3RH29 11-2DA11 0.050
STARTERS
COMBINATION
S00 2-pole 2 NC 3RH29 11-1DA02 0.039 3RH29 11-2DA02 0.050
S0 ... S3 2-pole 1 NO + 1 NC 3RH29 21-1DA11 0.039 3RH29 21-2DA11 0.050
S0 ... S3 2-pole 2 NC 3RH29 21-1DA02 0.041 3RH29 21-2DA02 0.050
3RH29 11-1FA22
S0 ... S3 2-pole 2 NO 3RH29 21-1DA20 0.041 3RH29 21-2DA20 0.050
3RT19 00-4RE01
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/45
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
3RA2 Accessories
Terminals
Note: UL 508 demands for “Combination Motor Controller Type E” 1” air gaps and 2” creepage distances
at lineside. The following terminal blocks must be used in S3 MSP’s 3RV10. The S2 MSP 3RV10 conforms
with stipulated air gaps and creepage distances without terminal block.
Terminal blocks are not required for use according to CSA. With size S0 these terminal blocks cannot
be used in combination with 3-phase busbars 3RV19.5. This also applies to size S3 in combination with
3RV29 28-1H transverse auxiliary switches.
3RT19 46-4GA07
4/46 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
3RA2 Accessories
Surge suppressors
Size S00 — For plugging onto the front side of the contactors with and without auxiliary switch blocks
4
3RT2.2 Varistors 24 … 48 AC 24 … 70 DC 3RT29 26-1BB00 0.010
48 … 127 AC 70 … 150 DC 3RT29 26-1BC00 0.010
3RT2.2 RC elements 24 … 48 AC 24 … 70 DC 3RT29 26-1CB00 0.010
STARTERS
COMBINATION
48 … 127 AC 70 … 150 DC 3RT29 26-1CC00 0.010
3RT2.2 Diode assemblies 24 DC 3RT29 26-1ER00 0.010
3RT29 26-1BB00 for DC operation and short break times 30 … 250 DC 3RT29 26-1ES00 0.010
Sizes S2
3RT2.3 Varistors 24 ... 48 AC 24 ... 70 DC 3RT29 36-1BB00 0.010
127 ... 240 AC 150 ... 250 DC 3RT29 36-1BD00 0.010
48 ... 127 AC 70 ... 150 DC 3RT29 36-1BC00 0.010
3RT2936-1E.00
Sizes S3
3RT20 4. Varistors 24 … 48 AC 24 … 70 DC 3RT29 36-1BB00 0.025
48 … 127 AC 70 … 150 DC 3RT29 36-1BC00 0.025
3RT20 4. RC elements 24 … 48 AC 24 … 70 DC 3RT29 36-1CB00 0.040
48 … 127 AC 70 … 150 DC 3RT29 36-1CC00 0.040
3RT20 4. Diode assemblies 24 DC 3RT29 36-1ER00 0.025
for DC operation and short break times, 30 … 250 DC 3RT29 36-1ES00 0.025
3RT2936-1CC00
can be plugged in at bottom
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/47
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
3RA2 Accessories
Surge suppressors, link modules
Electrical and mechanical link between motor starter protector and contactor
Spring-type
Terminals
Electrical and mechanical link between motor starter protector and contactor Order No.
Single-unit S00 S00 AC and DC 3RA29 11-2AA00
packaging S0 S0 AC 1) and DC 3RA29 21-2AA00 1 unit 0.040
3RA29 11-2AA00 Multi-unit S00 S00 AC and DC 3RA29 11-2A 10 unit 0.400
packaging S0 S0 AC 1) and DC 3RA29 21-2A 10 unit 0.770
Hybrid link modules from motor starter protector to contactor
For mechanical and electrical connection between motor starter protector with screw terminals and contactor with
spring-type terminals
Single-unit S00 S00 AC and DC 3RA29 11-2FA00 1 unit 0.029
packaging S0 S0 AC 1) and DC 3RA29 21-2FA00 1 unit 0.056
3RA29 11-2FA00 Multi-unit S00 S00 AC and DC 3RA29 11-2F 10 unit 0.290
packaging S0 S0 AC 1) and DC 3RA29 21-2F 10 unit 0.560
Electrical and mechanical link between motor starter protector and soft starter
Single-unit S00/S0 S00/S0 3RA29 21-1BA00 1 unit 0.001
packaging
Spring-type
Terminals
Electrical and mechanical link between motor starter protector and soft starter Order No.
Single-unit S00 S00 3RA29 11-2GA00 1 unit 0.038
packaging
S0 S0 3RA29 21-2GA00 1 unit 0.072
3RA29 11-2GA00 Multi-unit S00 S00 3RA29 11-2G 10 unit 0.380
packaging
S0 S0 3RA29 21-2G 10 unit 0.720
4/48 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
3RA2 Accessories
Mounting kits for Fast Bus
Accessories
For Version Screw Pack Weight
Conductors Terminals Qty. approx.
Size Order No. kg
Wiring kits for contactors
Reversing
S00 Electrical and mechanical connection for reversing 3RA29 13-2AA1 1 unit 0.001
contactors, optionally with integrated electrical
S0 and mechanical interlock 3RA29 23-2AA1 1 unit 0.001
S2 The kit contains: 3RA29 33-2AA1 1 unit 0.120
3RA29 23-2AA1 2 connecting pins for 2 contactors,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
• for main and auxiliary circuits
Wye-delta starting
S00 Electrical and mechanical link for three contactors 3RA29 13-2BB1 1 unit 0.001
of same size
S0 3RA29 23-2BB1 1 unit 0.001
4
S2-S2-S0 3RA29 33-2C 1 unit 0.070
3RA29 23-2BB1
S2-S2-S2 29RA2933-2BB1 1 unit 0.160
STARTERS
COMBINATION
Spring-type
Terminals
Reversing Duty
S00 Electrical and mechanical connection for reversing 3RA29 13-2AA2 1 unit 0.001
contactors, optionally with integrated electrical
S0 3RA29 23-2AA2 1 unit 0.001
and mechanical interlock
S2 The kit contains: 3RA29 33-2AA2 1 unit 0.001
2 connecting pins for 2 contactors, wiring
3RA29 23-2AA2 modules on the top and bottom
• for main circuits only
Wye-delta starting
S00 Electrical and mechanical link for three 3RA29 13-2BB2 1 unit 0.001
S0 contactors of same size 3RA29 23-2BB2 1 unit 0.001
S2-S2-S0 3RA29 33-2C 1 unit 0.001
S2-S2-S2 3RA29 33-2BB2 1 unit 0.001
Screw
Terminals
Wiring kits for contactors
Reversing
S00 Switches 2 contactors in series 3RA29 16-1A 1 unit 0.001
S0 3RA29 26-1A 1 unit 0.001
S2 3RA29 36-1A 1 unit 0.001
3RA29 16-1A
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/49
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
3RA2 Accessories
Mounting kits for Fast Bus
Accessories
For For Version Screw Pack Weight
Conductors MSPs Terminals Qty. approx.
Size Size Order No. kg
Mechanical interlocks
S2/S3 -- For reversing contactors, laterally mounted, 3RA29 34-2B 0.010
no electrical connections
(each contactor has 1NO/1NC auxiliaries)
3RA29 34-2B
3RA19 23-3B
3RA19 02-1B
4
S0 S0 Rated current 32 A, 8US12 51-5NT11 1 unit 0.183
45 mm wide, 260 mm long
Device holders for lateral mounting onto busbar adapters
STARTERS
COMBINATION
for 60 mm system
S00, S0 S00, S0 Up to 25 A, 8US12 50-5AS10 1 unit 0.183
45 mm wide, 200 mm long
S0 S0 Up to 40 A, 8US12 50-5AT10 1 unit 0.183
45 mm wide, 260 mm long
S2 S2 Up to 65A, 8US12 11-6MT10 1 unit 0.873
118mm wide, 260mm long
(includes 8US1261-6MT10 adapter)
6
-- -- Including connecting wedges, for 1 unit 0.023
widening busbar adapters or device
holders, 9 mm wide, 200 mm long
Spacers for fixing the motor starter onto the busbar adapter
-- S00, S0 (1 pack = 100 units) 8US19 98-1BA10 1 pack 0.183
Vibration and shock kits for high vibration and shock loads
-- S00, S0 8US19 98-1CA10 1 unit 0.183
RS assembly kits for reversing duty for 60 mm busbar systems
RS assembly kits for screw terminals Screw
terminals
S00, S0 S00 Comprising: 3RA29 13-1DB1 1 unit 0.001
S0 S0 • Wiring kits 3RA29 23-1DB1 1 unit 0.001
S00 S0 • Busbar adapters 3RA29 23-1EB1 1 unit 0.001
S2 S2 • Device holders 3RA29 33-1DB1 1 unit 1.235
• 2 connecting wedges
• Side modules
Link modules must be ordered
separately.
3RA29 23-1DB1
only Busbar adapter
pictured
RS assembly kits for spring-type terminals Spring-type
terminals
S00 S00 Comprising: 3RA29 13-1DB2 1 unit 0.001
S0 S0 • Wiring kits 3RA29 23-1DB2 1 unit 0.001
• Busbar adapters
• Device holders
• 2 connecting wedges
• Spacers
• Side modules
Link modules must be ordered
3RA29 23-1DB2 separately.
only Busbar adapter
pictured
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/51
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/27
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
SIRIUS
3RA2 3RA2 Motor Starters
Accessories
Connecting wedges, spaces, and tools
Accessories
3RA29 11-1CA00
4
qty.
kg
Tools for opening spring-type terminals by hand
Screwdrivers Spring-type terminals
for all SIRIUS devices with spring-type terminals
Length approx. 200 mm, 3RA29 08-1A 1 unit 0.045
3.0 mm x 0.5 mm,
titanium gray/black,
partially insulated
3RA29 08-1A
Blank labels
Unit labeling plates1) 3RT29 00-1SB20 340 units 0.200
for SIRIUS devices
20 mm x 7 mm,
pastel turquoise
6
NSB0_01429b
3RT19 00-1SB20
1) PC labeling system for individual inscription of
unit labeling plates available from:
murrplastik Systems, Inc.
www.murrplastik.com .
3RV29 28-0B
4/52 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
6/28 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Components for IEC types of coordination 1 and 2 at AC 500 V
■ Technical data
Three-phase standard motor1) Setting range Motor starter Contactor2) Size
4-pole at AC 500 V Inverse-time delayed protector
overload release
Standard Motor current
output (guide value) Type Type
P I
kW A A
IEC Type of coordination 1 at Iq = 50 kA/AC 400 V
Normal starting Class 10
1.5 3.6 3.5 ... 5 3RV20 11-1FA10 3RT20 15-1AP00 S00
2.2 4.9 4.5 ... 6.3 3RV20 11-1GA10
3 6.5 5.5 ... 8 3RV20 11-1HA10
4
0.06 0.2 0.14 ... 0.2 3RV20 11-0BA10 3RT20 15-1AP01 S00
0.06 0.2 0.18 ... 0.25 3RV20 11-0CA10
0.09 0.3 0.22 ... 0.32 3RV20 11-0DA10
STARTERS
COMBINATION
0.09 0.3 0.28 ... 0.4 3RV20 11-0EA10
0.12 0.4 0.35 ... 0.5 3RV20 11-0FA10
0.18 0.6 0.45 ... 0.63 3RV20 11-0GA10
0.18 0.6 0.55 ... 0.8 3RV20 11-0HA10
0.25 0.85 0.7 ... 1 3RV20 11-0JA10
0.37 1.1 0.9 ... 1.25 3RV20 11-0KA10
0.55 1.5 1.1 ... 1.6 3RV20 11-0AA10
0.75 1.9 1.4 ... 2 3RV20 11-1BA10
0.75 1.9 1.8 ... 2.5 3RV20 11-1CA10
1.1 2.7 2.2 ... 3.2 3RV20 11-1DA10
1.5 3.6 2.8 ... 4 3RV20 11-1EA10
1) Selection depends on the actual startup 2) Rated control supply voltage 120 V AC. Other
and rated data of the protected motor. voltages are possible.
■ Technical data
Three-phase standard motor1) Setting range Motor starter Contactor2) Size
4-pole at AC 500 V Inverse-time delayed protector
overload release
Standard Motor current
output (guide value) Type Type
P I
kW A A
IEC Type of coordination 1 at Iq = 50 kA/AC 500 V
Normal starting Class 10
On request 3RV2031-4DA10 3RT20 35-1AK60 S2
On request 3RV2031-4EA10 3RT20 35-1AK60
On request 3RV2031-4FA10 3RT20 35-1AK60
On request 3RV2031-4GA10 3RT20 36-1AK60
On request 3RV2031-4HA10 3RT20 36-1AK60
1) Selection depends on the actual startup 2) Rated control supply voltage 120 V AC. Other
and rated data of the protected motor. voltages are possible.
■ Technical data
Three-phase standard motor Setting range Standard Subsequent Contactor1) Size Short-circuit
4-pole at AC 690 V3) MSP IEC circuit-breaker MSP switching capacity Iq
with at 690 V
limiting function
Standard Motor current
output (guide value)
Type Type Type
P I
kW A A kA
4
Installation guidelines for AC 400/500 V
The following distances from earthed components must be observed when installing combinations:
STARTERS
COMBINATION
Motor starter protectors Distances from earthed or Z Z
in combination with contactors live parts
Y
MSP Rated operational Y X24) Z 1L1 3L2 5L3
Contactor voltage mm mm mm
No upstream circuit-breaker 1) Rated control supply voltage 120 V AC. Other 3) Selection depends on the specific startup
required; short-circuit proof up to 100 kA. voltages are possible. and rated data of the protected motor.
2) With these combinations, the distance between 4) Minimum distance to contactor at front.
the subsequent MSP and the contactor must be at For the MSP, no minimum distance
least 10 cm. at the front must be maintained.
3RA2 — up to 100 A
■ Technical data
Installation guidelines for AC 690 V
Size Mounting method Standard surface mounting for sizes S0 Surface mounting for sizes S0
up to 5.5 kW, S2 and S3 from 7.5 to 11 kW
S0 Mounting on an insulated
base plate. If screws are used 3-phase busbar
for fixing, the screws must not Size S0:
be earthed. 3RV29 15-1A
Alternatively, the standard rail
adapter can be used for all Size S2:
units. 3RV19 35-1A
Connection module
See accessories
The following distances from earthed components must be observed when installing combinations:
Two MSPs in combination with contactors Distances from earthed or live components
3RA2 — up to 100 A
■ Technical data
General data
Specifications IEC 60 947-1, EN 60 947-1 (VDE 0660 Part 100)
IEC 60 947-2, EN 60 947-2 (VDE 0660 Part 101)
IEC 60 947-4-1, EN 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102)
Type 3RA2. 1 3RA2. 2 3RA2. 3 3RA2.4
Size S00 S0 S2 S3
Number of poles 3 3 3 3
4
(VDE 0660 Part 102)
Rated fused short-circuit current Iq at 50/60 Hz AC 400 V kA 150 100 50
STARTERS
COMBINATION
acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1, DIN EN 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102)
Types of coordination to IEC 60 947-4-1, EN 60 947-4-1 1)
Power consumption of solenoid coils (with cold coil and Us, 50 Hz)
AC operation closing VA 27 65 190 270
p.f. 0.8 0.82 0.72 0.68
closed VA 4.2 8.5 16 22
p.f. 0.25 0.25 0.37 0.27
DC operation closing = closed W 4 5.9 – 15
Endurance of MSP
Mechanical endurance operating cycles 100 000 Up to 52A: 50 000 50 000
Electrical endurance operating cycles 100 000 from 65A: On request 50 000
Max. switching frequency per hour (motor starts) 1/h 15 15 15
Endurance of contactor
Mechanical endurance operating cycles 30 million 10 million
Electrical endurance operating cycles See endurance curves of contactors in Part 3.
Shock resistance (sine-wave acc. to IEC 60 068 Part 2-27 g up to 6 up to 6 up to 6 up to 6
pulse)
Touch protection on the front acc. to IEC 60529 IP 20 IP 20
Positively driven operation at contactors Yes Yes, from main contact to auxiliary NC contact
1) See selection and ordering data on pages 4/36 to 4/43.
3RA2 — up to 100 A
Technical data
Connection type Screw terminal Screw terminal Screw Terminals Box terminals
M3 Posidrive size 2 M3 Posidrive size 2 M6 Pozidriv size 2 Allen screw
Terminal screw
• Finely stranded with end sleeves (DIN 46 228 T1) mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5) 2) 2 x (1 ... 16)2)
2 x (0.75 ... 2.5) 2)
4
1 x (1 ... 25)2)
2 x (1 ... 25)2)
1 x (1 ... 35)2)
COMBINATION
STARTERS
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 16) 2) 2 x (18 ... 3)2)
AWG 2 x (18 ... 14) 1 x (18 ... 2)2)
AWG 2 x 12 2 x (18 ... 2)2)
1 x (18 ... 1)2)
Attention:
acc. to DIN 43 602
Start command “I”
right-hand or above
1) Cable-lug and busbar connection possible after 2) If two different conductor cross-sections are connected
removing the box terminals. to one clamping point, both cross-sections must lie in the
range specified. If identical cross-sections are used, this
restriction does not apply.
3RA2 — up to 100 A
4
the customer. A time saving is transverse auxiliary contact on IEC Type of coordination 2 the appropriate link module
also achieved with the link the MSP with one changeover together.
There must be no damage to the
STARTERS
COMBINATION
modules as – unlike with con- contact or one NO contact + overload trip or to any other For the order numbers for spe-
ventional wiring systems – there one NC contact. Special auxil- components after a short-circuit cial equipment and link mod-
is no need to rectify possible iary contact blocks that can be has been cleared. The 3RA ules, see the selection and
wiring errors. snapped on from below are combination starter can resume ordering data.
As a combination starter rated available for the contactor. operation without needing to be For the link modules for direct
for tap conductor protection for These two accessories enable be renewed. At most, it is per- starting or reversing mode and
group installation the 3RV the combination starters to be missible to weld the contactor assembly on a standard mount-
MSP is responsible for overload wired easily without having to contacts if they can be dis- ing rail or busbar, see accesso-
and short-circuit protection in route cables via the equipment. connected easily without any ries.
the motor circuit. Back-up pro- The special accessories for significant deformation.
If a MSP with a rotary operating
tective devices, such as fuses 3RA combination starters take mechanism is required for the
or SIEMENS Sentron circuit the form of link modules for lower setting ranges up to 12 A,
breakers are required as per 3RV MSPs and 3RT contactors.
NEC 430-53 guidelines for
■ Mounting the S0 MSP can also be assem-
bled with an S00 contactor. A
group installations for multiple Complete equipment special connecting module is
motor applications available for this purpose.
■ Technical data The 3RA combination starters
The 3RT contactor is ideal for can be ordered as complete For the installation of feeders, it
extremely complex switching For technical data, see pages equipment for direct starting or is imperative to use standard rail
tasks requiring durable compo- 4/56-4/58. Additional details for reversing mode. Control sup- adapters, as from size S2 for
nents. are contained in the respective ply voltages of 50 Hz AC 230 V direct starting and as from size
The permissible ambient tem- tables for the 3RV MSPs and or DC 24 V and assembly on a S0 for reversing, to ensure the
perature is 60 °C with butt- 3RT contactors. 35 mm standard mounting rail or necessary mechanical strength.
mounting and without derating in a 40 or 60 mm busbar system A standard rail adapter is not
(70 °C possible subject to cer- are possible. necessary if a busbar adapter is
tain restrictions). ■ Configuration used.
3RA combination starters are
available for motors up to 75 Hp Overload tripping times Assembly
at 460 V AC and setting ranges All the 3RA combination start- 3RA combination starters are
from 0.14 A to 100 A. ers described here are available for assembly on stand-
3RA combination starters are designed for normal starting, in ard mounting rails in accord-
supplied in four different other words for overload tripping ance with EN 50 022-35 x 15 or
sizes: times of less than 10 s on busbar adapters with a bus-
(CLASS 10). At rated-load oper- bar centre-line spacing of 40 or
Size Overall Max. For
ating temperature the tripping 60 mm and a busbar thickness
width rated three- times are shorter, depending on of 5 or 10 mm.
current phase the particular equipment and the The combination starters are
In max motors setting range. The exact values also suitable for screw fixing.
up to can be derived from the tripping
mm A HP characteristics of the MSPs. Size S00
S00 and
and S0
S0 can
can be
be
screwed on with
with the
the aid
aid of plug-
plug-
S00 45 8 5 in
in clips (see accessories
clips (see accessorieson on
S0 45 22 15 page 4/47).
page 4/47).
S2 55 50 40
S3 70 100 75
1 1 1 1 2 push-in lugs
3RV2928-0B
(only for screw fixing)
2 Motor starter protector
Size S00/S0
3 Screw terminals
2 2
3 Motor starter protector
Size S00/S0
Spring-type terminals
4 Link module
(Screw terminals)
3RA1921-1DA00 (for S00)
3RA2921-1AA00 (for S0, AC contactor)
3RA2921-1BA00 (for S0, DC contactor)
5 Link module
(Spring-type terminals)
4 5 3RA2911-2AA00 for S00
6 3RA2921-2AA00 for S0
4
6 Link module
(Hybrid)
3RA2911-2FA00 for S00
COMBINATION
STARTERS
3RA2921-2FA00 for S0
7 Contactor
IC10_08_03.fm Page 9 Thursday, May 24, 2018 10:33 PM Size S00/S0
8 8
7 Screw terminals
8 Contactor
IC01_00636
Size S00/S0
Spring-type terminals
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA2 Load Feeders
8
Left: 3RA21 load feeder with screw terminals
Center: 3RA21 load feeder with spring-type terminals
Right: Motor starter protector combination with screw terminals, with contactor with spring-type terminals General data
Direct-on-line starting • For standard rail mounting • Up to Size S3
1 1 1 2 push-in lugs
2 3RV2928-0B
3
(only Motor starter protector
for screw 1fixing)
Size S3
2 Motor starter protector
Screw terminals
3 Size S00/S0
2 Screw terminals2 Standard mounting rail adapter
3RA1942-1AA00
1 1 3 Motor starter protector
3 Mounting plate
Size S00/S0
4 Link module
Screw terminals/spring-type terminals
3RA1941-1AA00
4 Link module
3RA2921-1BA00 (Screw Screw terminals)
terminals
5 Contactor
5 Link module
3RA2921-1BA00 forSize S3 and screw terminals
S00/S0
3RA2911-2GA00 forScrew
S00 terminals
and spring-type terminals
3RA2921-2GA00 6 for
SoftS0starter
and spring-type terminals
4 Size S3
5 6 Solid-state switching device (Screw terminals)
Screw terminals
4 4
7 Soft starter
Size S00/S0
Screw terminals/spring-type terminals
5 6
6
IC01_00655a
7
IC01_00637
Load feeder for direct-on-line starting and standard rail mounting in size S3 (the version with screw terminals is shown in the picture)
8
Left: Motor starter protector combination with solid-state switching device with screw terminals
Right: Motor starter protector combination with soft starter with spring-type terminals
4/60 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog
8
3RA2 — up to 100 A
1 2 1 60 mm busbar adapter
for screw terminals
8US1251-5DS10 for S00
8US1251-5NT10 for S0
2 60 mm busbar adapter
for spring-type terminals
8US1251-5DT11 for S00
8US1251-5NT11 for S0
3 4
3 Motor starter protector
Size S00/S0
Screw terminals
4 Motor starter protector
Size S00/S0
Spring-type terminals
5 Link module
Screw terminals
3RA1921-1DA00 for S00
3RA2921-1AA00 for S0, AC contactor
3RA2921-1BA00 for S0, DC contactor
IC01_00639
5
6
4
6 Link module
3RA2911-2AA00 for S00
3RA2921-2AA00 for S0
STARTERS
COMBINATION
IC10_08_03.fm Page 10 T hursday, May 24, 2018 10:33 PM (additional 3RA2911-1CA00 spacer
for height compensation on AC contactors
size S0 with spring-type terminals)
8
7
7 Contactor
Size S00/S0
Screw terminals
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control 8Cabinet
Contactor
SIRIUS 3RA2 Load Feeders Size S00/S0
Spring-type terminals
General
Left: dataload feeder for direct-on-line starting with busbar adapter with screw terminals
3RA21
Right: 3RA21 load feeder for direct-on-line starting with busbar adapter with spring-type terminals
Direct-on-line starting • For 60 mm busbar systems • Size S2
4
8
3RA21 load feeder for direct-on-line starting with busbar adapter with screw terminals
1 1 1 Push-in lug
3RV2928-0B
(only for screw fixing)
2 Motor starter protector
3 Size S00/S0
2
Screw terminal
3 Motor starter protector
Size S00/S0
Spring-type terminal
4 Link module
Screw terminal
3RA1921-1DA00 for S00
3RA2921-1AA00 for S0, AC contactor
3RA2921-1BA00 for S0, DC contactor
5 Link module
Spring-type terminal
4 5 3RA2911-2AA00 for S00
3RA2921-2AA00 for S0
6 Contactor
4
Size S00/S0
Screw terminal
COMBINATION
STARTERS
7 Contactor
Size S00/S0
e Spring-type terminal
6 a
6 7
c
7
g
d
IC01_00641
8
h
b f
Left: 3RA22 load feeder with screw terminals with push-in lugs with two contactors for reversing duty and 3RA2913-2AA1 wiring kit for
connection of the contactors (incl. mechanical interlocking and connecting clips)
Right: 3RA22 load feeder with spring-type terminals with push-in lugs with two contactors for reversing duty and 3RA2913-2AA2 wiring kit
(incl. mechanical interlocking and connecting clips)
2
2 RH assembly kit for reversing duty and
standard rail mounting in size S0
Screw terminals
3RA2923-1BB1
Spring-type terminals
1)
3RA2923-1BB2
1 Comprising:
• Wiring kit for the
main and auxiliary circuits
• Two standard mounting rail adapters
• Two connecting wedges
• Mechanical interlock
• Two connecting clips
• Fixing accessories
4
Screw terminals/spring-type terminals
2 Standard mounting rail adapters
3RA2922-1AA00
STARTERS
COMBINATION
with two connecting wedges
8US1998-1AA00
3 Link module
a Screw terminals:
3RA2921-1AA00 for S0, AC contactor
4 3RA2921-1BA00 for S0, DC contactor
4 Spring-type terminals:
c 3RA2921-2AA00
2)
4 Contactor
Size S0
IC01_00642
8
3RA22 load feeder for reversing duty and standard rail mounting in size S0
(the version with screw terminals is shown in the picture)
RH assembly kits for reversing duty and standard rail mounting
in size S0, see page 8/51.
3RA2933-1BB1
Comprising:
• Wiring kit for the
main and auxiliary circuits
• Two standard mounting rail adapters
1
• Two side modules
• Four connecting wedges
• Mechanical interlock
• Two connectors for two contactors
• Fixing accessories
3RA2932-1AA00
with two side modules
3 3RA1902-1B
COMBINATION
STARTERS
8
3RA2933-2AA1
a Upper wiring module
b Lower wiring module
c Two connectors for two contactors
d Mechanical interlock
3RA2934-2B (not part of the wiring
kit, must be ordered separately)
Load feeder for reversing duty and standard rail mounting in size S2
(the version with screw terminals is shown in the picture)
RH assembly kits for reversing duty and standard rail mounting
in size S2, see page 8/51.
4
3RA1902-1B
and four connecting wedges
STARTERS
COMBINATION
8US1998-1AA00
3 Link module
a 3RA1941-1AA00
4 Contactor
4 size S3
c
4
d Wiring kit
Screw terminals
3RA2943-2AA1
a Upper wiring module
b Lower wiring module
8
Load feeder for reversing duty and standard rail mounting in size S3
(the version with screw terminals is shown in the picture)
RH assembly kits for reversing duty and standard rail mounting
in size S3, see page 8/51.
Screw terminals
3RA2913-1DB1 for S00
3RA2923-1DB1 for S0
Spring-type terminals
3RA2913-1DB2 for S00
1 3RA2923-1DB2 for S0 1)
Comprising:
• Wiring kit for the
main and auxiliary circuits
• Busbar adapter
• Device holder
• Two connecting wedges
• Mechanical interlock
• Two connecting clips for two contactors
• Fixing accessories
4
8
Screw terminals
8US1251-5DS10 for S00/S0
IC01_00644
8US1251-5NT10 for S0
d Wiring kit
Screw terminals Spring-type terminals
3RA2913-2AA1 for S00 8US1251-5DT11 for S00/S0
3RA2923-2AA1 for S0 8US1251-5NT11 for S0
Spring-type terminals 2 connecting wedges
3RA2913-2AA2 for S00 8US1998-1AA00
3RA2923-2AA2 for S0 60 mm device holder
b a Upper wiring module 8US1250-5AS10 or
8US1250-5AT10
b Lower wiring module (according to left adapter)
c Two connecting clips for two contactors 4 Contactor
Mechanical interlock Size S00/S0
d (can be removed if necessary) Screw terminals/spring-type terminals
4
3RA2931-1AA00
Screw terminals
STARTERS
COMBINATION
3 4 Contactor
Size S2
Screw terminals
Wiring kit
For screw terminals
3RA2933-2AA1
a Upper wiring module
b Lower wiring module
c Two connecting pins for two contactors
a
d Mechanical interlock
8
3RA2 — up to 100 A
MSP
3RV204
2 Brackets
COMBINATION
STARTERS
2 Contactors FBS0070B
3RT204
Circuit diagrams
Direct-on-line starting
Size S00: 3RA21.1 Sizes S0, S2 and S3: 3RA21 2, 3RA21 3
Reversing duty
Size S00: 3RA22 Size S0: 3RA22
3RA2 — up to 100 A
■ Dimension drawings
Size S00 · for standard rail mounting
4
S0 direct-on-line starter, S0/S0 and S00/S0 reversing starters,
AC, screw-type connection system AC, screw-type connection system
STARTERS
COMBINATION
3RA2120-..A 3RA2220-..B..-0AP0
S0/S0 and S00/S0 direct-on-line starters, S0/S0 and S00/S0 reversing starters,
AC, screw-type connection system AC, screw-type connection system
3RA2120-..D..-0AP0 3RA2220-..D..-0AP0
When mounting
When mountingthe
thecombinations,
combinations,observe
observe the
the installation
installation guidelines
guidelines (page
(page 4/60-4/61).
4/60-4/61).
3RA2 — up to 50 A
■ Dimension drawings
Size S0 · for standard rail mounting
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION
S0/S0 and S00/S0 direct-on-line starters, AC, S0/S0 and S00/S0 reversing starters,
screw-type connection system AC, screw-type connection system
3RA2120-..D..-0AP0 3RA2220-..D..-0AP0
When mounting the combinations, observe the installation guidelines (page 4/60-4/61).
When mounting the combinations, observe the installation guidelines (page 4/60-4/61).
3RA2 — up to 50 A
■ Dimension drawings
Size S2 · for standard rail mounting
Direct-on-line starting Reversing duty
4
1) Alternative fixing methods
STARTERS
COMBINATION
a) 2 35 mm mounting rails
acc. to DIN EN 50 022
Spacing: 125 mm
Depth: 7.5 or 15 mm.
b) 1 75 mm mounting rail
acc. to DIN EN 50 023.
1) Busbar adapter
suitable for rail thicknesses
of 5 and 10 mm
with chamfered edges.
When
When mounting thecombinations,
mounting the combinations,observe
observethe
the installation
installation guidelines
guidelines (page
(page 4/60-4/61).
4/58).
3RA2 — up to 100 A
■ Dimension drawings
Size S3 · for standard rail mounting
Direct-on-line starting
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION
Reversing duty
When
When mounting
mountingthe
thecombinations,
combinations,observe thethe
observe installation guidelines
installation (page
guidelines 4/60guidelines
(page and 4/64).4/60-4/64).
Product overview
3RE4 Enclosed IEC motor controllers
are well suited for both industrial and
commercial applications. They are durable
and dependable, particularly when it
comes to motor protection. Protecting the
performance of motors is a critical priority
and the 3RE4 enclosed starters are offered
with either thermal or solid-state overload
relays to maximize your motor protection.
4
Controller Features
STARTERS
COMBINATION
General Contactor
n UL motor horsepower rated n Horsepower rated per UL
n From fractional up to 60 Hp at 575 V n High contact reliability
n Non-combination type starters and contactors n NO and NC auxiliary contacts included as standard
n Reversing and non-reversing controllers n Permanently secured with screws on mounting panel
n Single phase and 3-phase loads n Screw type terminal connections
n Thermal and solid-state overload relays
n NEMA Type enclosures 1, 3/3R/4/12 and 4X 304 stainless steel
n Standard size and extra larger enclosures
n RoHS compliant
n Standards: UL 60947-4-1
n Certifications: cULus
Controller Type
11 = Non-combination non-reversing starter,1-phase, 2-pole
12 = Non-combination non-reversing starter,3-phase, 3-pole
14 = Non-combination reversing starter, 3-phase, 3-pole
16 = Non-combination non-reversing contactor
18 = Non-combination reversing contactor
26 = S0: 1-Ph Hp (2@115V, 3@208V, 3@230V), 3-Ph Hp (7.5@208V, 7.5@230V, 15@460V, 20@575V)
27 = S0: 1-Ph Hp (2@115V, 5@208V, 5@230V), 3-Ph Hp (10@208V, 10@230V, 20@460V, 25@575V)
COMBINATION
STARTERS
28 = S0: 1-Ph Hp (3@115V, 5@208V, 5@230V), 3-Ph Hp (10@208V, 10@230V, 25@460V, 25@575V)
35 = S2: 1-Ph Hp (3@115V, 5@208V, 7.5@230V), 3-Ph Hp (10@208V, 15@230V, 30@460V, 40@575V)
36 = S2: 1-Ph Hp (3@115V, 7.5@208V, 10@230V), 3-Ph Hp (15@208V, 15@230V, 40@460V, 50@575V)
37 = S2: 1-Ph Hp (5@115V, 10@208V, 10@230V), 3-Ph Hp (20@208V, 20@230V, 50@460V, 50@575V)
38 = S2: 1-Ph Hp (5@115V, 10@208V, 15@230V), 3-Ph Hp (20@208V, 25@230V, 50@460V, 60@575V)
Disconnect Type
A = None
Special
Y0 = (none)
Factory modifications (See selection starting on page 4/47.)
Non-Reversing Starter, 3-Phase, 3-Pole, Thermal or Solid-State Overload Relay, Standard Enclosure
4
NEMA Type Enclosure (Standard Size)
STARTERS
COMBINATION
3-Phase Motor Hp Rating per UL Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary
Indoor only Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame Contactor
208 V 230 V 460 V 575 V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size (for ref. only)
1.5 2 3 5 3RE4121–5AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4121–5CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4121–5EA●–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2015
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4121–7AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4121–7CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4121–7EA●–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2017
2 3 5 7.5 3RE4122–3AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–3CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–3EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2023
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4122–4AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–4CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–4EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2024
5 5 10 15 3RE4122–5AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–5CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–5EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2025
7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4122–6AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–6CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–6EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2026
10 10 20 25 3RE4122–7AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–7CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–7EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2027
10 10 25 25 3RE4122–8AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–8CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–8EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2028
10 15 30 40 3RE4123–5AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–5CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–5EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2035
15 15 40 50 3RE4123–6AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–6CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–6EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2036
20 20 50 50 3RE4123–7AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–7CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–7EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2037
20 25 50 60 3RE4123–8AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–8CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–8EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2038
Thermal overload relay Class 10 = 1 1 1
Solid-state overload relay selectable Class = 5 5 5
Non-Reversing Starter, 3-Phase, 3-Pole, Thermal or Solid-State Overload Relay, Large Enclosure
NEMA Type Enclosure (Large Size)
Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
3-Phase Motor Hp Rating per UL General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary
Indoor only Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame Contactor
208 V 230 V 460 V 575 V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size (for ref. only)
1.5 2 3 5 3RE4121–5BA●–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2015
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4121–7BA●–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2017
2 3 5 7.5 3RE4122–3BA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2023
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4122–4BA●–♦♦Y0 Not applicable — Standard enclosure includes 1 1 S0 3RT2024
5 5 10 15 3RE4122–5BA●–♦♦Y0 extra mounting space for accessories. 1 1 S0 3RT2025
7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4122–6BA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2026
10 10 20 25 3RE4122–7BA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2027
10 10 25 25 3RE4122–8BA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2028
Thermal overload relay Class 10 = 1
Solid-state overload relay selectable Class = 5
a For 3-phase controllers, 208 - 600 V coils will be wired secondary (if ordered). For single phase controllers, power transformer secondary (if ordered). 277 - 600 V
for incoming voltage. 24 and120 V coils will be wired 120 and 240 V coils will be wired for incoming voltage. coils do not apply.
as separate source or control power transformer 24 V coils will be wired as separate source or control
Non-Reversing Starter, Single Phase, 2-Pole, Thermal Overload Relay, Standard Enclosure
4
Rating per UL Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary
Indoor only Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame Contactor
115 V 208 V 230 V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size (for ref. only)
0.25 0.5 0.75 3RE4111–5AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4111–5CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4111–5EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2015
0.5 1.5 2 3RE4111–7AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4111–7CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4111–7EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2017
1 1 1 3RE4112–3AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–3CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–3EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2023
1 2 2 3RE4112–4AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–4CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–4EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2024
1 2 3 3RE4112–5AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–5CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–5EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2025
2 3 3 3RE4112–6AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–6CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–6EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2026
2 5 5 3RE4112–7AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–7CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–7EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2027
3 5 5 3RE4112–8AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–8CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–8EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2028
3 5 7.5 3RE4113–5AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–5CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–5EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2035
3 7 10 3RE4113–6AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–6CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–6EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2036
5 10 10 3RE4113–7AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–7CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–7EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2037
5 10 15 3RE4113–8AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–8CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–8EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2038
Non-Reversing Starter, Single Phase, 2-Pole, Thermal Overload Relay, Large Enclosure
NEMA Type Enclosure (Large Size)
1-Phase Motor Hp
Rating per UL Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary
Indoor only Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame Contactor
115 V 208 V 230 V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size (for ref. only)
0.25 0.5 0.75 3RE4111–5BA●1–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2015
0.5 1.5 2 3RE4111–7BA●1–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2017
1 1 1 3RE4112–3BA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2023
1 2 2 3RE4112–4BA●1–♦♦Y0 Not applicable — Standard enclosure includes 1 1 S0 3RT2024
1 2 3 3RE4112–5BA●1–♦♦Y0 extra mounting space for accessories. 1 1 S0 3RT2025
2 3 3 3RE4112–6BA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2026
2 5 5 3RE4112–7BA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2027
3 5 5 3RE4112–8BA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2028
a For 3-phase controllers, 208 - 600 V coils will be wired secondary (if ordered). For single phase controllers, power transformer secondary (if ordered). 277 - 600 V
for incoming voltage. 24 and120 V coils will be wired 120 and 240 V coils will be wired for incoming voltage. coils do not apply.
as separate source or control power transformer 24 V coils will be wired as separate source or control
Reversing Starter, 3-Phase, 3-Pole, Thermal or Solid-State Overload Relay, Standard Enclosure
4
NEMA Type Enclosure (Standard Size)
STARTERS
COMBINATION
3-Phase Motor Hp Rating per UL Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary
Indoor only Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame Contactor
208 V 230 V 460 V 575 V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size (for ref. only)
1.5 2 3 5 3RE4141–5AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4141–5CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4141–5EA●–♦♦Y0 2 2 S00 3RA2315
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4141–7AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4141–7CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4141–7EA●–♦♦Y0 2 2 S00 3RA2317
2 3 5 7.5 3RE4142–3AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–3CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–3EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2323
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4142–4AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–4CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–4EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2324
5 5 10 15 3RE4142–5AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–5CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–5EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2325
7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4142–6AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–6CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–6EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2326
10 10 20 25 3RE4142–7AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–7CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–7EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2327
10 10 25 25 3RE4142–8AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–8CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–8EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2328
10 15 30 40 3RE4143–5AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–5CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–5EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S2 3RA2335
15 15 40 50 3RE4143–6AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–6CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–6EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S2 3RA2336
20 20 50 50 3RE4143–7AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–7CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–7EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S2 3RA2337
20 25 50 60 3RE4143–8AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–8CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–8EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S2 3RA2338
Thermal overload relay Class 10 = 1 1 1
Solid-state overload relay selectable Class = 5 5 5
Reversing Starter, 3-Phase, 3-Pole, Thermal or Solid-State Overload Relay, Large Enclosure
NEMA Type Enclosure (Large Size)
Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
3-Phase Motor Hp Rating per UL General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary
Indoor only Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame Contactor
208 V 230 V 460 V 575 V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size (for ref. only)
1.5 2 3 5 3RE4141–5BA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S00 3RA2315
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4141–7BA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S00 3RA2317
2 3 5 7.5 3RE4142–3BA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2323
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4142–4BA●–♦♦Y0 Not applicable — Standard enclosure includes 2 0 S0 3RA2324
5 5 10 15 3RE4142–5BA●–♦♦Y0 extra mounting space for accessories. 2 0 S0 3RA2325
7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4142–6BA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2326
10 10 20 25 3RE4142–7BA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2327
10 10 25 25 3RE4142–8BA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2328
Thermal overload relay Class 10 = 1
Solid-state overload relay selectable Class = 5
a For 3-phase controllers, 208 - 600 V coils will be wired secondary (if ordered). For single phase controllers, power transformer secondary (if ordered). 277 - 600 V
for incoming voltage. 24 and120 V coils will be wired 120 and 240 V coils will be wired for incoming voltage. coils do not apply.
as separate source or control power transformer 24 V coils will be wired as separate source or control
Non-Reversing Contactor, 3-Pole (for both 1-Phase and 3-Phase), Standard Enclosure
4
Non-Reversing Contactor, 3-Pole (for both 1-Phase and 3-Phase), Large Enclosure
NEMA Type Enclosure (Large Size)
1-Phase Motor Hp 3-Phase Motor Hp Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
Rating per UL Rating per UL General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary Contactor
Indoor only Watertight, Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame (for ref.
115V 208V 230V 208V 230V 460V 575V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size only)
0.25 0.5 0.75 1.5 2 3 5 3RE4161–5BA●0–0YY0 1 0 S00 3RT2015
0.5 1.5 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4161–7BA●0–0YY0 1 0 S00 3RT2017
1 1 1 2 3 5 7.5 3RE4162–3BA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2023
1 2 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4162–4BA●0–0YY0 Not applicable — Standard enclosure includes 1 1 S0 3RT2024
1 2 3 5 5 10 15 3RE4162–5BA●0–0YY0 extra mounting space for accessories. 1 1 S0 3RT2025
2 3 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4162–6BA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2026
2 5 5 10 10 20 25 3RE4162–7BA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2027
3 5 5 10 10 25 25 3RE4162–8BA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2028
a For 3-phase controllers, 208 - 600 V coils will be wired secondary (if ordered). For single phase controllers, power transformer secondary (if ordered). 277 - 600 V
for incoming voltage. 24 and120 V coils will be wired 120 and 240 V coils will be wired for incoming voltage. coils do not apply.
as separate source or control power transformer 24 V coils will be wired as separate source or control
Reversing Contactor, 3-Pole (for both 1-Phase and 3-Phase), Standard Enclosure
4
NEMA Type Enclosure (Standard Size)
1-Phase 3-Phase
Motor Hp Motor Hp Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
STARTERS
COMBINATION
Rating per UL Rating per UL General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary Contactor
Indoor only Watertight, Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame (for ref.
115V 230V 208V 230V 460V 575V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size only)
0.25 0.75 1.5 2 3 5 3RE4181–5AA●0–0YY0 3RE4181–5CA●0–0YY0 3RE4181–5EA●0–0YY0 2 2 S00 3RA2315
0.5 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4181–7AA●0–0YY0 3RE4181–7CA●0–0YY0 3RE4181–7EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S00 3RA2317
1 1 2 3 5 7.5 3RE4182–3AA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–3CA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–3EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2323
1 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4182–4AA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–4CA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–4EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2324
1 3 5 5 10 15 3RE4182–5AA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–5CA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–5EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2325
2 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4182–6AA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–6CA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–6EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2326
2 5 10 10 20 25 3RE4182–7AA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–7CA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–7EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2327
3 5 10 10 25 25 3RE4182–8AA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–8CA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–8EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2328
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 3RE4183–5AA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–5CA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–5EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S2 3RA2335
3 10 15 15 40 50 3RE4183–6AA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–6CA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–6EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S2 3RA2336
5 10 20 20 50 50 3RE4183–7AA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–7CA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–7EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S2 3RA2337
5 15 20 25 50 60 3RE4183–8AA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–8CA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–8EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S2 3RA2338
Reversing Contactor, 3-Pole (for both 1-Phase and 3-Phase), Large Enclosure
1-Phase 3-Phase NEMA Type Enclosure (Large Size)
Motor Hp Motor Hp Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
Rating per UL Rating per UL General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary Contactor
Indoor only Watertight, Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame (for ref.
115V 230V 208V 230V 460V 575V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size only)
0.25 0.75 1.5 2 3 5 3RE4181–5BA●0–0YY0 2 0 S00 3RA2315
0.5 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4181–7BA●0–0YY0 2 0 S00 3RA2317
1 1 2 3 5 7.5 3RE4182–3BA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2323
1 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4182–4BA●0–0YY0 Not applicable — Standard enclosure includes 2 0 S0 3RA2324
1 3 5 5 10 15 3RE4182–5BA●0–0YY0 extra mounting space for accessories. 2 0 S0 3RA2325
2 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4182–6BA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2326
2 5 10 10 20 25 3RE4182–7BA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2327
3 5 10 10 25 25 3RE4182–8BA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2328
a For 3-phase controllers, 208 - 600 V coils will be wired secondary (if ordered). For single phase controllers, power transformer secondary (if ordered). 277 - 600 V
for incoming voltage. 24 and120 V coils will be wired 120 and 240 V coils will be wired for incoming voltage. coils do not apply.
as separate source or control power transformer 24 V coils will be wired as separate source or control
Thermal Solid-State
Overload Relay Overload Relay
Thermal Overload Relays, Trip Class 10, Single and Three Phase
Features and technical characteristics:
4
n Phase failure sensitivity n Manual and automatic RESET (selectable) n STOP button
n Includes NC trip contact and NO n Switch position indicator n Sealable cover (optional)
COMBINATION
STARTERS
Solid-State Overload Relays, Selectable Trip Class 5, 10, 20 and 30, Three Phase Only
Features and technical characteristics:
n Overload, phase failure and unbalance n Includes NC trip contact and NO alarm n Switch position indicator
protection contact n TEST function and self-monitoring
n Internal ground fault detection (selectable) n Manual and automatic RESET (selectable) n Sealable cover (optional)
n Internal power supply n Electrical remote RESET integrated n Screw-type terminals
Selection Information
These tables apply to 3RE4 products.
Replace the last two characters of the
3RE4 catalog number (Y0), with a code selected
from the tables below.
4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V B6 1 and 2
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light B7 1 and 2
STARTERS
COMBINATION
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light B8 1 and 2
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V C0 1 and 2
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light C1 1 and 2
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light C2 1 and 2
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V C3 1 and 3
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light C4 1 and 3
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light C5 1 and 3
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V C6 1, 2 and 4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light C7 1, 2 and 4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light C8 1, 2 and 4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V D0 1, 3 and 4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light D1 1, 3 and 4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light D2 1, 3 and 4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 600:120V, Red On Pilot Light P0 1, 2 and 4
Restrictions:
1. Valid only with non-reversing controllers.
2. Valid only with 120 V coil.
a ACPT in a NEMA type 1 enclosure with a size S00 or S0 controller 3. Valid only with 24 VAC coil.
requires a large size enclosure. A CPT in a NEMA type 1 enclosure
with a size S2 controller requires a standard size enclosure. 4. Not valid with single-phase controllers.
All other enclosure types may be standard size. 5. Not valid in NEMA Type 1 enclosures.
Selection Information
These tables apply to 3RE4 products.
Replace the last two characters of the
3RE4 catalog number (Y0), with a code selected
from the tables below.
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light G4 1 and 3
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light G5 1 and 3
COMBINATION
STARTERS
Restrictions:
1. Valid only with non-reversing controllers.
a ACPT in a NEMA type 1 enclosure with a size S00 or S0 controller
2. Valid only with 120 V coil.
requires a large size enclosure. A CPT in a NEMA type 1 enclosure 3. Valid only with 24 VAC coil.
with a size S2 controller requires a standard size enclosure.
All other enclosure types may be standard size. 4. Not valid with single-phase controllers.
Selection Information
These tables apply to 3RE4 products.
Replace the last two characters of the
3RE4 catalog number (Y0), with a code selected
from the tables below.
4
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light M1 2
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light M2 2
STARTERS
COMBINATION
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V M3 1
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light M4 1
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light M5 1
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V M6 2
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light M7 2
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light M8 2
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V N0 1 and 3
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light N1 1 and 3
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light N2 1 and 3
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V N3 2 and 3
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light N4 2 and 3
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light N5 2 and 3
Restrictions:
1. Valid only with 120 V coil.
2. Valid only with 24 VAC coil.
a ACPT in a NEMA type 1 enclosure with a size S00 or S0 controller
3. Not valid with single-phase controllers.
requires a large size enclosure. A CPT in a NEMA type 1 enclosure
with a size S2 controller requires a standard size enclosure.
All other enclosure types may be standard size.
Pilot Devices
Enclosure Catalog
Devicea NEMA Type Number
1 49SDPB5
Start-Stop Push Buttons,
momentaryb
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 49SDP05
1 NA
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons,
momentaryb
49SDPB5 49SDSBJ 49SDSB4 3/3R/4/12 & 4X 49SDP02
1 49SDSBJ
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 49SDS01
1 49SDSBJ
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch
2-Position Selector Switch 3-Position Selector Switch 49SDS02
COMBINATION
STARTERS
3/3R/4/12 & 4X
Pilot Lights
Enclosure Catalog
Devicea NEMA Type Voltage Number
Auxiliary Contacts
Device Frame Size Catalog Number
1 NO & 1 NC laterally mounted, S00 3RH2911-1DA11
screw terminals S0 and S2 3RH2921-1DA11
2 NO laterally mounted, S00 NA
screw terminals S0 and S2 3RH2921-1DA20
2 NC laterally mounted, S00 3RH2911-1DA02
screw terminals S0 and S2 3RH2921-1DA02
a 3SU 22 mm devices. Pilot lights include LED bulbs. c To use as an OFF indicator, the contactor must have a d To use as an overload relay (OLR) trip indicator, the
b Each contactor must have a normally open (NO) normally closed (NC) auxiliary contact available for the OLR must have a normally open (NO) auxiliary contact
auxiliary contact available for seal-in circuit. Order circuit. Order separately as needed. available for the circuit.
separately as needed.
4
Control relay, 2 NO / 2 NC 3RH2122-1●●●0 110/120 VAC 50/60 Hz AK6
ON-delay timer, 0.05 sec. – 100 hr., 24 – 240V AC/DC 3RP2525-1BW30 208 VAC 50/60 Hz AM2
STARTERS
COMBINATION
OFF-delay timer, 0.05 sec. – 100 hr., 24 – 240V AC/DC 3RP2535-1AW30 220/240 VAC 50/60 Hz AP6
277 VAC 60 Hz —
Replace ●●● with code from Coil Voltage Table. 480 VAC 60 Hz AV6
Relays and timers include screw terminals.
Relay Timer 600 VAC 60 Hz —
Miscellaneous
2-pole fuse block for control circuit, 600V / 30A, DIN rail mounted, CC fuses (not included) 3NW7523-0HG
Terminal block, 1-point unwired, DIN rail mounted, 6mm, 26Ab 8WA10111DF11
3NW7513-0HG 8WA1808
End retainer for DIN railb 8WA1808
DIN rail kit, 35mm x 5 in, for mounting optional accessoriesa MTR5
75D28182001 MTR5 Sealable cover for rotary dial on overload relay (10 per package) 3RV29 08-0P
Replacement Parts
Enclosure Kits
Type 1 Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 S.S.
Controller Frame Size & Type
NR = Non-Reversing Standard Size Large Sizee Standard Sizef Standard Sizef
R = Reversing Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
S00 NR, S0 NR 49EC14EB110705R 49EC14GB140807Rc 49EFN121006XRX 49EFW121006XRX
S00 R, S0 R 49EC14GB140807Rc 49EC14IB201208Rd 49EFN121006XRX 49EFW121006XRX
S2 NR, S2 R 49EC14IB201208Rdf — 49EFN141208XRX 49EFW141208XRX
a The accessory in a NEMA type 1 enclosure requires a c Enclosure 49EC14GB140807R requires mounting adaptor e These large enclosures are required for certain
large size enclosure. All other enclosure types may be plate 49EFA070500XXA which is sold seperately. accessories as indicated in the Field Modification pages.
standard size. d Enclosure 49EC14IB201208R requires mounting adaptor f These standard size enclosures include extra mounting
b Requires DIN rail kit or equivalent. plate 49EFA060800XXA which is sold seperately. space for accessories.
A D
C
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION
Figure 1 Figure 2
4
STARTERS
COMBINATION
4
STARTERS
COMBINATION
contents
Fast Bus busbar adapter system
5 Section
60 mm system Page
Selection and ordering data
• Busbar holders 5/9
5
• Fast Bus adapter shoes 5/11
• Incoming supply terminals 5/6
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
• Copper busbar 5/6
• Busbar covers 5/6
• Other accessories 5/6
Overview 5/2
Introduction 5/3
Technical Data 5/3
Dimension drawings 5/10-5/15
FBCB Fast Bus main and feeder 3RA2 Fast Bus combinations starters
circuit breakers Page 3RA6 Fast Bus compact starters
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• Fast Bus circuit breakers assemblies and kits 5/7 • See Section 4
• Fast Bus adapter shoes for VL breakers 5/8
(Section was last modified on 08/23/21) Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/1
Fast Bus
5
double set of lugs.
—Circuit breakers, 15A to 500A
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
If load exceeds 500A, the CB must be
separately panel mounted and fed to
a main lug infeed module.
3) Select 3RV MSP & 3RT contactor
components and appropriate adapter
shoe or select preassembled 3RA
starters. See section 4.
4) Select appropriate length busbar,
busbar holders, insulation covers
and any other required components.
5
3RV202 S0 3.5-12.5 the FUSE selection CIRCUIT BREAKER 65kA — 30kA
3RV202 S0 3.5-25 procedure listed below. selection procedure 65kA 65kA —
3RV202 S0 28-32 listed below. 65kA 50kA —
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
3RV202 S0 36-40 65kA 12kA —
3RV203 S2 11-50 65kA 65kA 25kA
3RV204 S3 28-100 65kA 65kA 30kA
1) Branch Circuit Protective Device for 480V-Ratings: The appropriate BCPD need to be determined in accordance with the National Electrical Code, Article 430-53 and the
application. The following devices are permitted:
Fuses: Classes RK1, RK5, J, G, T, CC or Circuit breakers: Listed Siemens type, with a marked short-circuit rating equal or larger than the available short-circuit
current rating. These devices were tested for group installation use at the above levels without any upstream branch circuit device.
2) 3RA2 used as Manual Motor Controller; Branch Circuit Protective Device for 600V-Ratings: Max. Class J 50A
3) Starter sizes S00,S0 and S3 require additional type E line side terminal adaptors on the MSP for type F applications. See section 1 accessories
End cover
Busbar holder
Insulating Base Plate
End cover
Busbar 3-phase Ground
Busbar Neuteral or PE Busbar Neuteral or PE Terminals for Round busbar
Ground busbar holder Conductors holder
Terminals for Round
Conductors
5/6 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Fast Bus
5
Design UL Current Rating Breaker Frame (SCCR Rating 1))
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
Sentron and GG Feeder Circuit Breakers ED (25kA) HHED (65kA) FXD (35kA)
FBCB250M
1) UL Short Circuit Current ratings are based on 480V. Contact Siemens for 600 V ratings.
2) FBCB100M -125M SCCR = 25kA @ 480V
FBCB150M -250M SCCR = 65kA @ 480V
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/7
Fast Bus
8US21 60-5AM00 Direct start load 1 50 8 245 55 600 yes 8US12 61-5FP08 0.292
feeders
POWER DISTRIBUTION
SYSTEMS
Reversing feeders
Busbar adapters 1 50 8 242 55 600 yes 8US12 61-5FP08 0.292
Busbar adapters 1 -- -- 242 55 600 yes 8US12 60-5AM00 0.202
+ Device holders -- -- -- 242 55 600 yes 8US12 60-5AP00 0.243
+ Connecting -- -- -- -- -- -- yes 8US19 98-1AA00 100 units 0.100
plates
Size S3 80 4 215 72 600 yes 8US12 11-4TR00 4) 0.659
1 100 -- 200 72 600 yes FBS100723R 0.590
-- 100 -- 200 72 600 yes FBS100722 0.610
8US12 11-4TR00
Product scheduled
For VL UL circuit breakers 2)
VL150 UL, -- 150 Tubular 190 105 600 yes 8US12 13-4AQ03 1.020
DG frame con-
tacts
VL250 UL, -- 250 Tubular 190 105 600 yes 8US12 13-4AQ03 1.020
FG frame con-
for obsolescence
tacts
VL400 UL, -- 400 Tubular 296 140 600 yes 8US12 13-4AH00 1.900
8US12 13-4AQ03 JG frame con-
VL400X UL, tacts
LG frame -- 540 3) 296 140 600 yes 8US12 13-4AH00 1.900
con-
Fall 2022
Tubular tacts
8US12 13-4AH00
1) UL508A labeled panels require the use of components that meet the creepage and air distances of 1” air clearance and 2” creepage distance.
N/A = not applicable for given item.
2) For use with 10mm x 30mm and twin T (TT) busbars only. Adaptors can be configured for main or feeder breakers applications.
3) Foruse with maximum 500A circuit breaker. Circuit breakers greater than 500A must be panel mounted off the busbar system and fed to the busbars
via an infeed module. See page 5/6.
4) Rated 100A @ 480V. Rated 100A @ 600V with Class J Fuses.
5/8 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog * You can order this quantity Product Category
or a multiple thereof. IEC
Fast Bus
5
200 mm long, 84 mm wide
For terminals up to 600 MCM 8US19 22-1GA02 1
200 mm long, 270 mm wide
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
8US19 22-1GA00
For terminals up to 600 MCM FBC135
200 mm long, 135 mm wide
8US1998-2BM00
1) UL508A labeled panels require the use of components that meet the creepage and air distances of 1” air clearance and 2” creepage distance.
N/A = not applicable for given item.
2) Terminals must be manually spaced on the busbar to comply with UL508A distances of 1” air clearance and 2” creepage distance.
3) Cannot be used on Twin T (TT) profile up to 1400 A.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/9
Fast Bus
Dimension drawings
A 0.187
L1
(5) L1
75
0.75 L 2
185
166
(20)
120
209
L2
50
Dimension A
NSE0_02058
40
NSE0_02071
31
FBB36 36 (914) L3 L3
FBB60 60 (1524)
01573 123
25 51
Copper Busbar/TT profile, 8US19 48-2AA00 8US19 22-1AC00 with 8US19 23-3UA01 Support for blanking covers,
5
30 32
POWER DISTRIBUTION
SYSTEMS
10
40
60
6
200
10
NSE0_02070
NSE0_02073
9 49,4
62,5
5,2 10,2
8US19 23-1AA01 Blanking cover, 8US1922-2EB00
NSE0_00721
30,5
NSE0_00720
30,5
8US19 22-2DA00
34
200
31
60
NSE0_01607
1,5
71
78
NSE0_02072
40 62,5
Dimension drawings
50 2 28
94
60
200
194
184
156
60
96
NSE0_02074
NSE0_02060
36
54 32 154 21 72
88 100
50 5 28,7
5
94
60
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
200
194
184
148
60
88
NSE0_02053
NSE0_02059
28
160 8,8 72
81 32 100,2
88
166
34
146
60
200
194
60
I2_13999a
20 28 32
180
Dimension drawings
Busbar device adapter, 8US12 50-5AM00 Busbar device adapter, 8US12 60-5AP00
20
5
6
60
3,4
182
60
242
10
NSE0_02051
47,4 23,7
53,8 51,7
Busbar device adapter, 8US12 61-5FM08 Busbar device adapter, 8US12 11-4TR00
5
12
5
148
POWER DISTRIBUTION
SYSTEMS
40
20
NSE0_02062
60
68
6
60
214
200
164
5
182
60
60
NSE0_02068
Ø
2,
5
41 26,5
,4 60 54,5
Ø3 47,4 23,7 8,5 72
2,9
54 60,2
Busbar device adapter, 8US12 51-5DM07 Busbar device adapter, 8US12 61-5FP08
10
12
148
5
20
170
5
20
53
NSE0_02063
6
48
60
6
5
60
5
182
60
242
182
,4
Ø3
60
10
,5
Ø3
NSE0_02061
Dimension drawings
Busbar device adapter, 8US12 51-5CM47 Busbar device adapter, 8US12 13-4AQ01
31,5
23
38,8
60
114,5
114,5
190
35 NSE0_02066
105
35,5
26,8
23
5
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
60
131,5
182
64
190
131,5
NSE0_02069
14 14 35 NSE0_02065
32 105
42
56
60
247,5
296
270
NSE0_02067
45
140 55
Dimension drawings
8US1941-2AA01
51
Type a b c d e f Max tighening torque
5mm 8US1921-2AA0. 7.5 11.5 22.5 25 5 10 4 Nm
8US1921-2AB0. 10.5 15.5 29 35 5 10 6 Nm
max. 98
8US1921-2AC0. 17 23.5 36 55 5 12 15 Nm
8US1921-2AD0. 14.5 20.5 32 42 5 12 10 Nm
85,5
10mm 8US1921-2BA0. 7.5 11.5 22.5 25 10 10 4 Nm
8US1921-2BB0. 10.5 15.5 29 35 10 10 6 Nm
8US1921-2BC0. 17 23.5 36 55 10 12 15 Nm
8US1921-2BD0. 14.5 20.5 32 42 10 12 10 Nm
43 40
51
42
max. 86
max. 84
43 31
38
5 SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
FBC135 8US1922-1GA00
60
194
189
200
60
10 32
84 35
55
8US19 22-1GA02
Dimension drawings
27
35
29 29 9
NSE0_01599
7 14
74
90
5
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
8US19 98-1CA00 8US19 98-1DA00
Technical specifications
Direct-on-line starters/ Size Connection methods Mounting Control voltage Width W Height H Depth D
reversing starters
mm mm mm
SYSTEMS 5
Mounting dimensions
Direct-on-line starters S00 Screw terminals Standard mounting rails AC/DC 45 167 97
6POWER DISTRIBUTION
W
DC 45 260 165
Spring-type terminals Standard mounting rails AC/DC 45 243 107
Busbar adapters AC/DC 45 260 165
Reversing starters S00 Screw terminals Standard mounting rails AC/DC 90 170 97
3RA22. 3RA22 1. Busbar adapters AC/DC 90 200 155
Spring-type terminals Standard mounting rails AC/DC 90 204 97
Busbar adapters AC/DC 90 260 155
S0 Screw terminals Standard mounting rail AC 90 265 120.3
3RA22 2. adapters DC 90 265 130
Busbar adapters AC 90 260 155
DC 90 260 165
Spring-type terminals Standard mounting rail AC/DC 90 270 131
adapters
Busbar adapters AC/DC 90 260 165
Important: Acc. to DIN 43602 start command "I" at the right or top
Shock resistance Acc. to IEC 60086 Part 2-27 g Up to 6 Up to 6
(sine-wave pulse)
Degree of protection Acc. to IEC 60947-1 IP20
Link module
3RA19 21-1DA00 for S00 Link module
3RA29 21-1AA00 for S0, AC contactor 3RA29 11-2AA00 for S00
3RA29 21-1BA00 for S0, DC contactor 3RA29 21-2AA00 for S0 1)
Contactor
Size S00/S0
Spring-type terminals
Contactor
5
Size S00/S0
Screw terminals 1) Additional3RA29 11-1CA00
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
spacer for height compensation
on AC contactors size S0 with
NSB0_02091a
spring-type terminals.
Left: 3RA21 motor starter for direct-on-line starting with busbar Right: 3RA21 motor starter for direct-on-line starting with busbar
adapters with screw connection adapters with spring-type connection
Link Module
Link Module
3RA2931-1A AC/DC
3RA1941-1A AC/DC
Contactor Contactor
3RT203 3RT204
Bracket
FBS0 070B
SIRIUS 3RA Fast Bus Combination Starters and Group Installation Assemblies
Selection
Link module
5
3
2 contactors
Size S00/S0
NSB0_02094b
Screw terminals/
spring-type terminals
Wiring kit
Screw connection:
2 3RA29 13-2AA1 for S00
3RA29 23-2AA1 for S0
Spring-type connection:
3RA29 13-2AA2 for S00
3RA29 23-2AA2 for S0
1 Upper wiring module
2 Lower wiring module
3 2 connecting clips
4 Mechanical interlock
2)
Additional 3RA29 11-1CA00 spacer (can be removed if necessary)
for height compensation on AC contactors
size S0 with spring-type terminals.
3RA22 motor starter for reversing duty and 60 mm standard mounting rail in size S00/S0
(the version with screw connection is shown in the picture)
SIRIUS 3RA Fast Bus Combination Starters and Group Installation Assemblies
Selection
2 Contactors
3RT203
5
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
3RA2933-2AA2
Wiring Kit
a Upper Wiring Module
u
b Lower Wiring module
u
a Link Module
3RA1941-1A AC/DC
b Mechanical Interlock Adapter Shoe
3RA2934-2B 8US1211-4TR00
MSP
3RV204
3RA2943-2AA1 a
u
Wiring Kit
a Upper Wiring Module
u
b Lower Wiring Module
u
b
2 Contactors
3RT204 2 Brackets
FBS0070B
b
u
SIRIUS 3RA Fast Bus Combination Starters and Group Installation Assemblies
Dimensions
3RA2110 3RA2210
Fast Bus Non-reversing Fast Bus Reversing
96.9
45 154.9 45 5
49
169.9
200
5
97
96.9
45 5
49
193.4
3RA2120-1.A24-0AP0
SIRIUS 3RA Fast Bus Combination Starters and Group Installation Assemblies
Dimensions
3RA2230
3RA2130 Fast Bus Reversing
Fast Bus Non-reversing
1)
1)
34
14
53
2)
SIEMENS
2)
SIEMENS
259
309
259
309
SIEMENS
3)
5
SIEMENS SIEMENS
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
NSK-8174
NSK-8175
7 18 18 68
17 28 95 10
10 55 142 10 17.5
DC 157 120
176
SIRIUS 3RA Fast Bus Combination Starters and Group Installation Assemblies
Dimensions
contents
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
6 Section
6
General data 6/41 – 6/43
M200D motor starters for AS-Interface
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
General data 6/44 – 6/46
M200D Basic motor starters 6/47
M200D Standard motor starters 6/48
M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
General data 6/49 – 6/54
Communication modules, motor starter modules 6/55
Software
Motor Starter ES 6/56
Accessories
For all M200D motor starters 6/57 – 6/61
For M200D motor starters for AS-Interface 6/62 – 6/63
ET 200pro For M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS 6/64
For M200D motor starters for PROFINET 6/65
SIRIUS M200D
■ Overview
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters are compact devices, 22.5 mm
wide, combining a large number of functions in a single
enclosure. They consist of combinations of relay contacts,
power semiconductors (hybrid technology), and an electronic
overload relay for operational switching of three-phase motors
up to 3 HP (at 480V).
The 3RM1 motor starters with overload protection with wide
setting range are available as direct-on-line starters and
reversing starters and as versions with safety-related shutdown
up to SIL 3/PL e.
8
expansion. The wiring of the safety-related signals to the relay
6
• Ergonomic enclosure
Note:
For SIRIUS 3SK safety
safety relays,
relays, see
see page
page 11/12.
13/133.
Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
General data
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
Article No. scheme
Product versions Article number
Product function Direct-on-line starters 3RM10 0 @ – @ AA @ 4
Failsafe direct-on-line starters 3RM11 0 @ – @ AA @ 4 with ATEX certification and safety-related shutdown
Reversing starters 3RM12 0 @ – @ AA @ 4
Failsafe reversing starters 3RM13 0 @ – @ AA @ 4 with ATEX certification and safety-related shutdown
Wide setting range for 0.1 ... 0.5 A 1
electronic overload 0.4 ... 2.0 A 2 For motor standard output up to 3/4 HP1)
release
1.6 ... 7.0 A (UL=6.1A) 7 For motor standard output up to 3 HP1)
Connection method Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 2
(push-in)
Mixed connection method 3 Spring-loaded terminals (push-in)
Rated control supply 24 V DC 0
voltage Us 110 ... 230 V AC; 110 V DC 1
Example 3RM13 0 1 – 2 AA 0 4
1) Standard three-phase motor; the actual startup characteristics of the motor
as well as its rated data are important factors here.
Note:
The article number scheme shows an overview of product For your orders, please use the article numbers quoted in the
versions for better understanding of the logic behind the article selection and ordering data.
numbers.
■ Benefits
Product advantages
• Less space required in the control cabinet (20 to 80%) thanks Standards and approvals
to high functional density, which also means reduced wiring • IEC/EN 60947-4-2
and testing
8
• UL 60947-4-2
6
• Greater endurance and reduced heat losses thanks to hybrid • CSA
technology • ATEX
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
• Lower costs for stock keeping and configuration as a result of • IEC 61508-1: SIL 3
the wide setting range of the electronic overload release • ISO 13849: PL e
(up to 1:5) • CCC approval for China
• Fast wiring without tools for rigid conductors or conductors
equipped with end sleeves thanks to spring-loaded terminals
(push-in)
• Safety-related shutdown in accordance with SIL 3/PL e by
shutting down the control supply voltage without additional
devices in the main circuit
•• The motor
motor starters
starters can be ideally
ideally combined
combinedwith
with3SK
3SK safety
safety
relays for safety-related
safety-related shutdown
shutdown (see
(seepage
page13/133).
11/12)
• Motor status feedback to the higher-level control system in the
case of 3RM10 and 3RM12 motor starters in the 24 V DC
version
• Virtually error-free wiring on the mains connection side and
reduction in short-circuit protective devices by means of
3RM19 infeed system
• ATEX certification of the overload protection of the 3RM1
Failsafe motor starters: "Increased safety" type of protection
EEx e according to ATEX directive 2014/34/EU
•• The 3RM1
3RM1 motor
motor starters
starters can
can be used with highly
highly energy-
energy-
efficient IE3/IE4 motors. In this regard,
regard, please
pleaseobserve
observethe
the
dimensioning and
information on dimensioning and configuring,
configuring,see
see
Application Manual.
Manual.
For more information about IE3/IE4, see page page 1/7.
1/7.
■ Technical specifications
More information
Industry
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RM1
www.siemens.com/product?3RM1 FAQs, see
FAQs, see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16311/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16311/faq
Equipment
Equipment Manual,
Manual, see
see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/66295730
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/66295730
IC01_00469
8
Adjustable current response value of the inverse-time delayed overload release A 0.1 ... 0.5 0.4 ... 2 1.6 ... 7
6
Control circuit:
Type of voltage of the control supply voltage DC AC/DC
Control supply voltage
• At DC V 24 110
• At AC at 50 Hz V -- 110 … 230
Frequency of the control supply voltage Hz -- 50/60
Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
General data
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
■ Accessories
More information
1
Equipment Manual,
Equipment Manual, see
see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/66295730
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/66295730
6
8US1716-0RK00 adapters for mounting rails in the main circuit.
The maximum summation current must not exceed 25 A. The
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
IC01_00169c
primary infeed is connected via a three-phase infeed terminal.
The busbars are available in three lengths, for two, three or five
motor starters. More than five devices can be connected by
clamping the connection tags of a second busbar rotated by
180°. 4
The three-phase busbars are finger-safe but empty connection
tags must be fitted with covers.
3
Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
General data
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
Fuse module for the use of 3RM1 motor starters on 8US busbar systems and mounting rails
The fuse module permits the very compact construction of a The fuse module can be combined with all 3RM1 motor starters.
load feeder with a maximum width of 22.5 mm. The 3RM1 motor The easily replaceable fuses protect the connected motor and
starter in combination with the integrated fuses for short-circuit the cables.
protection can therefore be used on 8US busbar systems.
Thanks to the range of different adapters, the fuse module can
be used in all 60 mm busbar systems and also in compact
busbar systems and on mounting rails. The interface to the
adapter also permits a simple and secure replacement of the
load feeder.
5 1 Busbar system
2 3 5
1 4 2 Cover profiles for busbars
3 Busbar adapter
4 Compact busbar adapter
IC01_00611a
8
6 STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
6
7
By means of the fuse module, 3RM1 motor starters can be used in busbar systems and 8US compact busbar systems, as well as on mounting rails
IC01_00178a
IC01_00218b
Motor
6
two motor starters. Device termination connectors terminate a •• For motor
motor suppression
suppression modules that are
are fitted
fitted in
in the
the main
main
circuit, (see page 8/94
see page 6/11).
group.
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Using the device connectors for safe group shutdown Note:
In combination with the 3RM11 and 3RM13 fail-safe motor For more
For moreinformation,
information,see
see
starters, the device connector can also be used for safety- https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109758696.
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109758696.
related shutdown. For this application, groups of no more than
five fail-safe motor starters can be connected using a device
connector, and the group must be terminated with a termination
connector. Removing the control voltage supply from the first
motor starter will safely shut down the whole group.
Operational power Adjustable current Control supply voltage SD Article No. Price PU PS*
for three-phase response value of the per PU (UNIT,
motor inverse-time delayed At DC At AC at SET, M)
at 460 V1) overload release 50 Hz
HP A V V d
Direct-on-line starters
-- 0.1 … 0.5 24 -- 2 3RM1001-@AA04 1 1 unit
3/4 0.4 … 2 24 -- 2 3RM1002-@AA04 1 1 unit
3 1.6 … 6.1 24 -- 2 3RM1007-@AA04 1 1 unit
-- 0.1 … 0.5 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1001-@AA14 1 1 unit
3/4 0.4 … 2 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1002-@AA14 1 1 unit
3 1.6 … 6.1 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1007-@AA14 1 1 unit
3RM1001-1AA04
Reversing starters
-- 0.1 … 0.5 24 -- 2 3RM1201-@AA04 1 1 unit
3/4 0.4 … 2 24 -- 2 3RM1202-@AA04 1 1 unit
3 1.6 … 6.1 24 -- 2 3RM1207-@AA04 1 1 unit
-- 0.1 … 0.5 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1201-@AA14 1 1 unit
3/4 0.4 … 2 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1202-@AA14 1 1 unit
3 1.6 … 6.1 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1207-@AA14 1 1 unit
8
3RM1201-1AA04
6
3RM1101-1AA04
Failsafe reversing starters
-- 0.1 … 0.5 24 -- 2 3RM1301-@AA04 1 1 unit
3/4 0.4 … 2 24 -- 2 3RM1302-@AA04 1 1 unit
3 1.6 … 6.1 24 -- 2 3RM1307-@AA04 1 1 unit
-- 0.1 … 0.5 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1301-@AA14 1 1 unit
3/4 0.4 … 2 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1302-@AA14 1 1 unit
3 1.6 … 6.1 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1307-@AA14 1 1 unit
3RM1301-1AA04
Type of electrical connection
• Screw terminals for main circuit, screw terminals for control circuit 1
• Spring-loaded terminals (push-in) for main circuit, spring-loaded terminals (push-in) 2
for control circuit
• Screw terminals for main circuit, spring-loaded terminals (push-in) for control circuit 3
1)
The actual startup characteristics of the motor as well as its rated data are
important factors here.
3RM1920-1AA
Three-phase busbars
• For 2 motor starters } 3RM1910-1AA 1 1 unit
3RM1910-1AA
3RM1910-1BA
3RM1910-1DA
6
3RM1910-6AA
Fuse modules for 3RM1 for use on busbars or mounting rails
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Fuse module with 3NW6007-1 fuse 2 3RM1932-1AB 1 1 unit
Fuse module without fuse1) 10 3RM1930-1AA 1 1 unit
3RM1932-1AB
Adapters
Adapters for 60 mm busbar systems 5 8US1216-0AS00 1 1 unit
22.5 mm x 200 mm x 41.5 mm
Note: The adapter can be used on busbars with a width of
12 mm and a thickness of 5 mm or 10 mm.
8US1216-0AS00
Adapters for 60 mm compact busbar systems 5 8US1616-0AK02 1 1 unit
22.5 mm x 160 mm x 41.5 mm
Note: The adapter can be used on busbars with a width of
12 mm, 15 mm, 20 mm, 25 mm or 30 mm and a thickness
of 5 mm or 10 mm.
8US1616-0AK02
1) For details of alternative fuses, see
see Equipment
EquipmentManual.
Manual.
8US1716-0RK00
Cover profiles1)2)
Cover profiles for busbars
12 mm x 5 mm x 1 000 mm 2 8US1922-2CA00 1 10 units
40 mm or 60 mm center-to-center busbar clearance
depending on busbar system
8US1922-2CA00
15 mm x 5 mm x 1 000 mm 2 8US1922-2AA00 1 10 units
20 mm x 5 mm x 1 000 mm
25 mm x 5 mm x 1 000 mm
30 mm x 5 mm x 1 000 mm
40 mm or 60 mm center-to-center busbar clearance
depending on busbar system
8US1922-2AA00
12 mm x 10 mm x 1 000 mm 2 8US1922-2BA00 1 10 units
15 mm x 10 mm x 1 000 mm
20 mm x 10 mm x 1 000 mm
25 mm x 10 mm x 1 000 mm
30 mm x 10 mm x 1 000 mm
8
6
3ZY1212-2EA00
Device daisy chain connectors 2 3ZY1212-2AB00 1 1 unit
For 3RM1 motor starters 24 V DC, 22.5 mm
For gaps without motor starters in assemblies
3ZY1212-2AB00
Device termination connectors 2 3ZY1212-2FA00 1 1 unit
For 3RM1 motor starters, 24 V DC, 22.5 mm
3ZY1212-2FA00
1) 2) configuration of
of aa busbar
busbar system,
system, see
The cover profiles for busbars can be used for maintaining minimum For further accessories for the configuration
spacing between the load feeders. see Catalog
Catalog LV 10.
LV 10.
3ZY1311-0AA00
8
6
For simple protection against unauthorized access
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
3ZY1321-2AA00
Coding pins for removable terminals 2 3ZY1440-1AA00 1 12 units
For mechanical coding of the terminals
3ZY1440-1AA00
Hinged cover
Replacement cover, without terminal labeling,
22.5 mm wide
• Titanium gray 2 3ZY1450-1AB00 1 5 units
• Yellow 2 3ZY1450-1BB00 1 5 units
3ZY1450-1AB00
3RK1911-6EA00
Screwdrivers Spring-loaded terminals
For all SIRIUS devices with spring-loaded terminals
Length approx. 200 mm, 2 3RA2908-1A 1 1 unit
3.0 mm x 0.5 mm,
titanium gray/black,
3RA2908-1A partially insulated
Overview
1 2 3 4 5 6 6 7
2
1
IC01_00662a
5 9
1 ET 200SP interface module
IC01_00613a
2 ET 200SP digital input
3 1 ET 200SP fail-safe motor starter 3 ET 200SP digital output
2 BaseUnit for ET 200SP motor starter 4 ET 200SP analog input
7 Dummy module consisting of
3 Fan 5 Dummy module consisting of BaseUnit + BU cover, 30 mm
BaseUnit + BU cover, 15 mm
4 3DI/LC module 8 3DI/LC module
4
6 ET 200SP motor starter F-DI and 9 Infeed bus cover
5 Infeed bus cover ET 200SP motor starter
Motor starter, BaseUnit, fan and 3DI/LC control module 3RK1308 motor starter in the ET 200SP I/O system
8
6
More information
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS
Homepage, www.siemens.com/ET200SP-motorstarter
Homepage, see www.siemens.com/ET200SP-motorstarter Further
Further components
components in in the
the ET
ET 200SP
200SP I/O
I/O system:
system:
Industry Mall,
Industry Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RK1308
www.siemens.com/product?3RK1308 •• Catalog
CatalogSTST70
70
TIA Selection
Selection Tool, see
see www.siemens.com/TST
www.siemens.com/TST •• Industry
Industry Mall, see
see www.siemens.de/product?ET200SP
www.siemens.de/product?ET200SP
ET 200SP
Load Feedersmotor starter
and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
Introduction
ET 200SP motor starters
Designing interference-free motor starters BaseUnits for motor starters
For interference-free operation of the ET 200SP station in
1 24 V and 500 V DC
accordance with IEC 60947-4-2 standard, use a dummy module
before the first motor starter. The dummy module consists of the 2 500 V AC
6ES7193-6BP00-0BA0 or 6ES7193-6BP00-0DA0 BaseUnit and 3 24 V DC
the 6ES7133-6CV15-1AM0 BU cover 15 mm.
4 without infeed
The 15 mm BU cover protects the plug contacts of the BaseUnit 5 3RK1908-0AP00-0EP0
against dirt. (not shown here)
Electromechanical switching devices in series with hybrid motor 6 3RK1908-0AP00-0FP0
starters (not shown here)
IC01_00535a
Switching an inductive load - in particular of motors <1 kW with 7 500 V AC
high inductance - with an electromechanical switching device with F-DI infeed
(e.g. contactor) can cause high and steep voltage edges. 8 500 V AC
1 2 3 4 7 8 9 10
The resulting faults/damage can be prevented by first with F-DI loop-through
disconnecting with the hybrid motor starter or by using EMC 9 without infeed
suppression modules: with F-DI infeed
• 3RT2916-1P.. EMC
• For 3RT2916-1P.. EMC suppression
suppression modules for direct 10 without infeed
mounting on the contactor, see page
page 13/133.
3/118 with F-DI loop-through
• For motor suppression modules
• modules that
that are
are fitted
fitted in
in the
the main
main
circuit, see
see page
page 18/104
6/21.
View of the BaseUnit infeeds for the motor starters
Note: BaseUnits are components for accommodating the ET 200SP
For more
more information,
information,see
see I/O modules.
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109758696..
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109758696. The self-assembling voltage buses integrated into the BaseUnits
3DI/LC control module reduce wiring outlay to the single infeed (both of auxiliary and
load voltage).
This is
is aa digital
digitalinput
inputmodule
modulewith
withthree
threeinputs
inputsfor
forlocal
localmotor
motor
starter functions
functions such
such as
as“manual
"manuallocal
localcontrol”,
control",“implementation
"implementation All modules following on the right are automatically supplied
of fast inputs”
inputs" or “end
"end position disconnection”.
disconnection". For
For aa list
list of
of all
allthe
the upon plugging the BaseUnits together, if BaseUnits are inserted
functions
functions permitted
permitted byby the
the 3DI/LC module, see chapter "Overview
“Overview with routing.
8
of functions"
functions”ininthetheEquipment
EquipmentManual.
Manual.
6
The rugged design and keyed connection technology enables
The module is plugged into the front of the motor starter from use in harsh industrial conditions.
which it is supplied with a 24 V DC operating voltage.
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
The BaseUnits are available with various infeeds for the motor
starters.
8
6
Example 3RK1908 – 0 A P 0 0 – 0 A P 0
Note:
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS
The article number schemes show an overview of product ver- For your orders, please use the article numbers quoted in the
sions for better understanding of the logic behind the article selection and ordering data.
numbers.
■ Benefits
Product advantages • The ET 200SP
• 200SP motor
motor starters
starters can
can be used with highly energy-
highly energy
efficient IE3/IE4 motors,
efficient IE3/IE4 motors, see
see Application
ApplicationManual.
Manual.
The ET 200SP motor starters offer a number of advantages: Take the current characteristics
characteristics ofof the
the connected
connectedmotor
motorandand
• Fully integrated into the ET 200SP I/O system (including motor starter into account when dimensioning.
dimensioning. In In addition
additiontoto
TIA Selection Tool and TIA Portal) the rated current, the maximum
maximum permissible
permissiblecurrent
currentrange
rangeofof
• High degree of flexibility when it comes to safety applications the motor starter and the ratio of the rated current
current to
to the
via SIMATIC F-CPU or SIRIUS 3SK safety relays up to SIL 3 starting current
current of
of the
the motor are
are relevant.
relevant.
and PL e Cat. 4. For more information on IE3/IE4, see page page 1/7.
1/7.
• Simple, integrated current value transmission Standards and approvals
• Extensive parameterization by means of TIA Portal • IEC/EN 60947-4-2
• Increase of plant availability through fast replacement of units • UL 60947-4-2
(easy mounting and plug-in technology) • CSA
• Greater endurance and reduced heat losses thanks to hybrid • ATEX
technology
• IEC 61508-1: SIL 3
• Less space required in the control cabinet (20 to 80%) as a
result of greater functional density (direct-on-line and • ISO 13849: PL e
reversing starters in same width) • CCC approval for China
• Extensive diagnostics and information for preventive
maintenance
• Parameterizable inputs via 3DI/LC control module
• Less wiring and testing required as a result of integrating
several functions into a single device
• Lower overheads for stock keeping and configuration as a
result of the wide setting range of the electronic overload
release (up to 1:3)
• Technology has lower inherent power losses than speed-
controlledSiemens
6/14 drive systems, so that
Industry Inc., less cooling
Industrial (and smaller
Control Catalog
footprint) are possible
Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
ET 200SP motor starter
General data
ET 200SP motor starters
Application
The ET 200SP motor starters are suitable for the following • Track switching and lifting table control in conveyor systems:
applications: Track switches can be implemented using the quick stop
• Switching and monitoring of function and lifting table controls by means of the "immediate
- three-phase motors with overload and short-circuit end position disconnection" function without any laborious
protection (e.g. 400 V asynchronous motors for secondary programming.
drives in conveyor systems) • Safe isolation of the drive from main power supply:
- single-phase motors with overload and short-circuit The isolating functions according to IEC 60947-1 offer
protection (e.g. 230 V motors for pump applications) protection against inadvertent activation during plant
- Resistive loads by means of current value and diagnostics maintenance.
via the maintenance function (e.g. for heaters)
Motor starters in the process industry
• Plant monitoring and energy management in conveyor
systems: For the ET 200SP motor starters, special BaseUnits are available
By means of the phase asymmetry and zero current detection that enable the device to be used in the ET 200SP HA
during current measurement, for example, drive belt I/O system, too. This is typically used in process engineering
monitoring and blocking monitoring are possible. applications.
Technical specifications
More information
Industry Mall, see
Industry Mall, see www.siemens.com/product?3RK1308
www.siemens.com/product?3RK1308 FAQs,
FAQs, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/21800/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/21800/faq
Equipment Manual,
Manual, see
see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109479973
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109479973
6
Width x height x depth mm 30 × 142 × 150
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
H
8
Operating frequency, rated value Hz 50 ... 60
6
Article number 3RK1908- 3RK1908- 3RK1908- 3RK1908- 3RK1908- 3RK1908- 3RK1908- 3RK1908-
0AP00-0AP0 0AP00-0BP0 0AP00-0CP0 0AP00-0DP0 0AP00-0GP0 0AP00-0HP0 0AP00-0JP0 0AP00-0KP0
Product designation BaseUnit
General technical
specifications:
Width x height x depth mm 30 × 215 × 75
H
Ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During transport °C -40 ... +70
• During storage °C -40 ... +70
Touch protection against Finger-safe
electric shock
Connections/terminals:
Type of connectable conductor
cross-sections
• At the inputs for supply voltage
- Solid 1 x 0.5 ... 2.5 mm2 --
- Finely stranded 1 x 0.5 ... 2.5 mm2 --
with end sleeve
- Finely stranded 1 x 0.5 ... 2.5 mm2 --
without end sleeve
- Solid for AWG cables 1 x 20 ... 12 --
• For infeed
- Solid 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 -- 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 -- 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 --
- Finely stranded 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 -- 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 -- 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 --
with end sleeve
- Finely stranded 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 -- 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 -- 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 --
without end sleeve
8
6
• For load-side outgoing feeder
- Solid 1 x 0.5 ... 2.5 mm2
1 x 0.5 ... 2.5 mm2
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
- Finely stranded
with end sleeve
- Finely stranded 1 x 0.5 ... 2.5 mm2
without end sleeve
- Solid for AWG cables 1 x 20 ... 12
Type of electrical connection for Spring-loaded terminals (push-in)
auxiliary and control circuits
Miscellaneous:
Type of screwdriver tip Slotted
Size of screwdriver tip Standard screwdriver 0.6 mm x 3.5 mm
8
6
3RK1308-0AB00-0CP0
Reversing starters
0.1 ... 0.4 3.2 NEW NEU
2 3RK1308-0BA00-0CP0 1 1 unit
0.3 ... 1 8 2 3RK1308-0BB00-0CP0 1 1 unit
0.9 ... 3 24 2 3RK1308-0BC00-0CP0 1 1 unit
2.8 ... 9 72 2 3RK1308-0BD00-0CP0 1 1 unit
4 ... 12 72 2 3RK1308-0BE00-0CP0 1 1 unit
3RK1308-0BB00-0CP0
Fail-safe direct-on-line starters
0.1 ... 0.4 3.2 2 3RK1308-0CA00-0CP0 1 1 unit
8
NEW NEU
6
0.3 ... 1 8 2 3RK1308-0CB00-0CP0 1 1 unit
0.9 ... 3 24 2 3RK1308-0CC00-0CP0 1 1 unit
2.8 ... 9 72 2 3RK1308-0CD00-0CP0 1 1 unit
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
4 ... 12 72 2 3RK1308-0CE00-0CP0 1 1 unit
3RK1308-0CE00-0CP0
Fail-safe reversing starters
0.1 ... 0.4 3.2 NEW NEU
2 3RK1308-0DA00-0CP0 1 1 unit
0.3 ... 1 8 2 3RK1308-0DB00-0CP0 1 1 unit
0.9 ... 3 24 2 3RK1308-0DC00-0CP0 1 1 unit
2.8 ... 9 72 2 3RK1308-0DD00-0CP0 1 1 unit
4 ... 12 72 2 3RK1308-0DE00-0CP0 1 1 unit
3RK1308-0DE00-0CP0
Type of product Supply voltage Loop through the SD Push-in terminals PU (UNIT, PS*
at DC rated potential group SET, M)
value from the left Article No. Price
per PU
8
V d
6
BaseUnits
For dummy modules
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS
6ES7193-6BP00-0BA0
3RK1908-1AA00-0BP0
Accessories
BU cover 15 mm for BaseUnits 1 6ES7133-6CV15-1AM0 1 5 units
Type A0 or A1
6ES7133-6CV15-1AM0
BU cover 30 mm For protection of 2 3RK1908-1CA00-0BP0 1 1 unit
empty slots, 30 mm
3RK1908-1CA00-0BP0
Infeed bus cover For ET 200SP 2 3RK1908-1DA00-2BP0 1 1 unit
(1 bag containing
10 covers)
3RK1908-1DA00-2BP0
Mechanical bracket Mechanical, 2 3RK1908-1EA00-1BP0 1 1 unit
(1 bag containing for ET 200SP
8
6
5 mechanical brackets)
3RK1908-1EA00-1BP0
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Fan Can be used for 3RK1308 } 3RW4928-8VB00 1 1 unit
3RW4928-8VB00
3RK1911-6EA00
3RK1911-6EB00
Starter Kit NEW NEU
consists of 5 3RK1908-1SK00 1 1 unit
3RK1308-0BC00-0CP0
reversing starter
(0.9 ... 3 A),
3RK1908-0AP00-0AP0
BaseUnit with 500 V and
24 V AC/DC infeed, and
EMC distance module
(consisting of
6ES7193-6BP00-0BA0
BaseUnit plus
6ES7133-6CV15-1AM0 BU
cover 15 mm)
3RK1908-1SK00
Overview
Flexible and cost-efficient distributed starter solutions
Be it their high degree of protection, compact design or inte-
grated multifunctionality – our motor starters and soft starters for
use in the field are ideal for realizing distributed drive solutions.
The modular concepts, distributed power supply and integrated
safety technology of our portfolio for a high degree of protection
consistently supports current trends in drive technology.
3RK1304 3RK1315
Type Page
ET 200pro motor starters
Motor starters in the SIMATIC ET 200pro I/O system up to 5.5 kW
Standard motor starters 3RK1304 6/28
High Feature motor starters 3RK1304 6/29
ET 200pro isolator modules • With switch disconnector function for safe disconnection 3RK1304 6/30
Safety modules local • Isolator module, 400 V disconnecting module 3RK1304 6/31
Safety modules PROFIsafe • F-Switch PROFIsafe 6ES7148 6/34
Accessories for ET 200pro motor starters • Incoming power supply, power loop-through connection on the field device, 3RK19 6/35
motor cable, power bus with power terminal connectors
6
ET 200pro – interface modules • For communication with PROFIBUS, PROFINET and IWLAN 6ES71 ST 70
ET 200pro – CPUs • Standard CPUs, fail-safe CPUs 6ES71 ST 70
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS
ET 200pro – I/O modules • Digital/analog expansion modules, fail-safe expansion modules, 6ES71 ST 70
power modules, ET 200pro pneumatic interfaces
9
■ Overview
ET 200pro motor starters in I/O system ET 200pro
More information
SIMATIC ET 200pro is the modular I/O system with high degree
Homepage,
Homepage, see see www.siemens.com/ET200pro
www.siemens.com/ET200pro
of protection IP65/66/67 for local, cabinet-free use. The
ET 200pro motor starters with the high degree of protection IP65 Industry
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?ET200pro
www.siemens.com/product?ET200pro
are an integral part of ET 200pro. Further
Further components
components in in the
the ET
ET 200pro
200pro distributed
distributed I/O
I/O system:
system:
•
• Interface modules, central
Interface modules, central units,
units, I/O
I/O modules,
modules, ETET 200pro
200pro PS,
PS,
see Catalog
see Catalog ST
ST 70
70
• ET200pro
• ET 200proFC-2
FC-2frequency
frequencyconverters,
converters, see
see Catalog
Catalog D 31.2
D 31.2
6
• Comprehensive diagnostic signals
with an appropriate connection, safety levels SIL 3
• Support for PROFIenergy (according to IEC 62061) and PL e (according to ISO 13849-1)
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
• Overload can be acknowledged by remote RESET can also be reached.
• Current asymmetry monitoring
9
Functionality
• Stall protection With the ET 200pro motor starters, any three-phase loads can be
• EMERGENCY START function on overload protected and switched.
• Current value transmission by bus The ET 200pro motor starters are available with mechanical and
• Current limit monitoring also electronic contacts.
• Full support of acyclic services The ET 200pro electromechanical starters are offered as
• Direct-on-line or reversing starters direct-on-line starters (DSe) and reversing starters (RSe) as
• Power bus connection can be plugged in using Han Q4/2 Standard and High Feature versions. There are device versions
connectors with or without control for externally fed brakes with 400 V AC.
• Motor feeder with Han Q8/0 plug Compared with the Standard motor starters, the High Feature,
mechanical motor starter also has:
• Conductor cross-section up to 6 x 4 mm²
• Four digital inputs
• 25 A per segment (power looped through using jumper plug)
• Advanced parameterization options
• In the Standard and High Feature versions
(with 4 DI on-board) The ET 200pro electronic starters are offered as direct-on-line
• Electromechanical switching and electronic switching starters (sDSSte/sDSte) and reversing starters (sRSSte/sRSte) in
the High Feature version.
• Electronic starter for direct activation or with integrated soft
starter function Compared with the High Feature mechanical motor starters, the
• Supplied with 400 V AC brake contact as an option High Feature electronic motor starter also has:
• Temperature sensor can be connected • Soft starting and smooth ramp-down function
(Thermoclick or PTC type A) • Deactivated soft start function as an electronic starter for
• Provision of the motor current in PROFIenergy format to applications with a high switching frequency
higher-level systems, motor current shutdown in dead times • Advanced parameterization options
using PROFIenergy
ET 200pro
Motor motor
Starters starter
for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro Motor Starters
General data
General data
As a result of the protection concept with solid-state overload • Expansions are easily possible through the subsequent
evaluation and the use of SIRIUS switching devices, size S00, adding of modules. The innovative plug-in technology also
additional advantages are realized on the Standard and does away with the wiring needed up to now. Through the hot
High Feature motor starters – advantages that soon make swapping function (disconnection and connection during
themselves positively felt particularly in manufacturing operation) a motor starter can be replaced within seconds if
processes with high plant stoppage costs: necessary, without having to shut down the ET 200pro station
• Configuration is made easier and flexibility is increased by the and with it the process in the plant. The motor starters are
fine modular structure with ET 200pro. When using ET 200pro therefore recommendable in particular for applications with
motor starters, the parts list per load feeder is reduced to two special demands on availability. Storage costs are also opti-
main items: the bus module and the motor starter. This makes mized by the low level of variance (two units up to 7.5 HP).
the ET 200pro ideal for modular machine concepts or solu- • With four locally acting inputs available on the High Feature
tions for conveying systems and in machine-tool building. motor starter it is possible to realize autonomous special
functions that work independently of the bus and the higher
level control system, e.g. as a quick stop on gate valve
controls or limit position disconnectors. In parallel with this, the
states of these inputs are signaled to the control system.
Article No. scheme
Example 3RK1304 – 5 K S 4 0 – 4 A A 0
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS
Modules 3RK1304 – 0 H S 0 0 – @ A A 0
Product function Isolator modules 6
Isolator modules 7 Safety modules local
400 V disconnecting modules 8 Safety modules local/PROFIsafe
Example 3RK1304 – 0 H S 0 0 – 6 A A 0
Note:
The Article No. scheme shows an overview of product versions
for better understanding of the logic behind the article numbers.
For your orders, please use the article numbers quoted in the
selection and ordering data.
6
Parameterizable starting voltage -- ✓
Parameterizable stopping voltage -- ✓
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Local device interface ✓
Firmware update ✓ By specialists
9
Thermal motor model ✓
Parameterizable trip class -- CLASS 10 fixed ✓ CLASS 5, 10, 15, 20
Parameterizable response in case of overload of thermal motor -- ✓ 3 possible states
model
Advance warning limit for motor heating % -- ✓ Parameterizable 0 ... 95
Advance warning limit time-related trip reserve s -- ✓ Parameterizable 0 ... 500
Parameterizable recovery time min -- ✓ 1 ... 30
Parameterizable protection against voltage failure -- Permanently integrated ✓
Reversing start function ✓ Order option
Parameterizable interlock time for reversing starters -- 150 ms fixed ✓ 0 ... 60 s
Integrated logbook functions ✓ 3 device logbooks
Integrated statistics data memory ✓
Parameterizable response in case of CPU/master stop ✓
PROFIenergy profile support
• Disconnection of the motor current during idle times ✓
• Measured motor current values ✓
Device indications
• Group fault SF LED (red)
• Switching state STATE LED (red, yellow, green)
• Device status DEVICE LED (red, yellow, green)
• Digital inputs -- IN 1 ... IN 4, LED
✓ Function available
-- Function not available
1) DS .... Direct-on-line starters
RS .... Reversing starters
DSS .. Direct-on-line soft starters
RSS .. Reversing soft starters
e ....... Electronic motor protection
te ...... Full motor protection (thermal + electronic)
s ....... Electronic switching with semiconductor.
Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro motor starter
ET 200pro Motor Starters
General data
General data
■ Benefits
ET 200pro motor starters provide the following advantages: • Extensive diagnostics and information for preventive
• High flexibility thanks to a modular and compact design maintenance
• Little variance among all motor starter versions • Parameterizable inputs for on-site control functions
(two units up to 5.5 kW) (High Feature)
• Extensive parameterization using STEP 7 HW Config • Cabinet-free design thanks to high degree of protection IP65
• Increase of plant availability through fast replacement of units
(easy mounting and plug-in technology)
■ Application
The SIMATIC ET 200pro motor starters are ideal for the use of Use of ET 200pro motor starters in conjunction with
several spatially concentrated distributed drive solutions in IE3/IE4 motors
which several motors, or digital or analog sensors and actuators
are addressed from a distributed station. They are perfectly Note:
suited for protecting and switching any AC loads. For the use of ET
use of ET 200pro
200pro motor
motorstarters
startersininconjunction
conjunctionwith
with highly
highly
energy-efficient IE3/IE4
energy-efficient IE3/IE4 motors,
motors, please
please observe
observe the information
the information
Application areas on dimensioning
dimensioningand andconfiguring;
configuring;
seesee Application
Application Manual.
Manual.
The SIMATIC ET 200pro motor starters are suitable for numerous
sectors of industry, e.g. machinery and plant engineering or
conveying applications.
6 STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
9
Technical specifications
More information
Equipment
Equipment Manual,
Manual, see
see Notes
Notes on security:
security:
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/22332388
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/22332388 System networking
networking requires
requires suitable
suitableprotective
protectivemeasures
measures(including
(including network
network
segmentation for IT
segmentation for IT security)
security)ininorder
ordertotoensure
ensuresafe
safeplant
plantoperation.
operation.
For more
For information on
more information on the
the subject
subjectof ofIndustrial
IndustrialSecurity,
Security,see
see
www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity.
www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity.
6
Rated operational voltage Ue V AC 400 (50/60 Hz)
• Approval according to EN 60947-1, Appendix N V AC Up to 400 (50/60 Hz) Up to 400 (50/60 Hz)
• Approval according to CSA and UL V AC Up to 600 (50/60 Hz) Up to 480 (50/60 Hz)
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Approval
9
• DIN VDE 0106, Part 101 V Up to 400 Up to 480
• CSA and UL approval V Up to 600 Up to 480
Conductor cross-sections
• Incoming power supply mm 2 Max. 6 x 4
Touch protection Finger-safe
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 400
Rated operational current Ie for starters
• AC-1 / 2 / 3 at 40 °C - At 400 V A 0.15 ... 2.0/1.5 ... 12.0 0.15 ... 2.0/1.5 ... 12.02)
- At 500 V A 0.15 ... 2.0/1.5 ... 9.0
• AC-4 at 40 °C - At 400 V A 0.15 ... 2.0/1.5 ... 4.0
Rated short-circuit breaking capacity kA 100 at 400 V
Type of coordination acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 1
Power of three-phase motors at 400 V kW Max. 5.5 Max. 5.5/43)
Utilization categories AC-1, AC-2, AC-3, AC-4 AC-53a4) (max. 9 A with
deactivated soft start
function up to CLASS 10)
Protective separation between main and auxiliary circuits V 400, acc. to EN 60947-1, Appendix N
Endurance of contactor
• Mechanical Operating cycles 30 million --
• Electrical Operating cycles Up to 10 million; depending on the current loading --
(see manual)
Permissible switching frequency Depending on the current loading, motor starting time, and relative ON period
(see manual)
Operating times for 0.85 ... 1.1 x Ue
• Closing delay ms 11 ... 50 --
• Opening delay ms 5 ... 45 --
1) 2)
DS .... Direct-on-line starters If the soft starter control function is deactivated, the permissible rated
RS .... Reversing starters operational current is reduced to 9 A up to CLASS 10.
DSS .. Direct-on-line soft starters 3)
With parameterization as electronic starter max. 4 kW.
RSS .. Reversing soft starters 4) 8-hour operation.
e ....... Electronic motor protection
te ...... Full motor protection (thermal + electronic)
s ....... Electronic switching with semiconductor.
Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro motor starter
ET 200pro Motor Starters
Standard motor starter IE3/IE4 ready
Standard motor starters
■ Overview
The functionality,
functionality,device
devicefunctions,
functions,and technical
and specifications
technical specifications
of the Standard motor starter
Standard motor starterare
aredescribed
describedinin“ET
"ET200pro
200proMotor
Motor
Starters, General
Generaldata”
data"see
(seepage
page 9/3onwards.
6/23 onwards).
✓ = Additional price
1) Only functions when
when used
used together
togetherwith
withthe
thebackplane
backplanebus
busmodule
moduleand
andthe
the
backplane bus module and the wide module
wide module rack. The backplane module rack
rack
must be
be ordered
ordered separately (see "Accessories
“Accessoriesfor
forET
ET200pro
200promotor
motor
starters",
starters”,page
page9/19).
6/39).
6 STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
9
■ Overview
The functionality,
functionality,device
devicefunctions,
functions,and
and technical
technical specifications
specifications The High Feature motor starter differs from the Standard motor
of
of the High Feature
the High Featuremotor
motorstarter
starterare
aredescribed
describedin in
“ET"ET 200pro
200pro starter in having more parameters and four integrated, freely-
Motor
Motor Starters, Generaldata”
Starters, General data"see
(seepage
page 9/3onwards.
6/23 onwards). parameterizable digital inputs.
6
• Without brake output and with 4 inputs 2 3RK1304-5@S70-3AA0 1 1 unit
• With brake output 400 V AC and 4 inputs 2 3RK1304-5@S70-3AA3 1 1 unit
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Setting range Additional
Rated operational current price
9
sRSSte High Feature • 0.15 ... 2.0 A None
K
• 1.5 ... 12.0 A L ✓
✓ = Additional price
1) Only
Only functions
functions when
whenused
usedtogether
togetherwith
withthe
thebackplane
backplanebusbusmodule
moduleand
andthe
the
wide module
wide module rack.
rack. The
The backplane
backplane busbus module
module and
and the
the wide
wide module
module rack
rack
must be
must be ordered
ordered separately
separately (see
(see "Accessories
“AccessoriesforforETET 200pro
200pro motor
motor
starters",
starters”,page
page9/19).
6/39).
2)
The electronic motor starters can be used not only as electronic motor
starters with a high level of switching frequency but also as fully fledged
soft starters for soft starting and stopping. The changeover from motor
starter to soft starter takes place through reparameterization in HW Config.
Depending on the setting, this results in the following current ranges:
- Parameterization as electronic motor starter: 0.15 to 2 A and
1.5 to 9 A (4 kW)
- Parameterization as soft starter: 0.15 to 2 A and 1.5 to 12 A (5.5 kW).
■ Overview
The isolator module with integrated group fusing function The following properties apply to the isolator module:
(i.e. additional group short-circuit protection for all subsequently • Increase of plant availability through fast replacement of units
supplied motor starters) and switch disconnector function is (easy mounting and plug-in technology)
used for safe disconnection of the 400 V operational voltage in
the plant. • Cabinet-free design thanks to high degree of protection IP65
Depending on the power distribution concept, all stations can be isolator module
The isolator moduleisisavailable
available
in in addition
addition in ainsafety
a safety version
version
equipped with an isolator module as an option. (see “Safety
"Safety local
local isolator module"
module”on onpage
page 9/11).
6/31).
■ Technical specifications
Type Isolator modules Type Isolator modules
General data Degree of protection IP65
Mounting dimensions (W x H x D) Touch protection Finger-safe
• Direct-on-line starters and reversing mm 110 x 230 x 170 Pollution degree 3, IEC 60664 (IEC 61131)
starters
Rated impulse withstand kV 6
Permissible ambient temperature voltage Uimp
• During operation °C -25 ... +55
• During storage °C -40 ... +70 Rated insulation voltage Ui V 400
Permissible mounting position Any Rated operational current Ie
for starters
Vibration resistance acc. to g 2
IEC 60068 Part 2-6 • AC-1/2/3 at 40 °C
- At 400 V A 25
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068 g/ms Half-sine 15/11 - At 500 V A 25
Part 2-27
Rated short-circuit breaking kA 50 at 400 V
Power consumption capacity
• From auxiliary circuit L+/M (U1) mA Approx. 20
• From auxiliary circuit A1/A2 (U2) -- Type of coordination acc. to 2
IEC 60947-4-1
Rated operational current Ie A 25
for power bus Protective separation between V 400, according to
main and auxiliary circuits DIN VDE 0106, Part 101
Rated operational voltage Ue V 400
Device functions
Approvals according to • Group diagnostics Yes, parameterizable
• DIN VDE 0106, Part 101 V Up to 500
Device indications
6
3RK1304-0HS00-6AA0
1) Only
Only functions when used
used together
togetherwith
withthe
therelated
related110
110mm
mmbackplane
backplanebus
bus
module and the wide module rack. The backplane bus module and the
wide module rack must be ordered separately (see page 6/39).
9/19).
■ Overview
Safety Solution local Functionality
With the Safety local modules Safety local isolator module
• Safety local isolator module and
• 400 V disconnecting module The Safety local isolator module features the same functions as
with an appropriate connection, safety level PL e a standard isolator module with an additional local safety
(according to ISO 13849-1) can be reached. function.
The Safety local isolator module contains a 3TK2841 module
and is equipped with M12 terminals for the connection of
external safety components.
Terminals 1 and 2 can be used to connect either one- or two-
channel EMERGENCY STOP circuits or protective door circuits
(IN 1, IN 2).
For monitored starts, an external START switch can be
connected to terminal 3.
The required safety functions can be set using two slide
switches located under the left M12 opening.
In the event of an EMERGENCY STOP, the Safety local isolator
module trips the downstream 400 V disconnecting module. This
safely separates the 400 V circuit up to PL e.
In combination with the 400 V disconnecting module, the
Safety local isolator module can be used for safety applications
up to PL e.
400 V disconnecting module
ET 200pro motor starter (Safety Solution local): Safety local isolator
module, disconnecting module, Standard starter and High Feature The 400 V disconnecting module can be used together with the
starter mounted on a wide module rack Safety local isolator module for local safety applications and
together with the F-Switch for PROFIsafe safety applications.
Safety local isolator module
It contains two contactors connected in series for safety-related
6
The Safety local isolator module is a repair switch with integrated disconnection of the main circuit.
safety evaluation functions that can be parameterized using
DIP switches. The auxiliary circuit supply of the device is over a safety power
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
rail in the backplane bus module.
It is used for
9
• Connection of a one- or two-channel EMERGENCY STOP The 400 V disconnecting module can be used in conjunction
circuit up to PL e (protective door or EMERGENCY STOP with the Safety local isolator module or with the F-Switch for
pushbuttons) and parameterizable start behavior safety applications up to PL e.
• For controlling the 400 V disconnecting module by means of a
safety rail signal
400 V disconnecting module
The 400 V disconnecting module enables the safe disconnec-
tion of an operational voltage of 400 V up to PL e. For operation
in a Safety Solution local application, it functions only in
combination with the Safety local isolator module.
For operation in a Safety PROFIsafe application it functions only
in combination with the F-Switch.
■ Technical specifications
Type Safety local isolator module 400 V disconnecting module
General data
Mounting dimensions (W x H x D)
• Direct-on-line starters and reversing starters mm 110 x 230 x 170 110 x 230 x 150
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +55
• During storage °C -40 ... +70
Permissible mounting position Any
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068, Part 2-6 2g
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068, Part 2-27 Half-sine 15 g/11 ms
Power consumption
• From auxiliary circuit L+/M (U1) mA Approx. 20
• From auxiliary circuit A1/A2 (U2) --
Rated operational current Ie for power bus A 25
Rated operational voltage Ue V 400 (50/60 Hz)
Approval DIN VDE 0106, Part 101 V Up to 500
CSA and UL approval V Up to 600
Conductor cross-sections
Incoming power supply mm2 Max. 6 x 4
Degree of protection IP65
Touch protection Finger-safe
Pollution degree 3, IEC 60664 (IEC 61131)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 400
Rated operational current Ie for starters
• AC-1/2/3 at 40 °C
- At 400 V A 16 25
- At 500 V A 16 25
Rated short-circuit breaking capacity kA 50 at 400 V
6
3RK1304-0HS00-7AA0
400 V disconnecting modules3)4)
Rated operational current 25 A 2 3RK1304-0HS00-8AA0 1 1 unit
3RK1304-0HS00-8AA0
1)
The Safety local isolator module only functions when used together with
the 400 V disconnecting module.
2) Only
Only in combination
combination with with the
the special
special backplane
backplane bus
bus module
module for
for the
the
Safety local
Safety local isolator
isolator module
module (see
(see "Accessories
“AccessoriesforforETET200pro motor
200pro motor
starters",
starters”,page
page9/19).
6/39).
3)
The 400 V disconnecting module functions only when used together with
6
the Safety local isolator module or with the F-Switch.
4) The 400 V disconnecting module functions only when used together with
The 400 V disconnecting module functions only when used together with
the
the backplane
backplane bus module and and the
the wide
wide module
module rack.
rack. The
The backplane
backplane bus
bus
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
module
module andand the
the wide
wide module
module rackrack must
must bebe ordered
ordered separately
separately (see
(see
"Accessories
“Accessoriesfor forETET200pro
200pro motor
motorstarters", page
starters”, 9/19).
page 6/39).
■ Overview
Safety Solution PROFIsafe Functionality
With the Safety PROFIsafe modules The PROFIsafe F-Switch is a fail-safe solid-state module for
• F-Switch and PROFIsafe safety applications. It has two fail-safe inputs and
• 400 V disconnecting module outputs for safe switching of the 24 V supply over backplane
with an appropriate connection, safety levels SIL 3 busbars. In combination with the 400 V disconnecting module,
(according to IEC 62061) and PL e (according to ISO 13849-1) fail-safe disconnection of ET 200pro motor starters is possible in
can be reached. PROFIsafe applications up to SIL 3/PL e.
F-Switch PROFIsafe 400 V disconnecting module
Fail-safe digital inputs/outputs in degrees of protection IP65 to See "Safety
“Safetymodules
moduleslocal",
local”,Overview,
Overview,page
page9/11
6/31and
and Technical
Technical
IP67 for near-machine, cabinet-free use. specifications, page
page6/32
9/12.
.
Fail-safe digital inputs
• For the fail-safe reading in of sensor information
(one-/two-channel)
• Including integrated discrepancy evaluation for 2v2 signals
• Internal sensor supplies (incl. testing) available
Fail-safe digital outputs
• Three fail-safe PP-switching outputs for safe switching of the
backplane busbars
The F-Switch is certified up to SIL 3/PL e and has detailed
diagnostics.
It supports PROFIsafe in PROFIBUS configurations as well as in
PROFINET configurations.
SET, M)
d
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS
3RK1304-0HS00-8AA0
F-Switch PROFIsafe
24 V DC, including bus module 1 6ES7148-4FS00-0AB0 1 1 unit
Note:
Connection module must be ordered separately
6ES7148-1FS00-0AB0
Connection modules for F-Switch
24 V DC 1 6ES7194-4DA00-0AA0 1 1 unit
1) The 400 V disconnecting module functions only when used together with
the Safety local isolator module or with the F-Switch.
2) The 400 V disconnecting module functions only when used together with
400 V disconnecting module functions only when used together with
the backplane
backplane bus module and the wide wide module
module rack.
rack. The
The backplane
backplane bus
bus
module and the wide
wide module
module rack
rack must
must be
be ordered
ordered separately
separately (see
(see
"Accessories
“AccessoriesforforETET200pro
200promotor
motor starters", page
starters”, 9/19).
page 6/39).
■ Overview
Infeed on
isolator module
1
RSM RSM
MS MS MS MS
NSA0_00467a
NSA0_00465a
3 4 7
2 9
5 / 6
Basic design of an ET 200pro version with (from the left) connection Infeed on the RSM isolator module
module for IM, interface module for communication (IM), RSM isolator
module, two ET 200pro motor starters (MS), and connections for energy
6
Legend:
Legend:
Infeed on Power
Power feeder plug(see
feeder plug (see page
page 9/17)
6/37)
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
ET 200pro motor starter b Power
Power connection plug(see
connection plug (see page
page 9/17)
6/37)
c Power
Power jumper plug(see
jumper plug (see page
page 9/17)
6/37)
9
d Motor
Motor connection plug(see
connection plug (see page
page 9/17)
6/37)
e Motor
Motor plug (seepage
plug (see page 9/17)
6/37)
f Motor
Motor plug withEMC
plug with EMCsuppressor
suppressor circuit
circuit (see(see
pagepage
6/37)9/17)
MS MS g Power
Power loop-through plug(see
loop-through plug (see page
page 9/17)
6/37)
h Power connection cable (see page 9/17)
Power connection cable (see page 6/37)
i Power connection cable for isolator module (see page 9/17)
Power connection cable for isolator module (see page 6/37)
j Motor cable (see page 9/18)
Motor cable (see page 6/38)
NSA0_00466a
10
8
11
12 13 13
ET 200pro
M200D M200D
IC01_00230a
6 STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
9
Motors
Power supply to the motors via the power bus with power T and double-T terminal connectors linked by power bus cables, spur lines to the field devices
(motor starters), and power loop-through connections to the motors via motor connection cables
Motor control via PROFIBUS Motor control via PROFINET
The interface modules (IM) for PROFIBUS can be combined For connection
For connectionmodules
moduleswith
with
thethe relevant
relevant accessories,
accessories, see see
with three different connection modules for connecting "Accessories for
“Accessories for ET
ET 200pro
200pro interface
interface modules"
modules”ininCatalog
Catalog ST
ST 70
70
PROFIBUS DP and the power supply: or the
or the Industry
Industry Mall.
Mall.
• Direct connection with cable gland
• ECOFAST connection with hybrid fieldbus cables (with two
copper cores for data transmission with PROFIBUS DP, and
four copper cores for the power supply), and ECOFAST plugs
(HanBrid)1)
• M12, 7/8" connection
- with M12 connecting cable and M12 plugs for data
transmission with PROFIBUS DP
- with 7/8" connecting cable and 7/8" plugs for the power
supply2)
For connection
connectionmodules
moduleswith
withthethe relevant
relevant accessories,
accessories, seesee
"Accessories
“Accessories for
forET
ET 200pro
200pro interface
interface modules"
modules”ininCatalog
CatalogST
ST70
70
or
or the
the Industry
Industry Mall.
Mall.
1) Hybrid 2)
Hybrid fieldbus
fieldbus connections
connections with
with HanBrid sockets designed as cabinet cabinet bushings
On the control cabinet bushings with
with two
twoM12
M12sockets
socketsfor
forthe
thePROFIBUS
PROFIBUS
bushings transmit
bushings transmit data and energy from the control cabinet
cabinet (IP20)
(IP20) to the
the M12 connecting cables (see page 6/66),
9/46), the
the 24
24 VV supply
supply of
of the
the motor
motor
field (IP65).
field (IP65). They
They are
are the interface
interface for jointly routing PROFIBUS
PROFIBUS DP DP and
and the
the starters is implemented via separate 7/8"
7/8" connecting
connecting cables.
cables.
auxiliary voltages
auxiliary voltages into
into the hybrid
hybrid fieldbus
fieldbus cable
cable (see
(see page
page 6/66).
9/46).
6
Power loop-through on the field device
Power jumper plugs 2 3RK1922-2BQ00 1 1 unit
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Power loop-through plugs
Connector set for power loop-through for connection to
9
ET 200pro motor starters/ET 200pro isolator modules,
comprising a cable-end connector hood, angular
outgoing feeder, pin insert for HAN Q4/2,
incl. gland
• 4 male contacts, 2.5 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BF50 1 1 unit
• 4 male contacts, 4 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BF10 1 1 unit
Motor cables
Motor connection plugs
Connector set for motor cable for connection to
ET 200pro motor starters, comprising a cable-end
connector hood, angular outgoing feeder, pin insert
for HAN Q8/0, incl. gland
• 8 male contacts, 1.5 mm2 5 3RK1902-0CE00 1 1 unit
• 6 male contacts, 2.5 mm2 5 3RK1902-0CC00 1 1 unit
Motor plugs
Connector set for motor cable for connection to motors,
comprising a cable-end connector hood, straight
outgoing feeder, female insert for HAN 10e, incl. star
jumper, incl. gland
• 7 female contacts, 1.5 mm2 30 3RK1911-2BM21 1 1 set
• 7 female contacts, 2.5 mm2 30 3RK1911-2BM22 1 1 set
Motor plugs with EMC suppressor circuit
Connector set for motor cable for connection to motors,
comprising a cable-end connector hood, straight
outgoing feeder, female insert for HAN 10e with
EMC suppressor circuit, incl. star jumper,
incl. gland
• 7 female contacts, 1.5 mm2 30 3RK1911-2BL21 1 1 set
• 7 female contacts, 2.5 mm2 30 3RK1911-2BL22 1 1 set
3RK1902-0CW00
Dismantling tools
• For male and female contacts for 9-pole 15 3RK1902-0AB00 1 1 unit
HAN Q4/2 inserts
• For male and female contacts for 9-pole 5 3RK1902-0AJ00 1 1 unit
HAN Q8 inserts
Sealing caps
For 9-pole power sockets
• 1 unit per pack 5 3RK1902-0CK00 1 1 unit
• 10 units per pack 5 3RK1902-0CJ00 1 10 units
3RK1902-0CK00
6
(one set contains ten sealing caps)
3RK1901-1KA00
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Motor suppression module
RC element for installation in motor terminal box
9
• Angular design 15 3RK1911-6EA00 1 1 unit
3RK1911-6EA00
• Round design 15 3RK1911-6EB00 1 1 unit
3RK1911-6EB00
1)
The wide module rack can accommodate all ET 200pro motor starters and
any optional modules (isolator module, Safety local isolator module and
400 V disconnecting module).
2)
The backplane bus module is a prerequisite for operation of the
ET 200pro motor starter and the optional module.
For more
For more connection
connectiontechnology
technology products,
products, seesee
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/65355810.
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/65355810..
■ Overview
More information
Industry Mall,
Industry Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3ZS1
www.siemens.com/product?3ZS1
Technical
Technical specifications
specificationsand
andsystem
systemrequirements,
requirements,see
see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16713/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16713/td
Overview
More information
Homepage, see
Homepage, see www.siemens.com/motorstarter
www.siemens.com/motorstarter
Industry
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?M200D
www.siemens.com/product?M200D
TIA Selection
Selection Tool
Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST
(TST Cloud),
Cloud),see
see
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=MS_M200D
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=MS_M200D
Basic functionality
The versions of the M200D motor starter are equipped with the
following properties and functions:
• Available as direct-on-line and reversing starters in a rugged
design
• Electromechanical or electronic switching version
• Low variance – only two device versions up to 7.5 HP thanks
to wide range setting
• All versions have the same enclosure size.
• Degree of protection IP65
SIRIUS M200D AS-i Basic motor starter with manual local operation • Quick and fail-safe wiring of system and motor cables using
The intelligent and highly flexible SIRIUS M200D motor starters ISO 23570 plug-in connector technology (Q4/2 and Q8/0)
for distributed installation start, monitor and protect motors and • Robust and widely used M12 connection method for digital
loads up to 7.5 HP. inputs and outputs
The M200D motor starters are available in four versions: • Integrated feeder connector monitoring
• Full motor protection through overload protection and a
M200D M200D M200D M200D temperature sensor (PTC, TC)
AS-i Basic AS-i Standard PROFIBUS PROFINET
• Short-circuit and overload protection integrated
Motor control with
• Integrated repair switch lockable with three locks
AS-i communication PROFIBUS PROFINET (multi-level service)
Mechanical or electronic switching • Uniform wiring to the SINAMICS G110D, SINAMICS G110M
6
and SINAMICS G120D frequency inverters and to the
Electronic switching with soft starter functionality ET 200pro distributed I/O system
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
-- • Extensive diagnostics concept using LEDs
• Optional integrated manual local control with key-operated
9
Function available
switch (ordering option)
-- Function not available
• Optionally available brake actuation with voltages from
180 V DC (no rectifier needed in motor) or 230/400 V AC
(ordering options)
Article No. scheme
Note:
The Article No. scheme shows an overview of product versions For your orders, please use the article numbers quoted in the
for better understanding of the logic behind the article numbers. selection and ordering data.
■ Benefits
M200D motor starters provide the following advantages for • Comprehensive offering of accessories, including
customers: ready-assembled cables
• High plant availability through plug-in capability of the main • The M200D motor starters can be installed with a few manual
circuit, communication and I/Os – relevant for installing and steps. The integrated plug-in technology enables far lower
replacing devices wiring outlay:
• Cabinet-free construction and near-motor installation thanks Preassembled cables can be plugged directly onto the motor
to the high degree of protection IP65 starter module.
• The motor starters record the actual current flow for the • Easy and user-friendly installation because all versions have
parameterizable electronic motor overload protection. the same enclosure dimensions.
Reliable messages concerning the overshooting or • Fast and user-friendly commissioning using optional manual
undershooting of setpoint values ensure comprehensive local operation
motor protection. All motor protection functions can be • Increase of process speed through integrated functions such
defined by simple parameterization as "Quick Stop" and "Disable Quick Stop", e.g. at points and
• Low stock levels and low order costs thanks to a wide setting crossings
range for the electronic motor protection of 1:10 • Optional manual local control with momentary-contact and
(only two device versions up to 7.5 HP) latching operation for easier startup and easier servicing
• The integrated wide range for the current enables a single
device to cover numerous standard motors of different sizes.
■ Application
The high degree of protection IP65 makes the M200D motor Use of SIRIUS M200D motor starters in conjunction with
starters suitable in particular for use on extensive conveying IE3/IE4 motors
systems such as are found in mail sorting centers, airports,
automotive factories and the packing industry. Note:
For the
the use
use of
ofSIRIUS
SIRIUSM200D
M200Dmotor
motorstarters in in
starters conjunction withwith
conjunction
For simple drive tasks, particularly in conveyor applications, the
new SINAMICS G110D frequency inverter series with a perform- highly energy-efficient
highly energy-efficient IE3/IE4
IE3/IE4 motors,
motors, please
please observe
observe the the
ance range from 0.75 kW to 7.5 kW and degree of protection information ondimensioning
information on dimensioning and
and configuring,
configuring, seesee Application
Application
IP65 is the ideal partner for the M200D motor starters. Manual.
Manual..
Overview
motor control
For motor controlusing
usingAS-Interface
AS-Interface there
there areare
thethe following
following Mounting and installation
M200D motor
M200D motor starter
starterversions:
versions:SIRIUS
SIRIUS M200D
M200D AS-iAS-i Basic
Basic andand
SIRIUS M200D
M200DAS-i
AS-iStandard
Standard(basic
(basicfunctionality,
functionality, see page 9/21 The M200D motor starters can be installed with a few manual
SIRIUS see page 16/41 steps. The integrated plug-in technology enables far lower wir-
"SIRIUS M200D
“SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters” "General
MotorStarters" “Generaldata"
data” "Overview").
“Overview”). ing outlay. Connecting cables can be plugged directly onto the
SIRIUS M200D AS-i Basic motor starter module. Swapping of the connecting wires and
malfunctions within the plant are prevented by preassembled
Functionality cables. The AS-i bus is connected cost-effectively using an M12
• Easy and fast on-site startup through parameterization of local connection on the device. All versions have identical enclosure
setting knobs (DIP switches) and rotary coding switches for dimensions for easier system design and conversion.
adjusting the rated operational current. The rotary coding
switch has an OFF position for deactivating the overload Parameterization and configuration
protection with the help of the thermal motor model when The particularly robust M200D AS-i Standard motor starter is
using a temperature sensor. characterized by numerous functions which can be flexibly
Communications parameterized. It enables highly flexible parameterization
through the AS-i bus using data records from the user program
• AS-i communication with A/B addressing according to as well as user-friendly local parameterization using the
Spec V2.1 Motor Starter ES startup software through the local point-to-
• The AS-i bus is connected cost-effectively using an point interface.
M12 connection on the device. Of the four digital inputs, Functions can be flexibly assigned to the digital inputs and
two are contained in the process image and can therefore be outputs, adapting them to all possible conveyor applications.
used in the PLC program. The other two inputs are locally All motor protection functions, limit values and reactions can be
effective and permanently assigned with functions. defined by parameterization. The AS-i Standard is unique. In its
• The LEDs can provide comprehensive diagnostics of the 6E/4A process image the motor starter sends all four digital
device on the spot. In addition to diagnostics using the inputs and the digital output via the process image to the PLC in
PAE process image, the device can create up to 15 different cyclic mode. System configuration and system documentation
diagnostic signals per slave. The message with the highest are facilitated not least by a number of CAX data.
priority can be read out through the AS-i communication. This
is yet another new development which distinguishes the Operation
M200D AS-i Basic motor starter from the rest of the market and The new generation of motor starters is characterized by its
adds innovative technology, maximum availability and advanced functionality, maximum flexibility and extremely high
transparency to the system. degree of automation.
6
SIRIUS M200D AS-i Standard All digital inputs and outputs exist in the cyclic process image.
The intelligent and highly flexible M200D AS-i Standard motor All limit values for monitoring functions and their reactions are
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
starter in A/B technology starts and protects motors and loads parameterizable and therefore adaptable to the application. The
up to 5.5 kW. They are available in direct-on-line or reversing motor starters record the actual current flow. Evaluating the
9
starter versions, in a mechanical version and also an electronic current of the parameterizable solid-state overload protection
version (the latter with soft start function). increases the availability of the drives, as do reliable messages
concerning the overshooting or undershooting of setpoint
The M200D AS-i Standard motor starter is the most functional values.
member of the SIRIUS motor starter family in the high degree of
protection IP65 for AS-i communication. Consistency with other Diagnostics and maintenance
products of the SIRIUS M200D motor starter range and with the
frequency converter and ET 200pro I/O system is assured. The M200D sets new standards for diagnostics. In addition to
diagnostics using the PAE process image and diagnostics by
Functionality "parameter echo" (up to 15 different diagnostic signals per slave
• AS-i communication with A/B addressing according to can be read out via AS-i communication), the possibility of
Spec 3.0 reading out diagnostic data records is unique on the market.
• Electronic version also with soft start function The AS-i Standard is recommended in particular for expansive
• AS-i slave profile 7AE/7A5 with process image 6E/4A and highly automated system components because the possi-
• Full TIA integration: All digital inputs and outputs exist in the bility of monitoring devices and systems with data records
cyclic process image and are visible through AS-i, providing (statistical data, measured values and device diagnostics)
maximum flexibility and best adaptability to the application. provides an in-depth view of the plant from the control room,
guaranteeing the monitoring process and increasing plant
• Additionally expanded diagnostics using data record through availability.
AS-i bus
• Complete plant monitoring using statistics data record and Preventive maintenance can be carried out with the integrated
current value monitoring by means of data records maintenance timer and plant downtimes prevented as a result in
advance.
• Parameterization through AS-i bus with the help of data
records or an expanded process image from the user program Local control of a drive is possible using the ordering option with
• Control of the motor starter using a command data record from integrated manual operation. This is yet another new develop-
the user program ment which distinguishes the M200D AS-i Standard motor starter
from the rest of the market and adds innovative technology,
• Flexible assignment of the digital inputs and outputs with all maximum availability and transparency to the plant.
available assignable input actions
• Parameterization using Motor Starter ES at the local interface
(ordering option for startup software)
• Diagnostics with the help of Motor Starter ES (ordering option
for startup software)
Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters for AS-Interface
M200D Motor Starters for AS-Interface
General data
General data
Data channels
Local optical interface (manual local)
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS
AS-i bus
9
6
Bypass function -- ✓ Only solid-state version
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
✓ Function available
9
-- Function not available
■ Application
The M200D AS-i standard is particularly suitable for highly auto- Use of M200D motor starters in conjunction with
mated applications in conveyor systems requiring devices and IE3/IE4 motors
systems to be monitored to prevent or limit plant downtime.
The option of planning the functions of the motor starter or its Note:
interfaces also creates the prerequisite for fine-adjustment to the For the use
use of
of SIRIUS
SIRIUSM200D
M200Dmotor
motorstarters
startersininconjunction with
conjunction with
function of the motor starter in the application and hence highly energy-efficient
highly energy-efficientIE3/IE4
IE3/IE4motors,
motors,please
please observe
observethethe
provides for extreme flexibility. information on dimensioning
information on dimensioningand andconfiguring,;
configuring,see see Application
Application
Manual.
■ Technical specifications
More information
Manuals for SIRIUS
SIRIUS M200D:
M200D: Notes
Notes on
on security:
security:
•• AS-i
AS-i Basic,
Basic, see
see In order
In order toto protect
protect plants,
plants, systems,
systems, machines
machines and
and networks
networks against
against cyber
cyber
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/35016496
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/35016496 threats, itit is
threats, is necessary
necessary to implement –– and
to implement and continuously
continuously maintain
maintain –– aa holistic,
holistic,
state-of-the-artindustrial
state-of-the-art industrial security
security concept.
concept. Siemens products and and solutions
solutions
•• AS-i
AS-i Standard,
Standard, see
see
represent only one component of such a concept.
represent concept.
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38722160
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38722160
For more
For more information
information onon the
the subject
subject of
of Industrial
Industrial Security,
Security, see
see
FAQs, see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16324/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16324/faq www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity.
www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity.
Main circuit
Maximum power of three-phase motors at 400 V AC kW 5.5 4 5.5 5.5
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS
• Approval acc. to UL and CSA V AC 600 (50/60 Hz) 480 (50/60 Hz) 600 (50/60 Hz) 480 (50/60 Hz)
• Rated operational current range A 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 12 -- 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 12 --
• Rated operational current range for soft starting A -- 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 12
• Rated operational current range for direct-on-line starting A -- 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 9 -- 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 9
Rated operational current for starters Ie at 400 V AC
• 400 V at AC-1/2/3 A 12 -- 12 --
• 500 V at AC-1/2/3 A 9 -- 9 --
• 400 V at AC-4 A 4 -- 4 --
• 400 V at AC-53a A -- 9 -- 12 for soft starting
9 for direct-on-line
starting
Mechanical endurance of contactor Operating cycles 30 million -- 30 million --
Trip class CLASS 10 CLASS 5, 10, 15, 20
Type of coordination acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 1 (2 for device 1 1 (2 for device 1
version 2A) version 2A)
Permissible switching frequency see manual see manual
Rated ultimate short-circuit breaking capacity Iq
• At 400 V AC kA 50
• At 500 V AC kA 502) 202) 50 202)
Short-circuit protection
• At Iemax = 2 A Integrated, 2 x13 Ie = 26 A
• At Iemax = 9/12 A Integrated, 2 x13 Ie = 208 A
Brake actuation (option)
Operational voltage V 230/400 AC or 180 DC
Uninterrupted current A < 0.5 at 230/400 V AC
< 0.8 at 180 V DC
Short-circuit protection Yes, 1 A melting fuse
1) 2) Only systems with grounded neutral point permitted.
DS .... Direct-on-line starters
RS .... Reversing starters
DSS .. Direct-on-line soft starters
RSS .. Reversing soft starters
te ...... Full motor protection (thermal + electronic)
s ....... Electronic switching with semiconductor.
M200D AS-i Basic without manual local operation M200D AS-i Basic with manual local operation
6
• Brake actuation (180 V DC) 5 ✓
Electronic starters (with thyristors)
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
15 3RK1315-6@S71-@AA@ 1 1 unit
Rated operational current setting range/A Additional price
9
• 0.15 ... 2 K None
• 1.5 ... 9 N ✓
Direct-on-line starters/reversing starters
• Direct-on-line starters 0 None
• Reversing starters 1 ✓
• Direct-on-line starters with manual local operation 2 ✓
• Reversing starters with manual local operation 3 ✓
Brake actuation
• Without brake actuation 0 None
• Brake actuation (230/400 V AC) 3 ✓
• Brake actuation (180 V DC) 5 ✓
✓ = Additional price
M200D AS-i Standard without manual local operation M200D AS-i Standard with manual local operation
Overview
The intelligent, highly flexible M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET
motor starters are the most functional motor starters of the
SIRIUS motor starter family in the high degree of protection IP65
for PROFIBUS/PROFINET communication.
They start and protect motors and loads up to 7.5 HP.
Direct-on-line and reversing starter versions are available, in a
mechanical version and also an electronic version (the latter with
soft start function).
The particularly robust M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET motor
starters are characterized by numerous functions which can be
flexibly parameterized. Their modular design comprises a motor
starter module and a communication module.
The M200D PROFINET motor starters enable TIA-integrated
parameterization through PROFINET from STEP 7 – in familiar,
user-friendly manner with the look and feel of PROFIBUS.
Functionality
• For basic
basicfunctionality,
functionality,see
seepage
page 9/21“SIRIUS
16/41 "SIRIUSM200D
M200DMotorMotor
Starters” "General
Starters" “General data"
data” "Overview"
“Overview” M200D motor starter module for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
• Electronic version also with soft start function (without communication module)
• Robust and widely used M12 connection method for the
digital inputs and outputs and the PROFIBUS/PROFINET bus
connection
• All four digital inputs and two digital outputs exist in the cyclic
process image. This provides complete transparency of the
process on the control level
• Full TIA integration: All digital inputs and outputs exist in the
cyclic process image and are visible through the bus,
providing maximum flexibility and excellent adaptability to the
application
6
• Flexible assignment of the digital inputs and outputs with all
available assignable input actions
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
• Extensive diagnostics concept using LEDs and through the
9
bus with the TIA-compatible mechanisms
• Expanded diagnostics using data records
• Complete plant monitoring using statistics data record and
current value monitoring by means of data records
• Parameterization through PROFIBUS/PROFINET bus with the M200D communication module for PROFIBUS
help of data records from the user program
• Control of the motor starter using a command data record from
the user program
• Removable modular control unit – quicker device replacement
and therefore lower costs when device outages occur – since
existing wiring is on the control unit and only one device needs
to be replaced
• Parameterization in STEP 7 HW Config using Motor Starter ES
(ordering option for startup software)
• Startup and diagnostics with the help of Motor Starter ES
(ordering option for startup software)
• Trace function through Motor Starter ES for optimized startup
and tracking of process and device values
Only with PROFINET:
• Just one bus system from the MES level to the devices – no
routers
• More stations on the bus and possible configuration of flexible
bus structures M200D communication module for PROFINET
• Automatic re-parameterization in case of device replacement
thanks to proximity detection
• Wireless integration of plant segments in difficult
environments using WLAN
• Easier expansion of the system thanks to a higher number of
stations on the bus and elimination of terminating resistors
parameterizable and therefore adaptable to the application. preventative maintenance and avoid plant downtimes through
Consistency with other products of the SIRIUS M200D motor look-ahead servicing.
9
6
1 ... 1 256 with CPU 319
Parameter assignment
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
DIP switches For address setting and terminating resistor --
Motor Starter ES Through bus, optical interface
9
PROFIBUS/PROFINET data records
From STEP 7/HW Config
Diagnostics
Acyclic through data records
Diagnostic interrupt support
Process image
Process image 2 bytes PAE/2 bytes PAA
Data channels
Local optical interface (manual local)
Motor Starter ES through local interface
Using Motor Starter ES through bus
Data records (acyclic)
Parameter assignment Using DS 131 (DS = data record)
Diagnostics Device-specific DS 92
Measured values Measured values DS 94
Statistics Statistical data DS 95
Commands Using DS 93
Slave pointer Slave pointer DS 96
Logbook Using Motor Starter ES and data records: device faults DS 72, tripping operation DS 73, events DS 75
Device identification Using DS 100
I&M data Using DS 231 ... 234 Using data records 0xAFF0 ... 0xAFF3
Inputs
Number 4
• Of these in the process image 4
Input action Parameterizable: For flexibly assignable action, see manual
Quick stop Parameterizable: latching, non-latching
Function available
-- Function not available
Brake output
180 V DC / 230/400 V AC / none
Motor protection
Overload protection Electronic, wide range 1:10
Short-circuit protection
Full motor protection
Temperature sensor Parameterizable via Motor Starter ES, data record: PTC or Thermoclick or deactivated
Device function
Repair switch
Current limit monitoring bottom Parameterizable
Current limit monitoring top Parameterizable
Zero current detection Parameterizable: tripping, warning
Blocking current Parameterizable
6
Asymmetry Parameterizable
Load type Parameterizable: single-phase and three-phase
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS
Shutdown class Parameterizable via Motor Starter ES, data record: CLASS 5, 10, 15, 20
9
Function available
-- Function not available
Benefits
M200D PROFINET motor starters with PROFIenergy
Both standards and laws are making environmental protection It is thus an objective within the industry to save energy and
and energy management increasingly important, as is the desire actively reduce CO2 emissions. By the careful use of valuable
to cut energy costs in production facilities and thus ensure a resources, the manufacturer-independent PROFIenergy profile
sustainable competitive advantage. on PROFINET can make an active contribution to environmental
protection.
Application
M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET motor starters are particularly Adaptability of the motor starter functions and maximum
suitable for fully TIA-integrated, highly automated conveyor flexibility of the device enable a broad range of application
applications that meet all needs with regard to the monitoring of without any limits. The PROFINET-specific expansions are the
devices and systems and preventive maintenance. best assurance of a future-proof investment.
Technical specifications
More information
Equipment Manual
Manual for
for M200D
M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET,
PROFIBUS/PROFINET, see Notes
Notes on
on security:
security:
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38823402
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38823402 In order
In order toto protect
protect plants,
plants, systems,
systems, machines
machines and
and networks
networks against
against cyber
cyber
FAQs, see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16325/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16325/faq threats, itit is
threats, is necessary
necessary to implement –– and
to implement and continuously
continuously maintain
maintain –– aa holistic,
holistic,
state-of-the-artindustrial
state-of-the-art industrial security
security concept.
concept. Siemens
Siemens products
products and
and solutions
solutions
represent only one component of such a concept.
represent concept.
For more
For more information
information onon the
the subject
subject of
of Industrial
Industrial Security,
Security, see
see
www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity.
www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity.
6
Protection class IEC 536 (VDE 0106-1) 1
Electrical specifications
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Main circuit
Maximum power of three-phase motors at 400 V AC kW 5.5
9
Rated operational voltage Ue
• Approval acc. to EN 60947-1 V AC 400 (50/60 Hz)
• Approval acc. to UL and CSA V AC 600 (50/60 Hz) 480 (50/60 Hz)
• Rated operational current range A 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 12 --
• Rated operational current range for soft starting A -- 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 12
• Rated operational current range for direct-on-line starting A -- 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 9
Rated operational current for starters Ie at 400 V AC
• 400 V at AC-1/2/3 A 12 --
• 500 V at AC-1/2/3 A 9 --
• 400 V at AC-4 A 4 --
• 400 V at AC-53a A -- 12 for soft starting,
9 for direct-on-line starting
Mechanical endurance of contactor Operating cycles 30 million --
Trip class CLASS 5, 10, 15, 20
Permissible switching frequency see manual
Rated ultimate short-circuit breaking capacity Iq
• At 400 V AC kA 50
• At 500 V AC kA 50 202)
Short-circuit protection
• At Iemax = 2 A Integrated, 2 x13 Ie = 26 A
• At Iemax = 9 /12 A Integrated, 2 x13 Ie = 208 A
1) DS .... Direct-on-line starters
RS .... Reversing starters
DSS .. Direct-on-line soft starters
RSS .. Reversing soft starters
te ...... Full motor protection (thermal + electronic)
s ....... Electronic switching with semiconductor.
2)
Only systems with grounded neutral point permitted.
Line voltage
380 V AC 400 V AC 440 V AC 480 V AC 500 V AC
Brake voltage with brake actuation 180 V DC1)
Operational voltage V 230/400 AC or 180 DC
Uninterrupted current A < 0.5 at 230/400 V AC, < 0.8 at 180 V DC
Short-circuit protection Yes, 1 A melting fuse
Rectified brake voltage V DC 171 180 198 216 225
Recommended brake coil voltage for Siemens motors V DC 170 ... 200 170 ... 200 184 ... 218 184 ... 218 --
1) Integrated brake actuation supplies DC power supply for the brake.
Control circuit
Operational voltage
V DC 20.4 ... 28.8
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS
• UDC24V-NS
• UDC24V-S V DC 20.4 ... 28.8
9
M200D motor starter module M200D motor starter M200D motor starter
PROFIBUS/PROFINET PROFIBUS PROFINET
(without communication module)
6
• 1.5 ... 12 L ✓
Direct-on-line starters/reversing starters
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
• Direct-on-line starters 0 None
• Reversing starters 1 ✓
9
• Direct-on-line starters with manual local operation 2 ✓
• Reversing starters with manual local operation 3 ✓
Brake actuation
• Without brake actuation 0 None
• Brake actuation (230/400 V AC) 3 ✓
• Brake actuation (180 V DC) 5 ✓
Electronic starters (with thyristors)
15 3RK1395-6@S71-@AD@ 1 1 unit
Rated operational current setting range/A Additional price
• 0.15 ... 2 K None
• 1.5 ... 12 L ✓
Direct-on-line starters/reversing starters
• Direct-on-line starters 0 None
• Reversing starters 1 ✓
• Direct-on-line starters with manual local operation 2 ✓
• Reversing starters with manual local operation 3 ✓
Brake actuation
• Without brake actuation 0 None
• Brake actuation (230/400 V AC) 3 ✓
• Brake actuation (180 V DC) 5 ✓
✓ = Additional price
■ Overview
More information
Industry Mall,
Industry Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3ZS1
www.siemens.com/product?3ZS1
Technical
Technical specifications
specificationsand
andsystem
systemrequirements,
requirements,see
see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16713/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16713/td
■ Overview
7
1
NSA0_00485a
NSA0_00484
2 4 9 10
5
M 8
3 6
1 Power feeder plug 7 Connection for motor control with AS-i communication
2 Power connection plug 8 AS-Interface M12 feeder
3 Power connection cable 9 Connection for digital input
(IO communication, 5-pole)
4 Motor connection plug
10 Connection for digital output
5 Motor plug (IO communication, 4- or 5-pole)
6 Motor cable
Power and motor connection on the M200D motor starter Communication connection using AS-Interface and digital inputs and
6
(in this example: M200D for AS-i) outputs
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
9
13 14 13 14
11 12 15 15
NSA0_00488a
NSA0_00487a
9 10 9 10
Communication connection using PROFIBUS and digital inputs and Communication connection using PROFINET and digital inputs and
outputs outputs
16
17 18 18
ET 200pro
M200D M200D
IC01_00231a
Motors
Power supply to the motors via the power bus with power T and double-T terminal connectors linked by power bus cables, spur lines to the field devices
6
(motor starters), and power loop-through connections to the motors via motor connection cables
Power bus Interruption-free thanks to power terminal connectors
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS
The power supply to the field devices (ET 200pro motor starters, In finger-safe connection technology the power T terminal
M200D motor starters) is provided via the power bus, in which
9
6
+ Power connection cables
Assembled at one end with "N" and jumper pin 11 and 12
for plug monitoring, with HAN Q4/2, angular;
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
open at one end; 5 x 4 mm2
• Length 1.5 m 10 3RK1911-0DC13 1 1 unit
9
• Length 5.0 m 10 3RK1911-0DC33 1 1 unit
Motor cables
Motor connection plugs
Connector set for motor cable for connection to
M200D motor starters, comprising a cable-end connector
hood, angular outgoing feeder, pin insert for HAN Q8/0,
incl. gland
• 8 male contacts, 1.5 mm2 5 3RK1902-0CE00 1 1 unit
• 6 male contacts, 2.5 mm2 5 3RK1902-0CC00 1 1 unit
Motor plugs
Connector set for motor cable for connection to motors,
comprising a cable-end connector hood, straight
outgoing feeder, female insert for HAN 10e, incl. star
jumper, incl. gland
• 7 female contacts, 1.5 mm2 30 3RK1911-2BM21 1 1 set
• 7 female contacts, 2.5 mm2 30 3RK1911-2BM22 1 1 set
+ Motor cables, assembled at one end
For connection to M200D motor starters, HAN Q8/0,
angular, length 5 m
• Motor cables for motor without brake, 4 x 1.5 mm2 15 3RK1911-0EB31 1 1 unit
• Motor cables for motor without brake with thermistor, 30 3RK1911-0EF31 1 1 unit
6 x 1.5 mm2
• Motor cables for motor with brake actuation, 30 3RK1911-0ED31 1 1 unit
braking voltage 400 V AC or 180 V DC, 6 x 1.5 mm2
• Motor cables for motor with brake actuation, 30 3RK1911-0EG31 1 1 unit
braking voltage 400 V AC or 180 V DC and thermistor,
8 x 1.5 mm2
• Motor cables for motor with brake actuation, 30 3RK1911-0EH31 1 1 unit
braking voltage 230 V AC,
6 x 1.5 mm2
• Motor cables for motor with brake actuation, 30 3RK1911-0EE31 1 1 unit
braking voltage 230 V AC and thermistor,
8 x 1.5 mm2
3RK1902-0CW00
Dismantling tools
6
HAN Q8 inserts
Sealing caps
9
3RK1902-0CK00
3RK1902-4BA00-5AA0
M12 plugs, angular 5 3RK1902-4DA00-5AA0 1 1 unit
Screw fixing, 5-pole screw terminals,
max. 0.75 mm2,
A-coded, max. 4 A
3RK1902-4DA00-5AA0
, Control cables, assembled at one end
M12 plugs, angular, screw fixing, 5-pole, 5 x 0.34 mm2,
A-coded, black PUR sheath, max. 4 A
• Cable length 1.5 m 5 3RK1902-4HB15-5AA0 1 1 unit
3RK1902-4H...-5AA0 • Cable length 5 m 5 3RK1902-4HB50-5AA0 1 1 unit
• Cable length 10 m 5 3RK1902-4HC01-5AA0 1 1 unit
Control cables, assembled at both ends
Straight M12 plug, straight M12 socket, screw fixing,
3RK1902-4PB15-3AA0 3-pole, 3 x 0.34 mm2,
A-coded, black PUR sheath, max. 4 A
• Cable length 1.5 m 5 3RK1902-4PB15-3AA0 1 1 unit
Further accessories
Handheld devices 5 3RK1922-3BA00 1 1 unit
For M200D motor starters (or for ET 200pro and ET 200S
High Feature motor starters) for local operation.
The motor starter-specific serial interface cables must be
ordered separately.
The RS 232 interface cable 3RK1922-2BP00 is used for the
MS M200D.
6
RS 232 interface cable 5 3RK1922-2BP00 1 1 unit
Serial data connection between M200D (or ET 200pro)
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
motor starters and the RS 232 interface of a
PC/PG/laptop (with the Motor Starter ES software) or the
3RK1922-3BA00 handheld device 3RK1922-3BA00
9
USB interface cable, 2.5 m 3 6SL3555-0PA00-2AA0 1 1 unit
Serial data connection between M200D (or ET 200pro)
motor starters and the USB interface of a PC/PG/laptop
(with the Motor Starter ES software).
M12 sealing caps } 3RK1901-1KA00 100 10 units
For sealing unused M12 input or output sockets and
M12 sockets for PROFIBUS and PROFINET
communication modules
3RK1901-1KA00 (one set contains ten sealing caps)
RONIS SB30 keys } 3SU1950-0FB80-0AA0 1 1 unit
Replacement key for M200D
for "manual local control" ordering option
3SU1950-0FB80-0AA0
For more
For more connection
connectiontechnology
technology products,
products, seesee
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/65355810.
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/65355810..
3RK1902-4CA00-4AA0
AS-Interface M12 feeders
For flat cable For Cable length Cable end in
feeder
AS-i/Uaux M12 socket -- not available 2 3RK1901-2NR20 1 1 unit
M12 1m not available 2 3RK1901-2NR21 1 1 unit
cable box 2m not available 2 3RK1901-2NR22 1 1 unit
3RK1901-2NR21
Cable terminating pieces } 3RK1901-1MN00 1 10 units
For sealing of open cable ends (shaped AS-Interface
cable) in IP67
3RK1901-1MN00
6
6
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
3RK1902-1DA00
• 5 male contacts 5 3RK1902-1BA00 1 1 unit
3RK1902-1BA00
Control cables, assembled at one end
M12, screw fixing, angular, B-coded, no terminating
resistor
3RK1902-1G. • 5 female contacts, 3 m 15 3RK1902-1GB30 1 1 unit
• 5 female contacts, 5 m 15 3RK1902-1GB50 1 1 unit
• 5 female contacts, 10 m 15 3RK1902-1GC10 1 1 unit
Control cables, assembled at both ends
M12, screw fixing, angular, pin/socket
5-pole, B-coded, no terminating resistor
• 3.0 m 15 3RK1902-1NB30 1 1 unit
3RK1902-1N.
• 5.0 m 15 3RK1902-1NB50 1 1 unit
• 10.0 m 15 3RK1902-1NC10 1 1 unit
Further accessories
6
6
order quantity 20 m, maximum order quantity 1 000 m
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Plugs
On M200D, 7/8" for screw fixing, angular,
9
screw terminal, 1.5 mm2
• 5 female contacts 5 3RK1902-3DA00 1 1 unit
3RK1902-3DA00
• 5 male contacts 5 3RK1902-3BA00 1 1 unit
3RK1902-3BA00
Supply lines, assembled at one end
7/8" for screw fixing, angular, 1.5 mm2
• 5 female contacts, 3 m 15 3RK1902-3GB30 1 1 unit
• 5 female contacts, 5 m 15 3RK1902-3GB50 1 1 unit
• 5 female contacts, 10 m 15 3RK1902-3GC10 1 1 unit
3RK1902-3G.
Supply lines, assembled at both ends
7/8", for screw fixing, angular at both ends,
5-pole pin/socket, 1.5 mm2
•3m 15 3RK1902-3NB30 1 1 unit
3RK1902-3N. •5m 15 3RK1902-3NB50 1 1 unit
• 10 m 15 3RK1902-3NC10 1 1 unit
7/8" sealing caps 1 6ES7194-3JA00-0AA0 1 10 units
1 pack = 10 units
6ES7194-3JA00-0AA0
Equipment Manual "SIRIUS M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET Motor Starters"
See
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38823402
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38823402
Overview
Auxiliary power infeed
HanBrid plug-in connection technology offers the option of
feeding in or looping through two separate auxiliary voltages of
24 V DC (switched/unswitched) into the field in addition to the
PROFIBUS signal. The terminal block with spring-loaded
terminals on the rear (cabinet side) of the hybrid fieldbus
connection provides a variety of interconnecting options for
these auxiliary voltages.
Passive hybrid fieldbus connections
• Bushing from the control cabinet (IP20) into the field (IP65)
• HanBrid plug-in design socket/socket or pin/socket
• Direct connection or FastConnect connection for PROFIBUS at
Hybrid fieldbus connection with two HanBrid sockets the rear
• Terminal block with spring-loaded terminals (0.25 to 2.5 mm2)
for infeeding or forwarding the auxiliary voltages
IP20
IP65
Hybrid fieldbus connections with HanBrid sockets designed as Hybrid fieldbus connection as passive cabinet bushing
cabinet bushings transmit data and energy from the control
Active hybrid fieldbus connections with refresher function
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS
cabinet (IP20) to the field (IP65). They are the interface for jointly
routing PROFIBUS DP and the auxiliary voltages into the hybrid • Bushing from the control cabinet (IP20) into the field (IP65)
9
Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
Hybrid fieldbus connections
Selection and ordering
Hybrid fieldbus connections
Technical specifications
Type Passive hybrid fieldbus connections Active hybrid fieldbus connections
Mechanics and environment
Dimensions (W x H x D) mm 93 x 103 x 65
Cutout (W x H) mm 80 x 90
Temperature range °C -25 ... +60
Degree of protection IP20 internal/IP65 on field side
Material/enclosure mm Plastic (black PC), flame retardant
Electrical specifications
Rated operational voltage
• 24 V DC not switched (NS) V DC 24, ± 25%
• 24 V DC switched (S) V DC 24, ± 25%
Max. rated current A 10
Power supply -- From 24 V DC not switched (NS)
Max. power consumption mA -- 130
Mains buffering ms -- > 20
Baud rate detection -- Automatic
Maximum cascading depth -- 9 hybrid fieldbus connections
Baud rates kbps 9.6/19.2/45.45/93.75/187.5/500/1 500/3 000/6 000 /12 000
Electrical separation V DC 500
6
Link type / function Connection IP65 Connection IP20 SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
(PROFIBUS) per PU SET, M)
9
d
Hybrid fieldbus connections
Passive
• Cu/Cu, for feeding into the field Socket/socket Direct connection 5 3RK1911-1AA22 1 1 unit
(2 x HanBrid)
• Cu/Cu, for looping through in the Pin/socket Direct connection 5 3RK1911-1AA32 1 1 unit
field (2 x HanBrid)
• Cu/Cu, for feeding into the field Socket/socket PROFIBUS FastConnect 5 3RK1911-1AF22 1 1 unit
(2 x HanBrid) bus connector
• Cu/Cu, for looping through in the Pin/socket PROFIBUS FastConnect 5 3RK1911-1AF32 1 1 unit
field (2 x HanBrid) bus connector
Active (refresher)
• Cu/Cu, for feeding into the field Socket/socket 9-pole Sub D socket 5 3RK1911-1AJ22 1 1 unit
(2 x HanBrid)
• Cu/Cu, for looping through in the Pin/socket 9-pole Sub D socket 5 3RK1911-1AJ32 1 1 unit
field (2 x HanBrid)
• Cu/Cu, for feeding into the field Socket/socket 9-pole Sub D socket 5 3RK1911-1AK22 1 1 unit
(2 x M12)
6ES7194-1JB10-0XA0
PROFIBUS ECOFASThybrid
PROFIBUS ECOFAST hybridcables,
cables,see
seeCatalog
CatalogSTST
7070
or or
Industry Mall.
Notes
6 STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
contents
Introduction
7 Section
7/2 – 7/3
SIRIUS 3RW soft starters
General data 7/4 – 7/11
High Performance soft starters
3RW55 soft starters
- General Data 7/12 – 7/25
- Inline circuit 7/26 – 7/29
- Inside-delta circuit 7/30 – 7/33
3RW55/55F
- Accessories 7/34 – 7/35
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters
- General Data 7/36 – 7/48
- Inline circuit 7/49
- Inside-delta circuit 7/50
- Accessories 7/51 – 7/52
General Performance soft starters
3RW52 soft starters
- General Data 7/53 – 7/64
- Inline circuit 7/65 – 7/66
- Inside-delta circuit 7/67 – 7/68
- Accessories 7/69 – 7/70
3RW52 Basic Performance soft starters
3RW50 soft starters
- General Data 7/71 – 7/79
- Inline circuit 7/80
- Accessories 7/81 – 7/82
3RW40 soft starters
- General Data 7/83 – 7/89
- Inline circuit 7/90 – 7/91
7
- Accessories 7/92 – 7/93
3RW30 soft starters
SOFT STARTERS
- General Data 7/94 – 7/101
- Inline circuit 7/102
- Accessories 7/103 – 7/104
3RW50
Soft Starter Software 7/105
Spare parts
For 3RW55/3RW55 Failsafe 7/105 – 7/107
For 3RW52 7/108 – 7/109
For 3RW50 7/110
Class 73/74 Enclosed Softstarter applications
Overview 7/111
Application 7/111
Selection and ordering data 7/112 - 7/123
Factory Modifications 7/124
Dimensional drawings 7/125
Schematics 7/126
Introduction
Introduction
Overview
More information
Homepage,
Homepage, seesee www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter
www.siemens.com/soft-starter Industry
Industry Online Support (SIOS)
(SIOS) topic
topic page,
page,see
see
Industry Mall,
Industry Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW
www.siemens.com/product?3RW https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
TIA Selection
TIA Selection Tool
Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST
(TST Cloud),
Cloud),see
see Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters(STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
6/8 or
or
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=Sirius3rwFolder
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=Sirius3rwFolder https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
Introduction
Introduction
6
• Hybrid switching devices for minimum power loss and two-phase motor control
• Soft Torque for reduced mechanical loading and optimum pump stop
• Parameterization using potentiometers
• ATEX/IECEx certification
3RW40 soft starters • Soft starting and stopping 7/83
• Current limiting
• Motor overload protection (optionally with thermistor motor protection)
• Up to 75HP @ 480V 600V ratings also available)
• Hybrid switching devices for minimum power loss and two-phase motor control
• ATEX certification
3RW30 soft starters • Soft starting with voltage ramp 7/94
• Up to 75HP @ 480V
7
Enclosures in • Complete starter includes 3RW40 or 3RW44 and CPT
NEMA 1, 3, 4, & 12 types 7/111
• Performance Range of up to 600 Hp (at 460 V)
UL/CSA listed
SOFT STARTERS
• Combination options include circuit breaker or fusible disconnect
• Application areas:
- Compressors - Lumber processing
- Pumps - Pulp & paper processing
- Stamping presses - Conveyors
- Cooling towers - Textiles
- Molding and extruding - HVAC
- Chippers and debarkers
Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Soft Starters
Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General data General data
Overview
More information
Homepage,
Homepage, seesee www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter
www.siemens.com/soft-starter Industry
Industry Online
Online Support (SIOS) topic page,
(SIOS) topic page,see
see
Industry Mall,
Industry Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW
www.siemens.com/product?3RW https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
TIA Selection
TIA Selection Tool
Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST
(TST Cloud),
Cloud),see
see Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
SoftStarters
Starters(STS),
(STS), see
seepage
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=Sirius3rwFolder
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=Sirius3rwFolder https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
3-phase controlled
3RW55 Failsafe
TIA integration
(√3)
7.5 to 400HP to 750HP
General 3RW52
performance 7.5 to 400HP
6
(√3)
to 750HP
2-phase controlled
Basic 3RW50
100 to 400HP
performance
3RW40
7.5 to 75HP
3RW30
1.5 to 75HP
Tupical
Pumping Ventilating Compressing Conveying Processing
IC01_00698
applications
7
SOFT STARTERS
Escalators ● ● ● ●
Piston compressors ● ● ● ●
Screw compressors ● ● ● ●
Small fans1) ● ● ● ●
Centrifugal blowers ● ● ● ●
Bow thrusters ● ● ● ●
7
Circular saws/bandsaws ●
Centrifuges ●
SOFT STARTERS
Mills ●
Crushers ●
● Recommended soft starter 1) The mass inertia of the fan is <10 times the mass inertia of the motor.
2)
❍ Possible soft starter The mass inertia of the fan is 10 times the mass inertia of the motor.
6
Ramp-up and ramp-down time s 0 ... 360 0 ... 360 0 ... 20 0 ... 20 0 ... 20 0 ... 203)
Pump stop (torque control)4) -- -- -- --
• Starting torque % 10 ... 100 10 ... 100 -- -- -- --
• Torque limit % 20 ... 200 20 ... 200 -- -- -- --
Soft Torque (torque limit) -- -- -- --
Integral bypass contact system
Intrinsic device protection --
5) 5) 5) 5)
Motor overload protection --
6) 6) 6)
Thermistor motor protection evaluation --
6) 6)
Analog output -- --
Remote RESET --
Adjustable current limiting --
Inside-delta circuit1) -- -- --
Breakaway pulse -- -- -- --
Automatic parameterization
7
-- -- -- --
Pump cleaning -- -- -- --
Condition monitoring
SOFT STARTERS
-- -- -- --
User account administration8) -- -- -- --
Creep speed in both directions of rotation -- -- -- -- --
Reversing duty -- -- -- --
Reversing DC braking4)7) -- -- -- -- --
DC braking4)7) -- -- -- -- --
Dynamic DC braking4)7) -- -- -- -- --
Motor heating -- -- -- -- --
Communication function9) -- --
9) 9)
HMI module installable in the cabinet door -- --
9) 9)
Operating measured value display -- --
9) 9)
Logbooks -- --
9) 9)
Statistical data and slave pointer function -- --
Trace function8) -- -- -- --
Programmable control inputs and outputs -- -- -- --
Number of parameter sets 3 3 1 1 1 1
Parameterizable via software8) -- -- -- --
Number of controlled phases 3 3 3 2 2 2
Heavy starting CLASS 304) -- -- -- --
5) When using the motor
motor overload
overload protection
protection according
according to
to ATEX/IECEx,
ATEX/IECEx,an
an
Function available
-- Function not available upstream contactor may
may be
be required,
required, see
see page
page 6/11.
7/10.
6)
1)
Inside-delta circuit only up to operational voltage 600 V. Special device versions only.
2) 7) Not possible in inside-delta circuit.
Note derating above 40 °C.
3) Only soft starting available for 3RW30. 8)
With software Soft Starter ES (TIA Portal).
4) 9)
Calculate soft starter and motor with size allowance where required. Only in conjunction with special accessories.
NSB0_01704
of the required rated operational current of the motor. 100
7
Entering the motor and load data will simulate the application
and prompt suggestions for suitable soft starters.
SOFT STARTERS
Link to the free download of the Simulation Tool for Soft Starters
(STS).
• Simple, quick and user-friendly interface
• Detailed and up-to-date Siemens motor database, including
IE3/IE4 motors.
• Simulation of heavy starting up to CLASS 30
• Update-capable (e.g. motors, load types, functions)
• Fast simulations with minimum input data
• Immediate, graphical curve charts of start operations with limit
values
• Table view of suitable soft starters for the application Everything at a glance: Simulation and results list
6
be ordered separately. The harmonic component load for start-
ing currents must be taken into consideration for the selection of
motor starter protectors (selection of release). Please observe
the maximum switching frequencies specified in the technical
specifications.
Notes:
When three-phase motors are switched on, voltage drops occur
as a rule on starters of all types (direct-on-line starters, wye-delta
starters, soft starters). The infeed transformer must always be
Inline circuit: Rated current Ie corresponds to the rated motor current In, dimensioned such that the voltage dip when starting the motor
three cables to the motor remains within the permissible tolerance. If the infeed
transformer is dimensioned with only a small margin, it is best for
the control voltage to be supplied from a separate circuit
L1 NSB0_00425
L2
(independently of the main voltage) in order to avoid the
L3
potential switching off of the soft starter.
7
N
For dimensioning soft starters,
dimensioning soft starters, we
we recommend
recommend our
our Simulation
Simulation
PE
Tool for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see page 6/8 or
page 7/7
our Technical Support:
Technical Support:
SOFT STARTERS
https://support.industry.siemens.com/My/ww/en/requests.
https://support.industry.siemens.com/My/ww/en/requests.
U2 L2 Recommended parameters for the initial commissioning of our
U1 SIRIUS 3RW soft starters are listed in every report of our
T1 T2 Simulation Tool for Soft Starters (STS). In addition, our
V1 High Performance soft starters provide support by means of
L1 V2 their commissioning wizards.
W2 W1 T3 L3
The types of coordination are indicated in the overload release. That is the case for motor starter protectors
corresponding tables by the symbols shown on (e.g. SIRIUS 3RV20).
orange backgrounds.
Circuit breakers without an overload release (e.g. SIRIUS 3RV23
Feeder tests and events motor starter protectors) must not be used because they do not
provide overload protection. The feeder tests for these were
To keep the scope of feeder tests with SIRIUS 3RW soft starters therefore not performed. If the motor feeder with SIRIUS 3RW
within economically reasonable limits, tests were conducted with soft starters is configured without a fuse, motor starter protectors
feeder components (motor starter protectors/circuit breakers, must be used that ensure tripping on an overload.
fuses) that cover the greatest number of use cases (different soft
starter versions depending on, for example, line voltage, type of Motor protection
circuit, or necessary overdimensioning). For the combined tests If fuses are used to provide
provide protection
protection against
against overload
overload and
that were conducted, the values for the short-circuit breaking short circuit
circuit of
of the
the cables,
cables, the the motor
motorisisprotected
protectedby bythe
the
capacity Iq in kA were determined and documented. SIRIUS 3RW
3RW soft
softstarter.
starter.IfIfthe
theconstraints
constraints(simple
(simplestarting
starting
If the short-circuit breaking capacity is the same, of course, conditions CLASS
CLASS 10, 10, listed
listed maximum
maximumvalues values for
forstarting
starting
smaller circuit breakers or fuses can also be used for the current, starting
starting time
timeand
andnumber
numberofofstarts
startsper perhour)
hour)ofofpage
page6/8
7/7)
selected soft starter provided the dimensioning of the short- are observed,
observed, thethemotor
motorfeeders
feederscan canbe beconfigured
configuredaccording
accordingtoto
7
circuit components is suitable for the connected three-phase IEC as described in the section about soft soft starters
starters (an
(an optional
optional
motor and the line protection for the cables used. For type of line contactor
contactor isisnot
notrequired).
required).IfIfthese
thesepreconditions
preconditionsare aremet, thethe
met,
coordination "2" (with semiconductor protection), it is also SIRIUS 3RW
3RW soft
softstarters
startersareareable
abletototrip
tripononoverloads
overloadstoto protect
protect
SOFT STARTERS
necessary to compare the characteristics because the the motor
motor in
in any
any case.
case.
protection function would no longer be completely ensured if too In other starting conditions and on heavy starting, the following
small a fuse were selected. If the soft starter does not have a must be considered:
motor protection function, the motor protection must also be
dimensioned appropriately. Trip classes
Setting the motor current Tested fuseless switchgear assemblies comprising SIRIUS 3RW
soft starters and motor starter protectors only comply with
If circuit breakers with an overload release are used (e.g. SIRIUS CLASS 10.
3RV20 motor starter protector), we recommend activating the To configure tested motor feeders, for example, for CLASS 20 or
motor protection function of the SIRIUS 3RW soft starter to CLASS 30, fuses must be used together with SIRIUS 3RW soft
protect the motor and setting the soft starter to the rated opera- starters.
tional current Ie of the motor. We recommend setting the circuit
breaker in such a way that it provides line protection but does not Line contactor
usually trip before the soft starter when a motor overload occurs. In applications with high starting frequencies or heavy starting
Line protection and motor protection as of CLASS 20, we recommend combining fuses with the use of
a line contactor on the line side so that a motor overload is
Line protection and motor protection are not ensured in all disconnected by the fault signaling contact of the soft starter in
operating cases, depending on: any case (that is, even in rare cases in which disconnection by
• How the motor feeder is constructed (e.g. with fuses or motor the SIRIUS 3RW soft starter is no longer possible due to the
starter protectors) operating state of the thyristors).
• Whether the SIRIUS 3RW soft starters are operated within the
specification relevant for the tests (IEC 60947-4-2)
• documented constraints
• Or whether the documented constraints (see
(seepage
page7/7)
6/8)have
have
been observed.
observed
6
ATEX/IECEx chapters of the Equipment Manual
Manual for
for the
theselected
selected
Avoid impermissibly high cable surface temperatures by soft starter.
correctly dimensioning the cross-sections.
The cable cross-section must be adequately dimensioned.
■ Benefits
Can be flexibly deployed in many applications
Strong portfolio: Intelligent operation:
comprehensive, coordinated soft starter portfolio concentrated, application-specific functionality
6
• The right hardware for all requirements, • Can be used in a wide variety of applications:
soft starters for tasks ranging from simple to demanding starting in Basic, Pumping, ventilating, compressing, moving and processing
General and High Performance versions
• Integrated, self-learning automatic parameterization depending on motor
• Extensive portfolio for individual expansion: starting conditions
Optional HMIs for installation in the device or mounting on the control
cabinet door • Application-specific functionality such as pump cleaning and pump stop
7
hybrid switching technology on board data available whenever and wherever needed
SOFT STARTERS
• Energy-efficient switching and mechanical protection of the drive train • Support from tools and data during engineering
thanks to soft starters with hybrid switching technology
• Simulation Tool for Soft Starters for support during product selection
• Low-wear switching extends the service life of the devices
• Very simple, standardized commissioning and configuration via
• Soft starting prevents current peaks, thereby increasing the network Soft Starter ES in TIA Portal
stability
• Integration in the automation system via communication interfaces
• Protection against disturbances in the application.
Mechanical protection for the drive train • Data availability and analysis:
large volumes of data at any time and anywhere, even into MindSphere
Overview
More information
Homepage, see
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter
www.siemens.com/soft-starter Industry
Industry Online Support (SIOS)
(SIOS) topic
topicpage,
page,see
see
Industry
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW
www.siemens.com/product?3RW https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
TIA
TIA Selection
Selection Tool
Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST
(TST Cloud),
Cloud),see
see Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=Sirius3rwFolder
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw55 https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
SIRIUS Soft
SIRIUS Soft Starter
Starter ES
ES (TIA
(TIA Portal),
Portal), see page 14/2
6
5
6 1
7
7
SOFT STARTERS
IC01_00582a
4
2
2 Communication modules
6 HMI push-in lugs for wall mounting
3 Hinged cover
7 HMI IP65 door mounting kit
4 Fan covers
8 HMI soft starter connection cable
5 Terminal covers
■ Benefits
6
Automatic parameterization Extremely easy commissioning and reliability even under changing load
conditions
Hybrid switching devices and three-phase motor control Minimum power loss and optimum/symmetrical motor control
7
Integration into TIA Portal – communication modules optional Efficient configuration and maximum flexibility in automation engineering
SOFT STARTERS
Removable HMI with color display, local interface, slot for micro SD memory Maximum flexibility with regard to user interface and intuitive menu guidance
card
Pump stop and torque control Reduced mechanical loading and optimum pump stop control
Certified according to ATEX/IECEx directive Suitable for the starting of explosion-proof motors
■ Technical specifications
More information
Technical specifications,
Technical specifications,see
see FAQs,
FAQs, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25099/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25099/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25099/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25099/td Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
Equipment
Equipment Manual
Manual “SIRIUS
"SIRIUS 3RW55
3RW55 Soft Starter",
Starter”, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753752
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753752
6
side-by-side mounting
• Above mm 100
• At the side mm 5
• Below mm 75
Maximum installation m 5 000 2 000 5 000 2 000 5 000 2 000
altitude above sea level1)
Degree of protection IP00
Ambient conditions
Ambient temperature
• During operation2) °C -25 ... +60
• During storage and °C -40 ... +80
transport
Environmental category
according to IEC 60721
• During operation 3K6 (no ice formation, no condensation), 3C3 (no salt mist),
3S2 (sand must not get into the devices), 3M6
7
• During storage 1K6 (only occasional condensation), 1C2 (no salt mist),
1S2 (sand must not enter the devices), 1M4
SOFT STARTERS
• During transport 2K2, 2C1, 2S1, 2M2 (max. height of fall 0.3 m)
1)
Derating from 1 000
000 m,
m, see
seecharacteristic
characteristiccurve
curveon
onpage
page6/8.
7/7.
2) Note derating above 40 °C.
7
SOFT STARTERS
6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 13 13 13
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 29.6/27.2/23.6 33.5/30.5/27.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 26/23.6/21.2 29/26/23
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3 3
7
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8
SOFT STARTERS
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 13 13 13
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 25/22.3/19.6 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 77/68/62 93/82.5/75.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 25/22.3/19.6 43.4/38/34.4 53/48/43 68/62/56 82.5/75.5/65
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3 3
7
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8
SOFT STARTERS
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 5/25 10/47 13/63 16/77 19/93
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 8.7/43.3 17.3/81.4 22.5/109 27.7/133 32.9/161
Type 10
3RW5534 3RW5535 3RW5536
Rated operational current Ie A 113 143 171
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 113/101/89 143/128/118 171/153/141
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 113/101/89 143/128/118 171/153/141
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28 28
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 10 10
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 113/101/89 143/128/118 171/153/141
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 21 21 21
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 8 8 8
6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 13
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 109/97/85 128/113/103 141/129/117
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 89/81/74 108/98/88 117/105/93
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3
7
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8
SOFT STARTERS
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 13 13 10 2
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 2 --
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 162/146/130 200/180/160 231/207/183 258/230/202 272/254/236 284/262/240
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 138/122/106 160/140/120 183/159/135 202/174/160 210/190/170 220/200/180
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3 3 3
7
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4 4
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8
SOFT STARTERS
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 42/210 50/250 63/315 74/370 94/470 114/570
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 72.7/363 86.6/433 109.1/545 128.2/640 162.8/814 197.5/987
6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 10 9 1
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 2 2 1
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 500/450/400 520/470/420 570/520/470 920/840/760 980/900/810
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 380/340/300 400/360/320 420/380/340 740/670/600 790/720/650
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3 3
7
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8
SOFT STARTERS
Q1 Q1
Q11 Q11
NSB0_01902
IC01_00544
M M
3~ 3~
ToC
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5513 3RV2032-4TA10 65 3RV2032-4TA10 18 3RV2032-4DA10 65 3RV2032-4DA10 18
3RW5514 3RV2032-4DA10 65 3RV2032-4DA10 15 3RV2032-4EA10 65 3RV2032-4EA10 15
3RW5515 3RV2032-4EA10 65 3RV2032-4EA10 15 3RV2032-4VA10 65 3RV2032-4VA10 15
3RW5516 3RV2032-4VA10 65 3RV2032-4VA10 10 3RV2032-4JA10 65 3RV2032-4JA10 10
3RW5517 3RV2032-4WA10 65 3RV2032-4WA10 10 3RV2032-4RA10 65 3RV2032-4RA10 10
3RW5521 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- --
3RW5524 3RV2032-4JA10 65 3RV2032-4JA10 10 3RV2032-4RA10 65 3RV2032-4RA10 10
3RW5525 3VA2163-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2163-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5526 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5527 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 15 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 10 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 15 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 10
3RW5534 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- -- 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- --
3RW5535 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- -- 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- --
3RW5536 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 30 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 10 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 30 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 10
3RW5543 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5544 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5545 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
7
3RW5546 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5547 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5548 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65
SOFT STARTERS
3RW5552 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65
3RW5553 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65
3RW5554 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65
3RW5556 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 -- -- -- --
3RW5558 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 -- -- -- --
Note:
The service factor or measurement inaccuracies have been
taken into account, for example, for the selection of the specified
motor starter protectors/circuit breakers; the specified short-
circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are covered by combination
tests. Smaller motor starter protectors/circuit breakers than
those specified can be used at any time as smaller ones trip
more quickly in the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-
circuit breaking capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any
case. The dimensioning of the short-circuit components must,
however, be suitable for the connected three-phase motor and
the line protection for the cables used.
In 690 V systems, in motor feeder tests with soft starters demon-
strable short-circuit breaking capacities can only be achieved
with the use of fuses (Iq > 5 to 10 kA).
F1 F1 F1
IC01_00545a
NSB0_01904
IC01_00565
M M M
3~ 3~ 3~
Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor (optional) gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)
for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems
up to 690 V up to 480 V up to 690 V up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V
6
in the supply in the supply in the delta in the delta
cable cable
Q11 F1 Q21 Q21 F1 Q21 Q21 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5513 3NA3820-6 3RT2025 3RT2025 3NA3820-6 3RT2027 3RT2035 3RT2025 3RT2025
3RW5514 3NA3820-6 3RT2026 3RT2027 3NA3820-6 3RT2027 3RT2037 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW5515 3NA3822-6 3RT2027 3RT2037 3NA3822-6 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5516 3NA3824-6 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2037 3RT2038 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5517 3NA3824-6 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2038 3RT2046 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5521 3NA3824-6 3RT2027 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5524 3NA3824-6 3RT2036 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2046 3RT2047 3RT2036 3RT2037
3RW5525 3NA3830-6 3RT2037 3RT2046 3NA3830-6 3RT2047 3RT1054 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW5526 3NA3132-6 3RT2038 3RT2046 3NA3132-6 3RT1055 3RT1055 3RT2038 3RT2046
3RW5527 3NA3136-6 3RT2046 3RT2047 3NA3136-6 3RT1056 3RT1056 3RT2046 3RT2047
7
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
In inside-delta circuits, motor feeders with soft starters can only
be operated in systems with up to 600 V.
F’1
Q21
Q11
NSB0_01905
M
3~
7
3RW5536 3NE1230-0 3RT1056 3RT1064
3RW5543 3NE1230-21) 3RT1064 3RT1064
SOFT STARTERS
3RW5544 3NE1331-0 3RT1065 3RT1065
3RW5545 3NE1334-2 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5546 3NE1334-2 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5547 3NE1436-2 3RT1076 3RT1276
3RW5548 3NE1437-2 3TF68 3TF68
3RW5552 3NB3350-1KK26 3TF68 3TF69
3RW5553 3NB3351-1KK26 3TF69 3TF69
3RW5554 3NB3351-1KK26 -- --
3RW5556 3NB3354-1KK26 -- --
3RW5558 3NB3357-1KK26 -- --
1)
For systems up to 500 V.
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
In inside-delta
inside-delta circuits,
circuits, aa gR
gRclass
classfull-range
full-rangefuse
fusecould
couldnotnot
provide the semiconductor
semiconductor protection
protection ofof the
the delta-connected
delta-connected
soft starter with a short-circuit breaking capacitythat
breaking capacity thatisisade-
ade-
quate for practical
practical use.
use. InIn this
this case,
case,wewerecommend
recommendusing using
aR class partial-range
partial-range fuses
fusesforforsemiconductor
semiconductorprotection
protectionfor
for
type of coordination "2" (see
coordination “2” (see page
page 6/25).
7/24).
F1 F1 F1
IC01_00546a
IC01_00566
M M M
3~ 3~ 3~
Soft starters gG class fuse aR class fuse Line contactor gG class fuse aR class fuse Line contactor (optional)
(optional)
6
for systems for systems for sys- for sys- for systems for systems for systems for systems for sys- for sys-
up to 690 V up to 690 V tems tems up to 600 V up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V tems tems
up to up to in the sup- in the sup- up to up to
480 V 690 V ply cable ply cable 480 V 600 V
in the delta in the delta
Q11 F1 F3 Q21 Q21 F1 F3 Q21 Q21 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW5513 3NA3820-6 3NE8017-1 3RT2025 3RT2025 3NA3820-6 3NE8017-1 3RT2027 3RT2035 3RT2025 3RT2025
3RW5514 3NA3820-6 3NE8020-1 3RT2026 3RT2027 3NA3820-6 3NE8020-1 3RT2027 3RT2037 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW5515 3NA3822-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2027 3RT2037 3NA3822-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5516 3NA3824-6 3NE8022-1 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8022-1 3RT2037 3RT2038 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5517 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2038 3RT2046 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5521 3NA3824-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2027 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5524 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2036 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2046 3RT2047 3RT2036 3RT2037
3RW5525 3NA3830-6 3NE3227 3RT2037 3RT2046 3NA3830-6 3NE3227 3RT2047 3RT1054 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW5526 3NA3132-6 3NE3227 3RT2038 3RT2046 3NA3132-6 3NE3227 3RT1055 3RT1055 3RT2038 3RT2046
7
3RW5527 3NA3136-6 3NE3227 3RT2046 3RT2047 3NA3136-6 3NE3227 3RT1056 3RT1056 3RT2046 3RT2047
3RW5534 3NA3244-6 3NE3231 3RT1054 3RT1054 3NA3244-6 3NE3231 3RT1064 3RT1064 3RT1054 3RT1054
SOFT STARTERS
3RW5535 3NA3244-6 3NE3233 3RT1055 3RT1055 3NA3244-6 3NE3233 3RT1065 3RT1065 3RT1055 3RT1055
3RW5536 3NA3365-6 3NE3334-0B 3RT1056 3RT1064 3NA3365-6 3NE3334-0B 3RT1066 3RT1075 3RT1056 3RT1064
3RW5543 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3333 3RT1064 3RT1064 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3333 3RT1075 3RT1075 3RT1064 3RT1064
3RW5544 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3335 3RT1065 3RT1065 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3335 3RT1076 3RT1076 3RT1065 3RT1065
3RW5545 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3RT1075 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3TF68 3TF68 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5546 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3RT1075 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3TF69 3TF69 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5547 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3RT1076 3RT1276 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3TF69 3TF69 3RT1076 3RT1276
3RW5548 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3342-1U 3TF68 3TF68 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3342-1U -- -- 3TF68 3TF68
3RW5552 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3343-1U 3TF68 3TF69 -- 3NC3343-1U -- -- 3TF68 3TF69
3RW5553 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3343-1U 3TF69 3TF69 -- 3NC3343-1U -- -- 3TF69 3TF69
3RW5554 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3343-1U -- -- -- 3NC3343-1U -- -- -- --
3RW5556 3 x 3NA3365-6 3 x 3NE3340-8 -- -- -- 3 x 3NE3340-8 -- -- -- --
3RW5558 3 x 3NA3365-6 3 x 3NE3340-8 -- -- -- 3 x 3NE3340-8 -- -- -- --
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are For CLASS 10 applications,
applications, asas an
an alternative
alternativeto the gG
to the gGclass
class
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci- full-range fuses
fuses for
for cable
cable and
andline
lineprotection
protection3NA3
3NA3(F1),
(F1),
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in 3RV2/3VA
3RV2/3VA motor
motor starter
starter protectors/circuit
protectors/circuit breakers
breakers can also bebe
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking used, possibly with reduced
possibly with reduced short-circuit
short-circuitbreaking
breakingcapacity
capacity
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The (see page 7/21).
6/22). In these cases, optional line contactors can be
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be dispensed with.
dispensed with.
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used. In inside-delta circuits, motor feeders with soft starters can only
be operated in systems with up to 600 V.
7
3RW55 Equipment Manual, Appendix A.3)
Soft starters DC braking contactor DC braking contactor assembly
SOFT STARTERS
for systems up to 400 V for systems up to 480 V for systems up to 690 V
with 2 NC contacts + with 3 NO contacts with 3 NO contacts with 3 NO contacts with 3 NO contacts
2 NO contacts parallel parallel parallel parallel parallel
Q11 Q93 Q91 Q92 Q91 Q92
Type Type Type Type Type Type
3RW5513 3RT2517 3RT2015 3RT2016 3RT2015 3RT2016
3RW5514 3RT2518 3RT2015 3RT2017 3RT2015 3RT2023
3RW5515 3RT2526 3RT2015 3RT2025 3RT2015 3RT2025
3RW5516 3RT2526 3RT2015 3RT2025 3RT2015 3RT2027
3RW5517 3RT2535 3RT2015 3RT2027 3RT2015 3RT2027
3RW5521 3RT2526 3RT2015 3RT2025 3RT2015 3RT2025
3RW5524 3RT2535 3RT2016 3RT2027 3RT2016 3RT2035
3RW5525 -- 3RT2024 3RT2027 3RT2024 3RT2037
3RW5526 -- 3RT2025 3RT2035 3RT2025 3RT2037
3RW5527 -- 3RT2027 3RT2036 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5534 -- 3RT2035 3RT2037 3RT2035 3RT2038
3RW5535 -- 3RT2036 3RT2038 3RT2036 3RT2046
3RW5536 -- 3RT2037 3RT2046 3RT2037 3RT2047
3RW5543 -- 3RT2045 3RT2047 3RT2045 3RT1054
3RW5544 -- 3RT2045 3RT1055 3RT2045 3RT1055
3RW5545 -- 3RT2446 3RT1056 3RT2446 3RT1056
3RW5546 -- 3RT1055 3RT1056 3RT1055 3RT1064
3RW5547 -- 3RT1456 3RT1065 3RT1456 3RT1065
3RW5548 -- 3RT1456 3RT1066 3RT1456 3RT1075
3RW5552 -- 3RT1065 3RT1075 3RT1065 3RT1075
3RW5553 -- 3RT1065 3RT1075 3RT1065 3RT1075
3RW5554 -- 3RT1466 3RT1076 3RT1466 3RT1076
3RW5556 -- 3RT1476 3TF68 3RT1476 3TF68
3RW5558 -- 3RT1476 3TF69 3RT1476 3TF69
3RW551. 3RW552.
6
13 3 5.5 -- -- 11.5 2 3 7.5 -- 5 3RW5513-@HA@4 1 1 unit
18 4 7.5 -- -- 15.9 3 5 10 -- 5 3RW5514-@HA@4 1 1 unit
25 5.5 11 -- -- 22.3 5 7.5 15 -- 5 3RW5515-@HA@4 1 1 unit
32 7.5 15 -- -- 28.4 7.5 10 20 -- 5 3RW5516-@HA@4 1 1 unit
38 11 18.5 -- -- 33.5 10 10 20 -- 5 3RW5517-@HA@4 1 1 unit
47 11 22 -- -- 41.6 10 10 30 -- 5 3RW5524-@HA@4 1 1 unit
63 18.5 30 -- -- 55.5 15 20 40 -- 5 3RW5525-@HA@4 1 1 unit
77 22 37 -- -- 68 20 25 50 -- 5 3RW5526-@HA@4 1 1 unit
93 22 45 -- -- 82.5 25 30 60 -- 5 3RW5527-@HA@4 1 1 unit
1) 3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
SOFT STARTERS
Note:
For the constraints
constraints for
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page
7
Control supply voltage
SOFT STARTERS
24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
Note:
For the constraints
constraints for
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page
3RW551. 3RW552.
6
25 5.5 11 15 -- 22.3 5 7.5 15 20 5 3RW5515-@HA@5 1 1 unit
32 7.5 15 18.5 -- 28.4 7.5 10 20 25 5 3RW5516-@HA@5 1 1 unit
38 11 18.5 22 -- 33.5 10 10 20 30 5 3RW5517-@HA@5 1 1 unit
Operational voltage 200 ... 690 V
25 5.5 11 15 22 22.3 5 7.5 15 20 5 3RW5521-@HA@6 1 1 unit
47 11 22 30 45 41.6 10 10 30 40 5 3RW5524-@HA@6 1 1 unit
63 18.5 30 37 55 55.5 15 20 40 50 5 3RW5525-@HA@6 1 1 unit
77 22 37 45 75 68 20 25 50 60 5 3RW5526-@HA@6 1 1 unit
93 22 45 55 90 82.5 25 30 60 75 5 3RW5527-@HA@6 1 1 unit
1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 690 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 2 days (d).
SOFT STARTERS
Note:
For the constraints
constraints for
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page
7
Control supply voltage
SOFT STARTERS
24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 690 V:
- Sizes 3 and 4: Standard delivery time SD = 2 days (d).
- Size 5: Standard delivery time SD = 5 days (d).
Note:
For the constraints
constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page
3RW551. 3RW552.
At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
6
22.5 5.5 11 -- 19.9 5 5 10 -- 5 3RW5513-@HA@4 1 1 unit
31.5 7.5 15 -- 28 7.5 7.5 20 -- 5 3RW5514-@HA@4 1 1 unit
43.3 11 18.5 -- 39 10 10 25 -- 5 3RW5515-@HA@4 1 1 unit
55.4 15 22 -- 49 15 15 30 -- 5 3RW5516-@HA@4 1 1 unit
65.8 18.5 30 -- 58 15 20 40 -- 5 3RW5517-@HA@4 1 1 unit
81.4 22 45 -- 72 20 25 50 -- 5 3RW5524-@HA@4 1 1 unit
109 30 55 -- 96 30 30 75 -- 5 3RW5525-@HA@4 1 1 unit
133 37 75 -- 118 30 40 75 -- 5 3RW5526-@HA@4 1 1 unit
161 45 90 -- 143 40 50 100 -- 5 3RW5527-@HA@4 1 1 unit
1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
SOFT STARTERS
Note:
For the constraints
constraints for
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page
At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for three- Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
196 55 110 -- 175 50 60 125 -- 5 3RW5534-@HA@4 1 1 unit
6
7
Control supply voltage
SOFT STARTERS
24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
Note:
For the constraints
constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page
3RW551. 3RW552.
At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 600 V
22.5 5.5 11 15 19.9 5 5 10 15 5 3RW5513-@HA@5 1 1 unit
31.5 7.5 15 18.5 28 7.5 7.5 20 25 5 3RW5514-@HA@5 1 1 unit
6
43.3 11 18.5 22 39 10 10 25 30 5 3RW5515-@HA@5 1 1 unit
55.4 15 22 30 49 15 15 30 40 5 3RW5516-@HA@5 1 1 unit
65.8 18.5 30 37 58 15 20 40 50 5 3RW5517-@HA@5 1 1 unit
43.3 11 18.5 22 39 10 10 25 30 5 3RW5521-@HA@6 1 1 unit
81.4 22 45 45 72 20 25 50 60 5 3RW5524-@HA@6 1 1 unit
109 30 55 55 96 30 30 75 75 5 3RW5525-@HA@6 1 1 unit
133 37 75 90 118 30 40 75 100 5 3RW5526-@HA@6 1 1 unit
161 45 90 110 143 40 50 100 125 5 3RW5527-@HA@6 1 1 unit
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 600 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 2 days (d).
Note:
SOFT STARTERS
At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 600 V
196 55 110 132 175 50 60 125 150 5 3RW5534-@HA@6 1 1 unit
6
7
Control supply voltage
SOFT STARTERS
24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 600 V:
- Sizes 3 and 4: Standard delivery time SD = 2 days (d).
- Size 5: Standard delivery time SD = 5 days (d).
Note:
For
For the constraints for
the constraints forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page
3RW5983-0TC20
3RW554 (2x) -- -- } 3RW5984-0TC20 1 1 unit
6
3RW5984-0TC20
Enclosure components
Hinged cover 3RW55 Without cutout -- } 3RW5950-0GL20 1 1 unit
3RW5950-0GL20
Communication modules
7
switch
PROFINET -- } 3RW5980-0CS00 1 1 unit
Standard
PROFIBUS -- } 3RW5980-0CP00 1 1 unit
3RW5980-0CS00
EtherNet/IP -- } 3RW5980-0CE00 1 1 unit
3RW5980-0CE00
Modbus RTU -- } 3RW5980-0CR00 1 1 unit
Modbus TCP -- } 3RW5980-0CT00 1 1 unit
3RW5980-0CR00
3RW5980-0HD00
Connecting cables
HMI connec- 3RW55 5 m, round For door } 3RW5980-0HC60 1 1 unit
tion cable 2.5 m, round mounting } 3UF7933-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
1.0 m, round } 3UF7937-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
0.5 m, round } 3UF7932-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
6
3UF793.-0BA00-0
Further accessories
Push-in lugs -- Two lugs are For HMI 2 3ZY1311-0AA00 1 10 units
for wall mount- required per modules and
ing device communica-
tion modules
3ZY1311-0AA00
Blank labels
Unit labeling 20 mm x For SIRIUS 20 3RT2900-1SB20 100 340 units
plates1) 7 mm, devices
titanium gray
IC01_00181
7
3RT2900-1SB20
SOFT STARTERS
3RW55 starter kit
SIRIUS 3RW55 -- Including 5 3RW5951-1ES04 1 1 unit
starter kit 3RW55 soft starter 13 A,
200 ... 480 V, 24 V AC/DC
Soft Starter ES V15.1,
24 V power supply unit,
connecting cable and
RJ45 network cable
3RW5951-1ES04
1)
PC labeling systems for individual inscription of unit labeling plates are
available from: murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (see page 16/15).
Overview
More information
Homepage, see
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter
www.siemens.com/soft-starter Simulation
Simulation Tool
Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
Industry
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW
www.siemens.com/product?3RW https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
Industry
Industry Online
Online Support
Support (SIOS)
(SIOS)topic
topicpage,
page,see
see SIRIUS Soft
SIRIUS Soft Starter
Starter ES
ES (TIA
(TIA Portal),
Portal), see page 14/2
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
6
5
1
6
7
7
SOFT STARTERS
IC01_00690
4
2
2 Communication modules
6 HMI push-in lugs for wall mounting
3 Hinged cover
7 HMI IP65 door mounting kit
4 Fan covers
8 HMI soft starter connection cable
5 Terminal covers
3RW55 Failsafe
3RW55 High Performance
Failsafe High Performancesoft
softstarters
starterswith
withaccessories,
accessories see
(seepage
page7/51.
6/52)
■ Benefits
6
Automatic parameterization Extremely easy commissioning and reliability even under changing load
conditions
Hybrid switching devices and three-phase motor control Minimum power loss and optimum/symmetrical motor control
7
Integration into TIA Portal – communication modules optional Efficient configuration and maximum flexibility in automation engineering
SOFT STARTERS
Removable HMI with color display, local interface, slot for micro SD memory Maximum flexibility with regard to user interface and intuitive menu guidance
card
Pump stop and torque control Reduced mechanical loading and optimum pump stop control
Certified according to ATEX/IECEx directive Suitable for the starting of explosion-proof motors
Fail-safe disconnection up to SIL 3 - PL e / STO Reduced costs and space requirements thanks to direct wiring of the
EMERGENCY STOP mushroom pushbutton to the soft starter for SIL 1
Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data NEW NEU
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
■ Technical specifications
More information
Technical specifications,
Technical specifications,see
see FAQs,
FAQs, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25776/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25776/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25776/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25776/td Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
Equipment
Equipment Manual
Manual “SIRIUS
"SIRIUS 3RW55
3RW55 Soft Starter",
Starter”, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753752
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753752
D
W
6
• Below mm 75
Maximum installation altitude above sea level1) m 2 000
Degree of protection IP00
Ambient conditions
Ambient temperature
• During operation2) °C -25 ... +60
• During storage and transport °C -40 ... +80
Environmental category according to IEC 60721
• During operation 3K6 (no ice formation, no condensation), 3C3 (no salt mist),
3S2 (sand must not get into the devices), 3M6
• During storage 1K6 (only occasional condensation), 1C2 (no salt mist),
1S2 (sand must not enter the devices), 1M4
• During transport 2K2, 2C1, 2S1, 2M2 (max. height of fall 0.3 m)
1)
Derating from 1 000
000 m,
m, see
seecharacteristic
characteristiccurve
curveon
onpage
page6/8.
7/7.
2) Note derating above 40 °C.
7
SOFT STARTERS
Type 3RW55..-.HF.4
Power electronics
Operational voltage, rated value V 200 ... 480
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -15/10
Operational voltage for inside-delta circuit, rated value V 200 ... 480
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -15/10
6
7
SOFT STARTERS
Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
NEW NEU
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 13 13 13
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 29.6/27.2/23.6 33.5/30.5/27.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 26/23.6/21.2 29/26/23
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3 3
7
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
SOFT STARTERS
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 13 13
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 77/68/62 93/82.5/75.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 0 0 0
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 43.4/38/34.4 53/48/43 68/62/56 82.5/75.5/65
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3
7
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4
SOFT STARTERS
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 10/47 13/63 16/77 19/93
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 17.3/81.4 22.5/109 27.7/133 32.9/161
Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
NEW NEU
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 4 0
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 0 0
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 109/97/85 128/113/103 141/129/117
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 6 6
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 0 0 0
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 89/81/74 108/98/88 117/105/93
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3
7
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4
SOFT STARTERS
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 0 13 5 12 6 1
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 0 4 0 3 0.4 --
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 162/146/130 200/180/160 231/207/183 258/230/202 272/254/236 284/262/240
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 138/122/106 160/140/120 183/159/135 202/174/160 210/190/170 220/200/180
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3 3 3
7
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4 4
SOFT STARTERS
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 42/210 50/250 63/315 74/370 94/470 114/570
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 72.7/363 86.6/433 109.1/545 128.2/640 162.8/814 197.5/987
Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
NEW NEU
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3RV2/3VA motor starter protectors/circuit breakers (without semiconductor protection)
Type of coordination "1", CLASS 10,
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq in kA, see table
Note:
generalrecommendations
For general recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.
Q1 Q1
Q11 Q11
NSB0_01902
IC01_00544
M M
3~ 3~
6
ToC
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5513 3RV2032-4TA10 65 3RV2032-4TA10 18 3RV2032-4DA10 65 3RV2032-4DA10 18
3RW5514 3RV2032-4DA10 65 3RV2032-4DA10 15 3RV2032-4EA10 65 3RV2032-4EA10 15
3RW5515 3RV2032-4EA10 65 3RV2032-4EA10 15 3RV2032-4VA10 65 3RV2032-4VA10 15
3RW5516 3RV2032-4VA10 65 3RV2032-4VA10 10 3RV2032-4JA10 65 3RV2032-4JA10 10
3RW5517 3RV2032-4WA10 65 3RV2032-4WA10 10 3RV2032-4RA10 65 3RV2032-4RA10 10
3RW5524 3RV2032-4JA10 65 3RV2032-4JA10 10 3RV2032-4RA10 65 3RV2032-4RA10 10
3RW5525 3VA2163-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2163-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5526 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5527 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 15 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 10 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 15 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 10
3RW5534 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- -- 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- --
3RW5535 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- -- 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- --
3RW5536 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 30 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 10 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 30 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 10
3RW5543 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5544 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5545 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5546 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
7
Note:
The service factor or measurement inaccuracies have been
taken into account, for example, for the selection of the specified
motor starter protectors/circuit breakers; the specified short-
circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are covered by combination
tests. Smaller motor starter protectors/circuit breakers than
those specified can be used at any time as smaller ones trip
more quickly in the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-
circuit breaking capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any
case. The dimensioning of the short-circuit components must,
however, be suitable for the connected three-phase motor and
the line protection for the cables used.
F1 F1 F1
IC01_00545a
NSB0_01904
IC01_00565
M M M
3~ 3~ 3~
Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)
(optional)
for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems
6
7
3RW5535 3NA3244-6 3RT1055 3NA3244-6 3RT1065 3RT1055
3RW5536 3NA3365-6 3RT1056 3NA3365-6 3RT1066 3RT1056
3RW5543 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1064 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1075 3RT1064
SOFT STARTERS
3RW5544 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1065 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1076 3RT1065
3RW5545 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF68 3RT1075
3RW5546 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF69 3RT1075
3RW5547 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1076 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF69 3RT1076
3RW5548 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF68 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3TF68
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
F’1
Q21
Q11
NSB0_01905
M
3~
6
up to 480 V up to 480 V
Q11 F’1 Q21
Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW5513 3NE1815-0 3RT2025
3RW5514 3NE1802-0 3RT2026
3RW5515 3NE1817-0 3RT2027
3RW5516 3NE1818-0 3RT2035
3RW5517 3NE1820-0 3RT2035
3RW5524 3NE1021-2 3RT2036
3RW5525 3NE1022-0 3RT2037
3RW5526 3NE1224-0 3RT2038
3RW5527 3NE1224-0 3RT2046
3RW5534 3NE1225-0 3RT1054
3RW5535 3NE1227-0 3RT1055
3RW5536 3NE1230-0 3RT1056
7
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
inside-delta circuits,
In inside-delta circuits,aagR
gRclass
classfull-range
full-rangefuse
fusecould
couldnotnot
provide the
provide the semiconductor
semiconductor protection
protectionof ofthe
thedelta-connected
delta-connected
soft starter with a short-circuit breaking
breaking capacity
capacitythat
thatisis
adequate for
adequate for practical
practicaluse.
use.InInthis
thiscase,
case,we werecommend
recommendusing using
class partial-range
aR class partial-rangefuses
fusesfor
forsemiconductor
semiconductorprotection
protectionforfor
coordination “2”
type of coordination "2" (see page 7/47).
6/48).
F1 F1 F1
IC01_00546a
IC01_00566
M M M
3~ 3~ 3~
Soft starters gG class fuse aR class fuse Line contactor gG class fuse aR class fuse Line contactor (optional)
(optional)
6
for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems
up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V
in the supply in the delta
cable
Q11 F1 F3 Q21 F1 F3 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW5513 3NA3820-6 3NE8017-1 3RT2025 3NA3820-6 3NE8017-1 3RT2027 3RT2025
3RW5514 3NA3820-6 3NE8020-1 3RT2026 3NA3820-6 3NE8020-1 3RT2027 3RT2026
3RW5515 3NA3822-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2027 3NA3822-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2036 3RT2027
3RW5516 3NA3824-6 3NE8022-1 3RT2035 3NA3824-6 3NE8022-1 3RT2037 3RT2035
3RW5517 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2035 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2038 3RT2035
3RW5524 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2036 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2046 3RT2036
3RW5525 3NA3830-6 3NE3227 3RT2037 3NA3830-6 3NE3227 3RT2047 3RT2037
3RW5526 3NA3132-6 3NE3227 3RT2038 3NA3132-6 3NE3227 3RT1055 3RT2038
3RW5527 3NA3136-6 3NE3227 3RT2046 3NA3136-6 3NE3227 3RT1056 3RT2046
7
3RW5534 3NA3244-6 3NE3231 3RT1054 3NA3244-6 3NE3231 3RT1064 3RT1054
3RW5535 3NA3244-6 3NE3233 3RT1055 3NA3244-6 3NE3233 3RT1065 3RT1055
3RW5536 3NA3365-6 3NE3334-0B 3RT1056 3NA3365-6 3NE3334-0B 3RT1066 3RT1056
SOFT STARTERS
3RW5543 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3333 3RT1064 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3333 3RT1075 3RT1064
3RW5544 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3335 3RT1065 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3335 3RT1076 3RT1065
3RW5545 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3TF68 3RT1075
3RW5546 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3TF69 3RT1075
3RW5547 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3RT1076 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3TF69 3RT1076
3RW5548 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3342-1U 3TF68 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3342-1U -- 3TF68
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
For
For CLASS
CLASS 10
10 applications,
applications, asas an
an alternative
alternative to
to the
the gG
gG class
class
full-range fuses for
full-range fuses for cable
cable and
andline
lineprotection
protection3NA3
3NA3(F1),
(F1),
3RV2/3VA
3RV2/3VA motor
motor starter
starter protectors/circuit
protectors/circuit breakers
breakers can
can also be
also be
used,
used, possibly with reduced
possibly with reduced short-circuit
short-circuitbreaking
breakingcapacity
capacity
(see
(see page 6/45). In
page 7/44). In these
these cases,
cases, optional
optional line contactors can
line contactors can be
be
dispensed with.
dispensed with.
6
3RW5543 -- 3RT1064
3RW5544 -- 3RT1065
3RW5545 -- 3RT1075
3RW5546 -- 3RT1075
3RW5547 -- 3RT1076
3RW5548 -- 3TF68
7
SOFT STARTERS
7
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page
SOFT STARTERS
At 40 °C At 50 °C SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At current At At At
230 V 400 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V
A kW kW A hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
113 30 55 101 30 30 75 5 3RW5534-@HF@4 1 1 unit
143 37 75 128 40 40 100 5 3RW5535-@HF@4 1 1 unit
171 45 90 153 50 50 100 5 3RW5536-@HF@4 1 1 unit
210 55 110 186 50 60 150 5 3RW5543-@HF@4 1 1 unit
250 75 132 220 60 75 150 5 3RW5544-@HF@4 1 1 unit
315 90 160 279 75 100 200 5 3RW5545-@HF@4 1 1 unit
370 110 200 328 100 125 250 5 3RW5546-@HF@4 1 1 unit
470 132 250 416 150 150 350 5 3RW5547-@HF@4 1 1 unit
570 160 315 504 150 200 400 5 3RW5548-@HF@4 1 1 unit
6
43.3 11 18.5 39 10 10 25 5 3RW5515-@HF@4 1 1 unit
55.4 15 22 49 15 15 30 5 3RW5516-@HF@4 1 1 unit
65.8 18.5 30 58 15 20 40 5 3RW5517-@HF@4 1 1 unit
81.4 22 45 72 20 25 50 5 3RW5524-@HF@4 1 1 unit
109 30 55 96 30 30 75 5 3RW5525-@HF@4 1 1 unit
133 37 75 118 30 40 75 5 3RW5526-@HF@4 1 1 unit
161 45 90 143 40 50 100 5 3RW5527-@HF@4 1 1 unit
pagepage
see 6/8.7/7.
SOFT STARTERS
At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At current At At At
230 V 400 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V
A kW kW A hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
196 55 110 175 50 60 125 5 3RW5534-@HF@4 1 1 unit
248 75 132 222 75 75 150 5 3RW5535-@HF@4 1 1 unit
296 90 160 265 75 100 200 5 3RW5536-@HF@4 1 1 unit
364 110 200 322 100 125 250 5 3RW5543-@HF@4 1 1 unit
433 132 250 381 125 150 300 5 3RW5544-@HF@4 1 1 unit
546 160 315 483 150 200 400 5 3RW5545-@HF@4 1 1 unit
641 200 355 568 200 200 450 5 3RW5546-@HF@4 1 1 unit
814 250 400 721 250 250 600 5 3RW5547-@HF@4 1 1 unit
987 315 560 873 300 350 750 5 3RW5548-@HF@4 1 1 unit
1) Note:
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d). For the
For the constraints
constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
pagepage
see 6/8.7/7.
3RW5983-0TC20
3RW5984-0TC20
Enclosure components
Hinged cover 3RW55 Without cutout -- } 3RW5950-0GL20 1 1 unit
3RW5950-0GL20
Communication modules
7
Communica- 3RW55 PROFINET -- } 3RW5950-0CH00 1 1 unit
tion module High Feature
SOFT STARTERS
with integral
switch
PROFINET -- } 3RW5980-0CS00 1 1 unit
Standard
PROFIBUS -- } 3RW5980-0CP00 1 1 unit
3RW5980-0CS00
3RW5980-0CE00
Modbus RTU -- } 3RW5980-0CR00 1 1 unit
Modbus TCP -- } 3RW5980-0CT00 1 1 unit
3RW5980-0CR00
3RW5980-0HD00
Connecting cables
HMI connec- 3RW55 5 m, round For door } 3RW5980-0HC60 1 1 unit
tion cable 2.5 m, round mounting } 3UF7933-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
1.0 m, round } 3UF7937-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
0.5 m, round } 3UF7932-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
6
3UF793.-0BA00-0
Further accessories
Push-in lugs -- Two lugs are For HMI 2 3ZY1311-0AA00 1 10 units
for wall mount- required per modules and
ing device communica-
tion modules
3ZY1311-0AA00
Blank labels
Unit labeling -- 20 mm x For SIRIUS 20 3RT2900-1SB20 100 340 units
plates1) 7 mm, devices
titanium gray
IC01_00181
7
3RT2900-1SB20
SOFT STARTERS
Overview
More information
Homepage, www.siemens.com/soft-starter
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter Industry
Industry Online Support (SIOS)
(SIOS) topic
topic page,
page,see
see
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW52
www.siemens.com/product?3RW52 https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
TIA Selection
TIA Selection Tool
Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST
(TST Cloud),
Cloud),see
see Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw52
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw52 https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
SIRIUS Soft
SIRIUS Soft Starter
Starter ES
ES(TIA
(TIA Portal)
Portal),for
see page 14/5 see page 14/5
diagnostics,
7
4
7
SOFT STARTERS
2
IC01_00581a
5
3
2 HMI modules
3 Communication modules
7 Push-in lugs for wall mounting
4 Hinged cover
8 IP65 door mounting kit
5 Fan covers
9 HMI soft starter connection cable
6 Terminal covers
3RW52 General
General Performance
Performance soft
soft starters
starters with
with accessories
accessories(see
(seepage 6/70),for
page7/69), forexpansion
expansionwith
withHMI
HMImodule
moduleororcommunication
communicationmodule
module
■ Benefits
6
Product characteristics / function Performance features / benefits
Hybrid switching devices and three-phase motor control Minimum power loss and optimum/symmetrical motor control
TIA-Integration – communication modules and HMI modules optional Efficient configuration and maximum flexibility in automation engineering
Wide range for control supply and main voltage Low variance, high system availability even with weak supply networks
Technical specifications
More information
Technical specifications,see
Technical specifications, see FAQs,
FAQs, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25100/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25100/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25100/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25100/td Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
Equipment Manual
Manual “SIRIUS
"SIRIUS 3RW52 Soft Starter",
Starter”, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753751
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753751
can be rotated can be rotated can be rotated for vertical mounting surface can be
+/- 10° and tilted +/- 90°, +/- 10° and tilted tilted +/- 22.5° forward or backward
forward or for vertical forward or
backward mounting surface backward
can be tilted
+/- 22.5° forward
or backward
Distance to be maintained with side-by-side mounting
• Above mm 100
• At the side mm 5
• Below mm 75
Maximum installation altitude above sea level1) m 5 000
Degree of protection IP00
Ambient conditions
Ambient temperature
• During operation2) °C -25 ... +60
7
• During storage and transport °C -40 ... +80
Environmental category according to IEC 60721
SOFT STARTERS
• During operation 3K6 (no ice formation, no condensation), 3C3 (no salt mist),
3S2 (sand must not get into the devices), 3M6
• During storage 1K6 (only occasional condensation), 1C2 (no salt mist),
1S2 (sand must not enter the devices), 1M4
• During transport 2K2, 2C1, 2S1, 2M2 (max. height of fall 0.3 m)
1) Derating
Derating from 1 000 m,
m, see
see characteristic
characteristiccurve
curveon
onpage
page6/8.
7/7.
2)
Note derating above 40 °C.
6
Operating frequency, rated value Hz 50 ... 60
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -10/10
Minimum load [% of IM]1) % 15
Maximum cable length between soft starter and motor m 800
1) Relative to the smallest adjustable Ie.
7
SOFT STARTERS
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 13 13 13 13 13
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 29.6/27.2/23.6 33.5/30.5/27.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 5.5/13 7.5/18 11.5/25 14/32 15.5/38
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 9.5/22.5 13/31.2 19.9/43.3 24.2/55.4 26.8/65.8
7
SOFT STARTERS
6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 13 13 13 13
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 65/59/53 93/82.5/75.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 3 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 4 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2 0 2.5 2.5
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 20/47 25.5/63 32/77 40.5/93
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 34.6/81.4 44.2/109 55.4/133 70.1/161
7
SOFT STARTERS
Type 10
3RW5234 3RW5235 3RW5236
Rated operational current Ie A 113 143 171
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting A 113/101/89 143/128/118 171/153/141
at 40/50/60 °C, AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 113/101/89 143/128/118 171/153/141
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 27 20
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 8 4
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 113/101/89 139/127/116 158/146/129
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 21 21 21
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 8 8 8
6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 13 12 12
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 1 1
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 109/97/85 113/103/93 129/117/105
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 53/113 68/143 81/171
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 91.8/196 118/248 140/296
7
SOFT STARTERS
6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 12 13 12 13 13 11
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1 4 3 4 4 2
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 162/146/130 200/180/160 195/171/147 258/230/202 272/236/218 284/262/240
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 90/210 100/250 135/315 160/370 200/470 240/570
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 156/364 173/433 234/546 277/641 346/814 416/987
7
SOFT STARTERS
Q1 Q1
Q11 Q11
NSB0_01902
IC01_00544
M M
3~ 3~
ToC
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5213 3RV2032-4TA10 65 3RV2032-4TA10 18 3RV2032-4DA10 65 3RV2032-4DA10 18
3RW5214 3RV2032-4DA10 65 3RV2032-4DA10 15 3RV2032-4EA10 65 3RV2032-4EA10 15
3RW5215 3RV2032-4EA10 65 3RV2032-4EA10 15 3RV2032-4VA10 65 3RV2032-4VA10 15
3RW5216 3RV2032-4VA10 65 3RV2032-4VA10 10 3RV2032-4JA10 65 3RV2032-4JA10 10
3RW5217 3RV2032-4WA10 65 3RV2032-4WA10 10 3RV2032-4RA10 65 3RV2032-4RA10 10
3RW5224 3RV2032-4JA10 65 3RV2032-4JA10 10 3RV2032-4RA10 65 3RV2032-4RA10 10
3RW5225 3VA2163-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2163-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5226 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5227 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 15 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 10 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 15 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 10
3RW5234 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- -- 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- --
3RW5235 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- -- 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- --
3RW5236 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 30 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 10 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 30 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 10
3RW5243 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5244 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5245 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5246 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
7
3RW5247 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5248 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65
SOFT STARTERS
Note:
The service factor or measurement inaccuracies have been
taken into account, for example, for the selection of the specified
motor starter protectors/circuit breakers; the specified short-
circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are covered by combination
tests. Smaller motor starter protectors/circuit breakers than
those specified can be used at any time as smaller ones trip
more quickly in the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-
circuit breaking capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any
case. The dimensioning of the short-circuit components must,
however, be suitable for the connected three-phase motor and
the line protection for the cables used.
F1 F1 F1
IC01_00545a
NSB0_01904
IC01_00565
M M M
3~ 3~ 3~
Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor (optional) gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)
for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems
up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V
6
in the supply in the supply in the delta in the delta
cable cable
Q11 F1 Q21 Q21 F1 Q21 Q21 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5213 3NA3820-6 3RT2025 3RT2025 3NA3820-6 3RT2027 3RT2035 3RT2025 3RT2025
3RW5214 3NA3820-6 3RT2026 3RT2027 3NA3820-6 3RT2027 3RT2037 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW5215 3NA3822-6 3RT2027 3RT2037 3NA3822-6 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5216 3NA3824-6 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2037 3RT2038 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5217 3NA3824-6 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2038 3RT2046 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5224 3NA3824-6 3RT2036 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2046 3RT2047 3RT2036 3RT2037
3RW5225 3NA3830-6 3RT2037 3RT2046 3NA3830-6 3RT2047 3RT1054 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW5226 3NA3132-6 3RT2038 3RT2046 3NA3132-6 3RT1055 3RT1055 3RT2038 3RT2046
3RW5227 3NA3136-6 3RT2046 3RT2047 3NA3136-6 3RT1056 3RT1056 3RT2046 3RT2047
3RW5234 3NA3244-6 3RT1054 3RT1054 3NA3244-6 3RT1064 3RT1064 3RT1054 3RT1054
7
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
F’1
Q21
Q11
NSB0_01905
M
3~
7
3RW5243 3NE1230-21) 3RT1064 3RT1064
3RW5244 3NE1331-0 3RT1065 3RT1065
SOFT STARTERS
3RW5245 3NE1334-2 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5246 3NE1334-2 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5247 3NE1436-2 3RT1076 3RT1276
3RW5248 3NE1437-2 3TF68 3TF68
1)
For systems up to 500 V.
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
In inside-delta
inside-delta circuits,
circuits, aagR
gRclass
classfull-range
full-rangefusefusecould
couldnotnot
provide the semiconductor
provide the semiconductor protection
protection of of the
the delta-connected
delta-connected
soft starter with a short-circuit breaking
breaking capacity
capacitythatthatisis
adequate for practical
adequate for practicaluse.
use.InInthis
thiscase,
case,we werecommend
recommendusing using
aR class partial-range
partial-range fuses
fusesfor
forsemiconductor
semiconductorprotection
protectionforfor
type of coordination "2" (see
coordination “2” (see page
page 6/65).
7/64).
F1 F1 F1
IC01_00546a
IC01_00566
M M M
3~ 3~ 3~
Soft starters gG class fuse aR class fuse Line contactor gG class fuse aR class fuse Line contactor (optional)
(optional)
6
for systems for systems for sys- for sys- for systems for systems for systems for systems for sys- for sys-
up to 600 V up to 500 V tems tems up to 600 V up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V tems tems
up to up to in the supply in the supply up to up to
480 V 600 V cable cable 480 V 600 V
in the delta in the delta
Q11 F1 F3 Q21 Q21 F1 F3 Q21 Q21 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW5213 3NA3820-6 3NE8017-1 3RT2025 3RT2025 3NA3820-6 3NE8017-1 3RT2027 3RT2035 3RT2025 3RT2025
3RW5214 3NA3820-6 3NE8020-1 3RT2026 3RT2027 3NA3820-6 3NE8020-1 3RT2027 3RT2037 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW5215 3NA3822-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2027 3RT2037 3NA3822-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5216 3NA3824-6 3NE8022-1 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8022-1 3RT2037 3RT2038 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5217 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2038 3RT2046 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5224 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2036 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2046 3RT2047 3RT2036 3RT2037
3RW5225 3NA3830-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2037 3RT2046 3NA3830-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2047 3RT1054 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW5226 3NA3132-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2038 3RT2046 3NA3132-6 3NE8024-1 3RT1055 3RT1055 3RT2038 3RT2046
7
3RW5227 3NA3136-6 3NE4124 3RT2046 3RT2047 3NA3136-6 3NE4124 3RT1056 3RT1056 3RT2046 3RT2047
3RW5234 3NA3244-6 3NE3332-0B 3RT1054 3RT1054 3NA3244-6 3NE3332-0B 3RT1064 3RT1064 3RT1054 3RT1054
3RW5235 3NA3244-6 3NE3334-0B 3RT1055 3RT1055 3NA3244-6 3NE3334-0B 3RT1065 3RT1065 3RT1055 3RT1055
SOFT STARTERS
3RW5236 3NA3365-6 3NE3335 3RT1056 3RT1064 3NA3365-6 3NE3335 3RT1066 3RT1075 3RT1056 3RT1064
3RW5243 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3333 3RT1064 3RT1064 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3333 3RT1075 3RT1075 3RT1064 3RT1064
3RW5244 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3336 3RT1065 3RT1065 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3336 3RT1076 3RT1076 3RT1065 3RT1065
3RW5245 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3336 3RT1075 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3336 3TF68 3TF68 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5246 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3336 3RT1075 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3336 3TF69 3TF69 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5247 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3RT1076 3RT1276 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3TF69 3TF69 3RT1076 3RT1276
3RW5248 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3TF68 3TF68 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 -- -- 3TF68 3TF68
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
For CLASS 10 applications,
applications, asas an
an alternative
alternativetoto the
thegG
gGclass
class
full-range fuses for
full-range fuses for cable
cableand
andline
lineprotection
protection3NA3
3NA3(F1),
(F1),
3RV2/3VA
3RV2/3VA motor
motor starter
starter protectors/circuit
protectors/circuit breakers also be
breakers can also be
used, possibly
possibly with
with reduced
reducedshort-circuit
short-circuitbreaking
breakingcapacity
capacity
(see page 7/61).
6/62). In these cases, optional lineline contactors
contactors can
can be
be
dispensed with.
dispensed with.
7
page 6/8.7/7.
see page
SOFT STARTERS
At 40 °C At 50 °C SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional cur- three-phase motors tional cur- SET, M)
rent At At At rent At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
113 30 55 -- 101 30 30 75 -- 5 3RW5234-@@C@4 1 1 unit
143 37 75 -- 128 40 40 100 -- 5 3RW5235-@@C@4 1 1 unit
171 45 90 -- 153 50 50 100 -- 5 3RW5236-@@C@4 1 1 unit
210 55 110 -- 186 60 60 150 -- 5 3RW5243-@@C@4 1 1 unit
250 75 132 -- 220 60 75 150 -- 5 3RW5244-@@C@4 1 1 unit
315 90 160 -- 279 75 100 200 -- 5 3RW5245-@@C@4 1 1 unit
370 110 200 -- 328 100 125 250 -- 5 3RW5246-@@C@4 1 1 unit
470 132 250 -- 416 150 150 350 -- 5 3RW5247-@@C@4 1 1 unit
570 160 315 -- 504 150 200 400 -- 5 3RW5248-@@C@4 1 1 unit
6
32 7.5 15 18.5 28.4 7.5 10 20 25 5 3RW5216-@@C@5 1 1 unit
38 11 18.5 22 33.5 10 10 20 30 5 3RW5217-@@C@5 1 1 unit
47 11 22 30 41.6 10 10 30 40 5 3RW5224-@@C@5 1 1 unit
63 18.5 30 37 55.5 15 20 40 50 5 3RW5225-@@C@5 1 1 unit
77 22 37 45 68 20 25 50 60 5 3RW5226-@@C@5 1 1 unit
93 22 45 55 82.5 25 30 60 75 5 3RW5227-@@C@5 1 1 unit
pagepage
see 6/8.7/7.
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional cur- three-phase motors tional cur- SET, M)
rent At At At rent At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 600 V
113 30 55 75 101 30 30 75 100 5 3RW5234-@@C@5 1 1 unit
143 37 75 90 128 40 40 100 125 5 3RW5235-@@C@5 1 1 unit
171 45 90 110 153 50 50 100 150 5 3RW5236-@@C@5 1 1 unit
210 55 110 132 186 60 60 150 150 5 3RW5243-@@C@5 1 1 unit
250 75 132 160 220 60 75 150 200 5 3RW5244-@@C@5 1 1 unit
315 90 160 200 279 75 100 200 250 5 3RW5245-@@C@5 1 1 unit
370 110 200 250 328 100 125 250 300 5 3RW5246-@@C@5 1 1 unit
470 132 250 315 416 150 150 350 450 5 3RW5247-@@C@5 1 1 unit
570 160 315 355 504 150 200 400 500 5 3RW5248-@@C@5 1 1 unit
7
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page
SOFT STARTERS
At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional cur- three-phase motors tional cur- SET, M)
rent At At At rent At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
196 55 110 -- 175 50 60 125 -- 5 3RW5234-@@C@4 1 1 unit
248 75 132 -- 222 75 75 150 -- 5 3RW5235-@@C@4 1 1 unit
296 90 160 -- 265 75 100 200 -- 5 3RW5236-@@C@4 1 1 unit
364 110 200 -- 322 100 125 250 -- 5 3RW5243-@@C@4 1 1 unit
433 132 250 -- 381 125 150 300 -- 5 3RW5244-@@C@4 1 1 unit
546 160 315 -- 483 150 200 400 -- 5 3RW5245-@@C@4 1 1 unit
641 200 355 -- 568 200 200 450 -- 5 3RW5246-@@C@4 1 1 unit
814 250 400 -- 721 250 250 600 -- 5 3RW5247-@@C@4 1 1 unit
987 315 560 -- 873 300 350 750 -- 5 3RW5248-@@C@4 1 1 unit
At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional cur- three-phase motors tional cur- SET, M)
rent At At At rent At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 600 V
22.5 5.5 11 15 19.9 5 5 10 15 5 3RW5213-@@C@5 1 1 unit
31.5 7.5 15 18.5 28 7.5 7.5 20 25 5 3RW5214-@@C@5 1 1 unit
43.3 11 18.5 22 39 10 10 25 30 5 3RW5215-@@C@5 1 1 unit
6
55.4 15 22 30 49 15 15 30 40 5 3RW5216-@@C@5 1 1 unit
65.8 18.5 30 37 58 15 20 40 50 5 3RW5217-@@C@5 1 1 unit
81.4 22 45 45 72 20 25 50 60 5 3RW5224-@@C@5 1 1 unit
109 30 55 55 96 30 30 75 75 5 3RW5225-@@C@5 1 1 unit
133 37 75 90 118 30 40 75 100 5 3RW5226-@@C@5 1 1 unit
161 45 90 110 143 40 50 100 125 5 3RW5227-@@C@5 1 1 unit
At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
SOFT STARTERS
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional cur- three-phase motors tional cur- SET, M)
rent At At At rent At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 600 V
196 55 110 132 175 50 60 125 150 5 3RW5234-@@C@5 1 1 unit
248 75 132 160 222 75 75 150 200 5 3RW5235-@@C@5 1 1 unit
296 90 160 200 265 75 100 200 250 5 3RW5236-@@C@5 1 1 unit
364 110 200 250 322 100 125 250 300 5 3RW5243-@@C@5 1 1 unit
433 132 250 315 381 125 150 300 350 5 3RW5244-@@C@5 1 1 unit
546 160 315 355 483 150 200 400 500 5 3RW5245-@@C@5 1 1 unit
641 200 355 450 568 200 200 450 600 5 3RW5246-@@C@5 1 1 unit
814 250 400 500 721 250 250 600 800 5 3RW5247-@@C@5 1 1 unit
987 315 560 630 873 300 350 750 950 5 3RW5248-@@C@5 1 1 unit
3RW5983-0TC20
3RW5984-0TC20
Enclosure components
Hinged cover 3RW52 With cutout for -- } 3RW5950-0GL30 1 1 unit
High Feature
HMI module
3RW5950-0GL30
7
With cutout for -- } 3RW5950-0GL40 1 1 unit
Standard HMI
SOFT STARTERS
module
3RW5950-0GL40
Communication modules
Communica- 3RW52 PROFINET -- } 3RW5980-0CS00 1 1 unit
tion module Standard
PROFIBUS -- } 3RW5980-0CP00 1 1 unit
EtherNet/IP -- } 3RW5980-0CE00 1 1 unit
3RW5980-0CS00
3RW5980-0CR00
3RW5980-0HF00
Standard -- } 3RW5980-0HS00 1 1 unit
3RW5980-0HS00
IP65 door 3RW52 IP65 For HMI } 3RW5980-0HD00 1 1 unit
mounting kit modules
for HMI
modules
6
3RW5980-0HD00
Connecting cables
HMI 3RW52 5 m, round For door } 3RW5980-0HC60 1 1 unit
connection 2.5 m, round mounting } 3UF7933-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
cable
1.0 m, round } 3UF7937-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
0.5 m, round } 3UF7932-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
3UF793.-0BA00-0
7
3UF7931-0AA00-0
Further accessories
Push-in lugs -- Two lugs are For HMI 2 3ZY1311-0AA00 1 10 units
for wall required per modules and
mounting device communica-
tion modules
3ZY1311-0AA00
Blank labels
Unit labeling -- 20 mm x For SIRIUS 20 3RT2900-1SB20 100 340 units
plates1) 7 mm, devices
titanium gray
IC01_00181
3RT2900-1SB20
1)
PC labeling systems for individual inscription of unit labeling plates are
available from: murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (see page 16/15).
■ Overview
More information
Homepage, www.siemens.com/soft-starter
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter Simulation
Simulation Tool
Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW50
www.siemens.com/product?3RW50 https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
TIA Selection
Industry Tool
Online Cloud (SIOS)
Support (TST Cloud), see see
topic page, SIRIUS Soft
SIRIUS Soft Starter
Starter ES
ES(TIA
(TIA Portal)
Portal),for
see page 14/5 see page 14/5
diagnostics,
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
2 HMI modules
3 Communication modules
4
4 Box terminal blocks
5 Terminal covers for box terminals
6 Terminal covers for cable lugs
and busbar connections
1
7 Fan cover
8 Push-in lugs for wall mounting
9 IP65 door mounting kit
7
11 COM connecting cable
IC01_00571
SOFT STARTERS
7 8
2
9
4
5 6
10
3RW50
3RW50 Basic
Basic Performance soft starters with accessories (see page
accessories (see page7/81),
6/82),for
forexpansion
expansionwith
withHMI
HMImodule
moduleororcommunication
communicationmodule
module
■ Benefits
6
Product characteristics / function Performance features / benefits
Hybrid switching devices and two-phase motor control Minimum power loss and optimized motor control by avoiding DC components
Small and compact design Space-saving, clearly arranged control panel layout
TIA-Integration – communication modules and HMI modules optional Efficient configuration and maximum flexibility in automation engineering
7
Motor overload and intrinsic device protection without additional wiring Adjustable trip classes, integrated diagnostics functions
SOFT STARTERS
Wide range for control supply and main voltage Low variance, high system availability even with weak supply networks
Certified according to ATEX/IECEx directive Suitable for the starting of explosion-proof motors with "increased safety" type
of protection
■ Technical specifications
More information
Technical specifications,see
Technical specifications, see FAQs,
FAQs, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25252/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25252/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25252/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25252/td Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
Equipment Manual
Manual “SIRIUS
"SIRIUS 3RW50 Soft Starters",
Starter”, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753750
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753750
7
• During transport 2K2, 2C1, 2S1, 2M2 (max. height of fall 0.3 m)
1)
Derating from 11 000
000 m,
m,see
seecharacteristic
characteristiccurve
curveon
onpage
page6/8.
7/7.
SOFT STARTERS
2) Note derating above 40 °C.
6
Minimum load [% of IM]1) % 15
Maximum cable length between soft starter and motor m 800
1)
Relative to the smallest adjustable Ie.
7
SOFT STARTERS
Type 10
3RW5072 3RW5073 3RW5074 3RW5075 3RW5076 3RW5077
Rated operational current Ie A 210 250 315 370 470 570
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 570/504/460
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
7
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 570/504/460
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
SOFT STARTERS
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43 43 43 28
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18 18 18 11
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28 28 28 28 16
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 8 10 10 10 10 4
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 570/504/460
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 21 21 21 21 20 21
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 8 8 8 8 7 8
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 8 13 12 13 12 13
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h -- 4 4 4 2 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 162/146/130 200/180/160 219/195/171 258/230/202 272/254/218 284/262/240
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 90/210 100/250 135/315 160/370 200/470 240/570
Q1
Q11
NSB0_01902
M
3~
6
ToC
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5055 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5056 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5072 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5073 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5074 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5075 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5076 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5077 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
Note:
The service factor or measurement inaccuracies have been
taken into account, for example, for the selection of the specified
motor starter protectors/circuit breakers; the specified short-
circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are covered by combination
tests. Smaller motor starter protectors/circuit breakers than
7
F1
Q21
Q11
NSB0_01904
M
3~
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
7
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
SOFT STARTERS
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
F’1
Q21
Q11
NSB0_01905
M
3~
6
up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V
Q11 F’1 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW5055 3NE1227-0 3RT1055 3RT1055
3RW5056 3NE1230-0 3RT1056 3RT1064
3RW5072 3NE1230-2 3RT1064 3RT1064
3RW5073 3NE1331-0 3RT1065 3RT1065
3RW5074 3NE1333-2 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5075 3NE1334-2 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5076 3NE1436-2 3RT1076 3RT1076
3RW5077 3NE1437-2 3TF68 3TF68
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
7
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
F1
Q21
F3
Q11
NSB0_01906
M
3~
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
7
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
SOFT STARTERS
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
For CLASS 10 applications, as an
applications, as an alternative
alternativeto
tothe
thegG gGclass
class
full-range fuses
full-range fuses for
for cable
cableand
andline
lineprotection
protection3NA3
3NA3(F1),(F1),
circuit breakers
3VA circuit breakers can
canalso
alsobe
beused,
used,possibly
possiblywith
withreduced
reduced
short-circuit breaking
breaking capacity
capacity(see
(seepage
page7/76).
6/77).InInthese
thesecases
cases,
optional line
optional line contactors
contactors can
can be
bedispensed
dispensedwith.
with.
3RW5055 3RW5075
6
210 55 110 132 186 40 50 150 -- S12 5 3RW5072-@@B@4 1 1 unit
250 75 132 160 220 50 60 150 -- S12 5 3RW5073-@@B@4 1 1 unit
315 90 160 200 279 60 75 200 -- S12 5 3RW5074-@@B@4 1 1 unit
370 110 200 250 328 75 100 250 -- S12 5 3RW5075-@@B@4 1 1 unit
470 132 250 315 416 100 125 350 -- S12 5 3RW5076-@@B@4 1 1 unit
570 160 315 355 504 125 150 400 -- S12 5 3RW5077-@@B@4 1 1 unit
see page
page 7/7.
6/8.
SOFT STARTERS
3RW5985-0FC00
Box terminal block
Box terminal 3RW505 (2x) Up to 70 mm2 -- } 3RT1955-4G 1 1 unit 41B
block for round Up to 120 mm2 } 3RT1956-4G 1 1 unit 41B
and ribbon
cables 3RW507 (2x) Up to 240 mm2 } 3RT1966-4G 1 1 unit 41B
(with auxiliary
conductor
3RT1956-4G connection)
Terminal covers
Covers for 3RW505 (2x) -- -- } 3RT1956-4EA2 1 1 unit 41B
box terminals 3RW507 (2x) -- -- 2 3RT1966-4EA2 1 1 unit 41B
6
3RT1956-4EA2
Covers for 3RW505 (2x) -- -- } 3RT1956-4EA1 1 1 unit 41B
cable lugs and 3RW507 (2x) -- -- 2 3RT1966-4EA1 1 1 unit 41B
busbar
connections
3RT1956-4EA1
Communication modules
Communica- 3RW50 PROFINET -- } 3RW5980-0CS00 1 1 unit 42S
tion module Standard
PROFIBUS } 3RW5980-0CP00 1 1 unit 42S
7
EtherNet/IP } 3RW5980-0CE00 1 1 unit 42S
Modbus RTU } 3RW5980-0CR00 1 1 unit 42S
}
SOFT STARTERS
Modbus TCP 3RW5980-0CT00 1 1 unit 42S
3RW5980-0CS00
COM 3RW50 0.3 m -- } 3RW5900-0CC00 1 1 unit 42S
connection
cable
3RW5900-0CC00 For mounting
laterally on the
device
3RW5980-0HF00
Standard -- } 3RW5980-0HS00 1 1 unit 42S
3RW5980-0HS00
IP65 door 3RW50 IP65 For HMI } 3RW5980-0HD00 1 1 unit 42S
mounting kit modules
for HMI
modules
6
3RW5980-0HD00
Connecting cables
HMI 3RW50 5 m, round For door } 3RW5980-0HC60 1 1 unit 42S
connection 2.5 m, round mounting } 3UF7933-0BA00-0 1 1 unit 42J
cable
1.0 m, round } 3UF7937-0BA00-0 1 1 unit 42J
0.5 m, round } 3UF7932-0BA00-0 1 1 unit 42J
3UF793.-0BA00-0
7
Further accessories
Push-in lugs -- Two lugs are For HMI 2 3ZY1311-0AA00 1 10 units 41L
SOFT STARTERS
3RT2900-1SB20
1) PC labeling systems for individual inscription of unit labeling plates are
available from: murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (see page 16/15).
Overview
More information
Homepage, www.siemens.com/soft-starter
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter TIA
TIA Selection
Selection Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST Cloud), see
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW40
www.siemens.com/product?3RW40 https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw40
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw40
Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
7
1
SOFT STARTERS
8
IC01_00539
3RW40 Basic
3RW40 Basic Performance
Performance soft starters with accessories
accessories (see
(see page
page7/92)
6/94)
■ Benefits
Small and compact design Space-saving, clearly arranged control panel layout
Motor overload and intrinsic device protection without additional wiring Adjustable trip classes, integrated diagnostics functions
Integrated in the SIRIUS modular system Link modules to motor starter protectors
6
Hybrid switching devices and two-phase motor control Minimum power loss and optimized motor control by avoiding DC components
Certified according to ATEX Directive 94/9/EC Suitable for the starting of explosion-proof motors with "increased safety" type
of protection EEx e.
Technical specifications
More information
Technical specifications,see
Technical specifications, see FAQs,
FAQs, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25251/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25251/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25251/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25252/td Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
Equipment Manual
Manual “SIRIUS
"SIRIUS 3RW30/3RW40 SoftStarters",
3RW30/3RW40 Soft Starter”, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38752095
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38752095
D
W
NSB0_00649a
(for 3RW402. ... 3RW404.) 90° 90°
6
7
1) In the case of deviations, please observe derating, see Equipment Manual
in the chapter "Configuring".
SOFT STARTERS
Type Terminal 3RW402., 3RW403., 3RW404.
Control electronics
Rated values
Rated control supply voltage A1/A2 V 24 AC/DC 110 ... 230 AC/DC
• Tolerance % ± 20 -15/+10
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
• Tolerance % ± 10
6
2)
Current limiting on soft starter set to 300% IM, Tu = 40/50 °C. Maximum installation vertical. The quoted switching frequencies do not apply for
adjustable rated motor current IM dependent on CLASS setting. automatic mode. Factors for permissible switching frequency in other
mounting position, direct mounting, side-by-side mounting, and
implementation of optional auxiliary fan, see Equipment Manual in the
chapter "Configuring".
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 4 s A 45/42 63/58 72/62 80/73 106/98
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 26/26 15/15 15/15 15/15 10/10
• For heavy starting (CLASS 20) at 40/50 °C
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 6 s A 38/34 46/42 50/46 64/58 77/70
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 30/30 31/31 34/34 23/23 23/23
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 8 s A 38/34 46/42 50/46 64/58 77/70
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 21/21 22/22 24/24 16/16 16/16
1) Measurement at 60 °C according to UL/CSA not required. 3) For intermittent duty S4 with ON period = 30%, Tu = 40/50 °C, stand-alone
2)
Current limiting on soft starter set to 300% IM, Tu = 40/50 °C. Maximum installation vertical. The quoted switching frequencies do not apply for
adjustable rated motor current IM dependent on CLASS setting. automatic mode. Factors for permissible switching frequency in other
mounting position, direct mounting, side-by-side mounting, and
implementation of optional auxiliary fan, see Equipment Manual in the
chapter "Configuring".
Q1
Q11
NSB0_01902
M
3~
ToC
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW4024 3RV2021-4AA10 55 3RV2021-4AA10 10
3RW4026 3RV2021-4DA10 55 3RV2021-4DA10 10
3RW4027 3RV2021-4EA10 55 3RV2021-4EA10 10
3RW4028 3RV2021-4FA10 55 3RV2021-4FA10 10
3RW4036 3RV2031-4WA10 10 3RV2031-4WA10 10
3RW4037 3RV2031-4JA10 10 3RV2031-4JA10 5
3RW4038 3RV2031-4KA10 10 3RV2031-4KA10 5
3RW4046 3RV2041-4RA10 11 3RV2041-4YA10 5
3RW4047 3RV2041-4MA10 11 3RV2041-4MA10 5
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller motor starter protec-
tors/circuit breakers than those specified can be used at any
time as smaller ones trip more quickly in the event of a short
7
circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking capacity) and thus
protect the soft starter in any case. The dimensioning of the
short-circuit components must, however, be suitable for the
SOFT STARTERS
connected three-phase motor and the line protection for the
cables used.
F’1
Q21
Q11
NSB0_01905
M
3~
Note:
7
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
F1
Q21
F3
Q11
NSB0_01906
M
3~
Soft starters gG class fuse aR class fuse Cylindrical Line contactor (optional)
fuses
6
for systems up for systems up for systems up for systems up for systems for systems for systems for systems
to 600 V to 600 V to 600 V to 600 V up to 480 V up to 400 V up to 480 V up to 600 V
Q11 F1 F3 F3 F3 F3 Q21 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW4024 3NA3820-6 -- 3NE4101 3NE8015-1 3NC2240 3RT2025 3RT2025/ 3RT2025
3RT2018
(in size S00)
3RW4026 3NA3822-6 -- 3NE4102 3NE8017-1 3NC2263 3RT2026 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW4027 3NA3824-6 -- 3NE4118 3NE8018-1 3NC2280 3RT2027 3RT2028 3RT2037
3RW4028 3NA3824-6 -- 3NE4118 3NE8020-1 3NC2280 3RT2028 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW4036 3NA3130-6 -- 3NE4120 3NE8020-1 3NC2280 3RT2036 3RT2036 3RT2038
3RW4037 3NA3132-6 -- 3NE4121 3NE8021-1 -- 3RT2037 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW4038 3NA3132-6 3NE3221 -- 3NE8022-1 -- 3RT2038 3RT2038 3RT2046
3RW4046 3NA3136-6 3NE3222 -- 3NE8022-1 -- 3RT2045 3RT2045 3RT2047
3RW4047 3NA3136-6 3NE3224 -- 3NE8024-1 -- 3RT2047 3RT2047 3RT1054
7
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
SOFT STARTERS
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
For CLASS 10 applications,
applications, as as an
an alternative
alternativeto
tothe
thegG
gGclass
class
full-range fuses
full-range fuses for
for cable
cableand
andline
lineprotection
protection3NA3
3NA3(F1),
(F1),
3RV2 motor starter protectors can also be be used,
used, possibly
possiblywith
with
reduced short-circuit
reduced short-circuit breaking
breakingcapacity
capacity(see
(seepage
page7/87).
6/88).InIn
cases, optional
these cases, optional line
linecontactors
contactorscancanbebedispensed
dispensedwith.
with.
3RW ambient temperature 40 °C 3RW ambient temperature 50 °C Size SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Rated values of Rated values of per PU (UNIT,
three-phase motors three-phase motors SET, M)
Opera- Rating at Opera- Rating at
tional operational voltage Ue tional operational voltage Ue
current Ie 230 V 400 V 500 V current Ie 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Rated operational voltage Ue 200 ... 480 V
12.5 3 5.5 -- 11 3 3 7.5 -- S0 2 3RW4024-@BB@4 1 1 unit
6
• Screw terminals 1
• Spring-loaded terminals2) 2
3RW ambient temperature 40 °C 3RW ambient temperature 50 °C Size SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Rated values of Rated values of per PU (UNIT,
three-phase motors three-phase motors SET, M)
Opera- Rating at Opera- Rating at
tional operational voltage Ue tional operational voltage Ue
current Ie 230 V 400 V 500 V current Ie 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Rated operational voltage Ue 200 ... 480 V,
with thermistor motor protection,
rated control supply voltage Us 24 V AC/DC
6
12.5 3 5.5 -- 11 3 3 7.5 -- S0 5 3RW4024-@TB04 1 1 unit
25 5.5 11 -- 23 5 5 15 -- S0 5 3RW4026-@TB04 1 1 unit
32 7.5 15 -- 29 7.5 7.5 20 -- S0 5 3RW4027-@TB04 1 1 unit
38 11 18.5 -- 34 10 10 25 -- S0 5 3RW4028-@TB04 1 1 unit
45 11 22 -- 42 10 15 30 -- S2 5 3RW4036-@TB04 1 1 unit
63 18.5 30 -- 58 15 20 40 -- S2 5 3RW4037-@TB04 1 1 unit
72 22 37 -- 62 20 20 40 -- S2 5 3RW4038-@TB04 1 1 unit
80 22 45 -- 73 20 25 50 -- S3 5 3RW4046-@TB04 1 1 unit
106 30 55 -- 98 30 30 75 -- S3 5 3RW4047-@TB04 1 1 unit
Rated operational voltage Ue 400 ... 600 V,
with thermistor motor protection,
rated control supply voltage Us 24 V AC/DC
12.5 -- 5.5 7.5 11 -- -- 7.5 10 S0 5 3RW4024-@TB05 1 1 unit
25 -- 11 15 23 -- -- 15 20 S0 5 3RW4026-@TB05 1 1 unit
32 -- 15 18.5 29 -- -- 20 25 S0 5 3RW4027-@TB05 1 1 unit
38 -- 18.5 22 34 -- -- 25 30 S0 5 3RW4028-@TB05 1 1 unit
45 -- 22 30 42 -- -- 30 40 S2 5 3RW4036-@TB05 1 1 unit
63 -- 30 37 58 -- -- 40 50 S2 5 3RW4037-@TB05 1 1 unit
7
72 -- 37 45 62 -- -- 40 60 S2 5 3RW4038-@TB05 1 1 unit
80 -- 45 55 73 -- -- 50 60 S3 5 3RW4046-@TB05 1 1 unit
SOFT STARTERS
106 -- 55 75 98 -- -- 75 75 S3 5 3RW4047-@TB05 1 1 unit
3RV2925-5AB
3RT2946-4F
Covers for soft starters
Terminal covers for box terminals
3RW403. S2 Additional touch protection to be fitted } 3RT2936-4EA2 1 1 unit
3RW404. S3 at the box terminals } 3RT2946-4EA2 1 1 unit
(two units required per device)
3RT2936-4EA2
Terminal covers for cable lugs and busbar connections
3RW404. S3 For complying with the voltage clear- 5 3RT1946-4EA1 1 1 unit
ances and as touch protection if box
terminal is removed
(two units required per device)
7
SOFT STARTERS
3RT1946-4EA1
Sealing covers
3RW402. to S0, S2, -- 5 3RW4900-0PB10 1 1 unit
3RW404. S3
3RW4900-0PB10
For motor For soft Version SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*
starter starters per PU SET, M)
protectors
Size Size d
Standard mounting rail adapters
For mechanical fixing of motor
starter protector and soft starter;
for snapping onto standard
mounting rail or for screw fixing
S2 S2 Single-unit packaging 2 3RA2932-1CA00 1 1 unit
6
3RW49..-8VB00
For soft starters Motor starter protectors SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*
Type Size Size per PU SET, M)
d
Link modules to motor starter protectors1)
Screw terminals
7
SOFT STARTERS
3RA2921-2GA00
1)
Can be used in size S0 up to 32 A.
Can be used in size S2 up to 65 A in combination with 3RA2932-1CA00
standard mounting rail adapter (specially for soft starters).
Can be used in size S3 only with mounting plate.
3RT2900-1SB20
1)
PC labeling systems for individual inscription of unit labeling plates are
available from: murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (see page 16/14).
Overview
More information
Homepage, see
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter
www.siemens.com/soft-starter Simulation
Simulation Tool
Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
Industry
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW
www.siemens.com/product?3RW https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
TIA
TIA Selection
Selection Tool
Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST
(TST Cloud),
Cloud),see
see SIRIUS Soft
SIRIUS Soft Starter
Starter ES
ES (TIA
(TIA Portal)
Portal),for
see page 14/5 see page 14/5
diagnostics,
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw30
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw30
1
SOFT STARTERS
IC01_00538
3RW30 Basic
Basic Performance soft starters
starters with accessories
accessories (see
(see page
page7/103)
6/105)
Benefits
Small and compact design Space-saving, clearly arranged control panel layout
Integrated in the SIRIUS modular system Link modules to motor starter protectors
6
Hybrid switching devices and two-phase motor control Minimum power loss and optimized motor control by avoiding DC components
Technical specifications
More information
Equipment Manual
Equipment Manual “SIRIUS
"SIRIUS 3RW30/3RW40
3RW30/3RW40 Soft
Soft Starters",
Starters”,see
see Catalog
Catalog LV
LV 10,
10, see
see www.siemens.com/lowvoltage/lv10
www.siemens.com/lowvoltage/lv10
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38752095
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38752095
FAQs, see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16213/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16213/faq
7
H
SOFT STARTERS
Permissible ambient temperature
During operation °C -25 ... +60; (derating from +40)
During storage °C -40 ... +80
Weight kg 0.58 0.69 1.20 1.71
Permissible mounting position1) 10° 10°
(auxiliary fan not possible) 10° 10°
NSB0_01897
1)
In the case of deviations, please observe derating, see Equipment Manual
in the chapter "Configuring".
Power loss
• In operation after completed starting with uninterrupted rated operational W 0.25 0.5 1 2 4
current (40 °C) approx.
• During starting with 300% IM (40 °C) W 24 52 80 80 116
Permissible rated motor current and starts per hour
• For normal starting (CLASS 10) at 40/50 °C
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 3 s A 3.6/3.3 6.5/6.0 9/8 12.5/12.0 17.6/17.0
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 200/150 87/60 50/50 85/70 62/46
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 4 s A 3.6/3.3 6.5/6.0 9/8 12.5/12.0 17.6/17.0
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 150/100 64/46 35/35 62/47 45/32
1) Measurement at 60 °C according to UL/CSA not required. 3) For intermittent duty S4 with ON period = 30%, Tu = 40/50 °C, stand-alone
2)
At 300% IM, Tu = 40/50 °C. installation vertical. The quoted switching frequencies do not apply for
automatic mode.
Power loss
• In operation after completed starting with uninterrupted rated operational W 8 13 19
current (40 °C) approx.
SOFT STARTERS
D
W
NSB0_01897
Permissible installation altitude m 5 000
(Derating
(Derating from
from 1 000,
000, see
see characteristic
characteristiccurve
curveon
onpage
page6/8)
7/7)
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 IP00
Control electronics
Rated values
Rated control supply voltage V 24 ... 230 AC/DC
6
• Tolerance % ± 10
Rated frequency at AC Hz 50/60
• Tolerance % ± 10
Power electronics
Rated operational voltage V AC 200 ... 400
Tolerance % ± 10
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Tolerance % ± 10
Uninterrupted duty (% of Ie) % 100
Minimum load1) (% of Ie); at 40 °C % 9
Maximum conductor length between soft starter and motor m 1002)
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
• According to IEC and UL/CSA, individual mounting A 3/2.6/2.2
at 40/50/60 °C, AC-53a
• According to IEC and UL/CSA, side-by-side mounting A 2.6/2.2/1.8
at 40/50/60 °C, AC-53a
Power loss
7
• In operation after completed starting with uninterrupted rated W 6.5
operational current (40 °C) approx.
SOFT STARTERS
• With utilization of maximum switching frequency W 3
Permissible starts per hour
(cannot be increased by using a fan)
• For intermittent duty S4 Tu = 40 °C, stand-alone installation vertical 1/h 1 500
• ON period = 70% for 300% Ie 1/s 0.2
Dead time after uninterrupted duty
with Ie before restart s 0
1)
The rated motor current (specified on the motor's name plate) should at
least amount to the specified percentage of the SIRIUS soft starter unit's
rated operational current Ie.
2) If this value is exceeded, problems with line capacities may arise, which
can result in false firing.
Q1
Q11
NSB0_01902
M
3~
ToC
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW3003 3RV2011-1EA10 50
3RW3013 3RV2011-1FA10 5
3RW3014 3RV2011-1HA10 5
3RW3016 3RV2011-1JA10 5
3RW3017 3RV2011-1KA10 5
3RW3018 3RV2021-4BA10 5
3RW3026 3RV2021-4DA10 55
3RW3027 3RV2021-4EA10 55
3RW3028 3RV2021-4FA10 55
3RW3036 3RV2031-4WA10 10
3RW3037 3RV2031-4JA10 10
3RW3038 3RV2031-4KA10 10
3RW3046 3RV2041-4RA10 11
3RW3047 3RV2041-4MA10 11
Note:
7
F1
Q21
Q11
NSB0_01904
M
3~
6
Q11 F1 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW30031) 3NA38052) 3RT2015 3RT2015
3RW3013 3NA3803-6 3RT2015 3RT2015
3RW3014 3NA3805-6 3RT2015 3RT2016
3RW3016 3NA3807-6 3RT2016 3RT2017
3RW3017 3NA3810-6 3RT2018 3RT2025
3RW3018 3NA3814-6 3RT2026 3RT2026
3RW3026 3NA3822-6 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW3027 3NA3824-6 3RT2027 3RT2028
3RW3028 3NA3824-6 3RT2028 3RT2035
3RW3036 3NA3130-6 3RT2036 3RT2036
3RW3037 3NA3132-6 3RT2037 3RT2037
3RW3038 3NA3132-6 3RT2038 3RT2038
7
3RW3046 3NA3136-6 3RT2045 3RT2045
3RW3047 3NA3136-6 3RT2047 3RT2047
1)
SOFT STARTERS
Iq = 50 kA at 400 V.
2)
3NA3805-1 (NH00), 5SB261 (DIAZED), 5SE2201-6 (NEOZED).
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
F’1
Q21
Q11
NSB0_01905
M
3~
1) Iq = 50 kA at 400 V.
2)
No SITOR fuse required!
Alternatively: 3NA3803 (NH00), 5SB221 (DIAZED), 5SE2206 (NEOZED).
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
F1
Q21
F3
Q11
NSB0_01906
M
3~
Soft starters gG class fuse aR class fuse Cylindrical fuses Line contactor (optional)
for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems
6
up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 400 V up to 480 V
Q11 F1 F3 F3 F3 F3 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW30031) 3NA38052) -- -- 3NE8015-1 3NC1010 3RT2015 3RT2015
3RW3013 3NA3803-6 -- 3NE4101 3NE8015-1 3NC2220 3RT2015 3RT2015
3RW3014 3NA3805-6 -- 3NE4101 3NE8015-1 3NC2220 3RT2015 3RT2016
3RW3016 3NA3807-6 -- 3NE4101 3NE8015-1 3NC2220 3RT2016 3RT2017
3RW3017 3NA3810-6 -- 3NE4101 3NE8015-1 3NC2250 3RT2018 3RT2025
3RW3018 3NA3814-6 -- 3NE4101 3NE8003-1 3NC2263 3RT2026 3RT2026
3RW3026 3NA3822-6 -- 3NE4102 3NE8017-1 3NC2263 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW3027 3NA3824-6 -- 3NE4118 3NE8018-1 3NC2280 3RT2027 3RT2028
3RW3028 3NA3824-6 -- 3NE4118 3NE8020-1 3NC2280 3RT2028 3RT2035
3RW3036 3NA3130-6 -- 3NE4120 3NE8020-1 3NC2280 3RT2036 3RT2036
3RW3037 3NA3132-6 -- 3NE4121 3NE8021-1 -- 3RT2037 3RT2037
7
3RW3038 3NA3132-6 3NE3221 -- 3NE8022-1 -- 3RT2038 3RT2038
3RW3046 3NA3136-6 3NE3222 -- 3NE8022-1 -- 3RT2045 3RT2045
3RW3047 3NA3136-6 3NE3224 -- 3NE8024-1 -- 3RT2047 3RT2047
SOFT STARTERS
1) Iq = 50 kA at 400 V.
2)
3NA3805-1 (NH00), 5SB261 (DIAZED).
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
For CLASS 10 applications,
applications, as as an
an alternative
alternativeto tothe
thegG
gGclass
class
full-range
full-range fuses
fuses for
for cable
cableand
andline
lineprotection
protection3NA3
3NA3(F1),
(F1),3RV2
3RV2
motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
breakers can
can also
alsobebeused,
used,
possibly
possibly with
with reduced
reducedshort-circuit
short-circuitbreaking
breakingcapacity
capacity
(see page 6/100).InInthese
page 7/98). thesecases,
cases, optional line
optional contactors
line contactorscan
can
be dispensed
dispensed with.
with.
• 24 V AC/DC 0
• 110 ... 230 V AC/DC 1
Soft starters for easy starting conditions and high switching frequency,
rated operational voltage Ue 200 ... 400 V,
rated control supply voltage Us 24 ... 230 V AC/DC
3 0.55 1.1 -- A 0.5 0.5 -- -- 22.5 mm
• With screw terminals } 3RW3003-1CB54 1 1 unit
• With spring-loaded terminals } 3RW3003-2CB54 1 1 unit
1)
Soft starter Ue 200 to 480 V with screw terminals:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
2) Main connection from size S2: screw terminals.
Note:
the constraints
For the constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
pagepage
see 6/8.7/7.
3RV2925-5AB
For soft starters SD Article No. Price PU PS*
Type Size per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
6
Auxiliary terminals
Auxiliary terminals, 3-pole
3RW304. S3 5 3RT2946-4F 1 1 unit
3RT2946-4F
Covers for soft starters
Terminal covers for box terminals
Additional touch protection to be fitted at the box terminals (two units
required per device)
3RW303. S2 } 3RT2936-4EA2 1 1 unit
3RW304. S3 } 3RT2946-4EA2 1 1 unit
3RT2946-4EA2
Terminal covers for cable lugs and busbar connections
For complying with the voltage clearances and as touch protection if
box terminal is removed
(two units required per device)
7
3RW304. S3 5 3RT1946-4EA1 1 1 unit
SOFT STARTERS
3RT1946-4EA1
For motor For soft Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*
starter starters per PU (UNIT,
protectors SET, M)
Si z e Size d
Mounting rails for mounting contactors for the customer assembly of 3RA21 load
feeders with busbar adapters for 60 mm systems
For the discrete configuration of direct-
on-line starters, an additional mounting
rail is needed for the contactor in addition
to the existing mounting rail on the bus-
bar adapter for the motor starter protec-
tor.
-- S0 For pushing onto the device adapter, in- 2 8US1998-7CB45 1 10 units
cluding fixing screws
8US1998-7CB45
Standard mounting rail adapters
For mechanical fixing of motor starter
protector and soft starter;
for snapping onto standard mounting rail
or for screw fixing
S2 S2 Single-unit packaging 2 3RA2932-1CA00 1 1 unit
3RA2932-1CA00
For soft starters Motor starter protectors SD Article No. Price PU PS*
Type Size Size per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Link modules to motor starter protectors1)
Screw terminals
3RA2921-2GA00
1)
Can be used in size S0 up to 32 A.
Can be used in size S2 up to 65 A in combination with 3RA2932-1CA00
6
3RP1903
per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
SOFT STARTERS
3RT2900-1SB20
1) PC labeling systems for individual inscription of unit labeling plates are
available from: murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (see page 16/15).
7
3RW553 (2x)
3RW554 (1x) -- } 3RW5984-0FF00 1 1 unit
SOFT STARTERS
3RW555 (3x) -- } 3RW5985-0FF00 1 1 unit
3RW5983-0FF00
Terminals and terminal covers
Box terminal 3RW552 (2x) -- } 3RW5982-0TB00 1 1 unit
block
3RW5982-0TB00
Screw terminals
Spring-loaded terminals
3RW5955-0TC20
3RW5950-0GD20
3RW55..-.HF.. Yellow NEW NEU
} 3RW5950-0GD30 1 1 unit
6
3RW5950-0GD30
Hinged cover 3RW55 With cutout for } 3RW5950-0GL30 1 1 unit
High Feature
HMI module
3RW5950-0GL30
7
SOFT STARTERS
3RW5980-0HF00
Interface cover 3RW55 -- } 3RW5980-0HL00 1 1 unit
3RW5980-0HL00
6
Connection cable for installing the HMI module in the soft starter
Connection cable -- 0.1 m, flat } 3UF7931-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
3UF7931-0AA00-0
Transport packaging
Transport 3RW551 -- } 3RW5951-0VY00 1 1 unit
packaging 3RW552, 3RW553 -- } 3RW5953-0VY00 1 1 unit
3RW554 -- } 3RW5954-0VY00 1 1 unit
3RW555 -- } 3RW5955-0VY00 1 1 unit
7
SOFT STARTERS
3RW5953-0VY00
Product Manufacturer's Article No. Type of product SD Article No. Price PU PS*
designation of the soft starter per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Fans
Fans 3RW5216/17 (1x), -- } 3RW5983-0FF00 1 1 unit
3RW5226/27 (2x),
3RW523 (2x)
3RW524 (1x) -- } 3RW5984-0FF00 1 1 unit
3RW5983-0FF00
Terminals
Box terminal block 3RW522 (2x) -- } 3RW5982-0TB00 1 1 unit
3RW5982-0TB00
Screw terminals
Spring-loaded terminals
3RW5953-0GB00
Cover for control 3RW52 Titanium gray } 3RW5950-0GD20 1 1 unit
SOFT STARTERS
cable duct
3RW5950-0GD20
Product Manufacturer's Article No. Type of product SD Article No. Price PU PS*
designation of the soft starter per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Enclosure components
Hinged cover 3RW52 Without cutout } 3RW5950-0GL20 1 1 unit
3RW5950-0GL20
Transport packaging
Transport 3RW521 -- } 3RW5951-0VY00 1 1 unit
packaging 3RW522, 3RW523 -- } 3RW5953-0VY00 1 1 unit
3RW524 -- } 3RW5954-0VY00 1 1 unit
6
3RW5953-0VY00
7
SOFT STARTERS
Product Manufacturer's Article No. Type of product SD Article No. Price PU PS*
designation of the soft starter per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Fan
Fan 3RW505 (1x) -- } 3RW5905-0FF00 1 1 unit
3RW507 (1x) -- } 3RW5907-0FF00 1 1 unit
3RW5905-0FF00
Terminals
Screw terminals
6
3RW5980-1TR00
Enclosure components
Hinged cover 3RW50 -- } 3RW5900-0GL00 1 1 unit
3RW5900-0GL00
Transport packaging
Transport 3RW505 -- } 3RW5905-0VY00 1 1 unit
packaging 3RW507 -- } 3RW5907-0VY00 1 1 unit
7
SOFT STARTERS
3RW5905-0VY00
Overview Application
The family of 3RW40 and 3RW44 softstarters are available in The Class 73/74 product is a fully enclosed solid state reduced
stand alone enclosed control designs for smooth starting and voltage starter designed for a wide variety of industrial applica-
stopping of standard NEMA design B three phase inductive mo- tions. The enclosed softstarter offerings are ideal for new as well
tors, thus eliminating physical stresses to the system and load as existing applications where total motor controls is required.
while minimizing starting current. These pre-engineered en-
closed designs offer convenience and flexibility in and UL/CSA Proper selection based on application data is made simple fol-
certified offering. Enclosed styles are available in combination lowing these easy steps:
and non-combination configurations through 600HP and system - Select proper RVSS by application
voltages of 200V, 230V, 480V, and 600V. • Select the 3RW40 versus the 3RW44 using the application
The Class 73 offers either the 3RW40 or 3RW44 in a non-combi- info provided in the open section of the catalog
nation style offering. These non-combination styles come stan- - Select the rating chart for normal starting or sever duty starting
dard with a choice of Type 1, 3R, 12, 4 NEMA rated enclosure, a
control transformer, Sirius softstarter with built-in overload and • Normal starting is rated at 350% of rated motor current
bypass, line side power terminal block, and a reset pushbutton. IM for 10 seconds and based on starts per hour – repre-
The enclosed offering can be powerfully matched with a wide sentative of a class 20 application.
variety of factory modified options such as pushbutton control, • Severe starting is rated at 350% of rated motor current
pilot lights, metering and other control options such as isolation Im for 20 seconds and based on starts per hour – repre-
contactors and emergency start bypass starters. 3RW44 en- sentative of a Class 20 application
closed styles are also available with optional through the door
keypad and Profibus communication. - Select model using Motor nameplate data
• Identify correct motor voltage column
The Class 74 offering includes all of the features of the Class 73
in a combination style design. Standard options are either a cir- • Select rate current or HP row
cuit breaker or fusible disconnect providing short circuit protec- • Find ordering number under desired enclosure type
tion and soft starting in one package. column (e.g. NEMA 1)
• Select appropriate system voltage
- Select factory modification on page 6/401)
Example:
3RW44, N12, CB disconnect, 460V, 200HP with a start/stop and
red run light
Order No.
74MT34BFAP A1 FC
Product Nomenclature
Class 73 and 74 Enclosed Soft Starters
7
SOFT STARTERS
Class
73 = Non-combination type
74 = Combination type
1)
Some modifications will require a larger ‘Modified’ box than the standard box
e.g. Isolation contactor, space heater, etc. See page 7/124 for instructions.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/111
Soft Starters
Ordering Information
� Enclosed devices should be ordered by Ideal applications for 3RW40 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters
b Fans
� The 3RW40 is designed for normal b Pumps
starting applications. b Easy starting loads starting in less than
� or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F 10 seconds
� or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F
Class 73 starters are built to UL and CSA
standards
Class 73 non-combination starters include:
3RW40 Enclosed features: b NEMA rated enclosure
b Available in NEMA 1,12,3R,4, and b 3RW40 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
4 stainless steel and bypass
b Compact size b Control Circuit Transformer
b Built-in Bypass contactor b Line side power terminal block
b Voltage ramp up and ramp down b Reset button
b Current limit adjustment of 125 - 550% b Isolation Contactor
b Internal overload class 10,15,or 20
b Internal self protection
b Fault monitoring
b Isolation Contactor
Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Ie for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
11 3 3 7.5 — 6 3RW4024-1BB14 73AR3_BFA 73AR3_DFA 73AR3_0FA 73AR3_EFA 73AR3_WFA
23 5 7.5 15 — 13 3RW4026-1BB14 73BR3_BFA 73BR3_DFA 73BR3_0FA 73BR3_EFA 73BR3_WFA
29 7.5 10 20 — 16 3RW4027-1BB14 73CR3_BFA 73CR3_DFA 73CR3_0FA 73CR3_EFA 73CR3_WFA
34 10 10 25 — 18 3RW4028-1BB14 73DR3_BFA 73DR3_DFA 73DR3_0FA 73DR3_EFA 73DR3_WFA
42 10 15 30 — 23 3RW4036-1BB14 73ER3_BFA 73ER3_DFA 73ER3_0FA 73ER3_EFA 73ER3_WFA
58 15 20 40 — 31 3RW4037-1BB14 73FR3_BFA 73FR3_DFA 73FR3_0FA 73FR3_EFA 73FR3_WFA
62 20 20 40 — 33 3RW4038-1BB14 73GR3_BFA 73GR3_DFA 73GR3_0FA 73GR3_EFA 73GR3_WFA
73 20 25 50 — 39 3RW4046-1BB14 73HR3_BFA 73HR3_DFA 73HR3_0FA 73HR3_EFA 73HR3_WFA
98 30 30 75 — 52 3RW4047-1BB14 73JR3_BFA 73JR3_DFA 73JR3_0FA 73JR3_EFA 73JR3_WFA
200V 6 6 6 6 6
7
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
SOFT STARTERS
460V 4 4 4 4 4
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Ie = FLA rating of motor
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C
7/112 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters
Ordering Information
Ideal applications for 3RW40 enclosed
� nclosed devices should be ordered by
E
softstarters:
the FLA of the motor.
b Fans
� he 3RW40 is designed for normal
T b Pumps
starting applications (Class 10 b Building/construction machines
applications). b Presses
� For factory modifications see page 7/124. b Escalators
b Transport systems
� For dimensional drawings see page 7/125. b Air conditioning systems
Class 73 non-combination starters include: b Ventilators
b NEMA rated enclosure b Assembly lines
3RW40 Enclosed features: Class 73 starters are built to UL and
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4 b 3RW40 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
stainless steel and bypass CSA standards.
b Compact size b Control circuit transformer
b Built-in bypass contactor
b Voltage ramp up and ramp down b Line side power terminal block
b Current limit adjustment of 125 - 550% b Reset button
b Internal overload class 10, 15, or 20
b Internal self protection
b Fault monitoring
For all technical information, please consult the 2006 Industrial Controls Catalog or contact your local sales support center.
7
117 — — 75 100 — 3RW4055-6BB35 73AS35BFA 73AS35DFA 73AS350FA 73AS35EFA 73AS35WFA
145 — — 100 150 — 3RW4056-6BB35 73BS35BFA 73BS35DFA 73BS350FA 73BS35EFA 73BS35WFA
205 — — 150 200 — 3RW4073-6BB35 73CS35BFA 73CS35DFA 73CS350FA 73CS35EFA 73CS35WFA
SOFT STARTERS
248 — — 200 250 — 3RW4074-6BB35 73DS35BFA 73DS35DFA 73DS350FA 73DS35EFA 73DS35WFA
315 — — 250 300 — 3RW4075-6BB35 73ES35BFA 73ES35DFA 73ES350FA 73ES35EFA 73ES35WFA
385 — — 300 400 — 3RW4076-6BB35 73FS35BFA 73FS35DFA 73FS350FA 73FS35EFA 73FS35WFA
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.
b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/113
Soft Starters
Ordering Information
� Enclosed devices should be ordered by Ideal applications for 3RW40 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters
b Fans
� The 3RW40 is designed for normal b Pumps
starting applications. b Easy starting loads starting in less than
� or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F 10 seconds
� or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F
Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
standards
Class 74 non-combination starters include:
3RW40 Enclosed features: b NEMA rated enclosure
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and b Circuit Breaker disconnect with shunt trip
4 stainless steel b 3RW40 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
b Compact size and bypass
b Built-in Bypass contactor b Control Circuit Transformer
b Voltage ramp up and ramp down b Isolation Contactor
b Current limit adjustment of 125 - 550%
b Internal overload class 10, 15, or 20
b Internal self protection
b Fault monitoring
b Isolation Contactor
Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Ie for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
11 3 3 7.5 — 6 3RW4024-1BB14 74AR3_BFAP 74AR3_DFAP 74AR3_0FAP 74AR3_EFAP 74AR3_WFAP
23 5 7.5 15 — 13 3RW4026-1BB14 74BR3_BFAP 74BR3_DFAP 74BR3_0FAP 74BR3_EFAP 74BR3_WFAP
29 7.5 10 20 — 16 3RW4027-1BB14 74CR3_BFAP 74CR3_DFAP 74CR3_0FAP 74CR3_EFAP 74CR3_WFAP
34 10 10 25 — 18 3RW4028-1BB14 74DR3_BFAP 74DR3_DFAP 74DR3_0FAP 74DR3_EFAP 74DR3_WFAP
42 10 15 30 — 23 3RW4036-1BB14 74ER3_BFAP 74ER3_DFAP 74ER3_0FAP 74ER3_EFAP 74ER3_WFAP
58 15 20 40 — 31 3RW4037-1BB14 74FR3_BFAP 74FR3_DFAP 74FR3_0FAP 74FR3_EFAP 74FR3_WFAP
62 20 20 40 — 33 3RW4038-1BB14 74GR3_BFAP 74GR3_DFAP 74GR3_0FAP 74GR3_EFAP 74GR3_WFAP
73 20 25 50 — 39 3RW4046-1BB14 74HR3_BFAP 74HR3_DFAP 74HR3_0FAP 74HR3_EFAP 74HR3_WFAP
98 30 30 75 — 52 3RW4047-1BB14 74JR3_BFAP 74JR3_DFAP 74JR3_0FAP 74JR3_EFAP 74JR3_WFAP
7
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
SOFT STARTERS
460V 4 4 4 4 4
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Ie = FLA rating of motor
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C
7/114 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters
Enclosed 3RW44
Ordering Information
�
Enclosed devices should be ordered by Ideal applications for 3RW40 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
b Fans
� he 3RW40 is designed for normal
T b Pumps
starting applications (Class 10 b Building/construction machines
applications). b Presses
� or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F b Escalators
b Transport systems
� or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F b Air conditioning systems
Class 74 non-combination starters include: b Ventilators
b Assembly lines
3RW40 Enclosed features: b NEMA rated enclosure
Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4 b Circuit breaker disconnect with shunt trip
stainless steel standards.
b 3RW40 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
b Compact size and bypass
b Built-in bypass contactor
b Voltage ramp up and ramp down b Control circuit transformer
b Current limit adjustment of 125 - 550%
b Internal overload class 10, 15, or 20
b Internal self protection
b Fault monitoring
For all technical information, please consult the 2006 Industrial Controls Catalog or contact your local sales support center.
Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Im for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
117 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4055-6BB34 74AS3_BFAP 74AS3_DFAP 74AS3_0FAP 74AS3_EFAP 74AS3_WFAP
145 40 50 100 — 75 3RW4056-6BB34 74BS3_BFAP 74BS3_DFAP 74BS3_0FAP 74BS3_EFAP 74BS3_WFAP
205 60 75 150 — 112 3RW4073-6BB34 74CS3_BFAP 74CS3_DFAP 74CS3_0FAP 74CS3_EFAP
248 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4074-6BB34 74DS3_BFAP 74DS3_DFAP 74DS3_0FAP 74DS3_EFAP
315 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4075-6BB34 74ES3_BFAP 74ES3_DFAP 74ES3_0FAP 74ES3_EFAP
385 125 150 300 — 224 3RW4076-6BB34 74FS3_BFAP 74FS3_DFAP 74FS3_0FAP 74FS3_EFAP
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
7
117 — — 75 100 — 3RW4055-6BB35 74AS35BFAP 74AS35DFAP 74AS350FAP 74AS35EFAP 74AS35WFAP
145 — — 100 150 — 3RW4056-6BB35 74BS35BFAP 74BS35DFAP 74BS350FAP 74BS35EFAP 74BS35WFAP
SOFT STARTERS
205 — — 150 200 — 3RW4073-6BB35 74CS35BFAP 74CS35DFAP 74CS350FAP 74CS35EFAP
248 — — 200 250 — 3RW4074-6BB35 74DS35BFAP 74DS35DFAP 74DS350FAP 74DS35EFAP
315 — — 250 300 — 3RW4075-6BB35 74ES35BFAP 74ES35DFAP 74ES350FAP 74ES35EFAP
385 — — 300 400 — 3RW4076-6BB35 74FS35BFAP 74FS35DFAP 74FS350FAP 74FS35EFAP
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/115
Soft Starters
Ordering Information
� Enclosed devices should be ordered by Ideal applications for 3RW40 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters
b Fans
� The 3RW40 is designed for normal b Pumps
starting applications. b Easy starting loads starting in less than
� or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F 10 seconds
� or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F
Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
standards
Class 73 non-combination starters include:
b NEMA rated enclosure
3RW40 Enclosed features: b Fusible Disconnect
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and b 3RW40 Sirius softstarter with built-in
4 stainless steel
b Compact size OL and bypass
b Built-in Bypass contactor b Control Circuit Transformer
b Voltage ramp up and ramp down b Isolation Contactor
b Current limit adjustment of 125 - 550%
b Internal overload class 10,15,or 20
b Internal self protection
b Fault monitoring
b Isolation Contactor
Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Ie for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
11 3 3 7.5 — 6 3RW4024-1BB14 74AR3_BFAF 74AR3_DFAF 74AR3_0FAF 74AR3_EFAF 74AR3_WFAF
23 5 7.5 15 — 13 3RW4026-1BB14 74BR3_BFAF 74BR3_DFAF 74BR3_0FAF 74BR3_EFAF 74BR3_WFAF
29 7.5 10 20 — 16 3RW4027-1BB14 74CR3_BFAF 74CR3_DFAF 74CR3_0FAF 74CR3_EFAF 74CR3_WFAF
34 10 10 25 — 18 3RW4028-1BB14 74DR3_BFAF 74DR3_DFAF 74DR3_0FAF 74DR3_EFAF 74DR3_WFAF
42 10 15 30 — 23 3RW4036-1BB14 74ER3_BFAF 74ER3_DFAF 74ER3_0FAF 74ER3_EFAF 74ER3_WFAF
58 15 20 40 — 31 3RW4037-1BB14 74FR3_BFAF 74FR3_DFAF 74FR3_0FAF 74FR3_EFAF 74FR3_WFAF
62 20 20 40 — 33 3RW4038-1BB14 74GR3_BFAF 74GR3_DFAF 74GR3_0FAF 74GR3_EFAF 74GR3_WFAF
73 20 25 50 — 39 3RW4046-1BB14 74HR3_BFAF 74HR3_DFAF 74HR3_0FAF 74HR3_EFAF 74HR3_WFAF
98 30 30 75 — 52 3RW4047-1BB14 74JR3_BFAF 74JR3_DFAF 74JR3_0FAF 74JR3_EFAF 74JR3_WFAF
200V 6 6 6 6 6
7
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
SOFT STARTERS
460V 4 4 4 4 4
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Ie = FLA rating of motor
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C
7/116 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters
Enclosed 3RW44
Ordering Information
� nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW40 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
b Fans
� he 3RW40 is designed for normal
T b Pumps
starting applications (Class 10 b Building/construction machines
applications). b Presses
� or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F b Escalators
b Transport systems
� or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F b Air conditioning systems
Class 74 combination starters include: b Ventilators
b Assembly lines
3RW40 Enclosed features: b NEMA rated enclosure
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4 Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Fusible disconnect
stainless steel standards.
b Compact size b 3RW40 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
and bypass
b Built-in bypass contactor
b Voltage ramp up and ramp down b Control circuit transformer
b Current limit adjustment of 125 - 550%
b Internal overload class 10, 15, or 20
b Internal self protection
b Fault monitoring
For all technical information, please consult the 2006 Industrial Controls Catalog or contact your local sales support center.
Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Im for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
117 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4055-6BB34 74AS3_BFAF 74AS3_DFAF 74AS3_0FAF 74AS3_EFAF 74AS3_WFAF
145 40 50 100 — 75 3RW4056-6BB34 74BS3_BFAF 74BS3_DFAF 74BS3_0FAF 74BS3_EFAF 74BS3_WFAF
205 60 75 150 — 112 3RW4073-6BB34 74CS3_BFAF 74CS3_DFAF 74CS3_0FAF 74CS3_EFAF
248 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4074-6BB34 74DS3_BFAF 74DS3_DFAF 74DS3_0FAF 74DS3_EFAF
315 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4075-6BB34 74ES3_BFAF 74ES3_DFAF 74ES3_0FAF 74ES3_EFAF
385 125 150 300 — 224 3RW4076-6BB34 74FS3_BFAF 74FS3_DFAF 74FS3_0FAF 74FS3_EFAF
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
7
117 — — 75 100 — 3RW4055-6BB35 74AS35BFAF 74AS35DFAF 74AS350FAF 74AS35EFAF 74AS35WFAF
145 — — 100 150 — 3RW4056-6BB35 74BS35BFAF 74BS35DFAF 74BS350FAF 74BS35EFAF 74BS35WFAF
SOFT STARTERS
205 — — 150 200 — 3RW4073-6BB35 74CS35BFAF 74CS35DFAF 74CS350FAF 74CS35EFAF
248 — — 200 250 — 3RW4074-6BB35 74DS35BFAF 74DS35DFAF 74DS350FAF 74DS35EFAF
315 — — 250 300 — 3RW4075-6BB35 74ES35BFAF 74ES35DFAF 74ES350FAF 74ES35EFAF
385 — — 300 400 — 3RW4076-6BB35 74FS35BFAF 74FS35DFAF 74FS350FAF 74FS35EFAF
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/117
Soft Starters
Enclosed 3RW44
Ordering Information
� nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW44 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
b Fans
� he 3RW44 is designed for normal
T b Pumps
starting applications. b Conveying systems and lifts
3RW44 Enclosed features:
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4
� or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F b Hydraulics
stainless steel b Machine tools
� or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F b Mills saws
b Compact size
b Built-in bypass contactor Class 73 non-combination starters include: b Crushers and grinders
b Multiple starting/stopping techniques b Mixers
including torque control b NEMA rated enclosure
b HVAC systems
b Internal overload class 5, 10, 15, 20, or 30 b 3RW44 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
The 3RW44 severe duty rating table should
b Built-in graphical LCD keypad and bypass
b Internal self protection be applied for high inertia applications
b Control circuit transformer
such rock crushers, chippers, screw
b Fault monitoring
b 3 parameter sets b Reset button compressors, ect.
b Communication capable via opt. Profibus Class 73 starters are built to UL and CSA
module
b Programmable inputs and outputs standards.
b External keypad available
Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Im for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
26 7.5 7.5 15 — 12 3RW4422-1BC34 73AT3_BFA 73AT3_DFA 73AT3_0FA 73AT3_EFA 73AT3_WFA
32 10 10 20 — 15 3RW4423-1BC34 73BT3_BFA 73BT3_DFA 73BT3_0FA 73BT3_EFA 73BT3_WFA
42 10 15 25 — 19 3RW4424-1BC34 73CT3_BFA 73CT3_DFA 73CT3_0FA 73CT3_EFA 73CT3_WFA
51 15 15 30 — 22 3RW4425-1BC34 73DT3_BFA 73DT3_DFA 73DT3_0FA 73DT3_EFA 73DT3_WFA
68 20 25 50 — 37 3RW4426-1BC34 73ET3_BFA 73ET3_DFA 73ET3_0FA 73ET3_EFA 73ET3_WFA
82 25 30 60 — 45 3RW4427-1BC34 73FT3_BFA 73FT3_DFA 73FT3_0FA 73FT3_EFA 73FT3_WFA
100 30 30 75 — 56 3RW4434-6BC34 73GT3_BFA 73GT3_DFA 73GT3_0FA 73GT3_EFA 73GT3_WFA
117 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4435-6BC34 73HT3_BFA 73HT3_DFA 73HT3_0FA 73HT3_EFA 73HT3_WFA
145 40 50 100 — 75 3RW4436-6BC34 73JT3_BFA 73JT3_DFA 73JT3_0FA 73JT3_EFA 73JT3_WFA
180 60 60 125 — 93 3RW4443-6BC34 73KT3_BFA 73KT3_DFA 73KT3_0FA 73KT3_EFA 73KT3_WFA
215 60 75 150 — 112 3RW4444-6BC34 73LT3_BFA 73LT3_DFA 73LT3_0FA 73LT3_EFA 73LT3_WFA
280 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4445-6BC34 73MT3_BFA 73MT3_DFA 73MT3_0FA 73MT3_EFA 73MT3_WFA
315 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4446-6BC34 73NT3_BFA 73NT3_DFA 73NT3_0FA 73NT3_EFA 73NT3_WFA
385 125 150 300 — 224 3RW4447-6BC34 73PT3_BFA 73PT3_DFA 73PT3_0FA 73PT3_EFA 73PT3_WFA
494 150 200 400 — 298 3RW4453-6BC34 73QT3_BFA 73QT3_DFA 73QT3_0FA 73QT3_EFA
7
551 150 200 450 — 336 3RW4454-6BC34 73RT3_BFA 73RT3_DFA 73RT3_0FA 73RT3_EFA
615 200 250 500 — 373 3RW4455-6BC34 73ST3_BFA 73ST3_DFA 73ST3_0FA 73ST3_EFA
693 200 250 550 — 410
SOFT STARTERS
7/118 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters
Enclosed 3RW44
Ordering Information
� nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW44 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
b Fans
� he 3RW44 is designed for normal
T
b Pumps
starting applications.
3RW44 Enclosed features: b Conveying systems and lifts
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4
� or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F b Hydraulics
stainless steel � or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F b Machine tools
b Compact size b Mills saws
b Built-in bypass contactor Class 73 non-combination starters include: b Crushers and grinders
b Multiple starting/stopping techniques b NEMA rated enclosure b Mixers
including torque control
b Internal overload class 10, 15, or 20 b 3RW44 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL b HVAC systems
and bypass
b Built-in graphical LCD keypad The 3RW44 severe duty rating table should
b Internal self protection b Control circuit transformer be applied for high inertia applications
b Fault monitoring b Line side power terminal block such rock crushers, chippers, screw
b 3 parameter sets b Reset button compressors, ect.
b Communication capable via opt. Profibus
module Class 73 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Programmable inputs and outputs standards.
b External keypad available
Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 20 Severe Duty (350% * Im for 20s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
26 7.5 7.5 15 — 12 3RW4422-1BC34 73AT3_BFA 73AT3_DFA 73AT3_0FA 73AT3_EFA 73AT3_WFA
32 10 10 20 — 15 3RW4423-1BC34 73BT3_BFA 73BT3_DFA 73BT3_0FA 73BT3_EFA 73BT3_WFA
42 10 15 25 — 19 3RW4424-1BC34 73CT3_BFA 73CT3_DFA 73CT3_0FA 73CT3_EFA 73CT3_WFA
51 15 15 30 — 22 3RW4425-1BC34 73DT3_BFA 73DT3_DFA 73DT3_0FA 73DT3_EFA 73DT3_WFA
68 20 25 50 — 37 3RW4426-1BC34 73ET3_BFA 73ET3_DFA 73ET3_0FA 73ET3_EFA 73ET3_WFA
82 25 30 60 — 45 3RW4427-1BC34 73FT3_BFA 73FT3_DFA 73FT3_0FA 73FT3_EFA 73FT3_WFA
97 30 30 60 — 45 3RW4434-6BC34 73GT3_BFA 73GT3_DFA 73GT3_0FA 73GT3_EFA 73GT3_WFA
113 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4435-6BC34 73HT3_BFA 73HT3_DFA 73HT3_0FA 73HT3_EFA 73HT3_WFA
134 40 50 75 — 56 3RW4436-6BC34 73JT3_BFA 73JT3_DFA 73JT3_0FA 73JT3_EFA 73JT3_WFA
175 50 60 100 — 75 3RW4443-6BC34 73KT3_BFA 73KT3_DFA 73KT3_0FA 73KT3_EFA 73KT3_WFA
195 60 75 125 — 93 3RW4444-6BC34 73LT3_BFA 73LT3_DFA 73LT3_0FA 73LT3_EFA 73LT3_WFA
243 75 75 150 — 112 3RW4445-6BC34 73MT3_BFA 73MT3_DFA 73MT3_0FA 73MT3_EFA 73MT3_WFA
263 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4446-6BC34 73NT3_BFA 73NT3_DFA 73NT3_0FA 73NT3_EFA 73NT3_WFA
326 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4447-6BC34 73PT3_BFA 73PT3_DFA 73PT3_0FA 73PT3_EFA 73PT3_WFA
494 150 150 400 — 224 3RW4453-6BC34 73QT3_BFA 73QT3_DFA 73QT3_0FA 73QT3_EFA
7
551 150 200 450 — 298 3RW4454-6BC34 73RT3_BFA 73RT3_DFA 73RT3_0FA 73RT3_EFA
615 200 200 500 — 336 3RW4455-6BC34 73ST3_BFA 73ST3_DFA 73ST3_0FA 73ST3_EFA
634 200 250 500 — 373 3RW4456-6BC34 73TT3_BFA 73TT3_DFA 73TT3_0FA 73TT3_EFA
SOFT STARTERS
650 200 250 550 — 410 3RW4457-6BC34 73WT3_BFA 73WT3_DFA 73WT3_0FA 73WT3_EFA
880 300 350 700 — 522 3RW4465-6BC34 73YT3_BFA 73YT3_0FA
940 300 350 750 — 559 3RW4466-6BC34 73ZT3_BFA 73ZT3_0FA
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
26 — — 15 20 — 3RW4422-1BC35 73AT35BFA 73AT35DFA 73AT350FA 73AT35EFA 73AT35WFA
32 — — 20 25 — 3RW4423-1BC35 73BT35BFA 73BT35DFA 73BT350FA 73BT35EFA 73BT35WFA
42 — — 25 30 — 3RW4424-1BC35 73CT35BFA 73CT35DFA 73CT350FA 73CT35EFA 73CT35WFA
51 — — 30 40 — 3RW4425-1BC35 73DT35BFA 73DT35DFA 73DT350FA 73DT35EFA 73DT35WFA
68 — — 50 50 — 3RW4426-1BC35 73ET35BFA 73ET35DFA 73ET350FA 73ET35EFA 73ET35WFA
82 — — 60 75 — 3RW4427-1BC35 73FT35BFA 73FT35DFA 73FT350FA 73FT35EFA 73FT35WFA
97 — — 60 75 — 3RW4434-6BC35 73GT35BFA 73GT35DFA 73GT350FA 73GT35EFA 73GT35WFA
113 — — 75 100 — 3RW4435-6BC35 73HT35BFA 73HT35DFA 73HT350FA 73HT35EFA 73HT35WFA
134 — — 75 125 — 3RW4436-6BC35 73JT35BFA 73JT35DFA 73JT350FA 73JT35EFA 73JT35WFA
175 — — 100 150 — 3RW4443-6BC35 73KT35BFA 73KT35DFA 73KT350FA 73KT35EFA 73KT35WFA
195 — — 125 200 — 3RW4444-6BC35 73LT35BFA 73LT35DFA 73LT350FA 73LT35EFA 73LT35WFA
243 — — 150 200 — 3RW4445-6BC35 73MT35BFA 73MT35DFA 73MT350FA 73MT35EFA 73MT35WFA
263 — — 200 250 — 3RW4446-6BC35 73NT35BFA 73NT35DFA 73NT350FA 73NT35EFA 73NT35WFA
326 — — 250 300 — 3RW4447-6BC35 73PT35BFA 73PT35DFA 73PT350FA 73PT35EFA 73PT35WFA
494 — — 400 500 — 3RW4453-6BC35 73QT35BFA 73QT35DFA 73QT350FA 73QT35EFA
551 — — 450 550 — 3RW4454-6BC35 73RT35BFA 73RT35DFA 73RT350FA 73RT35EFA
615 — — 500 600 — 3RW4455-6BC35 73ST35BFA 73ST35DFA 73ST350FA 73ST35EFA
693 — — 500 650 — 3RW4456-6BC35 73TT35BFA 73TT35DFA 73TT350FA 73TT35EFA
780 — — 550 700 — 3RW4457-6BC35 73WT35BFA 73WT35DFA 73WT350FA 73WT35EFA
880 — — 700 850 — 3RW4465-6BC35 73YT35BFA 73YT350FA
940 — — 750 900 — 3RW4466-6BC35 73ZT35BFA 73ZT350FA
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/119
Soft Starters
Enclosed 3RW44
Ordering Information
� nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW44 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
b Fans
� T he 3RW44 is designed for normal
starting applications. b Pumps
b Conveying systems and lifts
3RW44 Enclosed features: � F or factory modifications see page 7/124. b Hydraulics
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4 � F or dimensional drawings see page 7/125. b Machine tools
stainless steel
b Compact size � F or stocked versions see page 7/89. b Mills saws
b Built-in bypass contactor Class 74 non-combination starters include: b Crushers and grinders
b Multiple starting/stopping techniques b NEMA rated enclosure
b Mixers
including torque control b HVAC systems
b Internal overload class 5, 10, 15, 20, or 30 b 3RW44 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
b Built-in graphical LCD keypad and bypass The 3RW44 severe duty rating table should
b Internal self protection b Circuit breaker with disconnect be applied for high inertia applications
b Fault monitoring b Control circuit transformer such rock crushers, chippers, screw
b 3 parameter sets compressors, ect.
b Communication capable via opt. Profibus b Reset button
module Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Programmable inputs and outputs standards.
b External keypad available
551 150 200 450 — 336 3RW4454-6BC34 74RT3_BFAT 74RT3_DFAT 74RT3_0FAT 74RT3_EFAT
615 200 250 500 — 373 3RW4455-6BC34 74ST3_BFAT 74ST3_DFAT 74ST3_0FAT 74ST3_EFAT
693 200 250 550 — 410 3RW4456-6BC34 74TT3_BFAT 74TT3_DFAT 74TT3_0FAT 74TT3_EFAT
SOFT STARTERS
780 200 250 600 — 447 3RW4457-6BC34 74WT3_BFAT 74WT3_DFAT 74WT3_0FAT 74WT3_EFAT
970 350 350 800 — 597 3RW4465-6BC34 74YT3_BFAT 74YT3_0FAT
1076 350 400 900 — 672 3RW4466-6BC34 74ZT3_BFAT 74ZT3_0FAT
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
26 — — 15 20 — 3RW4422-1BC35 74AT35BFAP 74AT35DFAP 74AT350FAP 74AT35EFAP 74AT35WFAP
32 — — 20 25 — 3RW4423-1BC35 74BT35BFAP 74BT35DFAP 74BT350FAP 74BT35EFAP 74BT35WFAP
42 — — 25 30 — 3RW4424-1BC35 74CT35BFAP 74CT35DFAP 74CT350FAP 74CT35EFAP 74CT35WFAP
51 — — 30 40 — 3RW4425-1BC35 74DT35BFAP 74DT35DFAP 74DT350FAP 74DT35EFAP 74DT35WFAP
68 — — 50 50 — 3RW4426-1BC35 74ET35BFAP 74ET35DFAP 74ET350FAP 74ET35EFAP 74ET35WFAP
82 — — 60 75 — 3RW4427-1BC35 74FT35BFAP 74FT35DFAP 74FT350FAP 74FT35EFAP 74FT35WFAP
100 — — 75 75 — 3RW4434-6BC35 74GT35BFAP 74GT35DFAP 74GT350FAP 74GT35EFAP 74GT35WFAP
117 — — 75 100 — 3RW4435-6BC35 74HT35BFAP 74HT35DFAP 74HT350FAP 74HT35EFAP 74HT35WFAP
145 — — 100 125 — 3RW4436-6BC35 74JT35BFAP 74JT35DFAP 74JT350FAP 74JT35EFAP 74JT35WFAP
180 — — 125 150 — 3RW4443-6BC35 74KT35BFAP 74KT35DFAP 74KT350FAP 74KT35EFAP
215 — — 150 200 — 3RW4444-6BC35 74LT35BFAP 74LT35DFAP 74LT350FAP 74LT35EFAP
280 — — 200 250 — 3RW4445-6BC35 74MT35BFAP 74MT35DFAP 74MT350FAP 74MT35EFAP
315 — — 250 300 — 3RW4446-6BC35 74NT35BFAP 74NT35DFAP 74NT350FAP 74NT35EFAP
385 — — 300 400 — 3RW4447-6BC35 74PT35BFAP 74PT35DFAP 74PT350FAP 74PT35EFAP
494 — — 400 500 — 3RW4453-6BC35 74QT35BFAT 74QT35DFAT 74QT350FAT 74QT35EFAT
551 — — 450 600 — 3RW4454-6BC35 74RT35BFAT 74RT35DFAT 74RT350FAT 74RT35EFAT
615 — — 500 700 — 3RW4455-6BC35 74ST35BFAT 74ST35DFAT 74ST350FAT 74ST35EFAT
693 — — 550 750 — 3RW4456-6BC35 74TT35BFAT 74TT35DFAT 74TT350FAT 74TT35EFAT
780 — — 600 850 — 3RW4457-6BC35 74WT35BFAT 74WT35DFAT 74WT350FAT 74WT35EFAT
970 — — 800 1000 — 3RW4465-6BC35 74YT35BFAT 74YT350FAT
1076 — — 900 1100 — 3RW4466-6BC35 74ZT35BFAT 74ZT350FAT
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.
7/120 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters
Enclosed 3RW44
Ordering Information
� nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW44 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
� he 3RW44 is designed for normal
T b Fans
starting applications. b Pumps
3RW44 Enclosed features: b Conveying systems and lifts
� or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F
b Hydraulics
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4 or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F
stainless steel
�
b Machine tools
b Compact size � or stocked versions see page 7/89.
F b Mills saws
b Built-in bypass contactor Class 74 non-combination starters include: b Crushers and grinders
b Multiple starting/stopping techniques b Mixers
including torque control b NEMA rated enclosure b HVAC systems
b Internal overload class 5, 10, 15, 20, or 30 b 3RW44 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
b Built-in graphical LCD keypad and bypass The 3RW44 severe duty rating table should
b Internal self protection be applied for high inertia applications
b Fault monitoring b Circuit breaker with disconnect
such rock crushers, chippers, screw
b 3 parameter sets b Control circuit transformer compressors, ect.
b Communication capable via opt. Profibus b Reset button
module Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Programmable inputs and outputs standards.
b External keypad available
Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 20 Severe Duty (350% * Im for 20s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
26 7.5 7.5 15 — 12 3RW4422-1BC34 74AT3_BFAP 74AT3_DFAP 74AT3_0FAP 74AT3_EFAP 74AT3_WFAP
32 10 10 20 — 15 3RW4423-1BC34 74BT3_BFAP 74BT3_DFAP 74BT3_0FAP 74BT3_EFAP 74BT3_WFAP
42 10 15 25 — 19 3RW4424-1BC34 74CT3_BFAP 74CT3_DFAP 74CT3_0FAP 74CT3_EFAP 74CT3_WFAP
51 15 15 30 — 22 3RW4425-1BC34 74DT3_BFAP 74DT3_DFAP 74DT3_0FAP 74DT3_EFAP 74DT3_WFAP
68 20 25 50 — 37 3RW4426-1BC34 74ET3_BFAP 74ET3_DFAP 74ET3_0FAP 74ET3_EFAP 74ET3_WFAP
82 25 30 60 — 45 3RW4427-1BC34 74FT3_BFAP 74FT3_DFAP 74FT3_0FAP 74FT3_EFAP 74FT3_WFAP
97 30 30 60 — 45 3RW4434-6BC34 74GT3_BFAP 74GT3_DFAP 74GT3_0FAP 74GT3_EFAP 74GT3_WFAP
113 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4435-6BC34 74HT3_BFAP 74HT3_DFAP 74HT3_0FAP 74HT3_EFAP 74HT3_WFAP
134 40 50 75 — 56 3RW4436-6BC34 74JT3_BFAP 74JT3_DFAP 74JT3_0FAP 74JT3_EFAP 74JT3_WFAP
175 50 60 100 — 75 3RW4443-6BC34 74KT3_BFAP 74KT3_DFAP 74KT3_0FAP 74KT3_EFAP
195 60 75 125 — 93 3RW4444-6BC34 74LT3_BFAP 74LT3_DFAP 74LT3_0FAP 74LT3_EFAP
243 75 75 150 — 112 3RW4445-6BC34 74MT3_BFAP 74MT3_DFAP 74MT3_0FAP 74MT3_EFAP
263 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4446-6BC34 74NT3_BFAP 74NT3_DFAP 74NT3_0FAP 74NT3_EFAP
326 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4447-6BC34 74PT3_BFAP 74PT3_DFAP 74PT3_0FAP 74PT3_EFAP
494 150 150 400 — 224 3RW4453-6BC34 74QT3_BFAT 74QT3_DFAT 74QT3_0FAT 74QT3_EFAT
7
551 150 200 450 — 298 3RW4454-6BC34 74RT3_BFAT 74RT3_DFAT 74RT3_0FAT 74RT3_EFAT
615 200 200 500 — 336 3RW4455-6BC34 74ST3_BFAT 74ST3_DFAT 74ST3_0FAT 74ST3_EFAT
634 200 250 500 — 373 3RW4456-6BC34 74TT3_BFAT 74TT3_DFAT 74TT3_0FAT 74TT3_EFAT
SOFT STARTERS
650 200 250 550 — 410 3RW4457-6BC34 74WT3_BFAT 74WT3_DFAT 74WT3_0FAT 74WT3_EFAT
880 300 350 700 — 522 3RW4465-6BC34 74YT3_BFAT 74YT3_0FAT
940 300 350 750 — 559 3RW4466-6BC34 74ZT3_BFAT 74ZT3_0FAT
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
26 — — 15 20 — 3RW4422-1BC35 74AT35BFAP 74AT35DFAP 74AT350FAP 74AT35EFAP 74AT35WFAP
32 — — 20 25 — 3RW4423-1BC35 74BT35BFAP 74BT35DFAP 74BT350FAP 74BT35EFAP 74BT35WFAP
42 — — 25 30 — 3RW4424-1BC35 74CT35BFAP 74CT35DFAP 74CT350FAP 74CT35EFAP 74CT35WFAP
51 — — 30 40 — 3RW4425-1BC35 74DT35BFAP 74DT35DFAP 74DT350FAP 74DT35EFAP 74DT35WFAP
68 — — 50 50 — 3RW4426-1BC35 74ET35BFAP 74ET35DFAP 74ET350FAP 74ET35EFAP 74ET35WFAP
82 — — 60 75 — 3RW4427-1BC35 74FT35BFAP 74FT35DFAP 74FT350FAP 74FT35EFAP 74FT35WFAP
97 — — 60 75 — 3RW4434-6BC35 74GT35BFAP 74GT35DFAP 74GT350FAP 74GT35EFAP 74GT35WFAP
113 — — 75 100 — 3RW4435-6BC35 74HT35BFAP 74HT35DFAP 74HT350FAP 74HT35EFAP 74HT35WFAP
134 — — 75 125 — 3RW4436-6BC35 74JT35BFAP 74JT35DFAP 74JT350FAP 74JT35EFAP 74JT35WFAP
175 — — 100 150 — 3RW4443-6BC35 74KT35BFAP 74KT35DFAP 74KT350FAP 74KT35EFAP
195 — — 125 200 — 3RW4444-6BC35 74LT35BFAP 74LT35DFAP 74LT350FAP 74LT35EFAP
243 — — 150 200 — 3RW4445-6BC35 74MT35BFAP 74MT35DFAP 74MT350FAP 74MT35EFAP
263 — — 200 250 — 3RW4446-6BC35 74NT35BFAP 74NT35DFAP 74NT350FAP 74NT35EFAP
326 — — 250 300 — 3RW4447-6BC35 74PT35BFAP 74PT35DFAP 74PT350FAP 74PT35EFAP
494 — — 400 500 — 3RW4453-6BC35 74QT35BFAT 74QT35DFAT 74QT350FAT 74QT35EFAT
551 — — 450 550 — 3RW4454-6BC35 74RT35BFAT 74RT35DFAT 74RT350FAT 74RT35EFAT
615 — — 500 600 — 3RW4455-6BC35 74ST35BFAT 74ST35DFAT 74ST350FAT 74ST35EFAT
693 — — 500 650 — 3RW4456-6BC35 74TT35BFAT 74TT35DFAT 74TT350FAT 74TT35EFAT
780 — — 550 700 — 3RW4457-6BC35 74WT35BFAT 74WT35DFAT 74WT350FAT 74WT35EFAT
880 — — 700 850 — 3RW4465-6BC35 74YT35BFAT 74YT350FAT
940 — — 750 900 — 3RW4466-6BC35 74ZT35BFAT 74ZT350FAT
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.
b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/121
Soft Starters
Enclosed 3RW44
Ordering Information
� nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW44 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
� he 3RW44 is designed for normal
T b Fans
starting applications. b Pumps
3RW44 Enclosed features: b Conveying systems and lifts
� or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F b Hydraulics
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4
stainless steel � or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F b Machine tools
b Compact size Class 74 non-combination starters include: b Mills saws
b Built-in bypass contactor b Crushers and grinders
b Multiple starting/stopping techniques b NEMA rated enclosure
including torque control b Mixers
b 3RW44 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL b HVAC systems
b Internal overload class 5, 10, 15, 20, or 30 and bypass
b Built-in graphical LCD keypad b Fusible disconnect The 3RW44 severe duty rating table should
b Internal self protection be applied for high inertia applications
b Fault monitoring b Control circuit transformer
such rock crushers, chippers, screw
b 3 parameter sets b Reset button compressors, ect.
b Communication capable via opt. Profibus
module Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Programmable inputs and outputs standards.
b External keypad available
For all technical information, please consult the 2006 Industrial Controls Catalog or contact your local sales support center.
Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty b (350% * Im for 10s)
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
26 7.5 7.5 15 — 12 3RW4422-1BC34 74AT3_BFAF 74AT3_DFAF 74AT3_0FAF 74AT3_EFAF 74AT3_WFAF
32 10 10 20 — 15 3RW4423-1BC34 74BT3_BFAF 74BT3_DFAF 74BT3_0FAF 74BT3_EFAF 74BT3_WFAF
42 10 15 25 — 19 3RW4424-1BC34 74CT3_BFAF 74CT3_DFAF 74CT3_0FAF 74CT3_EFAF 74CT3_WFAF
51 15 15 30 — 22 3RW4425-1BC34 74DT3_BFAF 74DT3_DFAF 74DT3_0FAF 74DT3_EFAF 74DT3_WFAF
68 20 25 50 — 37 3RW4426-1BC34 74ET3_BFAF 74ET3_DFAF 74ET3_0FAF 74ET3_EFAF 74ET3_WFAF
82 25 30 60 — 45 3RW4427-1BC34 74FT3_BFAF 74FT3_DFAF 74FT3_0FAF 74FT3_EFAF 74FT3_WFAF
100 30 30 75 — 56 3RW4434-6BC34 74GT3_BFAF 74GT3_DFAF 74GT3_0FAF 74GT3_EFAF 74GT3_WFAF
117 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4435-6BC34 74HT3_BFAF 74HT3_DFAF 74HT3_0FAF 74HT3_EFAF 74HT3_WFAF
145 40 50 100 — 75 3RW4436-6BC34 74JT3_BFAF 74JT3_DFAF 74JT3_0FAF 74JT3_EFAF 74JT3_WFAF
180 60 60 125 — 93 3RW4443-6BC34 74KT3_BFAF 74KT3_DFAF 74KT3_0FAF 74KT3_EFAF
215 60 75 150 — 112 3RW4444-6BC34 74LT3_BFAF 74LT3_DFAF 74LT3_0FAF 74LT3_EFAF
280 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4445-6BC34 74MT3_BFAF 74MT3_DFAF 74MT3_0FAF 74MT3_EFAF
7
315 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4446-6BC34 74NT3_BFAF 74NT3_DFAF 74NT3_0FAF 74NT3_EFAF
385 125 150 300 — 224 3RW4447-6BC34 74PT3_BFAF 74PT3_DFAF 74PT3_0FAF 74PT3_EFAF
494 150 200 400 — 298 3RW4453-6BC34 74QT3_BFAF 74QT3_0FAF
SOFT STARTERS
7/122 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters
Enclosed 3RW44
Ordering Information
� nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW44 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
� he 3RW44 is designed for normal
T b Fans
starting applications. b Pumps
3RW44 Enclosed features: b Conveying systems and lifts
� or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F b Hydraulics
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4
stainless steel � or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F b Machine tools
b Compact size Class 74 non-combination starters include: b Mills saws
b Built-in bypass contactor b Crushers and grinders
b Multiple starting/stopping techniques b NEMA rated enclosure
including torque control b Mixers
b 3RW44 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL b HVAC systems
b Internal overload class 5, 10, 15, 20, or 30 and bypass
b Built-in graphical LCD keypad b Fusible disconnect The 3RW44 severe duty rating table should
b Internal self protection be applied for high inertia applications
b Fault monitoring b Control circuit transformer
such rock crushers, chippers, screw
b 3 parameter sets b Reset button compressors, ect.
b Communication capable via opt. Profibus
module Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Programmable inputs and outputs standards.
b External keypad available
For all technical information, please consult the 2006 Industrial Controls Catalog or contact your local sales support center.
Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 20 Severe Duty (350% * Im for 20s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
26 7.5 7.5 15 — 12 3RW4422-1BC34 74AT3_BFAF 74AT3_DFAF 74AT3_0FAF 74AT3_EFAF 74AT3_WFAF
32 10 10 20 — 15 3RW4423-1BC34 74BT3_BFAF 74BT3_DFAF 74BT3_0FAF 74BT3_EFAF 74BT3_WFAF
42 10 15 25 — 19 3RW4424-1BC34 74CT3_BFAF 74CT3_DFAF 74CT3_0FAF 74CT3_EFAF 74CT3_WFAF
51 15 15 30 — 22 3RW4425-1BC34 74DT3_BFAF 74DT3_DFAF 74DT3_0FAF 74DT3_EFAF 74DT3_WFAF
68 20 25 50 — 37 3RW4426-1BC34 74ET3_BFAF 74ET3_DFAF 74ET3_0FAF 74ET3_EFAF 74ET3_WFAF
82 25 30 60 — 45 3RW4427-1BC34 74FT3_BFAF 74FT3_DFAF 74FT3_0FAF 74FT3_EFAF 74FT3_WFAF
97 30 30 60 — 45 3RW4434-6BC34 74GT3_BFAF 74GT3_DFAF 74GT3_0FAF 74GT3_EFAF 74GT3_WFAF
113 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4435-6BC34 74HT3_BFAF 74HT3_DFAF 74HT3_0FAF 74HT3_EFAF 74HT3_WFAF
134 40 50 75 — 56 3RW4436-6BC34 74JT3_BFAF 74JT3_DFAF 74JT3_0FAF 74JT3_EFAF 74JT3_WFAF
175 50 60 100 — 75 3RW4443-6BC34 74KT3_BFAF 74KT3_DFAF 74KT3_0FAF 74KT3_EFAF
195 60 75 125 — 93 3RW4444-6BC34 74LT3_BFAF 74LT3_DFAF 74LT3_0FAF 74LT3_EFAF
243 75 75 150 — 112 3RW4445-6BC34 74MT3_BFAF 74MT3_DFAF 74MT3_0FAF 74MT3_EFAF
7
263 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4446-6BC34 74NT3_BFAF 74NT3_DFAF 74NT3_0FAF 74NT3_EFAF
326 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4447-6BC34 74PT3_BFAF 74PT3_DFAF 74PT3_0FAF 74PT3_EFAF
494 150 150 400 — 298 3RW4453-6BC34 74QT3_BFAF 74QT3_0FAF
SOFT STARTERS
551 150 200 450 — 336 3RW4454-6BC34 74RT3_BFAF 74RT3_0FAF
615 200 200 500 — 373 3RW4455-6BC34 74ST3_BFAF 74ST3_0FAF
634 200 250 500 — 373 3RW4456-6BC34 74TT3_BFAF 74TT3_0FAF
650 200 250 550 — 373 3RW4457-6BC34 74WT3_BFAF 74WT3_0FAF
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
26 — — 15 20 — 3RW4422-1BC35 74AT35BFAF 74AT35DFAF 74AT350FAF 74AT35EFAF 74AT35WFAF
32 — — 20 25 — 3RW4423-1BC35 74BT35BFAF 74BT35DFAF 74BT350FAF 74BT35EFAF 74BT35WFAF
42 — — 25 30 — 3RW4424-1BC35 74CT35BFAF 74CT35DFAF 74CT350FAF 74CT35EFAF 74CT35WFAF
51 — — 30 40 — 3RW4425-1BC35 74DT35BFAF 74DT35DFAF 74DT350FAF 74DT35EFAF 74DT35WFAF
68 — — 50 50 — 3RW4426-1BC35 74ET35BFAF 74ET35DFAF 74ET350FAF 74ET35EFAF 74ET35WFAF
82 — — 60 75 — 3RW4427-1BC35 74FT35BFAF 74FT35DFAF 74FT350FAF 74FT35EFAF 74FT35WFAF
97 — — 60 75 — 3RW4434-6BC35 74GT35BFAF 74GT35DFAF 74GT350FAF 74GT35EFAF 74GT35WFAF
113 — — 75 100 — 3RW4435-6BC35 74HT35BFAF 74HT35DFAF 74HT350FAF 74HT35EFAF 74HT35WFAF
134 — — 75 125 — 3RW4436-6BC35 74JT35BFAF 74JT35DFAF 74JT350FAF 74JT35EFAF 74JT35WFAF
175 — — 100 150 — 3RW4443-6BC35 74KT35BFAF 74KT35DFAF 74KT350FAF 74KT35EFAF
195 — — 125 200 — 3RW4444-6BC35 74LT35BFAF 74LT35DFAF 74LT350FAF 74LT35EFAF
243 — — 150 200 — 3RW4445-6BC35 74MT35BFAF 74MT35DFAF 74MT350FAF 74MT35EFAF
263 — — 200 250 — 3RW4446-6BC35 74NT35BFAF 74NT35DFAF 74NT350FAF 74NT35EFAF
326 — — 250 300 — 3RW4447-6BC35 74PT35BFAF 74PT35DFAF 74PT350FAF 74PT35EFAF
494 — — 400 500 — 3RW4453-6BC35 74QT35BFAF 74QT350FAF
551 — — 450 550 — 3RW4454-6BC35 74RT35BFAF 74RT350FAF
615 — — 500 600 — 3RW4455-6BC35 74ST35BFAF 74ST350FAF
693 — — 550 650 — 3RW4456-6BC35 74TT35BFAF 74TT350FAF
780 — — 600 700 — 3RW4457-6BC35 74WT35BFAF 74WT350FAF
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/123
Soft Starters
Factory Modifications
3RW Enclosure
Emergency HP Rated Bypass Starter Version Class NEMA Type Mod Suffix
3RW40ab 73/74 1/12/3R/4 A12
Available Modifications
Requiring the MODIFIED OPTIONS Box Size 3RW Enclosure
(to be used with the selections ending in GA*) Version Class NEMA Type Mod Suffix
Isolation Contactor 3RW40/44 73/74 1/12/3R/4 IC
100 VA Extra CPT Capacity 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL CA
Space Heater (120V separate control) 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL SH
Space Heater w/ T-stat (120V separate control) 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL ST
Lightning Arrestor 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL L
a (A) For sizes 73YT & 73ZT, mods IC & A12 are available individually or together; Isolation contactor IC is included as standard with version 3RW40 model R (4th
(B) For sizes 74YT & 74ZT (combination w\CB), mods IC & A12 are only available character of the cat. no.) soft starters.
individually (NOT together); (C) For sizes 74YT & 74ZT (combination w\ fusible disc), d Pilot lights are transformer type as standard. For LED type bulbs, order suffix FE in
mods IC & A12 are NOT available individually or together. addition to the standard device suffix(es). For example, to order red “ON” and green
An isolation contactor is included with the emergency HP rated bypass starter for “OFF” pilot lights with LED bulbs, order FA, FK and FE.
version 3RW40 soft starters.
7/124 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters
Class 73, 74
Dimensions are in inches and are for reference only (not for construction). Certain styles may deviate from values indicated.
7
970 - 1076 90 50 20
Amps A B C
3RW40new 11- 98 55 29 11 N1, N12 Fusible
SOFT STARTERS
117 36 18 15
Amps A B C
3RW40 145 - 205A 36 22 20
248 - 385 54 36 20 3RW44 494-780 90 50 20
26 - 51 26 12.5 15
68 - 82 36 18 15
3RW44 N4X Stainless Steel Standard Enclosure
100 - 117 36 22 20
145 - 385 54 36 20 Amps A B C
3RW40new 11- 98 55 29 11
117 - 145 54 36 20
N1, N3R, N12, N4 Modified Enclosure 3RW40
205 - 300 90 40 20
Amps A B C 26 - 42 36 23 15
3RW40 117-385 56 36 20 51 - 100 50 25 20
26-51 36 22 20 3RW44
3RW44 117 - 145 54 36 20
68-385 54 36 20 180 - 385 90 40 20
N4X Stainless Steel Modified Enclosure N1, N3R, N12, N4 Modified Enclosure
Amps A B C
Amps A B C
117 - 248 76 30 20
3RW40 117-385 54 36 20
3RW40 315 90 30 20
26-51 36 22 20
3RW44 385 90 40 20
68-385 54 36 20
26 - 215 76 30 20
3RW44 280 90 30 20
315 - 385 90 40 20
Class 73, 74
7
SOFT STARTERS
SINAMICS G120X
Introduction
SINAMICS G120X
An infrastructure drive for pumps, fans
and compressors
Siemens introduces an exciting new addition to the existing
SINAMICS product portfolio — the G120X — an “infrastructure”
drive up to 700 hp (630kW), which is targeted for pump, fan
and compressor applications in the water / wastewater, HVAC,
irrigation / agriculture and industrial chiller and refrigeration
industries.
Seamless process for higher efficiency
SINAMICS G120X is simple, seamless, cost- and energy-
efficient, robust, reliable and fit for digitalization. It integrates
easily into existing applications, works with any standard motor
(induction, synchronous and synchronous reluctance) and can be
configured for cost-optimization and resource-saving operation
which ultimately helps reduce total cost of ownership. SINAMICS
G120X meets all the latest industry standards with regard to
energy efficiency and product safety, and offers enhanced safety
with SIL3-rated safety functions and up to 100kA short-circuit
current rating according to new UL61800-5-1 design.
Application functions
Pump-specific
Service mode
n
7
Fan-specific
n Flying restart n Fire mode (essential service mode)
DRIVES
n Automatic restart n No load, torque and rotation (belt) monitoring with sensor
n Skip frequency bands
n Eco mode n Bypass mode n Support to high efficiency motors (PMSM and SRM)
n Hibernation or sleep mode n Energy / flow calculator n Real time clock and programmable timer (3)
Optimize pump and fan operation and increase system availability
Protection functions
n Phase-loss detection for both supply and motor n Motor overload monitoring and protection
n Overvoltage controller n Motor short-circuit and ground fault protection
n Undervoltage controller n Speed and torque monitoring
n Drive overtemperature protection n Blocking and stalling monitoring and protection
n Loss of analog input signal monitoring n Detection of missing communication telegrams
n External fault and warning monitoring (up to 3) n Detection of communication bus interruption
n Motor overtemperature protection (with and without sensor)
SINAMICS G120X
Technical data
Technical data
Line voltage and output power range
FSA…FSF 3AC 200V (-20%)…240V (+10%) 1 hp…75 hp (0.75kW…55kW)
FSA…FSG 3AC 380V (-20%)…480V (+10%) 1 hp…400 hp (0.75kW…250kW)
FSH, FSJ 3AC 380V (-15%)…480V (+10%) 400 hp…700 hp (315kW…560kW)
FSD…FSG 3AC 500V (-20%)…690V (+10%) 4 hp…250 hp (3kW…250kW)
FSH, FSJ 3AC 500V (-15%)…690V (+10%) 350 hp…700 hp (315kW…630kW)
Output voltage 3AC 0V….line voltage x 0.97
Input frequency 47 Hz…63 Hz
Output frequency
FSA…FSG 0 Hz…550 Hz (depending upon the control mode)
FSH, FSJ 0 Hz…150 Hz (depending upon the control mode)
Fundamental power factor (Cos φ) 0.96…0.99
Efficiency class IE2 (Based on power losses according to EN 50598-2 and IEC 61800-9-2)
Efficiency (η) 98%
Motor control n V/Hz control (linear, linear with flux current control / FCC, parabolic and eco mode)
n Sensorless less vector control (SLVC)
Supported motor types n Asynchronous (induction) motor
n Permanent magnet synchronous motor (PMSM)
n Synchronous reluctance motor (SRM)
2 Analog Inputs (AI 0…AI 1) Differential input 0V… 10V or -10V … +10V: typical current drain: 0.1 mA,
max. voltage 35V
DRIVES
0/4 mA ... 20 mA: 120 Ω input resistance, voltage < 10V, current < 80 mA
1 Analog Output (AO 0) Not isolated, switchable between voltage (0V… 10V) and current
(0/4 mA ... 20 mA) via parameter setting
1 motor temperature sensor input PTC, KTY, PT1000, bi-metallic switch with normally closed contact
1 failsafe digital input STO — electrically isolated
1 internal aux. supply voltage
24V DC, max. 250 mA
10V DC, max. 10 mA
1 external aux. supply voltage 24V DC (20.4 … 28.8V DC), current consumption 0.5A
1 memory card slot For optional SD memory cards (as a backup storage device for saving of the settings after drive com-
missioning, and also for a series commissioning of a several identical drives via cloning of the settings)
Additional control inputs and outputs (With optional I/O Extension Module)
2 Digital Inputs (DI 6…DI 7) 24V (12–30V) electrically isolated, 4mA current, PNP / NPN switchable
4 Digital (Relay) Outputs (DO 2…DO 5) 2x Type A and 2x Type C relay outputs rated 250V AC, 2A / 30V DC, 2A for resistive,
inductive or capacitive load
1 Analog Input (AI 2) Analog current input (0/4 mA … 20 mA) or Temperature sensor input
(Pt10000 / LG-Ni10000 / DIN-Ni1000)
1 motor temperature sensor input (AI 3) Temperature sensor input (Sensor Pt10000 / LG-Ni10000 / DIN-Ni1000)
2 Analog Output (AO 1 … AO 2) Not isolated, switchable between voltage (0V… 10V) and current (0/4 mA ... 20 mA)
via parameter setting
User interface
Standard Intelligent Operator Panel (IOP-2) — a high-resolution graphical color keypad
Optional Smart Access Module (SAM) Part number: 6SL3255-0AA00-5AA0 — a WiFi-based web server module and
engineering tool for quick setup and diagnostics using
a mobile device (PC, smartphone, tablet, etc.)
Basic Operator Panel (BOP-2) — a basic keypad
Blank (no Operator Panel / keypad)
SINAMICS G120X
General data
SINAMICS G120X
It’s the simple, seamless and easy-to-use drive — right out of the box.
Digitalization
Digitalization and IoT based secured health monitoring
SINAMICS CONNECT 300 SINAMICS CONNECT 300 (Part number: 6SL3255-0AG30-0AA0) is the
and IoT gateway. It is designed to acquire data through the serial port of the
Analyze MyDrives SINAMICS G120X and synchronize the data to MindSphere (cloud-based
open IoT operating system of Siemens) using the MindSphere application
Analyze MyDrives (AMD).
Certification
n CULUS
marking according to UL61800-5-1 and CSA C22.2 No. 274 with
Certification /
SCCR up to 100kA
marking
n CE marking according to European Low-Voltage Directive 2014/35/
EU EU and IEC/EN 61800-5-1, Machinery directive 2006/42/EC and IEC/
EN 61800-5-2, EMC Directive 2014/30/EU and IEC/EN 61800-3, RoHS
directive 2011/65/EU and EN 50581
n IE2efficiency level based on power losses according to EN 50598-2 and
IEC 61800-9-2
n Safe torque off (STO) SIL3 rating according to IEC/EN 61800-5-2
n EAC, K, RCM (formerly C-Tick), REACH, RoHS II, SEMI F47
Additional D
Dimensions and clearance distances FSA...FSJ depth
7
size mm (inch) mm (inch) mm (inch) mm (inch)
DRIVES
FSB 275 (10.8) 100 (3.9) 209 (8.2) 5.8 (12.8) 6.2 (13.7)
n For additional technical information including operating instructions please visit SINAMICS
G120X Technical Reference site: https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/us/en/ps/25454
SINAMICS G120X
Selection and ordering data
EMC class
No EMI / RFI filter U
Communication interface
PROFINET, EtherNet / IP™ (Standard) F
USS, Modbus, RTU, BACnet MS / TP B
PROFIBUS DP P
*Special coating or sealing for operation in harsh / corrosive environments
SINAMICS G120X
Selection and ordering data
7
560 700 830 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y E 6 6 – C 0
Special coating according to IEC/EN 60721-3-3
DRIVES
Class 3C2 (Standard) 2
Class 3C3* 3
User interface
Blank (No operator panel / keypad) 1
BOP-2 (Basic keypad, Class 3C3*) 2
IOP-2 (Standard — high-resolution graphical color keypad, Class 3C3*) 3
I / O extension module
without I/O extenstion module 0
with I/O extenstion module, Class 3C3* 1
EMC class
No filter (Standard — without integrated EMI / RFI filter) for FSA to FSF only U
Filter C2 (With integrated EMI / RFI filter Category C2) for FSA to FSG only, see Note 1 A
Filter C3 (Standard — with integrated EMI / RFI filter Category C3) for FSG to FSJ only, see Note 1 C
Communication interface
PROFINET, EtherNet / IP™ (Standard) F
USS, Modbus, RTU, BACnet MS / TP B
PROFIBUS DP P
*Special coating or sealing for operation in harsh / corrosive environments
Note 1: For frame sizes FSG, FSH and FSJ, the filter can be deactivated by removing a grounding screw / clip for applications in an ungrounded or
a high-resistance grounded or a corner-grounded supply system. Please refer to the SINAMICS G120X Operating Instructions for more information.
SINAMICS G120X
Selection and ordering data
Class 3C3* 3
DRIVES
User interface
Blank (No operator panel / keypad) 1
BOP-2 (Basic keypad, Class 3C3*) 2
IOP-2 (Standard — high-resolution graphical color keypad, Class 3C3*) 3
I / O extension module
without I/O extenstion module 0
with I/O extenstion module, Class 3C3* 1
EMC class
No filter (Standard — without integrated EMI / RFI filter) for FSD to FSF only U
Filter C2 (With integrated EMI / RFI filter Category C2) for FSD to FSE only A
Filter C3 (With integrated EMI / RFI filter Category C3) for FSF to FSJ only, standard for FSG to FSJ, see Note 1 C
Communication interface
PROFINET, EtherNet / IP™ (Standard) F
USS, Modbus, RTU, BACnet MS / TP B
PROFIBUS DP P
*Special coating or sealing for operation in harsh / corrosive environments
Note 1: For frame sizes FSG, FSH and FSJ, the filter can be deactivated by removing a grounding screw / clip for applications in an ungrounded or
a high-resistance grounded or a corner-grounded supply system. Please refer to the SINAMICS G120X Operating Instructions for more information.
SINAMICS G120X
Push-through kits, Options and Features
7
FSA 6SL3261-6GA00-0BA0 127 (5.0) 324 (12.8) 234 (9.2) 160 (6.3) 57 (2.2)
FSB 6SL3261-6GB00-0BA0 154 (6.1) 384 (15.1) 279 (11.0) 153 (6.0) 66 (2.6)
DRIVES
FSC 6SL3261-6GC00-0BA0 192 (7.6) 407 (16.0) 295 (11.6) 154 (6.1) 65 (2.6)
FSD 6SL3261-6GD00-0BA0 271 (10.7) 647 (25.5) 514 (20.2) 142 (5.6) 98 (3.9)
FSE 6SL3261-6GE00-0BA0 360 (14.2) 773 (30.4) 600 (23.6) 145 (5.7) 93 (3.7)
FSF 6SL3261-6GF00-0BA0 396 (15.6) 1003 (39.5) 749 (29.5) 185 (7.3) 185 (7.3)
FSG 6SL3261-6GG00-0BA0 384 (15.1) 1275 (50.2) 1026 (40.4) 184 (7.3) 188 (7.4)
n Special coating (Class 3C3) for operation of a drive in the harsh n Output dv / dt filter
environments where corrosive gases for example, Hydrogen Sulfide
n Output Sinusoidal filter
(H2S), Chlorine (Cl) or Ammonia (NH3) are often present
n Passive line harmonic filter
n Add-on Push-Through (PT) kit to enable UL Open Type / IP20 drive in
to UL Open Type / IP20 push-through drive (up to FSG) n EMI / RFI filters
n Input and output reactors n Communication:
PROFINET, EtherNet / IP™, USS,
Modbus RTU, BACnet MS / TP and PROFIBUS DP
n I/O extension module
Notes
7
DRIVES
contents
Introduction
8 Section
8/2
Solid-state switching devices
General data 8/3
Solid-state switching devices for resistive loads
Solid-state relays
3RF21 solid-state relays, single-phase, 22.5 mm 8/8
3RF20 solid-state relays, single-phase, 45 mm 8/9
3RF22 solid-state relays, three-phase, 45 mm 8/10
Solid-state contactors
General data 8/11
3RF23 solid-state contactors, single-phase 8/12
3RF24 solid-state contactors, 3-phase 8/14
Solid-state switching devices for switching motors
Solid-state contactors
General data 8/15
3RF34 solid-state contactors, 3-phase 8/16
3RF34 solid-state reversing contactors, 3-phase 8/17
3RF29 Function modules
Assignment of modules 8/18
Converters 8/23
Load monitoring 8/24
Heating current monitoring 8/25
Power controllers 8/26
Power control regulators 8/27
Technical data
Solid-state relays
3RF21 solid-state relays, single-phase, 22.5 mm 8/29
3RF20 solid-state relays, single-phase, 45 mm 8/32
3RF22 solid-state relays, three-phase, 45 mm 8/34
Solid-state contactors
3RF23 solid-state contactors, single-phase 8/36
3RF24 solid-state contactors, three-phase 8/39
3RF34 solid-state contactors, three-phase 8/41
8
3RF29 Function modules
Converters, load monitors, power controller, heating current monitors 8/46
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Power control regulators 8/48
Thermal data 8/49
Dimensions 8/63
Wiring diagrams 8/72
Introduction
Overview
Nomenclature Guide
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
3RF2 0 20 - 1 A A 0 2
SIRIUS SC Type Rating Terminal Type Switching Control Phases Coil Type Power Voltage
Note: This is only a guide to decode the model number. All possible combinations of these are not produced.
Character of "3" in position four indicates Sirius Innovations
General data
Overview
SIRIUS 3RF2 solid-state switching devices devices are constructed with complete insulation and can be
mounted directly to 3RV2 MSPs and SIRIUS overload relays,
Solid-state switching devices for resistive loads resulting in a very simple integration into motor feeders.
• Solid-state relays
• Solid-state contactors These three-phase solid-state contactors are equipped with a
two-phase control which is particularly suitable for typical motor
• Function modules current circuits without connecting to the neutral conductor.
Solid-state switching devices for switching motors Important features:
• Solid-state contactors • Insulated enclosure with integrated heat sink
• Solid state reversing contactors • Integrated mounting foot to snap on a standard mounting rail
The most reliable solution for any application or for assembly onto a support plate
• Variety of connection methods
Compared to electro mechanical contactors, our SIRIUS 3RF2
solid-state switching devices stand out due to their considerably • Plug-in control connection
longer service life. Thanks to the high product quality, their • Display via LEDs
switching is extremely precise, reliable and, above all, insuscep-
Selecting solid-state contactors
tible to faults. With its variable connection methods and a wide
spread of control voltages, the SIRIUS 3RF2 family is universally The solid-state contactors are selected on the basis of details of
applicable. Depending on the individual requirements of the ap- the network, the load and the ambient conditions. As the
plication, our modular switchgear can also be quite easily ex- solid-state contactors are already equipped with an optimally
panded by the addition of standardized function modules. matched heat sink, the selection process is considerably
simpler than that for solid-state relays.
Semiconductor relays
The following procedure is recommended:
SIRIUS SC semiconductor relays are suitable for surface mount-
ing on existing cooling surfaces. Installation is quick and easy, • Determine the rated current of the load and the mains voltage
involving just two screws. Depending on the nature of the heat • Select a solid-state contactor with the same or higher rated
sink, the capacity reaches up to 88 A on resistive loads. The current than the load
3RF21 semiconductor relays can be expanded with various • Testing the maximum permissible switching frequency based
function modules to adapt them to individual applications. on the characteristic curves. To do this, the starting current,
The semiconductor relays are available in 2 different widths: the starting time and the motor load in the operating phase
must be known.
• 3RF21 semiconductor relay with a width of 22.5 mm
• If the permissible switching frequency is below the desired
• 3RF20 and 3RF22 semiconductor relay with a width of 45 mm
frequency, it is possible to achieve an increase by overdimen-
sioning the motor.
8
Both variants are only available in the "zero-point switching" ver-
sion. This standard version is ideally suited for operation with re-
sistive loads. Benefits
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Selecting semiconductor relays • Devices with integrated heat sink, "ready to use"
When selecting semiconductor relays, in addition to information • Compact and space-saving design
about the power system, the load and the ambient conditions it • Reversing contactors with integrated interlocking
is also necessary to know details of the planned design. The
semiconductor relays can only conform to their specific techni- Application
cal specifications if they are mounted with appropriate care on
an adequately dimensioned heat sink. The following procedure Standards and approvals
is recommended: • IEC 60947-4-3
• Determine the rated current of the load and the mains voltage • UL 508, CSA for North America1)
• Select the relay design and choose a semiconductor relay with • CE marking for Europe
higher rated current than the load requires • C-Tick approval for Australia
1)
• Determine the thermal resistance of the proposed heat sink Please note: For reversing motor applications use overvoltage protection
device Type 3TX7462-3L; max. cut-off-voltage 6000 V; min. energy han-
• Check the correct relay size with the aid of the diagram dling capability 100 J.
Solid-state contactors for switching motors
The solid-state contactors for switching motors are intended for
frequently switching on and off three-phase current operating
mechanisms up to 5 HP and reversing up to 3 HP. The
General data
Function is available
Function is possible
Note: Permissible for use at altitudes of more than 2500 m above sea level with
the following derating for 3RF2 Devices:
Site altitude 2500 m above sea level:
•Reduction of rated insulation voltage to 0,93 x Ui
•Reduction of load current to 0,93 x Ie
8
General data
8
rated currents to make selection as easy as possible. Depend- Mounting regulations
ing on the version, current intensities of up to 88 A are achieved.
Like all of our solid-state switching devices, one of their parti-
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
cular advantages is their compact and space-saving design.
With their insulated mounting foot they can easily be snapped >70 (2,75)
onto a standard mounting rail, or they can be mounted on carrier
plates with fixing screws. This insulation enables them to be
>20 (0,8)
>20 (0,8)
>20 (0,8)
3RF24..
cations, such as for extended personal safety, the heat sink can
be grounded through a screw terminal.
The solid-state contactors are available in two different versions:
NSB0_01814
General data
Performance characteristics
Functions
The performance of the semiconductor switching devices are
Connection substantially determined by the type of power semiconductors
All SIRIUS SC semiconductor switching devices are character- used and the internal design. In the case of the SIRIUS SC semi-
ized by the great variety of connection methods. You can conductor contactors and semiconductor relays, only thyristors
choose between the following connection techniques: are used instead of less powerful Triacs.
SIGUT connection system (screw) Two of the most important features of thyristors are the blocking
voltage and the maximum load integral:
The SIGUT connection system is the standard among industrial
switching devices. Open terminals and a plus-minus screw are Blocking voltage
just two features of this technology. Two conductors of up to Thyristors with a high blocking voltage can also be operated
6 mm² 1) can be connected in just one terminal. As a result, without difficulty in power systems with high interference volt-
loads of up to 50 A can be connected. ages. Separate protective measures, such as a protective circuit
Spring-loaded connection system with a varistor, are not necessary in most cases.
This innovative technology holds the conductor without screw With SIRIUS SC, for example, thyristors with 800 V blocking volt-
connection. This means that very high vibration resistance is age are fitted for operation in power systems up to 230 V. Thyris-
achieved. Two conductors of up to 2.5 mm² 1) can be connected tors with up to 1600 V are used for power systems with higher
to each terminal. As a result, loads of up to 20 A can be dealt voltages.
with. Maximum load integral
Ring terminal end connection One of the purposes of specifying the maximum load integral
The ring terminal end connection is equipped with an M5 screw. (I²t) is to determine the rating of the short-circuit protection. Only
Ring terminal ends of up to 25 mm² can be connected. In this a large power semiconductor with a correspondingly high I²t
way it is possible to connect conductors with up to 88 A safely. value can be given appropriate protection against destruction
Additional finger safety can be provided with a special cover. from a short-circuit by means of a protective device matched to
the application. However, SIRIUS SC is also characterized by the
Switching types optimum matching of the thyristors (I²t value) with the rated cur-
rents. The rated currents specified on the devices in conform-
In order to guarantee an optimized control method for different ance with EN 60947-4-3 were confirmed by extensive testing.
loads, the functionality of our semiconductor switching devices
can be adapted accordingly.
The "zero-point switching" method is ideal for resistive loads,
i.e. where the power semiconductor is activated at zero voltage.
For inductive loads, on the other hand, for example in the case
of valves, it is better to go with "instantaneous switching". By
distributing the ON point over the entire sine curve of the mains
voltage, disturbances are reduced to a minimum.
A special “low noise” version is available due to a special con-
trol, this special version can be used in public networks up to
16A without any additional measures such as interference sup-
pressor filters. As a result, it conforms to limit value curve class
B according to EN 60947-4-3 in terms of emitted interference.
Function
Two-phase controlled version
8
1) For mm2 to AWG conversion see page 19/21 of Industrial Controls catalog.
General data
Inscriptionand
Selection labels for 3RF2
ordering dataseries
Designation Labeling area Color Order No. Std. Weight
(W x H ) Pack per pack
Qty approx.
Designation Labeling
Labeling areaarea
ColorColor SD No.
Order Article No. Std. Price PUWeight PS* PG
mm xHmm
(W x(W )x H) Pack per PU (UNIT,kg
per pack
Blank labels Qty SET, M)approx.
10 x mm
Unit labeling plates mm x mm Pastel
x7mm d 00-1SB10
3RT19 816 units kg
0.110
Blank labels
Blank labels for "SIRIUS" 1) turquoise
Unit
Unit labeling
labeling plates 20
10 xx 10
plates for 7
7 x7 Pastel
Pastel 3RT19
Titanium gray
3RT19 3RT2900-1SB10
20 00-1SB20
00-1SB10 340
816 units
units 1000.220
816 units
0.110 41B
"SIRIUS" 1) 1) turquoise
for "SIRIUS" 20 x 7 turquoise
Titanium gray 20 3RT2900-1SB20 100 340 units 41B
Labels for sticking 19 20 xx 19
6
7 x6 Pastel
Pastel 3RT19 00-1SB60 3060 unit
340 units 0.150
Adhesive labels
for "SIRIUS"
3RT19
Titanium gray
turquoise 5 00-1SB20
3RT2900-1SB60 1000.220
3 060 units 41B
for SIRIUS turquoise
Labels for sticking 19 19 xx 6
6 Zinc
Pastel 3RT19
3RT19 00-1SD60
00-1SB60 3060
3060 units
unit 0.150
0.150
IC01_00181
8
type, etc.) in the load feeder.
You can find more information on the Internet at:
Suitable filters can be ordered from EPCOS AG.
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
http://www.epcos.com
You can find more information on the Internet at:
http://www.epcos.com
Solid-State Relays
22.5 mm semiconductor relays
8/8 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category: SIRIUS SC
Solid-State Switching Devices
Solid-State Relays
45 mm semiconductor relays
3RF20 20-1AA02
Type Maximum achiev- Screw connection 2) Spring-loaded Ring cable connection Std. Weight
current able power for type connection 3) Pack per pack
1) current and Ue = Qty approx.
115 V 230 V 400 V
8
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, blocking voltage 1600 V
30 - - 12 3RF20 30-1AA@6 - - 1 unit 0.085
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
50 - - 20 3RF20 50-1AA@6 - - 1 unit 0.085
70 - - 28 3RF20 70-1AA@6 - - 1 unit 0.085
88 - - 36 3RF20 90-1AA@6 - - 1 unit 0.085
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V, control DC 4 ... 30 V switching
50 - - - 3RF20 50-1AA44 - - 1 unit 0.085
Instantaneous switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V, control 24 V DC
acc. to EN 61131-2
30 - - - 3RF20 30-1BA04 - - 1 unit 0.085
Order No. extension for
rated control supply voltage Us
DC 24 V acc. to EN 61131-2 0 0 0
AC 110 V... 230 V 2 2 2
Other rated control supply voltages on request.
1) The type current provides information about the performance of the semi-
conductor relay. The actual permitted operational current Ie can be smaller
depending on the connection method and cooling conditions.
2) Please note that this version can only be used for a rated current of up to
50 A and a conductor cross section of 10mm2.
3) Screw terminals and spring terminals (control current side).
Note: For mm2 to AWG conversion chart see Industrial Controls catalog page
19/21.
Product Category: SIRIUS SC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/9
Solid-State Switching Devices
Solid-State Relays
3RF22 solid-state relays, 3-phase, 45 mm
3RF22 30-2AB45
8
Type current1) Rated control supply volt- Ring terminal end connection Weight
age per pack
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
approx.
Order No.
A V kg
Zero-point switching
Rated operational voltage Ue 48 V ... 600 V
Two-phase controlled
30 4 ... 30 V DC 3RF22 30-3AB45 0.150
55 3RF22 55-3AB45 0.150
Three-phase controlled
30 4 ... 30 V DC 3RF22 30-3AC45 0.150
55 3RF22 55-3AC45 0.150
3RF22 30-3AB45
1) The type current provides information about the performance of the 2) Please note that the version with an M4 screw terminal can only be used
solid-state relay. for a rated current of up to approx. 50 A and a conductor cross-section of
The actual permitted rated operational current Ie can be smaller 10 mm2.
depending on the connection method and cooling conditions. 3) Please note that this version can only be used for a rated current of up to
approx. 20 A and a conductor cross-section of 2.5 mm2.
8/10 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category: SIRIUS SC
Solid-State Switching Devices
Solid-State Contactors
General data
Overview
Solid-state contactors
Rated current of the Example Max. conductor Minimum cable
The complete units consist of a solid-state relay plus optimized miniature circuit Type1) cross-section length from
heat sink, and are therefore ready to use. They offer defined breaker contactor to
rated currents to make selection as easy as possible. Depend- load
ing on the version, current strengths of up to 88 A are achieved. 6A 5SY4 106-6, 1 mm2 5m
Like all of our solid-state switching devices, one of their particu- 5SX2 106-6
lar advantages is their compact and space-saving design. 10 A 5SY4 110-6, 1.5 mm2 8m
5SX2 110-6
With their insulated mounting foot they can easily be snapped 16 A 5SY4 116-6, 1.5 mm2 12 m
onto a standard mounting rail, or they can be mounted on sup- 5SX2 116-6
port plates with fixing screws. This insulation enables them to be 16 A 5SY4 116-6, 2.5 mm2 20 m
used in circuits with protective extra-low voltage (PELV) or safety 5SX2 116-6
extra-low voltage (SELV) in building management systems. For 20 A 5SY4 120-6, 2.5 mm2 20 m
other applications, such as for extended personal safety, the 5SX2 120-6
heat sink can be grounded through a screw terminal. 25 A 5SY4 125-6, 2.5 mm2 26 m
The solid-state contactors are available in 2 different versions: 5SX2 125-6
• 3RF23 single-phase solid-state contactors, 1) The miniature circuit breakers can be used up to a maximum rated voltage
of 480 V!
• 3RF24 three -phase solid-state contactors
Single-phase versions
The 3RF23 solid-state contactors can be expanded with various
function modules to adapt them to individual applications.
Version for resistive loads, "zero-point switching"
This standard version is often used for switching space heaters
on and off.
Version for inductive loads, "instantaneous switching"
In this version the solid-state contactor is specifically matched to
inductive loads. Whether it is a matter of frequent actuation of the
valves in a filling plant or starting and stopping small operating
mechanisms in packet distribution systems, operation is carried
out safely and noiselessly.
Special "Low noise" version
Thanks to a special control circuit, this special version can be
used in public networks up to 16 A without any additional mea-
sures such as interference suppressor filters. As a result it con-
forms to limit value curve class B according to EN 60947-4-3 in
terms of emitted interference.
Special "Short-circuit-proof" version The setup and installation above can also be used for the solid-
Skillful matching of the power semiconductor with the perfor- state relays with a I2t value of at least 6600 A2s.
mance capacity of the solid-state contactor means that "short- Three-phase versions
8
circuit strength" can be achieved with a standard miniature cir-
cuit breaker. In combination with a B-type MCB or a conven- The three-phase solid-state contactors for resistive loads up to
tional line protection fuse, the result is a short-circuit resistant 50 A are available with
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
feeder. • two-phase control (suitable in particular for circuits without
In order to achieve problem-free short-circuit protection by connection to the neutral conductor) and
means of miniature circuit breakers, however, certain boundary • three-phase control (suitable for star circuits with connection to
conditions must be observed. As the magnitude and duration of the neutral conductor or for applications in which the system
the short-circuit current are determined not only by the short-cir- requires all phases to be switched).
cuit breaking response of the miniature circuit breaker but also
the properties of the wiring system, such as the internal resis- The converter function module can be snapped onto both ver-
tance of the input to the network and damping by controls and sions for the simple power control of AC loads by means of ana-
cables, particular attention must also be paid to these parame- log signals.
ters. The necessary cable lengths are therefore shown for the • Check the correct contactor size with the aid of the rated cur-
main factor, the line resistance, in the table above right. rent diagram, taking account of the design conditions.
The following miniature circuit breakers with a type B tripping
characteristic and 10 kA or 6 kA breaking capacity protect the
3RF23..-.DA.. solid-state contactors in the event of short-circuits
on the load and the specified conductor cross-sections and
lengths:
Solid-State Relays
SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactors – single phase selection
3RF23 10-1AA02 3RF23 30-1AA02 3RF23 40-1AA02 3RF23 50-3AA02 3RF23 70-3AA02 3RF23 90-3AA02
Type Maximum achiev- Screw connection Spring-loaded connec- Ring cable connection Std. Weight
current able power for tion Pack per pack
1)
Imax and Ue = Qty approx.
Imax. 115 V 230 V 400 V
A kW kW kW Order No. Order No. Order No. kg
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V
10.5 1.2 2.4 - 3RF23 10-1AA@2 3RF23 10-2AA@2 3RF23 10-3AA@2 1 unit 0.136
20 2.3 4.6 - 3RF23 20-1AA@2 3RF23 20-2AA@2 3RF23 20-3AA@2 1 unit 0.204
30 3.5 6.9 - 3RF23 30-1AA@2 - 3RF23 30-3AA@2 1 unit 0.354
40 4.6 9.2 - 3RF23 40-1AA@2 - 3RF23 40-3AA@2 1 unit 0.496
50 6 12 - 3RF23 50-1AA@2 - 3RF23 50-3AA@2 1 unit 0.496
70 8 16 - - - 3RF23 70-3AA@2 1 unit 0.944
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V, control 24 V DC acc. to EN 61131-2 3)
50 - - - 3RF20 50-4AA02 - - 1 unit 0.085
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V, control 24 V DC low power
20 - - - 3RF23 20-1AA02-0KN0 - - 1 unit 0.240
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V
10.5 - 2.4 4.2 3RF23 10-1AA@4 3RF23 10-2AA@4 3RF23 10-3AA@4 1 unit 0.136
20 - 4.6 8 3RF23 20-1AA@4 3RF23 20-2AA@4 3RF23 20-3AA@4 1 unit 0.204
30 - 6.9 12 3RF23 30-1AA@4 - 3RF23 30-3AA@4 1 unit 0.354
40 - 9.2 16 3RF23 40-1AA@4 - 3RF23 40-3AA@4 1 unit 0.496
50 - 12 20 3RF23 50-1AA@4 - 3RF23 50-3AA@4 1 unit 0.496
70 - 16 28 - - 3RF23 70-3AA@4 1 unit 0.944
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V, control 24 V AC/DC
10.5 - - - 3RF23 10-1AA12 - - 1 unit 0.165
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V, control 24 V DC low power
50 - - - 3RF23 10-1AA04-0KN0 - - 1 unit 0.165
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V, control 24 V AC/DC
10.5 - - - 3RF23 10-1AA14 - - 1 unit 0.165
20 - - - 3RF23 20-1AA14 - - 1 unit 0.240
30 - - - 3RF23 30-1AA14 - - 1 unit 0.400
40 - - - 3RF23 40-1AA14 - - 1 unit 0.550
50 - - - 3RF23 50-1AA14 - - 1 unit 0.550
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, control DC 4 ... 30 V
8
8/12 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category: SIRIUS SC
Solid-State Switching Devices
Solid-State Contactors
SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactors – single phase selection
Type Maximum achiev- Screw connection Spring-loaded connec- Ring cable connection Std. Weight per
current able power for tion Pack pack approx.
1)
Imax and Ue = Qty
Imax. 115 V 230 V 400 V
A kW kW kW Order No. Order No. Order No. kg
Instantaneous switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V
10.5 1.2 2.4 - 3RF23 10-1BA@2 - - 1 unit 0.136
20 2.3 4.6 - 3RF23 20-1BA@2 - - 1 unit 0.204
30 3.5 6.9 - 3RF23 30-1BA@2 - - 1 unit 0.354
40 4.6 9.2 - 3RF23 40-1BA@2 - - 1 unit 0.496
50 6 12 - 3RF23 50-1BA@2 - - 1 unit 0.496
70 8 16 - 3RF23 70-1BA@2 - 3RF23 70-3BA@2 1 unit 0.944
88 10 20 - 3RF23 90-1BA@2 - - 1 unit 2.600
Instantaneous switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V
10.5 - 2.4 4.2 3RF23 10-1BA@4 - - 1 unit 0.136
20 - 4.6 8 3RF23 20-1BA@4 - - 1 unit 0.204
30 - 6.9 12 3RF23 30-1BA@4 - - 1 unit 0.354
40 - 9.2 16 3RF23 40-1BA@4 - - 1 unit 0.496
50 - 12 20 3RF23 50-1BA@4 - - 1 unit 0.496
70 - 16 28 3RF23 70-1BA@4 - 3RF23 70-3BA@4 1 unit 0.944
88 - 20 35 3RF23 90-1BA@4 - - 1 unit 2.600
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, control 110 V to 230 V
30 - - - 3RF23 30-1AA25 - - 1 unit 0.400
Instantaneous switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, blocking voltage 1600 V
10.5 - - 4.2 3RF23 10-1BA@6 - - 1 unit 0.136
20 - - 8 3RF23 20-1BA@6 - - 1 unit 0.204
30 - - 12 3RF23 30-1BA@6 - - 1 unit 0.354
40 - - 16 3RF23 40-1BA@6 - - 1 unit 0.496
50 - - 20 3RF23 50-1BA@6 - - 1 unit 0.496
70 - - 28 3RF23 70-1BA@6 - 3RF23 70-3BA@6 1 unit 0.944
88 - - 35 3RF23 90-1BA@6 - - 1 unit 2.600
Low noise, zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V
20 2.3 4.6 - 3RF23 20-1CA@2 3RF23 20-2CA@2 - 1 unit 0.204
30 - - - 3RF23 30-1CA02 - - 1 unit 0.204
Low noise, zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V
20 - 4.6 8 3RF23 20-1CA@4 3RF23 20-2CA@4 - 1 unit 0.204
Instantaneous switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V,
control DC 4 ... 30 V switching
20 - - - 3RF23 20-1BA44 - - 1 unit 0.240
30 - - - 3RF23 30-1BA44 - - 1 unit 0.400
50 - - - 3RF23 50-1BA44 - - 1 unit 0.550
Short-circuit resistant with B-automatic device, zero-point switching,
rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V
20 2.3 4.6 - 3RF23 20-1DA@2 3RF23 20-2DA22 3RF23 20-3DA@2 1 unit 0.204
Short-circuit resistant with B-automatic device, zero-point switching,
rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V
20 - 4.6 8 3RF23 20-1DA@4 3RF23 20-2DA24 3RF23 20-3DA@4 1 unit 0.204
20 - - - 3RF23 20-1DA44 2) - - 1 unit 0.204
30 - - - 3RF23 30-1DA44 2) - - 1 unit 0.204
Low noise, zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V,
8
control 4 V to 30 V DC
70 - - 28 3RF21 70-1CA04 - - 1 unit 0.240
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
20 - - - 3RF23 20-1CA44 - - 1 unit 0.240
Order No. extension for
rated control supply voltage Us
DC 24 V acc. to EN 61131-2 0 0 0
AC 110 V ... 230 V 2 2 2
1) The type current provides information about the performance of the semi- Other rated control supply voltages on request.
conductor contactor. The actual permitted operational current Ie can be
smaller depending on the connection method and start-up conditions. 2) 4...30 DC control voltage
Derating acc. to curves from page 7/45, 7/46, 7/47.
3RF29 00-3PA88
Product Category: SIRIUS SC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/13
Solid-State Switching Devices
Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 solid-state contactors, 3-phase
Spring-loaded
terminals
Overview
Selecting solid-state contactors
The solid-state contactors are selected on the basis of details of
the network, the load and the ambient conditions.
The following procedure is recommended:
• Determine the rated current of the load and the mains volt-
age
• Select a solid-state contactor with the same or higher rated
current than the load
• Testing the maximum permissible switching frequency
based on the characteristic curves (see “Technical Informa-
tion”). To do this, the starting current, the starting time and
the motor loaded in the operating phase must be known.
• If the permissible switching frequency is under the desired
frequency, it is possible to achieve an increase only by
overdimensioning the motor and the solid-state contactor!
Solid-state contactor for direct-on-line starting
The solid-state contactors for switching motors are intended for Benefits
frequently switching on and off three-phase current operating
mechanisms up to 7.5 kW and reversing up to 3.0 kW. The • Units with integrated heat sink, “ready to use”
devices are constructed with complete insulation and can be • Compact and space-saving design
mounted directly on SIRIUS motor starter protectors, overload • Reversing contactors with integrated interlocking
relays and current monitoring relays, resulting in a very simple
integration into motor feeders.
Application
These three-phase solid-state contactors are equipped with a
two-phase control which is particularly suitable for typical motor Use in load feeders
current circuits without connecting to the neutral conductor. There is no typical design of a load feeder with solid-state relays
Important features: or solid-state contactors; instead, the great variety of connec-
• Insulated enclosure with integrated heat sink tion methods and control voltages offers universal application
opportunities. SIRIUS solid-state relays and solid-state contac-
• Integrated mounting foot to snap on a standard mounting
tors can be installed in fuseless or fused feeders, as required.
rail or for assembly onto a support plate
• Variety of connection methods Standards and approvals
• Plug-in control connection • IEC 60947-4-2
• Display via LEDs • UL 508, CSA for North America1)
• Wide voltage range for AC control supply voltage • CE marking for Europe
Switching functions • C-Tick approval for Australia
8
The solid-state contactors for switching motors are “”instan- • CCC approval for China
taneous switching” because this method is particularly suited
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
1) Please note: Use overvoltage protection device; max. cut-off-voltage 6000 V; min. energy
for inductive loads. By distributing the ON point over the entire handling capability 100 J.
sine curve of the mains voltage, disturbances are reduced to a
minimum
Solid-StateContactors
Solid-State Contactors for Switching Motors
3RF34 solid-state contactors, 3-phase
3RF34 solid-state contactors, three-phase
3RF34 10-1BB
3RF34 10-2BB
For online configurator see www.siemens.com/sirius/configurators.
Solid-StateContactors
Solid-State Contactors for Switching Motors
3RF34 solid-state reversing contactors,
3RF34 solid-state – reversing contactors, 3-phase
three-phase
3RF34 03-1BD
3.8 1/10 1/4 1/4 1/2 3/4 2 2 110 ... 230 AC B 3RF34 03-1BD24 1 unit
5.4 1/6 1/3 1/3 1 1 3 5 B 3RF34 05-1BD24 1 unit
7.4 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 10-1BD24 1 unit
6
3RF34 10-1BD
For online configurator see www.siemens.com/sirius/configurators.
Accessories
3RA29 21-1BA00
8
Link adapters for solid-state contactor to overload relay
Link adapters
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
for direct mounting of 3RB3 overload relays or 3RR2 current
monitoring relays to the solid-state contactor with screw
terminals
3RF39 00-0QA88
The adapter is snapped onto the enclosure of the 3RF34 con- A 3RF39 00-0QA88 1 unit
tactor and receives the fixing hooks of the 3RB3 overload
relays or the 3RR2 current monitoring relays for direct
mounting.
Blank labels
Unit labeling plates1)
for SIRIUS devices
20 mm × 7 mm, pastel turquoise D 3RT19 00-1SB20 340 units
NSB0_01429b
3SB19 00-1SB20
1) PC labeling system for individual inscription
of unit labeling plates available from:
murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH
Overview
Function modules for SIRIUS 3RF2 solid-state switching devices
A great variety of applications demand an expanded range of The following function modules are available:
functionality. With our function modules, these requirements can • Converters
be met really easily. The modules are mounted simply by click- • Load monitoring
ing them into place; straight away the necessary connections • Heating current monitoring
are made with the solid-state relay or contactor. The plug-in con- • Power controllers
nection to control the solid-state switching devices can simply • Power regulators
remain in use.
With the exception of the converter, the function modules can be
used only with single-phase solid-state switching devices.
Recommended assignment of the function modules to the 3RF21 single-phase solid-state relays
Order No. Accessories
Converters Load monitoring Heating current Power controllers1) Power regulators1)
Basic Extended monitoring
Type current = 20 A
3RF21 20-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA13 -- 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF21 20-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF21 20-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- -- --
3RF21 20-1A.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- --
3RF21 20-1A.42 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA13 -- 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF21 20-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF21 20-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF21 20-2A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 20-2A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 20-2A.22 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 20-2A.24 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 20-2A.42 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 20-2A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 20-3A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF21 20-3A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF21 20-3A.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF21 20-3A.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
Type current = 30 A
3RF21 30-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF21 30-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 30-1A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 30-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF21 30-1A.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF21 30-1A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF21 30-1A.42 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF21 30-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 30-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
Type current = 50 A
3RF21 50-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF21 50-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
8
3RF21 50-1A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 50-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF21 50-1A.24
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
Recommended assignment of the function modules to the 3RF22 three-phase solid-state relays
Order No. Accessories
Converters Load monitoring Heating current Power controllers Power regulators
Basic Extended monitoring
Type current up to 55 A
3RF22 ..-1A... 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
8
3RF22 ..-2A... 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF22 ..-3A... 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Recommended assignment of the function modules to the 3RF23 single-phase solid-state contactors
Order No. Accessories
Converters Load monitoring Heating current Power controllers1) Power regulators1)
Basic Extended monitoring
Type current Ie = 10.5 A
3RF23 10-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA13 3RF29 16-0JA13 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF23 10-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 10-1A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 10-1A.12 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA13 3RF29 16-0JA13 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF23 10-1A.14 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 10-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA33
3RF23 10-1A.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 10-1A.26 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 10-1A.44 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 10-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-2A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 20-2A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
8
3RF23 40-1B.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 40-1B.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
3RF23 40-3A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 40-3A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 40-3A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 40-3A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF23 40-3A.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 40-3A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 40-3A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
Type current Ie = 50 A
3RF23 50-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 50-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 50-1A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 50-1A.14 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 50-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF23 50-1A.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 50-1A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 50-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
1) The use of power controllers/regulators is also possible on zero-point
switching versions for full-wave control mode. The generalized phase con-
trol mode is recommended only for the combination with instantaneous
switching versions.
Recommended assignment of the function modules to the 3RF24 three-phase solid-state contactors
Order No. Accessories
Converters Load monitoring Heating current Power controllers Power regulators
Basic Extended monitoring
Type current up to 50 A
3RF24 ..-1..4. 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF24 ..-2..4. -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF24 ..-3..4. 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF24 ..-...5. -- -- -- -- -- --
Function Modules
Converters
Overview Design
Converter for SIRIUS SC semiconductor switching devices Mounting
This module is used to convert analog drive signals, such as Simply snapping onto the 3RF21 semiconductor relays or 3RF23
those output from many temperature controllers, for example, semiconductor contactors establishes the connections to the
into a pulse-width-modulated digital signal. The connected semiconductor switching devices. The connector on the semi-
semiconductor contactors and relays can therefore regulate the conductor switching devices from the control circuit can be used
output of a load as a percentage. on the converter without rewiring.
Technical specifications
Control input for converter and load monitoring
8
3RF29 00-0EA18
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Function Modules
Load monitoring
Functions If a current greater than the residual current of the switching de-
vice is measured in the deenergized state, the device triggers a
The function module is activated when an "ON" signal is applied thyristor fault after the set time delay. This means that the fault
(IN terminal). The module constantly monitors the current level output is activated and the "Fault" ("Thyristor" 1)) LED lights up.
and compares this with the setpoint value.
Supply fault
Start-up If no current is measured in the energized state, the device trig-
Pressing the "Teach" button switches the device on; the current gers a supply fault after the set time delay. This means that the
8
through the semiconductor switching device is measured and is fault output is activated and the "Fault" ("Supply"1)) LED lights up.
stored as the setpoint. During this process the two lower (red1)) 1) "Extended" load monitoring
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
8/24 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category: SIRIUS SC
Solid-State Switching Devices
Special versions:
Overview deviations from the standard version
Heating current monitoring for 3RF2 single-phase solid- 3RF29 ..-0JA1.-1KK0
state switching devices
If the current is below 50 % of the lower teach current during the
Many faults can be quickly detected by monitoring a load circuit teach routine, the device will go into "Standby" mode; the LOAD
connected to the solid-state switching device, as made possible LED will flicker. The device thus detects a non-connected load,
with this module. Examples include the failure of up to 6 load el- e. g. channels not required for tool heaters, and does not signal
ements, alloyed power semiconductors, a lack of voltage or a a fault. This mode can be reset by re-teaching.
break in a load circuit. A fault is indicated by LEDs and reported
to the controller by way of a relay output (NC contact).
Application
The principle of operation is based on permanent monitoring of
the current strength. This figure is continuously compared with The device is used for monitoring one or more loads (partial
the reference value stored once during start-up. In order to de- loads). The function module can only be used in conjunction with
tect the failure of one of several loads, the current difference a 3RF21 solid-state relay or a 3RF23 solid-state contactor. The
must be 1/6 of the reference value. In the event of a fault, an out- devices with spring-loaded connections in the load circuit are
put is actuated and the LEDs indicate the fault. not suitable.
The heating current monitoring has a teach input and therefore
differs from the load monitoring. This remote teaching function
enables simple adjustment to changing loads without manual
intervention.
8
Sealable covers 3RF29 00-0RA88 10 units 0.001
for function modules (not for converters)
& Contactors
3RF29 00-0RA88 Solid-State Relays
Overview Application
Power controllers for 3RF2 single-phase solid-state switch- The power controller can be used for:
ing devices • Complex heating systems
The power controller is a function module for the autonomous • Inductive loads
power control of complex heating systems and inductive loads. • Loads with temperature-dependent resistor
The following functions have been integrated: • Loads with ageing after long-time service
• Power controller for adjusting the power of the connected load. • Simple indirect control of temperature
Here, the setpoint value is set with a rotary knob on the module
as a percentage with reference to the 100 % power stored as The power controller can be used on the instantaneously switch-
a setpoint value. ing 3RF21 and 3RF23 solid-state switching devices (single-
phase). If only the full-wave operating mode is used, the power
• Inrush current limitation: With the aid of an adjustable voltage controller can also be used on the "zero-point switching" solid-
ramp, the inrush current is limited by means of phase control. state relays and contactors.
This is useful above all with loads such as lamps or infrared
lamps which have an inrush transient current. Power control
• Load circuit monitoring for detecting load failure, partial load The power controller adjusts the power in the connected load by
faults, alloyed power semiconductors, lack of voltage or a means of a solid-state switching device depending on the set-
break in the load circuit. point selection. It does not compensate for changes in the mains
Special versions: voltage or load resistance. The setpoint value can be predefined
deviations from the standard version externally as a 0 to 10 V signal or internally by means of a poten-
tiometer. Depending on the setting of the potentiometer (tR), the
3RF29 04-0KA13-0KC0 control is carried out according to the principle of full-wave con-
trol or generalized phase control.
During the teaching process the connected solid-state relay or
contactor is not activated; i. e. no current flow takes place. No Full-wave control
current reference value is stored. No part-load monitoring!
In this operating mode the output is adjusted to the required set-
3RF29 ..-0KA1.-0KT0 point value changing the on-to-off period. The period duration is
No part-load monitoring! predefined at one second.
Generalized phase control
In this operating mode the output is adjusted to the required set-
point value by changing the current flow angle. In order to ob-
serve the limit values of the conducted interference voltage for
industrial networks, the load circuit must include a reactor with a
rating of at least 200 µH.
3RF29 00-0RA88
Function Modules
Power control regulators
Overview Functions
Power controllers for SIRIUS SC semiconductor switching Start-up
devices
Pressing the "Teach" button switches the device on; the current
This module provides similar functionality to a power control reg- through the semiconductor switching device and the mains volt-
ulator. age are detected and stored. The resultant output is taken as the
100% output for the setpoint selection. During this process the
The following functions are integrated: two lower red LEDs flash alternately. Simultaneous maintained
Power control regulator with proportional-action control for ad- light from the three red LEDs indicates the completion of the
justing the power of the connected load. Here, the setpoint is set "Teach" process.
with a rotary knob on the module as a percentage with reference The "Teach" button can also be used to switch on the connected
to the 100% power stored as a setpoint. In this way the power is semiconductor switching device briefly for test purposes. In this
kept constant even in the event of voltage fluctuations or a case the "ON" LED is switched on.
change in load resistance.
Inrush current limitation: With the aid of an adjustable voltage Setpoint selection
ramp, the inrush current is limited by means of phase control. The setting on the setpoint potentiometer (P) determines how the
This is useful above all with loads such as lamps which have an setpoint selection is to be made:
inrush transient current.
External setpoint selection
Load circuit monitoring for detecting load failure, alloyed power
semiconductors, lack of voltage or a break in the load circuit. At 0 % the setpoint selection is set via an external 0 – 10 V analog
signal (terminals IN / 0 – 10 V). The device is switched on and off
via the power supply (terminals A1 / A2).
Area of application
Internal setpoint selection
The power controller adjusts the current in the connected load
by means of a semiconductor switching device depending on a Above 0 % the setpoint is set using the potentiometer. To allow
setpoint. This compensates for changes in the mains voltage or this, the potential at terminal A1 must additionally be applied at
in the load resistance. The setpoint can be predefined externally the IN terminal. After removal of the "ON" signal, the switching
as a 0 to 10 V signal or internally by means of a potentiometer. module is switched off.
Depending on the setting of the potentiometer (tR), the adjust- Inrush current limitation
ment is carried out according to the principle of full-wave control
or generalized phase control. The ramp time (tR) for a voltage ramp on switching on is set with
the potentiometer for the purpose of inrush current limitation. If a
Full-wave control time longer than 0 s is set, the device operates according to the
In this operating mode the output is adjusted to the required set- phase-angle principle. If 0 s is set, there is no voltage ramp and
point by changing the on-to-off period. The period duration is the device operates according to the principle of full-wave con-
predefined at one second. trol.
In this operating mode the output is adjusted to the required set- If upon switching on with voltage applied the current flowing is
point by changing the current flow angle. In order to observe the not greater than the residual current of the switching device, the
limit values of the conducted interference voltage for industrial device triggers a load fault. The fault relay is activated and the
power systems, a choke rated at at least 200 µH must be in- "Load" LED lights up.
cluded in the load circuit. Thyristor fault
If a current greater than the residual current of the switching de-
Design vice is measured in the deenergized state, the device triggers a
Mounting thyristor fault. The fault relay is activated and the "Thyristor" LED
8
lights up.
Easy snapping onto the 3RF21 semiconductor relays or 3RF23
semiconductor contactors establishes the connections to the Supply fault
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
semiconductor switching devices. Because of the special de- If no current is measured in the energized state, the device trig-
sign, the straight-through transformer of the power controller gers a supply fault. The fault relay is activated and the "Supply"
module covers the lower main power connection. The cable to LED lights up.
the load is simply pushed through and secured with the terminal
screw.
Product Category: SIRIUS SC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/27
Solid-State Switching Devices
Overview Function
Power control regulators for SIRIUS solid-state switching Setpoint selection
devices
The setpoint is selected either internally using the right-hand
The power control regulator is a function module for the autono- potentiometer P with 0 ... 100 % on the module or externally
mous power control regulation of complex heating systems and through the analog input 0 ... 10 V.
inductive loads, for the operation of loads with temperature-
dependent resistors or long-term aging, and for simple indirect 100 % corresponds in full-wave control to permanently On and
temperature control. in generalized phase control to a conduction angle of 180° and
hence maximum power.
The power control regulator can be used on the 3RF21 and
3RF23 instantaneous switching solid-state switching devices When the setpoint is selected internally the module is controlled
(single-phase). If only the full-wave control mode is used, the through the IN terminal. The terminal 10 then has no function.
power control regulator can also be used on the zero-point-
switching solid-state relays and contactors.
180° 100
Application
Modulation
Conduction angle
%
The power control regulator sets the load current of the solid-
state switching device depending on a setpoint value as a
90° 50
percentage. Changes in the mains voltage or in the load resis-
tance are not compensated in this case. The modulation, the
On/off ratio or the phase angle, remains unchanged in accor-
dance with the setpoint. The autonomous power control regula-
NSB0_01693
tion is performed between 0 and 100 % of the setpoint value
0° 0
Full-wave control
< 0,1 5,0 V > 9,9
If the left potentiometer tR is set to 0 s (= far left), the power External setpoint of analog voltage 0 ... 10 V
control regulator works according to the principle of full-wave
control. The power set, be it internal or external, is converted into 0 50 % 100
a pulse-width-modulated digital signal. The power control regu- Internal setpoint of potentiometer P
lator controls the On and Off time of the solid-state switching
device within a fixed period duration of 1 s so that the specified Input characteristic curve
power is applied to the load. The "ON" LED flashes in the same
rhythm as the solid-state switching device switches on and off. When the setpoint is selected externally (potentiometer P set far
left = 0 %) the module is controlled by applying the analog
Generalized phase control voltage 0 ... 10 V. 0 ... 10 V corresponds to 0 ... 100 % power.
Conversion of the voltage is linear between 0.1 and 9.9 V. Below
If the left potentiometer tR is set to higher than 0 s, the power
0.1 V the switching device remains off; at voltages above 9.9 V
control regulator works according to the principle of generalized
the power is always set to 100 %.
phase control. With generalized phase control, a choke rated at
at least 200 µH must be included in the load circuit in order to Inrush current limitation
observe the limit values of the conducted interference voltage
for industrial networks. The ramp time (tR) for a voltage ramp on switching on is set with
the left potentiometer for the purpose of inrush current limitation.
The set time refers to a power of 100 %. If, for example, a ramp
Design time of 10 s is set and the selected power is 60 %, then a power
of 60 % is reached after approx. 6 s.
Mounting
Easy snapping onto the 3RF21 solid-state relays or 3RF23 solid- Line and thyristor monitoring
8
state contactors establishes the connections to the solid-state The power control regulator recognizes supply failures and
switching devices. Because of the special design, the straight- thyristor faults. The faults are indicated by the LEDs on the mod-
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
through transformer of the function module covers the lower ule and the fault output is activated.
main power connection. The cable to the load is simply pushed
through and secured with the terminal screw.
Solid-State Relays
3RF21 Solid-state relays – technical data
Overview
22.5 mm semiconductor relays
With its compact design, which stays the same even at currents
of up to 88 A, the 3RF21 semiconductor relay is the ultimate in
space-saving construction, at a width of 22.5 mm. The logical
connection arrangement, with the power infeed from above and
connection of the load from below, ensures clean installation in
the control cabinet.
Technical specifications
Type 3RF21 ..-1.... 3RF21 ..-2.... 3RF21 ..-3....
General data
Ambient temperature
during operation, derating from 40 °C °C -25 ... +60
when stored °C -55 ... +80
Site altitude m 0 ... 1000; derating from 1000
Shock resistance g/ms 15/11
acc. to IEC 60068-2-27
Vibration resistance g 2
acc. to IEC 60068-2-6
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
Emitted interference
• Conducted interference voltage Class A for industrial applications
acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
• Emitted, high-frequency interference Class A for industrial applications
voltage acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
Noise immunity
• Electrostatic discharge kV Contact discharge 4; air discharge 8; behavior criterion 2
acc. to IEC 61000-4-2
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Induced RF fields acc. to IEC 61000-4-6 MHz 0.15 ... 80; 140 dBµV; behavior criterion 1
• Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2/5.0 kHz; behavior criterion 1
• Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV Conductor - ground 2; conductor - conductor 1; behavior criterion 2
Connection technique Screw-type connection Spring-loaded connection Ring cable connection
Main contact connection
Conductor cross-section
Solid mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (2.5 ... 6) 2 x (0,5 ... 2.5) -
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (2.5 ... 6), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5) -
1 x 10
Finely stranded without end sleeves mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) -
Solid or stranded AWG conductors AWG 2 x (14 ... 10) 2 x (18 ... 14) -
Insulation stripping length mm 10 10 -
Terminal screw M4 - M5
• Tightening torque Nm 2 ... 2.5 - 2 ... 2.5
lb.in 18 ... 22 - 18 ... 22
Cable lug
• DIN - - DIN 46234
-5-2.5, -5-6, -5-10, -5-16, -5-25
8
• JIS - - JIS C 2805 R 2-5, 5.5-5, 8-5, 14-5
Auxiliary/control contact connections
Conductor cross-section mm2 1x (0.5 ... 2.5); 2x (0.5 ... 1) 0.5 ... 1.5 1x (0.5 ... 2.5); 2x (0.5 ... 1)
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
AWG 20 ... 12 20 ... 12 20 ... 12
Insulation stripping length mm 7 10 7
Terminal screw M3 - M3
• Tightening torque Nm 0.5 ... 0.6 - 0.5 ... 0.6
lb.in 4.5 ... 5.3 - 4.5 ... 5.3
Solid-State Relays
3RF21 Solid-state – technical data
Order No. Imax 1) Ie acc. to IEC 60947-4-3 Ie acc. to UL/CSA Power loss Minimum load Leakage current
at Rthha/Tu = 40 °C at Rthha/Tu = 40 °C at Rthha/Tu = 50 °C at Imax current
A K/W A K/W A K/W W A mA
Main circuit
3RF21 20-..... 20 2.0 20 1.7 20 1.3 28.6 0.1 10
3RF21 30-1.... 30 1.1 30 0.79 30 0.56 44.2 0.5 10
3RF21 50-1.... 50 0.68 50 0.48 50 0.33 66 0.5 10
3RF21 50-2.... 50 0.68 20 2.6 20 2.9 66 0.5 10
3RF21 50-3.... 50 0.68 50 0.48 50 0.33 66 0.5 10
3RF21 70-1.... 70 0.40 50 0.77 50 0.6 94 0.5 10
3RF21 90-1.... 88 0.33 50 0.94 50 0.85 118 0.5 10
3RF21 90-2.... 88 0.33 20 2.8 20 3.5 118 0.5 10
3RF21 90-3.... 88 0.33 88 0.22 83 0.19 118 0.5 10
1) Imax provides information about the performance of the solid-state relay. Note: The required heat sinks for the corresponding load cur-
The actual permitted rated operational current Ie can be smaller depend- rents can be determined from the characteristic curves,
ing on the connection method and cooling conditions.
page 4/10. The minimum thickness values for the mounting sur-
face must be observed.
Control circuit
Method of operation DC operation AC/DC operation AC operation DC operation
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
1)
Applies to the version "Low Power" 3RF21 ..-.AA..-0KN0.
2)
Only for zero-point-switching devices.
Solid-State Relays
3RF21 solid-state relays – technical data
8
3RF21 50-....53) 3NA2 807 -- -- 3NW6 205-1 5SB3 11
3RF21 50-...6 3NA2 807-6 -- -- -- --
3RF21 70-...25) 3NA2 817 -- -- 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 31
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
3RF21 70-...45) 3NA2 812 -- -- 3NW6 212-1 5SB3 31
3RF21 70-....53)5) 3NA2 812 -- -- 3NW6 212-1 --
3RF21 70-...65) 3NA2 812-6 -- -- -- --
3RF21 90-...25) 3NA2 817 -- -- 3NW6 217-1 --
3RF21 90-...45) 3NA2 812 -- -- 3NW6 212-1 --
3RF21 90-....53)5) 3NA2 812 -- -- 3NW6 212-1 --
3RF21 90-...65) 3NA2 812-6 -- -- -- --
Solid-State Relays
3RF20 Solid-state relays – technical data
■ Overview
45 mm semiconductor relays
The semiconductor relays with a width of 45 mm provide for
connection of the power supply lead and the load from above.
This makes it easy to retrofit existing semiconductor relays. The
connection of the control cable also saves space in much the
same way as the 22.5 mm design, as it is simply plugged on.
■ Technical specifications
Type 3RF20
General data
Ambient temperature
during operation, derating at 40 °C °C -25 ... +60
when stored °C -55 ... +80
Site altitude m 0 ... 1000; derating from 1000
Shock resistance g/ms 15/11
acc. to IEC 60068-2-27
Vibration resistance g 2
acc. to IEC 60068-2-6
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
Emitted interference
• Conducted interference voltage IEC Class A for industrial applications
acc. to 60947-4-3
• Emitted, high-frequency interference Class A for industrial applications
voltage acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
Noise immunity
• Electrostatic discharge kV Contact discharge 4; air discharge 8; behavior criterion 2
acc. to IEC 61000-4-2
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Induced RF fields acc. to IEC 61000-4-6 MHz 0.15 ... 80; 140 dBµV; behavior criterion 1
• Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2/5.0 kHz; behavior criterion 1
• Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV Conductor - ground 2; conductor - conductor 1; behavior criterion 2
Connection, main contacts, screw con-
nection
Conductor cross-section
Solid mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5); 2 x (2.5 ... 6)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5); 2 x (2.5 ... 6); 1 x 10
Solid or stranded AWG conductors AWG 2 x (14 ... 10)
Insulation stripping length mm 10
Terminal screw M4
• Tightening torque Nm 2 ... 2.5
lb.in 18 ... 22
Connection, auxiliary/control contacts,
screw connection
Conductor cross-section mm2 1x (0.5 ... 2.5); 2x (0.5 ... 1.0); AWG 20 ... 12
Insulation stripping length mm 7
Terminal screw M3
• Tightening torque Nm 0.5 ... 0.6
lb.in 4.5 ... 5.3
8
Main circuit
Rated operational voltage Ue V 24 ... 230 230 ... 460 48 ... 600 400 ... 600
• Tolerance % -15/+10
• Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 600
Blocking voltage V 800 1200 1200 1600
Rage of voltage rise V/µs 1000
Solid-State Relays
3RF20 Solid-state relays – technical data
Order No. Imax1) Ie to IEC 60947-4-3 Ie to UL/CSA Power loss Minimum load Leakage current
at Rthha/Tu = 40 °C at Rthha/Tu = 40 °C at Rthha/Tu = 50 °C for Imax current
A K/W A K/W A K/W W A mA
Main circuit
3RF20 20-1AA.. 20 2.0 20 2.0 20 1.7 28.6 0.5 10
3RF20 30-1AA.. 30 1.1 30 1.1 30 0.88 44.2 0.5 10
3RF20 50-1AA.. 50 0.68 50 0.68 50 0.53 66 0.5 10
3RF20 70-1AA.. 70 0.4 50 0.95 50 0.8 94 0.5 10
3RF20 90-1AA.. 88 0.33 50 1.25 50 1.02 118 0.5 10
1) Imax provides information about the performance of the semiconductor
relay. The actual permitted operational current Ie can be smaller depend-
ing on the connection method and cooling conditions.
8
Order No. All-range fuse Semiconductor protection fuse Cable and line protection fuse
LV design Cylindrical design LV design Cylindrical design DIAZED quick
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
gR/SITOR gL/gG/3NA 5SB
3NE1 10 × 38 mm 14 × 51 mm 22 × 58 mm 10 × 38 mm 14 × 51 mm 22 × 58 mm
aR/SITOR aR/SITOR aR/SITOR gL/gG 3NW gL/gG 3NW gL/gG 3NW
3NC1 0 3NC1 4 3NC2 2
3RF20 20-1AA.2 3NE1 814-0 3NC1 020 3NC1 420 3NC2 220 3NA2 803 3NW6 001-1 3NW6 101-1 - 5SB1 71
3RF20 20-1AA.4 3NE1 813-0 3NC1 016 3NC1 420 3NC2 220 3NA2 801 - 3NW6 101-1 - 5SB1 41
3RF20 30-1AA.2 3NE1 815-0 3NC1 032 3NC1 432 3NC2 232 3NA2 803 - 3NW6 103-1 - 5SB3 11
3RF20 30-1AA.4 3NE1 815-0 3NC1 025 3NC1 432 3NC2 232 3NA2 803 - 3NW6 101-1 - 5SB1 71
3RF20 30-1AA.6 3NE1 815-0 3NC1 032 3NC1 432 3NC2 232 3NA2 803-6 - - - -
3RF20 50-1AA.2 3NE1 817-0 - 3NC1 450 3NC2 250 3NA2 810 - 3NW6 107-1 3NW6 207-1 5SB3 21
3RF20 50-1AA.4 3NE1 802-0 - 3NC1 450 3NC2 250 3NA2 807 - - 3NW6 205-1 5SB3 11
3RF20 50-1AA.6 3NE1 803-0 - 3NC1 450 3NC2 250 3NA2 807-6 - - - -
3RF20 70-1AA.22) 3NE1 820-0 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 817 - - 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 31
3RF20 70-1AA.42) 3NE1 020-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812 - - 3NW6 212-1 5SB3 21
3RF20 70-1AA.62) 3NE1 020-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812-6 - - - -
3RF20 90-1AA.22) 3NE1 021-2 - - 3NC2 200 3NA2 817 - - 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 31
3RF20 90-1AA.42) 3NE1 021-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812 - - 3NW6 212-1 5SB3 21
3RF20 90-1AA.62) 3NE1 020-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812-6 - - - -
1) Type of coordination "2" acc. to EN 60947-4-1: 2) These versions can also be protected against short-circuit with
In the event of a short-circuit, the control gear in the load feeder must not miniature circuit-breakers as described on page 7/11.
endanger persons or the installation. They must be suitable for further
operation. For fused configurations, the protective device must be
replaced.
Solid-State Relays
3RF22 Solid-state relays – technical data
Overview
45 mm solid-state relays Important features:
• LED indicators
The 3RF22 solid-state relays with a width of 45 mm provide • Variety of connection techniques
space advantages over solutions with single-phase versions. • Plug-in control connection
The logical connection arrangement, with the power infeed from
• Zero-point switching
above and connection of the load from below, ensures tidy
• Two or three-phase controlled
installation in the control cabinet.
Technical specifications
• Cable lug -- --
- acc. to DIN 46234 5-2.5 ... 5-25
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
3RF22 Solid-state relays – technical data
Order No. Imax1) Ie acc. to IEC 60947-4-3 Ie acc. to UL/CSA Power loss Minimum load Max. leakage
at Rthha/Tu = 40 °C at Rthha/Tu = 40 °C at Rthha/Tu = 50 °C at Imax current current
A K/W A K/W A K/W W A mA
Main circuit
3RF22 30-. AB.. 30 0.57 30 0.57 30 0.44 81 0.5 10
3RF22 55-1AB.. 55 0.18 50 0.27 50 0.19 151 0.5 10
3RF22 55-2AB.. 20 1.83 20 1.58
3RF22 55-3AB.. 50 0.27 50 0.19
3RF22 30-. AC.. 30 0.33 30 0.33 30 0.25 122 0.5 10
3RF22 55-1AC.. 55 0.09 50 0.15 50 0.1 226 0.5 10
3RF22 55-2AC.. 20 1.19 20 1.02
3RF22 55-3AC.. 88 0.15 83 0.1
1) Imax provides information about the performance of the solid-state relay.
The actual permitted rated operational current Ie can be smaller depend-
ing on the connection method and cooling conditions.
8
• ON-delay ms 1 + max. one half-wave
• OFF delay ms 1 + max. one half-wave
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Solid-State Contactors
3RF23 Solid-state contactors– technical data
■ Technical specifications
Order No. 3RF23 ..-.A... 3RF23 ..-.B... 3RF23 ..-.C... 3RF23 ..-.D...
General data
Ambient temperature
during operation, derating at 40 °C °C -25 ... +60
when stored °C -55 ... +80
Site altitude m 0 ... 1000; derating from 1000
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-6 g 2
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
Emitted interference acc. to IEC 60947-4-3 Class A for industrial applications Class A for Class A for
• Conducted interference voltage industrial industrial
• Emitted high-frequency interference voltage applications; applications
Class B for resi-
dential/business/
commercial
areas up to 16 A,
AC51 Low Noise
Noise immunity
• Electrostatic discharge acc. to IEC 61000-4-2 kV Contact discharge 4; air discharge 8; behavior criterion 2
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Induced RF fields acc. to IEC 61000-4-6 MHz 0.15 ... 80; 140 dBµV; behavior criterion 1
• Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2/5.0 kHz; behavior criterion 1
• Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV Conductor - ground 2; conductor - conductor 1; behavior criterion 2
Rated operational voltage Ue V 24 ... 230 230 ... 460 48 ... 600 400 ... 600
• Tolerance % -15/+10
• Rated frequency Hz 50/60 Hz
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 600
Blocking voltage V 800 1200 1200 1600
Rate of voltage rise V/µs 1000
Solid-State Contactors
3RF23 Solid-state contactors – technical data
■ Technical specifications
Order No. Type current AC-511) Power loss at Minimum load Leakage Rated impulse I2t value
Imax acc. to UL/CSA Imax current current withstand
IEC 60947-4-3 capacity Itsm
at 40 °C at 40 °C at 50 °C
A A A W A mA A A 2s
Main circuit
3RF23 1.-.A..2 10.5 7.5 9.6 11 0.5 10 200 200
3RF23 1.-.A..4 200 200
3RF23 1.-.A.45
3RF23 1.-.A..6 400 800
3RF23 2.-.A..2 20 13.2 17.6 20 0.5 10 600 1800
3RF23 2.-.C..2 25 600 1800
3RF23 2.-.D..2 10 1150 6600
3RF23 2.-.A..4 10 600 1800
3RF23 2.-.C..4 25 600 1800
3RF23 2.-.D..4 10 1150 6600
3RF23 2.-.A.45
3RF23 2.-.A..6 10 600 1800
3RF23 3.-.A..2 30 22 27 33 0.5 10 600 1800
3RF23 3.-.A..4
3RF23 3.-.A.45
3RF23 3.-.A..6
3RF23 4.-.A..2 40 33 36 44 0.5 10 1200 7200
3RF23 4.-.A..4 1200 7200
3RF23 4.-.A.45
3RF23 4.-.A..6 1150 6600
3RF23 5.-.A..2 50 36 45 54 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF23 5.-.A..4
3RF23 5.-.A.45
3RF23 5.-.A..6
3RF23 7.-.A..2 70 70 62 83 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF23 7.-.A..4
3RF23 7.-.A.45
3RF23 7.-.A..6
3RF23 9.-.A..2 88 88 80 117 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF23 9.-.A..4
3RF23 9.-.A.45
3RF23 9.-.A..6
Order No. Type current AC-511) Power loss Minimum Leakage Rated impulse I2t value
Imax acc. to UL/CSA AC-15 at Imax load current current withstand
IEC 60947- capacity Itsm
Parameters
at 40 °C 4-3 at 50 °C
at 40 °C
A A A A W A mA A A2s
Main circuit
3RF23 1.-.B..2 10.5 7.5 9.6 6 1200 1/h 11 0.5 10 200 200
3RF23 1.-.B..4 50 % ED 200 200
8
3RF23 1.-.B..6 400 800
3RF23 2.-.B..2 20 13.2 17.6 12 1200 1/h 20 0.5 10 600 1800
3RF23 2.-.B..4
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
50 % ED
3RF23 2.-.B..6
3RF23 3.-.B..2 30 22 27 15 1200 1/h 33 0.5 10 600 1800
3RF23 3.-.B..4 50 % ED
3RF23 3.-.B..6
3RF23 4.-.B..2 40 33 36 20 1200 1/h 44 0.5 10 1200 7200
3RF23 4.-.B..4 50 % ED 1200 7200
3RF23 4.-.B..6 1150 6600
3RF23 5.-.B..2 50 36 45 25 1200 1/h 54 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF23 5.-.B..4 50 % ED
3RF23 5.-.B..6
3RF23 7.-.B..2 70 70 62 27.5 1200 1/h 83 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF23 7.-.B..4 50 % ED
3RF23 7.-.B..6
3RF23 9.-.B..2 88 88 80 30 1200 1/h 117 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF23 9.-.B..4 50 % ED
3RF23 9.-.B..6
1) The type current provides information about the performance of the semi-
conductor contactor. The actual permitted operational current Ie can be
smaller depending on the connection method and start-up conditions.
Derating acc. to curves from page 7/34, 7/35, 7/36.
Solid-State Contactors
3RF23 Solid-state contactors – technical data
Order No. All-range fuse Semiconductor protection fuse Cable and line protection fuse
LV HRC Cylindrical design LV HRC Cylindrical design DIAZED quick
design design gL/gG 10 x 38 mm 5SB
gR/SITOR 10 x 38 mm 14 x 51 mm 22 x 58 mm 14 x 51 mm 22 x 58 mm
aR/SITOR aR/SITOR aR/SITOR 3NA gL/gG 3NW gL/gG 3NW gL/gG 3NW
3NE1
3NC1 0 3NC1 4 3NC2 2
3RF23 1.-....2 3NE1 813-0 3NC1 010 3NC1 410 3NC2 220 3NA2 803 3NW6 001-1 3NW6 101-1 - 5SB1 41
3RF23 1.-....4 3NE1 813-0 3NC1 010 3NC1 410 3NC2 220 3NA2 801 3NW6 001-1 3NW6 101-1 - 5SB1 41
3RF23 1.-....6 3NE1 813-0 3NC1 010 3NC1 410 3NC2 220 3NA2 803-6 - - - -
3RF23 2.-....2 3NE1 814-0 3NC1 020 3NC1 420 3NC2 220 3NA2 807 3NW6 007-1 3NW6 107-1 3NW6 207-1 5SB1 71
3RF23 2.-....4 3NE1 814-0 3NC1 020 3NC1 420 3NC2 220 3NA2 807 3NW6 005-1 3NW6 105-1 3NW6 205-1 5SB1 71
3RF23 2.-....6 3NE1 814-0 3NC1 020 3NC1 420 3NC2 220 3NA2 807-6 - - - -
3RF23 3.-....2 3NE1 803-0 3NC1 032 3NC1 432 3NC2 232 3NA2 810 - 3NW6 107-1 3NW6 207-1 5SB3 11
3RF23 3.-....4 3NE1 803-0 3NC1 032 3NC1 432 3NC2 232 3NA2 807 - 3NW6 105-1 3NW6 205-1 5SB3 11
3RF23 3.-....6 3NE1 803-0 3NC1 032 3NC1 432 3NC2 232 3NA2 807-6 - - - -
3RF23 4.-....2 3NE1 802-0 - 3NC1 440 3NC2 240 3NA2 817 - 3NW6 117-1 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 21
3RF23 4.-....4 3NE1 802-0 - 3NC1 440 3NC2 240 3NA2 812 - 3NW6 112-1 3NW6 212-1 5SB3 21
3RF23 4.-....6 3NE1 802-0 - 3NC1 440 3NC2 240 3NA2 812-6 - - - -
3RF23 5.-....2 3NE1 817-0 - 3NC1 450 3NC2 250 3NA2 817 - 3NW6 117-1 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 21
3RF23 5.-....4 3NE1 817-0 - 3NC1 450 3NC2 250 3NA2 812 - - 3NW6 210-1 5SB3 21
3RF23 5.-....6 3NE1 817-0 - 3NC1 450 3NC2 250 3NA2 812-6 - - - -
3RF23 7.-....2 3NE1 820-0 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 817 - - 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 31
3RF23 7.-....4 3NE1 020-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812 - - 3NW6 210-1 5SB3 21
3RF23 7.-....6 3NE1 020-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812-6 - - - -
3RF23 9.-....2 3NE1 021-2 - - 3NC2 200 3NA2 817 - - 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 31
3RF23 9.-....4 3NE1 021-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812 - - 3NW6 210-1 5SB3 21
3RF23 9.-....6 3NE1 020-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812-6 - - - -
1) Type of coordination "2" acc. to EN 60947-4-1:
In the event of a short-circuit, the controlgear in the load feeder must not
endanger persons or the installation. They must be suitable for further
operation. For fused configurations, the protective device must be
replaced.
8
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 Solid-state contactors – technical data
Overview
The complete units consist of a solid-state relay plus optimized circuits with protective extra-low voltage (PELV) or safety
heat sink, and are therefore ready to use. They offer defined extra-low voltage (SELV) in building engineering. For other appli-
rated currents to make selection as easy as possible. Depend- cations, such as for extended personal safety, the heat sink can
ing on the version, current intensities of up to 50 A are achieved. be grounded through a screw terminal.
Like all of our solid-state switching devices, one of their particu-
lar advantages is their compact and space-saving design. With Version for resistive loads, "zero-point switching"
their insulated mounting foot they can easily be snapped onto a This standard version is often used for switching space heaters
standard mounting rail, or they can be mounted on carrier plates on and off.
with fixing screws. This insulation enables them to be used in
Technical specifications
8
• Cable lug -- --
- acc. to DIN 46234 5-2.5 ... 5-25
- acc. to JIS C 2805 R 2-5 ,,, 14-5
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Connection, auxiliary/control contacts
• Conductor cross-section mm 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.0) 0.5 ... 2.5 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.0)
AWG AWG 20 ... 12 AWG 20 ... 12 AWG 20 ... 12
• S tripped length mm 7 10 7
• Terminal screw M3 -- M3
- Tightening torque, NM 0.5 ... 0.6 0.5 ... 0.6
∅ 3.5 , PZ 1 lb.in 4.5 ... 5.3 4.5 ... 5.3
1) These products were built as Class A devices. The use of these devices in
residential areas could result in radio interference. In this case the may be
required to introduce additional damping measures.
Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 Solid-state contactors – technical data
Order No. Type current Rated operational current Ie Power loss at Minimum load Max. leakage Rated impulse I2t value
IAC-51 current current withstand
IAC-51 acc. to acc. to current Itsm
IEC 60947-4-3 UL/CSA
at 40 °C for 40°C for 50 °C
A A A w A mA A A²s
Main circuit
3RF24 10-.AB.5 10.5 7.5 9.5 21 0.1 10 200 200
3RF24 20-.AB.5 20 15 18 39 0.5 10 500 1800
3RF24 30-.AB.5 30 22 26 61 0.5 10 1200 7200
3RF24 40-.AB.5 40 32 35 81 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF24 50-.AB.5 50 38 45 105 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF24 10-.AC.5 10.5 7 9 32 0.1 10 300 450
3RF24 20-.AC.5 20 15 18 67 0.5 10 600 1800
3RF24 30-.AC.5 30 22 26 93 0.5 10 1200 7200
3RF24 40-.AC.5 40 29 35 121 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF24 50-.AC.5 50 38 45 160 0.5 10 1150 6600
1) The type current provides information about the performance of the solid-
state contactor. The actual permitted rated operational current Ie can be
smaller depending on the connection method and start-up conditions.
For derating see the characteristic curves on page 4/18.
Operating times
• ON-delay ms 1 + max. one half-wave 40 + max. one half-wave
• OFF delay ms 1 + max. one half-wave 40 + max. one half-wave
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
Technical specifications
Type 3RF34 05-1BB.. 3RF34 10-1BB.., 3RF34 05-2BB.. 3RF34 10-2BB..,
3RF34 03-1BD.., 3RF34 12-1BB.., 3RF34 12-2BB..,
3RF34 05-1BD.. 3RF34 16-1BB.. 3RF34 16-2BB..
H
3RF34 10-1BD..
D
Dimensions (W x H x D) W mm 45 x 95 x 96.5 90 x 95 x 96.5 45 x 95 x 96.5 90 x 95 x 96.5
General technical specifications
Ambient temperature
• During operation, derating from 40 °C °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Installation altitude m 0 ... 1 000; derating from 1 000 on request
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-6 g 2
Insulation strength at 50/60 Hz V rms 4 000
(main/control circuit to floor)
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
• Emitted interference according to IEC 60947-4-2
- Conducted interference voltage Class A for industrial applications1)
- Emitted, high-frequency interference voltage Class A for industrial applications
• Interference immunity
- Electrostatic discharge kV Contact discharge: 4; Air discharge: 8;
according to IEC 61000-4-2 Behavior criterion 2
6
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
- Induced RF fields MHz 0.15 ... 80;
according to IEC 61000-4-6 140 dBµV; behavior criterion 1
- Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2; at 5 kHz; behavior criterion 2
- Surge according to IEC 61000-4-52) kV Conductor - Ground: 2; Conductor - Conductor: 1; Behavior criterion 2
Connection type Screw terminals Spring-type terminals
Operating devices Standard screwdriver size 2 and Pozidriv 2 3.0 x 0.5 and 3.5 x 0.5
Conductor cross-sections, main contacts
• Solid mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5)3), 2 x (2.5 ... 6)3) 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (1 ... 2.5)3); 2 x (2.5 ... 6)3); 1 x 10 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 -- 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded 2 x (AWG 14 ... 10) 2 x (AWG 18 ... 14)
Conductor cross-sections, auxiliary/control contacts
• With/without end sleeve mm2 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.0) 0.5 ... 2.5
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 20 ... 12 AWG 20 ... 12
Permissible mounting positions ±10° ±10°
NSB0_01703
1)
These products were built as Class A devices. The use of these devices in
8
residential areas could result in radio interference. In this case these may
be required to introduce additional interference suppression measures.
2)
The following applies for reversing contactors: To maintain the values, a
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
3TX7 462-3L surge suppressor (see "3TB Contactors", Chapter 3) should
be used between the phases L1 and L3 as close as possible to the revers-
ing contactor.
3)
If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping
point, both cross-sections must lie in one of the ranges specified.
Solid-State Contactors
Solid-State Contactors
3RF34 Solid-state contactors – technical data
3RF34 solid-state contactors, three-phase
Overview
These two-phase controlled, instantaneous switching solid-state
contactors in the insulting enclosure are offered in 45 mm width
to 5.2 A – and in 90 mm width to 16 A. This means that it is pos-
sible to operate motors up to 7.5 kW.
Technical specifications
Type 3RF34 05-.BB.. 3RF34 10-.BB.. 3RF34 12-.BB.. 3RF34 16-.BB..
Fuseless design
with 3RV2 motor starter protector, CLASS 10
Rated operational current IAC-531)
according to IEC 60947-4-2
• At 40 °C A 5.2 (4.5) 9.2 12.5 16
• UL/CSA, at 50 °C A 4.6 (4.0) 8.4 11.5 14
• At 60 °C A 4.2 (3.5) 7.6 10.5 12.5
Power loss at IAC-53
• At 40 °C W 10 (8) 16 22 28
Short-circuit protection with type of coordination "1"
at an operational voltage of Ue to 440 V
• Motor starter protector, type 3RV20 11-1GA10 3RV20 11-1JA10 3RV20 11-1KA10 3RV20 11-4AA10
• Current Iq kA 50 5 5 3
6
1)
The reduced values in brackets apply to a directly mounted circuit breaker
and simultaneous butt-mounting.
Type 3RF34 05-.BB.4 3RF34 05-.BB.6 3RF34 10-.BB.. 3RF34 12-.BB.4 3RF34 12-.BB.6 3RF34 16-.BB..
Fused design
with directly connected 3RB3 overload relay
Rated operational current IAC-53
according to IEC 60947-4-2
• At 40 °C A 4 7.8 9.5 11
• UL/CSA, at 50 °C A 3.6 7 8.5 10
• At 60 °C A 3.2 6.2 7.6 9
Power loss at IAC-53
• At 40 °C W 7 13 16 18
Minimum load current A 0.5
Max. off-state current mA 10
Rated peak withstand current Itsm A 200 600 600 1 200 1 150 1 150
I2t value A2s 200 1 800 1 800 7 200 6 600 6 600
Circuit diagrams
DC control supply voltage AC control supply voltage
1 L1 3 L2 5 L3 1 L1 3 L2 5 L3
A1 + A1 ~
A2 - A2 ~
6
NSB0_01794
NSB0_01795
2 T1 4 T2 6 T3 2 T1 4 T2 6 T3
3/N/PE 50 Hz 230/400 V
L1 DC 24 V
L2 L+
L3
L-
N
PE
F4
F1 F2 F3
U
S1
K1 R1
1 L1 3 L2 5 L3
A1+
A2-
NSB0_01778
8
2 T1 4 T2 6 T3
F1 ... F4 Fuses
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
K1 Solid-state motor
M1 contactor
M M1 Motor
~ R1 3TX7 462-3L varistor
S1 "ON" switch
Solid-State Contactors
Solid-State Contactors
3RF34
3RF34 solid-state
Solid-state reversing
reversing contactors,
contactors – technical data
three-phase
Overview
The integration of four conducting paths to a reverse switch, width with the three-phase reversing contactors. Devices with
combined in one enclosure makes this device a particularly 45 mm width cover motors up to 2.2 kW – and those with 90 mm
compact solution. Compared to conventional systems, for which width up to 3 kW.
two contactors are required, it is possible to save up to 50 %
Technical specifications
Type 3RF34 03-.BD.4 3RF34 05-.BD.4 3RF34 10-.BD.4
Fuseless design
with 3RV2 motor starter protector, CLASS 10
Rated operational current IAC-531)
according to IEC 60947-4-2
• At 40 °C A 3.8 (3.4) 5.4 (4.8) 7.4
• UL/CSA, at 50 °C A 3.5 (3.1) 5 (4.3) 6.8
• At 60 °C A 3.2 (2.8) 4.6 (3.8) 6.2
Power loss at IAC-53
• At 40 °C W 7 (6) 9 (8) 13
Short-circuit protection with type of coordination "1"
at an operational voltage of Ue to 440 V
• Motor starter protector, type 3RV20 11-1FA10 3RV20 11-1GA10 3RV20 11-1JA10
• Current Iq kA 50 50 10
6
1)
The reduced values in brackets apply to a directly mounted circuit breaker
and simultaneous butt-mounting.
Circuit diagrams
DC control supply voltage AC control supply voltage
6
1 L1 3 L2 5 L3 1 L1 3 L2 5 L3
A1+ A1~
A2- A2~
A3+ A3~
NSB0_01776
NSB0_01777
2 T1 4 T2 6 T3 2 T1 4 T2 6 T3
3/N/PE 50 Hz 230/400 V
L1
L2
L3
N
PE
F1 F2 F3 F4
U
S1
K1 R1
1 L1 3 L2 5 L3 S2
A1~
8
A2~
A3~
NSB0_01779
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
2 T1 4 T2 6 T3
F1 ... F4 Fuses
K1 Solid-state reversing
M1 contactor
M
~ M1 Motor
R1 3TX7 462-3L varistor
S1 "Counterclockwise" switch
S2 "Clockwise" switch
Function Modules
General and technical data
Overview
Function modules for SIRIUS SC semiconductor switching The plug-in connection to control the semiconductor switching
devices devices can simply remain in use.
A great variety of applications demand an expanded range of The following function modules are available:
functionality. These applications can easily be met with Sirius SC • Converter
function modules. The modules are mounted simply by clicking
them into place; straight away the necessary connections are • Load monitors (basic and enhanced)
made with the semiconductor relay or contactor. • Power controller
Technical specifications
Type 3RF29 ..-.E... 3RF29 ..-.F... 3RF29 ..-.G... 3RF29 ..-.H...
General data
Ambient temperature
during operation, derating at 40 °C °C -25 ... +60
when stored °C -55 ... +80
Site altitude m 0 ... 1000; derating from 1000
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-6 g 2
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
Emitted interference
• Conducted interference voltage Class A for industrial applications1)
acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
• Emitted, high-frequency interference voltage Class A for industrial applications
acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
Noise immunity
• Electrostatic discharge acc. to IEC 61000-4-2 kV Contact discharge 4; air discharge 8; behavior criterion 2
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Induced RF fields acc. to IEC 61000-4-6 MHz 0.15 ... 80; 140 dBμV; behavior criterion 1
• Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 2 kV/5.0 kHz; behavior criterion 1
• Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV Conductor - ground 2; conductor - conductor 1; behavior criterion 2
Connection, auxiliary/control contacts,
screw connection
Conductor cross-section mm2 1x (0.5 ... 2.5); 2x (0.5 ... 1) AWG 20 ... 12
• Insulation stripping length mm 7
Terminal screw M3
• Tightening torque Nm 0.5 ... 0.6
Converter diameter of hole mm - 7 17
1) Note limitations for power controller function module on page 2/31.
Type 3RF29 ..-.E..8 3RF29 ..-.F..8 3RF29 ..-.G..3 3RF29 ..-.G..6 3RF29 ..-.H..3 3RF29 ..-.H..6
Main circuit
Rated operational voltage Ue V -1) 110 ... 230 400 ... 600 110 ... 230 400 ... 600
• Tolerance % - -15 / +10
• Rated frequency Hz - 50/60
Rated insulation voltage Ui V - 600
Voltage detection
Measuring range V - 93.5 ... 253 340 ... 660 93.5 ... 253 340 ... 660
8
Type 3RF29 2.- 3RF29 2.- 3RF29 2.- 3RF29 5.- 3RF29 5.- 3RF29 9.- 3RF29 9.-
.F... .G... .H... .G... .H... .G... .H...
Current detection
Rated operational current Ie A 20 50 90
Measuring range A 4 ... 22 4 ... 55 4 ... 99
Number of partial loads 6 12 - 12 - 12 -
Overview
Function modules for SIRIUS SC solid-state switching The following function modules are available:
devices • Converter
A great variety of applications demand an expanded range of • Load monitoring
functionality. With our function modules, these requirements can • Heating current monitoring
be met really easily. The modules are mounted simply by click-
ing them into place; straight away the necessary connections • Power control regulators
are made with the solid-state relay or contactor. The plug-in • Power controller
connection to control the solid-state switching devices can
simply remain in use.
Technical specifications
8
may require to introduce additional damping measures.
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Technical specifications
Period duration s 1
Auxiliary circuit 11–12
Switching voltage V 24 AC/DC AC 110
• Actuating current (utilization category) A 0.5 (DC-12) 0.5 (AC-12)
• Switching voltage, min./max. V 15 ... 30 90 ... 121
Continuous thermal current, max. Ith A 1 1
Characteristics
SIRIUS SC semiconductor relays
Dependence of the device current Ie on the ambient temperature Ta (Chart data for SIRIUS SC relays based on I max)
SIRIUS SC semiconductor relay with 20 A type current (3RF21 20/3RF20 20)1)
Min. thickness of the heat sink the relay is mounted to
4 mm
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
0
2 6 10 14 18 22 0 10 20 30 40 50 60
50
40
30
20
10
0
6 10 14 18 22 26 30 34 0 10 20 30 40 50 60
8
Min. thickness of the heat sink the relay is mounted to
4 mm 5 mm 8 mm
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 0 10 20 30 40 50 60
Dependence of the device current Ie on the ambient temperature Ta (Chart data for SIRIUS SC relays based on I max)
SIRIUS SC semiconductor relay with 70 A type current (3RF21 70/3RF20 70)
Min. thickness of the heat sink the relay is mounted to
4 mm 5 mm 8 mm 10 mm
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 0 10 20 30 40 50 60
100
80
60
40
20
0
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 0 10 20 30 40 50 60
Derating curves
SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactor with 20 A type current (3RF23 20)
8
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Derating curves
SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactor with 50 A type current (3RF23 50)1)
Solid-State Relays
3RF22 solid-state relays, 3-phase, 45 mm
Characteristic curves
Dependence of the device current Ie on the ambient temperature Ta (two-phase controlled)
s
3 mm 5 mm
100
M in W
e in A
Rthha
Module power loss
80 0,35 K/W
0,45 K/W
0,56 K/W
60 0,75 K/W
1 K/W
1,3 K/W
1,7 K/W
40
2,2 K/W
3 K/W
4 K/W
20
5 K/W
7 K/W
10 K/W
0
4 8 12 16 20 24 28 32 36 0 10 20 30 40 50 60
s
3 mm 5 mm
160
M in W
e in A
140
Rthha
Module power loss
0,13 K/W
120
0,18 K/W
0,25 K/W
100
0,37 K/W
0,55 K/W
80
0,8 K/W
1,2 K/W
60
2 K/W
3 K/W
40
4 K/W
5 K/W
20
7 K/W
8
10 K/W
0
5 15 25 35 45 55 0 10 20 30 40 50 60
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Device current e in A Ambient temperature a in °C
Solid-State Relays
3RF22 solid-state relays, 3-phase, 45 mm
s
3 mm 5 mm 160
M in W
e in A
140
Rthha
Module power loss
120
0,26 K/W
0,33 K/W
100
0,44 K/W
0,62 K/W
80 0,9 K/W
1,3 K/W
60 1,7 K/W
2,2 K/W
40 3 K/W
4 K/W
20 5 K/W
7 K/W
10 K/W
0
4 8 12 16 20 24 28 32 36 0 10 20 30 40 50 60
Device current e in A Ambient temperature a in °C
s
3 mm 5 mm
2 50
M in W
e in A
Rthha
Module power loss
2 00
0,06 K/W
0,09 K/W
0,15 K/W
1 50
0,25 K/W
0,4 K/W
0,6 K/W
1 00 0,8 K/W
1,1 K/W
1,5 K/W
50 2 K/W
3 K/W
4 K/W
6 K/W
8
0
5 15 25 35 45 55 0 10 20 30 40 50 60
Device current e in A Ambient temperature a in °C
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 solid-state contactors, 3-phase
Characteristic curves
Derating curves, two-phase controlled
14 26
24
12
in A
22
10 18
16
8
14
12
6
10
8
4
6
2 4
NSB0_01675
2
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 2 4 6 8 10 12
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current e in A
25 50
45
in A
35
15 30
25
10 20
15
5 10
NSB0_01676
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 4 8 12 16 20 24
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current ein A
8
Type current 20 A (3RF24 20-.AB..)
40
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
78
72
35
in A
66
Module power loss PM in W
30 60
e
54
25 48
42
20
36
15 30
24
10 18
12
NSB0_01677
5
6
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 6 12 18 24 30 36
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current ein A
Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 solid-state contactors, 3-phase
50 110
45 100
in A
80
35
70
30
60
25
50
20
40
15
30
10 20
NSB0_01678
5 10
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 8 16 24 32 40 48
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current ein A
60 120
55
in A
40 80
35
30 60
25
20 40
15
10 20
NSB0_01679
5
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 10 20 30 40 50
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current e in A
8
Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 solid-state contactors, 3-phase
14
36
12 33
in A
10 27
24
8
21
18
6
15
12
4
9
2 6
NSB0_01680
3
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 2 4 6 8 10 12
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current e in A
25 75
70
65
in A
55
50
15 45
40
35
10 30
25
20
5 15
NSB0_01681
10
5
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current e in A
Type current 20 A (3RF24 20-.AC..) 1) Identical current/temperature curves for stand-alone and side-by-side
installation.
8
40
110
35
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
100
in A
90
30
e
80
25 70
60
20
50
15
40
10 30
20
NSB0_01682
5
10
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 4 8 12 16 20 24 28 32 36
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current e in A
Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 solid-state contactors, 3-phase
50 160
45
140
in A
120
35
100
30
25 80
20
60
15
40
10
NSB0_01683
5 20
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 8 16 24 32 40 48
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current ein A
60 200
180
in A
140
40
120
30 100
80
20
60
40
10
NSB0_01684
20
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 10 20 30 40 50
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current e in A
Solid-State Contactors
3RF34 solid-state contactors, 3-phase
Maximum permissible switching frequency depending on the starting time ta and the ON period tED
Ia Ie = 7,2 Ib Ie = 1
10000
Operating frequency 1/h
1000
Starting time
ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s
NSB0_01780
ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s
For motors with a starting current of 4- to 7.2 times the rated current and with a full load
Ia Ie = 7,2 Ib Ie = 0,6
10000
Operating frequency 1/h
1000
Starting time
8
ta = 0,05 s
100
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
ta = 0,1 s
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s
NSB0_01781
ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t ON in s
For motors with a starting current of 4- to 7.2 times the rated current and with a 60 % load
Solid-State Contactors
3RF34 solid-state contactors, 3-phase
Ia Ie = 4 Ib Ie = 1
10000
Operating frequency 1/h
1000
Starting time
ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s
NSB0_01782
ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s
For motors with a starting current of up to 4 times the rated current and with a full load
Ia Ie = 4 Ib Ie = 0,6
10000
Operating frequency 1/h
1000
Starting time
8
ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s
NSB0_01783
ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s
For motors with a starting current of up to 4 times the rated current and with a 60 % load
Solid-State Contactors
3RF34 solid-state reversing contactors, 3-phase
Maximum permissible switching frequency depending on the starting time ta and the ON period tED
Ia Ie = 7,2 Ib Ie = 1
10000
Operating frequency 1/h
1000
Starting time
ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s
NSB0_01784
ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s
For motors with a starting current of 4- to 7.2 times the rated current and with a full load
Ia Ie = 7,2 Ib Ie = 0,6
10000
Operating frequency 1/h
1000
Starting time
8
ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s
NSB0_01785
ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s
For motors with a starting current of 4- to 7.2 times the rated current and with a 60 % load
Solid-State Contactors
3RF34 solid-state reversing contactors, 3-phase
Ia Ie = 4 Ib Ie = 1
10000
Operating frequency 1/h
1000
Starting time
ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s
NSB0_01786
ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s
For motors with a starting current of up to 4 times the rated current and with a full load
Ia Ie = 4 Ib Ie = 0,6
10000
Operating frequency 1/h
1000
Starting time
8
ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s
NSB0_01787
ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s
For motors with a starting current of up to 4 times the rated current and with a 60 % load
Dimension drawings
SIRIUS SC semiconductor relays
22.5 mm semiconductor relays
Screw connection Spring-loaded Ring connection
3RF21 .0-1AA.. connection 3RF21 .0-2AA.. 3RF21 .0-3AA..
45 mm semiconductor relays
3RF20 .0-1AA.
8
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Solid-State Relays
3RF22 solid-state relays, 3-phase, 45 mm
Dimensional drawings
Solid-state relays
47,5
69
77
69
95
NSB0_01689a
13 31 29 33 29
26 47 45
30
47
Schematics
Two-phase controlled Three-phase controlled
DC control supply voltage DC control supply voltage
1 L1 3 L2 5 L3 1 L1 3 L2 5 L3
A1 + A1 +
A2 - A2 -
NSB0_01696
NSB0_01694
2 T1 4 T2 6 T3 2 T1 4 T2 6 T3
8
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors
8
Terminal cover for SIRIUS semiconductor switching devices
3RF29 00-3PA88
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
8
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Solid-State Contactors
Dimensions
Dimensional drawings
Type current 10.5 A
47,5
100
69
90
77
95